A History of Anthropological Theory [6 ed.] 9781487507299, 9781487524982, 9781487535964, 9781487535957


840 100 15MB

English Pages [396] Year 2021

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Table of contents :
Cover
Half Title Page
Title Page
Copyright
Dedication
Contents
List of Figures
Preface
Timeline
Introduction
PART ONE: The Early History of Anthropological Theory
Anthropology in Antiquity
The Middle Ages
The Renaissance
Voyages of Geographical Discovery
The Scientific Revolution
The Enlightenment
The Rise of Positivism
Marxism
Classical Cultural Evolutionism
Evolutionism versus Diffusionism
Archaeology Comes of Age
Charles Darwin and Darwinism
Sigmund Freud
Émile Durkheim
Marcel Mauss
Max Weber
Ferdinand de Saussure
PART TWO: The Earlier Twentieth Century
American Cultural Anthropology
Franz Boas
Robert Lowie and Alfred Louis Kroeber
Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict
Zora Neale Hurston
Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whorf
The Development of Psychological Anthropology
British Social Anthropology
A.R. Radcliffe-Brown
Bronislaw Malinowski
E.E. Evans-Pritchard
Edmund Leach
Max Gluckman and the “Manchester School”
The Legacy of British Social Anthropology
PART THREE: The Later Twentieth Century
French Structural Anthropology
Claude Lévi-Strauss
Mary Douglas
Latter-Day Structuralists
STRUCTURAL MARXISTS
MARSHALL SAHLINS
The Legacy of French Structural Anthropology
Cognitive Anthropology
Ethnoscience and the “New Ethnography”
Cultural Neo-Evolutionism
Leslie White
Julian Steward
Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service
The New Archaeology
Cultural Materialism
Marvin Harris
Nature versus Nurture
Biology of Behavior
The New Physical Anthropology
Ethology and Behavioral Genetics
Sociobiology
The Symbolic Turn
Victor Turner and Symbolic Anthropology
Clifford Geertz and Interpretive Anthropology
Post-Processual Archaeology
The Influence of Symbolic and Interpretive
Approaches
Transactionalism
Fredrik Barth
Anthropology and Feminism
Political Economy
Marx and the World System
Sins of the Fathers
Ideology, Culture, and Power
Postcolonialism
Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age
Speech Acts and the Ethnography of Communication
Ethnolinguistics and Sociolinguistics
Postmodernity
Paul Feyerabend
Michel Foucault
Pierre Bourdieu
Anthropology as Text
Critical Medical Anthropology
PART FOUR: The Early Twenty-First Century
Globalization
Culture, Gender, and Sexualities
Public Anthropology
Development and Controversy
Distinguishing Public from Applied Anthropology
Debating Fieldwork Ethics and the Military
Serving a Global Public
World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology
National Traditions and the Dominance of Anglo-America
Collaboration with “Other” Voices
Anthropologies of the Digital Age
Anthropocene
Conclusion
What’s in a Name?
A Canon in Question
On the Other Hand …
Demystifying the Department
Colonial Texts
A Four-Field Future?
Histories to Come
Glossary
Sources and Suggested Readings
Index
Recommend Papers

A History of Anthropological Theory [6 ed.]
 9781487507299, 9781487524982, 9781487535964, 9781487535957

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

A History of Anthropological Theory

This page intentionally left blank 

A History of ­Anthropological Theory SIXTH EDITION Paul A. Erickson and Liam D. Murphy

UNIVERSITY OF TORONTO PRESS Toronto Buffalo London

© University of Toronto Press 2021 Toronto Buffalo London utorontopress.com Printed in Canada ISBN 978-1-4875-0729-9 (cloth) ISBN 978-1-4875-2498-2 (paper)

ISBN 978-1-4875-3596-4 (EPUB) ISBN 978-1-4875-3595-7 (PDF)

All rights reserved. The use of any part of this publication reproduced, transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, or stored in a retrieval system, without prior written consent of the publisher – or in the case of photocopying, a license from Access Copyright, the Canadian Copyright Licensing Agency – is an infringement of the copyright law. Library and Archives Canada Cataloguing in Publication Title: A history of anthropological theory / Paul A. Erickson and Liam D. Murphy. Names: Erickson, Paul A., author. | Murphy, Liam D. (Liam Donat), 1968–, author. Description: Sixth edition. | Includes bibliographical references and index. Identifiers: Canadiana (print) 2020041125X | Canadiana (ebook) 20200411330 |   ISBN 9781487507299 (cloth) | ISBN 9781487524982 (paper) | ISBN 9781487535964   (EPUB) | ISBN 9781487535957 (PDF) Subjects: LCSH: Anthropology – Philosophy – Textbooks. | LCSH: Anthropology – History –   Textbooks. | LCGFT: Textbooks. Classification: LCC GN33. E74 2021 | DDC 301.01 – dc23 We welcome comments and suggestions regarding any aspect of our publications – please feel free to contact us at [email protected] or visit us at utorontopress.com. Every effort has been made to contact copyright holders; in the event of an error or omission, please notify the publisher. University of Toronto Press acknowledges the financial assistance to its publishing program of the Canada Council for the Arts and the Ontario Arts Council, an agency of the Government of Ontario.

For Bethany and Jeffrey For Siobhan

This page intentionally left blank 

Contents List of Figures  xi Preface  xiii Timeline  xvii Introduction  xix

PART ONE

THE EARLY HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY 1

Anthropology in Antiquity 1 The Middle Ages 5 The Renaissance 8 Voyages of Geographical Discovery 11 The Scientific Revolution 15 The Enlightenment 19 The Rise of Positivism 22 Marxism 24 Classical Cultural Evolutionism 30 Evolutionism versus Diffusionism 37 Archaeology Comes of Age 42 Charles Darwin and Darwinism 47 Sigmund Freud 59 Émile Durkheim 63 Marcel Mauss 66 Max Weber 67 Ferdinand de Saussure 71

PART TWO

THE EARLIER TWENTIETH CENTURY 77

American Cultural Anthropology 77 Franz Boas 78 Robert Lowie and Alfred Louis Kroeber 82 Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict 87

Contents

Zora Neale Hurston 92 Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whor f  98 The Development of Psychological Anthropology 100 British Social Anthropology  104 A.R. Radcliffe-Brown 105 Bronislaw Malinowski 107 E.E. Evans-Pritchard 109 Edmund Leach  112 Max Gluckman and the “Manchester School” 113 The Legacy of British Social Anthropology 114

PART THREE

THE LATER TWENTIETH CENTURY 117

French Structural Anthropology  118 Claude Lévi-Strauss 119 Mary Douglas 122 Latter-Day Structuralists 123 Structural Marxists 123 Marshall Sahlins 124 The Legacy of French Structural Anthropology 126 Cognitive Anthropology  128 Ethnoscience and the “New Ethnography” 129 Cultural Neo-Evolutionism  130 Leslie White 130 Julian Steward 132 Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service 133 The New Archaeology 134 Cultural Materialism  136 Marvin Harris 136 Nature versus Nurture  139 Biology of Behavior 139 The New Physical Anthropology 141 Ethology and Behavioral Genetics 141 Sociobiology 142 The Symbolic Turn  146 Victor Turner and Symbolic Anthropology 148 Clifford Geertz and Interpretive Anthropology 151 Post-Processual Archaeology 153 The Influence of Symbolic and Interpretive Approaches 155

viii

Contents

Transactionalism 156 Fredrik Barth 157 Anthropology and Feminism  158 Political Economy  165 Marx and the World System 165 Sins of the Fathers 167 Ideology, Culture, and Power 169 Postcolonialism 171 Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age  177 Speech Acts and the Ethnography of Communication 177 Ethnolinguistics and Sociolinguistics 179 Postmodernity 183 Paul Feyerabend 185 Michel Foucault 186 Pierre Bourdieu 189 Anthropology as Text 191 Critical Medical Anthropology 195

PART FOUR

THE EARLY TWENTY-FIRST CENTURY 199

Globalization 200 Culture, Gender, and Sexualities  205 Public Anthropology  209 Development and Controversy 210 Distinguishing Public from Applied Anthropology 213 Debating Fieldwork Ethics and the Military 216 Serving a Global Public 218 World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology  221 National Traditions and the Dominance of Anglo-America 221 Collaboration with “Other”Voices 226 Anthropologies of the Digital Age  230 Anthropocene 237 Conclusion 243

What’s in a Name?  244 A Canon in Question  245 On the Other Hand …  248 Demystifying the Department  251 Colonial Texts  252

ix

Contents

A Four-Field Future?  253 Histories to Come  254 Glossary 259 Sources and Suggested Readings 287 Index 363

x

Figures 1.1 Adam and Eve 9 1.2 The New World 12 1.3 The Old World Meets the New 13 1.4 Noble Savage 20 1.5 Machine over Man 26 1.6 United States Senator Joseph McCarthy 29 1.7 Sir James Frazer 36 1.8 Culture Areas of North America 38 1.9 Kon-Tiki 42 1.10 Boarding Noah’s Ark 45 1.11 Grave Creek Burial Mound, West Virginia 46 1.12 Carolus Linnaeus’s Biological Classification of Humanity 48 1.13 Comparison of Ape and Human Skeletons 50 1.14 Charles Darwin’s Study at Down House, Kent, England 51 1.15 Feelings about Darwinism Run High 58 1.16 Freudian Humor 61 1.17 In Awe of Jesus Christ 70 1.18   74 2.1 Getting into Character  79 2.2 The Senior Franz Boas  80 2.3 Robert Lowie in His Library  83 2.4 Alfred Louis Kroeber and Friends  84 2.5 The Senior Alfred Louis Kroeber  86 2.6 Margaret Mead  88 2.7 Ruth Benedict  90 2.8 Zora Neale Hurston  94 2.9 The Sapir-Whorf Hypothesis  99 2.10 Alorese Youth Drawings  101 2.11 The Kula Ring  108 2.12 Participant Observation  109 2.13 Nuer Seasonality  110 3.1 The Totemic Operator  120 3.2 The Structure of the Conjuncture  126 3.3 Leslie White  131 3.4 Liminality 149

Figures

3.5 Turtles All the Way Down  152 3.6 Formal Gardens at Castle Bromwich Hall, West Midlands, England  154 3.7 American Anthropological Association (AAA) Presidents  163 3.8 Protesting the War in Vietnam  167 3.9 Robert Redfield  168 3.10 Cecil Rhodes Straddling Africa  172 3.11 Colonial Anthropologist?  174 3.12 Postmodern Challenge  184 3.13 Randle McMurphy Confronts Nurse Ratched in One Flew Over the Cuckoo’s Nest 188 3.14 The Perfect Physique  192 4.1 Stereotyped Tourist  201 4.2 Globalized Food  203 4.3 The Globalization of Language  204 4.4 Social Science on the Front Line  218

xii

Preface This book itself has a history – a narrative of our past that we have retold with each new edition. Some 25 years ago, Paul Erickson organized a session of papers presented at an annual meeting of the American Anthropological Association exploring the theme “Teaching the History of Anthropological Theory: Strategies for Success.” His own paper was a survey of courses in the history of anthropological theory taught at colleges and universities throughout North America. The survey revealed that such courses were widespread in both graduate and undergraduate curricula. It also revealed that, owing to the diversified and sometimes fractious nature of anthropology, there was considerable variation in the scope of the courses and the way they were taught. Especially noteworthy were the great variation in the texts used and, at the same time, widespread dissatisfaction with the suitability of these texts. A recurring complaint of professors was “We need a suitable textbook.” Shortly thereafter, Erickson and Liam Murphy began a rich conversation concerning the history of anthropological theory that marked the beginning of a sustained “dialogue with the ancestors.” Appropriately, this dialogue has been mirrored in the relationship between the authors themselves: Erickson, the professor, and Murphy, his erstwhile student, himself later turned professor. Over two decades, this dialogue has yielded the twin successes of six editions of A History of Anthropological Theory and its companion volume, Readings for a History of Anthropological Theory. In the beginning, A History of Anthropological Theory was broadly based on a senior-level undergraduate course that Erickson had been teaching for many years, a course in which Murphy himself was enrolled. As with any university course, this one had evolved through the incorporation of elements of various texts that Erickson had used on and off for years. These texts included Paul Bohannan and Mark Glazer’s High Points in Anthropology (1989), Peter Bowler’s Evolution (1989), Annemarie de Waal Malefijt’s Images of Man (1974), Bruce Trigger’s A History of Archaeological Thought (1990), and Marvin Harris’s The Rise of Anthropological Theory (1968) and Cultural Materialism (1979). Although the first edition of this book was not written from any of these authors’ theoretical perspectives, its presentation and interpretation in places may have been similar. Therefore, we are indebted to these authors for early inspiration and for an organization of material that worked in the classroom. The five subsequent editions of the book have had to keep pace with ongoing changes in anthropological theory. Gradually, what once was new became not so

Preface

new, and in some cases old enough to be put in historical perspective, especially as the profession became increasingly self-reflective and critical of its own theoretical past. In order to cover these developments, new writing, especially about the later twentieth century and early twenty-first century, was required. This task fell primarily to Murphy, because these were the years when he entered the profession and engaged with it formatively. The sixth edition of A History of Anthropological Theory, then, reflects the wisdom and personal experiences – as well, of course, as the theoretical predilections – of two authors who have been anthropologists for a total of more than 70 years, the last 25 of them overlapping. All these years of give-and-take between us have made this book better. The sixth edition of A History of Anthropological Theory has been truly significantly revised. A scan of the table of contents will reveal major organizational changes. While we have preserved the four main parts of recent editions, we have moved almost all of our discussion of French structural anthropology from Part Two, The Earlier Twentieth Century, to Part Three, The Later Twentieth Century, where it chronologically belongs. There are two exceptions: we have moved our discussion of Marcel Mauss to Part One, The Early History of Anthropological Theory, to accompany our discussion of Émile Durkheim; and we have retained our discussion of Edmund Leach in Part Two but situated it within our discussion of British social anthropology. Cognitive anthropology really began with Edward Sapir (1884–1939) and Benjamin Lee Whorf (1879–1941), so we have moved our discussion of these two theorists to Part Two and, in recognition of Sapir’s status as a prominent student of Franz Boas, situated it within our discussion of American cultural anthropology. Finally, along organizational lines, we have moved our discussion of culture and sexualities (renamed Culture, Gender, and Sexualities) from Part Three to Part Four, The Early Twenty-First Century, where these issues really came to the fore, while leaving our discussion of feminism and its effects (renamed Anthropology and Feminism) in Part Three, in recognition of the rise of feminism in the 1960s and 1970s. Some of these changes are overdue, but others have been enabled by our ability to put recent theoretical developments in better historical perspective. The upshot is that Part Two is considerably shorter, and Part Three considerably longer, than in previous editions. Reflecting the educational background of its authors, A History of Anthropological Theory launched under the umbrella of the traditional North American “fourfield” framework for anthropology as a generalized field comprising the specialized subfields of archaeological, biological, cultural, and linguistic anthropology. We acknowledge that there are alternative national frameworks for anthropology and that in North America the four-field framework has come under increasing strain. We address these issues at several places in the book. Most North American anthropologists are still cultural anthropologists, so we still concentrate on this subfield. Some critics have pointed out that we have continued to title the book A History of Anthropological Theory rather than A History of SOCIAL & CULTURAL xiv

Preface

Anthropological Theory. We now acknowledge that greater truth in advertising is called for, so in this edition, while retaining the same title, we have made a concerted effort to augment our coverage of archaeological, biological, and linguistic anthropology. We have inserted some new material into existing sections of the book and, in the case of linguistic anthropology, have created a new section in Part Three called Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age. And there is more. We have inserted other new material throughout and revised some whole sections, including The Middle Ages, Public Anthropology, and World Traditions in Anthropology (now re-titled World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology). We have also added a new subsection on “noncanonical” American anthropologist Zora Neale Hurston; added a new section on the Anthropocene; updated and expanded our Study Questions and Sources and Suggested Readings; and rewritten much of our Conclusion to keep pace with the current state of anthropology and the world in which it operates. When new editions of textbooks appear, among students and professors alike there is a certain amount of skepticism about the value of adopting them to supersede previous editions. With all the changes we have made in this edition, we believe it delivers good value indeed. It can stand on its own or be paired with the sixth edition of Readings for a History of Anthropological Theory. As with previous editions, this sixth edition is organized around particular historical periods, places, schools, and individuals. These choices are ours. Some might call them “canonical,” implying that they are rather old-fashioned or tainted by a legacy of sexism, racism, classism, and colonialism within anthropology. Be that as it may, until recently these have been major influences in anthropological theory. Much of recent theory has been devoted to exposing this canon and replacing it with something else. In order to fully understand this movement, it is important to preserve the memory of what came before – thus our “dialogue with the ancestors.” This book tries to preserve a balance between the canon and its critics and to explain the theoretical differences among them. Experience has taught us that students in history of anthropological theory courses are usually prepared with background in one or more of the anthropology subfields, but rarely in all of them. For this reason, we have attempted to write A History of Anthropological Theory in straightforward, non-polemical, and jargonfree prose. The book is also largely free of elaborate references to the voluminous history of anthropological theory scholarship, and we have made the strategic decision not to include footnotes, endnotes, or in-text citations in order to keep the text streamlined. Readers are directed to our list of follow-up sources and recommended readings to locate the provenance of quotations and other citations. We have, however, included birth and death dates for key historical figures, where such dates were obtainable. The majority of students in history of anthropological theory courses are there not by choice, but because the course is a department major requirement. A common lament of these students is the challenging xv

Preface

vocabulary of theoretical “-isms” and “-ologies.” To help ease their pain, we have attempted to define each challenging word the first time it is used meaningfully in the text and have provided key words that are bolded in the text and defined in the margins and glossary. The thought-provoking study questions should also help. Still, students should not be lulled into complacency. Learning (and teaching) the history of anthropological theory is challenging, although ultimately highly intellectually rewarding. Producing the sixth edition of A History of Anthropological Theory has been extremely gratifying to us, personally as well as professionally. As has previously been the case, we would not have enjoyed the process nearly as much were it not for the moral and professional support of many people. Paul Erickson wishes to thank his wife, Dawn Erickson, and Liam Murphy wishes to thank Terri Castaneda, Jacob Fisher, and Michael Walker, all colleagues at California State University Sacramento, for their very helpful thoughts and suggestions concerning new developments and writing. He also wishes to thank several anthropologists referenced in Part Four, who generously helped to fill in some of the proverbial gaps. This sixth edition is dedicated to Paul’s daughter, Bethany, and son, Jeffrey, and to Liam’s beautiful daughter, Siobhan. Both authors are also indebted to the staff of the University of Toronto Press, primarily for being such enthusiastic supporters of our work, but also for being extremely helpful and accommodating at all stages of the revision process. Special mention is due our new editor, Carli Hansen, and her associates, who have been “in our corner,” as well as the numerous anonymous reviewers who have provided valuable advice on how to improve the book. Finally, we are very grateful to colleagues, students, and interested readers who gave us feedback. Through six editions, A History of Anthropological Theory appears to still have legs.We hope that this edition finds new users to join loyal continuing users, allowing it to walk for some time to come. Paul A. Erickson Halifax, Nova Scotia Liam D. Murphy Sacramento, California

xvi

Timeline Timeline 1800



1700



1600



Voyages of Geographic Discovery

1500



The Renaissance

1400



1300



1200



1100



1000



900



800



700



600



500



400



300



200



100



0



100



200



300



The Enlightenment The Scientific Revolution

The Middle Ages

Anthropology in Antiquity



1810



1820 The Rise of Positivism



1830



1840 Marxism



1850 Archaeology Comes of Age



1860

Charles Darwin and Darwinism Classical Cultural Evolutionism



1870



1880



1890



1900

Evolutionism versus Diffusionism Sigmund Freud Émile Durkheim Marcel Mauss Max Weber Ferdinand de Saussure

Preface TIMELINE

– 1910

American Cultural Anthropology

– 1920

– 1930

British Social Anthropology

– 1940

– 1950 Cognitive Anthropology

– 1960 Cultural Neo-Evolutionism Transactionalism

French Structural Anthropology

– 1970 Cultural Materialism The Symbolic Turn Political Economy

– 1980 Nature versus Nurture Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age Anthropology and Feminism

– 1990 Postmodernity

– 2000

Globalization Public Anthropology Culture, Gender, and Sexualities

– 2010 World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology Anthropologies of the Digital Age Low Anthropocene

xviii

Introduction Key Words: American Anthropological Association (AAA), emergent, humanism, religion, science Anthropology is a fascinating field of study of all peoples past and present. Traditionally in North America, the field has been divided into four subfields.The first subfield, biological anthropology, has been concerned with the evolutionary origins and diversity of the species Homo sapiens. Biological anthropologists include paleoanthropologists, who study human fossils; primatologists, who study our monkey, ape, and related evolutionary “cousins”; and human geneticists, who study the underlying basis of human physical similarities and differences. The second subfield, archaeological anthropology, has focused on the study of artifacts, or the material remains of past human activities, from which archaeologists have attempted to piece together broader aspects of past cultures. Prehistoric archaeologists (in light of colonial interactions, sometimes called pre-contact archaeologists) have specialized in studying the artifacts of peoples without written records, while historical archaeologists have specialized in studying the artifacts of peoples with written records. Classical archaeology, the study of ancient literate civilizations, is a special case of historical archaeology. Archaeologists cooperate with a wide range of other specialists, including geologists, biologists, and historians. The third subfield of anthropology, linguistic anthropology, has been concerned with the nature of language in general and with the nature, history, and social function of the multitude of particular languages spoken and written around the world. The fourth subfield, cultural anthropology, has been the study of human lifeways and thoughts, often summed up simply as “culture.” Cultural anthropologists, the most numerous in the field, have specialized in studying one or more cultural groups and domains, such as Inuit art, Hopi religion, or Australian Aboriginal kinship. Taken together, these four subfields have given North American anthropology a uniquely “holistic,” or broad-based and overarching, worldview. North American anthropologists – in fact all anthropologists – are quick to assert that any statement about “human nature” must pertain to the biological and cultural nature of everybody. In recent decades, the traditional interests of anthropologists in all four subfields have shifted. A conspicuous trend has been their splintering into an increasing number of special-interest groups. Arguably, this trend began with the addition of a “fifth” subfield, applied anthropology, which emerged to accommodate the interests of anthropologists finding employment outside universities and museums and,

Introduction

American Anthropological Association (AAA) Founded in 1902, the AAA is the largest professional association of anthropologists in the world, with a membership of over 10,000.

slightly later, the addition of a “sixth” subfield, public anthropology, representing the large number of anthropologists engaged with public issues. At the same time, anthropology itself has become globalized by the recognition of other national traditions beyond those of the hegemonic United States, Great Britain, France, and, to a certain extent, Germany.These trends have continued to the point where, in 2020, the American Anthropological Association (AAA), the largest association of professional anthropologists in the world, was divided into some 40 special-interest sections. These sections have interests as diverse as those represented, for example, by the Anthropology and Environment Society, Association for Feminist Anthropology, Association for the Anthropology of Policy, Association of Indigenous Anthropologists, Council on Anthropology and Education, Society for Humanistic Anthropology, and Society for Medical Anthropology. In circumstances of such diversity, anthropology, prone to introspection anyway, was bound to question its holistic worldview and intensify its efforts to understand just what it stands for theoretically. “Theory” in anthropology stands for different things in different anthropology circles. By invoking broad, often unstated, definitions such as “general orientation,” “guiding principle,” and “intellectual framework,” anthropologists have been able to discuss theory without always having to articulate just what it means to themselves or to others. This has been particularly true in the “history of anthropological theory,” an established topic of anthropological discourse in which “original,” “important,” and “influential” theories and theorists become “canonized” simply by being referred to as original, important, and influential by a sufficient number of anthropologists over a sufficient period of time. They then form lineages of theoretical ancestors in which descendants position themselves to gain theoretical identity. In most North American colleges and universities, undergraduate anthropology majors and graduate students complete a course or course unit in the history of anthropological theory. The manifest, or explicit, function of this experience is to enhance the theoretical sophistication of students and to introduce them to theories and theorists with whom they might not otherwise become acquainted. Its latent, or implicit, function is to serve as a “rite of passage” in which new generations of anthropologists “join the club” by recapitulating its intellectual history. Unfortunately, many students today regard the study of past anthropology as a mere backdrop to “real” research. Still others dismiss it as a collection of naïve or erroneous perspectives or cautionary tales about anthropologists who never really understood human life. Approached as a “dialogue with the ancestors,” however, rather than “one dead guy a week” (these felicitous phrases come from William Fowler and Julia Harrison), the history of anthropological theory can be exciting, thought provoking, and moving. It can also be ethically troubling for both its explicit and implicit colonial associations. Yet the history of anthropology can also be humbling and can nurture respect, as “younger” anthropologists come to xx

Introduction

realize that they are heirs to an anthropological legacy that is, in the main, and especially contrasted with many alternatives, well intentioned. In the current climate of interrogating, deconstructing, and decolonizing the anthropology canon, it becomes more important than ever to understand just what the canon was, is, and could be. Any history of anthropological theory is written by a particular historian at a particular time, in a particular place, and in the context of particular social hierarchies and relations of authority and power – what some anthropological theorists have called a “historical moment.” Any self-aware historian aims to be truthful but cannot, of course, expect to achieve “the truth, the whole truth, and nothing but the truth.” This is because the historian must select elements from the past and put them together in a way that makes sense in the present, which is always changing (or “emergent,” to echo a term much used in recent theory).The inevitable result is that the historian’s analytical categories are actually imposed on the past, rendering, for example, certain early figures and ideas, but not others, proto-anthropological. By selecting certain past figures and their ideas and by interpreting them in light of subsequent events to which we know they (often unwittingly) contributed, the historian can help us understand how anthropology came to be. Nonetheless, readers of any history need to keep in mind that the historian is creating a past, not the past, and is certainly not merely discovering the past. From the analytic perspective adopted in the early part of this book, preprofessional anthropological theory can be considered to be a branch of science, humanism, or religion. The differences among these three systems of thought have to do with how they treat the relationships among nature, people, and a cosmological order of existence frequently conceived of as “God.” In science, people and God are treated as secondary to nature, which is paramount in the sense that nature encompasses people and God. In the science of biology, for example, people are considered to be composed of pre-existing natural elements such as carbon and water, while in the science of psychiatry, or at least some versions of it, God is considered as created by a pre-existing human brain. In humanism, God and nature are treated as secondary to people, who are paramount in the sense that people encompass both God and nature. Examples of humanism can be found in literature and philosophy, where “Man is the measure of all things” and “human nature,” especially creatively expressed, is the central fact of existence. Finally, in religion, nature and people are treated as secondary to God, who is paramount in the sense that God encompasses nature and people. A familiar example of religion is the Judeo-Christian belief, expressed in the Bible, that God created “Heaven and Earth” and, within a few days, Adam and Eve. While it may not be apparent in the twenty-first century, in its very early days, going back centuries, anthropology was, in terms of these definitions, variously scientific, humanistic, and religious. xxi

emergent In poststructural theory, the term suggests the fluid character of culture and consciousness – always in the process of becoming and never “completed.”

science A system of thought that prioritizes nature, contrasted with humankind and with a divine or metaphysical order. humanism A system of thought that prioritizes people, contrasted with nature and with a divine or metaphysical order. religion An integrated system of meanings and practices that seeks to connect humankind and nature with a divine or metaphysical order.

Introduction

Aside from these theoretical complexities, anthropology can be seen to be searching for answers to fundamental questions asked by people everywhere, such as “Where did we come from?,” “Why do we differ?,” and “How does the world work?” Confronting an avalanche of technical information in books, articles, and reports, anthropologists sometimes forget that these questions are universal and, therefore, that all peoples have their own versions of anthropology. Mindful of the decolonizing critique addressed in our Conclusion, the version relevant to most readers of this book is the one that developed in the history of “Western” civilization – more properly, European and Euro-American, although we employ both terms synonymously throughout the text.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Is it worthwhile to try to preserve the traditional four (or five, or six) subfields of North American anthropology? 2. Which definition of anthropological theory that you have encountered makes the most sense? 3. Why should you study the history of anthropology? 4. Can anthropology be religious?

xxii

PART ONE

The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Perhaps more than any other Western academic discipline, anthropology embodies the ambition of scholarship to understand the character of humanity in all its diversity and complexity. Such an understanding can hardly be achieved without an appreciation for the rich history of thought that is the foundation upon which various contemporary perspectives and theoretical orientations have been erected. For this reason, any thorough discussion of the origins of anthropology must begin long before the formal emergence of the discipline in the late nineteenth century. In common with all Western academic disciplines, the roots of anthropology lie grounded in the intellectual traditions of the Greco-Roman “ancient” world. Traced by the historian, this world reveals the first contours of what, in hindsight, can be called a nascent anthropological perspective.

Anthropology in Antiquity Key Words: Augustinian Christianity, cultural relativism, Sophistry, Stoicism, tabula rasa, transcendental essences In the West, beginning in antiquity a few centuries before the birth of Christianity, Greco-Roman civilization produced several Classical intellectual traditions.Today, following the account of Annemarie de Waal Malefijt in Images of Man, some of these traditions seem scientific, or at least quasi-scientific, while others, such as the epic poetry of Homer (c. eighth century BCE) and Virgil (70–19 BCE), appear

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Sophistry An ancient Greek school of thought that attached greater importance to practical skills and social effectiveness than to the search for objective knowledge and absolute truth.

more humanistic or religious. The roots of what most of us today would call anthropology can be found in the efforts at early Classical science. The first group of Classical thinkers with a semblance of science were those philosophers whose thought predates that of Socrates, teacher of Plato. The preSocratics were really cosmologists, who speculated on the origin and nature of the cosmos, or embodied world. Some of these speculations were materialistic, meaning that they invoked natural rather than supernatural causes. One such preSocratic was the Greek philosopher Thales (c. 640–c. 546 BCE), who speculated that everything in the world came from water. Another was Anaximander (c. 622– c. 547 BCE), a pupil of Thales, who said that the original substance of the cosmos was not a known element but “something boundless” and undifferentiated. A third pre-Socratic was Empedocles (c. 490–c. 430 BCE), sometimes called an ancient precursor of Darwin. Empedocles believed that the cosmos evolved as different constituent elements encountered one another and formed larger bodies that survived if they were useful, a process vaguely resembling natural selection. Finally, an extreme version of pre-Socratic materialism is represented by Democritus (c. 460–c. 370 BCE), who proposed that human bodies, minds, and behavior derived from changes in the shape, size, and velocity of constantly moving universal particles, or “atoms.” Like other pre-Socratics, Democritus opposed the idea of a human “Golden Age” from which people had allegedly deteriorated. Instead, he saw progress and betterment in the working of natural forces. Pre-Socratic science was not modern in our sense of the word, of course, but it was different from ancient humanism and from the religion in ancient Greek myths such as that of Prometheus, a primordial deity said to have made people out of clay and stolen fire for them from Mount Olympus. Pre-Socratic philosophers saw people as created by nature, not gods. Another ancient Greek tradition more scientific than religious was the tradition of travel writing, best represented by Herodotus (c. 484–c. 425 BCE), the socalled father of history. In his travels beyond the limited world of ancient Greece, Herodotus observed diversity in race, language, and culture. He explained this diversity in a relatively objective, or non-ethnocentric, way by correlating it with geography, climate, and other features of the natural world. Herodotus was also humanistic because he stressed how human differences were caused by human, not divine, acts. This combination of science and humanism, as opposed to religion, makes his writing a kind of ancient precursor of ethnography. In the fifth century BCE, there was a major change in Greek life when democracy in the city-state of Athens superseded the older political system based on kinship. This fundamental shift in politics was accompanied by a shift in thought, leading to new philosophical schools. One new school was Sophistry, which taught that practical skills and social effectiveness were goals more important than the search for objective knowledge or absolute truth. The Sophist Protagoras (c. 481– c. 411 BCE), to whom some attribute the phrase “Man is the measure of all things,” 2

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

believed that human behavior is not influenced by gods but by life circumstances. Behavior, then, is really cultural convention and should be seen as such – a doctrine not unlike the twentieth-century doctrine of cultural ­relativism. Protagoras also explained how various cultural conventions may have come about through an evolutionary-like process. For some Sophists, relativism led to nihilism, the doctrine that nothing exists or is knowable.They became nihilists because they felt that virtues were not absolute and that knowledge was merely what was said to be true by people in power – an idea that foreshadows a key part of the nineteenth-century doctrine of Marxism. Even in the fifth century BCE, broad anthropological ideas had begun to take root. Some important Athenian philosophers were opposed to Sophistry, however. Socrates (c. 469–399 BCE) taught that there were universal values, even though they were difficult to perceive and express. People had to train their minds for these tasks. Education was important, according to Socrates, because it enabled people to see through their cultural conventions, not merely manipulate them, as the Sophists advocated. Plato (c. 427–347 BCE), the famous student of Socrates, agreed with his teacher that there were such universal values, which existed because they were innate in the human mind. According to Plato, people recognize objects because, before they perceive them, they have the idea of them. His Republic (360 BCE) was a dialogue about an ideal society constructed on the basis of people’s perceptions of flaws in real societies. He reconstructed the development of society through time in order to show what had changed and what had not.What had remained the same were the transcendental essences of things. For more than two millennia, the enduring legacy of thinking in terms of Platonic essences encouraged physical anthropologists to view species and “races” as distinct and unchanging. Overcoming this legacy became a major challenge for twentiethcentury evolutionists. The philosopher Aristotle (384–322 BCE), Plato’s student, agreed that society had developed over time, but he was much more empirical than Plato, examining the development of society in its own right rather than trying to pierce through it to a universal, transcendental realm. Aristotle was curious about the relationships among natural and social objects, which he assumed existed and were knowable. Contrasted with Plato, whose idea of transcendental essences became incorporated into religion, the legacy of Aristotle included science, inherited through Alexander the Great (356–323 BCE), whom Aristotle tutored. When Alexander the Great conquered the Greek city-states and the Persian Empire from India to Asia Minor and Egypt, founding the Egyptian city of Alexandria in 332, the scientific teachings of Aristotle spread. Socrates, Plato, and Aristotle lived in the “Golden Age of Greece.” After Alexander the Great died, the unity of Greek life and thought declined, and competing schools of thought emerged. Epicurus (c. 342–270 BCE) pursued Empedocles’ belief that people comprised atoms, which were dissolved at death 3

cultural relativism The proposition that cultural differences should not be judged by absolute standards.

transcendental essences The concept of ancient Greek philosopher Plato that the pure ideas of objects are more real than the varied individual manifestations of those ideas.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

tabula rasa Translated “blank slate,” the idea that the mind acquires knowledge through experience rather than recognizes knowledge that is innate. Stoicism An ancient school of thought that believed that nature and society are intrinsically orderly, allowing particular societies to be compared and contrasted in accordance with universal principles.

and reabsorbed into nature. Epicurus was an extreme utilitarian in that he considered society to be a mechanical extension of humanity and therefore subservient to it. Later, the Roman poet Lucretius (c. 96–c. 55 BCE) expressed these views more forcefully in his materialistic poem On the Nature of Things. Meanwhile, the Stoics, like the Epicureans, wanted a correct and happy life, but, unlike the Epicureans, they believed that nature and society were highly orderly. According to the Stoic philosopher Zeno (c. 336–c. 264 BCE), this order was not created by people or gods but was a natural cosmic order, sometimes called Logos. This concept was later co-opted by early Christian theologians seeking to defend their beliefs against various schools of Greek philosophy. Belief in a universal social order made it possible to compare and contrast particular social orders, a fundamental task of what today we call social science. Furthermore, according to the Stoics, matter, not mind, is real; matter can be perceived; and learning is the perception of matter. Therefore, contrary to Plato, the Stoics believed in what was later called tabula rasa, or “blank slate,” meaning a mind that acquires knowledge through experience rather than recognizing knowledge that is innate. Stoicism was the philosophical bridge between the Greeks and the Romans, forming the philosophical basis for Rome’s great advances in political organization and theory. In Rome, the idea of a natural order was developed into the concept of cosmopolis, or world citizenry, by statesman and orator Marcus Tullius Cicero (106–43 BCE). At the same time, other Roman writers such as Seneca (4 BCE– 65 CE) and Marcus Aurelius (121–180 CE) used the concept to explore humanistic and religious themes, paving the way for its eventual attachment to Christianity. In both realms, secular and religious, Stoicism encouraged people to make their particular thoughts and actions accord with something universal while telling them that, as rational beings, they were capable of this achievement. Such a philosophy is one of the great legacies of antiquity. Toward the end of the Roman Empire, social conditions deteriorated, and several religions competed for appeal to the socially oppressed, all building on the Stoic idea of an overarching supernatural order in the universe. At first, these religions, or sects, were outlawed because they preached obedience to divine rather than civil law. Prominent among them were Mithraism; Orphism; the cults of Cybele, Isis, and Osiris; and Christianity. Outpacing the competition, Christianity gained converts and (ironically for a religion of the oppressed) became the state religion of Rome under Emperor Constantine I (Constantine “The Great,” c. 288–337). This action led in the fourth century to the Patristic period of Church history, during which time orthodox Church doctrine was established by Church “Fathers.” For anthropology, the most consequential Church Father was the Bishop of Hippo in northern Africa, Saint Augustine (354–430), author of Confessions (397) and The City of God (c. 425). The Augustinian version of Christianity was the version that prevailed when the Roman Empire declined and Europe entered the Middle Ages. 4

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Major tenets of Augustinian Christianity were not conducive to science, especially social, or human, science. According to Augustine, God was perfect and human nature was sinful. The cosmos and humanity were not in harmony. The cosmos had been created by an omnipotent, or all-powerful, God who was inscrutable, or unknowable.Therefore, it was pointless for people to study God or nature. Human behavior was to be judged not by people or nature but by God. Finally, everything people could know about themselves, nature, and God was revealed in Scripture. These tenets, designed to account for the mystery of God, had the effect of smothering human curiosity and the sense that nature, too, is mysterious. Without mysteries and the curiosity to solve them, why bother to develop science? On the positive side for science, and later for anthropology,Augustinian Christianity did stress the importance of history because it was from history, as revealed in Scripture, that Christians could learn at least something about God. Furthermore, Augustinian history was lineal, not cyclical or recurrent, and it was a universal h ­ istory, not just the history of “nations.” These tenets laid the broad foundation for the temporal and spatial, or cross-cultural, perspectives of anthropology. The legacy of antiquity to anthropology, then, was the establishment of the humanistic, religious, and scientific intellectual outlooks. In various guises, and in different times and places, these outlooks have persevered in anthropology ever since.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Did anthropology exist in ancient China? 2. Who contributed more to anthropological theory, the Greeks or the Romans? 3. Would anthropology have been better off without the advent of Christianity?

The Middle Ages Key Words: alchemy, first cause, medieval synthesis, subsidiarity, Thomistic Christianity In the period following Augustine’s death, the Western Roman Empire declined and was occupied by non-Christian “barbarians” and “pagans.” The Christian tradition continued to flourish, however, in the Eastern Roman, or Byzantine, Empire, with its capital at Constantinople, founded by Constantine I in 330 CE. 5

Augustinian Christianity The theology of Saint Augustine, which became the state religion of Rome and prevailed during the first part of the Middle Ages.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Thomistic Christianity The theology of Thomas Aquinas, which unified scientific, humanistic, and religious ways of knowing.

first cause A phrase from ancient Greek philosophy that signals the ultimate source of all causation (hence existence) in the universe. It was adapted by Aquinas and other medieval thinkers for Christian theology.

There, and in pockets elsewhere, monastic Christian historians and encyclopedists such as Isidore of Seville (c. 560–636) denounced non-Christians while they kept the teachings of Augustine alive. Meanwhile, the pre-Christian intellectual traditions of antiquity were sustained by Middle Eastern Semitic peoples who, following the birth of the prophet Mohammed (c. 570 CE), spread the Islamic religion out of Arabia, across northern Africa, and all the way to Spain. Contrasted with early Christians, who embraced the transcendental and otherworldly qualities of Platonism, Arab intellectuals such as Ibn Khaldûn (1332–1406) had great respect for Aristotelian logic and science. More forcefully than Plato, Aristotle counteracted Augustine’s scientifically negative attitude that people were incapable of knowing nature and that nature, except through God, was incapable of being known.When Islam and Augustinian Christianity interacted, Christian theology changed. The critical interaction between Islam and Christianity occurred in the eighth century when Islamic Moors invaded Christian Spain. Afterward, Christian theology became increasingly “rational,” meaning that human reason was brought to bear on theological issues. This trend culminated in the theology of Thomas Aquinas (c. 1225–74), author of Summa Theologica (1267–73), one of the great treatises of the Roman Catholic Church. Thomistic Christianity (as the theology of  Thomas Aquinas is called) differed radically from Augustinian Christianity. Unlike Augustine, Aquinas reasoned that people could, and should, know God through knowing nature. The true essence of humanity was not only sin but also the kernel of the divinity created within each human being. Human reason was a gift of God, and people were morally responsible to use this gift to glorify God by learning about God’s creation, the natural world. Human reason could even be used to prove the existence of God. In Thomistic Christianity, God, people, and nature were harmonized into a self-contained intellectual system without internal contradictions. Nothing people discovered about nature through the exercise of their God-given reason could cast doubt on the credibility and authority of God or on his representative Church on Earth – or so it was asserted. In order to keep Thomistic Christianity intact, it was necessary to ensure that science remained consistent with the Word of God. Scholarly apologists (pride of place is generally accorded Aquinas) interpreted the writings of Aristotle and Church Fathers in such a way as to harmonize a Judeo-Christian vision of Godhead with Aristotle’s theory of the “first cause,” or self-created divine being. Scholasticism, as the doctrine supporting this activity came to be called, predominated in the Middle Ages. It has been caricatured as “seeing how many angels can be fitted onto the head of a pin” – that is, a profitless exercise in “casuistry” and the spinning of imaginative explanations in general disregard of the troubling conditions of human life (to say nothing of scientific discovery and insight). It comes as no surprise, therefore, and as some keen observers have remarked, that the term medieval has itself come to be an uncritical byword for superstitious 6

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

and “enchanted” thought. At the risk of getting ahead of discussion to follow later, one astute observation offered by K. Patrick Fazioli (whose perspective we discuss in more depth in our Conclusion) is that this dismissive attitude toward the “medieval mentalité” – accepted by virtually everyone – reflects nothing so much as an implicit commitment among twenty-first-century anthropologists to the unilineal evolution of science and rationality from primitive to civilized, and (just as alarming) an oblivious disregard within the contemporary discipline for its own colonial and ethnocentric reasoning: a logic that viewed the Middle Ages (together with its “natives”) as thoroughly unenlightened. It was imagined, to echo an insufficiently scrutinized truism, to be an epoch in which all the critical thought and proto-scientific imagination fashioned in antiquity were all but eclipsed in Europe. It is clear to specialist historians who have studied scholasticism, however, that the intellectual unity achieved by Thomistic Christianity – a “medieval ­synthesis” that unified the three elements whose varied relationships define science, humanism, and religion – was, no less than the philosophies of antiquity, a work of refined intellectual accomplishment. Among other things, the synthesis furnished a justification and rationalization of the rank ordering of authority and power in medieval societies. As dominion and sovereignty were God’s alone in the universe, this should be reflected in (indeed, mirrored by) the hierarchical structure of authority in medieval monarchies and the Papacy; or, according to a medieval phrase made famous in discussion not of religious orthodoxy but of occultism and alchemy, “as above, so below.” Central to this perspective was a principle of Church governance – subsidium, or subsidiarity – that is still embedded in liberal-democratic statecraft today. Subsidiarity advances the theory that authority should always be exercised locally (for instance, by priests and bishops, sheriffs and feudal lords) except in cases of tasks that can be overseen and performed only at a “higher” level (for instance, by kings and popes). Although human beings were certainly viewed as flawed by dint of their sinful natures, the influence of Plato and Aristotle, especially, encouraged a deeper reflection on the universe as a multifaceted expression of God’s profound creativity that human beings were well positioned to explore. “Science,” in this triad, was largely imagined as a form of intellectual discipline and reasoning in the Aristotelian tradition (although, as noted by Fazioli among others, this definition fails to take into account what would later be considered empirical exploration, discovery, and experimentation). Still, and however slighted the era’s key figures and works have been by anthropological histories (including earlier editions of this text), the medieval fusion perhaps inevitably gave way to events in the wider world. In particular, three complex events produced knowledge that, outside Thomistic circles, made the synthesis unravel. These events were the Renaissance, voyages of geographical discovery, and the Scientific Revolution, each of which shaped modern anthropology in critically important ways. 7

medieval synthesis  A perspective on the natural universe that attempted to harmonize faith and reason by fusing philosophical ideas from GrecoRoman antiquity with medieval Christian theology and concern for the allocation of authority (in both human society and the cosmos more generally). alchemy An array of medieval experimental practices intended to transform matter from one state of being to another (for instance, lead into gold). In this way, alchemy foreshadowed modern chemistry. subsidiarity A social and political principle, embedded in many modern nation-states, according to which authority should be exercised at the local level except in situations that only a higher level of authority can address.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How did medieval theologians present the relationship between human beings and God, and how does this differ from the modern perspective? 2. What is the “first cause,” and how did it unite medieval theologians with ancient Greek philosophy? 3. Could there be an Islamic anthropology?

The Renaissance Key Words: cross-cultural analysis, original sin The Renaissance, a revival of interest in ancient learning, marks the transition from the medieval to the modern world. The key developments took place from the fourteenth through the sixteenth centuries in the nuclear city-states of Western Europe, especially northern Italy. There, wealthy mercantilists and other members of the prospering middle class began to spend their money as “patrons” of artists and scientists who were unwilling to accept limits placed by the Church on their intellectual and creative freedom. The archetypical “Renaissance Man” was the Italian painter, sculptor, architect, musician, engineer, and mathematician Leonardo da Vinci (1452–1519). Like other creative geniuses of the Renaissance, da Vinci was enamored of the ancient world because it represented a pre-Christian source of knowledge and values. In Italy, the rediscovery of Roman antiquity was especially exhilarating because Rome was part of Italy’s own “glorious past.” Curiosity about the ancient world also produced Classical archaeology, which developed during the Renaissance as an effort to use Classical artifacts to supplement what was written in Classical texts.Today, Classical archaeology is more peripheral to anthropology than is prehistoric archaeology, which did not come into its own until the nineteenth century.There are three key differences between these two archaeologies. First, while Classical archaeologists deal with cultures only a few thousand years old, prehistoric archaeologists deal with cultures much older, in some cases millions of years old. Second, unlike prehistoric cultures, Classical cultures, such as those of Rome, Egypt, Greece, and Mesopotamia, were literate, leaving behind written records to help archaeologists interpret the features and artifacts they discover.Third, and most apparent to the legions of people fascinated by Classical archaeology, many Classical features and artifacts were monumental and showy, in some cases worth a great deal of money. It is this “flash” appeal of Classical archaeology that has made Heinrich Schliemann (1822–90), the excavator of Troy, and Howard Carter (1874–1939), the discoverer of King Tut’s tomb, household names. Flash appeal, coupled with romance and a sense of adventure, also account for why the fictional character Indiana Jones, portrayed by 8

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.1  Adam and Eve: This Renaissance engraving (1504) by Albrecht Dürer (1471–1528) depicts Adam and Eve being expelled from the Garden of Eden, an act of profound consequence in the Judeo-Christian account of human creation. © Private Collection/ Bridgeman Images.

actor Harrison Ford in a series of hugely popular movies going back to the 1980s, remains, to the chagrin of professional archaeologists, the single most popular stereotype of what an archaeologist is. In the early twenty-first century, although they share certain technologies and techniques of excavation and interpretation, Classical archaeologists and prehistoric archaeologists rarely occupy the same academic department. Nevertheless, they both use, and have always used, what they learn about the past to reflect on circumstances in the present. Aided by Classical archaeology, Renaissance thinkers came to realize that the ancients possessed a fuller and more satisfying grasp of human nature than did the austere Christians of the Middle Ages. 9

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

original sin The Christian idea that early sin resulted in the expulsion of humanity from the Garden of Eden.

cross-cultural analysis Analysis of similarities and differences across cultures.

Renaissance interest in the ancient world produced a new sense of time, which no longer seemed static but instead capable of producing change – change as dramatic as that represented by the difference between the ancient and medieval worlds. This realization led to a systematic contrast of ancient and medieval ways of life and, in turn, to a questioning of the authority of the medieval Catholic Church based on a preference for secular alternatives from the past. In the history of religion, this trend contributed to the Protestant reform movements of the sixteenth century, many of which stressed the “priesthood of all believers” and the importance of rationality in religious experience and practice. In the histories of humanism and science, the trend continued to broaden the secularization of thinking, paving the way for the emergence of the modern tradition of scholarly social criticism and analysis. Three influential social critics and analysts inspired by the Renaissance outlook were Desiderius Erasmus (c. 1466–1536), Thomas More (1478–1535), and Niccolò Machiavelli (1469–1527). In The Praise of Folly (1509), the Dutchman Erasmus opposed the idea of original sin, arguing that Greek virtues incorporated into early Christianity were superior to virtues espoused by later Christianity, which had grown excessively formal, bureaucratic, and corrupt. His highly irreverent book poked fun at the perceived stupidity, greed, and hypocrisy of priests and monks. In Utopia (1516), the Englishman More contrasted the evils of contemporary society with the virtues of a society constructed on secular principles and based on ethnographic accounts of “simpler” peoples, whose lives were happier because they lacked private property, money, and crime. In The Prince (1513), the Italian Machiavelli described the qualities of an effective political ruler, who must be strong, intelligent, and wise enough to understand the good and bad parts of human nature. All three of these influential Renaissance thinkers show that by the early sixteenth century there had emerged a strong tradition of secular social analysis that later, in anthropology, would become cross-cultural analysis. An important Renaissance legacy to anthropology was this secular, critical approach. In the postmodern era, anthropology also revived some of its ties to Renaissance-inspired humanities, as both theorists and practitioners turned away from science in favor of more creative, expressive, and even artistic styles of description and analysis.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Some people today are critical of what they call secular humanism. In the context of the Renaissance, what does this term mean? 2. What universal standards can anthropologists use to compare and contrast cultures? 3. In a world of limited resources, what archaeological sites should be given top priority for investigation?

10

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Voyages of Geographical Discovery Key Words: antipodes, monogenesis, natural children, natural slaves, Other, polygenesis During the late Roman imperial period, Saint Augustine pronounced that “No antipodes exist.” Antipodes were places on opposite sides of the world, together with the people who lived there. In making this pronouncement, Augustine was expressing the view, widely held at the time, that most parts of the world had already been discovered and that nothing dramatically different remained to be found. He was mistaken. Between Roman and early modern times, enough geographical exploration had taken place to bring Europeans into contact with peoples sufficiently different from themselves as to raise the question of whether they were even human. European exploration began in earnest with the eleventh-century Christian crusades to Africa and parts of the Middle East. Exploration expanded in the thirteenth century when the Mongols conquered much of the Holy Roman Empire in central and eastern Europe. One of the most famous European explorers was the Venetian Marco Polo (c. 1254–c. 1324), who spent 17 years in China at the court of the Mongol ruler Kublai Khan. Intense competition for profitable trade routes to Asia spurred further exploration by Portugal and Spain. By 1499, Vasco da Gama (c. 1469–1524) found his way around Africa to India, while a few years earlier, in 1492, seeking the same destination, Christopher Columbus (c. 1446–1506) “discovered” the “New World.” When Vasco Núñez de Balboa (c. 1475–1517) sailed around South America and reached the Pacific Ocean in 1513, it became clear that the New World was in fact new (to Europeans).The first round of European exploration was concluded by Ferdinand Magellan (c. 1480– 1521), one of whose ships circumnavigated the globe in 1522. Initially, European opinions of non-European Indigenous peoples presented a major challenge to the medieval synthesis of God, people, and nature. To Europeans, the Indigenous peoples, especially the “Indian” Natives of the New World, appeared extraordinarily different, far too primitive and savage to belong to a single family of God’s creation. Thomas Aquinas, who knew something about human diversity, had pronounced that Indigenous peoples were imperfect humans and, therefore, natural slaves to Europeans. At the time, this pronouncement seemed plausible, but problems with it quickly arose. Imperfect natural slaves lacked the mental and moral capacity for free agency, or the ability to make a conscious choice. Without free agency, Indigenous peoples could not make a valid conversion to Christianity as a means of achieving salvation. Therefore, they were denied the kingdom of God, rendering the efforts of missionaries futile. Christian theology had to change, and it did. The influential Spanish theologians Bartolomé de Las Casas (1474–1566) and José de Acosta (c. 1539–1600) 11

antipodes Opposites, or peoples on opposite sides of the world.

natural slaves The early theological conception of “primitive” peoples as innately imperfect and subservient to European Christians.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.2  The New World: This seventeenth-century map depicts the New World as the Island of Atlantis. From Winsor, Justin. Narrative and Critical History of America. Volume I. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1889. Copyright © 1889 by Houghton Mifflin Company.

natural children The early theological conception of “primitive” peoples as capable of “improvement” and conversion to Christianity.

redefined natural slaves as natural children, allowing benevolence to “save” them and make them civilized Christians. An important consequence of this redefinition, in theological terms, was to bring the human family closer together. But if all the peoples of the world were to belong to the same family, should they not be historically connected? The Protestant Reformation had made the Bible the sole authority on history for much of Christian Europe. A few biblical passages did imply historical connections among different peoples – for example, through Adam and Eve, the sons of Noah, and tribes dispersed after the destruction of the 12

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.3  The Old World Meets the New: In this image, early-sixteenthcentury Spanish soldiers are besieging the Aztec capital of Tenochtitlán. Tlaxcala, Lienzo de. “The Burning of the Idols by Hernan Cortes.” Illustration from a facsimile of a Mexican Indian picture history of c. 1550, 1892 (color engraving), Mexican School, 19th century. © Private Collection/ Archives Charmet/Bridgeman Images.

Tower of Babel. By and large, however, biblical support for the idea that all the peoples of the world were God’s children was scant and, in some circles, insufficient. Additional support was needed. In the period from the sixteenth through the eighteenth centuries, several ingenious schemes were designed to show that Europeans were historically connected to non-Europeans, especially to Indigenous peoples in America, with whom, following the colonization of America, Europeans were forced to interact. According to one scheme, Indigenous peoples were descendants of survivors of the sunken continent of Atlantis, a relationship purportedly demonstrated by cultural similarities between Europeans and the Incas and Aztecs. Another scheme made Indigenous peoples one of the ten Lost Tribes of Israel, while yet another, foreshadowing the modern scientific view, had them immigrating to America from northern Asia across the Bering Strait. Gradually, these schemes, inspired by the desire to reconcile natural observations with Christian theology, became more “scientific.” In anthropology, they led to monogenesis, the doctrine that human “races” constitute a single biological species with a common origin and physical differences produced by natural agents over time. Later, monogenesis faced stiff competition from polygenesis, 13

monogenesis The doctrine that human races constitute a single biological species with a common origin and with differences produced over time; contrasted with polygenesis. polygenesis The doctrine that human races constitute separate species with separate origins and innate differences; contrasted with monogenesis.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

the doctrine that human races constitute distinct species with separate origins and physical differences that are unalterable and racially innate. Debate between monogenists and polygenists was at times intense, reaching its peak in the heyday of classical nineteenth-century anthropology. Around that time, nearing the end of African-American slavery in the United States, defenders of slavery cited polygenesis in defense of their position, while critics of slavery, or abolitionists, cited monogenesis. Debate between polygenists and monogenists also invoked craniology, the study of human skulls. Polygenists argued that the skulls, and therefore the brains, of different races had not changed over time, while monogenists argued that they had indeed changed. Still, monogenists were scarcely racially egalitarian, and even in the twenty-first century, many biblically inspired Christians believe that three different racial groups have descended from the three sons of Noah: Europeans from Japheth, Asians from Shem, and Africans from Ham, who was cursed. In the twentieth century, the use of the terms monogenesis and polygenesis declined, but biological anthropologists continued, and to this day continue, to debate the significance of human physical similarities and differences. One debate occurred following publication of American biological anthropologist Carleton Coon’s 1962 book The Origin of Races. Coon (1904–81), who had studied at Harvard University under Earnest Hooton (1887–1954), elaborated a racial theory of German anthropologist Franz Weidenreich (1873–1948) that bore a superficial resemblance to nineteenth-century polygenism. In Coon’s time, anthropologists commonly believed that the species Homo sapiens had evolved from the species Homo erectus. Elaborating Weidenreich, Coon categorized Homo sapiens into five racial “types” named Caucasoid, Congoid, Capoid, Mongoloid, and Australoid. He claimed that these racial types originated with Homo erectus and had maintained their distinct identities while Homo erectus evolved into Homo sapiens. Furthermore, he claimed that the times at which these racial types had achieved sapiens status differed, with the Caucasoid, or “white” race, achieving it earlier and the Congoid and Capoid races, the black races of sub-Saharan Africa, achieving it later. The Origin appeared on the cusp of a theoretical shift in biological anthropology away from racial typology, which focused on fixed racial categories, toward the investigation of genetic processes that keep racial boundaries fluid and always changing, making racial categories ephemeral. Biological anthropologists of this emerging orientation, based significantly on the field of population genetics, were critical of Coon’s preoccupation with naming races and highly suspicious that his five races could have maintained their identities during the evolution of an entire global species. For these reasons, they characterized his theoretical framework as unacceptably old-fashioned. The Origin also appeared in the highly charged atmosphere of the American Civil Rights Movement. In 1961, businessman and writer Carleton Putnam (1901–98) (a distant relative of Coon’s) published a controversial book aligned with the practice of racial segregation. The American Association of 14

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Physical Anthropologists, of which Coon was then president, voted to censure the book. Coon resigned in protest. This whole episode was a harbinger of things to come, as biological anthropologists increasingly grappled with theoretical disputes about human diversity in the context of their real-world implications. Broadly speaking, no other event in Western history has been as significant for anthropology as the voyages of geographical discovery. These voyages brought Europeans into contact with the different kinds of people that anthropologists now study, creating what has been called the anthropological “Other.” They also launched the era of European global domination of Indigenous peoples by means of slavery, colonization, imperialism, and “globalization.” In the late twentieth ­century, anthropologists began to recognize their complicity in this domination and to agonize over ways to “decolonize” anthropology and give Indigenous ­peoples “voice.” This movement has had profound and reverberating implications for anthropological theory.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. When you first meet someone from a different culture, do you initially observe their similarities to you or their differences from you? 2. If Martians were to visit Earth, what do you think would be their first impression of humanity? 3. If Europeans had never encountered the New World, would their understanding of themselves have been different? 4. Is the word Caucasoid a good word to use to label races considered white?

The Scientific Revolution Key Words: British empiricism, cosmology, deduction, dualism, epistemology, French rationalism, induction, law of universal gravitation, mechanics A principal reason for the change of medieval into modern times was the Scientific Revolution, meaning the invention of modern science as a method of intellectual investigation and the growth of specialized sciences and their accumulated bodies of knowledge about the natural world. Because most anthropologists have embraced some version of science, contrasted with humanism or religion, anthropology today is rooted in these momentous events. There are two parts to the Scientific Revolution: the growth of scientific epistemologies and the accumulation of scientific knowledge. 15

Other A postmodernera label for the people anthropologists study, anthropologists being labeled Self.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY epistemology The branch of philosophy that explores the nature of knowledge. deduction In scientific epistemology, the use of logic to reason from general to particular statements; contrasted with induction. French rationalism The intellectual tradition associated with René Descartes and the scientific epistemology of deduction. dualism The idea of philosopher René Descartes that mind and matter constitute distinct realms knowable by distinct means. induction In scientific epistemology, the process of arriving at generalizations about particular facts; contrasted with deduction. British empiricism The scientific epistemology of induction fashioned by philosophers Francis Bacon and John Locke. mechanics The medieval science of motion. cosmology The branch of philosophy concerned with the origin and structure of the universe.

Epistemology is the branch of philosophy that explores the nature of knowledge. In the post-medieval era, when the intellectual authority of the Church was eroding, new epistemologies for science were required. Two major epistemologies emerged, both of which are employed by the practicing scientist today. One is deduction, the use of logic to reason from general to particular statements, or, defined more broadly, the process of drawing a conclusion from something known or assumed. Deduction is used in all sciences, especially the formal science of mathematics. The most famous intellectual architect of deduction was the French mathematician René Descartes (1596–1650), who reasoned, “I exist, therefore God exists, therefore the real world exists.” The Cartesian (the adjective derived from Descartes) version of deduction laid the foundation for the scientific tradition of French rationalism. A central tenet of Cartesian thought, one that would become pivotal in late-twentieth-century critiques of positivism, is dualism, which assumes the essential duality of a world divided into objects and subjects, the rational and the irrational, and the cultural and the natural. Underlying this dualism is a sharp distinction between the realm of mind and the realm of matter. The second epistemology of the Scientific Revolution is induction, the process of discovering general explanations for particular facts by weighing the observational evidence for propositions that make assertions about those facts.The most famous intellectual architects of induction were the English philosophers Francis Bacon (1561–1626) and John Locke (1632–1704), whose ideas formed an important part of the eighteenthcentury Enlightenment. Baconian and Lockean versions of induction laid the foundation for the scientific tradition of British empiricism. Both French rationalism and British empiricism have had followers in anthropology, leading to anthropological schools of thought with fundamentally different, and sometimes opposing, epistemologies. From the thirteenth through the seventeenth centuries, increasingly powerful applications of scientific epistemologies supplanted medieval ways of thinking to produce a series of scientific discoveries culminating in the revolutionary scientific synthesis of Sir Isaac Newton. The story of this revolution begins with mechanics, the science of motion, and with cosmology, a branch of philosophy concerned with the origin and structure of the universe. Medieval mechanics and cosmology derived from a combination of Christian theology and Aristotelian science. In the medieval worldview, the Earth was the center of the universe, and all bodies moved to its center in a form of motion that was considered natural. All other motion was considered unnatural and needed a mover to be explained. In unnatural motion, if a body ceased being moved, it would stop, or come to rest. The speed of a moving body depended on the force of the mover, with a constant force producing a constant speed. When a moving body met resistance, its speed would decrease. If the resistance decreased, its velocity would increase proportionately so that, in a vacuum, where there is no resistance at all, its speed should be instantaneous. To medieval scientists, the concept of instantaneous speed seemed absurd. Therefore, there was no vacuum. 16

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

In this system, naturally falling bodies should not accelerate, but they did.The solution to this problem, devised by medieval commentators, was to posit that air rushed in behind falling bodies, forcing them downward. As the height of the air beneath falling bodies decreased, they met less resistance and accelerated.This solution worked well for a while, but then it became unconvincing. There was the added problem of projectiles, or bodies impelled forward through the air.Why did projectiles slow down? According to a theory developed in the 1300s, projectiles were given the property of impetus, which spent itself in flight. By the same token, naturally falling bodies acquired impetus, which made them accelerate. The theory of impetus, a classic ad hoc explanation, was a bridge between medieval theories and the modern theory of inertia. Medieval mechanics was an integral part of medieval cosmology. In medieval cosmology, the earthly domain was cut off from the celestial, or spiritual, domain by the four elements of earth, water, air, and fire, which covered the Earth in layered orbs, or spheres. The celestial orbs comprised a fifth element, something unchanging and eternal.There were ten celestial orbs, the outer one the empyrean heaven. Aristotle had proclaimed these orbs real, although frictionless. Ptolemy (87–150), the great Greek astronomer at Alexandria, was forced to add almost 80 additional orbs with epicycles, smaller circles moving around the circumference of larger circles, to account for “irregularities” in planetary motion. This solution created a major new problem: the orbs, supposedly real, intersected. In 1543, the Polish astronomer Nicolaus Copernicus (1473–1543) helped launch the Scientific Revolution by announcing that the Earth moved around the Sun, not the other way around, and that the Earth revolved on its own axis. Copernicus intended his action, which reduced the number of required orbs to 34, to be conservative, bolstering the Ptolemaic system by salvaging elements of it that still worked. But the implications were ominous. If the Earth was not the center of the universe, how could it be special? How could God have created it for the glorification of people? Were there other worlds? Moreover, this solution created new technical problems and was beset by new nonconforming observations. If the Earth was rotating on its axis, why did falling bodies not land behind where they were dropped? Also, in the late 1500s, new stars and comets appeared, and their paths of movement, especially those of the comets, cut through the celestial orbs. To solve this problem, the Danish astronomer Tycho Brahe (1546–1601) took the next bold step by announcing that the orbs did not exist. Then, in the early 1600s, the German astronomer Johannes Kepler (1571–1630), freed from the constraints of orbs, described planetary orbits as ellipses rather than perfect circles. Kepler’s laws of planetary motion had planets moving around the Sun and sweeping equal areas in equal time, implying that planets closer to the Sun moved faster. Meanwhile, the Italian physicist and astronomer Galileo Galilei (1564–1642) used the telescope to observe sunspots and other “blemishes” on heavenly bodies. Reflecting on the revolutionary views of his predecessors, Galileo, in Dialogue Concerning the Two Chief Systems of the World (1632), systematically contrasted the 17

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

law of universal gravitation Isaac Newton’s scientific explanation of universal planetary and earthly motion.

Ptolemaic and Copernican worldviews. In the process, he solved the problem of falling bodies not landing behind where they were dropped by reasoning that everything on the Earth rotates with it; in other words, “behind” does not really exist. Still, two huge interrelated problems remained: what caused motion on Earth, now that the Earth was no longer the center of the universe, and what caused celestial bodies to move, now that there were no orbs? These remaining problems were solved by the British scientist Isaac Newton (1642–1727), who, in Mathematical Principles of Natural Philosophy (1687), showed that one law, the law of universal gravitation, accounted for the motion of bodies both on the Earth and in the celestial realm. Newton showed that all bodies move by being attracted to one another with a force proportional to the square of the distance between them. Bodies on the Earth move because they are attracted to the Earth (and the Earth to them), and celestial bodies move because they are attracted to one another in patterns consistent with Kepler’s laws of planetary motion. Contrasted with the medieval system, Newton’s system maintains that inertia keeps bodies moving unless they are affected by new forces, rendering it unnecessary to keep bodies moving by constantly applying the same force. Moreover, a constant force produces constant acceleration, not speed.The Newtonian cosmos is one law-bound system of matter in motion, with the Earth and its inhabitants careening through empty space in a way that scientists do not have to invoke God to explain. For his intellectual achievements, Isaac Newton was knighted and, after his death, buried in Westminster Abbey. Many years later, Charles Darwin – “the Newton of biology” – was buried nearby. The significance of the Scientific Revolution for anthropology is twofold. First, the physical universe conceived by Newton is the universe that most modern anthropologists accept. Second, Newton’s accomplishments in natural science inspired similar efforts in the social sphere. The result was that in the century following Newton, the eighteenth-century Enlightenment, the seeds of social science were planted, took root, and flourished. In the late twentieth century, however, many anthropologists began to question the efficacy of science, ushering in an era of self-doubt and, in some quarters, outright rejection of science as traditionally conceived. During that time, and continuing into the twenty-first century, the modern “Enlightenment Project” came under intense scrutiny.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What does it mean for anthropology to be scientific? 2. Can scientific anthropology be empirical by employing only induction and not deduction? 3. Do you think that in the future scientists might decide that Earth is the center of the universe?

18

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

The Enlightenment Key Words: comparative method, culture, deistic, ethnocentric, mechanical philosophy, noble savagery, perfectibility, progress, reason, savagery/barbarism/ civilization, theistic, universal historians The Enlightenment is the name given to the intellectual history of Europe in the eighteenth century, from the time of Newton’s Mathematical Principles of Natural Philosophy to the time of the French Revolution, beginning in 1789. During this period, following fast on the Scientific Revolution, intellectual attitudes coalesced to produce key concepts of social science. In anthropology, the most important of these concepts was culture. In a way, the Enlightenment was a continuation of the Scientific Revolution because Enlightenment intellectuals were so enamored of the philosophy of Newton that they extended it from the natural into the social realm. Newton’s philosophy was called the mechanical philosophy, referring to his image of the universe as a complex machine with fine-tuned interacting parts. The machine was always moving, and the job of the scientist was to learn just how. Because Newton believed that God had created the universe, his philosophy was also called deistic; unlike a theistic philosopher, he did not invoke God to account for its day-to-day machinations. Metaphorically, the Newtonian universe was a clock, with God the clockmaker. Another major figure in the Enlightenment was the British philosopher John Locke (1632–1704), who in An Essay Concerning Human Understanding (1690) expanded the scientific epistemology of British empiricism. The most important part of Locke’s epistemology for anthropology was his idea, resurrected from the ancient Stoics, that the mind of each newborn person is a tabula rasa, or “blank slate,” which is “written on” by life. This philosophy was so important because it was a philosophy of experience, in which human thoughts and behavior were understood to be acquired rather than inherited or in some other way innate. Such an understanding was indispensable for the emergence of the concept of culture, which can be defined here as the accumulated way of living created and acquired by people and transmitted from one generation to another ­extrasomatically – that is, other than through genes. Culture is the central concept of American anthropology. Its emergence during the Enlightenment is the reason for American anthropologist Marvin Harris’s argument, in The Rise of Anthropological Theory (1968), that before the Enlightenment anthropology did not really exist. During the Enlightenment, a number of intellectuals used the philosophies of Newton and Locke to organize and analyze data on human diversity generated by the voyages of geographical discovery. One such intellectual was the Jesuit Father Joseph Lafitau (1671–1746), who in Customs of American Savages Compared with Those of Earliest Times (1724) created an inventory of culture traits and categories 19

mechanical philosophy The philosophy, inspired by the law of universal gravitation, portraying the universe as a complex machine with fine-tuned, interacting parts. deistic Pertaining to deism, the view that God created the universe but remains relatively uninvolved in its day-to-day operations; contrasted with theistic. theistic Pertaining to theism, the view that God created the universe and remains active in its day-to-day operations; contrasted with deistic. culture Defined many ways; with reference to the Enlightenment, the accumulated way of living created by people and transmitted from one generation to the next extrasomatically rather than through genes.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.4  Noble Savage: This 1844–45 portrait by American artist George Catlin (1796–1872) shows Iowa medicine man See-Non-Ty-A in full regalia. Paul Mellon Collection (1965.16.346). Courtesy of the National Gallery of Art, Washington.

ethnocentric Pertaining to ethnocentrism, or cultural bias.

noble savagery The romanticization of “primitive” life. comparative method The use of extant primitive peoples to represent extinct primitive peoples, as in classical cultural evolutionism.

considerably less ethnocentric, or culturally biased, than those of his predecessors. Lafitau was one of several Jesuit missionaries whose eighteenth-century accounts of North American Indigenous peoples are still consulted by ethnohistorians. Another Enlightenment figure was the French social reformer Jean-Jacques Rousseau (1712–78), who in Discourse on the Origin and Foundation of Inequality among Men (1751) speculated on how and why human differences had developed over time. Rousseau sought to counteract what he considered to be overly intellectualized Enlightenment formulations by emphasizing human pathos and emotion. His speculations led him to conclude in The Social Contract (1762) that humanity had been happier in the past and that noble savagery was a condition whose disappearance ought to be lamented. In their speculative reconstructions of the past, both Lafitau and Rousseau used living Indigenous peoples as models for past “savages.” This was an early application of what in nineteenth-century anthropology would be called the comparative method.Arguably, it was also an early application of what in late-twentieth-century anthropological theory would be called the social construction of race, meaning that race is in the eyes of the beholder as much as, if not more than, the eyes of the beheld. 20

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Emulating the accomplishments of Newton, some Enlightenment intellectuals sought to discover “laws” of human history. These so-called universal historians proposed stages of human development during which, according to the philosophy of Locke, human experience was understood to have accumulated as culture. A prime example was the Italian philosopher Giambattista Vico (1668–1744), who in The New Science (1725) described how humanity had passed through the three stages of gods, heroes, and men. These stages were secular and, according to Vico, the product of human, not divine, action. Another universal historian was the Baron de la Brède et de Montesquieu (1689–1755), commonly known simply as Montesquieu, who in The Spirit of the Laws (1748) attempted to show how rules governing human conduct have always been correlated with culture. More radical was French philosopher François-Marie Arouet, better known by his nom de plume,Voltaire (1694–1778). In An Essay on Universal History, the Manners, and Spirit of Nations, from the Reign of Charlemagne to the Age of Louis XIV (1756), Voltaire actively attacked the theological view of history and traced the growth of Christianity in secular terms.The British historian Edward Gibbon (1737–94) used the same approach more subtly in The Decline and Fall of the Roman Empire (1776–78). Some universal historians of the Enlightenment stand out as more recognizably anthropological than others. One was the French statesman Anne Robert Jacques Turgot (1727–81), who in Plans for Two Discourses on Universal History (1750) described the passage of humanity through the three stages of hunting, ­pastoralism, and farming. Another was the French philosopher Marie Jean de Condorcet (1743–94), who in Sketch for a Historical Picture of the Progress of the Human Mind (1795) added more stages, for a total of ten, the last of which he p­ redicted to be the future. Prediction, he urged, was based on his confidence in laws about the past. The Scottish historians Adam Ferguson (1728–1816), John Millar (1735–1801), and William Robertson (1721–93) stressed the importance of technology and economy in defining stages of universal history. Robertson even used the schema of savagery, barbarism, and civilization, which became commonplace in the nineteenth century. In fact, from the perspective of nineteenth-century anthropology, the Scottish Enlightenment appears more theoretically sophisticated than the French. Enlightenment schemes of universal history were united by the common ideals of human reason, progress, and perfectibility. Reason referred to the exercise of human intellect unfettered by authoritarian faith, including faith in religion. Progress referred to the resulting positive direction of historical change, opposite to the direction presupposed by medieval Christianity, which considered humanity degenerate and fallen from the grace of God. Perfectibility referred to the final outcome of reason and progress, which, according to Enlightenment thinkers, would lead to the steady improvement of human conditions on Earth. Linked as it was to science, the intellectual agenda of the Enlightenment prevailed in anthropology for more than 100 years. In the earlier twentieth century, influential anthropological theorists began to question some of its ideals as unattainable, and 21

universal historians  Enlightenment thinkers who promulgated comprehensive laws and schemas of human history.

savagery/barbarism/ civilization A popular nineteenth-century tripartite schema for the universal evolution of humanity. reason The exercise of human cognitive functions independent or semi-independent of experience. progress The movement of humanity from a perceived inferior toward a perceived superior state. perfectibility The idea that humankind is capable of progressing or evolving into some desired end point.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

in the later twentieth century, other influential theorists offered a more strident critique of those ideals as undesirable. Meanwhile, toward the end of the eighteenth century, the ideals became slogans for social reform and then rallying cries for the French Revolution.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What is culture? 2. What are the implications of treating anthropology as a social science? 3. If you consider human history to have been progressive, how do you define the term progress? 4. Are there any cultural laws?

The Rise of Positivism Key Words: bourgeoisie, pietistic, positivism, Positivism, social dynamics, social statics, Volksgeist

bourgeoisie In Marxist terminology, the middle class.

pietistic Pertaining to piety, or religious reverence and devotion.

The French Revolution was a political movement that overthrew the absolute monarchy of the Bourbon regime and its associated system of upper-class privilege, unleashing a new middle class, the bourgeoisie. Beginning in 1789, the Revolution lasted for a protracted, bloody decade before Napoleon Bonaparte (1769–1821) assumed control of France in 1799. In a move widely considered to be a betrayal of revolutionary ideals, Bonaparte made himself emperor and plunged France into a series of expansionist wars that lasted until he was defeated at the Battle of Waterloo in 1815. Afterward, all of Europe needed a rest from political turmoil. The Revolution was fought on the basis of Enlightenment ideals that insisted on the human capacity for moral and intellectual progress and, ultimately, perfection. When the Revolution turned out badly, European intellectuals turned their backs on these ideals.The result was a rise in conservative attitudes aimed at maintaining, or regaining, the political status quo. Conservatism appeared in a number of guises. One was fundamentalist Christianity, which condemned social science as excessively materialistic, atheistic, and amoral. Many new Christian denominations developed, espousing “evangelical” or pietistic perspectives. In this new theology, Newton’s clockmaker God was replaced by a God of divine intervention, miracles, and punishment for those who strayed from the teachings of the Bible and its latter-day interpretations. Elsewhere, citizens fed up with radical “social engineering” established utopian, or visionary, socialist communities where they could 22

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

live and do as they pleased. A strong reaction to Napoleon’s vision of empire was nationalism, which promoted the ideology and mythology of particular peoples rather than a universal outlook on humankind. In Germany, which struggled to achieve nationhood, there was a revival of faith in predestination and a longing to return to past glory, resulting in a retreat from the idea of progress. This development had a noticeable effect on German ethnology, which embraced the idea of the Volksgeist, or special spirit, of Germans. Another guise of conservatism was Romanticism, a movement in art, literature, and even science that glorified the idiosyncratic, non-rational, and emotional sides of human nature and denied the primacy of Cartesian thought. Finally, there was racism, which was linked to all other guises of conservatism and which flourished in the nineteenth century. Conservatism also affected social science, which developed during the Enlightenment when principles of Newtonian science were used to investigate social change. In the early nineteenth century, social scientists also felt that it was time to put more emphasis on stability. The result was the all-encompassing philosophy of Positivism. Positivism (with a capital “P”) was the creation of the French philosopher Auguste Comte (1798–1857), an intellectual descendant of Marie Jean de Condorcet through the intermediary Claude Henri, Comte de Saint-Simon (1760–1825). Comte’s views are contained in his multivolume work Course of Positive Philosophy (1830–42), in which he described how almost all branches of knowledge have passed through three stages: theological, metaphysical, and positive. According to Comte, in the theological stage, phenomena were explained in terms of deities; in the metaphysical stage, in terms of abstract concepts; and in the positive stage, in terms of other phenomena. Starting with astronomy and physics in the Scientific Revolution, the natural sciences had already passed through the theological and metaphysical stages to become positive, meaning truly scientific. The social sciences, however, lagged behind. Comte took it upon himself to help them catch up. The social sciences had already passed out of the theological stage, where social phenomena had been explained in terms of God during the Middle Ages, well into the metaphysical stage, where they had been explained in terms of the abstract concept of reason during the Enlightenment. Now, Comte urged, social science should enter the positive phase in the post-Enlightenment nineteenth century. In Comte’s scheme, science involved the search for generalizations. In positive social science, these would be of two kinds. Social dynamics (named after a branch of physics) would search for generalizations about social change, while social statics (physics again) would search for generalizations about social stability. Comte maintained that the French Revolution had gone too far in attempting to promote dynamic change and that its excesses needed to be tempered with social statics. Together, social dynamics and social statics offered a comprehensive scientific perspective on social phenomena. 23

Volksgeist Translated “spirit of the people”; according to some early theorists, the ethnographic essence of a people.

Positivism The scientific philosophy of Auguste Comte.

social dynamics  In Positivism, the study of social change. social statics  In Positivism, the study of social stability.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

positivism The view that science is objective and value-free.

As the creator of Positivism, Comte was one of the founding fathers of modern social science, in particular sociology, which was built on the foundation of his pronouncement that social phenomena are to be explained in their own terms. At the same time, positivism (with a small “p”) underwent several philosophical transformations, so that by the middle of the twentieth century it had become synonymous with an outlook that promoted detached, value-free science as the model for social-scientific inquiry. By the end of the century, anthropologists of various persuasions had begun to realize that, far from being detached, science is permeated by values, even if those values are not always explicit. They had also begun to understand how science functions in a social context and to argue that scientists bear responsibility for the detrimental social uses of science. Opposed to the scientific model, these anthropologists began to see positivism as, at best, naïve and, at worst, a source of theoretical misguidance in aid of Western power and hegemony.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Is there anything wrong with anthropologists being nationalistic? 2. Can or should scientists be objective? 3. Is it possible for anthropologists to study the present without referring to the past?

Marxism Key Words: capitalism, communist revolution, dialectical materialism, dictatorship of the proletariat, idealist, labor theory of value, Marxism, materialism, means of production, primitive communism, proletariat, ruling class, thesis-antithesis-synthesis, vulgar materialists

dialectical materialism  The philosophy of Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels, commonly called Marxism. Marxism A collection of views derived from Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels and their theory of dialectical materialism.

As the nineteenth century progressed, in the wake of the French Revolution, the middle classes of Europe prospered. Meanwhile, the working classes grew restless and agitated for reform. Where the Industrial Revolution took hold, mainly in Britain, radical intellectuals rallied to support the growing labor movement. The most radical of these were Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels, co-creators of the theory of dialectical materialism, commonly called Marxism. Marxism has had a profound effect on the real world of politics. It has also affected anthropology, not only for this reason but also because aspects of Marx’s thought have been elaborated and formally incorporated within anthropological theory, even by anthropologists whose “allegiance” is not explicitly Marxist. 24

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Karl Marx (1818–83) was born in Prussia (now part of northern Germany), studied philosophy at the University of Berlin, and then studied law at the University of Bonn. He became interested in the relationship between politics and economics, turning to the utopian variety of socialism in 1843. Early on, he decided that utopian socialism was ineffective and that, to become effective, socialism would have to be made “scientific.” Friedrich Engels (1820–95) was the son of a German textile manufacturer who spent several years in the English cities of Manchester and Liverpool as the agent of a textile firm. England had already experienced the undesirable effects of industrialization and was debating parliamentary measures to improve the poor conditions of urban workers. Engels analyzed these conditions in The Condition of the Working Class in England (1844) and then expanded his analysis in collaboration with Marx. The result was their landmark treatise, The Communist Manifesto (1848). The essential ingredients of dialectical materialism can be found in The Communist Manifesto and the much larger work Capital (1867). Marx and Engels began with the premise of materialism, meaning their belief that human existence determines human consciousness, contrasted with the idealist belief that human consciousness determines human existence. More specifically, they believed that human thoughts, actions, and institutions are determined by their relationship to the means of production, meaning how people make a living in the material world. This relationship is always changing because the means of production themselves are always changing as people adapt to their physical conditions. In prehistory, according to Marx and Engels, who drew this part of their analysis from contemporary anthropology, people lived in a socio-economic system with material goods belonging to all, no private property, and equality under the “law.” In civilization, however, powerful individuals gained control of land, the basic source of wealth. Thus, primitive communism was superseded by a system of unequal classes and the exploitation of one class by another. Marx and Engels maintained that all modern societies are based on class distinctions. These distinctions become institutionalized in Church and State, which function to keep the ruling class, the class that controls the means of production, in power. As the means of production change, the nature of classes, which “organize” the means of production, also changes. Eventually, the means of production outgrow their form of organization, which is “overthrown” in a social revolution from which a new social system emerges. In classical Marxism, the sequence of social revolutions is dialectical, according to a revised version of the philosophy of Georg Wilhelm Friedrich Hegel (1770–1831). Hegel, an extreme idealist, described a world spirit manifesting itself in history through dialectical transformations of the form thesis-antithesis-synthesis. The thesis came first, followed by its opposite, the antithesis, which was then followed by a combination of the thesis and antithesis, the synthesis. Marx and Engels were attracted to Hegel’s philosophy but felt that it needed to be epistemologically upended. 25

materialism In dialectical materialism, the belief that human existence determines human consciousness; in cultural materialism, the equivalent of the principle of infrastructural determinism. idealist Pertaining to idealism, the view that ideas more than material existence cause culture change. means of production In dialectical materialism, how people make a living in the material world. primitive communism  In some versions of Marxism, the view that past primitive peoples lived in a state to which future communism will, in a fashion, return. ruling class In the theory of dialectical materialism, the class that controls the means of production. thesis-antithesissynthesis In dialectical materialism, Friedrich Hegel’s form for dialectical change.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.5  Machine over Man: This classic image from Charlie Chaplin’s 1936 Depression-era film Modern Times depicts the exploitation of factory workers that was the focus of the Marxist theory of dialectical materialism. © Roy Export S.A.S. Scan courtesy Cineteca di Bologna.

communist revolution In Marxist theory, the replacement of bourgeois by proletarian ownership of the means of production, ushering in socialism and ultimately communism. capitalism The political economic system characterized by private ownership of the means of production and unfettered exchange of commodities in the marketplace, yielding profit.

Therefore, they “stood Hegel on his head” and moved the dialectic from the ideal to the material world. In the resulting theory of dialectical materialism, social transformations assume a dialectical form, with one social stage, the thesis, inevitably “sowing the seeds of its own destruction” by harboring its opposite, the antithesis, which manifests itself in social revolution. This stage is followed by a third social stage, the synthesis, which retains elements of the preceding two. Marx and Engels’s main focus was materialism rather than dialectics. Their primary interest in revising Hegel’s philosophy was to use it to explain what had happened in world history and, through a communist revolution, what would happen in the future. Although Marx and Engels were aware of prehistory, ancient history, and non-Western history, they began their account with the Middle Ages and feudalism, a system of agricultural economics with classes consisting of ruling-class lords and a ruled class of unfree laborers, the serfs. During feudal times, a new manufacturing class emerged, the capitalists, whose power rested on money rather than land. The capitalist means of production was manufacturing, which, because of what it could produce, was superior to agriculture and eventually replaced it. For Marx and Engels, the triumph of capitalism over feudalism was 26

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

the French Revolution, after which lords and serfs were superfluous and the new classes became the ruling-class bourgeoisie and a ruled class of urban workers, the proletariat. Marx and Engels did not spend too much time analyzing feudalism and how it gave rise to capitalism. They were much more anxious to analyze capitalism and how it would give rise to communism. Their analysis was based on the labor ­theory of value, the materialist premise that goods and services should be valued in terms of the human labor required to produce them. According to this theory, the value of a good or service, a commodity, is directly related to the amount of labor put into it. Exploitation occurs when capitalists “expropriate” some of this value as profit. Moreover, capitalists buy and sell labor itself as a commodity, valuing it according to wages determined by the labor “market.” The result is that workers are alienated from the products of their labor and, therefore, from themselves. The disintegration of capitalism was the focus of the work Capital. In it, Marx explained how at first capitalism was progressive, opening up new markets as an efficient way of producing goods. But capitalism became regressive and less efficient, as competition among manufacturers decreased and economic power was concentrated in fewer and fewer hands.The growth of monopolies was inevitable, Marx observed, because competition produced winners as well as losers. Soon the monopoly system outgrew the original capitalist system of product diversity. Rich monopolists got richer by increasing profits, and poor workers got poorer because profit was taken from their wages.The proletariat became pauperized, and, as small business people were squeezed out by competition, they swelled its ranks. Under free-market conditions, a glut of laborers caused a decrease in wages, intensifying poverty. Because of cheaper labor, profits increased. For a while, profits were reinvested in production, but eventually production generated more and more goods able to be bought by fewer and fewer people. This downward spiral of events led to economic recession, depression, and labor unrest. Soon the capitalist world was ripe for revolution. In the mature phase of capitalism, the means of production would already be concentrated in a few locations. Workers could easily seize them in the name of the proletariat and nationalize them in the name of a nation governed by workers. The first stage of the revolution would be a temporary dictatorship of the proletariat, whose job would be to destroy the bourgeoisie as a class and eliminate private profit by putting it to public use. The result would be a classless society in which the state, formerly serving the interests of a few capitalists, would become agents of all workers. Eventually, the state would “wither away” and the final stage would emerge, the true stage of communism, in which workers would work according to their ability and receive compensation according to their needs. Final communism would represent a return to primitive communism with the technology of the industrial age. 27

proletariat In the lexicon of Marxism, the working class. labor theory of value The proposition of Karl Marx that commodities should be valued in terms of the human labor required to produce them.

dictatorship of the proletariat In the theory of dialectical materialism, the temporary phase of political organization leading to permanent communism.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

vulgar materialists  A label for cultural materialists who, according to their critics, ignore dialectical thinking.

Marxism achieved major political victories in the Soviet and Chinese revolutions of the twentieth century, which led to the installation of Marxist dogma and its modification by powerful politicians such as Vladimir Lenin (1870–1924), Joseph Stalin (1879–1953), and Mao Zedong (1893–1976). Marxism also took root outside politics in academic disciplines such as anthropology. Beginning in earnest in the 1930s, a minority of anthropologists embraced one or more of the tenets of Marxism. A few turned to Marxism in support of the fledgling communist regime in the Soviet Union, or in rejection of the capitalist system held responsible for the Great Depression. Since then, Marxist anthropologists have grown theoretically diverse and sometimes divergent. Some, such as structural Marxists, have stressed how a given economic system is constrained by its ruling ideology. Others, such as some political economists and postcolonial theorists, have blamed capitalism for world economic inequalities. Still others, such as some feminist anthropologists, have looked to Marxism as a means of understanding and combating the economic subjugation of women. Few Marxist anthropologists have accepted the entire theory of dialectical materialism, which history has helped refute. But they have demonstrated a personal commitment to help economically disadvantaged people and have been willing to use anthropology professionally for that purpose. Most Marxist anthropologists, including Marxist archaeologists, have preferred materialist over idealist explanations of culture change and historical over ahistorical approaches to cultural analysis. They have emphasized “class” because Marxism implies that different classes have different ideologies and “consciousnesses.” In Marxist circles, there have been disputes between so-called vulgar materialists, said by their detractors to be simpleminded materialists, and Marxist anthropologists who have embraced one form or another of dialectics. This latter group includes the structural Marxists, who blend classical Marxism with the twentieth-century anthropology of Claude Lévi-Strauss (1908–2009). Marxist anthropologists, vulgar and structural alike, join forces in criticizing anthropologists who promote “value-free” science – so-called positivist anthropologists. All science, they say, is value-laden, and those who deny this truth, naïvely or intentionally, perpetuate social inequities. In the era of the Cold War, the period of intense antagonism between the United States and the Soviet Union following World War II, several Marxist and other politically left-leaning anthropologists came under scrutiny by the American government. Anthropologist David Price probes this episode in a range of books, including Anthropological Intelligence: The Deployment and Neglect of American Anthropology in the Second World War (2008) and Weaponizing Anthropology: Social Science in Service of the Militarized State (2011). Citing documents obtained under the Freedom of Information Act, Price shows how in the early 1950s, using secret informants, the Federal Bureau of Investigation (FBI) compiled a dossier on University of Michigan anthropologist Leslie White. Meanwhile, anthropologist Melville Jacobs was forced to appear before a Washington State committee of the 28

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.6  United States Senator Joseph McCarthy, 1954: Recalling McCarthyism, or Senator McCarthy’s campaign against communism, reminds us that it was risky to espouse Marxist views in the United States during the Cold War. Copyright © Bettmann/CORBIS.

House Un-American Activities Committee, and anthropologist Gene Weltfish, who lost her job at Columbia University, was forced to testify before Senator Joseph McCarthy’s Committee on Government Operations. According to Price, these and other such anthropologists came under suspicion less for their possible (or actual) membership in the Communist Party than for their “radical” politics and social activism, which were aimed at correcting the perceived social inequities of capitalism. Price asserts that in 1951, Frederick Johnson and William W. Howells, respectively the executive secretary and the president of the American Anthropological Association, sponsored a proposal, approved by the Association’s executive board, to have the Central Intelligence Agency (CIA) compile a comprehensive roster of Association members, identifying their areas of cultural, linguistic, and geographical expertise. On the questionnaire designed to elicit this information, the involvement of the CIA was kept secret. Such an action would probably be unthinkable today, but at the time, the attitude of American anthropologists toward government espionage was more favorable. Just a few years earlier, during World War II, American anthropologists had worked willingly, even enthusiastically, with the government to help defeat fascist Germany and Japan, and during both world wars, American archaeologists patriotically provided cover for government intelligence-gathering projects overseas. This whole shadowy wartime era, when the government “spied” on anthropologists and anthropologists spied for the government, gives pause for thought during the twenty-first century “War on 29

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Terror,” including in the context of the controversy surrounding anthropologists’ participation in the United States army’s Human Terrain System (HTS) counterinsurgency program (2007–15). Criticism of President Barack Obama’s initiative to normalize political relations with Cuba, followed by President Donald Trump’s adversarial policies toward Cuba, Venezuela, China, and North Korea, show that anti-communist sentiment in America remains strong.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Is it reasonable to expect that, someday, social classes will be eliminated? 2. Materialism is often equated with consumerism. Is this the Marxist understanding of the term? 3. Has history confirmed the Hegelian dialectic? 4. What does it mean to be a Marxist anthropologist? 5. Why are Marxists so often labeled radicals?

Classical Cultural Evolutionism Key Words: adhesions, ancestor worship, anima, armchair anthropologist, classical cultural evolutionism, classificatory, consanguine, contract societies, cross-cousins, descriptive, evolution, exogamy, female infanticide, informant, matrilineal, monotheism, neo-evolutionists, patrilineal, polyandry, polytheism, prehistory, shamans, status societies, survivals, sympathetic magic, transmigrate, unilineal kinship systems evolution Whether in the realm of culture or biology, the transformation of one form into another.

classical cultural evolutionism The theoretical orientation of nineteenth-century cultural evolutionists who used the comparative method. prehistory The period of human existence before writing.

The word evolution means transformation of forms, a process in which something changes while remaining partially the same. Evolution is associated most closely with biology, but it can also apply to any natural or social science attempting to reconstruct the past. The Marxist theory of dialectical materialism and the Enlightenment schemes of universal history were evolutionary. So was the first major cultural anthropological “-ism”: the classical cultural evolutionism of the nineteenth century. Classical cultural evolutionism represents a continuation of Enlightenment universal historicism – with one important difference. While eighteenth-century universal historians concentrated on modern Western history, nineteenth-century cultural evolutionists concentrated on the history of non-Western peoples in prehistory, the time before writing.This difference derived from expanded ethnographic understanding of Indigenous peoples and convincing new archaeological 30

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

evidence that there was a prehistory. Taken together, ethnography and archaeology allowed nineteenth-century anthropologists to construct cultural evolutionary schemes in which descriptions of prehistoric artifacts were “fleshed out” with descriptions of present-day “primitive” peoples whose artifacts looked similar. This use of ethnography to supplement archaeology was called the “comparative method.” In the early twentieth century, influential anthropologists criticized the comparative method as too speculative, and cultural evolutionism fell out of favor as an anthropological theory. In the late 1940s, it was revived by another group of anthropologists who called themselves neo-evolutionists and labeled their nineteenth-century predecessors “classical.” The heyday of classical cultural evolutionism was the period from the 1860s through the 1890s. Although this followed the publication of Charles Darwin’s On the Origin of Species (1859), cultural evolutionism does not represent an application of Darwin’s biological ideas to the realm of culture. Cultural evolutionists were far more interested in ethnography, archaeology, and an expanded view of universal history than in Darwin’s theory of evolution by natural selection. It would be historically inaccurate to label cultural evolutionists “social” or “cultural” Darwinists. Classical cultural evolutionists fell into “major” and “minor” categories. Major figures were more original, influential, and productive as authors. Minor figures published less, had less influence, and commented more on the ideas of others. The major classical cultural evolutionists were Herbert Spencer (1820–1903), John Lubbock (1834–1913), Lewis Henry Morgan (1818–81), Edward Burnett Tylor (1832–1917), and James Frazer (1854–1941). Minor classical cultural evolutionists included Henry Maine (1822–88), Johann Bachofen (1815–87), and John McLennan (1827–81). With the exception of Bachofen, a German, and Morgan, an American, all of them were British. The effect of their work was to reinforce the prevailing attitude of smug Victorian superiority by demonstrating how modern civilization had evolved from primitive cultures in the direction of  “progress.” These classical cultural evolutionists were interested in an array of cultural institutions and beliefs. One group, led by Morgan, was interested in marriage, family, and sociopolitical organization. Another group, led by Tylor, was interested in religion, magic, and other ideological systems.With the exception of Spencer, a philosopher or sociologist more than an anthropologist, and Lubbock, an archaeologist as much as a cultural anthropologist, the classical cultural evolutionists “specialized” in one or the other of these interest groups. Lewis Henry Morgan, an unlikely candidate for future anthropological fame, grew up in and around Rochester, New York, where he later practiced law. He belonged to a fraternal order known as the League of the Iroquois and, in order to authenticate the order’s rituals, began to study nearby Iroquois tribes, eventually becoming adopted by them and helping them press their Indigenous land-claims cases in court. In his studies, Morgan relied heavily on his bilingual Indigenous assistant, Ely Parker (1828–95), probably the first significant informant in the history 31

neo-evolutionists  Twentieth-century anthropologists who revived and reformulated nineteenth-century classical cultural evolutionism.

informant  In anthropological fieldwork, someone who provides information to the fieldworker.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

classificatory A type of kinship, contrasted with the descriptive type, that merges kinship categories. descriptive A type of kinship system, contrasted with the classificatory type, that splits kinship categories. cross-cousins Cousins related through parents of the opposite sex. unilineal kinship systems Kinship systems reckoned through one parental line, either matrilineal or patrilineal. matrilineal Unilineal kinship systems reckoned through the female line.

patrilineal Unilineal kinship systems reckoned through the male line. consanguine A family type based on group marriage between brothers and sisters.

of American ethnography. Morgan took a keen interest in kinship, the study of how people are related to one another formally. This interest led to his first major book, League of the Ho-de-no-sau-nee, or Iroquois (1851), a study of Iroquois social organization. He expanded his studies with information gathered from travels throughout the United States and Canada and from responses to questionnaires distributed around the world by the Smithsonian Institution.This information was incorporated into his more comprehensive books, Systems of Consanguinity and Affinity of the Human Family (1870) and his magnum opus Ancient Society (1877). In Ancient Society, Morgan presented a vast scheme of cultural evolution on several interrelated levels. He began with the general stages of savagery, barbarism, and civilization, defined – somewhat inconsistently – as stages of hunting and gathering, plant and animal domestication, and “the state.” Each of these stages was divided – again somewhat inconsistently – into substages of  “lower,” “middle,” and “upper.” Morgan recognized that there were two kinship types. The classificatory type lumped together kinship categories that Anglo-Americans split into two or more categories, using, for example, a single term for “brother” and “brother’s children.” The descriptive type, exemplified by Anglo-Americans, maintained such split categories. Morgan believed that the classificatory type of kinship had predominated during savagery and barbarism, and then evolved into the descriptive type with the advent of civilization, when property superseded kinship as the main determinant of social relations. Groups still practicing classificatory kinship were said to be carry-overs from the savage or barbaric stage. Morgan divided kinship types into kinship systems, beginning with the Malayan system, where “mother” and “father” were lumped with “mother” and “mother’s brother.” According to Morgan, the Malayan system evolved into the Turanian-Ganowanian, or Iroquoian, system when cross-cousins, cousins related through parents of the opposite sex, became distinguished. Then, when social relations reckoned through descent superseded social relations based on distinctions between the sexes, there evolved unilineal kinship systems of sibs, clans, and tribes. At first, still in the stage of savagery, descent was reckoned through the female line because, owing to pregnancy, female parenthood could be determined more reliably than male parenthood. In the stage of barbarism, however, kinship reckoning through the male line commenced, changing matrisibs, matriclans, and matrilineal tribes into patrisibs, patriclans, and patrilineal tribes. Male kinship became even more important in the stage of civilization.To all these stages, kinship types, and kinship systems Morgan added family types, beginning with the consanguine type, which is based on group marriage between brothers and sisters, and evolving through a series of prohibitions of marriage between relatives into the monogamous nuclear family of civilized times. A pivotal part of Morgan’s scheme was his belief that a fundamental cultural shift occurred in the transition from the prehistoric stage of barbarism into the stage of civilization, which he characterized by writing, cities, monumental 32

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

architecture, and other anthropological hallmarks of states (contrasted with bands, tribes, and chiefdoms). For Morgan, this shift occurred when, because of the demands of plant and animal domestication in cities, territorial relations became more important than kinship relations. The growth of private property at the expense of community property prompted certain privileged groups to retain private property by inheritance through the male line.This shift in turn led to the emergence of stratified social classes whose access to strategic material resources was unequal. Thus, beginning in antiquity, the stage of civilization became fundamentally different from the preceding stages of savagery and barbarism. Moreover, like other cultural evolutionists, Morgan considered present-day primitive cultures to be vestiges of the prehistoric past. When Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels read Ancient Society, they were excited to find in it anthropological support for their belief that class-based inequalities were not engrained in human nature and that, under certain circumstances, a more egalitarian political system could work. They set about using Morgan’s scheme to augment the theory of dialectical materialism by showing how the institution of private property had originated and how, when it was abolished, the world would return, at least figuratively, to the communism with which humanity had begun. When Marx died, Engels completed the task. In his book Origin of the Family, Private Property, and the State (1884), Engels added Morgan to the select group of non-Marxists whose thoughts have been declared compatible with the Marxist cause. Although partially dated, the body of Morgan’s work has endured, and most modern anthropologists consider him to be the father of kinship studies. His nineteenth-century contemporaries disputed certain points. Differences between Morgan and minor classical cultural evolutionists centered on the sequence of cultural stages and the causes of their transformations. Morgan proposed a general evolutionary sequence of group marriage, or marriage ungoverned by complex kinship, followed by kinship determined through matrilineal and patrilineal descent. In Ancient Law (1861), Henry Maine disagreed, arguing that the first form of family was patrilineal. Maine also added an evolutionary distinction between status societies, which were family-oriented, held property in common, and maintained social control by social sanctions, and contract societies, which stressed individualism, held property in private, and maintained social control by legal sanctions. In Primitive Marriage (1865), John McLennan agreed with Morgan that group marriage had preceded patrilineal descent but disagreed with him on how the transition from one to the other had occurred. According to McLennan, group marriage was a period of great struggle in which not everybody who was born could survive. This situation led to female infanticide, the preferential killing of female over male children. The resulting shortage of females meant that they had to share males as mates, leading to polyandry. Males also captured females from other groups, leading to exogamy, or “mating out.” In Mother Right 33

status societies In the schema of Henry Maine, societies that are familyoriented, hold property in common, and maintain control by social sanctions; contrasted with contract societies. contract societies In the schema of Henry Maine, societies that stress individualism, hold property in private, and maintain control by legal sanctions; contrasted with status societies. female infanticide The practice of treating male children more favorably than female children, resulting in more female deaths. polyandry Mating or marriage involving one woman and more than one man. exogamy The practice of marrying or mating outside one’s kinship group; contrasted with endogamy.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

armchair anthropologist An anthropologist who has done little or no fieldwork. adhesions Edward Burnett Tylor’s name for cultural traits that are statistically significantly associated. survivals Edward Burnett Tylor’s name for nonfunctional cultural traits that are inherited from past generations.

anima An invisible and diffuse supernatural force that can take the form of souls and ghosts.

(1861), Johann Bachofen made similar arguments. Judged by modern standards, all of these schemes were excessively speculative, far beyond the ability of empirical evidence to determine. Morgan’s British counterpart was Edward Burnett Tylor, the “father” of cultural anthropology in Britain and, some say, in the West. Tylor was a prototypical Victorian armchair anthropologist who based his evolutionary schemes on reason as much as on ethnographic and archaeological data. In reconstructing culture, he correlated cultural components, called adhesions, and looked for clues to the past in cultural vestiges, called survivals. He argued vigorously against the Christian idea of human degeneration, arguing instead in favor of the secular Victorian idea of human progress. Tylor is credited with a number of important anthropological “firsts.” He became the first academic professor of anthropology, at Oxford University in 1884; he wrote the first anthropology textbook, Anthropology (1881); and, in Primitive Culture (1871), he offered the first definition of culture by a professional anthropologist: “[that] complex whole which includes knowledge, belief, art, law, morals, custom and any other capabilities and habits acquired by man as a member of society.” Tylor’s principal interest was the evolution of magico-religious beliefs and institutions, which he explained as the accumulation of rational answers to reasonable questions about the natural world.This approach was also taken by John Lubbock, who in The Origin of Civilisation (1870) outlined a scheme for the evolution of magic and religion. Lubbock’s scheme began with atheism, the belief in no deity, and ended with the belief in an omnipotent, or all-powerful, God. Evolutionary philosopher Herbert Spencer, author of Principles of Sociology (1876), took a similar approach to the evolution of magic and religion. A synthesis of Tylor’s and Spencer’s views can serve to illustrate the role of reason in this group of classical cultural evolutionists. In the Tylor–Spencer synthesis, religion, or proto-religion, began when the earliest prehistoric people tried to solve natural puzzles. Prehistoric people might have observed, for example, that clouds appear and disappear and the sun rises and sets, while rocks fail to move. Why were some natural objects animated and others not? The answer was that animated objects possessed anima, an invisible and diffuse supernatural force. Organisms were particularly animated, so their anima must have been especially powerful. Human organisms were animated in curious ways. In dreams, for example, people experienced themselves in different places, and then awoke to find themselves somewhere else. People cannot be physically present in more than one place at the same time, so, the reasoning went, they must have two dimensions, a physical dimension and a non-physical, or spiritual, dimension, which “travels.” T   his spiritual dimension became the “soul.” Observations on death served to confirm the existence of souls. When people die, initially they look the same as in life, but they are no longer animated. Therefore, their invisible souls must have departed. But where do souls go? Many never return, so they must 34

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

gather in another world, the “afterlife.” Other souls return to haunt and possess the living as “ghosts.”Therefore, these ghost-souls, some good and others bad, must be able to transmigrate. If souls survive after death, should they not be open to postmortem “conversation”? In the Tylor–Spencer synthesis, contacting souls became the job of magico-religious specialists such as sorcerers and shamans. Furthermore, in a non-literate and kin-based culture, souls would be reckoned as ancestors and venerated for their wisdom and advice, leading to ancestor worship. But how was the supernatural world of ancestral ghost-souls to be imagined? According to the synthesis, it could be imagined only as a reflection of life on Earth, and, when culture evolved, images of the afterlife would evolve in tandem. For this reason, in prehistoric and primitive cultures, with multiple, equally ranking lineages and clans, there would be multiple, equally ranking ghost-souls revered as deities –­ polytheism. When, in civilization, culture became class-based and stratified, deities became ranked; and when, early in civilization, authority came to rest in the hands of a single pharaoh, emperor, or priestly king, the number of deities shrank to one – for instance, the omnipotent “King of Kings” of Christianity. In this way, “advanced” monotheism, the prevailing form of religion in Victorian Britain, was the end product of a series of cultural transformations starting with primitive animism at the beginning of prehistoric time – the idea of  “progress.” Evolution results in continuity as well as change. In biological evolution, Homo sapiens retains traits of ancestral species, including pre-human species with ape-like and monkey-like traits. For many people, the suggestion that humanity is even partially animalistic provokes a visceral, negative reaction. Likewise, in Victorian Britain, cultural evolutionists such as Tylor and Spencer were criticized and became controversial when they suggested that Christianity, like the beliefs of people everywhere, had “primitive” roots. Anthropology has had a somewhat radical reputation ever since. The remaining major classical cultural evolutionist was James Frazer, whose multivolume work The Golden Bough (1890) was a cross-cultural compendium of myths, folklore, and literature. Like Tylor, Frazer was interested in the evolution of the mental processes involved in magic, religion, and science. In his evolutionary scheme, magic came first and was based on the principles of contact and sympathetic magic. “Magicians” believed that they could control nature by bringing special elements together or, where direct contact was impossible, by substituting a concordant element. When magic failed, as Frazer knew it usually would, magicians turned to religion, distinguished by a sense of humility and acceptance that people cannot control nature but can only ask for divine intervention through prayer and other acts of supplication. Finally, as “correct” knowledge of the world increased, religion was supplanted by science, which, like magic, exerted control over nature, but control that worked. Like monotheism for Tylor, science for Frazer represented the mature stage of a cultural evolutionary sequence that 35

transmigrate To pass into another body after death, as do spirits and ghosts. shamans Magicoreligious specialists who communicate with ancestral ghosts and other spirits. ancestor worship The veneration of departed relatives; in classical cultural evolutionism, a religious phase. polytheism The belief in multiple deities; contrasted with monotheism. monotheism The belief in a single deity; contrasted with polytheism.

sympathetic magic Magic that can affect an object through a similar object.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.7  Sir James Frazer (1854–1941): The distinguished late Victorian cultural evolutionist sits in his armchair. Monod, Lucien Hector. “Sir James George.” Pencil on paper, 1907. © Pitt Rivers Museum, Oxford, UK/Bridgeman Images.

retained features of ancestral stages. The present was a product of the past; thus, seemingly trivial, exotic, and irrelevant aspects of culture made sense. Cultural evolutionism was the pre-eminent theory of nineteenth-century anthropology, and, because anthropology as a profession emerged in the nineteenth century, it is the earliest theory for which anthropology is widely known. Not all nineteenth-century anthropologists embraced the theory, however; notably, many of the fledgling ethnographers working on the American frontier and in European colonies overseas. For these fieldworkers, experiencing rather than theorizing about Indigenous cultures was more important. As fieldwork intensified, the penchant for grand synthesizing subsided, and anthropologists adopted new, nonevolutionary, and even anti-evolutionary perspectives. Cultural evolutionism fell out of favor, re-emerging only temporarily in the United States after World War II. 36

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How does prehistory differ from history? 2. How could anthropologists determine whether Lewis Henry Morgan’s evolutionary schema is correct? 3. Many classical cultural evolutionary schemas comprised three major periods – for example, savagery, barbarism, and civilization. Why do you think that the number three was so popular? 4. How does modern-day Christianity incorporate elements from earlier stages in the evolution of religion?

Evolutionism versus Diffusionism Key Words:  anthropo-geography, criterion of form, culture areas, culture circle, diffusionism, heliocentrism, hereditarianism, independent invention, Kulturkreis, psychic unity, racism Classical cultural evolutionists embraced the nineteenth-century doctrine of ­psychic unity, formulated by German geographer and ethnographer Adolf Bastian (1826–1905). According to this doctrine, all peoples, primitive and civilized alike, had the same basic capacity for cultural change. Primitive peoples were less advanced than civilized peoples not because their primitiveness was innate but because they had been stunted in evolutionary growth through contact with other peoples or simply because they had started evolving later. The doctrine of psychic unity represented a continuation of the eighteenth-century Enlightenment belief that all peoples could progress. Related to psychic unity was the doctrine of independent invention, an expression of faith that all peoples could be culturally creative. According to this doctrine, different peoples, given the same opportunity, could devise the same idea or artifact independently, without external stimulus or contact. Independent invention was one explanation of cultural change. The contrasting explanation was diffusionism, the doctrine that inventions arise only once and can be acquired by other groups only through borrowing or immigration. Diffusionism can be construed as non-egalitarian because it presupposes that some peoples are culturally creative while others can only copy. When cultural evolutionism fell out of favor in the early twentieth century, diffusionism was there to take its place. A simple diffusionist concept was that of culture areas, introduced in 1917 by American anthropologist Clark Wissler (1870–1947). Motivated by 37

psychic unity The doctrine that all peoples have the same fundamental capacity for change. independent invention The doctrine, linked to psychic unity, that cultural innovation can occur independently in more than one place; contrasted with diffusionism. diffusionism The doctrine that cultural innovations evolve once and are then acquired through borrowing or immigration; contrasted with independent invention. culture areas  Geographical areas associated with particular cultures.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.8  Culture Areas of North America: Each culture area is an implied center of cultural diffusion. From Driver, Harold E. Indians of North America. Copyright © 1961 by the University of Chicago Press. Reprinted by permission of the University of Chicago Press.

New World pride, Wissler wanted to show European anthropologists that Indigenous groups in America were not all the same. Therefore, he divided them into distinct culture areas, each with a center where the most important traits of the group originated and from which they had outwardly diffused. Following Wissler’s lead, other students of Indigenous peoples used the culture area concept to organize data, catalog artifacts, and arrange museum displays. 38

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

European versions of diffusionism were much more theoretically extreme. One notorious version was heliocentrism, promulgated by British and British Commonwealth anthropologists Grafton Elliot Smith (1871–1937),William Perry (1887–1949), and, for some of his career,William H.R. Rivers (1864–1922). Smith and his fellow theoreticians were fascinated by stone megaliths such as Egyptian pyramids, which they linked to a cult of sun worship. Citing similarities between pyramids and stone megaliths in Europe and in Central and South America, Smith pronounced that world civilization had originated around 4000 BCE in Egypt and then spread out, becoming more “dilute” and in some places never taking hold because local Indigenous peoples were incapable of assimilating it. Smith converted Rivers and Perry, whose book The Children of the Sun (1923) became a staple of this theoretical trade. Another extreme version of diffusionism was the Kulturkreis, or culture circle, school, derived in part from the anthropo-geography of German ethnologist Friedrich Ratzel (1844–1904). Interested in the relationship of people to their geographical neighbors, anthropo-geographers expressed strong opposition to Adolf Bastian’s doctrine of psychic unity. Ratzel believed that, after diffusion, culture traits could undergo adaptations to local conditions, masking their sources. To overcome this obstacle, he invoked the criterion of form, which implied that similar and functionally useless traits were the ones that had probably diffused. Ratzel’s follower Leo Frobenius (1873–1938) used geographical statistics to explore patterns of diffusion further. The criterion of form and geographical statistics both figured in the Kulturkreis approaches of Fritz Graebner (1877–1934) and Wilhelm Schmidt (1868–1954). In The Method of Ethnology (1911), Graebner argued that primitive bands with seminal ideas had spread around the world in a complex pattern of overlapping and interacting concentric circles. In his twelve-volume work Origin of the Idea of God (1912– 54), Schmidt described how, through diffusion, the seminal idea of monotheism had “degenerated.” The appeal of heliocentrism and the Kulturkreis approach in anthropology turned out to be relatively limited. An undercurrent of both approaches was the hereditarian belief that some human races were more capable of cultural innovation than others. Hereditarianism, or “racism,” was an attitude that early-twentieth-century anthropologists strongly opposed. For this reason, doctrinaire diffusionism never achieved a wide following – with one exception, Nazi Germany. The racial policies of Nazism, or National Socialism, drew support from both archaeology and biological anthropology. These policies took root in the early nineteenth century ethnological concept of Volksgeist, when the special spirit of the German people became linked to their manifest destiny as a superior race. In the late nineteenth century, Volksgeist helped motivate the unification the German state and its militarization leading up to World War I. Germany’s defeat 39

heliocentrism Literally “sun-centeredness,” the diffusionist view that world civilizations arose from sun worship in Egypt and then spread elsewhere.

Kulturkreis Translated “culture circle”; according to certain theorists, the pattern of diffusion of cultural traits.

culture circle In German, Kulturkreis, a concept used to represent the process of cultural diffusion. anthropo-geography  The study of relationships among geographically contiguous cultures, as practiced by Friedrich Ratzel. criterion of form The criterion used by anthropo-geographers to determine that similar cultural forms are the result of diffusion. hereditarianism The idea that differences among human beings can be accounted for primarily in terms of differential gene distribution to an extent greater than most twenty-firstcentury biological anthropologists would accept. racism A variously defined label for views that differences among human races are relatively fixed by nature and can be ranked from inferior to superior.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

in the war, and its self-perceived humiliation by punishing postwar reparations, sowed seeds of popular discontent that contributed to the rise of Adolf Hitler. Prior to Hitler, German archaeology had maintained a relatively low national profile, but Hitler promoted it vigorously in order to prove that Germany was the cradle of all civilization and that world prehistory was really Aryan prehistory. German archaeologist Gustaf Kossinna (1858–1931) harnessed the Kulturkreis theory to his view that German artifacts found outside Germany showed that Germans had once brought civilization to these areas and that Germany deserved to occupy them again. This argument helped justify Germany’s invasion of Poland and Czechoslovakia. Later, Alfred Rosenberg (1892–1946), head of the Reich Ministry for the organization Occupied Eastern Territories, promulgated the view that history was shaped by an epic battle between “Nordic Atlantic,” including German, peoples and “Semites,” or Jews. His Nazi Party organization Amt Rosenberg was responsible for the formulation of cultural policy. A similar organization, Ahnenerbe, was appended to the German Schultzstaffel, or SS, led by senior Nazi officer Heinrich Himmler (1900–45). These organizations produced archaeology pamphlets, books, movies, and exhibitions as propaganda for the Nazi program. During the Nazi era, German biological anthropology was better known as “race science,” or “race hygiene.” It was dominated by eugenics, which advocated selective breeding to “improve” or “purify” desired racial stocks. In the early twentieth century, eugenics enjoyed widespread scientific, popular, and government support on both sides of the Atlantic Ocean, and, in fact, Nazi eugenicists modeled some of their policies on those of the state of California. Nazis, however, took eugenics to a whole new level, starting with the forced sterilization and euthanasia of mentally and physically handicapped people, homosexuals, gypsies, and other non-Aryans and progressing to the horror of the extermination of millions of Jews in the Holocaust. Early architects of German eugenics were Alfred Ploetz (1860–1940) and Wilhelm Schallmayer (1857–1919), and in the years preceding World War II, eugenics expanded at the Kaiser Wilhelm Institute for Anthropology, where anthropologist and Nazi Party member Eugen Fischer (1874–1967) became director. Fischer, one of the leading anthropologists in the Third Reich, had been among the most prominent German anthropologists before the war. In 1938, he led the German delegation to the International Union of Anthropological and Ethnological Sciences meetings in Copenhagen. Accompanying him as a member of this “anthropological” delegation was future Auschwitz “angel of death” Josef Mengele (1911−79) – surely a candidate for the most sinister figure to posture as an anthropologist in a professional context. The complicity of some of these and other German anthropologists and archaeologists in Nazi racial politics is widely acknowledged. While they may not have created these policies, they at least acquiesced to them. In the early twenty-first century, all this might seem difficult to believe, 40

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

but it did happen and has given conscientious anthropologists pause to ensure that it does not happen again. In the wake of Nazism and the Holocaust, within anthropology, any theory tinged with hereditarianism and racism became disreputable and difficult to defend. That included diffusionism. Accordingly, in recent decades, anthropologists, including archaeologists, who propose early human contact over long distances have been held accountable with the burden of proof. This is especially true in New World archaeology, where efforts to prove transatlantic and transpacific – and even extraterrestrial – contact have been greeted with varying degrees of skepticism. A sensational example is the effort to prove that certain Native American earthen works, glyphs, and “astronomical” structures are the legacy of contact with alien beings from outer space. Less sensational are claims that Viking explorers once penetrated deep into North America, leaving behind mysterious “rune stones.” A more respected example is the 1947 voyage of Thor Heyerdahl (1914–2002) between South America and Polynesia on his wooden raft Kon-Tiki. In the 1990s, the discovery in the state of Washington of the 9,000-year-old skeleton of “Kennewick Man,” with alleged Caucasian features, and the recognition of surprisingly old archaeological sites in South America softened the hard opposition of some New World archaeologists to the idea of early transoceanic voyages. The result is that archaeological investigation of the peopling of the Americas is more open-minded on this issue than it was a generation ago. Much of this investigation is scholarly, but some of it is what scholars call fantastic, fringe, cult, or pseudo-archaeology. Three scholarly critiques of these latter genres are Fantastic Archaeology: The Wild Side of North American Prehistory (1991) by Stephen Williams; Archaeological Fantasies: How Pseudoarchaeology Misrepresents the Past and Misleads the Public (2006), edited by Garrett G. Fagan; and Faking History: Essays on Aliens, Atlantis, Monsters, and More (2013) by Jason Colavito. These critiques shed important light on the public image of archaeology and, more broadly, of anthropology.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Is it reasonable to criticize diffusionism because it presupposes that some peoples are culturally creative while other peoples can only copy? 2. What do you think accounts for the widespread popular ­fascination with an early Viking presence in North America? 3. Why is it tempting to make archaeology political?

41

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.9  Kon-Tiki (1947): Norwegian adventurer Thor Heyerdahl sailed across the Pacific Ocean from South America to Polynesia on this raft in order to demonstrate the feasibility of pre-Columbian contact between the two regions. Reproduced by permission of the Kon-Tiki Museum, Oslo.

Archaeology Comes of Age Key Words: Imperial Synthesis, Indigenous archaeology, material culture, Moundbuilder Myth, Neolithic/New Stone Age, Paleolithic/Old Stone Age, seriationally, Stone Age, stratigraphy, Three Age System material culture Cultural meaning expressed in the products of human artifice, or artifacts.

Three Age System The archaeological ages of Stone, Bronze, and Iron.

Archaeology, the study of past material culture, arose during the Renaissance when scholars began to study Classical artifacts to supplement what they could learn from Classical texts. During the Enlightenment, archaeology continued to be the handmaiden of history, even though in northern Europe written records of the past were much more scant. An autonomous archaeology required that artifacts be the only kind of evidence of the past. This requirement could be met only after acceptance of the existence of “pre” history. The scientific community began to accept the existence of prehistory toward the middle of the nineteenth century. This acceptance was built on decades of preceding archaeological work. The first significant archaeological chronology independent of written records was the Three Age System of Christian Thomsen (1788–1865). Thomsen was a Danish museum curator who organized artifacts 42

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

into the sequence of Stone, Bronze, and Iron ages and then subdivided these ages seriationally – that is, according to the evolution of artifact style. He implemented his chronology in the Museum of Northern Antiquities in Copenhagen and incorporated it into his influential Guidebook to Scandinavian Antiquity (1836). Fellow countryman Jens J.A. Worsaae (1821–85) continued Thomsen’s work by investigating the stratigraphy, or systematic layering, of artifacts in Danish shell middens. In The Primeval Antiquities of Denmark (1843), Worsaae generalized the Three Age System to most of Europe. Daniel Wilson (1816–92), a British archaeologist who later emigrated to Canada, employed the Three Age System in The Archaeology and Prehistoric Annals of Scotland (1851); it was Wilson who actually coined the term prehistory. In the 1850s, archaeological examination of ancient dwellings on lakeshores in Switzerland showed that the late Stone Age of Europe had seen plant and animal domestication. To designate this new phase of agriculture and animal husbandry, archaeologists added the Neolithic period, or New Stone Age, to their chronologies. These early archaeological chronologies had to fit within the relatively brief time span of approximately 6,000 years, which is how long most Christian scientists believed that human beings had been living on the Earth. In order to make prehistory longer, new archaeological evidence was required. This evidence came from Stone Age caves and glacial deposits on river terraces in Britain and France. The key finds here were human skeletal remains and stone tools in geological association with skeletal remains of extinct prehistoric animals, mainly mammoth and woolly rhinoceros. These finds conflicted with fundamentalist Christianity because the fundamentalist, or literal, interpretation of the Bible was that God had created human beings after other forms of life. Non-fundamentalist Christians were more inclined to accept this new archaeological evidence and the longer period of prehistory it implied. In 1859, British geologist Charles Lyell (1797– 1875) led a contingent of distinguished scientists to the Somme River Valley in northern France, where amateur archaeologist Jacques Boucher de Crèvecoeur de Perthes (1788–1868) had discovered a series of old Stone Age tools. The contingent pronounced the tools authentic. Their action marked the first scientific consensus about the great time depth of prehistory and is the symbolic birth of the science of prehistoric archaeology. This action spurred more prehistoric archaeological research that was incorporated into major syntheses such as Lyell’s Geological Evidences of the Antiquity of Man (1863) and Pre-Historic Times (1865) by John Lubbock, who coined the term Paleolithic or Old Stone Age.Well before the end of the century, archaeologists had established a detailed chronology of the Paleolithic and all other major stages of European prehistory. Today, while all professional archaeologists and biological anthropologists accept the premises that the earth is very old, that evolution has taken place for a very long time, and that the human species evolved well after countless other species became extinct, these professionals represent only a tiny 43

seriationally According to the archaeological principle of seriation, or relative dating by the evolution of artifact style. stratigraphy The archaeological dating of artifacts relative to their placement in systematically layered earth. Stone Age The Old Stone Age, or Paleolithic, and the New Stone Age, or Neolithic. Neolithic or New Stone Age The period of prehistory characterized by polished stone tools and the domestication of animals and plants.

Paleolithic or Old Stone Age The period of prehistory characterized by chipped and flaked stone tools and hunting and gathering.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Imperial Synthesis  A name for the nineteenthcentury synthesis of archaeology, racism, and colonialism. Moundbuilder Myth The myth that a mysterious people other than Native Americans built impressive earthen mounds throughout the American Midwest.

fraction of the world’s population, even the world’s formally educated population. They are vastly outnumbered by people who reject the ideas of ancient prehistory and evolution and instead believe in one or another of various creationist accounts of the divine origin of the universe. The most extreme of these accounts depict the Earth and all living things on it originating about 6,000 years ago in six 24-hour days. In the United States, to present such accounts to the public, so-called creation museums have appeared in several states, as well as in Canada, China, Hong Kong, and the United Kingdom. One of the grandest of these museums is the Creation Museum in Petersburg, Kentucky. Operated by the Christian organization Answers in Genesis (AIG), it houses numerous visually impressive exhibits, including one that shows people coexisting with dinosaurs. Privately funded, the museum opened in 2007 and has attracted many visitors. In 2015, cashing in on this popularity, AIG opened Ark Encounter, a nearby creationist theme park. These installations, all of them controversial, have sprung up in the context of a heated American debate about the teaching of evolution in public schools. This debated ignited in 1925 with the famous “Monkey Trial” of highschool teacher John T. Scopes in Dayton, Tennessee, and rekindled in the 1980s with legal court challenges in other jurisdictions. In response to these developments, various anthropology and archaeology organizations mounted efforts to educate the public about anthropology from an early age, targeting elementary, junior, and senior high schools. The National Center for Science Education, for a long time led by biological anthropologist Eugenie Scott (b. 1945), published Creation Evolution Newsletter, which enjoyed wide North American circulation. In later years, these efforts have dovetailed with the rise of public anthropology and a concern with the public image of the profession. Back in the nineteenth century, like cultural evolutionists, archaeologists used the comparative method to reconstruct the prehistoric past. A prime example was Lubbock, whose 1865 book was fully titled Pre-Historic Times, as Illustrated by Ancient Remains, and the Manner and Customs of Modern Savages. But prehistoric archaeologists were less generous than cultural evolutionists in granting modern “savages” the ability to progress. Lubbock believed that white Europeans were the prime beneficiaries of a material progress that had been achieved through millennia of human struggle. In A History of Archaeological Thought (1989), Bruce Trigger represented Lubbock’s attitude as the Imperial Synthesis and characterized it as racist rationalization for European colonial expansion. Racism was certainly widespread because, outside Europe, where the prehistoric past was not “white,” the accomplishments of prehistoric races were denigrated. In North America, archaeologists were loath to accept the idea that Native peoples could have built the complex earthen mounds found along the Mississippi river valley. Instead, they proposed the Moundbuilder Myth, according to which the mounds had been built by a pre-Native race that either had migrated to Central and South America to build the grand monuments of the Aztecs and Incas or had “degenerated” into 44

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.10  Boarding Noah’s Ark: This replica at Ark Encounter park in Williamston, Kentucky, was built to dimensions derived from the Bible. Since opening in 2016, it has attracted hundreds of thousands of visitors. Wikimedia user Cimerondagert, 3 May 2019, CC-BY 4.0. https://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/File:Ark _Encounter_005.jpg.

“Indians.” A cornerstone publication on this controversy was Ancient Monuments of the Mississippi Valley (1848) by Ephraim G. Squier (1821–88) and Edwin H. Davis (1811–88). The same racist attitude prevailed in Africa, where archaeologists attributed mysterious stone ruins to King Solomon or other ancient Near Easterners. British colonial capitalist Cecil Rhodes (1853–1902) embraced this opinion and used it to argue that, in colonizing former Rhodesia, Europeans were really reclaiming lands that were formerly white. Colonialist archaeology came into play almost everywhere European archaeologists encountered non-white Indigenous peoples. In modern times, more and more archaeologists have come to recognize the political nature of their discipline and to acknowledge that racism was endemic in their nineteenth-century forerunners. A case in point is archaeologist David Hurst Thomas’s book Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, and the Battle for Native American Identity (2000). In his book,Thomas recounts the troubled history of grave robbing, the public display of Native peoples, and other dehumanizing practices that characterized American archaeology and physical anthropology well into the twentieth century. He concludes on an optimistic note that current 45

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.11  Grave Creek Burial Mound, West Virginia: Proponents of the nineteenth-century “Moundbuilder Myth” refused to believe that mounds such as this one, depicted here by an artist, could have been constructed by Indigenous peoples or their ancestors. From Squier, Ephraim G. and E.H. Davis. Ancient Monuments of the Mississippi Valley. Volume 1.Washington, DC: Smithsonian Contributions to Knowledge, 1848.

Indigenous archaeology  Archaeology that in theory and practice incorporates Indigenous perspectives and participation.

generations of American archaeologists and Native Americans have begun to work together to explore the human past in mutually acceptable ways. Thomas and other influential archaeologists have helped make contemporary archaeology highly engaged politically, ethically, and theoretically. Contemporary Marxist archaeologists tend to emphasize materialism and class struggle; feminist archaeologists to contest Western-based categories of sex and gender; political-economic archaeologists to look for the consequences of hegemonic systems such as capitalism; postmodernist archaeologists to emphasize how narratives about the past are socially constructed; and globalization-oriented archaeologists to analyze past cultures as not isolated but interconnected. Each of these perspectives has given rise to a burgeoning archaeology community. Contemporary public archaeologists are especially attuned to issues of accountability and inclusiveness. Noteworthy in this regard is the rise of Indigenous archaeology, or archaeology that incorporates Indigenous perspectives. Contesting the rigid boundary between history and prehistory, Indigenous archaeology seeks to “decolonize” archaeology and make room for alternative narratives, notably oral narratives. There has been a welcomed increase in the number of practicing Indigenous archaeologists, and consultation and partnership with Indigenous communities 46

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

has become a cornerstone of archaeological best practice. Indigenous archaeology appears to be on track to become the new normal in many jurisdictions.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How can the Bible be interpreted to show that Earth is only a few thousand years old? 2. Where did the term Stone Age come from? 3. What past archaeological practices would be considered unethical today? 4. In what ways can Indigenous perspectives change archaeology?

Charles Darwin and Darwinism Key Words: altruism, binomial nomenclature, biogenetic law, catastrophism, creationism, Darwinism, DNA, epigenetic evolution, evolutionary developmental biology, Great Chain of Being, group selection, Human Genome Diversity Project, Human Genome Project, inheritance of acquired characteristics, Lamarckism, missing links, natural selection, Neptunists, ontogeny, orthogenesis, phylogeny, punctuated equilibrium, recombinant DNA, sexual selection, Social Darwinism, species, struggle for existence, survival of the fittest, swamping effect, synthetic philosophy, synthetic theory of evolution, teleology, uniformitarianism, vitalism,Vulcanists The racism of nineteenth-century anthropology was linked to the smug optimism and sense of superiority of V   ictorian times. Darwinism, the name given to ideas associated with Charles Darwin’s theory of biological evolution, was part cause and part effect of these Victorian attitudes.The long, complex story of Darwinism begins with the Scientific Revolution. While dynamic, the universe envisioned by Isaac Newton was not evolving. Bodies moving according to the law of universal gravitation were not being transformed into new bodies or arranged in new ways. Evolution, however, was a logical next step. The first Newtonian-era scientists to explore evolution were geologists interested in the origin and development of the Earth. In medieval cosmologies, the Earth was “special” because it was the center of the universe and the habitat of people, the noblest creation of God. In the seventeenth century, such views persisted, so geology had to be carefully reconciled with scripture. One reconciliation was attempted by Thomas Burnet (1635–1715) in The Sacred 47

Darwinism A general label for ideas associated with Charles Darwin’s theory of evolution.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.12  Carolus Linnaeus’s Biological Classification of Humanity: In Systema Naturae (1735), Linnaeus (1707–78) was one of the first naturalists to classify the genus Homo within the animal kingdom. Systema Naturae (1735), digitized by Google.

48

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Theory of the Earth (1691). After Creation, the Earth had cooled, and layers of land formed above seas. The shape of the Earth was a perfect circle, created for people who then sinned and had to be punished. Punishment took the form of a deluge, or global flood, that caused almost all land to collapse under water, leaving “ugly,” imperfectly shaped mountains as a reminder of this sin. Another reconciliation was attempted by William Whiston (1667–1752) in A New Theory of the Earth (1696). After Creation, a comet had passed Earth and distributed dust that solidified into land by the force of gravity. Later, another comet distributed drops of water that precipitated the biblical Flood. Both Whiston’s and Burnet’s reconciliations were theologically ominous because they implied that the Earth was very old and rendered constant divine intervention redundant. Meanwhile, as faith in science began to supplant faith in Christianity, a pressing problem arose. Geologists discovered fossils of marine forms of life embedded in sedimentary rocks formed underwater but currently far above water on land. How did these fossils get there? Answering this question was a preoccupation of eighteenth-century geology. An initial explanation was that the rocks were products of the geological destruction, dislocation, and receding waters of the biblical Flood. It soon became apparent, however, that marine fossil-bearing strata were far more geologically complex. There were two options: either water had receded or land had risen. Geologists who preferred the first option were called Neptunists, named after Neptune, the Roman god of the sea; those who preferred the second option were called Vulcanists, named after Vulcan, the Roman god of fire. Pursuing the initial explanation, Neptunists maintained that marine fossils were deposited in sedimentary rocks formed underwater and then exposed as water receded.Vulcanists also believed that sedimentary rocks were formed underwater, but they maintained that the rocks were then thrust above water by earthquakes and volcanoes caused by pressure from a hot, molten, subterranean earthly core. When Vulcanists asked Neptunists where all the water went, Neptunists had no answer. But until there was more geological evidence of the power of earthquakes and volcanoes,Vulcanists were vulnerable too. A convincing, essentially Vulcanist geology was finally achieved by James Hutton (1726–97) in Theory of the Earth (1795), later popularized by John Playfair (1748–1819) in Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory of the Earth (1802). In the Hutton–Playfair model, not all sedimentary rocks were formed in universal water. Some debris washed into water from land, while molten masses penetrated the ocean floor and deposited additional strata, which were then thrust above water by volcanoes. These geological processes had been operating for so long that the age of the Earth was almost beyond scientific comprehension. Hutton summarized his view of relentless geological activity as “no vestige of a beginning, no prospect of an end.” All these developments culminated in Charles Lyell’s landmark multivolume work Principles of Geology (1830–3), a foundation of modern geology. To account 49

Neptunists Geologists who proposed that the principal agent of major geological change was the subsidence of water; contrasted with Vulcanists. Vulcanists Geologists who proposed that major geological changes were caused by the elevation of land brought about by volcanic heat; contrasted with Neptunists.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.13  Comparison of Ape and Human Skeletons: By comparing the skeletons of apes and “man,” Thomas H. Huxley (1825–95) compiled circumstantial evidence for human evolution. From Man’s Place in Nature. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. Copyright © 1959 by The University of Michigan Press.

uniformitarianism The doctrine that gradual geological agents of change have operated throughout the past; contrasted with catastrophism. catastrophism The geological doctrine that agents of geological change have been more dramatic in the past than in the present; contrasted with uniformitarianism.

for geological change, Lyell invoked a combination of agents, some Neptunist and others Vulcanist, that worked slowly over long periods of time. Because presentday agents of change such as wind and water erosion were slow, yet the changes they had produced were dramatic, Lyell was forced to conclude that the Earth was extremely old. His geology was a brand of uniformitarianism, the doctrine that the same nondramatic agents of geological change have been operating throughout history. Uniformitarianism contrasts with catastrophism, the doctrine that agents of geological change have been more dramatic in the past than in the present. Conservative scientists of Christian background who believed that the Earth was extremely young favored catastrophism over uniformitarianism because dramatic geological agents such as global floods could produce major change quickly. A distinguished catastrophist and antagonist of Lyell was French paleontologist Georges Cuvier (1769–1832), who interpreted change in the fossil record as evidence of a series of mass near-extinctions interspersed with survivals of a few fortunate life forms. Cuvier’s catastrophism was “progressive,” because it involved positive directional change, but he was not an evolutionist because change for him was essentially discontinuous, without transformation. Lyell’s uniformitarianism was less progressive because, like his predecessor Hutton, he regarded constructive and destructive agents as offsetting each other, in the long run achieving equilibrium. Lyell was a geological evolutionist, however, because his geological agents caused transformational change. And while Lyell opposed uniformitarianism in biology, the great achievement of his friend Charles Darwin was to combine the transformative nature of uniformitarianism with the progressive nature of catastrophism into a comprehensive theory of biological evolution. 50

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.14  Charles Darwin’s Study at Down House, Kent, England: Darwin (1809–82) wrote On the Origin of Species and other books here. Engraving, 1882. English School, 19th century. © Private Collection/ Bridgeman Images.

In the history of the idea of biological evolution, the great debate was about the origin of species. A species is a group of plants or animals whose members can reproduce with one another but cannot reproduce with members of other species. Where do species come from? The traditional scientific answer, based on Judeo-Christianity, was that God created all species, which were immutable, or fixed. New species did not appear in Creation through evolution, and old species did not disappear through extinction. Moreover, species were arranged in a fixed linear hierarchy, construed by medieval philosophers as the Great Chain of Being. Traditionally, species were “real,” not merely names for groups of individuals. They were transcendental, Platonic essences attesting to the perfection of Creation. A prime example of traditional creationism was developed by Carolus Linnaeus (1707–78), the Swedish biologist who classified living things into a hierarchy of taxonomic categories, using a system of binomial nomenclature, or two names, for the category of species. In his System of Nature (1735), Linnaeus introduced many of the taxonomic names (of kingdoms, phyla, genera, and so forth) that are used in evolutionary biology today. Until late in his life, however, Linnaeus denied evolution and adhered strongly to the creationist position. More liberal, or radical, Enlightenment biologists broke rank with traditional creationists. Their answer to the question of the origin of species was that species 51

species A group of organisms whose members can reproduce only with one another. Great Chain of Being A medieval philosophical schema that ranked all cosmic and earthly elements, including people, in a single ascending line of importance. creationism The view that biological species are divinely created and do not evolve. binomial nomenclature The hierarchical system of classifying living things into named scientific groups, with one name for genus and a second name for species.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

inheritance of acquired characteristics The mechanism of biological evolution, proposed by Jean Lamarck, whereby traits acquired in one generation can be transmitted to subsequent generations. DNA Deoxyribonucleic acid, the biochemical substance of heredity. vitalism The idea that biological evolution is self-motivated or willed. teleology The idea that biological evolution adheres to a long-term purpose or goal. orthogenesis The idea that biological evolution operates in one direction, usually leading to Homo sapiens.

were created by nature and were mutable, or susceptible to change. New species appeared and disappeared through natural causes. Species were not necessarily arranged in a fixed linear hierarchy, and they were not “real” in the Platonic sense of the term. Instead, they were transient categories that altered the face of Creation. Biologists who adhered to this set of ideas were called transformists, developmentalists, or, later, evolutionists. Before Darwin, a number of scientists proposed theories of biological evolution, among them Georges-Louis Leclerc, Comte de Buffon (1707–78), and Darwin’s own grandfather, Erasmus Darwin (1731–1802). The most influential pre-Darwinian evolutionist was Jean-Baptiste Pierre Antoine de Monet Lamarck (1744–1829), whose Zoological Philosophy (1809) appeared exactly 50 years before Darwin’s On the Origin of Species (1859). Lamarck’s approach to evolution differed from Darwin’s in ways that can be illustrated by the example of the evolution of the long-necked giraffe. According to Lamarck, the ancestor of the long-necked giraffe was a giraffe with a short neck. These short-necked giraffes lived on savannah-like grasslands where desirable edible vegetation was available on trees. To reach this vegetation, the giraffes stretched their necks. As a result, their offspring were born with longer necks – that is, necks longer than they would have been if their parents had not stretched. This new generation of giraffes stretched their necks for the same reason, so their offspring were born with still longer necks. Over time, as this process continued, neck length increased, until the present-day long-necked giraffe evolved. Lamarck was unable to prove that ancestral and descendant giraffes belonged to different species because, with ancestral giraffes extinct, he could not demonstrate that members of the two groups were unable to reproduce. Nonetheless, by comparing the magnitude of their difference to the magnitude of differences among known species, he was able to render this judgment. The non-Darwinian feature of Lamarckian evolution illustrated in this example will be obvious to any student of modern biology. It is the feature known as inheritance of acquired characteristics. In the example, the characteristic of longer necks was inherited by offspring because it was acquired by parents. Early modern biologists showed that acquired characteristics are not inherited unless their acquisition itself is hereditary, or preprogrammed in deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA); except for recombination, DNA is inherited from generation to generation intact. Other non-Darwinian features of Lamarckian evolution, not illustrated in this example, are vitalism, the doctrine that evolution is self-motivated, or willed; teleology, the doctrine that evolution adheres to a long-range purpose or goal; and orthogenesis, the doctrine that evolution has worked in a straight line to produce Homo sapiens. From many moral points of view, these features make Lamarckian evolution more palatable than Darwinian evolution. In the early nineteenth century, when Darwin was growing up, the Lamarckian version of evolution was the one most commonly discussed. 52

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Charles Darwin (1809–82) grew up in England at the dawn of the Victorian era. As a young man, he wanted to study medicine, but he soon learned that he could not stand the sight of blood, so he dropped out of medical school in Edinburgh and enrolled in Christ’s College, Cambridge. At Cambridge, he became a budding naturalist and was encouraged by a number of faculty “mentors.” One helped arrange his appointment as naturalist on the ship H.M.S. Beagle, which in 1831 set out on a five-year voyage around the world.The voyage of the Beagle was a crucible for Darwin’s ideas. Before the Beagle left England, Darwin had begun reading Lyell’s Principles of Geology. During the voyage, he completed reading this work and became inspired to search for a biological process equivalent to uniformitarian processes in geology. As the Beagle sailed around the Atlantic and Pacific coasts of South America, Darwin observed that the geographical distribution of varieties of plants and animals correlated with the distribution of variation in useful environmental resources. When he visited the Galapagos Islands off the coast of Ecuador, he observed that varieties of finches and tortoises differed slightly from one island to another and also differed from varieties on the South American mainland. How and why did these differences develop? When the Beagle arrived back in England, Darwin was already converted to the idea of evolution. He undertook years of scientific research to strengthen his reputation as a naturalist while he pondered new, non-Lamarckian mechanisms that might make evolution work.Then he read An Essay on the Principle of Population (1798) by Thomas Robert Malthus (1766–1834). Malthus was the pessimistic political theorist who explained how the human population of the world was increasing geometrically (2, 4, 8, 16, 32, etc.) while global resources needed for human survival were increasing only arithmetically (2, 4, 6, 8, 10, etc.). The inevitable consequence of these trends was that not everyone born could possibly survive. Darwin embraced this Malthusian vision and broadened it to include all of biological nature, where organisms engage in a struggle for existence producing survival of the fittest. Knowing now how evolution worked, Darwin began to draft his book on evolution. He worked on it sporadically for many years until, in 1858, he received a letter from fellow naturalist Alfred Russel Wallace (1823–1913). Wallace, writing from the Pacific South Seas, described a theory of evolution by natural selection that Darwin recognized immediately as almost exactly like his own. After consulting with friends, he decided to finish his book quickly. First, however, Darwin and Wallace presented a joint paper on evolution to a meeting of the Linnaean Society in London (neither man was actually there). The following year, in 1859, Darwin’s On the Origin of Species appeared. Ever since, the theory of evolution by natural selection, independently formulated by both Darwin and Wallace, has been known as “Darwinism.” A good way to understand Darwin’s theory of evolution is to contrast it with Lamarck’s theory using the example of the long-necked giraffe. Darwin would 53

struggle for existence Charles Darwin’s view that evolution by natural selection involves competition for limited resources and results in survival of the fittest. survival of the fittest In Charles Darwin’s theory of evolution by natural selection, the adaptive outcome of the struggle for existence.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

natural selection Charles Darwin’s mechanism for biological evolution, involving struggle for existence and survival of the fittest.

have approached this example with a different premise. A group, or population, of ancestral short-necked giraffes was living on savannah-like grasslands.They needed to eat vegetation from trees to survive. Some giraffes had slightly longer necks than others. These giraffes had a slight advantage over the other giraffes in the competitive struggle for vegetation needed to survive. Beating out the competition because of this natural advantage, they ate more, became healthier, or in some other way had more offspring. Gradually, over time, as the long-necked giraffes had more offspring than the short-necked giraffes, average neck length in the population increased until the present long-necked giraffe species evolved. Darwin represented this sequence of events as natural selection, meaning, metaphorically, that “nature” selects advantageous traits just like human breeders “artificially” select advantageous traits when they domesticate plants and animals. The result in both cases is that organisms become adapted to their environments. To argue his case in On the Origin of Species, Darwin adduced several kinds of evidence. Except for the results of plant and animal breeding, almost all of this evidence was circumstantial. He argued that anatomical and embryological similarities among organisms, the presence of vestigial organs, and, although incomplete, the record of fossils were all consistent with his theory. A problem for Darwinism – then and now – is that this same evidence is consistent with many versions of creationism. Suffice it to say that eventually the scientific community came to accept Darwin’s theory. His theory represents an extension of the Scientific Revolution from astronomy and physics into biology. Darwin really went beyond Newton, because he showed that basic structures of the universe evolve. On the Origin of Species provoked a barrage of moral, religious, and social criticism. Many critics failed to realize, or admit, that the book made hardly any reference to the evolution of Homo sapiens. Darwin ducked this controversial topic for several years. Some of his friends, however, confronted the controversy headon. The main implication for Homo sapiens was the evolution of human mental and moral qualities. Most Christians believed that animals lacked spirituality and were, mentally and morally, a world apart from human beings. Could evolution bridge this gap? In Geological Evidences of the Antiquity of Man (1863), Charles Lyell described human evolution as a natural leap onto a new plane of life. Alfred Russel Wallace disagreed, arguing that mental and moral superiority would have conferred no real selective advantage on animals and, therefore, could not have evolved in the first place. Why, for example, would an animal need to be artistic, mathematical, or philosophical? According to Wallace, divine intervention must have been responsible. Other scientists were more open to the idea of Darwinian human evolution. At the time, only a few human fossils were known, and, unfortunately for human evolutionists, these fossils appeared neither particularly old nor particularly primitive. Still, in Evidence as to Man’s Place in Nature (1863), Thomas Henry Huxley (1825–95) – nicknamed “Darwin’s Bulldog” because he defended Darwin so staunchly in public debates – classified people and apes in the same 54

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

taxonomic order. Without fossils, the artifact record of prehistory became more important, so human evolutionists also cited the work of archaeologists such as John Lubbock and cultural evolutionists such as Lewis Henry Morgan and Edward Burnett Tylor. Darwin eventually published his views on human evolution in The Descent of Man (1871). Much of this book, and also much of Darwin’s The Expression of the Emotions in Man and the Animals (1872), was devoted to the argument that differences between animals and people are differences in degree rather than in kind. To explain the evolution of human physical traits, Darwin used the mechanism of sexual selection. With sexual selection, traits evolve not because they confer an adaptive advantage in the struggle for existence but because they make members of one sex more attractive to the other and in this way increase reproductive success. Human intelligence, Darwin said, was evolved by natural selection as a by-product of upright stature, which freed human hands for the use of tools. To explain the evolution of human morality, Darwin relied on the mechanism of group selection. The core of morality was altruism, the willingness to sacrifice oneself for the good of others. Altruism was initially selected in groups, when one member behaved altruistically and, as a result, other group members benefited. Later, after human beings became intelligent, they extended altruism beyond the local group to all humanity in the form of abstract moral codes. Viewed from the perspective of modern science, Darwin’s explanations appear to conflate, or confuse, biological and cultural evolution. In this regard, he was not much different from his Victorian scientist contemporaries. Almost all ­nineteenth-century human evolutionists were extremely hereditarian. Like “racism” in archaeology, racism in biological anthropology was a legacy from the nineteenth century. Darwin and his friends did not espouse many of the religious, moral, and social attitudes now labeled “Darwinian.” The main religious challenge to his theories was not based on biblical fundamentalism, because by the 1860s the Bible was no longer widely accepted as necessarily historically accurate. Instead, it was based on morality. If human beings were the product of evolution, not divine creation, would not a system of morality have to be based on the process of evolution itself? And if so, would not the easiest way to construct such a system be to treat evolution as intrinsically and ultimately purposeful? The problem was that, contrasted with Lamarckian evolution, Darwinian evolution appeared to lack ultimate purpose; instead it operated opportunistically, selecting characteristics adapted to only a circumscribed time and place. Alternatively, if Darwinian evolution were a divine instrument – God’s way of creating – the mechanism of natural selection appeared excessively brutal. It involved relentlessly harsh struggle, competition, and death for individuals unable to adapt. It was always possible, of course, to argue, as many Darwinians did, that these unfortunate losses were compensated for by evolutionary “winners,” who helped humanity “improve.” But this position was morally 55

sexual selection Charles Darwin’s evolutionary mechanism whereby members of one sex compete for the attention of members of the opposite sex. group selection A form of natural selection in which individuals behave altruistically, helping their group, and thereby helping themselves; contrasted with kin selection. altruism Self-sacrificing behavior, seemingly contrary to natural selection.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY Lamarckism The evolutionary philosophy of Jean Lamarck, notably his mechanism of the inheritance of acquired characteristics. Social Darwinism  A loosely used term referring to social philosophies based on Darwinian evolutionism, especially the mechanism of natural selection. synthetic philosophy The all-encompassing philosophy of Herbert Spencer based on the premise that homogeneity is evolving into heterogeneity everywhere.

missing links Perceived gaps in the evolutionary record. biogenetic law The principle that ontogeny, the growth of the individual, recapitulates phylogeny, the growth of the species. ontogeny The biological growth of an individual. phylogeny The evolutionary growth of a species.

precarious, and in most cases it was easier to abandon Darwinian evolution in favor of the Lamarckian mechanism of inheritance of acquired characteristics, which seemed more humane and offered hope that people might take charge of their evolutionary fate. In the late nineteenth century, Lamarckism became the doctrine of choice for the majority of scientists seeking to reconcile evolution with religious morality. In discussions of social morality, the term Social Darwinism is historically misleading. Most of the social attitudes denoted by this term derive not from Darwin but from Herbert Spencer, the most philosophical and sociological of the classical cultural evolutionists. Spencer promoted a grandiose synthetic philosophy based on the premise that homogeneity was evolving into heterogeneity in several universal domains. Referring to the domain of evolutionary biology, Spencer was Lamarckian rather than Darwinian, but referring to the domain of social evolution, he believed that vigorous individual enterprise had risen to the fore. According to Spencer, a system of individuals acting in their own self-­interest produced the maximum social good. There were no moral absolutes. Instead, “might” made “right.” Spencer believed that human evolution should be allowed to take its “natural” course, unfettered by interventions that would “artificially” bolster human weaknesses otherwise slated for defeat. Spencer’s was the most popular version of Social Darwinism and the one used most often to rationalize social inequities among races, classes, and genders. Meanwhile, Huxley, Darwin’s “bulldog,” advocated an opposing version. Huxley was an agnostic who actively doubted religion and believed that science should maintain moral neutrality. He opposed Spencer and anyone else who based social morality on biological evolution. To the contrary, argued Huxley, through cosmic accident Homo sapiens had evolved to the point where people were able to understand that evolution has no purpose. Why not take advantage of this opportunity and create a morality that is independent of evolution and even goes against the harshness of nature? In the nineteenth century, between the extremes of Huxley and Spencer, there were so many different versions of Social Darwinism that the term really needs to be redefined almost every time it is used. Amidst all the wrangling over religious and social morality, Darwin’s theory of evolution by natural selection suffered major scientific setbacks. From the beginning, there had not been much experimental proof that natural selection could produce new species, even with artificial breeding, which produced mainly subspecies, or varieties. Another problem was the fossil record. Darwin admitted that the record was imperfect and contained gaps, or missing links. Some scientists filled these gaps with speculative evolutionary sequences, such as those based on the biogenetic law. This law stated that ontogeny, the growth of an individual, recapitulated phylogeny, the evolutionary growth of a species. Proponents of the law made extreme statements about embryological and paleontological similarities and detracted from the credibility of evolution as empirical science. Yet 56

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

another problem was the age of the Earth. Evolution by natural selection was a slow process that required a great deal of time to account for changes observable in the fossil record. Contemporary physicists, thinking about volcanic activity as an agent of geological change, decided that the Earth had been much hotter in the past than in the present and that volcanic activity had been much more forceful. A troubling implication was that this volcanic activity had wrought geological changes too quickly for Darwinian evolution to have worked. A final problem for Darwin was the swamping effect, the name given to the observation that small variations serving as raw material for natural selection would always be “swamped out” through heredity, preventing natural selection from ever getting started. Darwin was aware of all these scientific problems and as a result grew discouraged. He lost confidence in the complete efficacy of natural selection and, in later editions of On the Origin of Species, turned to other evolutionary mechanisms, including the Lamarckian mechanism of inheritance of acquired characteristics. The solutions to Darwin’s scientific problems were beyond his nineteenthcentury grasp. What Darwin needed was the theory of biological heredity pioneered, unknown to him, by Austrian monk Gregor Mendel (1822–84). By experimenting with pea plants, Mendel observed patterns of inheritance that showed heritable traits to be discrete rather than blended. Some traits, called recessive, disappeared temporarily in the presence of other traits, called dominant, but reappeared later when they were by themselves. Mendel knew little about the physical substance of heredity, now known to be DNA, located on genes on chromosomes in the nuclei of cells. His observations went largely unnoticed until 1900, when they were rediscovered by biologists investigating inheritance in plants. These biologists stressed heritable change by mutation, or large changes that occur within a single generation. In contrast, Darwinian natural selection involves small changes that occur over many generations. Biologists thereby separated into two camps: one, the Mendelians, promoting mutation, and the other, the Darwinians, promoting natural selection as the mechanism of evolution. In the 1930s, a group of mathematically inclined biologists showed that Mendelism and Darwinism are complementary, not antagonistic, because genes are subject to both mutation and natural selection. These biologists devised the synthetic theory of evolution, whereby an evolving population is conceived as a “gene pool” and evolution is defined as a change in the relative frequency of genes in that gene pool. The synthetic theory of evolution formed the basis of population genetics, the branch of biology with the scientific vocabulary used to study evolution from the mid-twentieth century onward. In the latter part of the twentieth century, a number of exciting theoretical and technological developments pushed the study of population genetics in new directions. One was the introduction in the 1970s of the theory of punctuated equilibrium by Stephen Jay Gould (1941–2002) and Niles Eldredge (b. 1943). Gould and Eldredge’s idea was that evolution was not always the slow, constant 57

swamping effect The observation in Charles Darwin’s time that small variations would always be diluted by heredity and therefore could not increase or intensify through natural selection.

synthetic theory of evolution The twentieth-century theoretical synthesis of Darwinian evolutionism and Mendelian genetics. punctuated equilibrium The concept that evolution occurs not always slowly and gradually but sometimes variably, with long periods of little change interspersed with rapid periods of extensive change.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

recombinant DNA The groundbreaking laboratory technology that allowed DNA from one organism to be cloned and inserted into another organism, facilitating understanding of how DNA works in those organisms. evolutionary developmental biology Or “evo-devo,” the genetic study of how development in different organisms occurs, with the aim of inferring evolutionary relationships among those organisms. epigenetic evolution The evolutionary process by which environmentally induced alteration of the expression of genes can be inherited, tantamount to Lamarckism.

FIGURE 1.15  Feelings about Darwinism Run High: This contemporary poster satirizes contemporary opposition to the teaching of evolution. Copyright © LearningReligions / Austin Cline. Reprinted by permission of Dotdash.com.

process envisioned by Charles Darwin but instead was a sometimes-variable process of hardly any change, or equilibrium, punctuated by periods of rapid change, especially at times of speciation. This idea prompted considerable debate among evolutionary biologists and anthropologists, who began to explore whether the pattern of human evolution conformed to the punctuated equilibrium model. At around the same time, the advent of recombinant DNA technology allowed researchers to explore DNA function at a level hitherto unachievable. These explorations led to the insight that DNA is not so much a “blueprint” as it is a “switch” for development of the individual, an insight that in turn led to an integration of embryology into the study of evolution in the new field of ­evolutionary developmental biology, or “evo-devo.” A related new theory was epigenetic evolution, based on the discovery that certain chemicals can alter the phenotypic expression of genes that then become heritable. Key environmental triggers for this action appear to be deprivation and stress. Epigenetics is potentially theoretically revolutionary because it implies that heritable modifications of a phenotype can be caused without changes to the underlying genotype, 58

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

tantamount to Lamarckism. Epigenetics may have been important in primate evolution, contributing to phenotypic differences among apes. It is also implicated in the activity of the human brain. In the early 1990s, recombinant DNA and other new technologies also facilitated the international Human Genome Project, which by the early 2000s had yielded the DNA identities of entire human beings. Slightly later, a group of geneticists launched the Human Genome Diversity Project, which sought to broaden the representativeness of this sample. The Human Genome Diversity Project was controversial within anthropology because it raised ethical issues surrounding consent and ownership of the DNA samples obtained from Indigenous people. All this discussion and debate took place at a time when ethics and accountability were becoming the rallying cry for a growing number of public anthropologists. The upshot is that in the early twenty-first century, for anthropology, the scientific and social dimensions of evolutionary biology have become intertwined.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. For a catastrophist geologist, do ancient fossils constitute evidence for evolution? 2. Why do you suppose many people find Lamarckian evolution more palatable than Darwinian evolution? 3. Why is the term natural selection an apt label for Charles Darwin’s mechanism of evolution? 4. Why is it challenging to explain human evolution in terms of natural selection? 5. Which version of morality based on Darwinism do you find most credible? 6. Is Darwinism a theory? 7. In any future human genome diversity project, which individuals should be used to represent that diversity?

Sigmund Freud Key Words: ego, Electra complex, father figures, hysteria, id, incest, Oedipus complex, pleasure principle, primal patricide, primeval family, psyche, racial memory, reality principle, subconscious, sublimate, superego, taboos, totems Besides Charles Darwin and Karl Marx, the nineteenth century produced four other intellectual giants whose influence on anthropology has been profound: 59

Human Genome Project A latetwentieth-century international research project that succeeded in mapping, or assigning, the structures of human DNA to particular places on particular human chromosomes. Human Genome Diversity Project A late-twentieth-century international research project involving the use of DNA obtained from Indigenous populations to reconstruct the pattern of evolutionary relationships among those populations.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

hysteria The clinical condition of calm hallucination that got Sigmund Freud interested in psychology. subconscious  According to Sigmund Freud, the part of the mind that is the seat of the psyche, of which people are aware only unconsciously. psyche According to Sigmund Freud, the subconscious, comprising the id, ego, and superego. id Or libido, according to Sigmund Freud, the part of the human psyche that expresses natural desires. ego Translated “I”; according to Sigmund Freud, the part of the psyche that interacts with the outside world. superego According to Sigmund Freud, the part of the psyche, sometimes called conscience, that monitors the id and mediates between the ego and the outside world.

Sigmund Freud, Émile Durkheim, Max Weber, and Ferdinand de Saussure. A fifth intellectual, Marcel Mauss, was linked to Durkheim. Each of these five theorists warrants special attention, beginning with Freud. Sigmund Freud (1858–1939) was a clinical psychologist who tried to help his patients overcome psychological disorders. He became an anthropologist of sorts when he speculated on the origin of these disorders. Ironically, anthropologists ended up rejecting most of Freud’s anthropological speculations while accepting many of his clinical insights. Freud was born in Vienna into a middle-class family headed by a strict father. In the 1880s, while he was a medical student, he became interested in radical medical experiments in which hysteria, a psychological state characterized by morbid or senseless emotionalism, appeared to be cured by hypnosis. Under hypnosis, hysterical patients recalled some experience, usually from childhood, that had been traumatic, and then they woke up and were no longer hysterical. For Freud, these experiments pointed to the existence of a mental subconscious. Patients with psychological disorders had concealed from themselves some action or thought that conflicted with the moral codes of society, Freud thought, and had then repressed the conflict in their subconscious mind, where it festered. Freud set out to determine how such patients might resolve their conflicts therapeutically. He began by studying dreams. In classical Freudian psychology, dreams are expressions of the subconscious mind. They express, in symbolic form, wishes or desires of which society disapproves. Freud probed the subconscious by deciphering dream symbols, most of which he interpreted as sexual because he believed that sex was the desire that society disapproved of most strongly and, therefore, was the desire most likely to lead to conflict and repression. In 1900, he published these views in his first major book, The Interpretation of Dreams. Freud proceeded to analyze art, literature, religion, and even politics in the same manner in which he analyzed dreams. These were ideologies and institutions that expressed, in symbolic form, feelings that could not be expressed in reality. They, too, held clues to repressed desires. Eventually, Freud’s distinction between psychologically “sick” and healthy people blurred, and he decided that the subconscious mind was universal. He divided the subconscious, sometimes called the psyche, into three levels: the id, or libido, the source of desire; the ego, or “I,” which experienced the outside world; and the superego, or conscience, which monitored the id and mediated between the ego and social norms. According to Freud, the ego and superego could be molded by culture, which restrained the id, the animalistic part of human nature with instinctive appetites and drives. The thrust of Freudian psychotherapy was to probe the subconscious to find the source of repressed conflict, make the patient consciously aware of the conflict, and thereby open the door to curing the patient with therapeutic devices. The Freudian depiction of human nature was pessimistic: everyone was born into a psychological minefield of potential conflict. Some people negotiated this 60

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

FIGURE 1.16  Freudian Humor: It seems ironic that so much light-hearted humor derives from a man whose vision of human nature was so dark. Copyright © Doug Grundy. Reproduced by permission of www.CartoonStock.com.

minefield better than others, avoided conflict, and grew up psychologically healthy. Others, less fortunate, succumbed to conflict, developed psychological disorders, and ended up in therapy. After Freud had finished creating his clinical framework, he wondered why this troubled state of human affairs had come into existence. His answer to this question was anthropological, with a twist. He presented his version of anthropology in a trilogy of books: Totem and Taboo (1918), The Future of an Illusion (1928), and Civilization and Its Discontents (1930). His central insight was that people in the present experience conflict because humanity in the past experienced conflict. Each person relives, or recapitulates, this past as racial memory. Freud’s account begins with the pleasure principle, his name for the natural libidinous tendency of people to seek psychosexual pleasure and avoid psychosexual pain. Culture opposes the pleasure principle because the consequence of everybody seeking pleasure would be chaos. Most people come to accept that they cannot seek pleasure directly, even though their desire to do so remains a source of tension. Instead, they rechannel, or sublimate, their desires into fantasies and institutions, which, according to Freud, represent an escape from libidinous reality. These people are acting on the reality principle because they are psychologically 61

racial memory  According to Sigmund Freud, the subconscious awareness of the history of the human psyche. pleasure principle  According to Sigmund Freud, living libidinously, as directed by the id; contrasted with reality principle. sublimate According to Sigmund Freud, to rechannel libidinous desires into culturally acceptable thoughts and behaviors. reality principle  According to Sigmund Freud, the principle of realizing that acting on the pleasure principle is dangerous and immature.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

primeval family In Sigmund Freud’s reconstruction of human history, the first family form – monogamous, nuclear, and patriarchal. primal patricide In Sigmund Freud’s hypothetical primeval family, the killing of the father by his sons. taboos Culturally prescribed prohibitions. incest Culturally proscribed inbreeding that, according to Sigmund Freud, is an act that led to the primal patricide. totems Objects of collective cultural veneration, according to several anthropological theorists, that are central to the maintenance of social stability. father figures In the psychology of Sigmund Freud, totems that represent culturally ambivalent attitudes toward adult men. Oedipus complex  According to Sigmund Freud, the troublesome psychological state of boys induced by their sexual desire for their mothers; contrasted with the Electra complex. Electra complex  According to Sigmund Freud, the troublesome psychological state of girls induced by their sexual desire for their fathers; contrasted with the Oedipus complex.

mature and realize that acting on the pleasure principle will get them into trouble. Psychologically immature people are inclined to act on libidinous impulse, experience conflict, undergo repression, and become neurotic or psychotic. For Freud, the least “civilized” cultures were the least repressive, so “primitive” adults were like civilized children. For Freud, civilization was opposed to human biological nature because it tried to tame the animal instincts of people. In fact, civilization was built on sublimated desire. How did this happen? He answered this question with a story about human evolution. The story began with the primeval family, which, for Freud, was monogamous, nuclear, patriarchal, and characterized by unrestricted sex. This family was fraught with problems and could not continue in its original form for very long. In the primeval family, sons desired their mother sexually, but their authoritarian father had priority of sexual access. Therefore, the sons resented their father, even though they respected and loved him at the same time. These ambivalent feelings were a source of major conflict. Eventually, resentment built up to the point where the sons got together and killed their father in the primal patricide, an act of profound consequence. Patricide was a libidinous act that the larger social group recognized as too disruptive to be allowed to recur. Moreover, the sons felt crippling remorse and guilt as a result of what they had done.To prevent a repeat performance, the group created cultural prohibitions – taboos – against unsanctioned killing and, equally important, against incest that might allow disruptive sexual feelings to come to the fore. The group also invented totems, objects of collective veneration, in the form of father figures, toward which sons could sublimate their ambivalent feelings. For Freud, these actions ushered in the totemic phase of human history. T   his phase, characterized by the superego, ensured that the expression of libidinous drives was repressed by guilt. For men, the psychological legacy of all this was the Oedipus complex, named after the legendary Greek son of Laius who unwittingly slew his father and went on to marry his mother. This complex was characterized by unresolved guilt-inducing desire of men for sexual gratification through their mothers. The corresponding legacy for women was the Electra complex, named after the legendary Greek daughter of Agamemnon who sought to kill her mother to avenge her father’s murder. The Oedipus and Electra complexes were not equivalent, because Freud believed that male and female sexuality fundamentally differed. From the perspective of twenty-first-century anthropology, Freudian theory certainly appears “sexist.” From the perspective of early-twentieth-century anthropology, his account of how each person relives the psychic development of humanity appeared to be a caricature of classical cultural evolutionism. If they were to incorporate some of Freud’s themes, early-twentieth-century anthropologists had to jettison a hefty amount of his theoretical apparatus. This was accomplished by the school known as American psychological anthropology. 62

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What is the evidence that the id, ego, and superego exist? 2. Is Freud’s account of the primal patricide plausible? 3. Do any other anthropological theories share Freud’s vision of culture, or civilization, as opposed to human nature?

Émile Durkheim Key Words: anomie, British social anthropology, collective consciousness, collective representations, elementary forms, elementary structures, French structural anthropology, group mind, mechanical solidarity, organic solidarity, profane, sacred, social facts Émile Durkheim (1858–1917) was a distinguished nineteenth-century French sociologist.The theoretical foundation of twentieth-century French anthropology can be found in his work on social structure. Durkheim was also a major influence on key twentieth-century British anthropologists, in particular Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown and his theory of structuralism and functionalism. For these reasons, he can be considered a forerunner of the two European schools known as French structural anthropology and British social anthropology. Durkheim’s familial legacy was Jewish. While young, he had a mystical experience that led him temporarily to Catholicism, but he ended up agnostic, albeit with a passionate interest in the cultural dimensions of religion. In 1879, he entered the elite École Normale Supérieure, where his philosophical bent set him apart from other students. At the time, following the Franco-Prussian War, France was experiencing a resurgence of nationalism and Catholicism, and Durkheim, a socialist as well as a Jew, found himself in the minority. In 1887, he moved to Bordeaux, site of the first teacher-training center in France, where he worked to reform the French school system, introducing social science into the curriculum. His theories then developed in progression with the publication of four books: Division of Labour in Society (1893), The Rules of Sociological Method (1895), Suicide (1897), and The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life (1912). In Division of Labour in Society, Durkheim explored the diversification and integration of culture, identifying two integrative patterns. Older, more “primitive” cultures were less diversified and had little division of labor. More homogeneous, they cohered because individuals were similar. Durkheim called this pattern of integration mechanical solidarity. Recent, more “civilized” cultures were more diversified and had considerable division of labor. More heterogeneous, they cohered because individuals were different. His vision was of individuals functioning independently but in harmony – much as the various organs of the body do 63

French structural anthropology The theoretical orientation of Claude Lévi-Strauss and his followers, invoking elementary mental structures, reciprocity, and binary oppositions. British social anthropology The school of structuralism and functionalism led by Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown and Bronislaw Malinowski.

mechanical solidarity  According to Émile Durkheim, social cohesion maintained by similarities among individuals; contrasted with organic solidarity.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

organic solidarity  According to Émile Durkheim, social cohesion maintained by differences and interdependence among individuals; contrasted with mechanical solidarity. social facts Émile Durkheim’s name for social phenomena, his units of sociological analysis. collective representations  According to Émile Durkheim, manifestations of the collective consciousness, or group mind. collective consciousness  According to Émile Durkheim, the source of collective representations of social facts, sometimes called the group mind. group mind According to Émile Durkheim, the source of collective representations of social facts, sometimes called collective consciousness. anomie According to Émile Durkheim, the sense of personal alienation caused by the absence of familiar social norms. elementary forms For Émile Durkheim, the equivalent of collective representations, similar to elementary structures.

to maintain an organism’s life. Because this metaphor seemed so apt, he called this second pattern of integration organic solidarity. Durkheim’s central insight was that social solidarity could be achieved in two different, organizationally opposite ways. His focus on social coherence, rather than change, represented a preference for what Auguste Comte called social statics rather than social dynamics. The Durkheimian vision of society was very different from that of Karl Marx, who saw solidarity as ephemeral and society riven with class conflict. For Marx, the state would eventually “wither away” and give rise to communism. For Durkheim, the more organic solidarity increased, the more government was necessary to regulate socially interdependent parts. Increased organic solidarity submerged the individual in an expanded social reality, where social interactions superseded individual interactions as determinants of social life. The academic discipline that would study social interactions was sociology. Durkheim established the theoretical framework for sociology in The Rules of Sociological Method. Social interactions were to be considered social facts and explained in terms of other social facts, not in terms of biology or psychology. Behind this pronouncement was Durkheim’s understanding that society was a realm unto itself, sui generis. He gave his conception of the social realm a special French twist. For Durkheim, social facts were collective representations of the collective consciousness, or group mind. This conception was Cartesian, following the rationalist French philosopher René Descartes, rather than Lockean, following the empiricist British philosopher John Locke. Rationalism was a fundamental part of the Durkheimian legacy to French structural anthropology. In Suicide, Durkheim demonstrated how to use his sociological rules to explain a particular social fact. He chose the fact of suicide because it was an act that seemed so individualistic yet, explained sociologically, could be shown to have a strong social dimension. Durkheim correlated types of suicide with patterns of social integration. With mechanical solidarity there was “altruistic” suicide, whereby individuals dissolved themselves into the homogeneous group, while with organic solidarity there was “egoistic” suicide, whereby individuals engaged in a dramatic form of self-expression. When social solidarity was in flux – that is, neither mechanical nor organic – individuals could commit a third type of suicide, which was brought about by anomie, Durkheim’s name for the feeling of alienation caused by the absence of familiar social norms. The purpose of Durkheim’s fourth book, The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life, was to expose the social origins of religion. To Durkheim, the term origins meant something very different than it did to cultural evolutionists and other kinds of anthropologists whose orientation was diachronic and who considered the origin of something to be its source in the past. For Durkheim, the origin of something was its source in the group mind. Accordingly, the elementary forms of religion were collective representations of the collective consciousness of people who attached sacred meaning 64

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

to moral principles and then gave those moral principles a social reality in order to make them persuasive. Some empiricists have found Durkheim’s logic circular: collective representations demonstrate the existence of the collective consciousness, which is posited to demonstrate the existence of collective representations. But Durkheim was not a consistent empiricist. He was a rationalist who believed that knowledge could exist independent of observation. Rationalism was imparted to French structural anthropology when Durkheim’s elementary forms of religion became Claude Lévi-Strauss’s elementary structures of kinship. For Durkheim, the origin of religion, and ultimately of society itself, lay in the impact of social ritual on individuals. His thesis was that “primitive man” (exemplified in particular by Aboriginal societies in Australia) experiences a sense of “effervescence” when interacting with his fellows that can be accounted for only by reference to a greater power existing outside the individual. Once the ritual has ended, and large clans have broken into smaller bands and dispersed to resume the mundane activities associated with “making a living,” individuals long for the cascade of sentiment that they had encountered during these periods of togetherness. Durkheim enshrined this distinction between the ritual and the everyday in his oppositional concepts of the sacred and the profane. These terms are appropriate, because they convey the forms of activity and emotion that surround the pure and powerful occasions of ritual togetherness as opposed to those that indicate the routine, the mundane, and the “polluted.” In particular, Durkheim took great pains to show how the effervescent sensations born in ritual are embodied in totems. These objects are, for Durkheim, powerful representations, or elementary forms, that bring these powerful sentiments to the surface of consciousness, even in the absence of ritual. Thus, they are icons par excellence of group integration and solidarity. Perhaps more importantly, they serve to remind primitive societies of the greater reality existing just outside themselves, a reality that fully makes itself felt only during social ritual. It is with some justification, therefore, that anthropologists have equated some people’s understanding of God with Durkheim’s vision of society, for in The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life the concepts of God and society seem interchangeable. In 1902, Durkheim was rewarded with the prestigious academic appointment as chair of education at the Sorbonne in Paris, where he came to exert considerable academic influence. A few years earlier, he had founded the journal Année Sociologique to publish his work and the work of the growing number of his students. It is significantly through this journal that his theories became known to French and British anthropologists. Tragically, during World War I, many of Durkheim’s students died, as did his son, a death that affected him deeply. In 1917, before the war ended, he himself died while recovering from a stroke. 65

elementary structures  In French structural anthropology, universal mental logics and their cultural manifestations.

sacred According to Émile Durkheim, that which is pure, powerful, and supernatural; contrasted with the profane. profane According to Émile Durkheim, that which is routine, mundane, impure, and “of the world”; contrasted with the sacred.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. If some societies cohere because people are similar while other ­societies cohere because people are different, where in this vision is there room for social conflict? 2. What are some modern-day examples of collective representations of a collective consciousness, or group mind? 3. In the Durkheimian sense, can there be the sacred without the profane?

Marcel Mauss Key Word: reciprocity

reciprocity According to Marcel Mauss, the elementary principle of exchanging gifts; according to Claude Lévi-Strauss, the elementary principle of exchanging women.

The intellectual transition from Durkheim to Lévi-Strauss and French structural anthropology (discussed in Part Three) was accomplished by Durkheim’s student and nephew Marcel Mauss (1872–1950). A decorated veteran of World War I, Mauss enjoyed a productive career that included a professional collaboration with his uncle at the helm of Année Sociologique. This was succeeded by lectureships in ethnology and religious studies at two French universities – first, the Institute of Ethnology, and later, the Collège de France. Contrasting the careers of many of his peers in the British and American schools, Mauss’s influence in the field of anthropology did not derive from his ethnographic monographs or fieldwork but rather from a meticulous attention to theoretical issues that lay at the heart of many published essays and lecture notes published posthumously. Mauss was a lifelong Durkheimian, and his overriding concern was to understand the structured nature of social cohesion, which he took to be embodied in a series of general mental principles that constituted “total social facts.” His most wellknown elaboration of the idea of the total social fact was expressed in his essay The Gift (1924), in which the apparently spontaneous act of gift exchange was shown to be regulated according to integrated mental rules of reciprocity that were binding on all parties to the exchange.These elementary principles or structures were understood to be the logic, or “glue,” that unified different kinds of social institutions (kinship, religion, aesthetics, economics, etc.). Hence, the phenomenon of the gift was to be sociologically interpreted as an embodiment of a basic principle of social life, situated at the intersection of different “domains” of social life and containing within it many types of meaning. A common example is the exchange of gifts at Christmastime. One of Mauss’s most important contributions was to shift the focus from Durkheim’s “mind” of the group to the minds of individuals. In Mauss’s scheme, elementary structures of individual minds precede elementary structures of the group mind, which in 66

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

turn precede elementary structures of the outside world. Mauss was particularly interested in elementary structures of the practice of giving gifts. For him, gift-giving was exchange, or reciprocity, which operated according to the elementary reciprocity principle:“to give, to receive, and to repay.” Reciprocity was an inherent mental structure, a logic shared by everyone. Unlike economic anthropologists, who considered reciprocity to be restricted to non-market economic transactions, Mauss considered it to be a universal principle of exchange that governed, besides economics, social organization and kinship – an idea elaborated by Lévi-Strauss through much of his writing.

STUDY QUESTION 1. Do holiday and birthday gift-giving practices appear to conform to Marcel Mauss’s principle of reciprocity? Why or why not?

Max Weber Key Words: agency, Calvinist Protestantism, charismatic prophets, cosmological order, ethical, Eurocentric, ideational, inner-worldly asceticism, multilineal, rationalized, relatively non-privileged, ritual, salvation, theodicy In the nineteenth century, Durkheim employed an organismic analogy to understand how social groups cohere, and Marx understood control of the material conditions of life to be the engine driving human history. Both theorists, therefore, believed that forces existing outside the individual (psychosocial on the one hand, dialectical on the other) act to condition cultural meaning and structure social relations. In neither formulation is much room left for the creative agency of individuals, and, in fact, both Durkheim and Marx are often criticized for treating the subjects of their theories as homogenous drones, mindlessly obeying the relentless forces that shape and control every facet of their existence. In contrast, German theorist Max Weber (1864–1920) is credited with viewing the holistic individual – acting, thinking, feeling – as central to the creation, maintenance, and innovation of social and cultural forms. For this reason, his work is often thought of as idealistic, or ideational, and is frequently contrasted with the materialism of Marx. Such a characterization is misleading because the creative agency that Weber attributes to individuals is grounded nevertheless in the relations of production and reproduction in any given society. In part because his work so effectively synthesized the supposedly antithetical forces of idealism and materialism, Weber became deeply influential in anthropological writing of the later twentieth century. 67

agency In recent anthropological theory, creative acts of intentioned individuals that generate social form and meaning.

ideational A term describing the view of Max Weber and others that the holistic individual is central to the creation, maintenance, and change of culture.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

multilineal According to Max Weber, culture change occurring in fits and starts in different historical contexts; according to Julian Steward, “branching” cultural evolution; contrasted with universal and unilineal cultural evolution. Eurocentric The rating of non-European cultures according to a generalized European scale of norms and values. relatively nonprivileged A phrase coined by Max Weber to describe those socioeconomic classes in complex societies most prone to the creation of new social forms. theodicy A Christian term used by Max Weber to describe the explanation of evil in the world despite the existence of an omnipotent, just, and loving God. ritual Any form of prescribed behavior that is periodically repeated and links the actions of the individual or group to a metaphysical order of existence. salvation According to Max Weber, escape from worldly capriciousness and evil through social arrangements rationalized in accordance with a divine plan, typically revealed by charismatic prophets.

Weber was the son of a prominent German politician and civil servant and grew up in a stimulating intellectual environment. In 1882, he enrolled as a law student at the University of Heidelberg, where he embellished his studies with economics, history, and theology. In 1894, he became a professor of economics at Freiburg University, the first of several academic appointments he held interspersed with other occupations. Early on, Weber developed an interest in social policy, and at the conclusion of World War I, he served as a consultant to committees drafting the Treaty of Versailles and the Weimar Constitution for postwar Germany. After the war, he resumed teaching but suffered opposition from rightwing students, dying shortly thereafter of pneumonia. In two of his most important works, The Protestant Ethic and the Spirit of Capitalism (1920) and (posthumously) The Sociology of Religion (1922), Weber presented his strategy for understanding how societies develop through time. Although his ideas were essentially evolutionist, they bore little resemblance to the unilineal theories of his nineteenth-century contemporaries, such as Edward Burnett Tylor or Lewis Henry Morgan. Rather than reducing the great variety of social forms in the world to a single unidirectional model that charts social evolutionary change from the “primitive” through the “civilized,”Weber sought a theory that placed existing beliefs and structures in particular historical contexts. For this reason, he is often thought of as a multilineal evolutionist whose theory accounts for the great diversity of human life but resists the temptation to rank this diversity according to a rigidly Eurocentric scale of norms and values. The principal elements of Weber’s schema may be outlined as follows. Complex societies arise from a progressive differentiation and intensification of labor, which in turn gives rise to a stratified hierarchy of social and economic classes. As a given social and historical environment grows in complexity, so too do the material inequities between these classes. These inequities, notably between the ruling elite and military classes and what Weber calls the relatively non-privileged classes of urban artisans and merchants, lead the latter to experience both a profound sense of alienation from sociopolitical power and a growing awareness of economic marginalization. This discrepancy between the world of their experience and that of their expectation (what is, as opposed to what should be – the problem of evil, or theodicy) is embodied in and expressed through an explicitly religious framework. This point is crucial to Weber’s model because, in his view, religion is the engine that drives social transformation through time.The merchant class’s despair and alienation from power foster deep anxieties about the apparent senselessness of the world: if one lives in accordance with a good and powerful deity’s wishes, fulfilling all ritual observances and prescribed ritual behavior, why does the world continue to be so problematic? This dilemma cries out, Weber maintains, for resolution. There is a need, using his terminology, for salvation from the world. Coming to the heart of his formulation of social change, Weber believes that this salvation is accomplished through the radical restructuring of beliefs about the 68

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

world, which in turn prescribes ethical behaviors to bring people into accord with this ethical new vision. Inner-worldly asceticism is the central disposition involved in this process because it entails “removing” oneself from corrupt worldly indulgences while (paradoxically) remaining within the world of human activity. For Weber, inner-worldly asceticism opposes the “outer-worldly” ascetics – monks, hermits, and others – who seek literally to escape the social world and its influences by retreating to special spaces (e.g., monasteries, deserts) where worldly things have no power or authority. By refraining from indulgence in specific corruptions that inhere in the world, the inner-worldly ascetic remains virtuous (by Judeo-Christian standards) even while participating in a world that is inherently corrupt. Crucially for Western society, material prosperity not only is excluded from this catalog of iniquity but also becomes a hallmark of one’s standing vis-à-vis divine will.The stimulus for such reformulation and renewal is understood to come from especially creative individuals, charismatic prophets, who generally claim to receive a new revelation of divine Truth that will reintegrate belief and action and in so doing restore psychosocial harmony to humanity. For Weber, the most significant example of an embodiment of this process occurred in the form of Calvinist Protestantism, an urban merchant’s religion that rationalized a new relationship between human beings and God. In this way, the French theologian John Calvin (1509–64) is to be considered a prophet, bearing a new vision of human life. Under this new covenant “revealed” to Calvin, individuals are directed to recreate heaven on Earth through hard work, as prescribed by God in Scripture, and obedience to the divine will. In this model, middle-class professionals – namely, merchants and artisans – are elevated to a position of ethical superiority; no longer are they to be ideologically dominated by ruling elites. Rather, urban merchants and artisans come to view themselves as a community of believers united by certain ethical tenets, adherence to which will certainly lead to a more materially rewarding and emotionally satisfying life. Therefore, a merchant might look to his material prosperity as a sign of God’s grace, or lack thereof. The burgeoning culture of sixteenth-century Renaissance commerce, once linked in this way to a cosmological order, became an increasingly compelling blueprint for action in the world. If people behaved in a certain way, in accordance with God’s will, they could expect to be materially rewarded in the here and now, and spiritually justified in the hereafter. Small wonder, then, that this new system of meaning and action ultimately resulted in the global triumph of industrial capitalism. Weber’s ideas about social evolution have been especially useful to anthropologists of recent generations because there has been an increasing reluctance to view societies and cultures as the static, pristine organisms of Durkheimian theory. Moreover, in recent years the discipline has become more concerned with issues pertaining to the creative agency of individuals, the cultural worlds they construct and inhabit, and the various permutations of consensus and conflict that exist within and between societies.Weber’s ideas really resurfaced in the 1970s and 1980s with the schools known as 69

ethical Pertaining to prescriptions for correct behavior that put the individual in accordance with a metaphysical order. inner-worldly asceticism According to Max Weber, the ethical demand of Calvinist Protestantism that Christians not retreat from the world in order to live piously. charismatic prophets As identified by Max Weber, individuals who experience a revelation that mandates the establishment of a new social order based on new ethical ideals. Calvinist Protestantism Those Christian doctrines and practices traced to John Calvin that oppose Roman Catholicism on the basis of scripture and justification by faith. rationalized According to Max Weber, evolved through the systematization of ideas, corresponding norms of behaviors, and motivational commitment to those norms. cosmological order  A phrase describing the nature of otherworldly deities or powers and their relationships to human beings.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.17  In Awe of Jesus Christ: Jesus is a prime example of Max Weber’s definition of a charismatic leader. Bloch, Carl. “Sermon on the Mount.” Image courtesy of the Hope Gallery and Museum of Fine Art.

political economy and postmodernism. Until then, they were eclipsed by the more fashionable ideas of Durkheim and, to a lesser extent, Marx.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Why is agency such an important concept in the history of anthropological theory? 2. According to Weber, under what social circumstances are charismatic prophets likely to be most effective? 3. How does Weber address the issue of perceived social injustice?

70

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

Ferdinand de Saussure Key Words: diachronic, historical linguistics, langue, parole, polysemous, sign, signified, signifier, synchronic Ferdinand de Saussure (1857–1913) is among the most important precursors to twentieth-century linguistic and cultural anthropology. He is also one of the least celebrated figures in these disciplines and among the least read. In part, this is doubtless due to the fact that he rarely published during his lifetime and the bulk of his legacy is vested in a posthumous collection of lectures compiled and published by a number of his students. Another reason for his relative obscurity outside linguistic circles probably relates to his low-key, generally conventional (even uneventful) academic career. As Jonathan Culler has put it, he seems to have had “no great intellectual crises, decisive moments of insight or conversion, or momentous personal adventures.” Nevertheless, Saussure remains one of the founding fathers – if not the founding father – of the modern discipline of linguistics as well as diverse streams of cultural and linguistic anthropology, influencing in different ways such important figures as Edward Sapir (1884–1939), Claude Lévi-Strauss, and Pierre Bourdieu (1930–2002). A contemporary of Marx, Freud, Durkheim, Mauss, and Weber, Saussure was born in Geneva, Switzerland, in 1857. He was a precocious student and fluent in several languages, and his early writings on the system of language, composed when he was only 15, drew the interest of older scholars who saw in the adolescent an emerging new talent. Despite this evident ability in the study of language, Saussure’s family had strong ties to the natural sciences, and he first studied physics and chemistry at the University of Geneva before reverting to his early passion for language in completing his bachelor’s degree. After two years of studying ­historical linguistics in Leipzig and another two in Berlin, in 1880 Saussure was awarded a doctorate and moved to Paris where he entered the École Pratique des Hautes Études as “Maître de conférences” (lecturer) in historical linguistics. In 1891, he was named Chevalier of the Legion of Honour – a token of the deep esteem in which his Parisian colleagues held him – and accepted a professorship in Geneva, where he taught at his alma mater. The work for which Saussure is best known was produced between 1907 and 1911 in the form of three consecutive lecture series on “general linguistics.” Seminal though these lectures were, his insights into linguistic analysis remained unpublished at the time of his death in 1913. It remained to a number of his most devoted colleagues and students, especially linguists Charles Bally (1865–1947) and Albert Sechehaye (1870–1946), to redact and publish a series of notes taken over the course of Saussure’s lectures, together with a number of his own lecture notes. These were published in 1916 under the title Cours de linguistique générale. While this work was an immediate sensation in continental linguistic circles, 71

historical linguistics  The study of language over time, consisting of the reconstruction and descriptive tracking of language genealogies over time.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

sign In Ferdinand de Saussure’s linguistics, the pair formed in the relation of a signifier to a signified, the essence of relations among meaningful units in a language. signifier In Ferdinand de Saussure’s linguistics, one of two units making up the sign, the word or image that represents a concept, the signified. signified In Ferdinand de Saussure’s linguistics, one of two units making up the sign, the concept generated in our minds when represented by a sound or image, the signifier.

Saussure’s influence among anglophile linguists and anthropologists was understandably inhibited by the late translation of the Cours into English in 1974. Much of Saussure’s innovation stems from his deep misgivings about the adequacy of linguistic theory in the late nineteenth century. In particular, language scholars of this era were more interested in tracking the genealogical lineages of discrete language forms (especially of the Indo-European language family) over time in order to “reconstruct” them and discover their temporal interrelatedness within a grand “tree” of many branches. Never, in his estimation, did his peers stop to ask the most pertinent question of all: what is language? Saussure’s answer is at face value deceptive in its simplicity. A language, he proposes, is a system of “signs” in which speech communicates ideas. The sign, as Saussure understands it, is made up of two distinct elements: the signifier (that which communicates meaning) and the signified (the concept communicated by the signifier).Without the capacity for communicating meanings as understood by a community of speakers, a sign cannot be linguistically relevant. This insight, obvious though it might appear, was little short of revolutionary for its focus on the systematic quality of language. By necessity, the sign is arbitrary, meaning there is no “natural” connection between the signifier and signified. If one uses the English signifier “tree” to denote the object that one recognizes to be a tree, this is obviously a different signifier than its Latin equivalent, “arbor.” Different though they are, both convey the same meaning. In other words, there is nothing intrinsic about the sequence of sounds in “tree” that connects to its referent. Its meaning varies from one sign system, or language, to the next. For Saussure, a few exceptions to this principle do exist – most famously onomatopoeia, in which the signifying sound seems to imitate or mimic the signified (for instance, the English word-sound “meow” signifying the sound made by a cat). A number of important consequences stem from these observations, which in and of themselves suggest little of the true complexity behind language. Discrete languages are not, of course, simple collections of signs. Rather, each language exists in the system of relations among its many signs. It is not the fact that each language encompasses different groups of signs that matters but that each organizes the relations among signs differently. It is for this reason that each language presents a basically different vision of the world. An old adage of anthropological lore (originating with Franz Boas) has it that the Inuit possess many different words for which anglophone Euro-Americans have one – “snow” – because there is a more complex relationship between the Inuit language community and the natural circumstances of their environment that requires a variegated knowledge of what is signified. In other words, whether snow is known primarily through its aridity, weight, shape, texture, position in relation to the ground, and so on actually makes a different world for the Inuit than what anglophone Euro-Americans might be expected to experience. Technically, this analogy may be inaccurate because linguists have demonstrated that the allegedly “many” Inuit words for snow actually 72

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

reflect fundamental differences in grammar between English and Inuit, in particular in terms of what constitutes a “word.” Nevertheless, the general point Saussure makes about the system or structure of language influencing experience had an important legacy in French and British social anthropology and among early American linguistic anthropologists in the work of Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whorf. Note, too, that the meaning of  “snow” (or any other concept) can only be fully grasped in relation to other features of weather – rain, hail, sunshine, and so on. In the absence of these, snow cannot signify what we understand it as signifying because there is no way of distinguishing it from other objects in the world. Another important and related point Saussure makes about signs is that they are not fixed or stable. Instead, they are endlessly shifting, creating new meanings and new social contexts. In English, there are many examples that spring readily to mind. Until several decades ago, the word “gay” invoked the concept of happiness or joviality. In contemporary usage, the term is seldom employed except in reference to homosexuality. The signifier has stayed the same, but that which is signified has been transformed. Muddying these waters still further, if one says, “I’m planning on buying new shoes today,” a reasonable reply might be to ask, “What type of shoes?” The signifier “shoe” references not just a particular kind of footwear but a genre of footwear; boots, stilettos, sneakers, and loafers all qualify depending on contextual factors. Signifiers are thus polysemous in character – they generate meanings that are utterly different from one another depending on such factors as speakers, listeners, and social and cultural context. It is possible to hear anglophones of an older generation still using the word “gay” to denote its earlier significance, whereas few under the age of 50 could now use the term without being aware of its plural significance. This quality by which the signifier and signified “mutate” according to usage leads to another important contribution of Saussure to linguistic theory – one that continued to be debated several generations after his death. This is the difference between a language system as a theoretical object (that is, each language consists of a system that is intangible) and a language as it is actually used – with all its incoherences, exceptions, and shortcuts. However “objective” a linguistic structure of relations might appear on paper, it obviously cannot account for language as spoken in its concrete manifestations. One might learn the “rules” of the language system but choose to ignore them in use. The results would not necessarily be incoherence but simply the imperfect outward expression of a coherent system. Saussure refers to this important distinction with the terms langue, the system of a language, and parole, objective instances of speech.When individuals are socialized in the conventions of a language, they learn the langue – the network of interrelated signs that permits both the understanding and reproduction of language. In contrast, parole involves the creative combination by individual speakers of signs within this system to express particular kinds of meanings. Of this difference, Saussure says that “we are separating what is social from what is individual and 73

polysemous Having more than one meaning or significance.

langue In Ferdinand de Saussure’s linguistics, reference to language as an abstract system that can be studied independently of actual speech, or parole. parole In Ferdinand de Saussure’s linguistics, reference to language as actually used in speech, often deviating from the abstract structural system of language, or langue.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 1.18  Arbor: Arbor, or in English tree, is both a collection of sounds and a concept, illustrating Ferdinand de Saussure’s distinction between the signifier and the signified. From Course in General Linguistics. Reprinted by permission of Philosophical Library Inc.

synchronic Concerned with the present more than the past; contrasted with diachronic. diachronic Historically oriented, or concerned with the past; contrasted with synchronic.

what is essential from what is ancillary or accidental.” For Saussure, it is the langue that must occupy the attention of linguists, rather than parole, which tends to distract from this all-important goal of grasping the essential rules whereby signs are related to each other. Like his contemporary Émile Durkheim, Saussure was also a key figure in distinguishing the synchronic from the diachronic. Whereas linguists of previous generations had been more concerned with tracking the historical development of languages and language families (diachrony), Saussure recognized that however contingent and evolving language forms might be, they could be studied only through the mapping of relations among meaningful units in an integrated, idealized, and unchanging structure (synchrony). Like Durkheim’s perspective, Saussure’s concern with linguistic statics was in later generations overemphasized at the expense of interest in language transformation – a development that process-oriented anthropological linguistics only began to redress in the second half of the twentieth century (see our discussion in Part Three). The tendency to reify language and culture as structures of interrelated signs can be deduced from the perspective of many anthropologists working in the mid-1900s who produced an influential body of theory that includes the Sapir-Whorf hypothesis, French structural anthropology, and different branches of ethnoscience.While later theorists, especially Pierre Bourdieu, have attempted to do away with what they rightly regard as a false dichotomy between social statics and change, or structure and agency, the very fact that history and diachrony are perceived as absent from the study of language says much about the enduring influence of Ferdinand de Saussure.

74

Part One  // The Early History of Anthropological Theory

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Would Saussure agree with the statement that the world of language is entirely artificial? 2. How many different onomatopoeic sounds can you make? 3. In Saussure’s sense, if one were to comprehend the entire langue of a language, could one predict what a given speaker of that language would say?

75

This page intentionally left blank 

PART TWO

The Earlier Twentieth Century

To varying degrees, earlier-twentieth-century anthropological theories represent a departure from those of the nineteenth century as new theorists sought to distance themselves from the unilineal evolutionary and hereditarian doctrines of their predecessors. In so doing, they drew for inspiration upon the theories of, among others, Sigmund Freud, Émile Durkheim, Max Weber, and Ferdinand de Saussure. The theories of Karl Marx were largely sidelined until their revival later in the century. Under the influence of strong anthropological personalities, modern American and British national traditions emerged in the first half of the twentieth century.These traditions, eclectic and replete with distinguished personalities, are generally known as American cultural anthropology and British social anthropology.

Key Words: four-field approach, holistic

holistic Pertaining to an overarching or integrated outlook, often associated with the broad scope of anthropological inquiry.

Under the leadership of Franz Boas and the first generations of his students, the professionalization of academic anthropology in the United States involved the cultivation of a distinctively holistic, “four-field” approach to the study of human life, which generally stressed the significance of historical change and the relativistic character of Euro-American and non-Western cultural norms and practices. Together with its pre-eminent geographical focus on Native American

four-field approach The traditional approach of American anthropology that divides the study of anthropology into the four fields of archaeological, biological, cultural, and linguistic anthropology.

American Cultural Anthropology

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

peoples, these were the epistemological foundations upon which theory in American anthropology was erected in the generations after Boas, helping to set the burgeoning field apart from its British and French counterparts as a distinctive expression of anthropological knowledge.

Franz Boas Key Words: American Anthropologist, cephalic index, Geisteswissenschaften, historical particularism, idiographic, Naturwissenschaften, nomothetic, salvage ethnography, Southwest School

American Anthropologist The flagship professional and peer-reviewed journal of the American Anthropological Association.

Almost singlehandedly, Franz Boas (1858–1942) launched American anthropology on the course it maintained throughout much of the twentieth century. At the outset of the twenty-first century, his influence continues to be felt in the curricula of most North American anthropology departments, which as a group more or less continue to adhere to the four-field approach he pioneered. Boas was born and educated in Germany, where he earned a doctoral degree in physics based on research into the optical properties of color. He took a field trip to northern Canada to study Indigenous peoples’ perception of color and while there converted to geography and then anthropology. Boas next visited the United States, where he spent time in New York City before becoming a curator at the new Field Museum of Natural History in Chicago. There, he built up an impressive collection of artifacts from the Pacific Northwest Coast, where he did ethnographic and linguistic field research among the Kwakiutl and related Indigenous groups. In the aftermath of a dispute with museum administrators, Boas left Chicago and joined the faculty of Clark University in Worcester, Massachusetts. A short time later, he moved back to New York and joined the faculty of Columbia University, where he remained for almost half a century. Boas was principally a cultural anthropologist, but he also did important work in linguistic anthropology, physical anthropology, and, to a limited extent, archaeological anthropology. He was an extraordinarily self-disciplined and prolific scholar, publishing more than 700 articles and books. He also had a strong hand in establishing and strengthening professional organizations such as the American Anthropological Association and its flagship professional journal, American Anthropologist. The list of anthropologists trained by Boas really does read like a Who’s Who. For example, in general anthropology and ethnography, there were Melville Herskovits (1895–1963), E. Adamson Hoebel (1906–93), Alfred Louis Kroeber, Robert Lowie, and Zora Neale Hurston; in psychological anthropology, Ruth Benedict and Margaret Mead; in American Indian studies, Alexander Goldenweiser (1880–1940), Paul Radin (1883–1959), and Clark Wissler; and in anthropological linguistics, Edward Sapir. When some of these students established 78

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

FIGURE 2.1  Getting into Character: Franz Boas (1858–1942) poses for a figure in an 1895 exhibit at the United States National Museum of Natural History. National Anthropological Archives, Smithsonian Institution, NEG MNH 8300: Franz Boas posing for figure in USNM exhibit entitled “Hamats’a coming out of secret room.”

other anthropology departments – Herskovits at Northwestern University, Sapir at the University of Chicago, and Kroeber and Lowie at the University of California at Berkeley – the Boasian approach to anthropology spread across the United States. In spite of all this personal influence, it is sometimes said that Boas established no anthropological “school.” This is because he did not make formulating new theory a high priority; rather, he spent much time criticizing old theory from the nineteenth century. Nevertheless, his approach to anthropology had pronounced characteristics. First and foremost, Boas was an ardent empiricist, much more rigorous than his late-nineteenth-century American predecessors. He was motivated to record as much information as possible about Indigenous North American cultures before they were “lost” through assimilation to expanding Euro-American cultures.This missionary-like zeal for salvage ethnography inspired students and 79

salvage ethnography   Ethnography motivated by the need to obtain information about cultures threatened with extinction or assimilation.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.2  The Senior Franz Boas: Boas became the towering personality in early-twentieth-century American anthropology. Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

historical particularism  The theoretical orientation of Franz Boas and many of his students who focused on the particular histories of particular cultures.

attracted them to anthropology, especially students who, like Boas, were prone to social activism. Furthermore, Boas was an arch-inductivist, urging anthropologists to “let the facts speak for themselves,” reject deductive schemes, and avoid premature generalizations. He was particularly critical of the comparative method of classical cultural evolutionists, who made unwarranted use of present-day ethnographic information in reconstructions of the past. Nobody, Boas protested, was “living in the Stone Age.” Because he considered evolutionary explanations “one-sided,” he urged anthropologists to consider diffusion as another cause of culture change. Overall, Boas wanted detailed, well-rounded stories of cultural development. In The Rise of Anthropological Theory (1968), anthropologist Marvin Harris labeled Boas’s approach to anthropology historical particularism – “historical” because Boas described the present in terms of the past, and “particular” because he considered the history of each culture to be unique. Other anthropologists have disagreed with this label, focusing instead on Boas’s overarching commitment to both natural and human science. Boas was heir to the tradition of Enlightenment egalitarianism, eclipsed during the nineteenth century by a surge of national chauvinism, hereditarianism, 80

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

and racist views. Racism was particularly strong in nineteenth-century American anthropology, where Samuel George Morton (1799–1851), Josiah Clark Nott (1804–73), and other members of the “American School” espoused racial polygenism, the doctrine that races are immutable, separately created species. The American School linked polygenism to the defense of black slavery in the antebellum American South. Rejecting the legacy of the American school, Boas insisted that environment dominates heredity in the determination of cultural differences. Having suffered prejudice as a Jew growing up in Christian surroundings, he was determined to shape anthropology into an academic discipline that would demonstrate to the world how race, language, and culture are causally unlinked. He did this creatively with a physical anthropological study of head shape. In nineteenthcentury anthropology, head shape – in particular, cephalic index, the ratio of head width to head breadth – was considered “fixed” and therefore, because the head contains the brain, represented a fixed measure of intelligence. Using sophisticated statistical techniques and a large body of data, Boas documented how head shape had changed in only one generation, as the American-born children of immigrants benefited from improved health and nutrition and other culturally conditioned inputs. Although some anthropologists have questioned the magnitude of this documented change, Boas’s landmark study remains an important beginning of the attempt to end racism in modern anthropology. Having come to cultural anthropology from physics, the rigorous Boas might have been expected to model cultural anthropology on natural science. This was not the case. In Germany, he had been influenced by Wilhelm Dilthey (1833–1911) and members of the neo-Kantian Southwest School of German philosophy. This group derived their ideas from philosopher Immanuel Kant (1724–1804), who taught that experience is filtered through innate categories of the mind. Neo-Kantians reformulated Kant’s teachings into the proposition that there are two kinds of sciences: Naturwissenschaften, or natural sciences, and Geisteswissenschaften, or human sciences of mental phenomena. The natural sciences could aim to be nomothetic, or seek explanatory generalizations and laws. The human sciences, however, had to concern themselves with mental phenomena, the core of human existence, and, according to neo-Kantians, could aim to be only idiographic, or seek descriptions of particular events. When Boas converted from physics to anthropology, he had this distinction between generalizing and particularizing sciences in mind. As a result, he stressed culture as a mental construct, paving the way for psychological anthropology and later brands of American anthropology that represented culture as something carried around in people’s heads. Boas was a social activist. In commenting on world affairs, he was an internationalist, opposing narrow-minded nationalism and overzealous patriotism. During World War I, he published a letter in The Nation denouncing four unnamed anthropologists for serving as American spies. For this action, the American 81

cephalic index The measured ratio of head breadth to head length, used in nineteenthcentury racial classifications.

Southwest School A group of German philosophers who differentiated human sciences, or Geisteswissenschaften, and natural sciences, or Naturwissenschaften. Naturwissenschaften  Translated “natural sciences”; contrasted with Geisteswissenschaften. Geisteswissenschaften  Translated “human sciences,” including anthropology; contrasted with Naturwissenschaften. nomothetic  Generalizing; contrasted with idiographic. idiographic  Pertaining to a particularizing approach to description and explanation; contrasted with nomothetic.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Anthropological Association censured him, a censure not rescinded until 2004. In the late 1930s, Boas undertook a study of American high-school textbooks and found that the majority of them misrepresented the concept of race, one-fifth of them promoting what might be called white supremacy. To counter this attitude, he asked his student Ruth Benedict to translate his ideas on race into a popular pamphlet, published later as The Races of Mankind (1943). At this time, during World War II, Nazism was denouncing “Jewish science.” Boas replied that there was only one science, the universal science of humankind. For speaking out like this, he is regarded by subsequent generations of activist anthropologists as a towering pioneer. In 1942, while Boas was having lunch at Columbia University, he suddenly slumped over and died. Anthropologist Claude Lévi-Strauss, who was sitting next to him, recalled later that he had witnessed the death of an intellectual giant and the end of an era in anthropology. Surviving Boas, however, was his legacy of commitment to what anthropologists later called public anthropology, which inspired many of his students.

Robert Lowie and Alfred Louis Kroeber Key Words: great man theory of history, superorganic The first two anthropologists to earn doctoral degrees under Boas at Columbia were Robert Lowie and Alfred Louis Kroeber. Robert Lowie (1883–1957) was born in Vienna before immigrating with his parents to New York City. In New York, he grew up in German-American surroundings, aspiring to a career in chemistry but switching to anthropology when poor manual dexterity called his ability to conduct laboratory experiments into question. In his autobiography, Lowie explains how growing up in two cultures, one German and the other American, made him a “marginal man,” not fully at home in either, or any, culture. At the same time, this aspect of his upbringing primed him for participant-observation fieldwork. Lowie earned a doctoral degree on the basis of fieldwork among American Native peoples. In 1917, he joined the faculty of the University of California at Berkeley, remaining there until his retirement in 1950. Lowie’s first important book was Primitive Society (1920), in which he criticized the cultural evolutionary approach, especially that of Lewis Henry Morgan. Following Boas, Lowie rejected the “one-sided” explanations of cultural evolutionists, although he also rejected extreme versions of diffusionism. There was, he insisted, no one determinant of culture. In History of Ethnological Theory (1937), he pursued this same theme, cautioning anthropologists against theoretical extremism of any kind. Behind his position were intellectual influences shared with Boas, namely, the Southwest School of German philosophy and an uncompromising empiricism, in Lowie’s case derived from philosopher Ernst 82

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

FIGURE 2.3  Robert Lowie (1883–1957) in His Library: Lowie drew inspiration from books as well as from field notes. BANC PIC 1980.003–fALB. Reproduced by permission of the Bancroft Library, University of California, Berkeley.

Mach (1838–1916). The Lowie program for anthropology consisted of undoing the ethnographic analyses of cultural evolutionists and redoing them in the framework of Boasian historical particularism. In Skull Wars, David Hurst Thomas casts Lowie’s arch-empiricist agenda in an unflattering light, showing how it led Lowie to deny credence to Native Americans’ oral history of their past. This denial raises the larger issue of who “owns” the prehistoric past: archaeologists and anthropologists or Indigenous peoples themselves? Answering this question became a preoccupation of later anthropological theorists. A long-time California colleague of Lowie was Alfred Louis Kroeber (1876– 1960). Kroeber was born and raised by immigrant parents in New York City, where, like Lowie, he experienced both German and American cultures. His first love was literature, but this changed when he met Boas and decided to take his doctorate in anthropology. Reflecting his literary background, Kroeber’s dissertation was a study of patterns, or configurations, of American Native style. In 1901, Kroeber moved to California to become curator of the Academy of Sciences Museum. He soon joined the University of California at Berkeley, where he stayed 83

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.4  Alfred Louis Kroeber and Friends: A young Kroeber (1876–1960), center, poses with Ishi, the last Yana Indian, right, and translator Sam Batwai in San Francisco in 1911. Courtesy of the Phoebe A. Hearst Museum of Anthropology and the Regents of the University of California (Catalogue No. 13–944).

84

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

until his retirement in 1946. Kroeber is well known for his textbook Anthropology (1923), his ethnographic compendium Handbook of the Indians of California (1925), and his theoretical treatise Configurations of Culture Growth (1944). While Lowie remained true to Boasian anthropology, Kroeber departed from Boas in an unexpected way. This happened when he promoted the concept of the superorganic. The concept of the superorganic goes back to Herbert Spencer and Émile Durkheim and, after Kroeber, was “revisited” by anthropologist Leslie White. It represents an emphatic statement of the importance of environment over heredity, “nurture” over “nature,” or culture over biology. It also represents an effort to give social-scientific disciplines such as anthropology a particular identity by showing that they have something special to study – culture, a realm sui generis, or unto itself, separate from psychology and “above” biology. Kroeber first published his ideas about the superorganic in 1917 in an article in American Anthropologist. In the article, he stressed the power of culture to shape human behavior, arguing against the great man theory of history, which stressed the power of individuals. Using historical examples, he sought to show that great men were only great because they happened to be in the right place at the right time. Instead of proposing cultural laws that determine behavior, Kroeber proposed cultural patterns, or trends. To illustrate the power of trends, he chose fashion, commonly considered to be subject to artistic whim and the caprice of the fashion industry. Instead, he countered, fashion features seemingly as capricious as hem length, lapel shape, and the number and placement of buttons all change cyclically, precisely enough to be plotted on graphs. The implication was that while people might think they are creative geniuses or manipulators, in fact they are creatures of culture, implementing changes for which the cultural time is ripe. The superorganic is one example – some say a caricature – of a scientific contrasted with a humanistic orientation for anthropology. It was an unexpected orientation for Kroeber, a student of literature, especially since he was taught by Boas, who opposed one-sided explanations. Throughout his career, Kroeber vacillated between the superorganic and traditional Boasian approaches. In 1944, he published Configurations of Culture Growth, a book on which he had been working almost day and night for years. This book was a survey of major world civilizations, in which Kroeber tried to determine whether there were any overall trends, or trajectories, of civilized development. His finding was largely negative: each civilization appeared to have its own unique trajectory – a historical twist to the Boasian doctrine of cultural relativism. After Configurations, Kroeber gradually retreated from the concept of the superorganic and returned to the Boasian fold. A famous, or infamous, anthropological episode reveals Kroeber’s own psychological configuration. In 1911, a disoriented man speaking an undecipherable tongue 85

superorganic The idea that culture is distinct from and “above” biology.

great man theory of history The theory that individuals affect the course of history more than do historical circumstances.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.5  The Senior Alfred Louis Kroeber: Kroeber was mainly a “configurationalist,” but he also pursued the idea of the “superorganic.” Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

appeared in the wilderness in northern California. Kroeber took a keen interest in the man and arranged for him to visit San Francisco, deciding that he was the sole survivor of a little-known Native American group, the Yana. Kroeber named the man Ishi, for “man,” and declared him to be the last pristine Native American alive. Ishi moved into the San Francisco Museum of Anthropology, where he greeted the public and consulted with anthropologists, in the process learning to speak limited English. Through interacting with Ishi for five years, Kroeber learned about the culture of his vanished ancestors. Sadly, Ishi developed tuberculosis and died in 1916. At the time of Ishi’s death, Kroeber was living temporarily in New York and Europe and had become engaged by the psychoanalytic psychology of Sigmund Freud.Troubled at the news, he sent a letter to his colleagues in California instructing them to respect the traditions of Ishi’s ancestors by cremating his body and burying it in an urn. There was to be no autopsy. Unfortunately, Kroeber’s letter arrived after an autopsy had already been performed and Ishi’s brain removed for preservation and study. Kroeber was distraught and entered a period of professional self-doubt. He remained in New York to undergo psychoanalysis and, when he 86

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

returned to California, temporarily practiced psychoanalysis himself. For the rest of his life he rarely spoke or wrote about the Ishi affair. After his death, his wife, Theodora Kroeber, published a book about it, Ishi in Two Worlds: A Biography of the Last Wild Indian in North America (1961). Her book kept the memory of Ishi alive. Many years later, it came to light that Ishi’s brain had been sent to the Smithsonian Institution in Washington, DC, where it remained in storage and largely forgotten for decades. In 1999, a coalition of interested parties, including the Butte County Native American Cultural Committee, located the brain. In anthropology circles a heated discussion ensued about what to do and, in retrospect, what to think about the events surrounding Ishi’s death. In 2000, leaders of the Redding Rancheria and Pit River groups, which claim descent from the Yana, took possession of the brain to return it to California and rebury it with Ishi’s exhumed ashes in a secret location.The whole Ishi episode, spanning nine decades, attests to the dramatic shift in attitudes toward stewardship of Indigenous peoples’ past that has taken place since Kroeber’s time. Expanding Kroeber’s outlook in an imaginative and forward-looking way was his daughter Ursula Kroeber Le Guin (1929–2018), a highly acclaimed writer of science fiction. Among Le Guin’s early and most influential works were The Wizard of Earthsea (1968) and The Left Hand of Darkness (1969). In these and other books and short stories, she drew on her childhood exposure to anthropology to create alternative fictional worlds, and in several of her stories she deployed anthropologists in the role of narrative protagonist. Literary critics have also detected in Le Guin’s corpus elements of the real-life story of Ishi, which appeared to have affected her deeply. Although Le Guin was not a professional anthropologist, her sciencefictional iterations of anthropological themes can be said to have foreshadowed, and in her later years paralleled, the postmodern turn in anthropological theory.

Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict Key Words: configurationalism, culture-at-a-distance, enculturation, gestalt, national character, psychological anthropology As American cultural anthropology developed, the search for cultural patterns launched by Kroeber, sometimes called configurationalism, took a turn into psychological anthropology, a uniquely American contribution to anthropological theory. This school was rooted in the Boasian teaching that culture is a mental phenomenon; was popularized by his most famous students, Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict; and was taken in new directions by anthropologists reacting to the psychology of Sigmund Freud. Early psychological anthropologists were curious about the relationship between culture and personality – namely, how individuals contribute to culture and how, 87

configurationalism The search for cultural patterns, often in the idiom of psychology. psychological anthropology  Anthropology concerned with the relationship between cultures and personalities.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.6  Margaret Mead (1901–78): An outspoken advocate of “cultural relativism,” Mead was the most famous American anthropologist of the mid-twentieth century. Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

enculturation  The process of an individual acquiring culture, usually while growing up.

through enculturation, culture contributes to, or shapes, individuals. Psychological anthropologists understood that this relationship would differ from culture to culture. Under the influence of Boas, they began to incorporate observations of human feelings, attitudes, and other psychological states into their fieldwork and publications. Anthropology became livelier and more engaging as it put on a human face. The anthropologist primarily responsible for this transformation was Margaret Mead (1901–78). The precocious daughter of academically oriented parents, Mead grew up in and around Philadelphia, attended college for one year in the American Midwest, and then headed east for what she expected would be a more cosmopolitan education at Barnard College, which was affiliated with Columbia University. An aspiring poet and writer, she gave up literature when she decided that she lacked the talent for commercial success and gravitated instead to Boas and his colleague Ruth Benedict, who convinced her that anthropology “mattered.” Boas was deeply involved with his effort to use anthropology to counteract hereditarian doctrines, one of which was Freudian psychology, then growing in academic popularity. Freud had pronounced that certain phases of human psychological development were fixed by nature and were universal. Boas disagreed, believing that Freud’s doctrine was culture-bound, or ethnocentric. He directed Mead to select a psychological phase of individual development, study it in a 88

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

non-Western culture, and demonstrate that its manifestation there was different than in the West. Mead selected (or ended up with) female adolescence in Samoa, a group of islands in the South Pacific. She lived there for several months with the family of a missionary, venturing out into villages to interview a select number of adolescent Samoan girls. The result of this pioneering fieldwork was the first of her many books, Coming of Age in Samoa (1928), an all-time anthropology “classic.” The message of Coming of Age in Samoa was that female adolescence in the islands was a psychologically untroubled transition from girlhood to womanhood, during which time Samoan adolescents were spared the “normal” trials and tribulations of sexual awakening because they, unlike their North American counterparts, had been sexually permissive as girls. The conclusion was that adolescence was not troubled by hereditary nature, and the inference was that American adolescents would be less troubled if Americans adopted a more permissive attitude toward sex. Mead’s book was an immediate commercial success, garnering public attention because of its bold and controversial pronouncements. The book launched her lifelong career as spokesperson for liberal causes, preaching tolerance and understanding and how learning about exotic behavior in faraway places provided an opportunity to reflect on “normal” behavior back home. In this capacity, she became the most famous anthropologist of the twentieth century and the anthropologist primarily responsible for giving anthropology its reputation for cultural relativism. Mead’s other groundbreaking books were Growing Up in New Guinea (1930) and Sex and Temperament in Three Primitive Societies (1935), which featured ethnographic examples of how sex roles are enculturated and, like adolescence, not programmed by nature. In some of her early work, Mead collaborated with her second husband, New Zealand anthropologist Reo Fortune (1903–79), and later she collaborated further with her third husband, British anthropologist and psychological researcher Gregory Bateson (1904–80); her first husband was ministerturned-archaeologist Luther Cressman (1897–1994). Mead also maintained an intimate friendship with Ruth Benedict, who encouraged her to persevere and provided counsel in times of distress. She, Benedict, and linguist Edward Sapir were all close friends, sharing literary efforts and experimenting with the application of psychological labels to cultures and individuals, including fellow anthropologists. Sapir was disappointed when Mead rejected his proposal of marriage. In 1982, four years after Mead’s death, Australian ethnographer Derek Freeman (1916–2001) published a critical account of her Samoan research in his book Margaret Mead and Samoa: The Making and Unmaking of an Anthropological Myth, following it up in 1999 with The Fateful Hoaxing of Margaret Mead: A Historical Analysis of Her Samoan Research. Freeman took Mead to task (posthumously) for being methodologically superficial and for failing to study Samoan history, which, according to Freeman, involved sexual violence and turmoil that belie Mead’s ethnographic portrait of Samoa as a peaceable, sexual paradise. In Freeman’s account, Mead was a naïve product of Boas, who pushed her too hard to do research that 89

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.7  Ruth Benedict (1887–1948): Benedict, a “configurationalist,” was a leading theoretician of the American culture-and-personality school. Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

would turn out the way he wanted. Freeman’s books sparked a vigorous and protracted debate among his, and Mead’s, defenders and detractors, creating a small cottage industry of polemical scholarship. When Mead arrived at Columbia, Ruth Benedict (1887–1948) was already there. Benedict had studied literature at Vassar College, taught high school, and, like Mead, reluctantly abandoned aspirations to be a commercial poet and writer. As a child, she had been introspective and withdrawn, suffering from impaired hearing that made her feel cut off from the outside world. Some who knew her called her “otherworldly.” Benedict wanted to write biographies of early feminists, but she was unsuccessful in having her first manuscript published. Seeking to fill her life with new meaning, she enrolled in an anthropology course at the New School for Social Research in New York City, where she met Franz Boas. Finding anthropology to be an outlet for her creativity and an intellectual vehicle to explore the underpinnings of her own sense of cultural alienation, she chose anthropology as her career. She did fieldwork under Kroeber, who introduced her 90

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

to configurationalism, and then returned to Columbia to teach with Boas, helping to train Mead and other distinguished students. Like Mead, Benedict was interested in the relationship between culture and personality. But while Mead described the culturally conditioned personalities of individuals, Benedict described the personalities of whole cultures. According to her, each culture had its own personality configuration, or gestalt. Compelling illustrations of this approach were the focus of her book Patterns of Culture (1934), for decades a venerated best-seller. In it, Benedict contrasted the personalities of three cultures: the Kwakiutl of the Pacific Northwest, the Zuñi of the American Southwest, and the Dobuans of the South Pacific. Borrowing names from German philosopher Friedrich Nietzsche (1844–1900), she characterized the Kwakiutl as “Dionysian” because they appeared megalomaniacal and prone to excess, staging vision quests involving self-torture and potlatch ceremonies with conspicuous consumption and destruction of material goods. In contrast, the Zuñi were “Apollonian” because they appeared peaceable and restrained by moderation, with low-key ceremonies that reined in sexual license. On the basis of ethnographic research conducted by Reo Fortune, Benedict characterized the Dobuans as “paranoid” because they appeared preoccupied with sorcery and suspicious of one another for stealing sweet potatoes. Benedict explained how these three cases illustrated the power of culture to shape divergent normative personalities, resulting in divergent definitions of “deviance.” In typical Boasian fashion, she concluded that, because what was deviant in one culture could be normative in another, deviance was not determined by nature. After Patterns of Culture, Benedict continued to implement the Boasian mandate for anthropology by promoting cultural relativism and combating ethnocentrism and racism both intellectually and politically.To show that the concept of race was scientifically weak and politically destructive, she wrote Race: Science and Politics (1945), and during World War II she joined other anthropologists in helping to defeat Nazism and the Axis powers by working for the American federal government in Washington, DC. This was at a time when anthropologists helping the government at war was much less controversial than it became during the Vietnam War and, more recently, the conflicts in Afghanistan and Iraq. A result of Benedict’s morally patriotic effort was her book The Chrysanthemum and the Sword (1946), a study of Japanese national character. During the World War II era, other national character studies – sometimes called culture-at-a-distance because they had to be done without the benefit of fieldwork – lost credibility when anthropologists made grandiose generalizations about the ability of childhood personality to shape the cultural behavior of adults. An infamous case in point was Geoffrey Gorer (1905–85), who attributed the “obsessive-compulsive” culture of Japan to premature toilet-training and the “manic-depressive” culture of Russia to prolonged infant swaddling. These theoretical debasements of the psychological approach were caused, in part, by reckless application of the psychology of Sigmund Freud. 91

gestalt  A psychological configuration, attributed by some psychological anthropologists to an entire culture.

national character  According to certain psychological anthropologists, the dominant personality of a nation. culture-at-a-distance  The study of cultures without the benefit of fieldwork, practiced by American psychological anthropologists in the era of World War II.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Mead and Benedict were the two most famous female anthropologists of the early twentieth century. The rise of feminist anthropology in the late twentieth century sparked a renewed interest in their lives, times, and friendship. This interest then spread to lesser-recognized female students of Boas, notably Zora Neale Hurston. Mead, Benedict, and Hurston, along with other anthropologists, are now subjects of numerous biographies – there are more than ten biographies of Mead alone – that explore how individuals who feel culturally alienated may gravitate to anthropology, “find themselves” in the discipline, and even, if only unconsciously, fashion it according to their own psychological needs.

Zora Neale Hurston Key Word: autoethnographic If a major theoretical thrust of Boasian anthropology was to counteract ethnocentrism and racism, why were none of the traditionally celebrated Boasian theorists persons of color? This is an instructive question. One obvious answer is that at the time, the structure of race relations in the United States discouraged and often outright prevented persons of color from pursuing the requisite formal education. But another answer is that the traditional canon of anthropological theorists has been determined overwhelmingly by white (and male) anthropologists. In the late twentieth century, under the influence of new theoretical perspectives, anthropologists began to redress this imbalance and bring to light hitherto overlooked luminaries. One of them is Zora Neale Hurston (1891–1960). Her life trajectory is especially compelling and warrants telling at some length so that it can serve to represent the struggles of other persons of color to achieve anthropological recognition. Zora Neale Hurston was an African-American woman who grew up in the American South in the days of strict racial segregation. She overcame these disadvantages and achieved success through determination, charisma, and talent. Hurston was born in Alabama but from an early age grew up in Eatonville, Florida, a small, all-black community. Because the community was all black, she developed more self-confidence than if she had grown up “on the wrong side of the tracks” in a predominantly white, racist town. As a child, she was independent and sometimes sparred with her father, the Reverend John Hurston, moderator of the local Baptist Association. Reverend Hurston admonished his daughter that independence would get her in trouble when she entered the large, white outside world. Hurston’s mother was highly intelligent and taught her and her seven siblings to use their minds at all times. In school, she blossomed. In the fifth grade she impressed some visitors so much that they gave her a library of used literary classics, which she devoured with relish. Classic literature showed her how to enlarge her world with the power of imagination. 92

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

Hurston’s mother died when she was nine, and her father remarried a short time later.The family moved to Jacksonville, where, because Hurston and her stepmother quarreled, she ended up with relatives. She was dirt poor and worked as a maid.Then she landed a job as a wardrobe girl with a touring Gilbert and Sullivan repertory company. Working with this company was the major educational experience of her youth. In Baltimore, she decided to return to school, owning one dress and one pair of shoes. In high school, Hurston once again shone and after graduating in 1918 moved to Washington, DC, to attend Howard University. In five years she completed one and a half years’ worth of courses while she worked as a manicurist, pursued the first of her several relationships with men – and wrote. Her first short story, based on her Eatonville childhood, was published by Howard’s literary club in 1921. Because Hurston showed promise, a Howard professor recommended her to Charles Johnson, influential editor of the National Urban League’s newspaper Opportunity, published in New York. Hurston relocated to New York and ingratiated herself into highbrow literary circles, impressing one socially prominent benefactor so much that she arranged for a scholarship for Hurston to resume studying at Barnard College of Columbia University, where she became the college’s first black student. Barnard was a turning point for Hurston, because under the influence of Columbia professor Franz Boas, whom she admired, she grew from an aspiring writer into an aspiring anthropologist. Through Boas, she realized that she had already lived American black folklore without knowing that folklore as an anthropological concept existed. She realized furthermore that through folklore her Eatonville experience could be validated and that she was in an opportune position to validate it. In anthropological terms, her childhood participation in black folklore had given her the ability to observe it. Meanwhile, as her interest in anthropology grew, her writing flourished, and she became conspicuous in the literary movement known as the Harlem Renaissance. During the 1920s, chic liberal whites became fascinated with black culture. Hurston became a black glamor girl on the Manhattan literary circuit, entertaining whites with what some detractors called her Uncle Remus–like vernacular stories of the South. Hurston’s celebration of black sensuality embarrassed some “bourgeois” blacks who aspired to overcome stereotypes they thought damaged their chances for success in the white world. Hurston balked at repudiating her folk origins for black bourgeois respectability. She was determined to show that blacks were neither always downtrodden nor trying to emulate whites but instead had their own authentic folk culture of storytelling, spirituals, and rituals.With some other young so-called “New Negro” writers, Hurston founded the radical magazine Fire!!!. The group parodied more respectable black writers by calling themselves the “Niggerati.” Her self-declared mission was to distill the Eatonville essence and represent it to the Harlem Renaissance and then to the outside world. 93

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.8  Zora Neale Hurston (1891–1960): This photograph of Hurston beating the hountar, or mama drum, captures her enthusiasm and zest for life. Library of Congress. New York World-Telegram & Sun Collection. http://loc.gov/pictures/resource/cph .3c08549/.

At this time, like fellow Boasians Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict, Hurston was being pulled back and forth between literature and anthropology. She converted some recollections of real Eatonville stories into fiction and then reconverted the fiction back into fact for an article in the Journal of American Folklore. Boas had convinced Hurston that she ought to help salvage black folklore before it was lost, so in 1927 she headed back south on a collecting expedition funded by Columbia. Her career prospects looked bright. Black folklore was virtually untapped by anthropologists, and Hurston was in a position to tap it with experience and skill. But Hurston struggled to find a suitable style, or theoretical approach, to collect folktales. She sometimes felt that she had to suppress the writer, or artist, in her to let the anthropologist, or social scientist, come out. She became distracted, and her commitment to collecting folktales waned. Eventually she decided that a well-crafted story about Eatonville might represent her people 94

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

just as well as, if not better than, a faithfully reproduced folktale. Meanwhile, Hurston visited Alabama to record the reminiscences of elderly Cudjo Lewis, reported to be the sole survivor of the last slave ship to visit the United States. In 1931, she completed a manuscript based on his reminiscences. A book version of the manuscript, the well-received Barracoon:The Story of the Last “Black Cargo,” was published posthumously in 2018. In New York, Hurston had met Charlotte Osgood Mason, a wealthy white Park Avenue philanthropist who took a liking to her and with whom she felt a spiritual bond. Mason became her patron for many years. With affection, Hurston called her Godmother. The patronage, however, was a mixed blessing. Believing that she could guide Hurston’s career better than Hurston herself, Mason proposed a contract giving Hurston money for research in exchange for proprietary rights over all material collected. Hurston, who needed money, signed. Even though she had a knack for being accepted by informants, she found her collecting trips for Mason just as troublesome as the ones for Boas. She sought Boas’s help organizing her collected material while keeping Mason in the dark (Godmother preferred popular to scholarly publication). Boas convinced Hurston to ask her secret patron for money for a PhD. Mason refused but gave Hurston more money for “independent” research over which she held the same proprietary rights of publication. Partly out of necessity, Hurston began to think of herself once again as a writer more than as an anthropologist, but she was stymied by Mason’s refusal to allow her to explore alternative avenues of artistic expression, such as plays, in favor of books, which Mason told Hurston would be a more “lasting monument to your people.” After her first novel, Jonah’s Gourd Vine (1934), was published to good reviews, and her folkloristic narrative Mules and Men (1935) (for which Boas wrote an introduction) was about to be published, Hurston decided that a Columbia PhD would enhance her clout and boost her career. Her literary reputation was now good enough to land a foundation scholarship without Mason’s help, but when the foundation unexpectedly cut back its money, Hurston gave up. She remained at Columbia “on the books” but spent almost all of her time writing. Boas had difficulty tracking her down while she avoided confronting him with her final decision that she did not want to help bury black folklore in anthropological journals. This Columbia experience effectively ended Hurston’s flirtation with “pure” academics. Personal circumstances, and a then-rigid separation between fiction and non-­ fiction in anthropology, conspired to help her fictional side win out. In this regard, Hurston made a different choice than did Mead and Benedict, both of whom, while blessed with literary skills, focused their anthropology careers on non-fiction. In late-twentieth-century anthropology, owing to theoretical shifts, all three of these anthropologists would have found more latitude to combine both perspectives. During the Great Depression, her most productive years, Hurston achieved fame and a measure of financial success by writing essays, stories, and, especially, novels parlaying the porch banter of her Eatonville youth into what she called “crayon enlargements of life.” Arguably her most ambitious novel was Moses, Man 95

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

of the Mountain (1939), in which she cast the biblical hero in an African-American idiom as a symbol of deliverance for blacks. She did some research on voodoo in Jamaica and Haiti, published in her book Tell My Horse (1938), but some academic reviewers found the journalistic style of the book unsatisfying. While in Haiti, Hurston wrote what ultimately became her best-known novel, Their Eyes Were Watching God (1937), in which main character Janie Crawford, an AfricanAmerican woman of Hurston’s age, recounts her life story intertwined with themes of sexuality, gender, race, and personal identity. In 1942, resting somewhat on her hard-earned laurels, Hurston moved back to Florida to put down roots. There she wrote her autobiography, Dust Tracks on the Road (1942), in which she claims to have known as a child that her fate was to “walk out to the horizon and see what the end of the world was like.” She began turning away from celebrating black folklore in fiction to writing magazine articles for whites. Having tried a variety of jobs, including writing scripts for Paramount Studios in Hollywood, working for the Works Progress Administration (WPA), and teaching at black colleges, she bought a houseboat and settled down in Daytona Beach. Then, out of the blue, came calamity. In 1948, Hurston was falsely charged with molesting the young son of a woman from whom she had rented a room in New York. The charge was eventually dismissed, but Hurston was shattered by the lurid tabloid publicity, coming, as it did, at the time of publication of her first novel about Southern whites, Seraph on the Suwanee (1948). Her world collapsed from the weight of this episode, which is widely believed to have propelled her down an intellectual, spiritual, and physical spiral from which she never recovered. The scandal appears to have pushed her already conservative racial politics further right, because she was particularly bitter that a black court clerk had leaked word of the charge to the press. Hurston retreated to a small rented house in Eau Gallie, Florida, where she tended garden and eked out a living by writing a few more articles for magazines. For a while she took a job as a maid in a wealthy Miami neighborhood. When the story broke in a Miami newspaper, she explained her employment as a means of regeneration. Hurston’s loathing of self-pity, and her drive to prevent anthropologists from feeling sorry for blacks as disadvantaged, made her politics more conservative still. When she criticized the landmark 1954 US Supreme Court decision Brown v. Board of Education banning “separate but equal” schools and wrote that blacks should not use integration to succeed on white terms, she was criticized by leading civil rights organizations. She had long been suspected of romanticizing her Eatonville youth, and her racial views had fallen out of step with the march of time. Once again Hurston was dirt poor, having suffered financially from the scandal and not having worked at any job for more than a year since 1932. All she ever really cared about was having enough money to write. Now she was forced to 96

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

grow her own food and pawn her typewriter for groceries. When she was evicted from her house, she moved to Fort Pierce, where her health deteriorated rapidly. In 1959, she suffered a stroke and was admitted to a county welfare home where three months later, in early 1960, she died. Had Hurston lived just a few years longer, she would have witnessed the birth of the tumultuous American Civil Rights Movement. Hurston was buried in obscurity in Fort Pierce’s segregated cemetery, which grew over with weeds until the distinguished black writer Alice Walker, who had discovered her work, made a pilgrimage there 13 years later to erect a gravestone with the epitaph “Genius of the South.” In 1975, Walker published an article about Hurston in an issue of MS. magazine, and in 1977 literary scholar Robert Hemenway published a groundbreaking book about her, Zora Neale Hurston: A Literary Biography. In literary circles, these two publications helped launch a posthumous recognition and celebration of Hurston that continues to this day. Hurston’s posthumous recognition and celebration in anthropology began two decades later. After her death, her manuscripts, correspondence, and memorabilia, many of them rescued from a fire, were lost or dispersed. A significant collection ended up at the University of Florida, where anthropologist Irma McClaurin (b. 1952), undertaking to create a canon of black anthropologists, sought to define Hurston’s place in the history of anthropological theory. Anthropological theory had changed dramatically since Hurston’s time. New theories such as interpretive anthropology, reflexive anthropology, and postmodern anthropology (discussed later in this book) were more compatible with her style. In terms of theory, it is now evident that Hurston was truly ahead of her time. McClaurin and other commentators point out that in Mules and Men, Hurston revealed that when she was away from home at Barnard, she realized for the first time that she could be somebody outside herself and use anthropology as a “spy glass” for viewing her own world. Deploying this spyglass, she adumbrated theoretical approaches that decades later became mainstream. In researching and writing Barracoon, she learned to operate reflexively and not to privilege her voice over the voice of Cudjo Lewis. By projecting herself into her own fictional characters and then using those characters to speak to her readers, as she did in Their Eyes Were Watching God, she was multivoiced and autoethnographic. In Tell My Horse, when describing voodoo, besides observing, she drew on her own participation, blurring the lines between author objectivity and subjectivity. Especially noteworthy was Hurston’s characteristic use of black vernacular dialect, which earlier literary critics worried would reinforce black racial stereotypes but which later anthropologists praised for authenticity. Furthermore, she was a pioneer in diaspora studies, linking the contemporary black American experience to slavery and, before that,  Africa. And finally, as a strong and independent African-American woman, she has taken her rightful place in the lineages of black and feminist anthropology. 97

autoethnographic  A term suggesting both the study of a culture and/or society by a member of that culture and/or society and the inclusion of autobiographical information in ethnographic writing in such a way that the author in a sense becomes their own informant.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

In 2019, historian Charles King published Gods of the Upper Air: How a Circle of Renegade Anthropologists Reinvented Race, Sex, and Gender in the Twentieth Century. In this circle, right alongside Boasians Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict, is Zora Neale Hurston. King’s book can stand to represent the expanding recognition of Hurston as an anthropological theorist and her movement toward near-canonical status in the field. Fittingly, the first part of the book’s title derives from Hurston herself, whom King quotes from her autobiography. That quotation seems as true for anthropology today as it did for Hurston in 1942. I do not say that my conclusions about anything are true for the Universe, but I have lived in many ways, sweet and bitter, and they feel right for me … I have walked in storms with a crown of clouds about my head and the zig zag of lightning playing through my fingers. The gods of the upper air have uncovered their faces to my eyes.

Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whorf Key Word: Sapir-Whorf hypothesis Sapir-Whorf hypothesis  The proposition of Edward Sapir and Benjamin Whorf that the structure of language conditions the nature of cultural meaning.

An important precursor to cognitive anthropology was the Sapir-Whorf hypothesis, named after anthropological linguist Edward Sapir and his associate Benjamin Lee Whorf. Sapir was a student of Boas and close friend of Benedict and Mead. Like them, he wrote poetry and explored the relationship between personality and culture. Talented both artistically and mathematically, Sapir devoted most of his career to the study of language, first in Canada, then at the University of Chicago, and finally at Yale University, where he co-founded the anthropology department. Whorf was a chemical engineer who worked for the Hartford Fire Insurance Company in Hartford, Connecticut. Developing an interest in the Indigenous languages of Mesoamerica, he began to study with Sapir at Yale in nearby New Haven. Under Sapir’s influence, Whorf disciplined his penchant for philosophizing about the relationship between language and culture and in the 1930s collaborated with Sapir in the formulation of their hypothesis. The Sapir-Whorf hypothesis, sometimes called the principle of linguistic relativity, expresses the view that the mental structures of languages and cultures are correlated – each one influences the other. Sapir and Whorf were especially interested in the influence of language on culture, which Whorf in particular held to be significantly determining. Their chief example was a contrast between the Hopi language and culture (Hopi is a language spoken in the southwestern United States) and a combination of European languages and cultures called Standard Average European, or SAE. In SAE languages, the concept of time is “objectified” by being quantified in expressions such as “ten days.” In contrast, in the Hopi language, time is “subjectified” by lacking quantification in expressions that instead represent time as a process of “becoming later.” SAE languages also use objective 98

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

FIGURE 2.9  The Sapir-Whorf Hypothesis: The hypothesis of Edward Sapir (1884–1939) and Benjamin Lee Whorf (1897–1941) states that languages classify experiences differently. From Language, Thought and Reality: Selected Writings of Benjamin Lee Whorf, edited by John B. Carroll. © 1956 Massachusetts Institute of Technology, by permission of The MIT Press.

“mass” nouns such as “food” and “water,” which must be individualized with adjectives such as “some” and adjectival phrases such as “a glass of.” The Hopi language, on the other hand, lacks mass nouns; instead, every noun is individualized, rendering it subjective without the need for qualification. Furthermore, SAE speakers objectify the concept of space by using spatial metaphors in rhetorical expressions such as “make a point,” “grasp an idea,” and “come straight to the conclusion.” However, Hopi speakers subjectify space with special parts of speech called “tensors.” In each of these cases, according to Sapir and Whorf, the contrast between the structure of SAE and Hopi languages is correlated with a contrast between objectifying SAE and subjectifying Hopi cultures, which “structure” the world differently. Sapir and Whorf believed that culture is carried around in people’s heads as a classificatory logic that creates meaning. Different cultures have different meaning systems, which, like the phonemic systems of language, are equally worthy yet mutually incomprehensible in the absence of a means of crosscultural communication. 99

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

The Development of Psychological Anthropology Key Words: basic personality structure, Freudian anthropology, maintenance systems, personality variables, primary cultural institutions, projective systems, psychodynamic, secondary cultural institutions

Freudian anthropology The school of psychological anthropology incorporating certain elements of the psychology of Sigmund Freud, also called psychodynamic anthropology.

Psychological anthropologists such as Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict knew about Freudian psychology but were unwilling to use it as the basis of their work. Nevertheless, Boasian-era anthropologists found elements of Freudian theory appealing. Psychological anthropology entered a new phase when anthropologists critiqued Freudian theory, rejected much of it, and then incorporated some of it into a revised theoretical perspective. In many ways, Freudian theory represented the very kind of anthropology that Franz Boas and his students were trying to overcome. Freud’s ideas were highly speculative, overly generalized, evolutionary, hereditarian, sexist, and, in equating non-Western adults with Western children, racist and ethnocentric. Boas used Mead to try to disprove Freud’s pronouncement that adolescent psychosexual turmoil was universal. British social anthropologist Bronislaw Malinowski had a similar goal in mind when he demonstrated that the Oedipus complex was irrelevant for the matrilineal South Pacific Trobriand Islanders because, in their kinship system, “mother’s brother,” not “father,” was the source of authority over sons.This kind of research showed that if any parts of Freudian theory were to be salvaged for anthropology, the whole theoretical edifice would have to be reconstructed with cross-cultural variables. While finding Freudian theory objectionable and anachronistic, Boasian anthropologists at the same time found it stimulating and engaging. Like anthropology, Freudian psychology was iconoclastic, forcing people to analyze thoughts and behavior they usually accepted as “normal.” And it was a body of thought about personality, a subject in which anthropology could claim no special expertise. Psychological anthropologists were drawn to Freudian psychology in the 1930s, and, when this happened, they had to change it in major ways. They abandoned Freud’s explanation of psychic evolution, downplayed his emphasis on sex, recast his formulations in terms of cultural relativism, and focused on the development of normal, as opposed to pathological, personality. The result was a new Freudian phase in psychological anthropology, characterized by the study of the development of personality cross-culturally, with a strong emphasis on the importance of early childhood experiences. The chief theoretical architect of Freudian anthropology was Abram Kardiner (1891–1981), a psychoanalyst who studied with Freud but who realized that Freud’s ideas were culture-bound – a partial product of Freud’s own childhood – and had to be overhauled. To accomplish this task, he convened a seminar of anthropologists in New York City in the late 1930s. Major participants included 100

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

primary cultural institutions In psychodynamic anthropology, institutions that affect how children are raised and that shape basic personality structure. secondary cultural institutions In psychodynamic anthropology, social institutions that are projections of basic personality structure and help people cope with the world.

FIGURE 2.10  Alorese Youth Drawings: Cora Du Bois (1903–91) used these drawings by 14-year-old male Atamau Maugliki to interpret Alorese “basic personality”: a) coconut tree; b) fern; c) evil spirit; d) village guardian spirit carving; e) seer’s evil familiar spirit; f) fern; g) spirit altar; h) hawk (flower); i) village guardian spirit carving; j) spirit boat carving. From The People of Alor, Volume II. Copyright © 1944 by the University of Minnesota Press. Reproduced by permission of the University of Minnesota Press.

Boasians Ruth Benedict, Ruth Bunzel (1898–1990), Edward Sapir, and Cora Du Bois (1903–91). Their objective was to develop a theoretical framework for investigating how different cultural experiences nurtured different personality types. With input from the seminar, Kardiner devised a research model with three major components: primary cultural institutions, secondary cultural institutions, and basic personality structure. Primary institutions were those that affected child-rearing practices – for example, arrangements for the feeding, weaning, and daily care of infants. Secondary institutions were the major institutions of society, politics, and religion. In Kardiner’s model, basic personality structure was shaped by primary institutions and then “projected” onto secondary institutions, which functioned to help people cope with the world by depicting it in familiar, culturally adaptive terms. Kardiner called this approach psychodynamic. 101

basic personality structure In psychodynamic anthropology, core personality, shaped by primary cultural institutions and projected onto secondary cultural institutions. psychodynamic  Pertaining to the school of psychological anthropology that adopted certain elements of the psychology of Sigmund Freud; often called Freudian anthropology.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

The task of psychodynamic research was to assess primary institutions, secondary institutions, and basic personality structure independently, and then to correlate them in terms of Kardiner’s model. To assess basic personality structure, psychodynamic anthropologists used clinical tests such as the Thematic Apperception Test, or TAT, and the Rorschach, or “ink blot,” test to get informants to “project” their personalities on paper. The first systematic research of this kind was done by Cora Du Bois on the island of Alor in the Dutch East Indies. Du Bois collected Rorschach profiles, children’s drawings, and psychological life histories, which she then sent back for assessment to clinical specialists in New York. They concluded that the basic Alorese personality was shallow, indifferent, and apathetic. How did such a basic personality develop? According to Du Bois, it developed from the early childhood experience of maternal neglect, caused by Alorese mothers’ need to spend extended periods of time away from their children tending crops in fields. This neglect taught children to expect that their emotional needs would not be readily satisfied, with the further consequence that low expectations were projected onto Alorese religion, characterized by unresponsive deities and carelessly manufactured effigies. Shaped through this kind of projection, Alorese religion was able to help children adapt to the maternal neglect they received. Du Bois’s book The People of Alor (1944) was the theoretical high point of psychodynamic anthropology. The theoretical low points were the national character studies of the World War II era, notably Geoffrey Gorer’s studies of Japan and Russia, which marked the end of the serious blend of anthropology and Freudian theory. Beginning in the 1950s, innovations in social scientific research methods, in particular the increased use of statistics, prompted anthropologists to distance themselves from Freudian psychology, which, from the perspective of empirical science, appeared rife with ill-defined and uninvestigable concepts. A new generation of psychological anthropologists began to purge anthropology of these concepts and to use statistics to make cross-cultural generalizations precise.The pioneering effort in this new direction was John Whiting and Irvin Child’s Child Training and Personality: A Cross-Cultural Study (1953). Whiting and Child generated cross-cultural data from, among other sources, the new Human Relations Area Files at Yale University and manipulated these data statistically to reveal significant cross-cultural associations. One of these, described by Marvin Harris in The Rise of Anthropological Theory, involved the following traits: prolonged periods of nursing at a mother’s breast; prolonged postpartum prohibitions of sexual intercourse; polygyny, or the practice of a man having more than one wife; infants sleeping exclusively with their mothers; patrilineality and patrilocality, or determination of genealogical descent and postmarital residence through the male line; and strict, often severe, male puberty rites. In statistics, association does not necessarily prove cause, but it can suggest cause and help narrow the search for cause-and-effect relationships. Anthropologists have been able to link Whiting and Child’s traits in a cause-and-effect chain of events beginning with the need for prolonged periods of nursing to supplement 102

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

dietary protein and ending with the need for strong male puberty rites to sever the close attachment of son to mother in cultures with male domination.Whiting and Child modified Kardiner’s psychodynamic model and renamed its major components: primary institutions became maintenance systems, especially as they affected child training practices; secondary institutions became projective systems; and basic personality structure became personality variables. In the 25 years between Coming of Age in Samoa and Child Training and Personality, American psychological anthropology evolved through pre-Freudian, Freudian, and post-Freudian phases. A brand of anthropology that began as a humanistic, almost literary attempt to make Americans more tolerant of different kinds of cultures and personalities ended up, in the middle of the twentieth century, modeled after psychologically “detached” social science. Meanwhile, psychological anthropology began to be surpassed by cognitive anthropology and later, although to a lesser extent, by psychiatric anthropology, a specialization within postmodern medical anthropology. Throughout all these transformations, the investigation of culture and personality remained a uniquely American contribution to anthropological theory.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Franz Boas was a forceful personality in anthropology. Overall, how much do you think anthropological theory is influenced by people rather than ideas? 2. Should it be a mission of anthropology to combat racism in the public domain? 3. Is Boas’s historical particularism tantamount to history rather than anthropology? 4. Most anthropologists believe that Indigenous peoples first ­entered North America by immigrating across the Bering Strait land bridge. Many Indigenous peoples believe that their peoples have inhabited North America forever. Which of these beliefs is correct? 5. If Osama bin Laden had not been born, do you think that someone else would have masterminded the attacks of 9/11? 6. Was it wrong for Alfred Louis Kroeber to bring Ishi to San Francisco to live? 7. Is cultural relativism a viable ethical position? 8. What is the point of finding fault with Margaret Mead’s Samoan fieldwork? (continued )

103

maintenance systems In the psychological anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s primary cultural institutions without Freudian components. projective systems  In the psychological anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s secondary cultural institutions without Freudian components. personality variables  In the psychological anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s basic personality structure without Freudian components.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

9. Do you think that anthropologists are capable of creating theories to serve their own personal needs and desires? 10. In Ruth Benedict’s sense, can you think of any personality characteristic that would be considered deviant in every culture? 11. If the United States or Canada were subject to a national character study, what do you think would be each country’s national character? 12. Sometimes it is said that domestic violence is a self-perpetuating cycle in which people who were abused as children become abusers as parents. Explain this cycle in psychodynamic terms. 13. Have a friend look at the image of the “perfect physique” on page 192 and then ask them to write a one-paragraph story about the image. What aspects of your friend’s personality appear to be projected into this story? 14. What lessons for anthropology have you learned from reading about the life of Zora Neale Hurston? 15. Why do you think that anthropologists were so taken with the psychology of Sigmund Freud?

British Social Anthropology structuralism In British social anthropology, the synchronic concern with social structure, sometimes called social morphology; in French structural anthropology, the concern with the elementary forms of minds and cultures. functionalism In British social anthropology, either Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown’s theory of how parts of a society contribute to the whole of society or Bronislaw Malinowski’s theory of how culture responds to biological needs in a hierarchically organized way.

Key Words: functionalism, organic (or organismic) analogy, social function, social morphology, social physiology, social structure, structural-functionalism, structuralism In Britain, the leading early-twentieth-century anthropologists were Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown and Bronislaw Malinowski. By force of personality and intellect, these two figures infused British anthropology with a theoretical agenda far different from the one that had consumed the efforts of their nineteenth-­ century forebears. Working separately and, in the case of Radcliffe-Brown, under the influence of Émile Durkheim, they founded the school known as British social anthropology.The pivotal “-isms” of British social anthropology were structuralism, functionalism, and, sometimes, structural-functionalism. These “-isms,” especially as incorporated in the work of Radcliffe-Brown and his students, were based on Durkheim’s organic, or organismic, analogy, the conceptualization that society is like an organism. Analogies between social and biological phenomena were rooted in the Scientific Revolution, which inspired social scientists to model their enterprise on natural science and flourished after Darwinism, which drew attention to both 104

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

biological and social evolution. Biological organisms have both structures and functions.The scientific study of organic structure is morphology, while the scientific study of organic function is physiology. According to the organic analogy, the scientific study of societies should include social morphology and social physiology. A further inference is that the scientific study of society should include social evolution, but British social anthropologists associated evolutionism with nineteenth-century anthropology and did not wish to elaborate this part of the organic analogy. T   heir orientation was synchronic, meaning ahistorical, rather than diachronic, or concerned with change through time. The British understanding of “society” was significantly different from the American understanding of “culture.” American anthropologists understood culture to comprise economic, social, political, and religious thoughts and behavior, with both synchronic and diachronic dimensions. In contrast, British anthropologists focused more narrowly on the synchronic study of society. Social structure was the matrix, or enclosing form, of society, while social function was the role that individual parts of society played in maintaining the structural whole. The result of proper social functioning was a social structure maintained in equilibrium, or, in terms of the organic analogy, structural “health.” Derived from Durkheimian thought, the twinned theories of structuralism and functionalism inclined British anthropologists to see society as harmonious and stable, unlike evolutionists, who saw culture as prone to change, or Marxists, who saw it as conflicted. British social anthropologists also differed from American historical particularists in their synchronic orientation and their relative lack of involvement with material culture, which American anthropologists maintained through closer affiliations with archaeologists.

structuralfunctionalism In British social anthropology, the synchronic concern with social structure and social function. organic (or organismic) analogy Likening society to an organism, a conceptual device of numerous anthropological theorists. social morphology In British social anthropology, according to the organismic analogy, the study of social structure. social physiology In British social anthropology, according to the organismic analogy, the study of social function. social structure In British social anthropology, the social matrix of behavior; sometimes called social morphology. social function In British social anthropology, the contribution of a part of society to the whole of society; sometimes called social physiology.

A.R. Radcliffe-Brown Key Words: genealogical method, lineages The prototypical British social anthropologist, Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown (1881–1955) embodied, more than any other figure of his generation, the emerging aspirations of an increasingly professionalized group of scholars seeking ways to move beyond the evolutionist principles bequeathed to them by the armchairbound speculation of Tylor, Morgan, and others. Trained in natural science and introduced to anthropology at Cambridge University, Radcliffe-Brown was initially influenced by members of the 1898–9 Cambridge Anthropological Expedition to the Torres Straits, a body of water separating Australia and New Guinea. This expedition was a groundbreaking deployment of a multidisciplinary team of researchers to gather information about Indigenous peoples in the Straits area. Members of the team included anthropologist 105

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

genealogical method The method of focusing ethnographic fieldwork on kinship, pioneered by British social anthropologists, notably William H.R. Rivers.

Alfred Cort Haddon (1855–1940), physician Charles Seligman (1873–1940), and psychologist William H.R. Rivers (1864–1922), along with several linguists and photographers. The expedition set new standards for excellence in fieldwork, yielded numerous publications, and helped launch or solidify the careers of key members. Rivers’s career is especially noteworthy. For one thing, he went on to found the genealogical method of anthropology, a method based on the insights that the nub of non-Western social organization is kinship and that kinship can best be understood through the study of cultural history and psychology. But Rivers also became a neurologist and psychiatrist, and during World War I he practiced at the Craiglockhart War Hospital outside Edinburgh, Scotland. Craiglockhart was set up to treat soldiers traumatized by the horrors of trench warfare. These soldiers had developed a psychiatric condition then known as shell shock but now known as post-traumatic stress disorder, or PTSD. Rivers struggled with the ethics of his job of restoring the mental health of his patients so that they could be sent back into battle. One distinguished patient was poet and war protestor Siegfried Sassoon (1886–1967), with whom Rivers developed a close relationship and who, despite Rivers’s trepidation, returned to battle voluntarily. Novelist Pat Barker used Craiglockhart as a setting for her highly praised Regeneration Trilogy (1991–5). The first novel in the trilogy, Regeneration, was made into a 1997 movie of the same name, with British actor Jonathan Pryce in the role of Rivers. Under the tutelage of Rivers, early in his career Radcliffe-Brown conducted genealogical research in the Andaman Islands in the Bay of Bengal and made a name for himself with his now classic monograph The Andaman Islanders (1922). Subsequently, he held teaching appointments in England, Australia, South Africa, and the United States, where in the early 1930s he taught and was chair of the Anthropology Department at the University of Chicago.There, he interacted with Boasian anthropologists such as Robert Lowie and Fred Eggan (1906–91) and by most accounts, perhaps aided by his sometimes flamboyant personality, exercised a great deal of personal and professional influence, widening the appeal of what he conceived of as a natural science of primitive society beyond the confines of British anthropology. Besides The Andaman Islanders, his major publications include The Social Organization of Australian Tribes (1930–1); A Natural Science of Society (1948); African Systems of Kinship and Marriage (1950), edited with C. Daryll Forde (1902–73); and Structure and Function in Primitive Society (1952). In spite of his early exposure to Rivers’s ethnology, in his own work RadcliffeBrown balked at the non-comparative work of his mentor and sought a more “scientific” basis for anthropology. Accordingly, among British anthropologists he is frequently credited with employing Durkheim’s ideas about mechanical and organic solidarity as the theoretical basis of his original ethnographic fieldwork in Australia and Africa. Ultimately, his original insights transformed Durkheimian theory into a more empirically grounded variant in which mechanical and, 106

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

especially, organic solidarity served as a framework within which a comparative, synchronic sociology of non-Western social systems might be carried out. The primary question that Radcliffe-Brown attempted to answer in his research was how ritual activity and different social institutions, especially kinship, contributed to the maintenance of social structure in and across “primitive” societies. Among his best-known contributions to structural-functionalist theory were delineations of the structural principles that informed the solidarity of sibling groups and lineages, and the various social practices associated with them, whose primitiveness made them invisible to the Western eye. Generally speaking, Radcliffe-Brown is better represented in the work and thought of the many students he influenced within the British tradition and beyond than he is by his own corpus of research and writing, which was not vast. With the exception of Malinowski, who developed his own distinctive perspective on functionalism, most anthropologists working in the British tradition in the first half of the twentieth century followed in the footsteps of Radcliffe-Brown, who introduced many in the profession to the work of Durkheim.

Bronislaw Malinowski Key Words: kula ring, participant observation Second only to Radcliffe-Brown, the most influential British social anthropologist of the first half of the twentieth century was Bronislaw Malinowski (1884–1942). Malinowski was born and raised in Poland and studied anthropology at the London School of Economics, where he entered the British scene. In 1914, he set out to do fieldwork in New Guinea and had stopped at the Trobriand Islands when World War I broke out. The British government allowed him to stay in the Trobriands, where he spent several years doing ethnographic research that led to his ethnography Argonauts of the Western Pacific (1922), widely regarded as the best of the early classics. Eventually, Malinowski returned to the London School of Economics, where during the 1920s and 1930s he helped train the second generation of British social anthropologists. In the twilight of his career, he also taught briefly at Yale University, although his influence there in no way rivaled that of Radcliffe-Brown among American anthropologists in Chicago. The titles of some of Malinowski’s books were titillating and “juicy”: for example, Sex and Repression in Savage Society (1927) and The Sexual Life of Savages (1929). He also wrote Freedom and Civilization (1944), A Scientific Theory of Culture (1944), and A Diary in the Strict Sense of the Term (1967). The diary was published 25 years after Malinowski’s death and is noteworthy for its intensely personal, often brooding and melancholy account of his years as a Trobriand fieldworker. 107

lineages Multigenerational kinship groups with membership determined by ties to common ancestors.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.11  The Kula Ring: As analyzed by Bronislaw Malinowski (1884–1942), in the “ring,” necklaces (soulava) are exchanged clockwise, armshells (mwali) counterclockwise. From Keesing, Cultural Anthropology, 1st edition. Copyright © 1976 Wadsworth, a part of Cengage Learning, Inc. Reproduced by permission. www.cengage.com/permissions.

participant observation The style of anthropological fieldwork requiring the fieldworker to see things from both the “native” and the fieldworker’s points of view. kula ring A cultural and economic exchange network among inhabitants of the Trobriand Islands, studied by Bronislaw Malinowski.

Anthropologists acknowledge Malinowski to be the first and foremost early practitioner of the ethnographic method of participant observation, by which fieldworkers attempt to achieve ethnographic understanding through an artful synthesis of  “insider,” “subjective” participation and “outsider,” “objective” observation. Participant observation is heavily theorized in anthropology today. In Argonauts of the Western Pacific, Malinowski also rendered a classic analysis of the Trobriand kula ring of economic exchange and explored Freudian psychology in the context of a non-Western matrilineal culture. In addition to these contributions, Malinowski lays claim to anthropological fame for his theory of functionalism. Malinowski’s formulation of functionalism differed from Radcliffe-Brown’s by being rooted in biology actually rather than analogously. Like Freud, Malinowski acknowledged that people have basic biological needs, including a basic need for sex. Culture functions to satisfy these basic needs with basic responses. In so doing, it creates a second level of cultural needs, or instrumental needs, which are satisfied with instrumental cultural responses. Instrumental responses create integrative 108

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

FIGURE 2.12  Participant Observation: Bronislaw Malinowski joins in with Trobriand Islanders during ethnographic fieldwork in 1918. Image MALINOWSKI/3/18/2, reproduced by permission of the Library of the London School of Economics and Political Science.

cultural needs, which, in turn, are satisfied by integrative cultural responses. For example, the basic need for sex leads to an instrumental need for the social organization of sexual relations, which in turn leads to an integrative need for an ideology or belief system to reinforce that organization. This whole theoretical hierarchy of needs and responses that themselves become needs was inspired by Malinowski’s fieldwork in the Trobriands, where, according to his own diary, he suffered because his basic biological needs were not being satisfied in a “foreign” culture. In recent years, historians of anthropology have set their sights beyond the mainstream national anthropological traditions of Britain, France, and the United States. Increasingly, they have recognized not only the international character of anthropology but also the diversity of cultural contexts that nurture anthropologists and their theories. A prime example is Malinowski, whose Polish roots, previously glossed over, are becoming more conspicuous in histories of British social anthropology.

E.E. Evans-Pritchard Key Word: colonial encounter A second generation of British social anthropologists followed in RadcliffeBrown’s and Malinowski’s footsteps and broadened their anthropological path. 109

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 2.13  Nuer Seasonality: This is how British social anthropologist E.E. Evans-Pritchard summarized the seasonality of the Nuer of eastern Africa in 1940. From The Nuer: A Description of the Modes of Livelihood and Political Institutions of a Nilotic People. New York: Oxford University Press, 1960, p. 97. Reproduced by permission of Oxford University Press, USA.

Perhaps most notable among this cadre was Edward Evan Evans-Pritchard (1902–73). Unlike his predecessors, Evans-Pritchard developed a distinctively historicist perspective that was at the time unique within British social anthropology and created a certain affinity between his work and that of his American peers. It is, accordingly, the paradox and genius of Evans-Pritchard’s legacy that, although his theory perhaps represents the apogee of structural-functionalism in the tradition of Radcliffe-Brown, it also addresses those issues of overriding concern to later generations of anthropologists. Increasingly throughout his career, EvansPritchard opposed the positioning of anthropology as an experimental or natural science. Instead, he preferred to regard it as one of the humanities and saw the proper role of the ethnographer as an interpreter of history and cultural meaning. For this reason, many have felt that he might justifiably be cited as the father of interpretive or symbolic anthropology. More than any other figure of his generation, working within the structural-functionalism established by Radcliffe-Brown, Evans-Pritchard moved Radcliffe-Brown’s science-oriented British social anthropology in a more “cultural” direction by proposing that the best approach to investigating social structure was to frame it as a series of flexible, logical, cognitive “maps” giving form and meaning to social behavior. Between the 1920s and 1940s, Evans-Pritchard established a reputation as an East Africanist, composing a number of elegant ethnographic studies based on his fieldwork among the Azande and Nuer societies of the southern Sudan; best 110

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

known among them are Witchcraft, Oracles, and Magic among the Azande (1937), The Nuer (1940), African Political Systems (1940, with Meyer Fortes), Kinship and Marriage Among the Nuer (1951), and Nuer Religion (1956). Particularly in his work among the Nuer, he revisited Radcliffe-Brown’s notion of social structure and rejected the idea that societies are best understood through the machine-like organic analogy. In a manner that prefigured the work of Lévi-Strauss and Clifford Geertz (1926–2006), Evans-Pritchard chose instead to seek interpretations of cultural structures that provided meaning for members of a society by weaving together various aspects of life experience. For example, the Nuer possess a unified cultural structure, or system of abstract logic, that informs both the ideas that individuals have about ecology, space, time, and kinship and the social relations and practices that are generated by these ideas. Several generations of anthropology students will ­remember something about the Nuer from having viewed the ethnographic documentary film The Nuer (1971), a staple in anthropology classrooms for decades. In addition to his reputation as a prolific fieldworker, Evans-Pritchard is also legendary for having been an early champion of the cause of cultural relativism. Unlike his American peer Boas, for whom a relativistic perspective derived from his conviction that different societies have fundamentally incommensurable historical experiences, Evans-Pritchard was primarily concerned to prove the coherence and logic of what many anthropologists and philosophers (notably the French scholar Lucien Lévy-Bruhl [1857–1939]) took to be “primitive” thought, in order to show that the capacity for order and rationality was not limited to the Western world but was, rather, a sine qua non of all human social life. Famously, he set out to affirm the logic of the primitive worldview in his ethnographic masterpiece Witchcraft, Oracles and Magic among the Azande (1937). Evans-Pritchard rejected arguments set out by some of his contemporaries that witchcraft and sorcery were evidence of pre-rational logic. These arguments, not coincidentally, had the effect of confirming for many the notion of a natural hierarchy of cultures and races, the apex of which was nearly exclusively the province of white Europeans. Evans-Pritchard convincingly argued the opposite. Based on long-term ethnographic fieldwork among the Azande, he reasoned that such beliefs, and the complex of practices, expectations, and fears associated with them, were indeed quite rational if one adopted the assumptions of Azande society about the interpenetration of seen and unseen worlds and the capacity of some individuals to do others harm. This harm could be done either consciously, through the technical manipulation of powerful objects, or unconsciously, by way of a special organ of the body that caused misfortune in others. Despite his commitment to a historical and relativistic perspective, it is ironic that Evans-Pritchard’s work is frequently cited as an excellent example of research conducted under the shadow of European colonialism in Africa. While recognizing his contributions, latter-day political-economic and postmodern critics of the “colonial encounter” have also viewed his research, and that of others of his generation, as being both morally tainted and theoretically suspect. Nevertheless, 111

colonial encounter The historical encounter between European colonizers and the Indigenous peoples of the world, who were then often marginalized or oppressed by colonialism.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

even his harshest critics recognize the careful thought, eloquent prose, and eye for detail that informed Evans-Pritchard’s ethnographic writing.

Edmund Leach Key Word: oscillating equilibrium

oscillating equilibrium Edmund Leach’s term for the continuing existence of social structure, even against the backdrop of constant social change.

Edmund Leach (1910–88) figures among the most important of British social anthropologists, in particular for his highly original analysis of social structure and conflict in Burma in which he challenged many tenets of the perspective of his mentors, Bronislaw Malinowski and Raymond Firth (1901–2002). He did this by developing a distinctive approach to structural-functionalism, modeled on the theory of Claude Lévi-Strauss, with which he became acquainted in the early 1950s. In Political Systems of Highland Burma (1954), written while Leach was a professor at the London School of Economics, he emphasized the shifting nature of cultural meaning and political power among the diverse Kachin of the Burmese (Myanmar) highlands, among whom he had lived while serving as a British officer during World War II. In this book, Leach argued that the language of myth served as a window onto the Burmese social order and that anthropological interpretation of that language would reveal the underlying structures of the Kachin social order. Wary of the structural-functional tendency to impose rigid grids of behavior on what he viewed as the fluid and highly changeable character of social life, he proposed that instead of viewing as immutable their own theoretical constructs, anthropologists might consider their method of analysis – structural-functionalism – as a “necessary evil”: an explanatory framework that enabled social scientists to artificially “capture” the workings of a society that was, in reality, always in a state of flux, or, to employ Leach’s term, oscillating equilibrium. Among the Kachin, he argued, there existed a single social system that was nevertheless internally differentiated along an axis running between two social “poles”: the hierarchically ranked gumsa Kachin at one extreme and the egalitarian gumlao Kachin at the other. In his later years at Cambridge University, Leach became an ardent and eloquent exponent of French structuralism, largely from the proverbial “armchair,” with his own coterie of students interested in structural analysis. Among his areas of study in the 1970s was mythology in the Judeo-Christian tradition, within which, he posited, religious mythmaking generally involved attempts by exegetes, or interpreters, to bridge a structural opposition between life and death with the concept of “another world.” One of the most compelling examples of Leach’s structural analysis of Judeo-Christian mythology was his comparison and contrast of John the Baptist and Jesus Christ. 112

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

Max Gluckman and the “Manchester School” Key Words: Manchester School, Rhodes-Livingstone Institute, rituals of rebellion, social process Max Gluckman (1911–75) is recognized by many within the British anthropological tradition as the figure most responsible, perhaps even more so than Edmund Leach, for infusing Radcliffe-Brown’s formulation of social structure with an intensive focus on the mechanisms of social control and change. Ethnographically, he helped to train a generation of anthropologists through his association with the Rhodes-Livingstone Institute (later, the Zambian National Research Institute) in the late 1930s and early 1940s; under his tutelage, such important figures as Victor Turner helped shift the focus in British social anthropology away from largely static and atemporal social structure toward a concern for dynamic social process. A South African who had received his doctoral training in social anthropology at Oxford University, Gluckman was especially concerned with identifying and explaining the dynamics of social equilibrium and change in southern Africa. In 1949, following his association with the Rhodes-Livingstone Institute and after several years at Oxford University, Gluckman founded the Department of Social Anthropology at the University of Manchester, where he established a coterie of students committed to his distinctive approach to processual and political theoretical exposition. This fabled Manchester School of social anthropology was responsible for producing a number of the key texts in anthropology of the 1950s and 1960s, all of which bore the mark of Gluckman’s influence. His own body of work included a number of classics in the subgenres of political and legal anthropology (which he created), including Rituals of Rebellion in Southeast Africa (1954), Custom and Conflict in Africa (1955), Order and Rebellion in Tribal Africa (1963), and Politics, Law and Ritual in Tribal Society (1965). The distinctive character of Gluckman’s research and theory derived from its overarching concern with the nature of social stability and its inverse, social change, interests that led him and his students to develop an original body of research in urban areas as well as the traditionally rural environments studied by anthropologists. In particular, the urbanizing and industrializing Copperbelt of central Africa, a region that straddles Zambia and the Democratic Republic of Congo, was an important site of research for a number of anthropologists working out of the Rhodes-Livingstone Institute who sought to better understand processes of rural–urban migration. With respect to anthropological theory, Gluckman is especially well known for developing the notion that all societies incorporate what he termed rituals of rebellion. These, he argued, were important “release valves” for any social order, because of their potential to minimize real conflict by sublimating it within ritual performance. Such performances were powerful because of their capacity 113

Rhodes-Livingstone Institute A research institute in Zambia that conducted much ethnographic research in the final years of British colonialism, later called the Zambian National Research Institute. social process  According to late structural-functionalism, social change as the ongoing creation of a fluid, dynamic social structure.

Manchester School A coterie of anthropologists trained under Max Gluckman at Manchester University in the 1950s and 1960s.

rituals of rebellion A phrase coined by Max Gluckman to describe the socially constructive role of ritual in helping to avoid real conflict.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

to draw attention both to conflict itself and to the need for legitimate authority to contain disruptions of the social order. In this way, social stability was maintained through the incorporation of tension and hostility into conventional and socially legitimate ritual, thereby heading off true revolution. Local ideas about law and legality played a large role in this approach, because of the influence that Gluckman believed these had on the adjudication of disputes and conflict.

The Legacy of British Social Anthropology Key Words: descent group, indirect rule

descent group  Individuals who perceive themselves to be descended in a lineage from a real or hypothetical common ancestor.

From the remainder of an exceptionally large and diverse corpus of British research, theoretical insight, and biography, a few additional contributors to the first decades of social anthropology merit attention. In the main, as Evans-Pritchard had done, the most significant ethnographic monographs from the 1930s through the 1960s expanded upon and gave cultural, historical, and/or political “teeth” to the structural-functionalist admonitions of Radcliffe-Brown. Prominent among these additional contributors was Raymond Firth, whose 600-plus-page monograph We, the Tikopia (1936) helped transform prevailing notions of what structural-functionalist ethnography could be by adding considerable historical and economic depth to his analysis of society in the Solomon Islands. Also, Edmund Leach’s lauded work Political Systems of Highland Burma (1954) infused Durkheimian structural-functional analysis, to that point predicated on the notion of a pre-reflective social solidarity, with a structuralism inspired by his celebrated “conversion” to the work of Lévi-Strauss, which led to the idea that common social conventions and institutions might be shared by otherwise very diverse linguistic and cultural groups. Likewise, Meyer Fortes (1906–83) wrote prolifically concerning the complexity of social relations in Ghana (see, for instance, The Web of Kinship among the Tallensi [1949]) and drew sharp distinctions between the kind of social mechanisms responsible for creating solidarity in the domestic familial sphere (psychological and moral) and those responsible for maintaining solidarity within the larger jural and political descent group. In addition to these, Victor Turner (1920–83), a student of Gluckman’s, cultivated an extremely influential body of process-oriented research on social organization among the Ndembu of Zambia, before going on to be the preeminent figure in British symbolic anthropology. At an early stage in his career, the monograph Schism and Continuity in an African Society (1957) proved to be perhaps the most politically sophisticated structural-functional monograph of the period. Lastly, the influence of British research, especially that of Radcliffe-Brown, was such that it also had a sustained impact in Boasian America, where Fred Eggan, who partially converted to structural-functionalism as a result of his interaction 114

Part Two   // The Earlier Twentieth Century

with Radcliffe-Brown in Chicago, infused the epistemology with his own diachronic and historical perspective. The colonial encounter spoken of by later generations of anthropologists loomed large in the research of British social anthropologists in the first half of the twentieth century. This was primarily because the British Empire, a colonial power of global influence, occupied many territories, especially in Africa, perceived by all as ripe for ethnographic fieldwork – all, that is, except their Indigenous inhabitants. Accordingly, many anthropologists, including Evans-Pritchard, Fortes, and Gluckman, set about conducting intensive fieldwork among people who had little choice but to bear the presence of these intrusive strangers for what were often long periods of time. In 1940, Fortes and Evans-Pritchard published African Political Systems, a controversial book of essays on African ethnography. Some of these essays aimed to counter the contention of evolutionary anthropologists that the evolution of pristine political organization, contrasted with kinship organization, was linked to high population density. The authors cited African examples to show that, contrary to this linkage, some groups with low population density had political organization, while other groups with high population density lacked political organization. Anthropologists critical of British social anthropology have used African Political Systems to illustrate the shortcomings of this approach, which, they argue, paid insufficient attention to African history and therefore failed to recognize that these ethnographic exceptions were evolutionary distortions caused by colonialism and slavery. British social anthropologists have also been criticized for implicitly and explicitly supporting the British foreign policy of indirect rule, which relied on ethnographic knowledge to manipulate, co-opt, and cooperate with Indigenous leaders, thus avoiding the need to govern by deployment of brute force. Malinowski and Radcliffe-Brown were antagonists who sparred over theoretical details and never managed to agree on who the real functionalist was. Given the eventual rejection of functionalism as an epistemology in anthropology, this turned out to be a moot point, and the melodrama and rhetoric that characterized these early debates today seem somehow anachronistic. Nevertheless, it should not be forgotten that together, like Franz Boas, their counterpart in the United States, Malinowski and Radcliffe-Brown gave British anthropology distinction and a twentieth-century identity that was grounded in empirical research and rigorous theory rather than the armchair speculation and hypothesizing of unilineal evolutionists such as Tylor and Morgan. While Malinowski’s variety of biocultural functionalism was the first to be discredited and discarded (together with his conclusions and personal biases) by his disciplinary progeny, his painstaking, long-term ethnographic fieldwork among the Trobriand Islanders continues to be the paradigmatic model for all graduate students heading “into the field.” Likewise, the detail and quality of his numerous monographs established a seminal style of data analysis as literary genre that has yet to be 115

indirect rule  The British colonial policy of co-opting Indigenous leaders in order to avoid having to govern by force.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

displaced as a vehicle for the exposition of research within sociocultural anthropology. Just as important, the structural-functionalism pioneered by Radcliffe-Brown served as a bridge between the foundational work of Émile Durkheim and the interests of a second and then a third generation of British social anthropologists peopled by scholars of such high caliber and diverse abilities as Evans-Pritchard, Fortes, Leach, Gluckman, Firth, Douglas, and Turner. These anthropologists were able to combine notions of structure with a political and cultural nuance and sophistication that still stand up to scrutiny in the twenty-first century.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Can you describe society without using words borrowed from biology? 2. Why are so many anthropologists, including British social anthropologists, preoccupied with the study of kinship? 3. What special insights can anthropology bring to the practice of psychiatry? 4. How does Bronislaw Malinowski’s fieldwork method of participant observation relate to the epistemological distinction between emics and etics, a distinction discussed elsewhere in this book? 5. How does Malinowski’s theory of functionalism contrast with Sigmund Freud’s vision of culture and human nature? 6. Can anthropology be an experimental science? 7. Give two examples of the concept of oscillating equilibrium. 8. Why did so many British social anthropologists conduct their fieldwork in Africa? 9. Why did E.E. Evans-Pritchard think it was important for anthropologists to show that so-called primitive thought is rational? 10. According to Max Gluckman, why are rituals of rebellion not revolutionary? 11. Does it make any difference that some British social anthropologists supported the British colonial policy of indirect rule over Africa? 12. How might earlier-twentieth-century American anthropology have turned out differently if, at the time, the United States had been a colonial power? 13. How might earlier-twentieth-century British anthropology have turned out differently if, at the time, Native peoples were living in Britain?

116

PART THREE

The Later Twentieth Century

As the nineteenth century ended, evolutionist schemes developed by Morgan and Tylor were obviously no longer tenable against an increasingly sophisticated and fast professionalizing discipline of anthropology. During the first half of the twentieth century, the British school of social anthropology fell heavily under the sway of Émile Durkheim and his intellectual progeny (especially Radcliffe-Brown and his students). Over time, the Durkheimian focus on integrated structure chafed as British social anthropologists (for instance, Leach, Evans-Pritchard, and Gluckman) sought ways to inflect their research with concern for both the irreducibility of cultural meaning, on the one hand, and the social and political agency of individual subjects, on the other. In North America, meanwhile, an altogether different configuration of anthropological knowledge was taking shape under the careful tutelage of Franz Boas. Unlike the structuralist and functionalist perspectives espoused by their Britishschool peers, American cultural anthropologists cultivated an avowedly historical approach that emphasized the radical diversity of cultural form rather than its psychosocial solidarity. Despite its emphases on change through time and empiricism, culture historicism often sacrificed breadth of analysis for the sake of precision. As a result, even those innovations made by Mead and Kroeber, and later by cognitive anthropologists, have been seen by subsequent generations as theoretically impoverished.The perceived central weakness of historical particularism was precisely its inability to grasp broader cross-cultural historical patterns and processes. The post-World War II period saw new perspectives take shape on both sides of the Atlantic. In France, an exciting field of theory was emerging out of the work

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

of a singular intellectual, Claude Lévi-Strauss, whose adaptation of Durkheimian theory to the analysis of cultural and mental logic spawned many streams of analysis. In another vein, ecological, materialist, and cognitive anthropology-as-science reached its apogee in the work of several theorists, including Leslie White, Julian Steward, Marvin Harris, Harold Conklin, and others. As the decades wore on, the ideas of Karl Marx enjoyed a revival, particularly in the thinking of anthropological political economists. Max Weber’s ideas, too, enjoyed new popularity as mediated by Clifford Geertz, whose vision of culture-as-text became enormously influential in the later decades of the century.Victor Turner’s research, meanwhile, echoed Geertz’s concern for symbolic meaning even as it looked to Durkheim for inspiration about the making and unmaking of social structure. From the 1980s onward, however, even these exciting theoretical turns in social and cultural anthropology were seeming less and less appealing as the feminist, postmodern, post-structural, and postcolonial critiques assumed center stage across diverse spaces of anthropological work. Finally, biological, archaeological, and linguistic anthropology also witnessed dramatic shifts in perspective along the axis of nature and nurture, synchrony and diachrony, and structure and agency, among others. For these and other reasons, the story of later-twentieth-century anthropology, when contrasted with that of the earlier part of the century, cannot easily be told in terms of national traditions of theory, still less in terms of an objective, positivist “science.” Instead, discussion of this period must be approached largely in terms of distinctive approaches to theory – “schools” of thought that unfolded across a patchwork of personalities and disciplinary interests.

French Structural Anthropology While Franz Boas, A.R. Radcliffe-Brown, and their students were promulgating their brands of anthropology in North America and Great Britain, other theoretical influences were at work in France – wellspring of pre-professional anthropology ranging from Thomas Aquinas to Jean-Jacques Rousseau to Marcel Mauss. Here, classical cultural evolutionism never really took hold. In its place, the seminal and pervasive influence of Émile Durkheim ensured that, when French anthropology assumed its twentieth-century identity, it did so in a way that was more continuous with, rather than a radical departure from, its nineteenth-century legacy. Durkheim, a rationalist as much as an empiricist, had understood thought to precede observation and the origins of social phenomena to be in the group mind. In his theoretical terms, the elementary forms of social phenomena were collective representations of the collective consciousness of people, which promoted social cohesion and solidarity. This outlook became the basis for French structural anthropology when Claude Lévi-Strauss converted the concept of elementary forms into that of elementary structures. 118

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Claude Lévi-Strauss Key Words: binary oppositions, generalized exchange, matrilateral cross-cousin marriage, patrilateral cross-cousin marriage, phonemes, Prague School, restricted exchange, structuralism Claude Lévi-Strauss was the guru of French structural anthropology and one of the most celebrated, even if not always understood, anthropologists of the twentieth century. Lévi-Strauss studied at the University of Paris before leaving France in the 1930s to become a professor at the University of São Paulo in Brazil. While there, he conducted himself as a kind of expatriate, doing fieldwork published later as the ethnographic travelogue Tristes Tropiques (1955). In the 1940s, he spent several years as a professor at the New School for Social Research in New York, where he interacted with Franz Boas. In 1950, LéviStrauss became director of studies at the École Pratique des Hautes Études, followed in 1959 by an appointment as chair of social anthropology at the Collège de France. During his years as a student, Lévi-Strauss flirted with politics while immersing himself in the traditions of French ethnography and the ideas of Marcel Mauss. Following his Brazilian fieldwork, he turned his attention to anthropological theory, publishing The Elementary Structures of Kinship (1949) and Structural Anthropology (1958). These books present a complex analysis of kinship based on one aspect of reciprocity: the reciprocal exchange of women. Working in the tradition of Durkheim, whose concern was solidarity, LéviStrauss began with the proposition that reciprocal exchange among social groups promotes alliances, which facilitate social interaction and make society cohere. These alliances are achieved through the reciprocal exchange of women as “gifts.” The propensity, or structure, for gift-giving is innate in the human mind, which operates with a universal logic of dualities, called binary oppositions, something he learned from the Prague School of structural linguists, led by linguist Roman Jakobson (1896–1982), who helped formulate the concept of phonemes. In structural linguistics, phonemes are minimally contrasting pairs of sounds that create linguistic meaning. In structural anthropology, binary oppositions are contrasting pairs of mental constructs that create social meaning. Some of the binary oppositions Lévi-Strauss discussed at great length are life versus death, culture versus nature, and self versus other.With binary oppositions, the relationship between elements is as important as the elements themselves.This relationship is “mediated.” For example, the binary opposition between kinship groups, a transformation of the binary opposition of self versus other, is mediated by the exchange of women. In structuralism, binary oppositions are part of an integrated system of logically connected categories of meaning that structure social activity and the way in which that activity is conceptualized. 119

binary oppositions  In French structural anthropology, the universal logic of dualities. Prague School  A school of linguists based in Prague that pioneered the analysis of phonemes. phonemes Minimally contrasting pairs of sounds that create linguistic meaning. structuralism In British social anthropology, the synchronic concern with social structure, sometimes called social morphology; in French structural anthropology, the concern with the elementary forms of minds and cultures.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.1  The Totemic Operator: This is a model of totemic “structure” in the theoretical schema of Claude Lévi-Strauss (1908– 2009). Lévi-Strauss claimed that the philosophy of structuralism came to him while he was contemplating a dandelion puff. From The Savage Mind. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1962. Copyright © 1962 by Librarie Plon. Copyright © 1966 George Weidenfield and Nicholson Ltd. Reprinted by permission of the University of Chicago Press.

Because Lévi-Strauss analyzed social organization in the way that structural linguists analyze language, form was as important as content. In the case of the elementary structures of kinship, Lévi-Strauss observed that kinship groups who exchange women create a form, or relationship, among themselves, as well as relationships among exchanged women. This relationship helps to mediate the groups; that is, it brings them closer together. Implicated in exchanges of women are four basic relationships: brother and sister; husband and wife; father and son; and mother’s brother, or “uncle,” and sister’s son, or “nephew.” Each of these relationships is either “positive,” promoting harmony and happiness, or “negative,” promoting hostility and antagonism. According to Lévi-Strauss, the mind balances positives and negatives, so in a given exchange system, two of the relationships 120

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

must be positive and two must be negative. From culture to culture, the content of the relationships can change, but their form, logic, or structure remains the same. In Lévi-Strauss’s scheme, the reciprocal exchange of women can assume either of two forms. Restricted exchange creates a relationship between two kinship groups through “symmetrical” cross-cousin marriage, whereby brothers and sisters in one group marry cross-cousins – cousins related through parents of the opposite sex – in the other group. Generalized exchange creates a relationship between more than two kinship groups through “asymmetrical” cross-cousin marriage, whereby brothers and sisters are not exchanged between two groups directly but return to their groups after having been circulated through other groups. According to Lévi-Strauss, generalized exchange promotes more solidarity than restricted exchange because it creates alliances involving more kinship groups. Beyond this, he identified two forms of generalized exchange, one of which he thought promotes more social solidarity than the other. Matrilateral cross-cousin marriage, or marriage to mother’s brother’s children, leads to a “long cycle” of generalized exchange, while patrilateral cross-cousin marriage, or marriage to father’s sister’s children, leads to only a “short cycle.” The long cycle promotes more solidarity than the short cycle because it creates alliances involving more kinship groups.This difference, Lévi-Strauss thought, explains why matrilateral cross-cousin marriage is more prevalent than patrilateral cross-cousin marriage in the ethnographic record. Besides kinship, where Lévi-Strauss made substantial theoretical contributions to anthropology, structural anthropologists have analyzed a wide range of cultural domains, including, notably, food preferences and myths. In an analysis of the North American Native myth of the “tricky coyote,” Lévi-Strauss set up two pairs of analogous binary oppositions – agriculture is to warfare as life is to death – and claimed that hunting mediates agriculture and warfare because hunting preserves human life while leading to the death of animals. Scavenging animals like the coyote mediate yet another pair of binary oppositions – herbivore to carnivore, also analogous to life and death – so coyotes must be tricky. In The Raw and the Cooked (1969), a book devoted to the structure of cuisine, Lévi-Strauss contrasted raw, cooked, and rotted foods. For cooked foods, boiling is to roasting as culture is to nature. Boiled foods are served to kinspeople while roasted foods are served to strangers, because kinspeople are associated with culture while foreigners are associated with nature. Later, Lévi-Strauss extended his analysis of the structure of cuisine to human cannibalism, predicting that when kinspeople are cannibalized, they should be boiled, whereas when strangers are cannibalized, they should be roasted. In his book Cultural Materialism (1979), anthropologist Marvin Harris, an opponent of structuralism, presented evidence that these predictions are not borne out in ethnographic reality. Many have noted that, perhaps more than any other anthropologist of the twentieth century, and regardless of which side of the Atlantic Ocean one hails from, Claude Lévi-Strauss was responsible for the single most original body of theory and writing to emerge in the discipline. Indeed, it often seemed as though 121

restricted exchange  According to Claude Lévi-Strauss, the exchange of women between two kinship groups. generalized exchange  According to Claude Lévi-Strauss, the exchange of women among more than two kinship groups, promoting greater social solidarity than restricted exchange. matrilateral crosscousin marriage   Marriage to a child of one’s mother’s brother; contrasted with patrilateral cross-cousin marriage. patrilateral crosscousin marriage  Marriage to a child of one’s father’s sister; contrasted with matrilateral cross-cousin marriage.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

much of the theoretical agenda of late-twentieth-century anthropology was set by Lévi-Strauss – both by those who explicitly and implicitly championed his ideas and by others, notably Marvin Harris, who argued against them. It was certainly not long before the structuralist thesis that Lévi-Strauss proposed caught the interest of anglophone anthropologists, who began to expand upon his work in earnest during the 1960s.

Mary Douglas Key Words: pollution, purity

purity According to Mary Douglas, the ideal of a seamless social order symbolically excluding that which threatens a society’s basic categories of understanding; contrasted with pollution. pollution According to Mary Douglas, aspects of the world unexplained by a society’s basic categories of understanding, thereby threatening the social order; contrasted with purity.

While French structural theory flourished in the francophone world, it required translation for most Anglo-American anthropologists, in both the literal and the figurative senses, because the British and Americans were not accustomed to Durkheimian analysis that was mentalistic and synchronic. Those anthropologists responsible for communicating and championing the work of their French colleagues in the anglophone world were accordingly looked to as “filters” and interpreters of structuralist analysis. Two of the most articulate exponents of LéviStrauss’s structuralism during the 1950s and 1960s were Edmund Leach (who turned to French structuralism after his work as a structural-functionalist, as discussed in Part Two) and Mary Douglas. British anthropologist Mary Douglas (1921–2007) is recognized as one of the most important interpreters of French structuralism for an anglophone readership. A student under Meyer Fortes and Max Gluckman, Douglas, an Africanist, was also deeply influenced by the work of E.E. Evans-Pritchard (one of her professors and mentors) and, subsequently, Lévi-Strauss. A professor at the University of London and Oxford University before taking a position at Northwestern University, Douglas was influential for her groundbreaking study of the mental rules of classification governing the universal concepts of purity and pollution. In particular, her cross-cultural study of ritual prohibitions against things that are “dirty” – regardless of how this concept is locally constructed – has been of lasting value to anthropologists seeking to understand how social boundaries are created, sustained, or transgressed. In her best-known work, Purity and Danger: An Analysis of Concepts of Pollution and Taboo (1966), she argued that Durkheimian principles of social order were expressed in culturally generated formulations of the pure and the impure: purity is structurally connected to ideas concerning social harmony, coherence, logic, and boundaries, while impurity is associated with “dirty things” that are morally “dangerous” insofar as they suggest ambiguity and uncertainty about social rules and meaning. Famous examples from the work include analyses of Old Testament temple rituals and food prohibitions in a chapter entitled “The Abominations of Leviticus.” 122

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Latter-Day Structuralists French structuralism continued to exert considerable influence across the social sciences, even though its impact has in recent years been largely indirect. At the very least, the notion of “structure,” whether cognitive (as Lévi-Strauss emphasized) or social (as early generations of British social anthropologists proposed), has been a resilient “straw man” in contrast to which more recent generations of anthropologists have developed more “process”-centered theories and epistemologies. Still, it seems clear that the Durkheimian tradition in anthropology, which stresses the integrated aspects of social and cultural life, is still a fundamental orientation for those seeking to break new theoretical ground. Accordingly, others have refused to throw the proverbial baby out with the bathwater and have instead attempted to infuse French structuralism with a concern for social class and power dynamics.

structural marxists Key Words: formalists, structural Marxists, substantivists One of the most theoretically abstract offshoots of French structuralism was socalled structural Marxism. This body of theory grew out of an anthropological debate that began during the 1960s between economic formalists and economic substantivists. Formalists such as Scott Cook (b. 1937) maintained that the traditional Western definition of economics, the allocation of scarce resources among unlimited wants, also applies to non-Western economies. Substantivists such as George Dalton (1926–91), Karl Polanyi (1886–1964), and Marshall Sahlins disagreed, maintaining that formalists were ethnocentric and that capitalist conceptions do not apply to economies lacking markets and the political apparatus of states. According to substantivists, people in cultures governed by kinship do not think like economic materialists and strategize to maximize their material advantages because the primary significance of their economic transactions is social. Some substantivists even argued that economic exploitation does not exist if people do not think of themselves as exploited. Structural Marxists aimed to resolve the tensions arising from these debates. In some ways, their idea was to apply Hegelian dialectics to social theory itself – the formalist “thesis” and substantivist “antithesis” being resolved in a new synthesis that linked materialism and idealism. This marriage of materialism and idealism would not, it seems, have been unappealing to Lévi-Strauss himself. In his autobiographical Tristes Tropiques, he describes Marxism as one of “three mistresses” guiding the development of structuralism from its inchoate beginnings to coherent maturity. This being said, it is difficult to divine Marxist leanings in Lévi-Strauss’s sprawling corpus of ethnography. Although hints of a Marxist position emerge in The Savage Mind (1962), in 123

formalists Economic anthropologists who maintained that Western economic concepts apply to nonWestern economies; contrasted with substantivists. substantivists  Economic anthropologists who maintained that Western economic concepts do not apply to non-Western economies; contrasted with formalists. structural Marxists  Proponents of a theoretical blend of Marxism, dialectical philosophy, and French structural anthropology.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

which he claims as one of his goals the development of a theory of superstructures “scarcely touched upon by Marx,” this line of reasoning was generally underdeveloped in his writing. There is, however, some idea of what he had in mind. In his analysis of Native American mythology, Lévi-Strauss argues that contradictions in the place of women as both commodities and social beings are reflected in myths that specify conflict between different species of animals. As pioneered by Maurice Godelier (b. 1934) and Jonathan Friedman (b. 1946) in the 1970s, the central ambition of structural Marxism was to relate the theory of dialectical materialism to a theory of dialectical idealism by demonstrating that the structure of economic transactions derives from the structure of thought. As discussed by Marvin Harris in Cultural Materialism (1979), under the influence of Lévi-Strauss, structural Marxism was little short of an effort to “dematerialize” Marxism – that is, the theory of dialectical materialism – and refocus it on the structure of dialectical thought. Thought, as opposed to behavior, is implicated by the Marxist concepts of “class consciousness” and “social relations” of the means of economic production. Pursuing these ideas, structural Marxists like Friedman began searching for hidden “dialectical” structures that make economies tick. Friedman found that the structure of capitalist economies is a fetish for money, while the structures of non-capitalist economies are rooted in social and religious values. The apogee of structural Marxism within anthropology came in the late 1970s, as another Marx-inspired perspective, political economy, and post-structural analyses inspired by such theorists as Michel Foucault (1926−84), Jacques Lacan (1901−1981), and Antonio Gramsci (1891−1937) began to grow in influence.

Marshall Sahlins Key Word: structure of the conjuncture Perhaps the most famous latter-day exponent of structuralism within anthropology after Lévi-Strauss is American Marshall Sahlins (b. 1930), who in the 1960s abandoned cultural neo-evolutionism, a theory discussed later in this book, and published his most evocative and controversial theses on structuralism in the 1980s, well into a period of introspective malaise and uncertainty in the discipline. Best known among these is Sahlins’s application of structuralist concern for symbolic patterning to his interest in colonial encounters in the Pacific. In Islands of History (1985), Sahlins offers an ingenious resolution to the tension between cultural structure and historical change by way of analyzing the colonial encounter between European eighteenth-century explorer-colonists and Native Melanesians. In particular, he explores English–Hawaiian relations that culminated in the fabled death of British Royal Navy officer and explorer Captain James Cook (1728−1779) at the hands of Native Hawaiians in the late eighteenth century. The 124

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

problem lies in how to explain the reception of Europeans by Native Hawaiians possessed of their own cultural structure of symbols and meanings. From Sahlins’s perspective, this dark episode proves an ideal case study in which to explore the relations between culture and history. He argues that the cultural structure of any community is not static but rather open to transformation depending on context. When circumstances warranted, pre-contact Hawaiian culture adapted to the new situation – framing their encounter with Europeans within an Indigenous logic of social relations. In this way, the presence of Englishman Cook and his crew not only provoked but also required explanation. Sahlins argues that contact, or “conjuncture,” between two distinct cultural structures – that of the Hawaiian and that of the European – precipitated change to both, in effect creating a hybrid structure at the point of encounter. It is this structure of the conjuncture that must be explored in order to understand both why Cook was killed and, more relevant for anthropology, how apparently static cultural structures change through time. In essence, Sahlins’s argument is that Native Hawaiians in the late eighteenth century understood Cook to be a fertility god because he acted in accordance with Hawaiian mythical expectations of divinity. He “became” Lono, whose annual return and ritual sacrifice were crucial to the smooth functioning of Hawaiian society – a people dependent on Lono’s divine power (mana) to ensure health, fecundity (of women, animals, and the Earth), and prosperity from one agricultural cycle to the next. When Cook, after a period of tension and miscommunication with Hawaiians, was killed by a sharp blow to the head (provoked by the attempted kidnapping of a Hawaiian king), his crew saw the event as nothing short of murder. Sahlins makes the case that, to the contrary, for the Hawaiians, the killing of Cook was a symbolically powerful act within the Indigenous cultural structure. Given their belief in Cook’s divinity, it was entirely predictable, as was the idea that he would appear post-mortem during the following year’s rites of fertility renewal. In this structure of the conjuncture, Cook is recreated in the image of Hawaiian mythology, in terms of both his quality as a being and his relationship to Hawaii and Hawaiians. This perspective has been taken to task by anthropologist Gananath Obeyesekere (b. 1930), in what may be described as one of the more lively, engaging, and protracted debates (spanning at least three books) in recent social and cultural anthropology. In brief, Obeyesekere argues for a reading of Cook’s encounter with the Hawaiians that places awareness of the depredatory intentions of European colonials at the forefront of Hawaiian consciousness. Far from lack of awareness of Cook’s colonial ambitions, it was precisely the conflict created by these that resulted in the captain’s killing. The idea that Cook was made a god is, in this wise, itself a myth of European auto-aggrandizement. To this, Sahlins has responded by having Obeyesekere hoisted by his own petard: if the perception of eighteenth-century Hawaiians was more complex than permitted by deterministic cultural structures, then so too was European self-imagining. And so the 125

structure of the conjuncture Marshall Sahlins’s phrase describing the space of intersection between different cultural structures, where contingency produces historical change.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.2  The Structure of the Conjuncture: The killing of Captain James Cook by Native Hawaiians in 1779, depicted here, was the subject of a protracted theoretical debate between anthropologists Marshall Sahlins (b. 1930) and Gananath Obeyesekere (b. 1930). Clevely, John the Younger. “Death of Captain James Cook at Kealakekua Bay, Hawaii, in 1779.” Reproduced by permission of the Art Archive at Art Resource, NY.

debate went, more enlightening, perhaps, of recent debates in anthropology than of structuralism per se. With the debate largely behind him, Sahlins has continued to publish prolifically on themes related to structuralism, notably the relationship between structure and history, the priority of ideology over economy, and how culture shapes biology rather than the other way around.

The Legacy of French Structural Anthropology Key Word: obscurantism, solipsism Lévi-Strauss’s perspective on linguistic and cognitive structure, which (via linguist Roman Jakobson) draws heavily on Saussure’s theory of signs, has been the central target of criticism on several fronts. Some, such as materialist Marvin Harris, have derided structuralism for assuming, as Lévi-Strauss appears to in places, that cultural structures are the empirical “reality” of any given society – an assumption that would seem to set aside the possibility of scientific understanding, not to mention common 126

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

sense. If this is the case, then relativism is privileged as more than just a research principle: it becomes a precondition of anthropological understanding and comparison. Even Sahlins, eloquent expounder of structuralism though he is, has not been able to resolve this inconsistency, which has significant implications for his work on the colonial encounter in Hawaii. Among Hawaiians, the historical moment of encounter with the English is informed by and fused with cosmology. If this can be the case, he argues, the notion of historical objectivity, too, must be investigated for its mythical properties. Taken seriously, this reduction of anthropological analysis to poetics would seem to rob the field of its power to explain cultural process. Others, ranging from post-structural guru Michel Foucault to the preponderance of social and cultural theorists today, are less polemical. Their view is that Lévi-Strauss’s focus on cognition tends to ignore the practical, emotive, and diachronic aspects of culture. In denying, at least tacitly, the somatic, social, and historical, structuralism is exposed to the criticism that it leaves the door open for obscurantism, solipsism, and extreme relativism – all of which stand in stark contrast to structuralism’s universalist pretensions. Still, the idea that patterned sequences of symbolic meaning stand in observable, “decipherable” relation to other such sequences is of enduring appeal, and many anthropologists have made efforts to adapt this aspect of French structuralism to more contextually – and historically – sensitive ethnography. One might consequently ask how valid these critiques are and to what extent they have been accepted by anthropological theorists. As Joel Robbins has noted in an essay, such critiques amount to “willfully simple-minded interpretations of the hot/cold distinction” that ignore Lévi-Strauss’s more subtle arguments concerning social and historical change. In Robbins’s view, Lévi-Strauss’s supposedly ahistorical perspective must be considered a meditation on “the danger of universalizing a Western cultural model of the nature and value of change as a theoretical construct.” For this reason his legacy, and that of French structuralism, must be seen as contributing to a growing disciplinary awareness of the need for caution in exporting Western models of society and culture: a contribution that would be of great significance to anthropologists in later decades.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. In what ways is French structural anthropology rooted in the theories of Émile Durkheim? 2. In the Lévi-Straussian sense, what do you suppose mediates the binary oppositions between life and death, and culture and nature? Could there be other mediators? 3. What is the evidence that culture is based on binary oppositions? (continued)

127

obscurantism  Deliberate obfuscation or vagueness aimed at preventing facts or details about something from becoming known. solipsism The idea that the individual self is the only reality and that the external world exists only in one’s imagination.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

4. Analyze from a Lévi-Straussian perspective the last meal you ate. 5. What is your opinion of Mary Douglas’s idea that dirty things are morally dangerous because they suggest ambiguity and uncertainty about social boundaries and rules? 6. Is structural Marxism so different from dialectical materialism that it should not even be called Marxist? 7. Why did Marshall Sahlins and Gananath Obeyesekere make so much of the killing of Captain James Cook? 8. In what ways is French structural anthropology indebted to linguistics? 9. In your opinion, what does French structural anthropology fail to do?

Cognitive Anthropology cognitive anthropology  The school concerned with folk taxonomies and semantic domains as practiced in ethnolinguistics and by ethnoscientists in the New Ethnography. emic In theories including cultural materialism, the epistemological perspective of the investigated, or “the insider point of view”; contrasted with etic. etic In theories including cultural materialism, the epistemological perspective of the investigator, or “the outsider point of view”; contrasted with emic. phonemics The study of linguistic meaning created by sounds. phonetics The study of linguistic sounds that create meaning.

Key Words: cognitive anthropology, emic, etic, phonemics, phonetics Turning back now to the United States, by the time Franz Boas died, his grip on American anthropology had loosened. In the post-Boasian era, historical particularism faded into the background of an increasingly crowded landscape of anthropological theories. One of these theories was cognitive anthropology. Cognitive anthropology was rooted in Boasian cultural relativism, with input from anthropological linguistics. Its theoretical orientation was emic, contrasted with etic. This contrast originated in the 1950s with linguist Kenneth Pike (1912–2000), who made an analogy with the contrast between phonemics and phonetics in linguistics. Phonemics is the study of linguistic meaning created through sound, while phonetics is the study of linguistic sounds themselves. Linguists can study the sound systems of languages for their own sake, with language speakers supplying raw data. To discover which sounds are meaningful, however, they must rely on language speakers as authorities. Phonetics represents the point of view of the “outsider,” the linguist investigator, while phonemics represents the point of view of the “insider,” the speaker being investigated. Relating this distinction to the anthropological fieldwork technique of participant observation, Pike decided that participation was “emic” because, in principle, its goal was to enable anthropologists to think and behave like Indigenous peoples, while observation was “etic” because its goal was to have anthropologists remain detached. The emic approach was “seeing things from the native’s point of view,” which, according to Pike, would promote cross-cultural understanding and combat ethnocentrism in accordance with the doctrine of cultural relativism. Pike 128

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

advocated both emic and etic approaches to anthropology, but he preferred the emic.

Ethnoscience and the “New Ethnography” Key Words: componential analysis, ethnoscience, ethnosemantics, folk taxonomies, New Ethnography, semantic domain Cognitive anthropology coalesced during the 1960s when a faction of American anthropologists, growing out of the tradition of Boas, sought to make their emic orientation explicit and, inspired by linguistics, to improve their methodological rigor. The school, variously called ethnoscience, ethnosemantics, or the New Ethnography is best known for its investigative techniques, devised mainly by practitioners Harold Conklin (1926−2016), Charles Frake (b. 1930), and Ward Goodenough (1919–2013). The object of these techniques was to describe native cognition, or perception, as a semantic domain, or domain of meaning, with a cognitive “code” that could be “cracked.” The most compelling technique of this sort was componential analysis, which generated folk taxonomies of meaning resembling the Linnaean taxonomy of Western biology. Just as the Linnaean taxonomy classifies living things using a hierarchy of categories defined by biological criteria, folk taxonomies classify cultural realms using hierarchies of categories defined by cultural criteria. The goal of componential analysis was to uncover these criteria. By interviewing native informants in the manner of anthropological linguists, who utter contrasting sounds and then ask informants whether the contrasts are meaningful, componential analysts produced “cultural grammars,” or “maps” of semantic domains, ranging from Subanun boils and Zeltal firewood to “ethnobotanical” classifications of Amazonian pharmaceutical plants. Cognitive anthropologists shared the view that culture is a formal system of rules for thought and behavior. Unlike in Western biology, however, where the Linnaean classification has traditionally been held to be “right” and folk classifications of living things “wrong,” in cognitive anthropology all classifications were treated as culturally context-dependent. The popularity of cognitive anthropology peaked in the 1960s and then declined. Today, by name, cognitive anthropology is an uncommon anthropological subfield. Anthropologists interested in cognition are more likely to associate themselves with other cognitive sciences, including cognitive linguistics, computer science, and even the study of artificial intelligence. Meanwhile, at the peak of its popularity, cognitive anthropology had attracted criticism from anthropologists of opposing theoretical orientations, conspicuous among them new cultural evolutionists and materialists and those more interested in hermeneutically based approaches to the study of culture. 129

ethnoscience  A term referencing the collection of theories and methods used in cognitive anthropology. ethnosemantics Refers to the study of linguistic meaning, logic, and organization in cultural context. New Ethnography A synonym for cognitive anthropology that references the methods and theories of ethnoscience and ethnosemantics. semantic domain A mental domain of cultural meaning that is the focus of inquiry in cognitive anthropology. componential analysis A research technique of cognitive anthropologists used to generate folk taxonomies of semantic domains. folk taxonomies According to cognitive anthropologists, culturally conditioned maps of semantic domains.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Which later-twentieth-century anthropological theories were primarily emic in orientation, and which etic? 2. Do you think that people speaking different languages see the world in fundamentally different ways? 3. Is culture a mental code?

Cultural Neo-Evolutionism Key Word: cultural neo-evolutionism

cultural neoevolutionism  Twentieth-century cultural evolutionism, a revival and reformulation of classical cultural evolutionism.

An outstanding new theme in post-Boasian anthropology was a revival of nomothetic approaches, which had been eclipsed by Boas’s preference for the idiographic approach of historical particularism. The search for cross-cultural generalizations was aided by the Human Relations Area Files, established in the 1940s by George Peter Murdock (1897–1985) at Yale University and used in the 1950s to do research for Whiting and Child’s Child Training and Personality.The outstanding new nomothetic theory was cultural neo-evolutionism, a reformulation of nineteenth-century classical cultural evolutionism that in some ways was anti-Boasian. The new cultural evolutionism was the brainchild of four American anthropologists: Leslie White, Julian Steward, Marshall Sahlins (before his conversion to French structuralism), and Elman Service, with input from British archaeologist V. Gordon Childe (1892–1957). All played significant roles in the development of neo-evolutionist theory, and their perspectives are worth discussing in some detail. In addition to Childe’s contribution, cultural evolutionism also had a significant impact in the subdiscipline of archaeology, where it informed a body of new theory called the New Archaeology.

Leslie White Key Words: culturology, entropy, layer-cake model of culture, second law of thermodynamics, sui generis, thermodynamic law, thermodynamics Leslie White (1900–75) was an anthropologist trained in the Boasian tradition but who broke rank with Boas radically during his long career at the University of Michigan. His Marxist, or Marxist-like, orientation made him a controversial figure both on campus and in the anthropology profession, so much so that he was 130

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

FIGURE 3.3  Leslie White (1900–75): White was the leading exponent of mid-twentieth-century cultural neo-evolutionism.

sui generis  In its own realm, or on its own terms. culturology Leslie White’s name for the nomothetic study of culture.

Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

investigated by the FBI. White’s views are summarized in two books: The Science of Culture (1949), a collection of essays, and The Evolution of Culture (1959), an exposition of the course and process of evolution. White considered culture to be a system of its own kind, sui generis, akin to Kroeber’s concept of the superorganic. Cultural “laws” would constitute the science of culturology. The linchpin of the system was thermodynamics, the study of the conversion of forms of energy in the universe. White was impressed with the second law of thermodynamics, which stated that the universe is running down structurally and dynamically, resulting in increased entropy, or disorder. According to White, biological evolution works in the opposite direction, taking “negative entropy” from the universe and increasing order in the production of complex forms of life. Cultural evolution, which supplants biological evolution in the case of Homo sapiens and ancestral species, enhances this trend. To explain the evolution of culture, White proposed 131

thermodynamics The study of conversion of energy in the universe, a fundamental part of culturology as expressed in the second law of thermodynamics. second law of thermodynamics The scientific proposition that the universe is running down, thereby increasing disorder, or entropy. entropy Disorder in the universe, increasing according to the second law of thermodynamics.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY thermodynamic law  E × T > P, or energy times technology yields cultural product, the nomothetic basis of Leslie White’s culturology.

layer-cake model of culture Leslie White’s model of culture, with technology and economy at the bottom, ideology at the top, and social and political organization in between.

a thermodynamic law: culture evolves as the amount of energy harnessed per capita per year is increased or as the efficiency of the means of putting this energy to work is increased. The law was symbolized E × T > P – energy times technology yields cultural product. White defined four major stages of cultural evolution, each of which began with an energy “revolution.” The first revolution was the invention of tools, which increased the ability of the human body to obtain food calories. The second was the “Neolithic Revolution,” a term coined by archaeologist Childe to describe the increased control over food energy achieved by the domestication of plants and animals. The third and fourth revolutions were the harnessing of fossil fuels in the eighteenth century and of atomic energy in the twentieth century. In between these revolutions, culture evolved as the technology for using these new energy sources improved. An integral part of White’s thermodynamic system was his layer-cake model of culture, a depiction of culture comprising a layer of technology and economy at the bottom, a layer of ideology at the top, and a layer of social and political organization in between. In the “determination” of cultural evolution, the bottom layer predominated, because innovations in technology and energy took place there. In assigning priority to technology and economy over ideology as the impetus for cultural change,White was an avowed cultural materialist. Some of his materialism came from Marxism, which he is alleged to have “discovered” on a trip to the Soviet Union in the 1920s. This was the interest that caused him to be put under surveillance by the FBI. Connected to Marxism was the work of Lewis Henry Morgan, whose views on the importance of private property impressed Friedrich Engels. White also “discovered” Morgan and became determined to rehabilitate Morgan’s reputation as a cultural evolutionist while criticizing Franz Boas for bringing that reputation into disrepute. White’s criticism of Boas (posthumously) was even stronger than Derek Freeman’s criticism of Margaret Mead.

Julian Steward Key Words: adaptation, band, cultural ecology, multilineal, potlatch, unilineal, universal

cultural ecology  The examination of interactions between cultural and environmental variables.

While White was promulgating evolutionism in Michigan, an antagonist was gathering strength in Illinois: Julian Steward (1902–72), the “father” of modern cultural ecology. Steward, another Boasian by intellectual upbringing, was a longtime professor at the University of Illinois who influenced a host of distinguished political and economic anthropologists, including Morton Fried (1923–86), Andrew Vayda (b. 1931), Eric Wolf (1923–99), and Elman Service. Cultural ecology nurtured a nomothetic approach to anthropology because it focused on the articulation between culture and nature, linking anthropology to nomothetic 132

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

natural sciences such as biology, demography, and chemistry. Steward’s work grew out of the “culture area” concept used by Boasians Alfred Louis Kroeber and Clark Wissler to demarcate American Native groups. Each group inhabited a geographical area to which, through culture, it adapted. Adaptation became the rubric of cultural ecology. In 1936, Steward published a seminal essay on the economic and social basis of bands. In this essay he defined band as distinguished from what Service later called “tribe,” “chiefdom,” and “state.” He also defined three types of bands –­ patrilineal, matrilineal, and “composite” – and linked each type to particular ecological circumstances. Steward’s approach prompted some Boasians to rethink their eclectic approach to anthropological explanation and to concentrate instead on cultural ecology. The result was a reinterpretation of some famous ethnographically reported events, notably the Northwest Coast ceremony of the potlatch, which Ruth Benedict had depicted as a conspicuously wasteful drive for social status but which Helen Codere (1917–2009) and Wayne Suttles (1918–2005) later explained as an ecologically adaptive, redistributive feast. As a cultural ecologist, Steward was not primarily a cultural evolutionist. Nevertheless, he took enough interest in evolutionism to find White’s pronouncements extreme. He distanced himself from White by calling the latter’s brand of evolutionism universal and his own brand multilineal. He called the nineteenthcentury brand unilineal. Implied by these labels was Steward’s view that he was a specialist while White was a generalist. The labels “unilineal” and “multilineal” meant that classical cultural evolutionists believed that evolution proceeds in only one direction and cannot skip stages, whereas Steward believed that evolution can branch off in numerous directions as cultures adapt to varied circumstances. For years, Steward and White sparred over points of cultural evolutionary theory, with Steward accusing White of being so general that he could not explain anything in particular and White accusing Steward of being so particular that he could scarcely be called an evolutionist. It took two of their colleagues, Sahlins and Service, to resolve this dispute in 1960.

adaptation In cultural ecology, the result of cultures adjusting to environments, or in Darwinian evolution, the result of natural selection.

Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service

unilineal Pertaining to the view that cultural evolution proceeds along the same lines everywhere, as in classical cultural evolution; contrasted with multilineal and universal evolution.

Key Words: general evolution, specific evolution For many years, Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service (1915–96) were colleagues at the University of Michigan, where they worked in close association with Leslie White. A one-time student of Julian Steward, Service maintained an interest in the ecological basis of social groupings, the theoretical framework for his popular text Primitive Social Organization (1962), which featured the fourfold division and evolutionary sequence of bands, tribes, chiefdoms, and states. 133

band The simplest form of human social organization, placed in evolutionary sequence before the tribe, chiefdom, and state.

potlatch A Pacific Northwest Indigenous ceremony characterized by conspicuous exchange and consumption of goods.

universal Pertaining to a single schema for global cultural evolution; contrasted with unilineal and multilineal evolution. multilineal According to Max Weber, culture change occurring in fits and starts in different historical contexts; according to Julian Steward, “branching” cultural evolution; contrasted with universal and unilineal cultural evolution.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

general evolution In the cultural evolutionary schema of Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service, the study of long-range evolutionary progress and trends. specific evolution In the cultural evolutionary schema of Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service, the study of how cultures differentiate by adapting to local environments.

Sahlins began his work in economic anthropology and was a strong proponent of cultural evolutionism and materialism before he began to combine French structural and historical analyses in the late 1960s, as discussed earlier in this book. In 1960, Sahlins and Service co-authored Evolution and Culture, in which they sought to reconcile the views of Steward and White. In the time-honored anthropological tradition of treating biology and culture as analogs, they argued that, like biological evolution, cultural evolution has two different dimensions. The dimension of general evolution was being pursued by White, who was concerned with long-range evolutionary progress and trends, while the dimension of specific evolution was being pursued by Steward, whose explanation of local adaptation was analogous to Darwin’s mechanism of natural selection. Having demonstrated that White and Steward were really complementary rather than antagonistic, Sahlins and Service settled down to a decade of work together at Michigan, where, with White, they formed a powerful evolutionary triumvirate. The “Michigan School” influenced a number of other cultural evolutionists and ecologists, for example, Alexander Alland Jr. (1931−2016), Robert Carneiro (1927−2020), and Yehudi Cohen (1928–98), who kept the nomothetic approach to cultural anthropology alive. Later, Sahlins moved to the University of Chicago and Service moved to the University of California at Santa Barbara, Sahlins largely abandoning and Service maintaining their respective cultural evolutionary orientations.

The New Archaeology Key Words: culture-historical archaeology, ethos, general systems theory, hypothetico-deductive model, Midwestern Taxonomic Method, New Archaeology, processual archaeology culture-historical archaeology  Archaeology as practiced in the era of Franz Boas’s historical particularism. Midwestern Taxonomic Method The archaeological classification used in culture-historical archaeology. New Archaeology The nomothetic archaeology advocated by Lewis Binford; also called processual archaeology.

The new cultural evolutionism had a major impact on prehistoric archaeology, mainly through White. Since its establishment in the mid-nineteenth century, prehistoric archaeology had progressed through several stages linked to stages in the development of cultural anthropology. There was functionalist archaeology, Marxist archaeology, and, under the influence of Boas, culture-historical archaeology, represented in the United States by the Midwestern Taxonomic Method. Archaeologist Betty Meggers (1921–2012), a student of White, was inspired by his thermodynamic formula for cultural evolution, E × T > P. Finding the culture-historical approach unproductive, she decided to apply the formula to archaeology, believing that if archaeologists knew technology (T) and environment (E), they could reconstruct cultural product (P).This idea was developed further by another student of White’s, Lewis Binford (1931–2011), who became the leader of the New Archaeology of the 1960s. 134

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Binford grew up with the “old” culture-historical archaeology but changed under the influence of White. He decided that archaeology ought to be an integral part of anthropology because archaeologists and anthropologists share the same goal: to explain similarities and differences among cultures. To “explain” meant to offer generalizations about cultural systems and cultural evolution. Binford acknowledged that cultures change in response to both the natural environment and other cultures, but he maintained that, in explaining change, some parts of culture are more important than others. He rejected the conception of culture as “shared values,” a concept promulgated by psychologically oriented students of Boas, such as Benedict and, later, Clyde Kluckhohn (1905–60), for whom culture was ethos, or spiritual character. Instead, Binford adopted White’s layer-cake model of culture and argued that, in archaeology, artifacts, as objects of material culture, can reflect all three layers, yielding a well-balanced picture of cultures in the past. To realize this potential, archaeologists need to be trained as ethnologists so they can learn how artifacts function in the present and then “read” these functions back in time. Under Binford’s influence, the New Archaeology revived the nineteenth-century “comparative method.” Aiming to make archaeology scientific, Binford adopted a number of nomothetic devices. One was the hypothetico-deductive model for scientific explanation, developed by philosopher of science Carl G. Hempel (1905–97). This model directed scientists to hypothesize “covering laws” from which specific circumstances could be deduced – predicted or retrodicted – and then compared with empirical reality. Another was general systems theory, a cybernetic model for culture that involved “feedback loops” and “positive,” or system-maintaining, and “negative,” or system-changing, cause-and-effect chains. Binford argued vigorously against psychological explanations of culture. One well-known example of his nomothetic approach to archaeology was his devising of a mathematical formula to predict the age of clay pipes, commonly encountered in colonial North American archaeological sites, from the diameter of their stem bores. Like White and Kroeber (when he promoted the concept of the superorganic), Binford opposed the great man theory of history, believing instead that human behavior is determined by forces – laws – of which individuals are largely unaware and over which they can exert little control. This hyper-scientific, anti-humanistic, and “positivist” attitude made the new cultural evolutionism and the New Archaeology pills too bitter for many anthropologists to swallow. Because of its preoccupation with cultural process, the New Archaeology came to be called processual archaeology. Beginning in the 1980s, it attracted severe criticism from post-processualists, who saw in it almost everything that was wrong with modern science. At the same time, in cultural anthropology, “postmodernists” severely criticized modern science for many of the same reasons. In reaction to these trends, to defend science, Binford teamed up with other like-minded, outspoken anthropologists, notably Marvin Harris. 135

ethos A term meaning spiritual character, used by some anthropologists to characterize a whole culture.

hypothetico-deductive model A philosophical model for scientific explanation used in the New Archaeology. general systems theory  A cybernetic model for culture used in the New Archaeology.

processual archaeology  A name post-processual archaeologists use for the nomothetic New Archaeology.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. In what ways does Leslie White’s neo-evolutionary theory represent a radical departure from the tenets of Boasian anthropology? 2. White was a materialist. How does his materialism differ from the materialism of Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels? 3. Do you find Marshall Sahlins’s and Elman Service’s reconciliation of the theories of Leslie White and Julian Steward satisfactory? 4. Was White a positivist? 5. What was new about the New Archaeology?

Cultural Materialism Key Word: cultural materialism

cultural materialism  The theory of Marvin Harris that distinguishes emic from etic perspectives and mental from behavioral domains, and that advocates infrastructural determinism.

An important part of the resurgence of nomothetic anthropology in the post-­Boasian era was cultural materialism, an unabashedly scientific perspective developed by iconoclastic anthropologist Marvin Harris (1927–2001). Harris was a native New Yorker who spent most of his career at Columbia University before moving to the University of Florida in 1981. Early on, he conducted fieldwork in Brazil and Mozambique, which transformed his outlook and helped lead to his formulation of the theory of cultural materialism.The tenets of cultural materialism are set forth in greatest detail in four of his 17 books: The Nature of Cultural Things (1964), The Rise of Anthropological Theory (1968), Cultural Materialism (1979), and Theories of Culture in Postmodern Times (1999). Cultural Materialism was his theoretical manifesto.

Marvin Harris Key Words: behavioral domain, cultural eclectics, cultural idealists, false consciousness, infrastructural determinism, mental domain, universal pattern ­ arris began to develop cultural materialism in an effort to purge modern anthroH pology of some of the legacy of Boas and continued to develop it in an effort to combat the spread of new nonscientific and antiscientific attitudes in the profession. Cultural materialism addresses a central problem for scientific anthropology: people can be both subjects and objects of scientific investigation. They can think 136

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

and say things about themselves, just as scientists think and say things about them. Where, then, does true knowledge reside? The answer, according to Harris, can be found by maintaining two pairs of cross-cutting epistemological criteria: mental versus behavioral domains and emic versus etic domains. The mental domain is what people think; the behavioral domain is what people do. The emic domain belongs to the participant, the etic domain to the observer. Combined, these two pairs of distinctions yield four epistemological perspectives: the emic behavioral perspective is what people think about their own behavior; the emic mental perspective is what people think about their own thoughts; the etic behavioral perspective is what the observer observes about other people’s behavior; and the etic mental perspective is what the observer observes about other people’s thoughts. While all four perspectives are possible, two are problematic and ought to be approached with caution. The emic behavioral perspective is problematic because, according to Harris, people can develop false consciousness and misrepresent the meaning of their own behavior to themselves and to others. The etic mental perspective is problematic because it is difficult to find out what is going on inside someone else’s head. According to Harris, the etic behavioral and emic mental perspectives lack these drawbacks and are more likely to yield useful information. In Harris’s understanding of scientific anthropology, there is room for both emic and etic perspectives, but they must be kept separate and maintain their own operational definitions and data languages. In the end, the etic perspective predominates. In emics, the native informant is the ultimate judge of validity; in etics, it is the scientific observer. Both natives and scientists can be “objective,” but when natives are objective, they themselves become scientists. For Harris, objectivity is not mere intersubjectivity, or mutual understanding and the ability to participate in one another’s cultures; there is only one objective truth – the etic truth of science. Like White, Harris divides culture into several levels, which form a universal pattern, a modification of Leslie White’s layer-cake model of culture. Harris’s levels are mode of production, mode of reproduction, domestic economy, political economy, and behavioral superstructure. Each has an etic behavioral dimension and an emic mental dimension. Favoring the etic behavioral dimension, Harris combines the modes of production and reproduction into the component etic behavioral infrastructure, combines domestic and political economies into the component etic behavioral structure, and relabels behavioral superstructure the component etic behavioral superstructure. A fourth component, mental and emic superstructure, applies to all levels of the universal pattern. The core of cultural materialism is the principle of infrastructural determinism, the name Harris gave to his presupposition that, more often than not, culture changes first in the etic infrastructure and then reverberates through etic structure and superstructure to affect emic superstructure last. In Harris’s vocabulary, cultural idealists explain 137

mental domain  In the theory of cultural materialism, what people think, contrasted with what people do. behavioral domain  In the theory of cultural materialism, what people do, contrasted with what people think.

false consciousness  In the theories of Marxism and cultural materialism, the capability of people to misrepresent the meaning of their behavior to themselves and others.

universal pattern  In cultural materialism, the levels of culture – infrastructure, structure, and superstructure – with emic and etic and mental and behavioral dimensions. infrastructural determinism In Marvin Harris’s theory of cultural materialism, the name for the belief that culture change usually begins in the etic infrastructure. cultural idealists  Anthropological theorists who attach causal priority to the domain of thought rather than behavior.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY cultural eclectics  Anthropological theorists who on different occasions attach causal priority to the domain of thought rather than behavior, or behavior rather than thought.

culture change as occurring in the opposite direction, while cultural eclectics explain culture change inconsistently. The “materialism” in cultural materialism derives from Marxism, which Harris acknowledged as the source of this part of his theory. But, according to Harris, Marx and Engels omitted mode of reproduction from their formulation; confused mental and behavioral and emic and etic realms; and were saddled with the Hegelian dialectic, a metaphysical rather than scientific principle. Once Harris rid dialectical materialism of these “mistakes,” the name cultural materialism seemed more appropriate. Why infrastructural determinism? According to Harris, it is because infrastructure is the primary interface between culture and nature and the place where people are obliged to start using culture to cope with nature in orderly ways. Scientists, looking for order, are probably going to find it there. As a theoretical agenda for anthropology, cultural materialism had much in common with neo-evolutionism and the New Archaeology. All three of these approaches are, or were, staunchly pro-science. All have been espoused by forceful anthropology personalities, notably Harris, who spent much of the latter part of his career defending scientific anthropology against inroads by structuralist, symbolic, interpretive, and postmodern approaches. In several high-profile cases, Harris excoriated Lévi-Strauss and other structuralists for their symbolic analyses of myth, hygiene, and cuisine, and he sided with Michael Harner (1929−2018) in his debate with structuralist Marshall Sahlins over whether Aztecs practiced cannibalism for calories or religion. In these efforts, he was criticized for theoretical intolerance, “one-sidedness,” and a lack of appreciation for alternative “culturally sensitive” ways of doing anthropology. Although the number of Harris’s “disciples” remained small, he is widely credited with stimulating polemical discussions that enriched anthropology overall. He also brought anthropology to a wide readership with popular best-selling books such as Cows, Pigs, Wars, and Witches (1974), Cannibals and Kings (1977), and America Now (1981). The Washington Post once characterized Harris as a “storm center in his field.”This characterization sums up what many anthropologists consider to be his central legacy.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. The concept of false consciousness presupposes that people are not aware of why they behave the way they do. Does this presupposition strike you as counterintuitive? 2. How might Marvin Harris respond to the criticism that cultural materialism is merely his own emic mental construct? 3. How would you go about finding out whether the Aztecs practiced cannibalism for food or for religion?

138

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Nature versus Nurture Key Words: biologize, nature, nurture Another, very different intellectual current in late-twentieth-century anthropology was the move in some quarters to biologize cultural anthropology. All the earlier Boasian and post-Boasian anthropological “-isms” had shared an opposition to such hereditarian interpretations of human cultural variation. Nurture, not nature, was a hallmark of early-twentieth-century anthropology in Britain, France, and the United States, where anthropologists sought to put much of Darwin’s century, the nineteenth century, behind them. In the decades following World War II, from the late 1940s through the early 1970s, anthropology expanded in universities, especially in North America, where the discipline was organized into the four subdisciplines of cultural, physical, archaeological, and linguistic anthropology. As universities prospered, these subdisciplines grew and became highly specialized, but cultural anthropology dominated, attracting by far the largest number of practitioners and setting the intellectual tone for the profession. Meanwhile, in biological anthropology, specialists such as osteologists, primatologists, and geneticists practiced their trades and were largely ignored by their more academically influential colleagues. But in the 1960s, this relationship changed.

biologize To regard as caused by heredity more than by environment. nurture In the context of the nature versus nurture debate, the source of human behavior from environment rather than heredity. nature In the context of the nature versus nurture debate, the source of human behavior from heredity rather than environment.

Biology of Behavior Key Words: australopiths, Jensenism, K-selection, naked apery, Pioneer Fund, r-selection, scientific racism The impetus for change was the emergence in biological anthropology of an interest in the biology of human behavior. Preliminary explorations of this topic were several “popular” accounts of human aggression, territoriality, and sexuality as “genetic.” Two examples were African Genesis (1961) and The Territorial Imperative (1966) by Chicago playwright and anthropology aficionado Robert Ardrey (1908–80). Ardrey was captivated by the earlier discovery of South African fossil australopiths, an extinct group of ape-like human ancestors. In African Genesis, he argued that one species of australopith, Australopithecus africanus, killed off another species, Australopithecus robustus, and that all modern people are descended from this “killer ape.” In other words, violence was “in our genes.” In The Territorial Imperative, he pursued a similar hereditarian argument that a primitive human ­propensity to seek and defend private property made socialist programs of communal property “contrary to human nature.” A third, and more notorious, example was The Naked Ape (1967) by primate zoologist Desmond Morris (b. 1928). Morris attributed all kinds of human characteristics to evolved bipedal 139

australopiths Primitive, ape-like human ancestors known from fossils found in Africa.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

naked apery A disparaging term used to describe unfounded assertions about the inheritance of human behavior.

Jensenism The label attached to the view of behavioral geneticist Arthur Jensen that IQ is highly heritable and differs among human races. r-selection In certain evolutionary theories, the reproductive strategy whereby parents choose to have many offspring and invest lightly in their upbringing, contrasted with K-selection. K-selection In certain evolutionary theories, the reproductive strategy whereby parents choose to have few offspring and invest heavily in their upbringing, contrasted with r-selection. Pioneer Fund A philanthropic organization dedicated to advancing the “scientific study of heredity and human differences,” said by its detractors to be tinged with biological determinism and racism. scientific racism  Improper or incorrect science that actively or passively supports racism.

locomotion, including pendulous female breasts, which, according to him, evolved as substitutes for female buttocks when males needed a sexual symbol appropriate for “face-to-face” sexual intercourse. Generally, cultural anthropologists and mainstream biological anthropologists disputed the claims of these authors as unsupported by science, and, in disrespect, some dubbed their approach “naked apery.” Nevertheless, in criticizing naked apery as extreme, some anthropologists began to wonder what might be true about a biological basis for human nature. Four other anthropologically noteworthy controversies beginning in the 1960s concerned the biological bases of race and of class.The first controversy, recounted earlier in this book, took place in the early 1960s following publication of biological anthropologist Carleton Coon’s The Origin of Races (1962). The second occurred in the late 1960s when University of California at Berkley psychologist Arthur Jensen (1923–2012) proposed that variation in intelligence quotient, or IQ, is predominantly genetic and therefore that the measured 15-point difference in IQ between American blacks and whites cannot be entirely eliminated by educational reform. The scientific merit of this argument, based significantly on studies of identical and “fraternal” twins reared together and apart, was widely criticized. Anthropologists’ criticisms were so strong that the term Jensenism became synonymous with racism in subsequent controversies about genes and behavior. A third controversy surrounded Richard Herrnstein and Charles Murray’s vigorously contested book The Bell Curve: Intelligence and Class Structure in American Life (1994). Herrnstein (1930–94), a Harvard University psychologist, and Murray (b. 1943), a fellow at the American Enterprise Institute, argued that variation in intelligence is highly heritable and correlated with social success, making the upper class a kind of “genetic meritocracy.” Anthropologists’ reactions to The Bell Curve were just as negative as they had been to the work of Jensen. At around the same time, Canadian psychologist J. Philippe Rushton (1943–2012), who taught at the University of Western Ontario, stirred a fourth controversy by publishing his book Race, Evolution, and Behavior: A Life History Perspective (1995). Rushton based his views on the evolutionary distinction between “r-selected” and “K-selected” strategies of reproduction, with groups practicing r-selection favoring quantity of offspring and groups practicing K-selection favoring “quality” of offspring. Key to this distinction was variation in the amount of care that parents invest in their offspring, with r-selecting parents investing less and K-selecting parents investing more. Guided by these principles, Rushton arrayed “Mongoloids,” “Negroids,” and “Caucasoids” on a continuum based on their rankings on numerous scales of variation, including fertility, intelligence, criminality, and sexual anatomy, conspicuously penis size. From the outset, anthropologists suspected that Rushton’s views were politically tainted, especially after he became head of the right-wing, New York City–based non-profit organization the Pioneer Fund. All of these controversies helped give rise to the term scientific racism, which in recent decades anthropologists have used to label a host of propositions that link variation in human behavior to variation in human biology. 140

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

The New Physical Anthropology Key Words: biocultural anthropology, New Physical Anthropology, typological thinking Meanwhile, in the wake of the scientific and political controversies created by Ardrey, Morris, Coon, Jensen, Rushton, and Herrnstein and Murray, other countervailing developments worked to bring cultural and biological anthropologists closer together. One such development was promulgation of the New Physical Anthropology, launched in the 1950s by biological anthropologist Sherwood L. Washburn (1911–2000). The New Physical Anthropology had little to do with the new cultural evolutionism and the New Archaeology launched at approximately the same time. Washburn simply urged biological anthropologists to embrace the synthetic theory of evolution, the synthesis of Darwinism and Mendelian genetics that biologists had achieved in the 1930s. Extended to biological anthropology, this synthesis directed anthropologists to study biological process more than form and to abandon typological thinking, or thinking in terms of fixed “pure” races. This change in scientific attitude made biological anthropology more acceptable to cultural anthropologists. Meanwhile, biological anthropologists worked out cultural explanations for the geographical distribution of sickle-cell anemia and intolerance of lactose, or milk sugar. These explanatory successes led to the emergence of the new field of biocultural anthropology, aimed at exploring interactions between human biology and culture in accordance with the principles of evolutionary ecology. The resulting cooperation between biological and cultural anthropologists primed some anthropologists to be more receptive to the next wave of biological explanations of human behavior. The 1970s saw the emergence, or ascendance, of three such bio-behavioral explanatory approaches, which affected anthropology to varying degrees: human ethology, behavioral genetics, and sociobiology.

Ethology and Behavioral Genetics Key Words: behavioral genetics, body language, ethology, fixed action pattern, human biogram, innate releasing mechanism, key stimulus, kinesics, phenotype, polygenic, proxemics The first bio-behavioral approach to come of age in the 1970s, human ethology, grew out of animal psychology and zoology and involved a commitment to hereditarian concepts such as fixed action pattern, innate releasing mechanism, and key stimulus. Human ethologists examined both the ontogeny, or individual growth, and phylogeny, or evolutionary growth, of biologically linked 141

New Physical Anthropology The name for physical anthropology committed to the synthetic theory of evolution. typological thinking Thinking of biological groups as homogeneous or pure when in fact they are heterogeneous and mixed. biocultural anthropology  Anthropology aimed at exploring interactions between human biology and culture, usually according to ecology. ethology The study of animal behavior in the understanding that it sheds light on the innateness of certain human behaviors. fixed action pattern  As conceived by human ethologists, an innate sequence of behavior released by a key stimulus of an innate releasing mechanism. innate releasing mechanism As conceived by human ethologists, the mechanism that, when triggered by a key stimulus, releases a fixed action pattern. key stimulus As conceived by human ethologists, the device that triggers an innate releasing mechanism, thus releasing a fixed action pattern.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY human biogram A term used in human ethology to describe the alleged suite of inherited predispositions of Homo sapiens. body language  A colloquial term for nonverbal communication. kinesics The scientific study of human body motion. proxemics The scientific study of posture as a form of nonverbal communication, sometimes called “body language.” behavioral genetics The branch of genetics that investigates inherited contributions to behavioral differences. phenotype The product of gene action, often affected by environment. polygenic Variation in phenotype affected by the action of many genes.

behaviors that, in the language of ethology, constitute the human biogram. According to ethologists, cultural “universals,” like some facial expressions and gestures, are potentially genetic. A diluted form of ethology found its way into the anthropological study of nonverbal communication, or body language, in the sciences of kinesics and proxemics, the studies of body motion and body position. Anthropologists Lionel Tiger (b. 1937) and Robin Fox (b. 1934) also promoted a diluted form of ethology in books such as Men in Groups (1970) and The Imperial Animal (1971), where they expounded their views on “natural” human tendencies. While human ethology could trace its lineage back to Charles Darwin’s treatise The Expression of the Emotions in Man and Animals (1872), and while it had popular appeal, the approach failed to earn widespread scientific respect. Many critics ended up using the adjective “ethological” to describe any proposition that recklessly attributed human behavior to heredity. The second bio-behavioral approach to be developed in the period was human behavioral genetics: the extension of genetic analysis from anatomy and physiology to behavior, which behavioral geneticists treat as a phenotype, or product of gene action. Behavioral geneticists study both “normal” and “abnormal” behavioral phenotypes in order to determine whether they might have either a simple Mendelian or a more complex polygenic component. Some human behavioral geneticists rely on contrasts of the behaviors of twins reared together and apart to help them assign the sources of behavioral differences to nature and nurture. Arthur Jensen’s investigation of race, genes, and IQ employed some of these techniques, as did The Bell Curve. Because behavioral genetics is specialized, technical, and mathematical, it has proved challenging for anthropologists to communicate their criticisms of it to the wider public. Engaging counterarguments can be found in biological anthropologist Jonathan Marks’s thought-provoking books, including What It Means to Be 98% Chimpanzee: Apes, People, and Their Genes (2002), Why I Am Not a Scientist: Anthropology and Modern Knowledge (2009), Tales of the Ex-Apes: How We Think about Human Evolution (2015), and Is Science Racist? (2017). Marks (b. 1955) urges caution in accepting at face value geneticists’ claims to have discovered individual genes, such as “gay” genes, that govern human behavior. He is a formidable foe for anyone making unsupportable assertions about biological determinism in anthropology.

Sociobiology sociobiology An investigation of the biological basis of social behavior using the evolutionary principles of kin selection and inclusive fitness.

Key Words: biology of nepotism, environment of evolutionary adaptedness, evolutionary psychology, inclusive fitness, kin selection, reciprocal altruism, sociobiology, xenophobic The bio-behavioral approach that made the greatest inroads in late-twentiethcentury anthropology was sociobiology. This approach became controversial 142

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

almost immediately after the publication of Edward O. Wilson’s landmark book Sociobiology:The New Synthesis (1975). Wilson (b. 1929) was a Harvard University entomologist who had been working on the evolutionary problem of altruism, or self-sacrificing behaviors, such as sterile worker ants devoting themselves to helping a queen ant reproduce. The problem with altruism was how to explain it in terms of Darwinian evolution by natural selection. If altruistic behavior is genetic, it should be subject to the action of natural selection, but the result of such action should be the reduction or elimination of the genes responsible. Still, altruism persisted. How? Earlier zoologists had proposed the mechanism of group selection, whereby individuals sacrifice themselves for the good of groups and then, as group members, benefit indirectly. This mechanism was never entirely convincing, however, so in the early 1970s a number of geneticists proposed the alternative mechanism of kin selection. This mechanism became the scientific cornerstone of Wilson’s book. Wilson solved the problem of altruism essentially by defining it out of existence. Altruism is not really altruistic; instead, it is “selfish,” as he explained with his new concept of inclusive fitness. According to Wilson, the genetic basis of most behaviors is polygenic, meaning the result of the action of multiple genes. Genetic relatives share these genes, so individuals who sacrifice themselves can still transmit their sacrificing genes to future generations, as long as they sacrifice themselves for relatives. Sociobiology has been called the biology of nepotism, an apt nickname, because sociobiologists predicted that genes incline individuals to behave more favorably to relatives than to non-relatives and more favorably to close relatives than to distant ones. In this way, individuals maximize their inclusive Darwinian fitness and reproductive success. Evolutionary biologist Richard Dawkins (b. 1941) captured many of these ideas in the title of his provocative book The Selfish Gene (1976). More recently, Dawkins has achieved notoriety for his defense of evolution in The Greatest Show on Earth: The Evidence for Evolution (2009) and, especially, for his defense of atheism in The God Delusion (2009). For sociobiology, life is a series of strategic choices in which individuals unconsciously assess the personal costs and benefits of alternative behaviors and end up choosing the alternative with the greatest inclusive yield. Because sociobiologists argued that overall degrees of genetic relatedness can be quantified – parents and children share 50 per cent of their genes, half-siblings 25 per cent, “first” cousins 12.5 per cent, and so forth – they were able to make precise predictions about behavior and then compare them with empirical reality. To explain altruism among non-relatives, sociobiologist Robert Trivers (b. 1943) introduced the supplementary evolutionary mechanism of reciprocal altruism. According to reciprocal altruism, individuals behave altruistically toward non-relatives in the understanding that non-relatives will behave altruistically toward them, a kind of biological Golden Rule. 143

kin selection  In sociobiology, reproductive success via genes shared with relatives; sometimes called the biology of nepotism. inclusive fitness  In sociobiology, the measure, or result, of kin selection. biology of nepotism  A colloquial label for sociobiology focusing on the preferential treatment of kin.

reciprocal altruism In sociobiology, the “biological Golden Rule,” said to account for altruistic behavior among non-relatives.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

xenophobic Pertaining to xenophobia, the fear and dislike of foreigners.

Some of the most controversial pronouncements of sociobiology concerned differences between males and females. Both males and females are motivated to maximize their inclusive fitness but, according to sociobiologists, in fundamentally different ways. In species with two distinct sexes, males produce a large number of mobile sperm and do not themselves bear children, while females produce a small number of non-mobile eggs and do bear children. These biological differences imply the evolution of behavioral differences. Males are selected to compete for females because females are a reproductively relevant resource. The reproductive potential of males depends on the number of females they can inseminate. On the other hand, females are selected to resist male advances because, once inseminated, they cannot become pregnant again until after giving birth. The reproductive potential of females depends on the “quality,” not quantity, of male suitors. By depicting males as sexually indiscriminate and females as “choosy,” sociobiologists exposed themselves to the criticism that they were affirming Western sex-role stereotypes. By proposing that both males and females prefer their “own kind” over “foreigners,” sociobiologists exposed themselves to the further charges that they are racist and xenophobic. The bulk of Wilson’s book focused on insects and other non-human animal species. In the final chapter, however, he speculated on how sociobiology might account for at least some of the behavior of Homo sapiens. Later, he and other sociobiologists refined these speculations and developed a scaled-down, modified version of “human sociobiology.” Human sociobiology, featured in Wilson’s book On Human Nature (1994), provoked a storm of opposition in anthropology, where culture was held to be vastly more important than biology as the determinant of behavioral differences. Cultural anthropologists as otherwise divergent as cultural materialist Marvin Harris, in Cultural Materialism (1979), and structuralist Marshall Sahlins, in The Use and Abuse of Biology (1976), united to criticize human sociobiology as erroneous and irrelevant and to condemn it as an ideology of disguised Social Darwinism. Sahlins went to great lengths to show that the “selfish” and “altruistic” directives embedded in world kinship systems do not accord with those predicted by degrees of biological relatedness. This staunch judgment was the opinion of the majority of cultural anthropologists. At the same time, a small minority came to adopt the sociobiological perspective, notably ethnographer Napoleon Chagnon (1938–2019), who used it to explain the outcome of matings among South American Yanomami Indians. In primatology, sociobiology, in one form or another, became a dominant research strategy. A milestone in this regard was The Langurs of Abu (1977), a book in which primatologist Sarah Blaffer Hrdy (b. 1946) explained how new langur monkey “alpha males” killed the infants of displaced alpha males in order to make the infants’ mothers sexually receptive, and then impregnated the mothers in order to propagate their own genes.

144

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Sociobiology still pervades primatology, frequently identifiable under the more recent rubric of evolutionary psychology. A foundational text for evolutionary psychology was The Adapted Mind: Evolutionary Psychology and the Generation of Culture (1992), edited by anthropologists Jerome Barkow and John Tooby and psychologist Leda Cosmides. In this text, various authors set forth key tenets of the new discipline, which draws on several other disciplines besides sociobiology but which is transparently identifiable in many ways as sociobiology recast in a new vocabulary. According to evolutionary psychologists, the modern human mind comprises domain-specific regions that preserve cognitive adaptations to an earlier Paleolithic way of life, a time dubbed the “environment of evolutionary adaptedness.” These adaptations, spanning kinship, mating, and parenting strategies and an array of other more specific behaviors, such as flight responses and phobias, can be maladaptive, or “misfit,” in contemporary settings. Evolutionary psychologists seek to explain precisely how they are misfit. Evolutionary psychology has become a popular topic of discussion among media pundits and an equally popular target of criticism by public anthropologists. By breathing new life into the nature versus nurture debate, it has mined a mother lode of speculations that can appear intuitive but that are in need of an anthropological reality check.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Why have hereditarian views been so controversial in ­latertwentieth-century anthropology? 2. How would you define the term scientific racism? 3. How should a university professor accused of scientific racism be held accountable for his or her views? 4. If all human beings exhibit the same behavior, is that behavior genetic? 5. How would you go about finding out whether human aggression is genetic? 6. Is it proper to describe animal behavior using human terms such as selfish and altruistic? 7. What kind of moral code could be based on the understanding that human behavior is genetically programmed to be self-interested? 8. Is human sociobiology sexist? 9. What would a Marxist anthropologist think about sociobiology? 10. How does the mind evolve?

145

evolutionary psychology  An outgrowth of sociobiology that uses Charles Darwin’s theory of evolution to explain aspects of human mentality and behavior as adaptations from the past. environment of evolutionary adaptedness A term used by evolutionary psychologists to designate prehistoric settings to which humans adapted their behaviors in ways that can be maladaptive in contemporary settings.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

The Symbolic Turn Key Words: cargo cults, hermeneutics, revitalization movement Paralleling developments in self-consciously nomothetic, materialist, ecological, cognitive, and bio-behavioral anthropology in the latter half of the twentieth century was a new concern: understanding the systematic character of cultural meaning. In Britain, the ascendancy of social analysis rooted in Durkheimian structuralism and structural-functionalism had long since begun to show signs of strain. For many anthropologists, including Leach, Gluckman, and their students, the static nature of structural analysis seemed increasingly a fatal flaw, as did an overall lack of focus on the flexible character of social and cultural meaning and its central role in social and political change cross-culturally. One influential answer derived from a new body of research that came to be called symbolic anthropology. Meanwhile, for a new generation of American anthropologists coming of age in the 1960s in particular, the Boasian-inspired frameworks bequeathed to them by the culture and personality and cognitive schools were inadequate for at least two pivotal reasons. First, they were perceived as being ethnocentrically biased on a number of levels, especially with respect to the supposedly universal importance of the individual psyche; second, because both bodies of theory were in fact quite schematically rigid, neither was sufficiently able to address the increasingly important theoretical problem of social and cultural change. In the United States, this concern surfaced with, among other influences, the rediscovery of the theories of Max Weber, particularly by the theoretical school that would be known as interpretive anthropology. The rediscovery of Max Weber both reflected and stimulated a new concern for the importance of meaning and the human potential to act creatively in the world. While this had arguably been a concern of cultural anthropologists all along, the essential premise of structuralist theory (in its various guises) was that culture constrained, or controlled, people more than it served, or enabled, them. It was as if people were simply the vehicles for social and psychological structures and not the other way around. This dominion of structures was unacceptable to a growing number of anthropologists, and yet, in the United States, the “obvious” second option – historical particularism in the Boasian tradition – remained equally unpalatable, mainly for its narrowness of focus and its relative lack of theory. An emerging consensus was that ways had to be found to explain society and culture without appealing to minutely controlling social structures or to inaccessible psychological ones. In the 1960s and 1970s, this fresh interest in exploring meaning was expressed in the language of symbols and interpretation. One of the earliest to adapt Weber’s thought to explicitly anthropological analysis was Anthony F.C.Wallace (1923–2015). In his influential historical ethnography 146

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

about the Iroquois, The Death and Rebirth of the Seneca (1972), Wallace applied his concept of the revitalization movement, which was more fully formulated in his theoretical revitalization work Religion: An Anthropological View (1966). In both, the author drew heavily on Weber’s idea that during periods of cultural dissonance or crisis, it is the charismatic prophet who rationalizes a new and more satisfying religious worldview for the members of a society. A second now-classic Weberian study was The Trumpet Shall Sound (1968) by Peter Worsley (1924–2013), which describes how many Indigenous peoples of Indonesia and New Guinea are led by a variety of charismatic prophets in a series of millennial “cargo cults.” Worsley’s and Wallace’s studies were strikingly similar in that both sociocultural contexts examined were ones in which colonial powers placed severe economic, political, and cultural stress on the colonized, generating a “breakdown” in the indigenous social order. In both settings, the revitalizing social movements rationalized the impact of colonialism into worldviews that stipulated the omnipotence of a supernatural power or agent who would ultimately restore harmony and happiness if specific ethical and behavioral criteria were adhered to. Wallace’s and Worsley’s analyses highlighted the socially transformative potential of human agency. They incorporated Weber’s synthesis of materialism and idealism, which to some anthropologists seemed more useful than Marx’s theory, often viewed as reducing culture to a reflex of material conditions. This particular Weberian theme became conspicuous in the writings of later postmodern anthropologists, for whom cultural hermeneutics and relations of political and economic power loomed large. In addition, the roots of what came to be called symbolic anthropology in Britain and interpretive anthropology in the United States can be traced back, at least indirectly, to the neo-Kantian philosophy of Wilhelm Dilthey and others, who helped formulate the distinction between the natural sciences, or Naturwissenschaften, and social sciences, or Geisteswissenschaften. According to this distinction, promulgated by Franz Boas, the natural sciences deal with entities amenable to generalizations, while the social sciences deal with “mental” entities unique to individuals and groups. To this distinction phenomenologist-­ philosopher Edmund Husserl (1854–1938) added the observation that natural science is unsuitable for the study of cultural life because cultural life has meaning, which is best understood subjectively as “lived experience.” Husserl’s assertions notwithstanding, it would, finally, be difficult to argue that symbolic and interpretive anthropologists were inspired by anything less than a desire to do sound empirical research in the best anthropological tradition. What differentiated symbolic and interpretive anthropologists from their colleagues working in explicitly materialist or ecological traditions was their relentless insistence that human societies are distinctive because of their capacity for culture and that social and cultural life is held together by interpenetrating networks of symbols, each of which is a carrier of cultural meaning. This much, at least, the 147

revitalization movement A term coined by Anthony F.C. Wallace to describe the spontaneous evolution of culture that occurs when communities experience conditions of extreme social and economic duress or marginalization. cargo cults Melanesian religious revitalization movements that anticipate and celebrate the future return of material affluence.

hermeneutics The study of meaning, especially in literary texts, applied by interpretive and postmodern anthropologists to the study of culture.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

symbolists and interpretivists had in common. In spite of this underlying similarity, it must be kept in mind that even from the outset, clear differences existed between the two schools, and that these differences both derived from, and had a deep impact on, the respective characters of British and American research.

Victor Turner and Symbolic Anthropology Key Words: anti-structure, communitas, dominant symbol, instrumental symbols, liminal, multivocal, ritual process, symbolic anthropology

symbolic anthropology  The anthropological school, associated with Victor Turner, espousing the view that social solidarity is a function of the systems of symbolic logic that connect people.

In Britain, the most influential and academically respected symbolic anthropologist was Victor Turner (1920–83). Turner was born in Glasgow, Scotland, and developed an early interest in poetry and classics. After serving in World War II, he turned his attention to anthropology. A student of Max Gluckman,Turner was, like most British anthropologists of his generation, heavily influenced by Émile Durkheim’s dictum that social cohesion was achieved “organically” through the interpenetration of a given society’s component parts. Like Gluckman, Turner was concerned with exposing the political character of social relations, with the general goal of accounting for social coherence even in contexts where many interpersonal conflicts seemingly threatened to tear a community apart. Fieldwork among the Ndembu of Northern Rhodesia (now Zambia) convinced him of the centrality of ritual, in particular, to the maintenance of social order. This insight garnered the young anthropologist much respect when his findings were published in one of the most important monographs of late structural-functionalism, Schism and Continuity in an African Society (1957). Turner’s early perspective on the importance of ritual informed much of his later work and shaped the direction of his theoretical interests. Throughout the 1960s, he continued to move still further away from the previous generation of structural-functionalists, for many members of which the essence of organic solidarity lay in the concrete institutions and formalized relations of society. Instead, Turner focused on the Durkheimian idea that social solidarity is a function of the systems of symbolic logic that connect people. In this way, his symbolic anthropology had much in common with Lévi-Strauss’s structuralism, similarly inspired by Durkheim. Unlike his French peers (indeed, unlike Durkheim himself), for whom symbolic contrasts and correspondences were seen as a universal mental template on which all culture is built, Turner’s main innovations in anthropology derived from his view that social unity is basically problematic and should not be taken for granted. Whereas Durkheim believed that primitive humankind came together out of some primordial psychological need for togetherness,Turner argued that people are essentially forced to repeatedly construct social life against those forces in the natural world that constantly threaten to destroy it. Because 148

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

X

you are here FIGURE 3.4  Liminality: This drawing illustrates Victor Turner’s sense of the term as “betwixt and between.”

symbols are the primary vehicles whereby this solidarity is organized, they are instruments, or “tools,” employed by people to achieve a particular end – the reproduction of social order. Again drawing on his work among the Ndembu, Turner explored ways in which various objects and actions of ritual are deployed as complex instrumental symbols that are the “means to the ends” of any given ritual, such as rootlets from fruit-bearing trees wielded in the context of ritual with the explicit purpose of enhancing female fertility. At a broader level, another set of symbols, which Turner dubbed “dominant,” possessed a role that he considered to be both multivocal and ubiquitous, being present in any number of ritual events and being used for a variety of meanings, some of which might represent conflicting interests in the Ndembu community. Among the many examples Turner explored ethnographically, one that is frequently cited concerns the Ndembu mudyi tree, a dominant symbol par excellence.Turner viewed the mudyi tree, which contains a white latex, as the equivalent of a national flag among the Ndembu – a symbol that might, depending on the ritual context, evoke milk, the kin bonds between mothers and children, and the continuity of Ndembu kinship from one generation to the next. Less harmoniously, Turner deciphered the Nkang’a, or girl’s puberty ritual, to be an occasion in which Ndembu women’s mobilization about the mudyi tree symbolized the opposition of females to males, thus revealing the conflicted, rather than consensual, character of the Ndembu social order. For Turner, this was evidence that Ndembu social integration and coherence had to be forcibly maintained in light 149

instrumental symbols  Victor Turner’s term for those symbols that can be consciously wielded in ritual as a form of technology in order to achieve particular ends. multivocal The quality of having more than one possible meaning or interpretation. dominant symbol Victor Turner’s term for a symbol with multiple, and sometimes contradictory, meanings.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

ritual process Arnold van Gennep’s term for the tripartite nature of ritual, involving separation from society, transition to a new social status, and a new incorporation into society.

liminal An ephemeral psychosocial space in which social arrangements are subject to transformation, inversion, and affirmation. anti-structure  According to Victor Turner, the side of culture expressed through ritual “chaos,” as during liminal states.

communitas A term employed by Victor Turner to refer to the ritual fusion of individuals into a collective identity.

of these and other self-destructive tendencies. He argued that symbolism was the key to understanding this process, because of the dominant symbol’s capacity to “stand for unity and continuity in the widest Ndembu society, embracing its contradictions.” Much of Turner’s theoretical exposition of symbols and symbolic performance was published in a widely read collection of ethnographic essays, The Forest of Symbols (1967). Beyond this extension of Durkheimian theory, Turner is also credited with breathing fresh life into the ideas of Arnold van Gennep (1873–1957), who, much earlier in the twentieth century, had speculated about the “ritual process.” In his work The Rites of Passage (1959), van Gennep argued that ritual involves the passage of individuals from one social state to another and that this entailed three stages: “separation” from the group, “transition” to a new state, and “incorporation” (more properly thought of as “re-incorporation”) within the social order. Intrigued by his predecessor’s insights, Turner elaborated his still largely Durkheimian concept of ritual, in which the coming together of individuals involves the performance of solidarity, to include a theory of process modeled largely on van Gennep’s concept of “liminality.” Turner believed that rituals generate a liminal period in which all notions of social “structure” are undone through the physical and symbolic separation of certain individuals from society. In being marked, or set apart, as special, these individuals cease for a period of time to occupy a certain position within the social order and, in effect, are for that period considered both “outside” society and in some cases even a danger to it. This temporary negation of social structure Turner named “anti-structure.” In many instances, anti-structure and liminality might be observed with respect to particular individuals undergoing transitional “rites” in which they pass from one life stage to another. Examples of such events might include coronation ceremonies, death rituals, or the ubiquitous rites of transition from boyhood to manhood and girlhood to womanhood. On a larger scale, anti-structure is more familiar to many in, for instance, the guise of carnival: an event at which the ritualized chaos of anti-structure involves inverting “normal” identities and roles, so that men are ritually transformed into women and women into men, kings into servants and servants into kings, old into young and young into old, and so on. Anti-structure is possible, Turner argued, because the liminal state is one in which all the limitations of everyday structure are dispensed with and new creative possibilities opened up. A central aspect of this theory is that, throughout all inversion and liminal transformation of norms and identities, members of a society ultimately come to recognize and reaffirm the basic structural cohesion that they had known all along in their routine existence outside of ritual. It is by way of this newfound solidarity, or reintegration, that society avoids the truly revolutionary implications of liminality and is instead fused by what Turner called communitas – an increased awareness of the social order, reminiscent of Durkheim’s idea that rituals are emotionally effervescent events. 150

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Clifford Geertz and Interpretive Anthropology Key Words: interpretive anthropology, semiotic, text, thick description In the United States, meanwhile, a new generation of avowedly cultural anthropologists was busily developing its own semiotic, or cognition-focused, perspective, which also depended on the social circulation and ritual performance of symbols. The two central players in this evolving Americanist approach were David Schneider (1918–95) and, especially, the founder of interpretive anthropology, Clifford Geertz (1926–2006). Geertz studied philosophy as an undergraduate at Antioch College and then, following military service in World War II, enrolled as a graduate student in the Department of Social Relations at Harvard. This celebrated interdisciplinary department, established in 1946, brought together sociologists, anthropologists, and psychologists with interlocking theoretical interests. Its founding chair and leading light was the highly influential American sociologist Talcott Parsons (1902–79). While studying in Germany, Parsons had become engaged with the ideas of Max Weber as expressed in The Protestant Ethic and the Spirit of Capitalism. What attracted Parsons to Weber was his blending of agency and structure into a grand theoretical framework for analyzing societies. During his long career, Parsons parlayed this framework into an elaborate set of theories of his own, most notably in The Structure of Social Action (1937) and Toward a General Theory of Action (1951). By action, Parsons meant voluntary social interaction, which, he asserted, could be understood only by taking individual motivations and goals into account. At the same time, these motivations and goals were overwhelmingly shaped by social circumstances. By introducing individual action, or Weberian agency, into an otherwise traditional structural-functional framework, Parsons opened the door for his followers to develop and expand the interpretive approach. At Harvard, Geertz studied under Parsons, with whom he became friends, and also under Boasian anthropologist Clyde Kluckhohn. After graduation, he held various academic appointments before joining the Institute for Advanced Studies at Princeton, the institution with which he was most closely associated. Whereas Turner derived his core thoughts from Durkheim, Geertz’s intellectual lineage originates, in part through Parsons, with Weber, whose emphasis on meaning, as opposed to structure, gave Geertz’s work a very different orientation from that of his British counterpart. Taking his cue from Kluckhohn, Geertz incorporated into this theory the idea that at the core of culture is a set of integrated moral values that preserves the correspondence of the world “as it is” with the world “as it should be.” More specifically, this prototypical interpretive anthropologist set out to show how lived experience is integrated into a coherent public system of symbols that both renders the world intelligible and seems uniquely suited to do so. For Geertz, this epistemology was deeply grounded in the assumption that “man is an animal suspended 151

semiotic Pertaining to the relationship between symbols and what they represent. interpretive anthropology The anthropological school, associated with Clifford Geertz, espousing the view that culture is lived experience integrated into a coherent, public system of symbols that renders the world intelligible.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.5  Turtles All the Way Down: As recounted by Clifford Geertz (1926–2006), a story goes like this: “There is an Indian story … about an Englishman who, having been told that the world rested on a platform which rested on the back of an elephant which in turn rested on the back of a turtle, asked … what did the turtle rest on? Another turtle? And that turtle?”   “Ah, Sahib, after that it is turtles all the way down.” Copyright © Shutterstock.com.

thick description  In the interpretive anthropology of Clifford Geertz, the process of interpreting culture as text. text In the interpretive anthropology of Clifford Geertz, the equivalent of culture, interpreted through a process of thick description.

in webs of significance that he himself has spun” and that the study of culture is not, therefore, an “experimental science in search of law” but rather an “interpretive one in search of meaning.” The meaning Geertz set about describing in his prolific career is not locked inside the discrete psychologies of individuals, however, but in a network of meaningful signifiers (that is, symbols) on public display. In his enormously influential book The Interpretation of Cultures (1973), Geertz set out his own vision of the ethnographic method, the centerpiece of which was a research technique called “thick description.” Geertz prescribed this method as the most effective tool in the ethnographer’s tool kit for teasing out the “text” of culture, that is, the fine details of human life that make behavior intelligible. “Doing ethnography,” he wrote, was like “trying to read … a manuscript.” Geertz held this method to be particularly effective in unraveling the various layers, or “webs,” of meaning performed by participants in ritual. 152

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

In a famous example that formed the focus of one of the best-known essays in The Interpretation of Cultures, Geertz analyzed the “Balinese cockfight” from an interpretive perspective. The significance of the event, he argued, was in its power to convey multiple messages about the cultural “ethos” in which participants lived – a social environment characterized by status competition between individuals sorted into hierarchical, gendered rankings. Tongue deeply in cheek, Geertz offered that men of locally high rank competed with one another by proxy through their “cocks” (i.e., roosters), which fought to the death in primal blood-sport. He hypothesized that when such rivalry occurred between individuals of near or equal ranking, the performative force of the ritual could be said to be emotionally “deep” for onlookers; that is, such rituals were of great social force in imparting a sense of the meaning of social relations. For Geertz, such relations constituted an important theme of the Balinese social order, which, because they lurked just below the level of awareness, had to be symbolically performed in order to have public force. In sum, the cockfight was a symbolic microcosm, or text, of Balinese society, collectively shared by all witnesses to the event. The ritual was, in short, a “story they [the Balinese] tell themselves about themselves.” In the twenty-first century, following the rise of postmodernism, interpretive anthropology seems increasingly anachronistic. Nevertheless, Geertz remains iconic among American anthropologists and is still revered by many for infusing the discipline with a heavy dose of much-needed Weberian corrective to earlier ethnocentric approaches. A prolific writer, Geertz also remains highly respected for his extensive fieldwork in, and ethnographic portraits of, Java, Bali, and Morocco. In short, he was probably the single most influential American anthropologist of the late twentieth century.

Post-Processual Archaeology Key Words: contextual archaeology, critical anthropologists, interpretive archaeology, landscape archaeology, post-processual archaeology In the subdiscipline of anthropological archaeology, the interpretive perspective was to find favor as well, especially among those disenchanted with the “excesses” of Lewis Binford’s avowedly scientific approach to archaeology. Many archaeologists had been uncomfortable with the so-called New Archaeology and its adherence to key canons of Cartesian rationalism and objectivity. For them, archaeology was allied to history more closely than to science, and, because history was a humanity, the holistic explanations of Boasian particularism seemed more appropriate than the covering-law model and “economic determinism” of Binford. Some of these archaeologists embraced the viewpoint of critical anthropologists that science 153

critical anthropologists  Anthropologists who self-reflect and share criticisms of positivism.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.6  Formal Gardens at Castle Bromwich Hall, West Midlands, England: A “contextual” interpretation of this eighteenth-century archaeological site is that formal gardens make “statements” about socially accessible and inaccessible space.

interpretive archaeology Another name for contextual, or post-processual, archaeology, reflecting its origins in Geertzian interpretive anthropology. contextual archaeology Another name for postprocessual archaeology critical of the nomothetic New Archaeology. post-processual archaeology  Postmodern-era archaeology critical of the New Archaeology; also called contextual archaeology. landscape archaeology  Archaeology that considers artifacts and features to be expressions of culture, both incorporating and modifying elements of the natural world.

From Meaningful Architecture: Social Interpretations of Buildings. London: Ashgate Publishing. Copyright © 1994 by Martin Locock. Reprinted by permission of Martin Locock.

is elitist and those of French structuralists and structural Marxists that material culture has a symbolic dimension, consciousness causes change, and artifacts reflect social relations as well as adaptation to environments. In the 1980s, British archaeologist Ian Hodder (b. 1948) codified these views into what came to be called interpretive, contextual, or “post-processual” archaeology. This new perspective spread with the publication of Hodder’s several influential books, notably Symbolism in Action: Ethnoarchaeological Studies of Material Culture (1982) and Reading the Past: Current Approaches to Interpretation in Archaeology (1986). Echoing the influential French historian Michel Foucault, “contextual” refers to Hodder’s view that artifacts are embedded in a web of cultural “discourse” that affirms social relations and enhances the power of privileged groups. “Post-processual” referred to his view that the quest to discover law-like processes of culture change, characteristic of the New Archaeology, should be abandoned. Believing that archaeological interpretation is subjective, Hodder has held archaeologists accountable for scrutinizing their own biases. More recently, in his book Where Are We Heading?: The Evolution of Humans and Things (2018), he has reflected on the entanglement that people created with material culture, drawing important inferences for the future of the Earth. A latter-day version of post-­processual archaeology is landscape archaeology, 154

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

in which the spatial distribution of artifacts and features is rendered a cultural landscape that both incorporates and modifies meaningful elements of nature. Like symbolists and postmodernists in anthropology, post-processualists in archaeology largely abandoned purely positivist scientific objectivity as an unattainable and undesirable theoretical goal. In so doing, they unsettled the profession and helped pave the way for a new wave of culturally sensitive critiques. Resulting from this development have been new and imaginative ways of integrating archaeology within cultural anthropology and of integrating non-traditional voices, including female and Indigenous voices, into archaeology itself.

The Influence of Symbolic and Interpretive Approaches From the 1960s into the 1980s, symbolic and interpretive approaches both expressed and nurtured a growing apprehension within the discipline – namely, that those claims to authoritative knowledge that anthropologists had previously taken for granted were at best tenuous – at least in the cynical environment of the late-twentieth-century academy. It is, therefore, ironic that the same cynicism that cultivated the particularistic, neo-Kantian tendencies in that period also gave rise in the mid-1970s to political economy, a perspective that opposes symbolic and interpretive anthropology in its renewed emphasis on history and objectivity. This was not to be the “old” structuralism of classical British and French approaches but a new body of thought heavily inspired by the historicism of Marx and Engels. Cultures, the new anthropological political economists argued, were not local and internally undifferentiated. Rather, they were translocal phenomena, shaped and directed by unequal access to power and material resources. The central problem with symbolic approaches was not that they laid such emphasis on meaning but that their claims to be doing away with the notion of “structure” were spurious. In fact, anthropological political economists insisted, they were busily constructing a new structural orthodoxy in which individual agency still had no real place and in which social change could not really be accommodated. Whereas both symbolic and interpretive perspectives were essentially Cartesian, at least to the extent that they continued to assume a theoretical distinction between the observer and the observed, the postmodern “turn” of the 1980s and 1990s sought to do away even with this distinction. Nevertheless, a reasonable argument can be made that the postmodern paradigm so popular with a recent generation of anthropologists has its most immediate anthropological antecedent in those analyses of symbols and meaning pioneered by Turner, Geertz, and Hodder. 155

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Symbolic and interpretive anthropology represented a new, or renewed, interest in cultural meaning. In this context, what does the term meaning mean? 2. How is Max Weber’s concept of theodicy potentially useful in the analysis of revitalization movements? 3. In Victor Turner’s sense of the term, is the quadrennial presidential election a dominant symbol for the United States? 4. According to Turner, why is anti-structure necessary? 5. In social rituals and rites of passage, could liminality be dangerous? 6. In the interpretive anthropology of Clifford Geertz, who gets to decide whose interpretation of a culture is correct? 7. According to Geertz, why is it better for descriptions of culture to be thick rather than thin? 8. If you could give post-processual archaeology another name, what would it be? 9. What does it mean to label an anthropological theory “Cartesian”? 10. In their heyday, did symbolic and interpretive anthropology constitute a new paradigm in anthropological theory?

Transactionalism Key Words: symbolic interactionism, transactionalism

symbolic interactionism  A sociological theory, associated with Talcott Parsons, that focuses on the decisionmaking strategies of individuals in social situations; similar to transactionalism. transactionalism The anthropological theory of Fredrik Barth that focuses on the decisionmaking and economicmaximizing strategies of individuals; similar to symbolic interactionism.

The transactionalist perspective within anthropology represented an attempt to overcome the limitations of traditional structural-functionalism by revisiting the notion of the individual as the basic unit of social life, a notion that had featured prominently in the work of Malinowski but that was largely eclipsed by RadcliffeBrown’s vision of Durkheimian social structure. Also frequently referred to as “methodological individualism,” it shared much common ground with symbolic interactionism, a counterpart school in sociology established by Talcott Parsons. Transactionalism was characterized by a sharp focus on the decision-making strategies adopted by individuals living in particular political “arenas.” The perspective enjoyed a degree of success between the late 1950s and 1970s, largely as a result of the influence of Norwegian anthropologist Fredrik Barth. Other important figures within the transactionalist school included British anthropologist George Bailey (b. 1924) and British-Canadian anthropologist Robert Paine (1926–2010). 156

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Fredrik Barth A one-time student of Raymond Firth and Edmund Leach, and for more than two decades holding academic appointments in the United States, Fredrik Barth (1928–2016) was widely respected for his fieldwork conducted in Pakistan, which produced the influential ethnography Political Leadership among Swat Pathans (1959). Barth’s best-known theoretical exposition, and the one in which the key tenets of transactionalism are discussed in the greatest detail, is Models of Social Organization (1966). Reflecting the thought of philosopher Karl Popper (1902–94), who considered the individual social agent or actor the “linchpin” in the creation and maintenance of social relationships, a Barthian perspective holds that social life is, at base, a complex series of economic transactions between individual social actors, all of whom share the same goal of maximizing their interests or gain through the strategic choices they make. In this view, structured systems of norms and values are created and sustained through the economic interests of individuals. For this reason, social structure should be considered for its emergent rather than fixed nature. Social relationships are “generated,” sustained, and changed as a result of the economic choices made by individuals, each of whom has learned to play and manipulate the “rules” of a social “game.” Perhaps the most important implication of this line of reasoning is that individuals, rather than social systems or cultures, should be looked to as the engines of social continuity and change. Among the Swat Pathans, for instance, Barth argued that the social structure was subject to manipulation by leaders and clients, each of whom worked to realize their own self-interest. Like those political-, conflict-, and urban-oriented approaches championed by Gluckman and, later, by anthropological political economists, transactional theory proved especially appealing for its apparent transcendence of a key dilemma posed by structural-functional analysis: that individuals are caught in and defined by the social and cultural structures in which they are, in a sense, “imprisoned.” Where, in this form of analysis, was room to be found for social and cultural change? Certainly by the 1950s, many British social anthropologists were searching for ways to move beyond what were increasingly seen as, at best, the partial truths of classical Radcliffe-Brownian structural-functionalism. While transactionalism seemed for a time to hold out the promise of a new paradigm for social relations, practitioners of this form of analysis have also been taken to task for assuming, rather than providing evidence for, the rational, economically driven character of human social activity. Several questions were frequently raised. First, was the nature of social and cultural structure really determined by the calculating, voluntary, decision-making processes of individuals? And, second, were these notions about the rational and the cognitive not themselves Western in origin? Furthermore, in light of the historical conditions and regimes in and under which different peoples have lived and died, were individuals really always “free” to make choices that maximized their social or economic gain? 157

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Calling these latent assumptions of transactionalism into doubt meant that, in spite of its laudable attempts to draw concern for the individual into orthodox British structural-functionalism, Barthian theory was ironically subject to much of the same criticism as other forms of structural anthropology – namely, that the individuals of transactional analysis were hardly more creative than those of structural-functionalism because the theory depended on a particularly narrow, prepolitical, overly rational, unhistorical perspective of how individuals act vis-àvis one another. Nevertheless, the preoccupation of the transactionalist approach with the individual cultural agent deepened the concern for understanding social and cultural change within anthropology and in so doing hastened an emerging crisis over the nature of social integration and structure.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How does Fredrik Barth’s concept of methodological individualism differ from anthropological approaches that emphasize symbolic or materialist understandings of social life? 2. What do sociobiology and transactionalism have in common?

Anthropology and Feminism Key Words: androcentrism, anthropological feminism, bio-logic, body-reasoning, feminist anthropology, gender, patriarchy feminist anthropology  The view that perspectives and values associated with gender, and in particular those that inform ideas about “women” as a global category different from “men,” must be incorporated into anthropological reasoning and writing. anthropological feminism A term generally used synonymously with feminist anthropology.

The rise of a self-consciously feminist anthropology, or, for some, anthropological feminism, can be attributed to the advent of new, progressive, or “radicalized” political and social agendas in the 1960s and 1970s, both in and outside academia, and to the disciplinary introspection that had begun to plague (or liberate, depending on one’s point of view) anthropology entering the final decades of the twentieth century. As the qualifying adjective suggests, feminist anthropologists have argued that a more powerful and inclusive understanding of society and culture can be achieved only by studying the cultural representations and experiences of, and practices associated with, women. From the outset, this emerging body of theory and research was intended to bear little resemblance to previous generations of structuralism and structuralfunctionalism. The goals of an efflorescing “anthropology of women” were to be emancipatory: feminist anthropology was unabashedly partisan, in that 158

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

practitioners actively sought redress for imbalances created and sustained by an unjust social order – at home and abroad – that accorded men and women different status and privilege. Much of the inspiration for this movement can be attributed to new ways of thinking about gender, gender roles, and gender identity in the field of psychology. By the late 1960s, a consensus was taking shape that while sex was biological in origin, gender (which in earlier Anglo-American English had related mostly to grammar) was to be understood as a social and psychological construct – an assertion that conflicted with received ideas about biology as a deterministic foundation for reifying the male and the female. Still, the emerging distinction between sex-as-biology and gender-as-culture (that is, the outcome of fluid and socially mediated processes of agency and meaning) made possible anthropological exploration of both the cross-cultural variability of gender constructions and the various inequities, stratifications, and exclusions of women at home. To these ends, a distinctive feature of early feminist scholarship in anthropology was that it attempted to expose the sins of a discipline scarred by a legacy of androcentrism with respect to both the identity and the interests of its core practitioners. At issue was a troubling fact of much ethnographic research: notwithstanding important contributions made by Margaret Mead, Ruth Benedict, and many others to advancing a women-oriented perspective (just how many women have been marginalized by a conventional anthropological canon will be apparent below), it was clear that most fieldwork and writing in American, French, and British anthropology had to that point been conducted by Western men, who undoubtedly brought with them to their various fieldsites all the gender biases and assumptions inherent in their own societies. In practical terms, one consequence was that these male ethnographers were far more likely to have access to male-dominated institutions and practices than they were to those associated with women, a fact that almost inevitably skewed their research focus and emphasis in favor of such cultural institutions as war, politics, economics, and religion. This focus and emphasis, feminist anthropologists argued, had formed a nucleus of research priorities to the exclusion of child-rearing, domestic life, and other spheres of social and cultural life dominated by women in many non-Western societies. In such works as Michelle Rosaldo and Louise Lamphere’s Women, Culture, and Society (1974) and Rayna Reiter’s Toward an Anthropology of Women (1975), feminist anthropologists wondered aloud how a holistic and inclusive anthropological perspective could be hoped for under these conditions. The most widespread solution advanced during the 1960s and 1970s bore a resemblance to the salvage ethnography of decades past, in that a new generation of feminist researchers (the overwhelming majority of whom were female) was encouraged to investigate those women-centered practices and institutions that had until that time been neglected by their male counterparts. In so doing, they hoped that their efforts would redress what they considered to be a gross 159

gender The various social roles and identities assigned to individuals and groups on the basis of their biological sex.

androcentrism A deeply held and culturally conditioned bias that views males as inherently intellectually, spiritually, morally, and physically superior to females.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

patriarchy A social group governed exclusively by a male or groups of males.

imbalance in research foci. However sanguine, this ambition to “level the playing field” between the anthropological study of men and women, so eagerly embraced by a first generation of feminist thinkers, seems in hindsight rather awkward or even naïve. One effect of the postmodern turn of the 1980s was to cast doubt on the possibility of objective renderings of all social categories – including those implied by the terms “men” and “women.” As the field developed, a universal application of the thesis that women were everywhere subordinate to men was coming under increasing criticism from feminists in the non-Euro-American world, for whom such assumptions both sidestepped the issue of very real differences between women of different ethnic and socio-economic background and obscured the fact that relations between men and women in the non-Western world could be (and often were) very different from those assumed by Western feminists, with their largely unquestioned ideas about global patriarchy and the subordination of women to men. At a broader level, another important product of the disciplinary introspection that took anthropology by storm in the 1980s was a willingness, even eagerness, to examine with new eyes the guiding premises of anthropology. Although this was universally hailed as a significant development within the discipline, at least some were uncomfortable with the easy assimilation of a new branch of scholarship within the accepted canon. Marilyn Strathern (b. 1941), for instance, has written of her dismay at recognizing feminism as subject to a tendency within sociocultural anthropology to fetishize eclecticism while simultaneously rejecting it. That is, while by the 1980s the normative state of anthropological science involved trumpeting diversity and relativism as key virtues of anthropology, a significant irony of this truism was that this same concern for diversity was subject to an underlying drive toward integration. As new perspectives emerged, those deemed to be of enduring value by some segment of the scholarly community were grafted to the existing corpus of theory, igniting it like so many neglected campfires, individually insignificant but merging under the right conditions in conflagration. Indeed, this assumption continues to prevail in introductory texts that wed, however imperfectly, four internally diverse subfields into a “functioning” machine or organism. For Strathern, it has been important to draw a sharp distinction between what feminism can contribute and has contributed to the anthropological body – a splinter field that has been dubbed “feminist anthropology” – and a critical and provocative area of scholarship she refers to as “anthropological feminism.” Contrasting a watered-down feminism/anthropology hybrid, anthropological feminism preserves its autonomy and refusal to be obscured through absorption. That this has occurred constitutes nothing less, in her view, than violence done to the integrity of feminism’s core ethic: a commitment to viewing social life as riven with hierarchical relations of domination and inequity. In this way, the vision of smooth integration and holism, although doubtless comforting and encouraging for the many champions of a unified anthropology, seems almost utopian. 160

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Strathern’s perspective has to varying degrees been shared by many anthropologists working within a feminist perspective. Oyèrónké Oyewùmí (b. 1957), for instance, examines sex and gender in Yoruban society from a postcolonial perspective, one that refuses to accept the “ground rules” of Western scholarship in which the social world reflects underlying biological realities. In her analysis, this form of determinism, “bio-logic” or “body-reasoning” as she calls it (an elaboration of ideas pioneered by Michel Foucault, whose work will be discussed below), distorts the capacity of native Africans to produce and manage categories of knowledge that diverge from what is taken for granted in colonially imposed and, by definition, universalizing scientific discourse. This privileging of biology impairs the development of a more sophisticated, nuanced feminist anthropology insofar as the physical body and the social meanings accruing to it have been collapsed. By way of example, she points to the non-existence of gender as a category of social distinction in pre-colonial Yoruban society. Instead of social rank tied to anatomical features, she argues that Yoruban hierarchy is based on “a different kind of map”: seniority as a function of relative age. Even more problematic for bio-centric science is the fluidity with which hierarchy appears to have been managed in pre-colonial Africa. Social statuses are not fixed or immutable, as is assumed in bio-logic, but flexible and situational, permitting those constructed as fundamentally “different” to be fundamentally “the same” if warranted by a given situation or context. In this case, there is no need for conditional identification, such as that made in Anglo-American society when occupational categories are qualified according to gender, as in “female soldier” and “male nurse.” Oyewùmí’s study, published in the 1990s, points to another critical insight of 1980s anthropology – one that has enduring value for postmodern and post-­ structural theorists: that gender identities are not natural phenomena to be assumed a priori but rather are highly variable and fluid social processes to be observed in use and context. For the purposes of cross-cultural analysis, in the 1980s it was argued persuasively that anthropologists should be careful to draw a distinction between sex and gender. Sex, it was observed, refers solely to empirically verifiable, universal, biological differences between males and females. In contrast, and as ethnographic research continued to confirm, gender is always and everywhere the product of distinctive cultural and historical contexts. Although these terms have frequently been conflated in the history of Western society (and elsewhere), resulting in the development of many unquestioned assumptions about the “natural” characters and propensities of men and women, a point of consensus among postmodern feminists (and among the majority of anthropologists who accept their insights) has been that the vast majority of allegedly fundamental differences between males and females – and all that such differences mean for gendered identity, behavior, division of labor, and ideas about nature – are in fact culturally mediated representations that are highly variable across societies. 161

bio-logic A term used to describe a foundational assumption of biological determinism that underlies Western scientific reasoning about sex and gender. body-reasoning A term describing the Western scientific assumption that the human body is a universal foundation for objective knowledge concerning social and sexual identity.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Reflecting the now-universal agreement that there are no biologically binding characteristics, roles, or practices that set human males apart from human females, most would agree that a comparative anthropology should vigorously engage the many cultural processes informing the social organization of ideas and practices involved in the making of women and men. Still, there is of course more to this largely “presentist” snapshot than meets the eye – at least when considered on the broad canvas of history as a professional field. In a thought-provoking essay that evaluates the traditional canon and finds it wanting, Louise Lamphere (b. 1940) discusses the various ways in which women and peoples of color have been rendered invisible – even within a field that since Boas has presented itself as attentive to matters of occlusion and discrimination. Taking textbooks such an earlier edition of this one to task, Lamphere argues forcefully for a reappraisal of the work of many lesser-known figures who, because they were not part of a largely white, male anthropological establishment, generally labored in obscurity on the margins of the discipline. In many cases, she argues, figures such as Elsie Clews Parsons (1875–1941), Anita Newcomb McGee (1864–1940), and even the redoubtable Margaret Mead stood in the shadows of better-known mentors and peers who, because they were white men, earned accolades for professional accomplishment even when their contributions were, in hindsight, of inferior quality and/or quantity. In some cases, such as the two most famous women anthropologists in the US tradition, Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict, women anthropologists are known today largely for their pioneering of one or another theoretical perspective or school (psychological anthropology or national character studies, for instance, as discussed above). In truth their contributions were far deeper and broader – touching, as did Benedict’s writing, on critical approaches to race and sexuality that in many ways prefigured current interest in publicly relevant approaches to anthropological practice (of which more in Part Four). While Lamphere’s essay is wide ranging, we include two examples here from the anthropological past to illustrate her argument. A scion of privilege, Elsie Clews Parsons was in no need of an academic career to make a living. Still, her work – a “psychological approach to culture [that] highlighted the interplay between social constraint and individual psychology” – took shape alongside that of her friend and peer, Alfred Louis Kroeber. An innovative writer who developed a rich autoethnography of New York’s white upper-classes in cross-cultural comparison, she also penned a variety of dialogically oriented articles that looked at the role(s) of women in Pueblo culture. In a prescient move, her blending of writing styles, genres, and voices was ahead of its time and foreshadowed developments to come in the 1980s postmodern critique of ethnographic representation. By rights, Lamphere suggests, Parsons should be better known (even much better known – at least as well known as Kroeber, in the view of many) for her anticipation of collaborative ethnography and textuality. Sadly, her general erasure from the canon-as-known is evidence of a field in sharp need of corrective strategies 162

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

FIGURE 3.7  American Anthropological Association (AAA) Presidents: (clockwise) Margaret Clark (1982), Yolanda Moses (1995–7), Louise Lamphere (1999–2001), and Virginia Dominguez (2009–11). Since the 1980s, the number of AAA presidents who are women has increased, but women have not yet achieved overall parity with men. “Margaret Clark,” “Yolanda Moses,” “Virginia Dominguez”: Reproduced by permission of the American Anthropological Association. Not for sale or further reproduction. “Louise Lamphere”: Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

163

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

to recuperate such women and their work from obscurity (there is perhaps no greater example of this than Zora Neale Hurston, whose work is both presented above and discussed in our Conclusion). Lamphere also provides a more personal example in the figure of Michelle Rosaldo (1944–81), who is almost certainly better known generally (if unjustly so) for her tragic, accidental death while conducting fieldwork among the Ilongot of the Philippines. Like Parsons, Rosaldo stood alongside a male anthropologist, her husband and ethnographic collaborator, Renato Rosaldo (b. 1941). Of Michelle Rosaldo, with whom she collaborated in editing a seminal text of feminist anthropology, Lamphere writes that she had deep insight into gender asymmetries, the structural constraints and frictions associated with child-rearing cross-culturally (and how this affected both women and men), the social foundations of emotion, and the ways in which Western categories of knowledge (such as the domestic– public dichotomy) have been reified and naturalized through a distinctive formation of Euro-American knowledge and social power. While it can be argued that Rosaldo’s status within anthropology was curtailed by her early passing, it is equally clear that her work has often merited but passing mention in works such as this one. That is, the writing of anthropological history is a selective process in which some figures are foregrounded and others overshadowed.We hope, however, that the conversation on how to rectify these lacunae has now been joined – at least in this volume. While any short list of leading figures in this diffuse stream of activist, critical, and creative scholarship must, perforce, seem rather arbitrary, a few names do stand out. Besides Marilyn Strathern and Michelle Rosaldo, among the most widely read are Lila Abu-Lughod (b. 1952), Judith Butler (b. 1956), Micaela di Leonardo (b. 1949), Henrietta Moore (b. 1957), Sherry Ortner (b. 1941), and Rayna [Reiter] Rapp (b. 1946) – each of whom has moved the proverbial goalpost to a post-androcentric anthropology. It is important to note the significance of this ongoing transformation – one that interrogates the epistemological assumptions of gender itself – as well as its deep entanglement with human sexuality. These developments will be discussed in Part Four.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How would you characterize the relationship between sex and gender? 2. How would you distinguish ideology from theory? Is feminist anthropology ideological? 3. Was Margaret Mead a feminist? 4. Should there be a masculinist anthropology? 5. In the absence of patriarchy, is anthropological feminism necessary?

164

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Political Economy Key Words: anthropological political economy, development and underdevelopment theory, political economy, world-system theory For many anthropologists working in the 1960s and 1970s, among the most influential of the new perspectives to emerge in social theory were two related schools of analysis: development and underdevelopment theory and world-system theory. Within sociocultural anthropology, these, together with a fresh reflection on the key tenets of Marxist analysis, became the foundation for a critical perspective generally called political economy, or, more precisely, anthropological political economy.

Marx and the World System Key Words: core, modernization, periphery, underdevelopment, world-system The first incarnation of “political economy” per se dates to the eighteenth century and was originally devised by Enlightenment-era social theorists in their investigation of the origin and nature of, and relationships between, nation-states and their colonial holdings around the world. By way of definition, in his work A Discourse on Political Economy (1755), Jean-Jacques Rousseau distinguished between the terms particular economy, which signified “the wise and legitimate government of the house for the common good of the whole family,” and general or political economy, which extended the particular meaning to “that great family, the State.” Early theorists such as Rousseau deemed general economic institutions “political” in character because they were manipulated by national governments seeking to maximize gain through capitalist appropriation and exchange. While the governmental and narrowly economic aspects of this first generation of “classical” political economics were soon segmented into distinctive academic disciplines (political science and economics, respectively), this original emphasis on the political character of capitalist exchange persisted in the nineteenth century, when Marx and Engels sought to understand the morally exploitative dimensions of wealth distribution. In the twentieth century, the political and economic disparities between the “developed” and “underdeveloped” worlds, growing apace since the breakup of colonialism following World War II, nevertheless remained largely unexamined by social science until the 1960s, when the influential German-born economist André Gunder Frank (1929–2005) began to criticize modernization. Frank, a peripatetic scholar who worked on three continents, believed the global capitalist 165

development and underdevelopment theory André Gunder Frank’s theory about the systematic exploitation of underdeveloped nation-states and regions by developed nation-states and regions. world-system theory Immanuel Wallerstein’s theory that core nation-states are engaged in the systematic exploitation of peripheral nationstates for labor and natural resources. political economy An anthropological perspective viewing sociocultural form at the local level as penetrated and influenced by global capitalism. anthropological political economy The view that peoples exposed to the global expansion of capitalism experience and modify it in different and creative ways.

modernization The Western practice of transforming noncapitalist, preindustrial economies into capitalist, industrial economies.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

underdevelopment  A condition that, in the opinion of many political economists, is actually caused rather than ameliorated by international development initiatives. core In world-system theory, Western nations and regions that expropriate and control resources of nonWestern nations and regions; contrasted with periphery. periphery In worldsystem theory, non-Western regions dominated economically and politically by Western regions; contrasted with core. world-system  According to political economists, the global expansion of Western capitalism, creating a world-system of unequal commodity exchange.

agenda to be more sinister than benign, making dependent satellites of those “developing” nation-states with which the Western world came into contact and systematically extracting surplus goods and labor in exchange for much less. Underdevelopment was not, in Frank’s estimation, a product of local conditions but the result of progressive capitalist exploitation. The most detailed exposition of this kind emerged in the work of Immanuel Wallerstein (1930−2019), an American-born sociologist whose best-known writings on the globalizing character of capitalist economies are found in the three volumes of The Modern World-System (1980). In them, he identified the historical emergence of a Euro-American “world-economy” in which bourgeois capitalists in the “core” nations of Europe and America appropriate the profits generated by proletarians in the “periphery,” or the rest of the world. Like Frank, Wallerstein understood the proletariat to be trapped in a worldsystem of unequal exchange in which Euro-American society penetrated, politically subjugated, and economically exploited external populations and their produce. Like the theory of Marx and Engels before them, the work of Wallerstein, Frank, and others did not spring into existence ex nihilo but was, rather, emblematic of broader trends in and outside of academia. By the early 1960s, radical emancipatory social agendas – such as those associated with the countercultural, antiwar, anti-colonial, gay and lesbian rights, and feminist movements – began to emerge on a large scale in Western society. In the main, the philosophical foundations on which such liberation movements were based originated within the academic world itself and had a marked impact on the development of intellectual discourse from the 1960s through the 1990s. For sociocultural anthropology especially, these trends heralded an upheaval in how the discipline was to regard itself – an intense period of reflection and introspection that has not abated to this day. During the 1960s and 1970s, it was becoming increasingly clear to many anthropologists that their discipline not only had failed to problematize the impact of Western colonial and economic imperialism around the world but also had neglected to recognize the essential links between the rise of anthropological knowledge and colonialism. They began to realize that a large majority of the ethnographic texts composed in the first half of the twentieth century had been written by white Euro-American men, whose work was often made possible by the political and military subjugation of the peoples they studied. In short, many of the remote and exotic communities of the classic ethnographic gaze were captive to, and dependent on, a global system of capitalism and militarism. Many anthropologists came to believe, with horror, that their discipline had been the unwitting accomplice of the colonial endeavor and that it had profited from the oppression of the very peoples whom many well-intentioned ethnographers sought to frame in a sympathetic manner. 166

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

FIGURE 3.8  Protesting the War in Vietnam: During the 1960s and 1970s, antiwar and other political protest movements promoted reflexivity within anthropology. Copyright © Bill Irwin.

Sins of the Fathers Key Words: authoritative knowledge, great tradition, little tradition The epistemological challenge posed by Frank and Wallerstein, together with the revolutionary political climate of the 1960s intellectual world, represented the culmination of a number of theoretical and moral crises that had been troubling anthropologists for a generation, primarily in relation to the growing disaffection with structural analysis in its various forms.Therefore, disaffection and disillusionment among the anthropological rank-and-file were not, strictly speaking, new developments, even occurring as they did in the tumultuous 1960s. 167

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.9  Robert Redfield (1897–1958): Redfield developed a theoretical distinction between “great” and “little” traditions, foreshadowing some of the insights of anthropological political economy. Photograph by Blackstone Studios, New York.

great tradition Robert Redfield’s term for cultures characterized by literacy, industrialization, and rational religions; contrasted with little tradition. little tradition  According to Robert Redfield, cultures characterized by illiteracy, preindustrial economies, and “irrational” supernatural beliefs; contrasted with great tradition.

In the British tradition, Gluckman and Leach, among others, had been steadily working since the 1940s to correct the “sins” of their disciplinary fathers by advocating sweeping revisions to structural-functionalism in order to make it more politically and historically relevant. Moreover, as early as the 1950s, American anthropologists had also been feeling less and less comfortable with the idea that the discipline must study timeless, self-contained, and largely rural communities. Notably, in an effort to cultivate a more historically aware anthropology, Robert Redfield (1897–1958) developed a theoretical distinction between the great tradition of the literate, religious, and urban to contrast with the little tradition of the oral, magical, and rural. Formulations heavily grounded in a Durkheimian concept of structure or organic analogy, as were those of British and French anthropologists, were subject to particular scrutiny. Still, the theoretical insights that were to revolutionize anthropological theory merely simmered until the 1960s. It was during this decade that many basic 168

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

assumptions about the character and truth-value of anthropological knowledge came under serious attack from various quarters, both within the field and without. Among the most strident of anthropological criticisms was that the pristine, timeless, and self-contained organic community of anthropological invention was, in reality, just that – a figment of the ethnographic imagination. A more powerful understanding of human societies, it was argued, would seek to circumvent Cartesian assumptions of Western bourgeois culture: that there existed an untamed and unchanging primitive “Other” that would undoubtedly benefit from contact with the materially wealthy, the literate, the industrial, and the otherwise “civilized.” Similarly, a much-cherished notion of the empirical researcher was also called into question. No longer was it taken for granted that the world was easily or dispassionately observed or that the authors of ethnography were themselves utterly impartial or objective. Seeking to displace these anachronistic perspectives, a number of scholars began to display, rather than conceal or mystify, the various conflicts, class interests, and arrangements of power and dependency embedded in the history of global capitalism – a history in which anthropology itself had played a role. It was out of this “post-”structural concern for social process, power, conflict, and the origin of authoritative knowledge that anthropological political economy was born.

Ideology, Culture, and Power Key Words: hegemony, ideology Anthropological political economy was, then, a product of its times. Distinguishing these anthropologists from their colleagues working in one or another materialist or symbolic subdiscipline was their desire to understand the nature of encounters between large-scale regional, national, and international capitalist forces and local, non-Western societies and cultural traditions. To this extent, the new perspective shared the general goals of economic historians like Frank and Wallerstein. In contrast to world-system theory, however, anthropologists working within this perspective remained resolute in their commitment to understanding the autonomy and integrity of local societies and cultures, especially in the nonWestern world. These, it was argued, were not culturally fragile communities that could (or should) be simply dissolved by the imperialist policies and agendas of global capitalism, no matter how well-intentioned the ambitions of international development or patronizing Western powers might be. Rather, a more enlightened moral and theoretical stance demanded study of the mutually significant encounters between capitalist economies and local societies around the world, arguing, in effect, that there did not exist a single world-system, but many. Explicit in this research objective was the idea that the effects of capitalism did not constitute a “one-way street” and that local peoples and cultures exercised a degree of agency 169

authoritative knowledge The idea that one body of knowledge is privileged over other bodies in that it has greater access to ultimate reality or the “truth.”

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

ideology A term used by Karl Marx and Marxist scholars denoting a system of beliefs that influences the outlooks of individuals and groups.

hegemony A term for the capacity of one social group to impose particular beliefs or political and economic conditions upon another group.

in accepting, transforming, or even rejecting the expansion of market economies. If such subtle and multifarious processes were taking place, these anthropologists wanted to know how, and in what ways. In sum, as a group, anthropological political economists remained anthropologists in the best traditions of sociocultural analysis dating back to Malinowski and Boas. At this point, an important question arises about the nature of political economic theory in anthropology. It is well and good to advocate a study of the encounter between radically different systems of cultural and economic behavior, but how, precisely, do these worlds of experience interpenetrate and affect one another? The political economic tradition within anthropology has viewed culture as being shaped in the context of unequal access to wealth and power. This perspective, drawing as it does on Marxist assumptions about conflict between social and economic groups, may be thought of as materialist because the material conditions of human existence are understood to condition the character of social relations. However, unlike cultural materialism, which viewed infrastructure (modes of production and reproduction) as a primary determinant of culture, political economy, like structural Marxism, has considered the material conditions giving rise to these as being grounded in ideology. Because ideologies are constructed systems of ideas, they reflect and perpetuate the specific interests of their authors. For political economy, following Marx, such interests are inscribed in the ways in which a society differentiates itself according to socio-economic class, gender, and ethnicity, to name but a few prominent criteria. Whoever controls the means of producing wealth and power, it is argued, also controls conditions for the production of knowledge itself. When knowledge about the world is taken for granted, or unquestioned, it loses its arbitrary character and comes to be seen as “natural.” Ideology at this stage ceases merely to embody the interests of one group within society and becomes a dominant perspective of the society; it is taken for granted by the powerful and powerless alike. Unchallenged dominant ideologies, such as that cluster of heterogeneous meanings and activities that makes up global capitalism, assert the economic and political interests of some while simultaneously “mystifying” this essential inequality in power relations for others. Political economists refer to this mystification as hegemony. As this suggests, the anthropological concept of culture had the potential to be reformulated when set within a political economic context. Positioning themselves in the idealist-materialist “breach” between the cognitive, symbolic, and interpretive camps, on the one hand, and various manifestations of materialism, on the other, political economists redefined culture as a system of objective and concrete forces, or ideologies, the effects of which might be investigated ethnographically. Accordingly, a recent generation of theorists has proposed that the unity, the objectivity, and even the existence of culture ought not to be assumed. Rather, the matter-of-fact, taken-for-granted quality of culture should be recast as problematic because a political economic perspective on the relationships between nation-states 170

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

raises significant (and troubling) theoretical and moral questions about the historical conditions in which particular “cultures” and social groups come to exist, become powerful, or, as the case may be, become dependent or subjugated. Abstract though this theoretical edifice undoubtedly is, the main tenets of political economy are grounded and given practical depth in much of the detailed ethnographic research that has characterized publishing in this subfield. For example, in his influential ethnography The Devil and Commodity Fetishism in South America (1980), Michael Taussig (b. 1940) argues that the inequities of capitalism are the subject of critical evaluation by poor laborers, who employ the Judeo-Christian Devil as a moral commentary on a system of economic relations over which they have little or no control. In Taussig’s scheme, it is the local culture, rather than the doctrines of industrial capitalism, that creates meaning out of an encounter between radically different societies. More recently, the two-­ volume series entitled Of Revelation and Revolution (1991, 1997), by John Comaroff ­(b. 1945) and Jean Comaroff (b. 1946), has similarly analyzed the impact of colonialism in South Africa by applying many of the same concepts. Other prominent examples of anthropological texts that incorporate an explicitly political economic framework are Europe and the People Without History (1982) by Eric Wolf; Sweetness and Power: The Place of Sugar in Modern History (1985) by Sidney Mintz (1922–2015); Anthropologies and Histories: Essays in Culture, History, and Political Economy (1989) by William Roseberry (1950–2000); and Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter (1973), edited by Talal Asad (b. 1933). The effort within anthropological political economy to understand the complex character and interdependency of global and local processes certainly illuminated the changing and malleable character of culture, but for many anthropologists such issues raised more questions than they answered. Among the most troublesome was this: If past ethnographic representations of the “exotic” peoples did not so much reflect objective reality as further the norms, values, and assumptions of Western society (i.e., that there were indeed primitive and timeless cultures in dire need of civilizing), how was a new generation of cultural anthropologists to liberate itself from ethnocentrism and still construct accurate and meaningful accounts of cultures that, in the final analysis, were still very different from those of EuroAmerican scholars? Part of the answer to this question came in the form of a new branch of literary and cultural criticism: “postcolonial theory.”

Postcolonialism Key Words: Hinduism, multiculturalism, postcolonial perspective, secularism As early as the 1950s, the disintegration of European colonialism following World War II was raising questions of importance to anthropological theorists about 171

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.10  Cecil Rhodes Straddling Africa: In Victorian times, colonialist Cecil Rhodes (1853–1902) dreamed of a single railway linking British territories from Egypt to South Africa. “The Rhodes Colossus Striding from Cape Town to Cairo,” Punch, December 10, 1892.

the relationship between the developed and developing worlds. Wishful thinking aside, many anthropologists found it increasingly difficult to take seriously the existence of those pristinely bucolic communities that had been the discipline’s bread and butter for decades. “Post”-colonial states and societies did not simply revert back to a pre-colonial period when they achieved autonomy. Instead, it was clear that they and the powers that had dominated them were both profoundly transformed by the experience. In the case of the former, postcolonial states were left with myriad infrastructural, cultural, and economic conditions that could not simply be wiped away.With respect to the latter, former colonial powers 172

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

were transformed in subtle and not-so-subtle ways: subtle in terms of the corrosive effects of power mingled with racism and class antagonisms, not-so-subtle in terms of the great diasporic movements of people from the periphery to the metropole. The consequences of immigration from former colonies to centers of power continue to reverberate in twenty-first-century Europe, where underclasses of migrant labor have been spawned together with public-housing projects into which migrants have been ghettoized. Beyond the predictable unrest, political turmoil, and social injustice on various levels, another effect of this process has been that the center no longer “recognizes” itself: where once it was white, it is now brown, and where once it was Christian, it is now swamped in a multiplicity of faiths and non-Western rituals. In 2015, the world’s attention was riveted on the staggering drama of hundreds of thousands of refugees seeking entry into Europe from nearby war-torn countries such as Iraq, Libya, and Syria. Ever since, from all corners of the world, have come media reports of political conflict and violence as millions of people flee or are displaced from their homes, creating new and ever-changing diasporas. Feeding into this awareness is a never-ending stream of real-time images posted on social media. In the postcolonial period, the proverbial chickens have most definitely come home to roost. Through the 1960s and 1970s, these developments contributed to an unsettled quality within anthropology that fermented without clear resolution, direction, or theoretical innovation. Then, in 1979, perhaps the most powerful and articulate exponent and champion of a postcolonial perspective published a book that would set a new moral and epistemological course for anthropology.The book was Orientalism (1979), and the scholar was Edward W. Said (1935–2003). Said’s influence and stature across various academic disciplines (including political science, anthropology, history, literary criticism, philosophy, music, and cultural studies) were extensive, to say the least. The late journalist Christopher Hitchens (1949–2011) once remarked that Said’s followers constituted not so much a “school” as a “diaspora.” In addition to his contributions to scholarship, Said’s legacy is also grounded in his activism on behalf of dispossessed peoples (especially Palestinians) who were the frequent focus of much of his non-academic as well as academic writing. This interest was doubtless connected to his upbringing as a Palestinian Christian in Jerusalem. Given his political vision, Said at times courted controversy, particularly among those who disdained pro-Palestinian politics. In anthropology, he may certainly be considered a forerunner of “public anthropology,” a stream of interest that promotes anthropology as a moral undertaking as well as a scientific one. The publication of Orientalism is widely regarded as a seminal moment in what has become the dynamic interdisciplinary field of postcolonial studies. Said seeks in this series of essays to decipher the mechanisms of control employed by the British and French colonial empires to circumscribe and objectify the mysterious and exotic “Oriental” subjects of imperial power. Within anthropology, the growing numbers of those influenced by Said found especially troubling their 173

postcolonial perspective The anthropological study of how the legacy of colonialism has altered both the former colonizing and the formerly colonized states.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.11  Colonial Anthropologist?: E.E. Evans-Pritchard (1902–73) poses with some Zande boys in Sudan in the late 1920s. PRM 1998.341.576. Reproduced by permission of Pitt Rivers Museum, University of Oxford.

discipline’s undeniable historical participation in these relations of inequality.They were haunted by the possibility that they themselves, together with their disciplinary forebears, had played a role in violating those same non-Western peoples whose right to exist they had championed and for whom they had frequently become self-appointed advocates. Adopting a self-consciously postcolonial perspective has therefore involved both an analysis of the effects of Western expansion into, and domination of, the non-Western world and a moral discourse according to which the insidious effects of imperialism are viewed as an ongoing problem – not 174

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

vanquished simply by the withdrawal of Western empires from political and military domination. At the broadest level, a question posed by the postcolonial critique can be put in this way: How have Indigenous societies of the colonial world been obliged to change in response to the history of military, economic, and ideological dominion imposed upon them since at least the sixteenth century? Just as significantly, postcolonial anthropologists have also endeavored to problematize these encounters by styling them as an opportunity for scholars to devise new ways of imagining the West’s vision of itself in relation to the non-Western world. Talal Asad, for instance, has argued in Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter (1973), an influential book that predated Orientalism by several years, that the really interesting questions in postcolonial studies do not concern whether non-European societies and cultures continue in the present to be overwritten by European institutions and histories, but rather the extent to which non-Europeans have variously elided, appropriated, and hybridized European forms within their own systems of cultural knowledge and practice. Such questions may be addressed only by looking at the mechanisms employed to condition social understanding. In Asad’s judgment, it is not the case that colonial regimes have eradicated non-Western civilizations, although the situation is sometimes framed this way in public discourse. Rather, the complex cultural mingling ushered in by the colonial encounter suggests a far more subtle set of processes in which Indigenous histories are being rewritten by those who appropriate Western ones. Similarly, in a 1998 essay,Vivek Dhareshwar seeks to unveil the complex epistemological problems that attend European theoretical exposition of the non-European world – particularly in the case of India. Taking to task the “arid debates” on such topics as relativism and multiculturalism that he sees saturating the Western theoretical tradition, Dhareshwar proposes that a “metatheory” is needed in order to explain Western assumptions that infuse ideas of Otherness. He suggests that the very notion of cultural multiplicity is itself the product of Western epistemology, and for this reason it can neither be made intelligible nor ring true to the lived experience of subjects in postcolonial settings. What, he asks, are the specific conditions under which Western theoretical positions and descriptions are possible? By way of example, Dhareshwar points to debates concerning secularism and religion in modern India. Since “Hinduism” is itself a Western construct, he argues, and one nested within a broader category, “religion,” it makes little sense to engage in argument about secularism in Indian society. These categories say more about Western Cartesian reasoning than they do about Indian traditional culture, which draws no sharp distinction between the religious and the secular. Likewise, Hinduism itself has no value as a category outside the Western system that has created it as an explanatory cipher and sine qua non of Indian culture. Only when such issues have been revisited in scholarship, he maintains, can a truly dynamic theory of culture be built. Throughout the 1970s, political economy in anthropology, conditioned by a surging interest in postcolonial theory in other humanistic disciplines, in some 175

multiculturalism  Descriptively, a term that refers to the coexistence of a multiplicity of cultures, adopted by many nation-states, including Canada and India, as a formal aspect of public policy, seeking to promote and deepen it as a social and political attribute. secularism The assumption that religious faith and institutions are waning in the context of better scientific understanding of the universe and modernizing world. Hinduism An umbrella term for the many local and regional religions of India, most of which emphasize the concept of dharma (loosely defined as cosmic law or ultimate truth, toward which Hindus aspire with the goal of salvation), together with their associated myths, rituals, and ascetic practices.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

ways sought to rewrite the idea of social structure to acknowledge the moral and epistemological ills of the European colonial encounter. Even though such efforts incorporated an explicit concern for power relations and social hierarchies, they could not escape their own theoretical assumptions – which, much like the schools of theory that had come before, were rooted in a scientific and structural analysis largely alien to the peoples among whom anthropologists worked. Grounded as it was in Marx’s political philosophy, even political economy could ultimately be read as ethnocentric, because it held culture to be the product of materialist power struggles – a uniquely Western form of analysis. As the 1980s began, more and more anthropologists found themselves questioning whether it made sense to continue reducing complex cultural reality to any single cause or configuration of causes, given that no theory they devised would be a transparent window on reality but rather a “text” inextricably rooted in Western biases. These questions were and remain significant because they cut to the very heart of what anthropology attempts to do: devise powerful and streamlined models that explain how people interact with each other and the world.Was it possible, many began to wonder, for anthropological knowledge to remain valuable given its foundations in the European Enlightenment? The fact that extracting anthropology from its “modernist” heritage of Cartesian objectivism was extraordinarily difficult proved no impediment to the efforts made by many anthropologists who came to be called (whether they embraced the label or not) “postmodern.”

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What elements of political economic theory are Marxist? 2. From the perspective of political economy, what is meant by the phrase “the development of underdevelopment”? 3. Can anthropologists ever escape the global reach of capitalism? 4. What is meant by the term anthropological Other? 5. Is it reasonable to accuse political economy of being ethnocentric? 6. What is “Orientalism,” and who are the “Orientals”? 7. In what ways has Edward Said’s work been influential in anthropology? 8. How does postcolonial theory characterize the relationship between the Western world and non-Western peoples? 9. In what ways has Western scientific theory been inadequate in dealing with the postcolonial age, according to theorists such as Talal Asad and Vivek Dhareshwar?

176

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age In the wake of the Sapir-Whorf hypothesis and, later, the language-based modeling of ethnoscience and componential analysis, linguistic anthropology (or “anthropological linguistics,” as some preferred to call it) faced something of a crossroads from the mid-1960s onward. The reigning, explicitly anthropological paradigms pioneered by Boas, Sapir, Whorf, Conklin, Frake, and others were all constructivist in form but positivist at their base. The same can be said of Lévi-Strauss, whose structuralism synthesized concern for mental and linguistic phenomena. In sum, linguistic anthropology as a subfield of anthropology (at least in North America) had anchored itself in the empiricist epistemology of ancestors like Pike, Jakobson, and Saussure. These assumptions, which turned on the quantitative, genealogical, and relational mapping and classification of morphemes, phonemes, lexicons, and the like, have continued to be productive in the discipline of linguistics. But the positivist, descriptive model has proved less easily adapted to the evolving field of anthropology, which even by the 1960s was fast approaching a decolonizing and hermeneutically focused moment. Alessandro Duranti (b. 1950) suggests that, beginning in the later 1950s and especially the 1960s, we can conceive of successive waves in the transformation of linguistic anthropology away from formal study of what might be termed the “descriptive and historical linguistics of pre-literate societies” to a new paradigm – one that fuses a concern with form and structure to considerations of language as it is used, constructed, and performed, moment-to-moment. Such usage, in turn, would be considered in distinctive social and cultural contexts characterized by power-laden social hierarchies. This emerging consensus – one that generally accentuates performativity over structure – can be discussed as unfolding in stages that correspond to the work of a number of important language theorists.

Speech Acts and the Ethnography of Communication Key Words: dialect, ethnography of communication (EOC), illocutionary acts, perlocutionary acts, speech acts, speech community, speech event Among the most seminal of these language theorists was J.L. Austin (1911–60), originator of a deeply influential body of theory focused on what he called “speech acts.” Austin’s key insight was that the referential “truth-value” of language (which is positivist and descriptive) would always be a secondary consideration when contrasted with language as social activity that accomplishes the goals of speakers. In his book How to Do Things with Words (1955), Austin outlined his theory of illocutionary acts (also called “performatives”) – that is, those elements of speech that are intended to generate specific outcomes and which often 177

speech acts J.L. Austin’s term to describe the social character of any given occasion of speech; these occasions involve the linguistic forms used, the intentions embedded within those forms, and the effects (intended and unintended) on those listening. illocutionary acts  Pertains to linguistic performances and accomplishments made “real” in and through the speech itself (for instance, “I promise,” “I swear”).

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY perlocutionary acts  Pertains to the effects of a linguistic performance on the listener(s) (for instance, the effect of fear created by the phrase “the end of the world is coming”). ethnography of communication (EOC)  Originally called the “ethnography of speaking,” EOC was intended by Dell Hymes as a method of applying ethnographic methods to the analysis of patterns of meaningful speech use within and across social and speech communities. The change in name reflects a recognition that meaningful communication is also non-vocal and nonverbal. speech community  Dell Hymes’s term for a social group that is partially integrated through language and can therefore be identified by way of a shared use of a language or language variety. dialect A specific variety of a broader, more inclusive language system in which aspects of vocabulary and grammar index the social and cultural background of a speaker or community of speakers. speech event Dell Hymes’s term for a specific form of communicative exchange that is conditioned by various culturally specific and extralinguistic variables.

carry the force of social convention and law. The first-person singular use of “I do” in a marriage ceremony is a classic example; such utterances carry meanings that are context dependent or convey an underlying significance when combined with other factors (tone and volume of voice, for instance).These include such culturedependent conventional categories of speech as threats, questions, demands, announcements, and praise. Correspondingly, perlocutionary acts are listener responses to these illocutionary utterances – an acknowledgment, acceptance, or rejection of their effects, as the case may be. Some of Austin’s ideas were elaborated and nuanced by another important figure in language theory, philosopher John Searle (b. 1932). Searle classified all speech into several major types of speech acts. These included “assertives,” in which speakers assert the truth of what they are saying; “directives,” in which speakers attempt to induce action on the part of listeners; and “expressives,” in which speakers express or appeal to psychology and emotion (as, for instance, in thanking or apologizing). Novel and inspiring though speech act theory was, it tended to conform to a certain prescriptive structure of its own. For linguistic anthropologists, the move to a truly contextual study would require further elaboration of the relations between patterns of cultural meaning and speakers. It would also require attention to the “messiness” and inchoate character of speech, replete as it is with inconsistencies, mistakes, partially complete utterances, and so on. In moving toward an approach that addressed these concerns, the work of John Gumperz (1922–2013) and Dell Hymes (1927–2009), in particular, proved seminal. Their new approach to the anthropology of language was initially called the “ethnography of speaking” but became the ethnography of communication (EOC). The main ­questions posed by Gumperz and Hymes shifted language study even further away from the historical and structural than Austin and Searle had done, by grounding language use firmly in the matrices of social life. This work concerned identifying the norms or codes of communication for any given “speech community,” defined, straightforwardly enough, as any group of people who speak and understand the same dialect (also called a “language variety”). How, they asked, were such norms maintained, violated, and changed? How were topics, attitudes, and nonverbal cues (e.g., body posture) made relevant and appropriate (or the opposite of these) to any given social setting? Who were the participants to any given “speech event”? Such events, which include a wide range of social interactions (for instance, church services, medical appointments, courtroom trials, college classes, Thanksgiving Day dinners, football games) were defined in terms of how readily recognized they were by speakers to be important moments of social interaction – ones demanding foreknowledge of, and competence in, appropriate speech and modes of social interaction. At the level of one-on-one or small-scale interaction, Austin’s speech acts became salient in this model, but in concert with patterns identified at the level of events and communities. In discussion of this approach, Hymes proposes that ethnographic research within a speech community 178

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

will reveal particular features and functions of well-known genres of speech events (sermons, inaugural addresses, college lectures, etc.) and colloquial events (polite conversation, “shop” talk, gossip, and so on), all of which are applied by speakers in different ways in different social settings. By investigating the cultural value of language content, form, and performance, Hymes suggests, we will learn about patterns of social organization in any given community, as well as about the role of language performance in socialization within a group – that is, how do new or young members develop communicative competence?

Ethnolinguistics and Sociolinguistics Key Words: anti-languages, code-switching, cultural appropriation, diglossia, ethnolinguistics, language ideology, rhoticity, sociolinguistics, Spanglish, Standard American English (SAE) But other questions related to the always fluid and emergent character of language demanded that the ethnography of communication be, as it were and at the very least, fine-tuned. In particular, it was clear that no speech communities (any more than cultures) were perfectly integrated, and that there in fact existed at any time (especially within populous modern societies) an inestimable number of speech communities of all scales, breadths, and degrees of ephemerality. Speakers, according to this insight, move in and out of one or another community or event, navigating the particular contexts of speech use just as skilled sailors navigate and adjust to unpredictable weather conditions at sea. Another seminal contribution to this contextually oriented body of work was thus pioneered by linguist William Labov (b. 1927), who famously investigated language variation within and across speech communities in US urban centers. In a well-known example drawn from interviews he conducted in several department stores in New York City in 1962, Labov determined that a single linguistic variable, the postvocalic /r/ (that is, where the consonant “r” occurs after a vowel), coded by its presence or absence in everyday speech the relative social status of store employees and customers. Remarkably, whether /r/ was used or not was a function of experimental interviewing designed to oblige speakers to use both “casual” and “emphatic” pronunciation of the phrase “fourth floor.” Labov discovered a correlation between the relative affluence of shoppers, store prestige and pricing, and the use of /r/ as a marker of prestige. Employees in the higher-prestige environments (Saks Fifth Avenue and Macy’s) tended to rhoticity (as use of /r/ is called) more frequently, code-switching (that is, moving back and forth) between use and non-use depending on their level of concentration. In the less-prestigious store included in the study (S. Klein), use of /r/ was less prevalent or non-existent. This finding was supported by evidence that speakers across all social classes pronounced the 179

rhoticity Describes a dialect in which there is conventional pronunciation of /r/ following a vowel in such words as “car” or “fourth.” Frequently, such usage or lack thereof denotes broader social meanings associated with social class or geo-linguistic region. code-switching The use by a speaker or speakers of more than one language variety, grammar, or vocabulary within a speech event, typically in response to extralinguistic variables such as the identity of participant-listeners and the relative formality or context of the event.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

sociolinguistics A branch of linguistics that examines the interrelations between speech/communication and other domains of social and cultural life (for instance, the categories of regional origin, ethnicity, gender, age-set, socio-economic status).

ethnolinguistics A general term for the anthropological study of language in cultural context. diglossia The coexistence of different languages or language varieties within a relatively integrated speech community. Differential use among these is typically conditioned by context of use, formality of occasion, the identity of participants in a speech event, and so on. Spanglish An informal and often pejorative term for a hybrid language variety in geo-linguistic settings or regions in which both English and Spanish language varieties are spoken. It is typically associated with Spanishspeaking communities in different regions of the US and is frequently characterized by code-switching and neologism.

/r/ when reading vocabulary in which it was embedded, but that pronouncing it in an unreflexive manner expressed links with speech communities differentiated in geographic residency and socio-economic class. The name he coined for this context-dependent branch was sociolinguistics – a name that has largely remained in place as a label for this type of study. Both Gumperz and Hymes’s and Labov’s studies presaged a more contemporary focus on language not solely as a prescriptive, constrictive, grammatically integrated structure (corresponding, as in the Sapir-Whorf perspective, with a particular cultural logic) but rather as a cultural resource that is used by creative agents to accomplish social acts – language as a human phenomenon that is “done” and “performed,” much as Austin and Searle had proposed. Major questions in this type of research turn on how and why certain choices are made in linguistic and paralinguistic expression, and aim to identify the cultural factors and meanings that inform such choices – for instance, implicit and explicit understanding of pre-existing relations among participants in a speech event (which includes conflict as well as consensus) and familiarity with the conventions and expectations surrounding code-switching, turn-taking, phatic markers, and other features of interaction.The context thus becomes an act to be accomplished, and relations are not merely “expressed” by communication but constituted through it. “Choice” is, in this way, not to be thought of primarily as a “rational’ activity but rather as an expression of implicit and embodied “knowledge” that can be fully studied only as it emerges in social interaction. Participants in communications produce, reproduce, and transform social meanings and relations by way of the language and discursive strategies they bring to any given interactive context – be it in a classroom, workspace, courtroom, or around the family dinner table. In many ways, these ideas echo the work of postmodernists and post-structuralists, much of which was emerging in the same period; but they can also, ironically, be viewed as a sharpening of Saussure’s notion of parole, as contrasted with langue, many decades earlier. In time, many anthropologists would come to prefer the term discourse to “language” because the former casts a much broader net across the spectrum of human communicative performance, whereas the latter is still too readily bound up with issues of speech and writing. As Duranti frames it, this “big tent” conception of language is now to be “considered a domain of action in which agency is constantly an issue as opposed to a system of predefined rules that are separate from social life.” Inspired by Hymes, Labov, and others, a generalized term applied to anthropologists and linguists who study the culturally contexted performance of language is ethnolinguistics. From the 1980s through the new millennium, ethnolinguistics has in many respects retained the essential reasoning behind the ethnography of communication and sociolinguistics – in particular that languages exist in a tight dialectic with the social and cultural worlds in which they are embedded. Still, most linguistic anthropologists have sought to broaden and deepen their understanding 180

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

of language use according to a variety of scales and contexts, with a firm understanding that social life is inherently contested and fraught with unequal access to all sorts of resources: symbolic and linguistic as well as material. The coexistence within every society of distinctive dialects (called diglossia and generally associated with ethnicity, gender, age-set, religion, and social class–based communities) and styles or codes (often associated with workplaces, youth cultures, churches, sport teams, etc.) further complicates this already complicated terrain of speech events and speech acts. Looming large in this fresh understanding of linguistic diversity, too, is the recognition that such events and practices do not merely “reflect” or refer to an objectified reality of language but actually create, reproduce, transform, and adapt it in a reflexive process of mutual elaboration that we can compare (albeit very loosely) to a “feedback loop.” In this way of thinking about language, words and utterances become commodities that signify social power and authority, or the lack thereof. Often, speakers of non-standard varieties of a national language also speak the standard variety; this involves code-switching according to the immediate context and interlocutors – for instance, the speaking of “Spanglish” at home and Standard American English (SAE) in the workplace or at school, where a hybridized language such as Spanglish might be stigmatized. Exponents of standard varieties are, moreover, generally empowered to legitimize and naturalize their status by way of the institutional tools of linguistic domination and hegemony: encyclopedias, dictionaries, grade-school textbooks, and all manner of standardization available to the socially and economically powerful. None of this is to imply, however, that stigmatized language varieties are static or fixed in place, and still less that speakers are helpless in the face of power. A good example of the conflicted and political nature of language use – how linguistic codes might signal opposition or antagonism – lies in the concept of anti-languages, developed by M.A.K. Halliday (1925–2018). In Halliday’s view, such varieties are characterized by similar grammar and vocabulary as broader “official” or “standard” varieties. Contrasting these, speakers of anti-languages seek deliberately to conceal oppositional, rebellious, or countercultural meanings within arcane forms and conventions that (in theory) can be understood only by insiders. So corporate groups such as the Mafia, online gamers, and death metal fans frequently fashion new oppositional dialects that signal inclusion and exclusion. In the political economy of language, it occasionally happens that subaltern terms are revalorized, commodified, and eventually mainstreamed. Such was the case over the past generation, for instance, with the styles of talk, music, and fashion originally associated with hip-hop culture among young, primarily urbanite African Americans.The packaging, selling, and appropriation of what can be called a vernacular of resistance has raised important linguistic and ethical questions about cultural appropriation, hybridization, and parody when linguistic codes are abstracted from their original context for use by those widely viewed as illegitimate (for instance, white middleclass, suburban youth) within the community of origin. 181

Standard American English (SAE) Refers to the “umbrella” or “majority” variety of English used in the US. Because it is widely perceived to be lacking distinctive regional, ethnic, or class markers, SAE is the language variety of education, media, and socio-economically privileged classes. It is conventionally considered, by speakers and non-speakers alike, to be the basic standard against which other varieties of spoken English are measured and evaluated. anti-languages As discussed by M.A.K. Halliday, antilanguage varieties share basic grammar and vocabulary with other varieties but are stylized and valorized by members of socially marginal or ostracized groups – typically for the purpose of signaling social inclusion and exclusion. cultural appropriation  A phrase that suggests the adoption of culturally meaningful aspects of one social community (for instance, language varieties, clothing styles, hairstyles) by members of a dominant social community. Because this process often involves the nonconsensual extraction of subaltern culture by members of a dominant group or class, the process has come to be regarded by many as a form of colonial violence.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

language ideology  A phrase that describes beliefs, conventional understandings, and values associated with any given language variety as held by speakers themselves.

Beyond shedding light on the complexity of language as an objective, takenfor-granted property of social relations, at the turn of the twenty-first century a new body of theory within linguistic anthropology moved closer toward investigation of how language users think and speak about their language. The study of language ideology is thus one step removed from looking at communication in action. Rather, this “metalinguistic” approach has looked at the value and meaning of language as a social product. How do speakers rationalize and valorize their own language and co-speakers in relation to other varieties and their speech communities? Such questions remain especially significant in light of ongoing debates about immigration by non-native speakers into national spaces imagined by citizens to be linguistically homogenous and in need of protection from the allegedly diluting effects of impure “contamination” by linguistic Others. As linguistic anthropologists and others have shown, however, discriminatory exclusions on the basis of language, ethnicity, religion, and other factors ignore the patchwork of diversity that already exists within such spaces and, more importantly, the contingent, situational ability of speakers to exhibit profound levels of diglossia and capacity to code-switch – shifting seamlessly from one language variety to another depending on the social needs and expectations of the moment. In the view of noted linguistic anthropologists Kathryn A. Woolard (b. 1950) and Bambi B. Schieffelin (b. 1945), the study of language ideology has proven “a much-needed bridge” between the study of language and the study of broader social processes; it holds out the promise of being the glue that binds the linguistic to social forms.With the near-simultaneous emergence of the postmodern critique in the 1980s, the stage was set for a sharp turn to reflect on the entanglements of language, ideology, practice, personhood, and even the body itself as manifested in human social life, but also in the texts that are its anthropological medium.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What are the most important differences between speech act theory and the linguistic theories of Edward Sapir and Benjamin Lee Whorf? 2. How did William Labov’s work in New York influence new theory about the relationship of language to society? 3. In what ways has concern for linguistic diversity influenced sociolinguistics? 4. What are anti-languages? How might these help us to understand social and linguistic diversity? 5. What is meant by the term metalinguistics in discussing language ideologies?

182

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Postmodernity Key Words: deconstruction, modernity, nihilism, postmodern, post-structural, reflexivity While transactionalism, feminist anthropology, and political economy hastened the demise of the traditional structural-anthropological picture of society and culture, the advent of the postmodern perspective, or postmodernity, is often credited with “exploding” the culture concept once and for all. While this is an exaggeration, it is certain that the theoretical concerns that ethnographers began to express during the 1960s and 1970s – concerns that feminist anthropologists and anthropological political economists, in particular, sought to address – were not easily resolved.While not forming a movement properly labeled as homogeneous, postmodernists working within a variety of disciplines have certainly shared a perspective that emphasizes the subjectivity of experience and, consequently, the impossibility of any one form of authoritative knowledge. In anthropology, the so-called postmodern turn had the effect of advancing and refining debate over the theoretical and ethical issues first raised by political economists and others. Unfortunately, the precise meanings of the terms postmodern and postmodernity are still further obscured by their all-too-frequent conflation with another weighty adjective: “post-structural.” Strictly speaking, the terms post-structural and the noun derived from it, post-structuralism, refer, straightforwardly enough, to the growing malaise and increasing uneasiness with structuralism that erupted in the 1970s, particularly from within the academic field of literary criticism. Especially in France, where Lévi-Strauss’s work and person had achieved a lofty interdisciplinary stature and influence during the 1960s and 1970s, fickle dissatisfaction with what came to be seen as an overly cognitive, insufficiently political, socially uncontextualized body of theory fueled a wave of post–Lévi-Straussian zeal among such philosophical, left-leaning, and literary luminaries as Jacques Derrida (1930–2004) and Jacques Lacan. This initial flood of interest in deconstructing mental, cultural, and social structures as manifested in literary and philosophical discourse has had a deep impact on the shape and focus of anthropological theory, notably in the work of Michel Foucault and Pierre Bourdieu, and has understandably become identified with a broader philosophical and political-economic critique of Enlightenment objectivity within anthropology and other human sciences. Therefore, while a contemporary generation of anthropologists tends to employ the terms postmodern and post-structural interchangeably, it is worth noting that postmodernity embraces a much wider range of interdisciplinary dispositions in which the “modernist” acquisition of scientific and objective knowledge is critiqued as a Western, Enlightenment-inspired project. This discussion will henceforth concern itself primarily with the notion of the postmodern, although where postmodernity 183

postmodern Pertaining to postmodernism, the intellectual stance that experience is subjective and no one version of it can be authoritative.

post-structural  An adjective that expresses disenchantment with static, mechanistic, and controlling models of culture, with a consequent interest in social process and agency.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.12  Postmodern Challenge: Many anthropology students find postmodern theory difficult to fathom. Coypright © www.istockphoto.com/RTimages.

modernity According to postmodern theorists, the Enlightenmentinspired, invented tradition of dispassionate scientific inquiry. deconstruction A term describing the ambition of postmodernism to understand the political and cultural contexts “hidden” behind the writing, or “construction,” of narratives.

illumines (or stalks, depending on one’s point of view), post-structuralism is seldom far behind. Postmodernists have been accused of seeking to transcend and supplant modernity and even to do away with scientific anthropology, narrowly conceived, altogether.There are two major objections to this rather hyperbolic rush to judgment. First, even the most zealous champions of postmodernism acknowledge that the logic of modernity is not easily dispensed with because it is embodied in key Western assumptions about an objective world that can and should be subdued and controlled – politically, economically, and ideologically – by orderly, dispassionate, and rational Europeans and Euro-Americans. More important is a misunderstanding that many have about the purposes of cultural deconstruction and reflexivity. There is a significant distinction to be made between the brands of nihilism and solipsism that many postmodernists are accused of embracing and the pursuit of more penetrating insights into social and cultural processes. 184

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

Most anthropological theorists who are dismissed with the epithet “postmodernist” reject the idea that they are not engaged in developing new knowledge that more accurately reflects the experienced world. The difference is that these scholars – a majority of contemporary social and cultural anthropologists – accept that scientific accounts are like any other, the products of social negotiation and construction, not the mere description of objective, self-evident facts. Because socalled postmodernists push the definition of what it means to do science, a serious claim can be made that they are more scientific than their positivistically inclined colleagues. This, however, is a debate best reserved for the professional journals and classrooms. For the moment, some roots of the postmodernist perspective can be explored in the works of three seminal theorists. Paul Feyerabend, Michel Foucault, and Pierre Bourdieu have all influenced the emergence of a distinctive perspective that underscores much contemporary anthropological theory. These are followed by discussions of current approaches that unite critical cultural analysis with interpretive anthropology. Conspicuous among such approaches has been medical anthropology, a diverse body of research devoted to the cross-cultural investigation of health and healing systems and practices.

reflexivity A popular postmodern analytical strategy of reflecting on the biases and assumptions that inform one’s own theories and perspectives. nihilism The perspective that traditional values and beliefs are fundamentally uncertain and that existence is at base nonsensical.

Paul Feyerabend Key Words: diary disease, normal science, paradigm, philosophical anarchist, scientific revolution A genealogy of postmodernity might begin with the Austrian-born philosophical anarchist Paul Feyerabend (1924–94), who argued that there is no logical way to choose between conventional scholarly models, or paradigms. The concept of paradigms came from historian and philosopher of science Thomas Kuhn (1922– 96), who in his highly influential book The Structure of Scientific Revolutions (1962) argued that science is largely conventional, consisting of answers to questions that scientists agree are appropriate to ask at a particular time and place. For a while, according to Kuhn, this period of so-called normal science yields results, but, eventually, nonconforming observations instigate scientific “revolutions” whereby old questions are superseded by new ones to which the observations conform. A new period of normal science ensues, until other nonconforming observations instigate another scientific revolution. Kuhn called the intellectual framework for normal science a “paradigm” and the process of scientific revolution a “paradigm shift.” His prime example was the shift from Aristotelian to Newtonian science in the Scientific Revolution of the seventeenth century. Although he acknowledged that the history of science is progressive, his most influential point was that scientific paradigms fundamentally differ. 185

philosophical anarchist Following Paul Feyerabend, someone who believes that all scientific paradigms are logically equivalent, with no logical way to choose among them. normal science  According to Thomas Kuhn, science conducted within a scientific paradigm. scientific revolution  According to Thomas Kuhn, the replacement of one scientific paradigm with another. paradigm According to Thomas Kuhn, an intellectual framework for “normal” science, which is superseded by another paradigm in a scientific “revolution.”

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

diary disease Pierre Bourdieu’s tonguein-cheek label for the radical deconstruction of some postmodern theorists, particularly those preoccupied with second-guessing their own analyses.

Extending Kuhn’s perspective, Feyerabend argued that there is no logical way to choose between paradigms because all such explanations are inevitably interpretations. Scientific thought and institutions, like any others, are the products of lived experience, as are their assumptions about the “truth,” or authoritative nature, of their special knowledge.The truth-claims of scientists, Feyerabend insisted, cannot therefore be understood as superior to other manners of explanation for social phenomena; rather, all explanations are basically incommensurable. Likewise, an important insight of anthropologists in recent years has been that modernity has carried forward these truth-claims since at least the sixteenth century. The recognition has been that this project is itself a historical event.The modernist perspective itself constitutes a cultural artifact – the product of creative social action through time and not a “revelation” or awakening to the true understanding of an external objective reality. This revolution in perspective caused both great excitement and upheaval in the humanities and social sciences. While a number of scholars stand out for their extensive contributions to developing a postmodern perspective – Antonio Gramsci, Anthony Giddens (b. 1938), and Raymond Williams (1921–88), for instance – two in particular have directly influenced the course of anthropological theory and deserve special consideration: French social theorists Michel Foucault and Pierre Bourdieu. At the outset of this discussion, it is only fair to point out that neither theorist has identified his own work with that of “radical” postmodernists within cultural anthropology. In fact, Foucault’s work has been dismissed by some as an overly structural approach that does little to account for the agency and creativity of individuals, while Bourdieu went to some pains to distance his work from the work of those he considered to be nihilistically minded cultural interpretivists and deconstructionists who deny outright the possibility of objectivity in social science. Rejecting this proposition, Bourdieu felicitously, if cynically, dubbed this philosophy within anthropology the “diary disease.” Foucault and Bourdieu should not, therefore, be thought of as “postmodern” in narrow terms. Rather, their contribution has been to theorize such concepts as power, resistance, and agency in ways that have importantly influenced a recent generation of cultural anthropologists.

Michel Foucault discourses of power Michel Foucault’s phrase for the spectrum of institutions, rhetorics, and strategies employed by one group to dominate another group.

Key Words: discourses of power, knowledge, madness Writing in the 1970s, Michel Foucault a famous and outspoken French philosopher and historian of culture, viewed social institutions and relationships as being intimately grounded in a pervasive economy of discourses of power that shape relations between people at all levels in a society. In his formulation, 186

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

“power” ceased to be solely a function of formal political institutions and became something inscribed in everyday life. The many different roles played by individuals (employers, employees, doctors, patients, men, women, priests, the faithful, teachers, students, etc.) all bear the stamp of certain kinds of relations between people in which some dominate and others are subjugated. Whoever dominates these relationships, Foucault argued, also controls the economic and ideological conditions under which “knowledge” or “truth” (and therefore “reality”) are defined. Dominating classes inscribe their power, in Foucault’s scenario, in and through a series of tactics and strategies that instruct people to “be” a certain way in the world. In this way, beginning with the Enlightenment and the rise of the nation-state in the eighteenth century, discourses of science, sexuality, and humanism became dominant in European society, preserving their power through mechanisms of control such as prisons, hospitals, asylums, and museums. Foucault’s central contribution to postmodern social theory has been to show how power determines different social forms through history. Because modernity is viewed, alongside other configurations of knowledge, as the product of power, the objective character of scientific knowledge is shown to be a historical construct. An influential example of the Foucauldian perspective can be found in his work Madness and Civilization (1973), in which he charted the development of the concept of insanity in Western society. While his argument is often subtle and complex, a simplified synopsis runs as follows. Until the late eighteenth century, what Western society currently calls “insanity,” or “madness,” was viewed by educated Europeans and Americans as being of supernatural origin. This reflected the European medieval and post-medieval assumption that the world and the universe were understood with recourse to the inscrutable and purposeful Will of God. In this context, there was a social tendency to accommodate “mad” people because such individuals were often viewed as being “touched” by, or “fools” for, God – a belief often accompanied by the idea that they were spiritually powerful, or wise, and thereby capable of better expressing divine will than those around them. Interestingly, anthropologists have observed this phenomenon in small-scale, non-Western societies in which “shamans” and “witch doctors” are often people who are perceived to be gifted with spiritual authority or power. Likewise, a good example of this social role being expressed in Western literature is the importance of the “fool” in Shakespeare’s play King Lear (c. 1605). During the European Renaissance of the late fifteenth and early sixteenth centuries, scholarly knowledge was characterized by a rediscovery of Classical antiquity and an interest in the Platonic ideal of rationality and the power of the human intellect – a process that anticipated the rise of humanism. Foucault argued that under this new epistemological regime, the beginnings of a fabled “Age of Reason,” the world ceased to be God-centered, and those conditions that had to that point been thought of as tinged with divine power came to be revisited 187

knowledge According to Michel Foucault, information linked to social discourses of power.

madness According to Michel Foucault, a cognitive and emotive condition defined by people in power, the definitions changing over time.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.13  Randle McMurphy (Jack Nicholson) Confronts Nurse Ratched (Louise Fletcher) in One Flew Over the Cuckoo’s Nest (1975): This highly acclaimed film captures many of Michel Foucault’s views on madness and civilization. Copyright © 1975 The Saul Zaentz Company. All rights reserved.

under the sharp gaze of humanism and rationality. One effect of this process was that those considered to be mad were re-evaluated and found wanting within the new human-centered scale of norms and values. Far from being chosen by God, henceforth these individuals were no longer even fully considered people as such. Having lost or been denied the faculty of reason – a defining characteristic, in the early humanistic perspective, of what it means to be human – they came to be seen as almost certainly defective. In the seventeenth through nineteenth centuries, with the rise of science and the philosophy of positivism (i.e., the possibility of acquiring objective knowledge), the role of the divine in human affairs was reduced still further, and “insanity” came to be seen as a disease in which the intellect was no longer under the control of those afflicted. With the insane no longer perceived as fit to live in society, the asylum was founded to enforce and institutionalize a separation between rational society and that which was considered pathologically irrational. What becomes of those considered to be insane under these new conditions? Because their new status precluded consideration as complete human beings, such individuals began to be considered a part of the natural world. Like other aspects of the natural world subject to scientific scrutiny, penetration, and investigation, their bodies, too, became the objects of scientific fascination and investigation. One goal of this work was to find new ways to contain and investigate the insane – a 188

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

process that inaugurated the disciplines of psychiatry, psychology, and, indeed, the medical professions as a whole. For a late-twentieth-century readership, such a description of events could not help but be disturbing from an ethical point of view, given its assumptions about the essentially inhumane nature of science and medicine. Still, Foucault’s central objective in this history of madness was not to moralize but to shore up his theoretical position on the power of authoritative discourses to shape and define what people accept as objective truth. Hence, none of the changes that took place between the medieval era and the Enlightenment occurred because there was a truly objective transformation in the condition of people designated as mad. Whereas the modern world considers scientific discovery and knowledge to be the result of a gradual accumulation of objective information, Foucault argued that those things that in any time or place are considered truth and objective knowledge are themselves contingent on a relationship between the vagaries of history and shifting power relations between social classes. In short, what counts as “real” knowledge about the natural world – in this example, the mental condition of those designated as insane – is determined by those classes of people that possess the authority to shape and control knowledge itself. In this way, Foucauldian theory redefines the concept of “knowledge” itself. No longer a reference to real or objective understanding, knowledge is primarily a way of naming and ordering the world that favors the powerful and seeks to maintain the status quo. Moreover, the quality of knowledgeable “expertise” in a given field is bestowed upon accredited individuals who participate in institutions that help to maintain this status quo. Specialists such as judges, lawyers, doctors, teachers, and scientists are experts only because they are designated to be experts by the socially powerful. In the case of the transition from the medieval era to the Enlightenment, Foucault identifies a “changing of the guard”: the epistemological authorities and assumptions of the medieval world (the Church and its earthly representatives) are replaced by a new set of authorities whose authority derives from their insight into the newly emergent epistemologies of humanism and science. Besides madness, Foucault wrote widely about the history of sexuality, using the same analytic framework of authoritative knowledge and discourses of power. He is recognized as the first public intellectual in France to die of HIV/AIDS.

Pierre Bourdieu Key Words: doxa, fields, habitus, practice (or praxis), symbolic capital, symbolic domination, taxonomies Addressing similar issues relating to power and domination but coming at the problem from another angle, French intellectual Pierre Bourdieu worked during 189

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY practice (or praxis)  According to Pierre Bourdieu, the concept that society is constructed by purposeful, creative agents who bring society to life through talk and action. taxonomies According to Pierre Bourdieu, internalized symbolic representations that make the social world what it is for people who live in it.

fields According to Pierre Bourdieu, the dynamic configuration, or network, of objective relationships among social agents and positions. doxa Pierre Bourdieu’s term for a psychological state in which all members of a community consider relations natural, including relations of social, economic, and political inequality. symbolic domination According to Pierre Bourdieu, the tendency of dominant social groups to create and sustain a worldview in which all members of a society, including subjugated members, participate. symbolic capital  According to Pierre Bourdieu, the body of meanings, representations, and objects held to be prestigious or valuable to a social group.

the 1970s and 1980s to develop a theory that places individuals at the center of social processes. Unlike Foucault, whose theory viewed individuals and their interrelationships as being determined by discourses of power, Bourdieu held that these same persons and social arrangements are created by human agents who assemble their cultures through practice, or praxis.What people “do” in practice is create, reproduce, and change a variety of taxonomies that are understood to be the basis of social relations. These taxonomies are made up of symbolic representations that do not merely reflect ideas about the world but actually make the world what it is for the people who live in it. Individuals are powerful to the extent that they can impose on others taxonomies that reproduce their own power and authority; they are powerless to the extent that they are unable to escape their social positioning in relation to the taxonomies created by others. Either way, the taxonomies wielded by the powerful in relation to the powerless are relevant only insofar as they are lodged within a configuration of social relations. The notion of the “relational” is so significant in Bourdieu’s thought because it helps to move social science away from those various formulations of social structure as conceived by an earlier generation of Durkheimian thinkers. For Bourdieu, social structures and cultures were not to be compared to machines or organisms, because culture and society are ultimately not things but systems of relationships, or fields. He defined fields as fluid, open-ended “networks” of “objective relations between positions.” Complex societies, he argued, were composed of any number of fields (i.e., artistic, intellectual, economic, religious, etc.), which, although coexisting spatially and temporally, were nevertheless discrete and integrated according to their own internal “logics.” Within fields, the total imposition of one group’s set of taxonomies upon another’s results in the production of a “natural” order, or doxa, in which the essentially arbitrary character of the powerful taxonomies is obscured. What emerges, for the powerful and powerless alike, is a sense that certain thoughts, feelings, and actions are part of the outer objective world, while others (those of the dominated) are “unnatural.” In short, social relations that come to be taken for granted are actually the result of one interest group’s symbolic domination of others within a society. What is seen to be “real” in any society, from this perspective, inevitably reflects the point of view of whoever’s interests are served by that reality. Unlike Foucault’s model, in which individuals are simply dominated by a powerful system that exists independently of their own actions, Bourdieu’s model stipulates that this system of meaning-in-conflict is characterized by individual social actors participating in a pervasive economy of symbols in which autonomous individuals and groups attempt to accrue and distribute symbolic capital, or symbols of prosperity and prestige, with differing degrees of success. A critical feature of this system, and one that distinguishes Bourdieusian from Foucauldian thought, is that even individual members of the dominated classes within this economic system are sometimes able to transform the nature of what counts as socially prestigious or valuable 190

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

by creating alternative taxonomies that resist those imposed by the powerful. Bourdieu referred to the wellspring of this individual agency as the “habitus,” or the ways in which personal history and social positioning allow individuals to improvise or innovate. An example of Bourdieu’s concepts that might be familiar to a recent generation of students is “jailing,” a fashion style that originated when socially marginalized jail inmates had their belts removed to prevent them from committing suicide, resulting in low-slung pants, but that hip-hop musicians later transformed into prestigious and profitable lines of clothing, underclothing, and accessories that proclaimed resistance in the outside world.

Anthropology as Text Key Words: cline, deme, social constructionism Throughout the 1980s and 1990s, Foucault’s and Bourdieu’s ideas had a dramatic impact on anthropological theory. Depending on one’s sympathies, their work has been either highly illuminating or deeply mystifying. Regardless, it is clear that for many anthropologists, suddenly there seemed no center, no firm ground from which students of human life could gaze objectively at their subject matter. Henceforth, no “truth” would be taken for granted and no perspective left unchallenged. “Deconstruction” became a new watchword for anthropologists, because the sanguine ambition of positivism to explain the world was no longer seen as a possibility. On the contrary, to be a “vulgar” positivist was to be misguided because it was not the culture itself that needed explaining so much as the anthropologist’s explanation of that culture. It was the representation or account of a people, in other words, that required understanding, or deconstruction, because discrete cultures as “objects” are only apprehended at all through such accounts, which are themselves enshrined in the ethnographic text. Some years before, Clifford Geertz and the interpretive school had also employed the metaphor of text in an effort to show that, like the written page, cultures might also be read and deciphered for meaning. Unlike Geertz’s approach, which has been considered rather naïve and inconsistent by postmodernity for its perceived willingness to turn the ethnographic gaze on everyone’s cultural meanings but the ethnographer’s own, postmodernist authors claim to probe greater depths of social reality by self-consciously reflecting on the contingent cultural factors embedded in their own representations. Over the years, some critics have mistakenly understood this to mean that postmodernity denies outright the existence of objective reality and have accused postmodernist researchers of solipsism. These claims notwithstanding, it is ironic that the postmodern perspective in effect recapitulates an idea that has been prominent in anthropology since Boas and his students first championed the cause of 191

habitus Pierre Bourdieu’s term for the capacity of individuals to innovate cultural forms based on their personal histories and positions within the community.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 3.14  The Perfect Physique: In the culture of the gym, do men use their bodies as social capital? Copyright © iwww.istockphoto.com/Yuri.

cultural relativism in the first decades of the twentieth century: that culture mediates and conditions all knowledge of the world, like a lens. In this way, while it is clear that a world truly does exist independently of how we know it, it is equally clear that there is no perspective, scientific or otherwise, that is not in the last instance rooted in particular histories and biases – an integral feature, seemingly, of our common humanity. In anthropology, the postmodern perspective has been most influential in the writing of ethnography. Anthropologists working in the final decades of the twentieth century became extremely conscious of the subjective nature of the 192

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

documents they produced. James Clifford and George Marcus’s edited volume Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography (1986) has been particularly influential in advancing the ideas that cultural accounts are constructed texts and that the relations among the writer, reader, and subject matter of ethnography are complex and problematic. Whereas standard interpretive approaches would view subjects as creative actors busily constructing their social worlds out of symbols, postmodernists have noted with deep irony that these same ethnographers privilege their own status as external observers. Accordingly, while everybody else was evidently forced to build culture, anthropologists were exempt from this process; it was for them to observe, rather than to be observed. In contrast, postmodern writers argue that ethnography, no less than any other form of creative writing, privileges the authorial perspective. This insight has had deep implications for anthropological theory. Because the account being produced always comes from a particular viewpoint – most often that of the white, middle-class, educated Euro-American male – it reflects and asserts (albeit implicitly) the concerns and interests of its author. True objectivity is hardly possible, because even if researchers deliberately adopted a non-stereotypical object of study, they would still have little choice but to employ the analytical categories and concerns explicitly and implicitly fashioned by the academy and (more broadly) the society in which the knowledge they “possess” has been formed. What goes unquestioned – the division of the ethnographic project into subject and object – betrays the subtle yet powerful influence of modernity on anthropological theory. Recognizing the impossibility of pure objectivity, a recent generation of ethnographers has attempted to circumnavigate the ethical and methodological dilemmas raised by postmodern theory. They have done so by looking for ways in which to describe different cultures and societies without denying the subjectivity of the people being analyzed and without laying claim to absolute, or authoritative, knowledge about them. Needless to say, given that anthropology has been suffused with and directed by modernist concerns, this lofty ambition is easier proclaimed than accomplished. Heavily influenced by the writings of Foucault and Bourdieu, one popular strategy has been to show how the subjects of ethnography themselves set about creating and negotiating the categories of meaning that inform their social worlds. Often labeled “social constructionism,” after a phrase popularized by sociologists Peter Berger (1929−2017) and Thomas Luckmann (1927−2016) in the 1960s, this methodology attempted to highlight the essentially contingent nature of culture by demonstrating how ethnographic subjects employ language and patterned activity to create, sustain, and change meaning.This approach has been highly influential in anthropological writing. For instance, The Invention of Tradition (1992), edited by Eric Hobsbawm (1917–2012) and Terence Ranger (1929–2015), is a collection of historical essays that points to the recent “invented” origins of traditions and practices that are often portrayed as being ancient markers of ethnic identity. In this vein, much attention has 193

social constructionism  The theory that sociocultural phenomena are products of historically situated interpersonal negotiation accomplished through patterned language and activity.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

deme A reproductively isolated human population, sometimes used as a synonym for the concept of race. cline A mapped gradient of the geographical distribution of a particular genetic trait, sometimes used as a replacement for the concept of race.

been focused by a recent generation of anthropologists on how different forms of human community, such as those identified according to social positioning (i.e., according to such criteria as socio-economic class, race, ethnicity, and gender), are constructed in and inscribed on a wide variety of historical contexts. Social constructionism has also had a major impact on the way in which anthropologists conceptualize race. This impact took place at around the same time that biological anthropologists were abandoning racial typology and moving toward a dynamic, population-genetics–based concept of racial boundaries as ambiguous. In 1972, geneticist Richard Lewontin (b. 1929) published an influential study of human diversity using numerous genetic markers. He found that fully 85 per cent of genetic variation occurred within races while less than 15 per cent occurred among them. If race accounted for so little of the genetic diversity among people, Lewontin and biological anthropologists wondered, what scientific meaning did the concept have? The emerging answer was not very much, or none at all. In terms of evolutionary theory, this answer made perfectly good sense, because genetic diversity is the raw material for natural selection.There are no biologically homogeneous, or pure, races. All races are biologically heterogeneous, or “impure,” and natural selection simply changes the composition of that heterogeneity over time.While this new insight did not take hold overnight, it soon became apparent that the term “race” needed replacing, so biological anthropologists began deploying alternative terms such as deme, or breeding isolate, and cline, a mathematical gradient of the frequencies of genetic markers over space. Clines proved especially useful to illustrate the biological arbitrariness of fixed race categories. The more clinal traits were considered, the less the clines corresponded, implying that, even as clusters of genetic traits, fixed biological races do not really exist. Social constructionism mapped onto this emerging biological understanding quite easily, because it answered this question: If race has little or no scientific validity, why is the concept so prevalent? The answer is that while race may not be biologically real, it is very real as a social construction. For teachers, a simple classroom activity will demonstrate this point. Ask any group of students to glance at their fellow classmates and then note in writing how many named races they represent. Collect the notes and then randomly select and read a few of them aloud. It is virtually certain that no two named groupings will be the same – will the real race please stand up! This activity can then segue into a discussion of why the groupings differ. Current cultural anthropology theories – feminism, political economy, postmodernism, and the like – can provide guidance here, showing their relevance. The American Anthropological Association’s 1998 Statement on Race can serve as a reasonable marker for when social constructionism in anthropology became mainstream. Since then, the need to promulgate this understanding to the public looms large. The world is awash in deadly racial conflicts. At the same time, more and more people are using commercial DNA testing kits such as 23andMe 194

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

and AncestryDNA to find ancestral groups where they “belong.” Anthropological cautions and correctives are clearly needed.

Critical Medical Anthropology Key Words: allopathic, biomedicine, epiphenomenon, ethnomedical, medical anthropology While the origins of medical anthropology predate the ascendancy of postmodernity within sociocultural anthropology by a number of years, it has been with the emergence of the postmodern perspective in particular that the subfield has come to prominence as a field of critical scholarship. In this context, the recent history of medical anthropology serves as an especially good example of the impact of postmodernism on anthropological theory. In its broadest aspect, medical anthropology may be defined as the study of the social and cultural dimensions of health and illness, together with Indigenous theories of cause and treatment (what is sometimes still referred to as “folk medicine”). In contrast with many other subfields of academic anthropology, however, many medical anthropologists have successfully created a professional niche for themselves outside the university system, primarily by turning their knowledge of theory to practical advantage by offering “actionable” insights into clinical practice and public policy formation. Classical ethnographers have long concerned themselves with the investigation of non-Western practices related to medical knowledge and treatment, or ethnomedical systems. One example is Evans-Pritchard’s study of witchcraft as a folk illness. Generally speaking, ideas about health, illness, misfortune, and supernatural power were viewed by earlier generations of sociocultural anthropologists as part of an integrated social and cultural structure. More recently, the influence of postmodernity, feminist anthropology, and political economy has been felt by ethnomedical researchers, who have come to emphasize the ideological or conflicted nature of Indigenous practice. Rather than being elements in an integrated social “whole,” folk medical practices have come to be seen in recent years as one site of contest between conflicting local and translocal ideologies that variously square off against one another or mingle to create new forms of practice, belief, and power relations. In recent years, Western, or allopathic, biomedicine has itself been subject to this level of analytical scrutiny. For instance, building on the work of Foucault, “critical” medical anthropologists such as Nancy Scheper-Hughes (b. 1944), Mark Nichter (b. 1949), and Margaret Lock (b. 1936) view medicine as having an ideological component. More than a set of insights about how to diagnose and treat illness, biomedicine is treated as but one aspect of Euro-American ideological 195

medical anthropology  The cross-cultural, pan-historical study of sickness and health.

ethnomedical  Pertaining to ethnomedicine, the anthropological study of non-Western medical systems.

allopathic The treatment of illness and disease using the knowledge and techniques of Western biomedicine. biomedicine The science-based form of ethnomedical knowledge and practice dominant in Western societies.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

epiphenomenon  A phenomenon resulting from another phenomenon.

expansion into the non-Western world. For this reason, many medical anthropologists working from this perspective have advocated a radical decentralization of medical knowledge and practice from the Western medical establishment, itself treated as the product of Enlightenment-era struggles to define the “real.” Thus, biomedical practice cannot be extracted from the political economy of capitalism, in which social behaviors and institutions are inevitably shaped and controlled by the experience of Western hegemony. Other critical medical anthropologists have been involved in investigating the often-complex dynamics that arise between distinctive medical systems. These often come to compete with one another in socio-economically stratified and heterogeneous societies, such as those one finds in modern Western nation-states. This concern for understanding medical pluralism has been at the heart of an efflorescence of “applied” research undertaken by such anthropologists as Andrea Sankar and Sandra Lane, which, in recent years, has become a prominent feature of debates regarding the formation of public health policy and clinical and psychiatric practice. In contrast to critical medical anthropology, a defining feature of this applied perspective is that practitioners seek to contribute to the amelioration of health care by introducing local or Indigenous knowledge into biomedical practice, thus making Western medicine of greater utility, especially in non-Western settings. For instance, many applied practitioners are employed by hospitals or international development organizations to assist biomedical professionals in better understanding the cultural factors affecting particular health practices that may, or may not, be perceived as problematic from the position of Western medicine. Though diverse in its approaches, the mainstream within critical medical anthropology has in these ways focused squarely on the sociocultural nature of health and illness. Contrasting with both of these, another branch of practice within the subfield has struck a distinctly more “etic” position that also lays claim, in the best Boasian tradition, to being a truly holistic approach to studying human phenomena. Those with an ecological orientation within medical anthropology have looked for patterns in the interrelationships between environmentally conditioned, health-relevant variables (for instance, the prevalence of particular diseases or the availability of food) and sundry human social and economic practices (for instance, those relating to agriculture or migration). All claims to holism notwithstanding, however, ecologically oriented medical anthropology has drawn withering fire from other quarters within the subfield, and from sociocultural anthropology more generally, for its allegedly “reductionist” position vis-à-vis social and cultural behavior. According to critics, ecologically oriented medical anthropologists treat culture as a mere reflex, or epiphenomenon, of ecological processes. For this reason, they are accused of too seldom placing cultural practice and institutions at the heart of human ecology. This kind of critical anthropological conversation, both inside and outside of medical anthropology, has continued into the early twenty-first century. While 196

Part Three   // The Later Twentieth Century

the literature is voluminous across the various branches of medical anthropology, a shortlist of widely used texts includes David Landy’s edited volume Culture, Disease, and Healing: Studies in Medical Anthropology (1977), Thomas Johnson and Carolyn Sargent’s edited volume Medical Anthropology: A Handbook of Theory and Method (1990), Nancy Scheper-Hughes’s influential ethnography Death Without Weeping:The Violence of Everyday Life in Brazil (1992), and Andrea Sankar’s Dying at Home: A Family Guide for Caregiving (1999).

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What are the theoretical implications of the observation that no one form of knowledge is authoritative? 2. In postmodern theory, what is meant by the term modernity? 3. In 2011, the American Anthropological Association considered removing a description of anthropology as scientific from its LongRange Plan. Was this idea ill-advised? 4. Paul Feyerabend once pronounced that “the best education consists in immunizing people against systematic attempts at education.” What is the theoretical basis of this pronouncement? 5. Are Michel Foucault’s discourses on power satisfactory as a definition of culture? 6. How does Foucault’s account of madness and civilization alter the definitions of science, humanism, and religion set forth in the introduction to this book? 7. Should we question the credibility of Foucault’s views because Foucault himself was a socially powerful expert in the academic community? 8. Explain how the concept of agency figures in the theories of Pierre Bourdieu. 9. Are Bourdieu’s fields satisfactory as a definition of culture? 10. In postmodern terms, what does it mean to deconstruct an anthropological explanation of culture? 11. How many “races” are there? 12. What can or should the ethnographer do if all knowledge of a culture is subjective? 13. If, as critical medical anthropologists assert, medicine is ideological, is it any less effective? 14. What is the biomedical definition of illness?

197

This page intentionally left blank 

PART FOUR

The Early Twenty-First Century

In the early twenty-first century, postmodern theorizing has appeared to plateau, wane, or morph into other theoretical vocabularies, including the vocabulary of globalization, which has been on the rise for the last two decades. At the same time, a trend away from narrow positivism continues, and we now find a deeper engagement than ever before with the dialectics of subjective experience and the performance of social and cultural structure – especially as these emerge in and through the practices, choices, and exclusions of anthropologists themselves. Conspicuous developments in this regard have been the rise of public anthropology (together with a related set of concerns about anthropological ethics and public accountability) and the decolonizing critique in anthropology (which seeks accountability from within the discipline itself). Moreover, research interests have lately been formed in the context of unceasing changes to culture and technology all about us, as tectonic shifts in these seem to occur with increasing regularity. At the broadest level, the rapid globalization of cultural meaning and practice has been the soil in which new ideas ripe for anthropological investigation are cultivated – evidenced below in the discussion of a growing body of work focused on the internet, social media, gaming, and communications technology. In a different vein, the feminist turn combined with unprecedented shifts in public opinion on such topics as sexuality and gender has in recent years spawned new and vibrant areas of anthropological research. Finally, growing recognition of the plight of our planet (and the dire effects of human activity on it) has fostered a new body of critical interdisciplinary theory that seeks to understand nature and humanity’s place in it with fresh eyes: Anthropocene. While the vectors of

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

anthropological activity and theorizing have proliferated exponentially in the early twenty-first century, we endeavor in this section to illuminate some of the main developments.

Globalization Key Words: creolization, globalization, global village, glocalization

globalization The expansion of Western institutions and lifeways into nonWestern cultures and the emergence of new forms of cultural practice that are global in scope.

global village Marshall McLuhan’s term for an increasingly interconnected global society.

A latter-day heir to world-system theory and anthropological political economy, the study of globalization, or “globalization theory,” was one of the most conspicuous bodies of work to derive from the mingling of these perspectives with postmodernity in the 1980s and 1990s. Because the perspective does not so much prescribe a single method or research agenda as it advocates a general outlook, its supporters have been many and diverse. Among the better-known anthropological texts that have been included in this corpus are Modernity at Large:The Cultural Dimensions of Globalization (1996) by Arjun Appadurai (b. 1949); Global Culture: Nationalism, Globalization, and Modernity (1990), edited by Mike Featherstone (b. 1946); and Globalization: Social Theory and Global Culture (1992) by Roland Robertson (b. 1938). In the 1960s, Canadian communications theorist Marshall McLuhan (1911– 80) famously foreshadowed attention to globalization within the social sciences when he speculated that the world was increasingly being homogenized into a “global village” in which the diversity of local cultures was being radically reshaped (and, ultimately, limited) through increasingly advanced and universal systems of communications and travel technology. The “message” conveyed by such technology, he speculated, was in fact identical with the “medium” of its transmission. Hence, societies the world over would inevitably and inexorably become less heterogeneous, forever conditioned by a new global orientation and sensibility. While the most ominous implications of this prediction have yet to be realized, McLuhan’s insight continues to be valuable for anthropologists working in the early twenty-first century. As one of the perspective’s most eloquent exponents, Roland Robertson, has defined it, the phenomenon of globalization describes both an etic “compression of the world” through processes of increased technological, economic, and cultural interdependence and an emic awareness of the transformations stimulated by this interdependence – what he calls an “intensification of consciousness of the world as a whole.” Another way of putting this is that globalization-oriented anthropologists ask what are perhaps the next obvious questions to follow from the ideas pioneered by Frank, Wallerstein, and the anthropological political economists: namely, beyond the imbalances in political and economic power generated by a capitalist world-system, what other sociocultural 200

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

FIGURE 4.1  Stereotyped Tourist: This stereotype embodies some of the globalized expectations that ordinary tourists can take with them to their destinations. Copyright © iwww.istockphoto.com/viki2win.

phenomena do we observe to be consequences of the interpenetration of Western and non-Western cultural worlds, and how are we to characterize and account for these? Infusing these questions with the postmodern concern for individual agency and creativity, students of globalization further inquire how new forms of subjective understanding and reflexivity are produced as a result of these new global forms of interdependence. 201

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

glocalization A term popularized by Roland Robertson to describe the coexistence of globalizing and particularizing tendencies in a society. creolization An anthropological term borrowed from linguistics suggesting the fusion of divergent cultural concepts and practices, particularly in the context of postcolonial and globalization studies.

This collision between the objective forces of the world-system and the capacity of individuals and communities to construct their own worlds socially and subjectively is not easily described, let alone explained. Following its coining by economists, Robertson uses the term “glocalization” to denote the coexistence or co-presence of the universal and the particular in any society. Other terms, such as “creolization,” have been borrowed by anthropologists from linguists to articulate much the same concept. How can anthropologists account, precisely, for this hybridizing tendency? World-system theorists assert that global capitalist expansion involved the progressive interpenetration, mingling, and outright domination of some social and cultural institutions and practices (those of the so-called developing world) by others (those of the so-called developed world). Adding much-needed nuance to this view, anthropological political economy went on to insist that, while such imbalances in power and authority are certainly created by this encounter of the West with the Rest, they are hardly “totalizing,” or wholly determinative, of cultural form and meaning. Through the subjective understanding and activity of local cultural agents, the hegemony of global capitalism is both changed and resisted. The globalization perspective represents a further refinement of these political-economic ideas, one that is leavened by what we might call a cautionary tale of postmodernity: that society and culture cannot simply be reduced to, or “written off ” as, mere effects of a capitalist world-system, no matter how powerful and all-embracing this system might appear from the standpoint of Western eyes. In particular, one insight grounded in this postmodern dictum has been instrumental in shaping globalization theory into a distinctive branch of research in the 1990s and early twenty-first century. This concerns a recognition by many anthropologists that, far from there being a simple reaction to or against the world-system, the “core” of the system is itself transformed through contact with its own “periphery,” so much so, in fact, that it becomes difficult to speak of a single world-system at all. A more exact description would identify a multitude of overlapping, interpenetrating world-systems that shape and condition one another. This “brave new world” sketched by globalization-oriented theorists certainly defies easy description. One useful analogy might be that the world’s societies are now “woven” together culturally, economically, and politically. Like any tapestry or quilt, the threads that make up this global society are stronger in some places and weaker in others.They merge and intertwine to form patterns, colors, and textures that are quite distinct from those of each thread considered independently. It is these overarching patterns and colors, rather than their local variants, that are the new substance of cultural form in a globalizing age. To the extent that it focuses on the character and influence of the linkages that bind localities together across geographical regions, the globalization perspective has shared a concern with anthropological political economy. However, a new 202

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

FIGURE 4.2  Globalized Food: This shop in Hospet, India, sells an eclectic mix of Western and local snacks. Copyright © paul prescott/ Shutterstock.com.

insight introduced by globalization theory is that the linkages do not describe merely a set of objective social, economic, or political relationships between people who are geographically distant from one another. Instead, drawing on the postmodern concern to understand subjectivity and agency, globalization theorists look to the subjective dimensions of this process: how does a growing local awareness of global connections and identity both inspire and lay the foundation for new forms of consciousness, cultural meaning, and social practice? To cite an early and influential example of this perspective, in his pioneering work Imagined Communities (1983), Benedict Anderson (1936–2015) reconstructs the concept of the nation-state from the ground up, effectively arguing that the original European nation-states were “imagined” into being as a result of the postmedieval influence on vernacular languages of what was in the sixteenth century a radically new technology: the print media. Once invented, the exponential dissemination of knowledge, ideas, and language permitted by this new technology empowered local cultural actors both to reflect on the larger political, economic, and cultural processes around them and to develop new perspectives and meanings rooted in the experience of common language and homeland. It is this emphasis on the production of wholly new subjectivities and “systems” that distinguishes globalization-oriented anthropologists from their predecessors in world-system theory.The globalization perspective insists that local cultures are 203

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 4.3  The Globalization of Language: Could this be the world language of the future?

not passively overwritten by or dissolved within that unidirectional, apparently unstoppable, global steamroller known as Western industrial capitalism. More often than not, globalization theory holds, the world’s allegedly peripheral cultures and societies “hegemonize the hegemonizers” by generating new forms of global cultural consciousness whose roots are neither Western nor easily explained by the logic of political-economic expansion.To the contrary, such formerly “peripheral” cultural phenomena as reggae music, Buddhism, Japanese sushi cuisine, ScotsIrish folk dancing, and Native American artwork and sculpture, to cite but a few examples, would all seem to be non-Western cultural exports that are themselves becoming the bases for global cultural practices. This same phenomenon takes place within the “West” as well. Consider, for instance, the replacement in France of the McDonald’s character, Ronald McDonald, with Asterix the Gaul, a popular French character more appealing to the French public, or the decision to serve alcoholic beverages to teenagers in restaurants at Disneyland Paris (“Euro-Disney”), breaking with its American counterparts,Walt Disney World and Disneyland. Such processes have been facilitated in no small measure by the advent of sophisticated electronic media, communication, and travel technologies. These have created a transnational environment in which many different forms of cultural innovation are possible. No longer limited by geopolitical “places” or “homelands,” social movements and organizations as different in their goals as Amnesty International and al Qaeda may both flourish in the “non-place” space of the Internet. Moreover, the expanding possibilities for the movement of people around the world have intensified global phenomena such as tourism and migration. These, and other, movements have been eloquently theorized by Arjun Appadurai as flowing through what he calls ethnoscapes, mediascapes, technoscapes, financescapes, and ideoscapes, which, according to him, are often in unpredictable disjuncture, pregnant with the possibility for creating new cultural forms. Although a bewildering number of human futures appear possible as a result of these developments, one thing does seem all but certain: such transformations are unlikely to slow down at any point in the near future. The same might therefore be said of globalization-oriented anthropology. Conceptually unfettered 204

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

from assumptions about the effects of colonialism, with its tacit opposition of the Western to the non-Western world, and from the regional or national bias of earlier generations of anthropologists, the globalization perspective seems on track to expand the horizon of anthropological research well into the twenty-first century.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Is the world getting bigger or smaller? 2. How does globalization theory draw on the theories of both political economy and postmodernism? 3. Why do you suppose it might be difficult to predict the globalized future?

Culture, Gender, and Sexualities Key Words: berdache, clitoridectomy, intersex, nonbinary, queer, repressive hypothesis, Stonewall Riots, third gender, transgender, Two Spirit In Part Three, we discussed the rise of feminist anthropology as both a body of theoretical innovation and a political project. Over the last several decades, the political priorities of women’s studies and feminist emancipation have been augmented with a theoretical concern for generating a more expansive, inclusive field of scholarship – one that would erode the lingering idea that continuing focus on the feminine, per se, would contribute to “biologizing” gender. At the same time, new awareness of and interest in other forms of gendered identity, in particular transgender identity and masculinities, have led to flourishing areas of research, both within anthropology and in the expanding world of interdisciplinary studies. Concurrently, there has been a rapid rise in interest in sexuality or sexual orientation as a fluid category that incorporates ideas about gender, desire, and sexualized practice. The terms gender and sexuality have each emerged to some degree as distinct domains of analysis. However, pairing them together here is appropriate given the deeply entangled connections between various gendered identities and sexualities. Further, while the investigation of gender grew out of feminist studies, activism, and a growing concern to problematize and historicize cultural meaning, the advent of interest in masculinities and transgender experience among (especially) cultural anthropologists has provoked recognition that such identities are emergent aspects of the human experience and consciousness rather than givens 205

transgender The designation of personal and social identities that do not conform to conventional or normative ideas about appropriate gender and sex roles within a society.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

third gender A widely used term that denotes both the existence of nonbinary gender identities and the general fluidity of gender as a cultural formation. Two Spirit Since 1990, a term used by many Indigenous people in North America to designate individuals in Indigenous societies who elide the gender binary of man−woman. berdache Originally a seventeenthcentury French term designating a younger, submissive partner in a homosexual relationship, referring historically to Indigenous individuals who appeared, from the perspective of French colonizers and others, to be neither men nor women in terms of behavior and appearance.

of nature. Not surprisingly, such insights have spawned new subsets of research interest across the discipline. In this section, we review some of the key aspects of these developments. In recent years, ethnographers and historians have explored the concept of third gender in a variety of societies. Most frequently referred to as “Two Spirit” persons (and formerly referred to as berdache), transgender individuals feature in historical accounts of many Western and Great Plains Indigenous societies and exemplify the shifting, blurry boundaries between cultural constructions of masculinity and femininity. Within the Two Spirit category, anatomical males expressed conventions of female dress and social roles, but not necessarily sexuality (anatomical females adopting male social roles have also been documented, though less frequently). This category of persons, indeterminate by the standards of a rigid Western gender binary, may be said to embody the “two spirits” of males and females. Similar third-gender categories are associated with the Indian hijra and Thai kathoeys – again, these persons are mainly anatomically male but live their lives as women (while generally regarding themselves as neither men nor women). Anthropological research among these and other transgender communities has provoked deep questioning of normative assumptions concerning two genders that mirror two sexes as the natural products of human evolution. Just as significantly, what have until recent years been the unmarked categories of “men” and “masculinities” are now the focus of vibrant research and debate. A pioneer researcher in this field, R.W. Connell (b. 1944) argues that the category of masculinity must be problematized if anthropologists and others are ever to undo destructive, ahistorical assumptions about an innate, essential masculinity that mirrors “traditional” ideas about the feminine in Western culture. For Connell, perspectives on gender that reify as universal frames of knowledge that represent at best 5 per cent (and merely a historical sliver) of humanity is a “startling ethnocentrism” that only fine-grained ethnographic and historical analyses can destabilize. The “cure” she prescribes is sustained pursuit of “local constructions of the masculine” that will help to denaturalize “masculinity” as a reified object, replacing it with a better understanding of how men constitute themselves as a distinct gender in relation to women. In particular, the institutional contexts of these places and practices (especially with respect to the power inflections of the state, workplace, and family) are defining features of what masculinity “is,” rather than mere background. The masculine, in other words, is the historical product of a complex intermingling of institutions and power, external to which it ceases to have meaning as an aspect of cultural being; one cannot, Connell says, “be masculine in a particular way … without affecting the conditions in which that form of masculinity arose: whether to reproduce them, intensify them, or subvert them.” Sexualities have also been among the most vibrant areas of anthropological research over the past several decades. As with so many areas of anthropological interest (from religion to family life), current approaches in this domain of 206

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

research have their origins very early in the professional discipline. From the midnineteenth century, an insatiable Eurocentric fascination with the “primitives” and “savages” went hand in hand with an abiding curiosity about the way in which men and women were imagined in such non-Western contexts. Most especially, ethnocentric speculation stoked a vicarious interest in the sexual practices of these people – with assumptions about unchecked debauchery and “primitive promiscuity” all but taken for granted. Even among respected anthropologists and the publishers of ethnographic monographs, such damaging clichés were tolerated (and occasionally indulged) in order to preserve public interest in the lifeways of others. Perhaps the most famous examples of such mixed motives (if we may call them that) involve the towering figures of Bronislaw Malinowski and Margaret Mead. Arguably, both Malinowski’s The Sexual Life of Savages in North-Western Melanesia (1929) and, especially, Mead’s Coming of Age in Samoa (1928) represent the twilight of this colonial-era pattern.Though these books have been the focus of controversy for various reasons, both have also been acclaimed for their richly textured portraits of non-Western sexual convention. Still, ethnographers though the middle years of the twentieth century grew ever more reluctant to titillate readers and romanticize the “natives.” Clearly, then, early interest in human sexuality among anthropologists fell squarely within the domain of the voyeuristic. In terms of “serious” research, until the 1970s human sexuality had been largely styled an evolutionary (and hence “natural”) mechanism designed to reproduce the species. Much of this was transformed through the revolutionary social theory of historian-philosopher Michel Foucault, whom we discussed in Part Three. Foucault’s perspective on the historical contingency and variability of an ostensibly universal “natural” human sexuality has continued to be important for anthropologists and others (Connell, discussed above, is one example). Perhaps his best-known contribution to the study of human sexuality is his discussion of what is sometimes referred to as the repressive hypothesis. According to this perspective, the open expression of sexual desire, pleasure, and practices in European modernity has been subject to an increasingly rigorous series of disciplining practices since at least the eighteenth-century Enlightenment. Specifically, this widely disseminated discourse confined “legitimate” sexual expression to the sphere of domestic marriage, while simultaneously excluding from overt expression the many other varieties of sexual desire and behavior increasingly positioned as “deviant.”Within this regime of surveillance, “non-natural” sexuality had a very small number of outlets through which it could be addressed; notably, prostitution (which aimed to conceal improper sexual acts) and psychiatry (which aimed to discipline the mind/body) provided socially recognized institutions where deviance could be articulated. In his writing, Foucault interrogates the assumption that such social management and control has been as pervasive as is widely assumed – particularly in light of the fact that there seems, embedded in the discourse of repression itself, a preoccupation with sexuality and its expressions. 207

repressive hypothesis  A conventional term for the historical process in which ideas about “normal” sexual expression came to have social power over sexual behavior and mores in Western society.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Stonewall Riots A series of spontaneous civil protests by gay and lesbian activists in the wake of a June 1969 police raid on the Stonewall Inn, a gay nightclub in the Greenwich Village district of New York City.

queer Originally a nineteenth-century pejorative for samesex relationships and desires, the term has been “reclaimed” in recent decades as an umbrella concept for non-heteronormative perspectives, politics, and academics. intersex Refers to individuals born with an atypical blend of genetic and phenotypical sex characteristics, the combination of which is not fully described in conventional sex nomenclature. nonbinary Refers to individuals who identify with neither conventional masculine nor conventional feminine social roles. clitoridectomy A rite of passage still practiced in some societies in which adolescent females are forced to undergo excision of their clitoris, frequently justified on the grounds of religion.

While many aspects of Foucault’s ideas have been contested, his assertion that ideas connected with sex and sexuality are not natural but have a history that can be “excavated” has endured. His view has been adopted by many postmodern and post-structural theorists who interrogate the meaning and origins of taken-forgranted concepts. Following developments in social theory and historical episodes such as the 1969 Stonewall Riots in New York City, new interest in sexuality – its history and social effects – emerged from many quarters. In the United States and other Western democracies, a more sophisticated and mature understanding of human sexuality and its diversities has grown alongside fast-moving developments (both in culture and in law) in the area of ensuring civil rights for gay Americans. In the twenty-first century, the more inclusive and increasingly ethnicized designation LGBT (lesbian, gay, bisexual, and transgender) signals the ongoing importance of Foucault’s insight into the historical contingency of sexuality. In recent years, the fluidity of this concept has been marked by changes to the initialism to render it still more inclusive. Currently LGBTQ, which adds “queer” to the designation, is widely used, while a still more inclusive concept, LGBTQIA, adds “intersex” and “asexual” (while at least implying another term, “nonbinary”).That these otherwise separate orientations and characteristics have been collapsed into a contiguous concept reflects a political commonality between those who identify with each – to varying degrees, all continue to be stigmatized as, at a minimum, non-standard expressions of sexual identity and belonging. In cruder frames of reference, they are even styled as unnatural and immoral. It is this connection that makes for “natural allies” among them. Beginning in the early 2000s, the term queer itself became a preferred term in the description of non­binary, non-normative sexual politics and has served as the foundation for a variety of social, political, and academic movements. For many anthropologists, documenting the lives and struggles of people stigmatized and marginalized for their sexualities remains the most pressing issue in ethnography. For others, “deviant” sexual practices (such as those characteristic of the BDSM [bondage, discipline, sadomasochism] community) provide a focus. Still others are deeply involved in political debates about sexuality that turn on such issues as same-sex marriage, women’s rights in the areas of sexuality and reproduction, the international AIDS crisis, clitoridectomy (sometimes inaccurately called “female circumcision”), prostitution, and sex trafficking. Of arguably equal importance in the anthropological study of sexualities is the domain of the so-called normal. While those sexualities that have been historically and culturally stigmatized as “unnatural” or “deviant” have understandably received the lion’s share of attention from scholars, Foucault’s reasoning alerts us to the dangers inherent in allowing some forms (for instance, the Western idealization of heterosexual, romantic monogamy) to remain unmarked – that is, the baseline of normality from which all other forms deviate. That such “natural” proclivities remain understudied is perhaps a reflection of contemporary political imperatives, 208

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

but their general absence from study and problematizing obscures the cultural foundations of sexual hegemony in many societies. Therefore, we believe that much in the same way that a concern for the formation of masculinities came to be incorporated within a more inclusive domain of gender analysis, heterosexualities will eventually become of interest in a discipline that prides itself on challenging cultural conventions and the simplistic understanding of the natural. Far from being discrete strains of activity, many or all of these issues are combined in the research of various scholar-activists. Given that most of these foci are inflected by considerations of gender, race, religion, language, international and domestic law, kinship, medicine, human rights, and other dimensions and institutions of culture, they reflect the broadest sweep of anthropological priorities today.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. What does the existence of a third gender or Two Spirit identity in a number of societies suggest about the traditional ideas about the man−woman binary? 2. How important do you think the “repressive hypothesis” has been in Western culture? Is Foucault correct to think that repression is itself evidence of cultural preoccupation with the sexual? 3. Do you think it is important to devote more study to ostensibly “normal” heterosexual identities as well as non-traditional ones, and why?

Public Anthropology Key Words: Center for a Public Anthropology, Cultural Survival, Cultural Survival Quarterly, public anthropology The twenty-first century has witnessed a new (or renewed) approach to doing anthropology in which practitioners set themselves apart from their “cloistered” academic cousins. Public anthropology, as it has been styled, represents a fresh effort to engage with issues, debates, and situations as they unfold in and apply to the proverbial “real world.” Louise Lamphere credits David Maybury-Lewis (1929–2007) and Pia Maybury-Lewis (1926–2015) for having the vision and foresight to see the potential for anthropology to engage in real-world struggles for social and environmental justice as early as 1972, when they co-founded (along with Evon Z. Vogt Jr. [1918–2004] and Orlando Patterson [b. 1940]) the non-­ governmental organization Cultural Survival. In a prescient move (see below), 209

public anthropology  An anthropology primarily and directly engaged with issues of concern to the general public, rather than to anthropologists alone. Cultural Survival  Co-founded in 1972 by David Maybury-Lewis and Pia Maybury-Lewis, Cultural Survival is a non-governmental organization that globally advocates for Indigenous peoples’ rights and culture.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Cultural Survival Quarterly Formerly the Cultural Survival Newsletter, Cultural Survival Quarterly is the main periodical publication of the Cultural Survival NGO. It features essays by scholars and Indigenous writers on topics related to Indigenous peoples’ rights around the world. Center for a Public Anthropology A non-profit institution founded in 2001 by Robert Borofsky that promotes the application of anthropological method and theory to addressing and resolving “public problems in public ways.”

these anthropologists recognized a rapid deterioration in the living conditions of the Shavante Indians of central Brazil and determined to found an organization dedicated to promoting and protecting both Amazonian peoples and Indigenous rights around the world. The work undertaken by the organization they created includes such initiatives as partnering with Indigenous activists to implement cooperatives and language programs, assisting in leadership and work training, engaging state-level institutions (including the US Senate) in order to defend Indigenous land rights, and documenting and publicizing the plight of Indigenous peoples by way, initially, of the Cultural Survival Newsletter, and, in recent years, through a high-profile website and the newsletter’s successor, the journal Cultural Survival Quarterly. Lampere holds that Cultural Survival laid the groundwork for ethics and engagement that would come to embody what is now generally called “public” (or, by some, “engaged”) anthropology. The origins of this moniker itself are somewhat uncertain, but it is commonly suggested that the phrase “public anthropology” was coined (or at least adopted) by Robert Borofsky (b. 1944), a professor at Hawai’i Pacific University. Regardless of its provenance, it is clear that from the late 1990s Borofsky has played a pivotal role in framing this new approach to anthropology. Though prolific on the topic generally, he is perhaps best known for founding, in 2001, the Center for a Public Anthropology. It is by way of this largely online center, which disseminates the majority of its perspectives, findings, and publications via its website (publicanthropology.org), that interest in this field of activity (to call it a subfield would be very premature) has been broadcast.

Development and Controversy Key Words: California Series in Public Anthropology, ivory tower The genesis of Borofsky’s idea for a center lies in his own experience of writing ethnography that sought, according to the center’s website, to “reframe the opposition between indigenous and Western perspectives on Pacific history.” Despite glowing reviews and a sense that his book – Remembrance of Pacific Pasts: An Invitation to Remake History (2000) – might have and perhaps should have had more public impact than it did, the book, like so many ethnographic monographs, eventually faded from the already overcrowded book stalls and academic catalogs. Borofsky concluded that dissemination of academic research and theory in the traditional academic marketplace was insufficient to raise the profile of a discipline already associated by many with the exotic, the quaint, and (ultimately) the trivial.What was needed, he reflected, were “collaborative structures that pushed … ideas forward.” The center owes its origins, also, to the bitter controversy surrounding journalist Patrick Tierney’s 2000 book Darkness in El Dorado: How Scientists and 210

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

Journalists Devastated the Amazon. In this work, Tierney made a variety of scandalous (even libelous) accusations against well-known anthropologist Napoleon Chagnon and geneticist James Neel (1915–2000), among others, whose conduct among the Yanomami, Tierney wrote, was part of a broader effort by the US government to conduct secret experiments on human subjects. Chagnon and Neel, it was claimed, deliberately infected the Yanomami with a vaccine that caused or exacerbated an outbreak of lethal measles in what amounted to an act of genocide. Other claims were made about other Amazon-based researchers that claimed an array of sexual improprieties. In the wake of this disciplinary scandal, deep investigation by the American Anthropological Association, the National Academy of Sciences, Brazilian officials, and others, uniformly concluded that the vast majority of Tierney’s claims were so unsubstantiated as to constitute fraud if not outright fiction; today, Tierney’s book is often cited as an example of the worst form of journalistic slander. All that said, one of the few elements of Tierney’s claims that proved to be true concerned a bargain that Chagnon said he struck with the Yanomami to exchange various goods for blood that would be used for biomedical research on diseases that directly affected them – especially the measles. In the event, this agreement did not happen. The blood, removed in 1967 to a number of research laboratories in the US, was kept refrigerated for decades before being subject to genetic testing in the 1990s. In the early 2000s, the Yanomami became aware that their blood was still being kept and experimented on – a fact that horrified them, as such conduct was anathema to their custom that all a deceased person’s physical remains and possessions be disposed of. Borofsky and others became aware (because of the scandal) that anthropology as a discipline had a stake in any resolution to this problem. This theft (for it may be called that) took place under the radar of public opinion, but the Tierney scandal had made the discipline’s reputation headline news. A large part of how Borofsky approached building public anthropology thus proceeded in the shadow of scandal. Among the center’s most impressive accomplishments has been a multi-year lobbying to have those blood samples taken by the US returned to the Yanomami. After years of legal wrangling and international diplomacy, this finally took place in 2015. Repatriation of these samples (2,693 vials in all) has almost certainly been among the most important accomplishments for anthropologists seeking to redress a checkered past while at the same time consolidating the value of anthropology in the public sphere. Beyond this important accomplishment, the center has advanced its goals by way of a variety of distinctive projects, each of which has been designed to address lacunae in the relationship between the discipline of anthropology and its many publics. Arguably the most important current function of the center (and one that seems more “academic” than the others) is the California Series in Public Anthropology. This book series represents a collaboration between Borofsky’s 211

California Series in Public Anthropology  A book series started in 2001 by Robert Borofsky and published by the University of California Press. The series is devoted to promoting and disseminating work by anthropologists who are “engaged intellectuals” and to recasting how a public readership interprets issues of social importance.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

ivory tower A euphemistic and usually pejorative term for the academy or universities.

center and the University of California Press, a major publisher of academic texts in anthropology. Other projects of recent vintage include a series of blogs that address a variety of topical issues in anthropology (generally by way of interviews with and discussions among high-profile anthropologists). Also, a community action (website) project is intended as an online seminar for students from a wide range of colleges and universities. The general ambition has been to train students how to think and write (by way of peer-reviewed op-ed pieces) about how anthropology might effectively engage the contemporary world and its bewildering array of problems (for instance, climate change). It is hoped that to the extent they are disseminated and published, these opinion pieces help to shape public opinion and institutional conduct both inside and outside of anthropology. Other initiatives include a blog featuring a number of discussion threads and interviews; the Metrics Project, which enumerates anthropological publications of public interest and significance; an archive of introductory-level film-lectures on anthropology; and (in a pivot away from anthropology toward educational assessment and training) a college-level “Assessment of Core Educational Proficiencies” presented as a relatively inexpensive means of evaluating critical-thinking,­ problem–solving, and writing skills. Past projects include the 2006 Public Outreach Ranking in Anthropology, intended as an evaluative tool to assess and rank-order departments with doctoral programs according to their degree of commitment to public outreach, and the 2013 Faculty Media Impact Project, which compiled a list of anthropological citations in non-disciplinary publications. Over the course of two decades, the center has certainly been a very highprofile purveyor of work by public anthropologists. If one is to judge by the array of conferences, new graduate programs, prizes and fellowships, and a section of the American Anthropological Association (to say nothing of peer-reviewed publications), then interest in public anthropology as a domain of professional activity has certainly grown. The site is slick, attractive, and eminently anthropological – featuring as it does a variety of images of ethnographic interlocutors who generally (and perhaps ironically, for an organization that strikes a non-traditional stance) fit traditional ideas about those non-white and developing world peoples with whom ethnographers are historically associated. Be that as it may, the center’s laudable mission statement – one that can be applied to public anthropology writ large – is to encourage scholarship that confronts “public problems in public ways” and transcends the conventional “do no harm paradigm” in order to “serve the common good (as it is generally defined) and especially the communities anthropologists work with in their research.” As such, the body of work subsumed within public anthropology cannot be considered innovative in sociocultural theory, both in approach and, as it were, “packaging” – unless, of course, one takes a very loose perspective on theory in which rending the frontier between the ivory tower and the public can itself be considered a theoretical orientation. 212

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

Distinguishing Public from Applied Anthropology Key Words: applied anthropology, cultural resource management (CRM), eugenicist, museological, neoliberal economics, truthy In an essay marking a decade of the center’s existence, David Vine writes of Borofsky that broad sympathy for his objectives coalesced as “a much-needed antidote for a discipline many thought had become insular, often incomprehensible, and generally irrelevant to the lives and struggles of most people.” While these characterizations are understandable, given the generally cloistered history of academic disciplines, they have also been considered by many to be wildly misleading. Many in the eclectic and hardy “fifth subfield” of applied anthropology, for instance, took umbrage with their apparent invisibility, and consequent marginality, as the perspective evolved. It would seem clear that the differences between “applied” and “public” approaches are not always self-evident from an external perspective. According to Louise Lamphere, what they share are the goals of collaboration and partnership with Indigenous “stakeholders,” an ambition to influence policy formation at various governmental levels (from the nation-state to the municipal), and a concern for outreach to a public that still imagines the work of anthropologists to be limited to exotica and what Michel-Rolph Trouillot (1914–2012) has scathingly referred to as the “savage slot.” For the self-declared public anthropologist, therefore, stakeholders both within and outside of higher education are part of a larger project that, as Trevor Purcell says, “directly and indirectly [contributes] to the general good – not just to the academic or career good.” Anthropologists conduct their daily lives “as the embodiment of sociopolitical participation.” They are, in this view, direct heirs to the postmodern controversy of the 1980s and 1990s during which, in Ben Feinberg’s enigmatic characterization, “debates within the discipline involved tearing at our own flesh and flaunting the sackcloth of self-doubt” while “we sparred with each other and devoured our elders in the hidden corners and footnotes of obscure journals.” Public anthropology aims to transcend the academic by becoming relevant in ways that other social sciences (especially sociology and economics) have long since taken for granted. This call to action is not simply a new trend in how anthropologists manage their professional lives. If it were, discussion of public anthropology would not be justified in a volume about theory. The goal of scholars advocating a public orientation is more subtle than this, and it has deep implications for social and cultural theory. The question of who constitutes this “public” is central. The adjective does not refer simply to the wider world outside the hallowed halls of academia. Rather, the notion of what counts as public is set within the context both of anthropology as a distinctive historical product and event within Euro-American scholarship and of anthropologists as distinctive agents in the formation and propagation of knowledge about human beings. 213

applied anthropology  Anthropology conducted by anthropologists working outside traditional academic settings such as universities.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

museological  Pertaining to museology, the academic discipline focusing on museum organization, management, and cultural representation. cultural resource management (CRM) Activities that share the practical goal of protecting and preserving objects and places deemed to be of cultural significance.

Anthropologists have now recognized and “owned up to” the discipline’s role in (among other things) supporting colonialism, justifying ethnocentrism, and reifying differences between the sexes. It seems clear that, at the very least, twenty-first-century anthropologists will no longer be uncritical of their own biases and assumptions. Instead, the globalizing world of free markets, homogenizing popular culture, and techno-rationalizing industry to which we all are rapidly, if differently, becoming witness places anthropologists and anthropology squarely within a network of global movements, debates, and conversations. Anthropologists are, in other words, part of the public – not elevated above it as lofty observers. It is in their capacity as members of the public that they participate, bringing the professional skills and critical insights of anthropology to the wider world. Rather than submit to professional imperatives that buy “respectability” and “esteem” by acceding to careerism (for example, by jumping the many hoops of the tenure system) and unspoken assumptions about the authoritative status of doctorates and the professoriate, anthropologists, as those promoting a public orientation assert, must engage the lived and eminently political struggles of their subjects – now peers and no longer the mere objects of their scrutiny (we revisit this issue below in the World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology section). Consequently, to the holy grail of positivist science Borofsky extends the following olive branch: objectivity, he writes, is to be found “less in the pronouncement of authorities than in the conversation among concerned parties.” So what does this mean, exactly, for the work of anthropologists seeking to cultivate a “public” orientation? It means, first of all, that the work of the anthropologist must disdain all notion of objectivity and distance, putting into practice those principles advanced in the canons of postmodern, feminist, and globalization theory. In practical terms, realizing this ideal involves recognizing that anthropologists are neither unbiased nor dispassionate observers, nor should they be. Public anthropology proposes that anthropologists, like any other sector of society, are morally and ethically accountable for the subjects of their study, a responsibility that cannot simply be wished away by laying claim to the old chestnuts of objectivity and relativism.To the contrary, anthropologists must by definition be activists and interventionists – seeking, as Karl Marx once observed in a critique of philosophy, to change rather than merely interpret the world. They must bring their expertise and skill to the public and political arenas of popular (that is, accessible) writing, community action, and policy formation, as well as to the “traditional” areas of applied research: the medical, corporate, museological, and cultural resource management (CRM) sectors. While anthropologists have of course “doubled” as activists for generations (within American anthropology, Franz Boas and Margaret Mead are conspicuous examples), anthropological theory itself has seldom if ever been scrutinized in this way, save in the wishful musings of prescient scholars such as Sherry Ortner (b. 1941), who in a (now) classic 1984 essay on the 214

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

history of anthropology advocates for a practice-oriented approach in which such binaries as theory and action are reconsidered. The public anthropologist is not the “opposite” of the academic anthropologist but a public intellectual engaged in important debates and controversies of concrete significance for the world in which he or she lives. One main difference, then, between applied and public anthropology is that the latter in a sense calls upon a far greater ethical commitment on the part of researchers. Ironically, this focus has sometimes put public anthropologists at odds with other applied or “practicing” anthropologists. Many of these, especially those trained in the more positivistic or quantitatively oriented branches of the discipline, retain a sense that anthropologists are scientists in search of objective knowledge. Precisely because it insists that moral accountability is part of the anthropological enterprise by definition, public anthropology calls into question venerable canons of method. While many (but not all) sociocultural anthropologists have long been accustomed to interrogating the interpretive and subjective aspects of their practice, many biological and archaeological anthropologists have not, paving the way for a fresh rift between the subfields over questions of method, epistemology, and purpose. It is important to note that while these trends exist and persist, many positivist anthropologists do acknowledge responsibility to their subjects in many official and unofficial ways, even while stopping short of embracing the revolution in theoretical perspective called for by public anthropology. Another way in which we might frame this is that a significant difference between “public” and “applied” approaches concerns the positioning of researchers relative to the contexts and foci of their work; that is, many applied anthropologists work within institutions, while many public anthropologists work outside these. Many forays into public anthropology are thus decidedly and self-consciously critical; that is, they are not beholden to employers and do not accept at face value the goals, perspectives, and claims to benevolence of “official” stakeholders (such as governments, corporations, and medical industries). Instead, they seek ways to challenge underlying logics and inequities built in to such systems, and in many cases they speak on behalf of those most vulnerable to hierarchies of power and authority. A volume edited by Catherine Besteman and Hugh Gusterson is a good example. In Why America’s Top Pundits Are Wrong: Anthropologists Talk Back (2005), Besteman and Gusterson invite readers to reconsider the role of the pundit in American society. The authors show that popular and populist writers, journalists, and on-air personalities do not so much engage in meaningful examination of controversial issues as reproduce simplistic and long-cherished notions about social and cultural evolution, biological determinism, the timelessness of traditional society, and the intractable character of ethnic and religious animosities. That such ideas have long since been refuted in anthropological writing is itself evidence, they argue, that the scholarly community has involved itself far too little in cultivating a more nuanced perspective among the wider public. In what amounts to a continuation of colonial practice, 215

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

neoliberal economics  A form of politicaleconomic ideology in which governments promote competition among businesses within a capitalist market theoretically free of state oversight.

eugenicist Pertaining to eugenics, the nowdiscredited science that endeavored to “improve” humanity through selective breeding. truthy A satirical term coined by television personality Stephen Colbert to describe the implicit acceptance of a proposition where logic dictates otherwise or where there is a seeming lack of supporting evidence.

the world’s powers treat developing and war-torn states as so many unruly children who will “mature” only through the firm and benevolent hand of Western-style democracy, neoliberal economics, and military coercion. Seemingly outside this process, well-known pundits and public intellectuals – agents of political, economic, and cultural establishments – are mythmakers who persuade by providing their positions with the veneer of scientism: an elite discourse in which readers are invited to participate and which offers sure cognitive “satisfaction” by virtue of its paintby-numbers explanations. Certain kinds of experts who have marshaled particular bodies of “facts” receive copious funding from politically and socially conservative organizations while, in the absence of such support, dissenting viewpoints recede into the horizon. By way of example, Besteman and Gusterson cite the well-known 1994 study The Bell Curve, by Richard J. Herrnstein and Charles Murray, in which intelligence among the American public is treated as the outcome of differential gene distribution. Left unsaid, much of the funding for hereditarian studies such as this is supplied from the coffers of formerly eugenicist organizations such as the Pioneer Fund, mentioned earlier in our biology of behavior discussion. Objectivity, empirical validation, and truth thus become the products of ideological jostling and the politics of knowledge. According to faux pundit Stephen Colbert’s withering satire, the “knowledge” deriving from such studies is not so much truth as “truthy.” Public anthropologists, the authors maintain, can play an important role in distinguishing the truth from the truthy, the inclusively scientific from the exclusively mythological. Indeed, if anthropologists are to descend from their ivory towers to inhabit the conflicted world of subjects and objects, they have an obligation to do so.

Debating Fieldwork Ethics and the Military Key Words: Human Terrain System (HTS)

Human Terrain System (HTS) From 2007 to 2015, a United States army program in which servicepersons trained across a range of social scientific fields studied civilian populations in regions where the army was deployed, in order to advise military leaders on how best to engage and communicate with these populations, broadly supporting the goals of counterinsurgency.

Another highly controversial public engagement within contemporary anthropology was a debate about the application of ethnographic and other social scientific methods to counterinsurgency operations in areas where the United States and its allies have fought wars, most recently in Afghanistan and Iraq. In particular, a United States army initiative begun in the late 2000s called the Human Terrain System (HTS) was a lightning rod for heated debate and, in many cases, hyperbolic rhetoric. In many ways, the HTS controversy shed a bright light on the difficulties separating the public and “critical” from the applied and “collaborative.” While the goals and means of HTS had almost certainly been in flux since its inception, its professed ambition was to “win the hearts and minds” by deploying into theaters of war a corps of social scientists (not exclusively anthropologists) whose primary purpose was to carry out “operationally relevant socio-cultural research and analysis.” Less prosaically, the program attempted to forge understanding and cooperation 216

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

between local peoples and the United States military. In this way, it was hoped, the potentially devastating effects of miscommunication and the “collateral damage” it brings might be avoided. At its core, the assumption behind HTS was that solid appreciation for and knowledge of cross-cultural difference hold the key to defusing some elements of conflict in war zones. In the program, pre-deployment soldiers and civilian workers received several months of training on topics such as regional culture, social scientific method and theory, and regional language. Often, these men and women had little or no prior education in such topics prior to entering the program. The theoretical foundations of this training were, to be charitable, modest – involving little more than prescribing short-term “hanging out” with and talking to local peoples about their concerns and ambitions. While quantifying the effects of the training on which this work was scaffolded has been difficult (especially with the passage of time), advocates insist that the program forged at least some level of mutual respect between US soldiers and the peoples with whom they interacted while deployed and – more to the point – that it mitigated avoidable civilian casualties and other harmful events. Not surprisingly, however, the HTS program endured a firestorm of withering criticism from many within the anthropological establishment who dismissed it as a cynical tool of neocolonialism.These critics argued that HTS provided cover and even legitimacy for espionage operations that contravened basic ethical obligations among anthropologists to do no harm to one’s fieldwork respondents.They argued with some justification that the United States military establishment and intelligence agencies have a track record of manipulating social science for purposes that have little or nothing to do with assisting Indigenous people or learning about other cultures. It is a matter of public record that during the time of the HTS program there were indeed examples of abject failure – from allegations of entrenched sexism and criminal behavior to the tragic and perhaps avoidable deaths of HTS members in the line of duty. Yet supporters point out that such failures cast into sharp relief the need for a civilian academic establishment to engage more deeply with military and intelligence agencies in order to help avoid such tragedies. To withdraw one’s expertise and willingness to engage in dialogue with the military, Department of State, and Department of Defense, such reasoning goes, is tantamount to throwing in the towel: an admission of failure to inform how US foreign policy is designed and implemented. Some among the program’s defenders argue that to withhold anthropological insight and perspective from deploying soldiers is to simultaneously perpetuate a dearth of basic cross-cultural knowledge among soldiers and to uphold an elitist order of United States society in which some enjoy the moral rectitude and status of cultural critics while less fortunate others “get their hands dirty.” In this brief discussion, it is impossible to resolve issues that are, perhaps, intractable. A more germane question for the purposes of this book is whether HTS was a good example of public anthropology. Certainly, it sought to be applied anthropology – but as we note above, this is far from obviously the 217

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

FIGURE 4.4  Social Science on the Front Line: In April 2010, psychologist and Human Terrain System (HTS) member Dr. Richard R. Boone interviewed local residents of the Barak District in Afghanistan’s Logar province to find out about their daily lives. Anthropologist members of the HTS performed similar functions. Photograph by Staff Sgt. Donald Reeves. Image courtesy of DVIDS.

same thing.The infusion of concern over ethical standards and goals within anthropology and the engagement of anthropologists with the public sphere are what drive this and other controversies yet to come. How may the discipline reasonably respond to conflicting imperatives? On the one hand, anthropology’s shared cornerstones of cultural relativism and commitments to transparency and to the welfare and interests of field informants would seem to preclude putting anthropologists’ skills and training in the service of institutions – such as the military and intelligence communities – that do not always appear to share these goals. There is also great value in preserving anthropology’s traditional independence as a source of cultural observation and criticism; in the final analysis, the HTS program did not allow for this – surely a significant problem in terms of its ultimate dénouement.

Serving a Global Public Key Words: ethnohydrology, United Nations General Assembly Happily, the examples of anthropologists working productively and (one hopes) harmoniously in the public domain are now legion. Although these incorporate a wide range of interests, among the most prominent (and compelling) have 218

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

been those that seek to engage and mitigate the massive, global problems associated with human destruction of ecologies and depletion of resources. To cite but one example, an intriguing initiative along these lines has been the Global Ethnohydrology Study co-created by anthropologist Amber Wutich (b. 1978), a professor at Arizona State University. In this interdisciplinary study, Wutich has ethnographically investigated cultural knowledge, norms, and values concerning water – a splinter field of anthropological scholarship called ethnohydrology. In this work, water is studied as a vital resource that has been taken for granted but that is now imperiled by various factors (ranging from urbanization to climate change). One attendant assumption, grounded in contemporary culture theory, is that ecology and ecological process exist in a mutually constitutive dynamic with social and cultural worlds and that the “meanings” and practices associated with water inevitably vary depending on context. Although the study began in the desert climate of Arizona, an ongoing goal has been to expand beyond the local and regional to develop a deep cross-cultural understanding of how water availability and use intersects with culture, health, and (crucially) climate change and sustainability. At the broadest level, the project has sought to partner with various stakeholders to better understand and identify solutions for an alarming deepening of water insecurity especially as it relates to households across the world. The “public” significance of this public anthropology could not be more apparent. In 2010, the United Nations General Assembly recognized the human right to clean water and sanitation and drafted a resolution calling on nation-states and other organizations active in international development to provide financing and resources to the end of meeting this ambition. Having created a cross-cultural scale for the evaluation of water insecurity, implemented by way of a survey tool designed for application in a variety of social environments, Wutich and her research partners were able, in fairly rapid order, to identify an unanticipated cultural phenomenon, which she refers to as “water-sharing.” An unofficial economic institution (and one all but absent in the water-related scholarship to that point), water-sharing involves sharing the risks of water insecurity among households in regions subject to chronic water insecurity. In particular, Wutich and her colleagues looked at eight sites in sub-Saharan Africa where watersharing practices had been part of grassroots subsistence strategies – conditioned by such considerations as kinship, ethnicity, religion, and residential proximity. In this study, researchers observed that neighbors were more likely to share with one another than with kin (perhaps because of the physical demands involved in carrying water) and that such exchanges were typically styled as “gifts” for which no reciprocal (or perhaps delayed reciprocal) action was expected. The ethics of such gifting were found to turn on a cultural and religious norm in which water was inextricably bound to the idiom of life itself. Significantly, another finding was that households with less water were more likely to share than houses with more water – perhaps 219

ethnohydrology The ethnographic study of how people think about, use, and manage water and water resources.

United Nations General Assembly The General Assembly is the central policy-making body of the United Nations, and the only UN body in which all member states have equal representation.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

because it was the very lack of this vital resource driving the need to share in the first place. Paradoxically, households with greater access to water tended to share it less, perhaps highlighting a desire to avoid entering into social relations where such exchanges created relations of social indebtedness and exploitative relations among neighbors and kin that could conceivably jeopardize important social networks. In pointing out the potential risks to such networks that could result from ignoring such grassroots redistributive practices – perhaps in favor of formal water provision – Wutich and her colleagues have made an important contribution to raising the profile of anthropology as relevant to managing a significant global problem. Just as importantly, the creation of a survey-based method for measuring water insecurity gives development specialists and other actors a powerful tool with which to track and evaluate water availability in developing states. For these reasons, it is hoped that their work presages increased support for cooperative strategies that address the issue of water availability in a wide variety of social and cultural spaces. As these examples attest, for anthropology to have any role in the generation and promotion of public policy, perhaps especially in the domains of natural resource management and national defense, many believe that the discipline must be a part of the process and not stand aloof – willing to criticize but unwilling to engage. What could or should this engagement look like? If anthropologists and other academics are indeed accountable to the “public,” which public do they serve? Mainstream American opinion? The cloistered and often arcane public of the anthropology profession? The sundry publics of field research (who often care little about ethnographic ambitions)? How do anthropologists thread this needle? This brief foray into the complex fields of public engagement should serve to illustrate just how far from cut and dried such issues can be, and consequently how difficult a meaningful public anthropology is to construct.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Do you expect most public anthropologists to be politically conservative or liberal? 2. In public anthropology, is it problematic that the boundary between an anthropologist’s professional and personal lives might blur? 3. How many anthropology publics are there? 4. Why do you suppose anthropology remains relatively little known or understood by the public? 5. Why do you suppose so many people find it easier to accept truthy rather than truthful statements?

220

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

6. Do you think that, these days, anthropologists are spending too much time on ethical issues? 7. Did the United States army’s HTS program qualify as public anthropology, and why did it prove so controversial among anthropologists? 8. What role did controversy over Patrick Tierney’s book Darkness in El Dorado play in the formation of a more publicly oriented anthropology? 9. How might the Global Ethnohydrology Study raise the profile of anthropology as a publicly engaged field of experience? 10. What kind of controversy in anthropology would draw the most attention from the public?

World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology The turn toward a more introspective and self-critical discipline has had a number of consequences for how the history of social and cultural anthropology is theorized and presented in classrooms, textbooks, and elsewhere. One of the more significant lacunae (made more so by its retrospectively obvious “elephant in the room” quality) has been the near absence in the “mainstream” discipline of nonWestern anthropologies as a focus for discussion. This problem may be considered in two ways: first, as a function of the Anglo-American ascendancy over other professional anthropological traditions as practiced in “first-world” nation-states, and second, as a consequence of excluding Indigenous peoples and their voices from the creation of anthropological texts. Each of these will be considered in turn.

National Traditions and the Dominance of Anglo-America Key Words: anglocentrism, G.I. Bill, Russian social anthropology, world anthropologies To begin, the field of social and cultural anthropology has been saturated with perspectives and theoretical orientations derived largely from the distinctively national traditions of Anglo-North America, France, and to some extent Germany (by way of Max Weber’s latter-day influence and Franz Boas’s espousal of ethnological neo-Kantianism). While it is well known among scholars that other schools and orientations exist (for instance, in Russia, Japan, India, and Brazil), 221

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

anglocentrism  A privileging of the Anglo-American English language as a global medium of communication and patterns of cultural practice and consumption, tending to marginalize other languages and those who use them. world anthropologies  A term referring to the existence or potential existence of different forms of anthropological theory and professional practice, rooted in different cultural and linguistic traditions around the world. G.I. Bill Technically the Serviceman’s Readjustment Act, the General Infantry Bill implemented in the United States in 1944 in order to provide various benefits to veterans of World War II, including subsidized tuition and living expenses for veterans wishing to attend college or vocational school.

awareness of these has been generally slow to develop. Even their very existence tends to be muted in journals and monographs where the work of anthropological “Others” has been largely a question of footnotes and other de rigueur citations. How are we to explain the absence of this body of scholarship from disciplinary discourse, and more importantly what steps can be taken to integrate alternative national traditions into the fold of a global, non-parochial anthropology? To answer this question, it is of course important to remember that language plays a crucial role in making any discourse (academic or otherwise) accessible. While a comprehensive account of the twentieth-century ascendency of Anglo-American English is well beyond the scope of this book, it is clear that the emergence of English as the international language of commerce, diplomacy, media, popular entertainment, and scholarship has been a significant factor in elevating the profile of specifically British- or American-rooted anthropologies to more conspicuous positions relative to other national or non-Western traditions. This elevation has also to some extent encompassed “peripheral” states such as Canada, Australia, South Africa, Kenya, and India, where English is either one or the only official language. What we might call anglocentrism continues in the present day and is made possible by international geopolitics and cultural globalization, in which the English language has assumed a pivotal position in directing international public tastes, patterns of economic consumption, and ideas about prestige. Furthermore, use of a common language has made it possible for students and professionals hailing from Britain, the United States, and the British Commonwealth to attend or work in colleges and universities on both sides of the Atlantic Ocean, thus deepening and strengthening relations within anglophone anthropology, too often to the exclusion of other varieties. In sum, and as globally relevant as they remain in other respects, Russian, Spanish, Portuguese, Japanese, Chinese, and a host of more regional tongues remain at the linguistic periphery of anthropological theory and research. Another important factor in the unequal emergence of world anthropologies concerns the expansion of the North American academy itself. In the United States, a growing manufacturing economy after 1945, combined with an unprecedented demand for post-secondary education (driven by the G.I. Bill, which made college-level education accessible to returning veterans), made the United States the site of a burgeoning academic industry. Compared with a handful of private colleges and universities early in the twentieth century, today there are over 4,500 institutions of higher education in the United States and approximately another 100 in Canada.This efflorescence has made it possible to expand both the numbers of degree-granting departments and the ranks of professional anthropologists. From the late 1940s, older doctorate-granting universities were thus in a position to graduate many more “fresh” anthropologists in the secure knowledge that there would be academic positions awaiting these students in an ever-expanding web of regional and state university systems. As one might expect, this has been something of a selfreinforcing cycle in which an increase in the number of professional anthropologists 222

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

has influenced the proliferation of programs granting doctoral and master’s degrees. Eventually, even the sheer volume of North American academic institutions has not been enough to absorb the number of professional-level anthropologists, many thousands of whom have subsequently looked to make anthropology “relevant” outside academia (an evolution that stimulated interest in public anthropology). It might even be argued that this expanding web of anthropological training and practice gave rise to a distinctively North American understanding of the postmodern condition: more practitioners across more departments have resulted in an increased fragmentation of professional interests, theoretical orientations, and applications. In North America, this situation has doubtless been stimulated by the history of a four-field approach in many if not most anthropology departments. In sum, the political economy of anthropological training and practice in North America, combined with the ascendency of English as the primary medium of instruction, debate, and publishing, has generated a status quo of center and margins from which escape has proven difficult. Existing within, but in some sense apart from, the Anglo-American dynamic, French anthropology has been extraordinarily influential in the domain of theoretical innovation. In this volume, for instance, much discussion has already been devoted to the stature and influence of such luminaries as Émile Durkheim, Marcel Mauss, Ferdinand de Saussure, Claude Lévi-Strauss, Michel Foucault, and Pierre Bourdieu. The work of these scholars, only two of whom (Lévi-Strauss and Bourdieu) may be considered anthropologists in the narrow sense of the term, has been profound in the English-speaking world. In particular, Durkheim’s perspective was hugely influential on British social anthropology in the early and mid-twentieth century in spite of the deep linguistic divide separating practi­ tioners. In turn, Lévi-Strauss’s structuralism – considered by many, even following its dénouement, to be the most important body of distinctively anthropological theory in the twentieth century – was built on an intellectual edifice erected by Durkheim. Though long out of fashion, this structuralism continues to thrive as a rallying point or lightning rod, depending on one’s point of view. Informed by Durkheim, French structuralism was incorporated into both British and American traditions by way of such well-known anthropologists as Edmund Leach (a convert from the British structural-functionalist school) and Marshall Sahlins, both of whom put their own stamp on the idea of cultural structures of logic and reasoning. The influence of French anthropology, like other non-English varieties, has been greatly constrained by a dearth of translation. Although structuralism had been known in France since the late 1950s, for instance, it only became “fashionable” in the Englishspeaking world with the translation of Lévi-Strauss’s work, beginning in the late 1960s and carrying on through the mid-1970s. While Foucault’s books were in some cases available in translation two or three years following their original publication in French, his full influence in anthropology came only during the 1980s – a fact that may speak to differences in style of exegesis and writing between French- and English-speaking 223

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

social scientists. Translation of works by lesser-known scholars has been far less easy to come by. One influential exception to this pattern was Deadly Words: Witchcraft in the Bocage, by Jeanne Favret-Saada (b. 1934), which emerged in English translation in 1980, a scant three years following its original 1977 publication in French as Les mots, la mort, les sorts.This book is remarkable for being a welcome exception to an otherwise frustrating state of affairs. Happily, in recent years initiatives have taken root within the American Anthropological Association and other professional bodies with the goal of providing translations of non-English monographs for dissemination in the Englishspeaking world. A notable example to emerge recently is The Land of Remorse:A Study of Southern Italian Tarantism, by Ernesto De Martino (1908–65) – an anthropologist considered central to the emergence of anthropology in Italy. That the original Italian work, published in 1961 as La Terra Del Rimorso, did not appear in English for over 40 years should give us pause. Interestingly, if not surprisingly, the reverse process – translation from English to non-English – has been far more prevalent, even when the works in question are of more modest stature. Over the years, for instance, we have noticed translations of this book into Portuguese,Turkish, and modern Greek. Early in the twenty-first century, it is fair to say that anthropology exists in some shape or form in dozens of nation-states around the world. This does not necessarily imply that anthropology departments per se exist in all countries, but it is clear that professional anthropologists, many of whom received their training in North America or Europe, are employed within academic departments and colleges across a range of social science and humanities programs. This body of professionals does not include the many who work in state agencies, the public sector, and the private sector. With respect to anthropological theory and schools of thought, there are also a number of distinctive approaches that have lingered at the margins of mainstream anthropology, in some cases for decades. While any enumeration of these here is necessarily limited if not perfunctory, a few deserve mention for their past or present relevance in social and cultural research. In Europe, a number of less well-known perspectives have coexisted with the British, French, and German “metropolitan” traditions. Occasionally, one or more of these have risen to popularity within mainstream anthropological theory. Notable among them has been Norwegian Fredrik Barth’s transactional perspective, often referred to as methodological individualism or “generative” anthropology. Discussed in Part Three, Barth’s approach stands out because it inaugurated a distinctively Norwegian strand of anthropological theory that enjoyed some measure of success in the English-speaking anthropology community, particularly in the 1970s and 1980s. It is significant, however, that all of Barth’s major works were originally published in English, making them immediately available to Englishspeaking anthropologists. Other European varieties of anthropology include significant research undertaken by Dutch, Italian, Serbian, Bulgarian, Czech, Polish, and Russian anthropologists. Some among this group of scholars, notably those hailing from the Netherlands and Russia (which we must historically connect to 224

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

the former Soviet Union), have pedigrees of research related to colonialism, much as do the United Kingdom and France. Unlike the British and French traditions, however, scholars from these nations do not generally have a lengthy track record of English-language publication – at least not to such a degree as to give them widespread influence in the anglocentric anthropological community. Russian anthropology represents something of a distinctive case in that it comprises both a large body of scholarship with a lengthy pedigree, overlaps with but is in many ways alien to European cultural patterns, and for generations embodied an overtly nomothetic research template in the form of Marxism, or dialectical materialism. In some ways, it is something of a conceit – if not an outright mischaracterization – to attribute marginality to a branch of the discipline as well developed as anthropology within the former Soviet Union. The political and economic power of the Soviets through much of the twentieth century provided a context within which generations of Russian scholars sought to align ethnographic data with Marxist evolutionary theory. While the ideological foundations of Marxist reasoning have long since been discarded within Western anthropological circles, the influence of Marx’s work has been profound in such schools as structural Marxism and cultural materialism. In the twenty-first century, materialism and the power relations among antagonistic social classes and groups have continued to attract interest, even as the overly constraining elements of structure are themselves jettisoned. In post-Soviet Russia, practitioners are seeking to redefine what it means to do Russian social anthropology over and against the Soviet ethnological tradition, and it remains to be seen whether crosspollination and dialogue between East and West will take root. Japan represents an interesting case in which a national tradition of anthropological research coexists with a history of engagement by Western anthropologists interested in studying the exotica of a non-Western civilization. Within Japan itself, many Western anthropologists carry out extensive ethnographic research on a great variety of foci (everything from deaf culture to baseball to rap music), much of which is disseminated in English-language monographs and journals. How much of this body of work dovetails with “indigenous” anthropology carried out by Japanese anthropologists is an open question, as is how to characterize the theoretical orientations of Japanese researchers working in Africa, Europe, China, and former Japanese colonies in East Asia, among other locations. From the perspective of theory, Japanese anthropology would seem to have internalized a current Western focus on the study of modernity both at home and abroad, but any distinctively Japanese features of this theme have yet to be introduced to anglophone (or other) readers, due once again to a general absence of translation. As anthropologist Kaori Sugishita has pointed out in the Other People’s Anthropologies (2010) anthology, this pattern mimics a wider and unquestioning interest among Japanese to “join the West” in terms of economic wealth and power. Africa and Latin America present cases where distinctive varieties of anthropological theory have yet to blossom, although ethnographic and other 225

Russian social anthropology A term now used by some Russian anthropologists to distinguish current social and cultural research in the region from the outmoded Soviet ethnology, which imposed a framework of dialectical materialism on all research.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

anthropological research has of course been conducted in both regions for many decades. Unlike the Russian or Soviet case, but similar to the Japanese, most African national anthropologists working south of the Sahara Desert (northern Africa represents something of a different case, in anthropology as in many things) are trained in metropolitan centers in Europe and North America. In Africa, many anthropologists employ English or French as their primary languages of research dissemination and teaching. The great majority of scholars working in these regions have been foreign nationals, although the tide is slowly turning in this regard, particularly in Kenya and South Africa – a postcolonial state with a better economic and educational infrastructure than elsewhere. Clearly, constraints placed on research and travel budgets place many African anthropologists in the unenviable position of having limited options. The same is true in Central and South America. Spanish and Portuguese remain marginal languages in global anthropology, and while there are a number of peer-reviewed journals and publishers that cater to their work, it remains the case that in order to disseminate research, publication in English is necessary even when undesirable. The forgoing is necessarily a mere sketch of where things stand with the many “other anthropologies” that continue to take shape around the world. It remains to be seen whether local languages and theoretical orientations may be drawn into a pluralistic and cosmopolitan network of multi-sited anthropologies, in which dialogue and the sharing of perspective are no longer limited by language and economic factors. The twentieth-century “competition” (if we can frame it as such) among national and linguistic traditions of anthropology presents a fascinating case study of the multi-stranded evolution of higher education and theory building, to say nothing of the jostling for academic authority and prestige across the industrialized world. Still, these developments within professional anthropology are arguably of far less consequence to the current and future vitality of the field than is the reframing of Indigenous and Native peoples as active collaborators in the creation of anthropological knowledge, in lieu of being its passive objects.

Collaboration with “Other” Voices Key Words: indigenous anthropology, jointly told tales, Ogotemmêli, policy of Indian termination and assimilation While we reserve extensive discussion of decolonization for our Conclusion, the rise of “deep” collaboration and authorial parity as goals of anthropological text-making deserve comment here as an important plank of “world traditions” in the field. What we might call the “collaborative turn” in social and cultural anthropology is a logical, moral, and (many would say) inevitable consequence of those critiques of the colonial encounter and politics of textual representation 226

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

discussed earlier. Inspired especially by events during the 1960s and 1970s (especially countercultural and postcolonial theory and activism, together with the academic writings these spawned), many anthropologists both within and beyond the academy have for some years been seeking to reinvent the basis of their own claims to authority by working with (as opposed to merely among) those same Native and Indigenous peoples once (and in many cases still) subjugated to imperialistic gaze and control. This growing sense that anthropological reasoning and practice were sorely in need of “reformation” dates to the waning days of European imperialism following World War II. A smattering of ethnographic research and publication presaged what was to come. Notably, French anthropologist Marcel Griaule (1898–1956) famously “conversed” with Ogotemmêli (d. 1962), a high priest of the Dogon people of Mali in western Africa. From the 1930s through the 1950s, a rich ethnographic portrait of Dogon cosmology was textually “painted” by way of these conversations, published in French in 1948 and in English translation in 1965 as Conversations with Ogotemmêli: An Introduction to Dogon Religious Ideas. Griaule’s work was, however, a true stand-out in an ethnographic discipline still internationally characterized on the whole by realism, scientism, and Othering of native informants. Linguistic anthropologist Dell Hymes captured this sentiment in 1969 by writing (seemingly with frustration) that any viable discipline of the future would ultimately be obliged to choose between “the protection of academic comfort and privilege” and the seeking of knowledge in service to humanity. This same spirit of resistance to the ethnographic enterprise enlivened Vine Deloria Jr.’s (1933–2005) 1969 book Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto – a work in which various institutions and bureaucracies were criticized (notably in the chapter “Anthropologists and Other Friends”) both for their exploitation of Native Americans in the interests of career building and (more damningly) for failing to oppose the US government’s policy of Indian termination and ­assimilation (most especially the 1953 “House Concurrent Resolution 108”), according to which traditional Native American lifeways were deemed untenable and mass “civilization” of Native peoples was proclaimed a national imperative. Similarly, works by Talal Asad, Edward Said, Michel Foucault, and others all had significant impact, directly and indirectly, on how anthropologists reflected on their work and “their” subjects in the final decades of the twentieth century. Emerging as these perspectives did in an age of political and cultural upheaval in many domains of Euro-American society, they inspired something of a “crisis of conscience” for many and laid bare not solely the colonial foundations of anthropology but also a certain self-satisfied and delusional “fantasy” that had for decades been passed off as objective truth: that anthropologists were self-evidently the morally superior champions of non-Western peoples. At least as far back as Malinowski and Boas, the professional development of the discipline had incorporated and stoked a smug assumption that anthropologists were acting at least 227

Ogotemmêli A priest and cosmologist of the Dogon people of central Mali in western Africa. Ogotemmêli, who from the 1940s through the 1950s shared his knowledge with French ethnographer Marcel Griaule, remains a critical source of information on Dogon religion and mythology.

policy of Indian termination and assimilation A general phrase for a series of formal US government legislative policies that sought to dismantle Native American cultural and tribal organization from the 1940s through the 1960s. In particular, House Concurrent Resolution 108 (1953) formalized the policy of “termination” of Indian tribal identity by withdrawing all federal assistance and eliminating the reservation system.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

indigenous anthropology A phrase employed by some anthropologists (e.g., Donald Messerschmidt) to indicate the study of particular social communities and cultures by members of those cultures, rather than outsiders or those working within a Eurocentric colonial system.

as the de facto surrogates of those peoples whom they wrote about and built careers around. Uncomfortable revelations of the kind discussed by Deloria Jr., to say nothing of the racially charged ethnocentrism of Bronislaw Malinowski’s fieldwork diaries (first published in 1967), were devastating to the disciplinary conscience in a number of ways. Even in the wake of the postmodern and postcolonial critiques, allegations continued to emerge of ethnographic misrepresentation and careerism-over-ethics in ethnographic work – perhaps most strikingly in the fallout from Nancy Scheper-Hughes’s award-winning ethnographic study of culture and mental illness in a western Irish community, entitled Saints, Scholars, and Schizophrenics: Mental Illness in Rural Ireland (1979). The author was frequently pilloried for appearing to have made public what had been matters of a private nature among her informants, concerns that Scheper-Hughes herself sought to redress by way of a chapter-length mea culpa offered in the book’s twentiethanniversary edition in 2001. Although some of the subsequent agonizing over fieldwork priorities and ethics spurred on by these and other episodes has been characterized as somewhat overwrought (as is discussed in our Conclusion), it has been clear for many years that the golden self-image cherished by generations of anthropologists was tarnished as much by human frailty as by the structures of empire. For many, a reasonable if partial solution to this problem involved a sustained attention to “indigenous anthropology” as the practice of doing ethnographic research “at home” within one’s own social community and culture. Donald Messerschmidt (b. 1940), for instance, wrote in 1981 that the widespread withdrawal of anthropologists from their traditional moorings in exotica signaled “an end to the era of colonial anthropology and the beginning of a new maturity of purpose.” From his perspective, indigenous anthropology (known variously as “native anthropology,” “insider anthropology,” and “autoethnography,” among others) promised to skirt the thorny issue of anthropology as a “handmaiden” to colonialism by redirecting practitioners to work within their “own” social and cultural worlds. With several decades’ hindsight, the suggestion of a radical shift in professional curiosity – in which many anthropologists would cease working outside their own societies – always seemed somewhat unlikely given the sheer breadth of professional interests. While it is clear that many thousands of anthropologists have indeed turned from the strategy of “familiarizing the exotic” to “exoticizing the familiar” and that entire subfields have emerged with this in mind, the mainstream of social and cultural anthropology continues to see the world at large, and all the peoples in it, as the proper subject of its research foci. A more practical approach, as Vincent Crapanzano (b. 1939) noted in a famous contribution to Clifford and Marcus’s 1986 volume Writing Culture (discussed in Part Three), was attention to rejuvenating what it meant to “do” anthropology. In his view, ethnographers could not be content to settle for an 228

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

easy lip-service to the principle of cultural relativism. Rather, any anthropology that truly lived up to the relativist mantra would seek at every turn to undo power asymmetries between researchers and researched by replacing the trope of “reading over the shoulders of natives” with one of “reading alongside natives.” What had been a uniformly monological activity in which the observer-anthropologist studied and textually represented people as observed objects of the scientific gaze would henceforth become a dialogical, collaborative project in which all parties became equal contributors to the fashioning of anthropological knowledge. In his popular textbook Tales of the Field, John Van Maanen (b. 1943) has called narratives of this type “jointly told tales.” He wonders aloud about the discipline being brought to the “brink of ending the game” to the extent that collaboration involves acknowledging the authority of natives to “speak for themselves” with true authority – not simply as sources of data to be mined by the ethnographer. On the other hand, the dialogical aspect of this ethnographic craft would seem to stipulate that in order to remain “anthropological,” such collaborative narratives would by definition retain some degree of commitment to scholarly ideas, theories, and methods. What would be fundamentally different about such undertakings would be the “reciprocal” quality of the work, in which anthropologists and natives would together write in ways both intelligible and relevant to those being represented; that is, the products of these collaborations would cease to benefit anthropologists alone and would henceforth be of service to all. The future of such work would seem promising. Still, it has been observed that a true commitment to this undertaking is far from a quick fix and its real consequences far from cosmetic. Indigenous feminist anthropologist Zoe Todd has argued in a 2016 essay that a seismic shift in how Euro-American scholars view their place in the world is in order if Indigenous perspectives are to be given the professional weight they merit. For Todd, current areas of anthropological interest such as the Anthropocene, posthumanism, and the ontological turn would seem to engender great excitement – up until the point where Indigenous voices might be expected to receive credit where credit is due. Lamenting the failure of Euro-American anthropology to confront its own colonialist legacy, she points out that the discipline still implicitly rewards the erasure of Indigenous bodies, voices, and history from social scientific narratives – a fact made still more problematic by the potential for Euro-American scholars to appropriate, distort, and “flatten” Indigenous perspectives in academic contexts (especially conferences and classrooms) where these voices are not enlivened by Indigenous scholars themselves. It would seem that until the settings and structures of Euro-American academe are accommodated to the legitimate aspirations of Indigenous voices, the call for a truly collaborative discipline will likely inspire more window-dressing than revolutionary change. The question of academic politics and the formation of knowledge is one we will revisit in our Conclusion. 229

jointly told tales a phrase coined by John Van Maanen to describe the postmodern effort to produce ethnographic narratives that are dialogical and that showcase the “shared character of cultural descriptions.”

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Describe the cultural and linguistic context in which some varieties of anthropological theory became central and others marginalized. 2. What is the significance of textual translation when considering the influence of non-anglophone anthropologies? 3. Do Russian/Soviet, Japanese, and African varieties of anthropology express theoretical orientations that are different from anglocentric ones? If so, how? 4. Do you think the US government policy of Indian termination and assimilation affected how anthropologists think about the peoples they study? Why or why not? 5. In your view, what might be the pros and cons for anthropological theory of jointly told tales?

Anthropologies of the Digital Age digital Referring to the use of two digits, 0 and 1, in creating specific sequences of electronic directions or information, particularly in the context of computer software. binary coding In computer software and other information technology, the expression of meaning in sequences of 0s and 1s, two binary digits that can be exponentially combined and recombined to produce new meanings. cybernetics The study of regulatory systems and structures taking various forms, including digital, mechanical, biological, and social systems, a term now aligned most closely with how any system is controlled by technology.

Key Words: analog, binary coding, COVID-19, cybernetics, digital, Dot Com collapse, link-up, modernization theory, Silicon Valley, Silicon Valley Cultures Project, Web 2.0, World of Warcraft,Y2K Anthropological theorists in the early twenty-first century are increasingly turning their attention to powerful cultural and technological currents that have come, in a staggeringly brief period of time, to engulf the entire world (albeit more unevenly than many might assume). We refer to this advent and explosion, taking place roughly since the late 1970s, as the “digital age.” The term “digital” is itself interesting, as, in the words of Heather Horst and Daniel Miller, it “seems to have become a discursive catchall for novelty.” That is, the word has transcended its origins as a technical reference to embrace not only a vast array of innovations but also a certain cultural worldview that anticipates new and unprecedented developments and their intimate connection to the fabric of everyday life. Strictly speaking, however, the word is defined as “everything that has been developed by, or can be reduced to, the binary – that is bits consisting of 0s and 1s.” The discovery and application of binary coding in the midtwentieth century signaled a radical transformation in the possibilities for information and communications technologies. Among the first anthropological students of cybernetics technology was Claude Lévi-Strauss, who sought early in his career to articulate the mathematical models of 1950s computer technologies to his evolving perspective on culture. It can be reasonably inferred that Lévi-Strauss’s particular contribution to anthropological theory – French structuralism – drew 230

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

many of its assumptions about rationality and systematicity from the first awakenings of the digital age. Of course, this period witnessed the emergence of many new and sophisticated technologies – most of which were used by government and military institutions (those pondered by Lévi-Strauss, for instance, were employed in the development of missile guidance systems) and only a few of which (notably analog television) became part of the daily rituals of domestic life – and then only for affluent peoples of Western societies. It has only been in the past 30 or 40 years that the everyday worlds, first of millions and eventually of literally billions, have been dramatically affected by the tools and possibilities of digital technologies – especially by way of the personal computer in its various evolutions, together with the powerful software technologies that made these possible.These have been followed by personal digital assistants (such as the PalmPilot), pagers, cellphones, tablets, smartphones, and gaming consoles. The rapid emergence – and just as rapid obsolescence – of these and a host of other devices has been driven by new markets of consumers the world over; this in turn has spawned a variety of new industries and made household names of such figures as Bill Gates (b. 1955), Steve Jobs (1955–2011), and Mark Zuckerberg (b. 1984). But perhaps more important than the cultural artifacts themselves (the smartphones, computers, tablets, etc.), and casting a long shadow over worldwide social and cultural practices, has been the internet – the ubiquitous global system of digital networks that in just a few short years has become vital to every modern industry, state, and economy; this is especially true in terms of the staggering reach of social media platforms such as Facebook, Twitter, Instagram, TikTok,YouTube, WhatsApp, Tumblr, and many others (in 2020, Facebook reported some 2.23 billion active users around the world). The power and reach of such technologies to create, sustain, and transform social and cultural worlds cannot be overstated; yet, notwithstanding Lévi-Strauss’s early interest, anthropological theory had for some years been slow to engage them. In recent years, however, the global ubiquity and political-economic power of online platforms and devices have changed all of that, as we discuss in this section. In a 2010 essay, Gabriella Coleman (b. 1973) reviewed the multifarious, yet tentative, ways in which ethnographers began in the early 1990s to study digital culture. Much early interest was stimulated by the heady and even utopian predictions concerning the “brave new world” of digital power, synergy, and “endless possibilities” that accompany the universal availability of such tools. With hindsight, Coleman reflects that these ideas and the florid language that so often was used to describe them suggest deeply rooted notions of “rupture” and “transformation.” They represent a break with the pre-modern, analog order and the ushering in of a better, more unified transnational order. We note, too, that this utopianism had a dark underbelly of apocalypticism, as exemplified by the “Y2K” (Year 2000) panic of 1998–9, in which certain dire consequences were forecast in 231

analog Electronic signals characterized by a limitless range of possible values within a specified range, made increasingly obsolete with the widening availability of digital technology.

Y2K Also known as “the Millennium Bug,” an acronym for the Year 2000, referring both to a computer technology problem and to the consequent social panic that emerged in the run-up to the year 2000.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Dot Com collapse  Also referred to as the “Dot Com crash” or “bursting of the Dot Com bubble,” a sharp drop in stock value for many internetbased e-companies in 1999–2001, following a protracted period of strong growth and uninhibited venture capitalism throughout the 1990s. Web 2.0 A phrase coined in the mid2000s to describe the development of new online tools and platforms that enable the creation and distribution of user-generated content – for instance, blogs, wikis, and social networking websites.

anticipation of global digital technology’s inability to distinguish the year “2000” from the year “1900.” Real technological issues, soon resolved, were swamped by an imaginary of global catastrophe and breakdown in law and order that never materialized. The failure of Y2K to produce catastrophe, followed in short order by the Dot Com collapse of 2000 (in which many of the innumerable and ostensibly profitable online companies to emerge in the 1990s lost some or all of their value in what is generally likened to the bursting of a bubble), took some of the luster off the rosy predictions of an imminently better world.What had been an almost axiomatic certainty that the digital age would inevitably and mechanistically improve the lives of millions or billions across a range of domains (education, economy, and politics, to name the most obvious) came under sharp scrutiny. Still, interest rose once again as new, more powerful devices and internet platforms came online in the mid-2000s. The advent of what has been styled “Web 2.0” – consisting of user-created internet activity such as wikis, blogs, YouTube, and various forms of social media (especially Facebook) – combined with greatly enhanced possibilities in mobile technology and file sharing (the many guises of smartphones and tablets, especially, together with digital music platforms such as Apple Music, Spotify, Deezer, and Pandora, to name but a few) to produce a diverse range of possibilities in the use of digital culture. But this digital culture is also highly susceptible to abuse: the so-called dark web is a “digital underground” consisting of tens of thousands of sites run by various criminal enterprises, sex offenders, terrorists and political extremists, and drug traffickers, among others. If anything, these uses and abuses are not abating but continue to expand. Returning to the 1990s, it was in the context of emerging technologies whose powers and limits were unknown that there arose a division of labor among anthropologists in relation to digital culture. According to Coleman, some prominent theorists (including Arjun Appadurai and Arturo Escobar [b. 1952]) turned their gaze to the “cultural implications” of digital media, while a small number of others began to conceive ethnographic research on the various economic, political, and cultural movements in the blossoming online world (much of this latter focus tried to investigate the online proliferation of anthropological knowledge in the form of website and virtual displays of various kinds). Among the former, one important strain of thought involved the critique of what was perceived as hyperbole in popular culture: the granting of “autonomous power to technology to engender change” when it seemed just as likely that such tools might mediate and “facilitate social reproduction.” Faye Ginsburg (b. 1952), for instance, has argued that widespread discourses lauding the transformative power of digital technologies solidify notions of a profound “digital divide” in which there are “haves” and “have-nots” on a global scale. In so styling the digital age, she argues, such simplistic claims rehearse (sometimes unwittingly, but generally on purpose) older ideas about the need for modernization of the 232

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

non-modern world. Digital power, in this wise, is but another strand of global international development and modernization theory, which, as many anthropologists have argued, tends to assume a unilineal trajectory of progress from the pre-modern, preindustrial, preliterate, and (perhaps) pre-civilized to a better world – as patronizingly defined by the standards and values of Western industrial democracies. This pre-modern is, the reasoning goes, in need of assistance not merely to catch up in terms of industry, medicine, or education but also to be better adapted to the digital age now consuming the world. As Ginsburg reminds us, however, this myopic vantage is erected on the flawed, yet pervasive, assumption that the digital age inevitably produces a “shared subjectivity” or “whole new sensorium” in which the lives of vast swathes of cultural Others are improved. From among those anthropologists who have produced research that looks at digital technology in context, a variety of ethnographic studies have emerged. Frequently, these illuminate the processes by which technology is “provincialized” to distinctive cultural worlds. As Coleman puts it, such studies show how digital media become “central to the articulation of cherished beliefs, ritual practices, and modes of being in the world.” In short, digital technology is made to fit existing forms and institutions, not the other way around. By way of example, Heather A. Horst (b. 1973) and Daniel Miller (b. 1954) have written of the 1990s rise of the cellphone in Jamaica. In their 2006 book The Cell Phone: An Anthropology of Communication, they show how the society adapted this new tool to its own needs and values over the course of a scant few years.The rural community of Orange Valley, for example, went from having very few phones at all (the few that existed were landlines in the homes of affluent residents) to witnessing large numbers of individuals across all economic classes carrying phones in their pockets. In this multi-sited study, the authors show how the technical ability to store large numbers of cellphone numbers on one’s phone permits an exploitation of economic and social connections that were desirable, but next to impossible, prior to the wide availability of cheap cellphones. For young women in particular, the phenomenon of the “link-up” is a means of securing financial assistance from a variety of sources (young men, primarily) and of ensuring ready connection to some family members (“cousins” and “aunties”) and children.With regard to the latter, the new connectivities enabled by cellphones foster a more direct way of accessing child care and child-rearing – much of which is done by female relatives other than “baby-mothers.” In this context, then, cellphones mediate “coping strategies” – particularly with the goal among low-income families (the majority of study participants) of making ends meet by asking (“begging” in Jamaican patois) for money and other favors for which reciprocity is not necessarily expected. Other studies are interesting for the way in which they probe groups who, as Coleman says, “can and do culturally dwell in digital technology.” These formations follow different developmental trajectories, but anthropologists have been 233

modernization theory  An eclectic range of social scientific and historical perspectives that track the transformation of “traditional” societies, industries, economies, and political systems into “modern” ones.

link-up A phrase identified by Heather Horst and Daniel Miller as important to many Jamaican cellphone users, in particular young women of low income who employ cellphones as a “coping strategy” for establishing and maintaining social and economic networks.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

Silicon Valley A name given to the southern end of the San Francisco Bay area in northern California, specifically to the Santa Clara Valley, which has been among the most fertile centers of the high-tech industry. Silicon Valley Cultures Project Founded in 1991 by anthropologists at San Jose State University, a project conducting long-term, multi-sited research into high-technology communities and workplaces, the use of information technology, and the heterogeneous cultural worlds that connect workers and residents with the region’s high-tech industry and economy.

World of Warcraft Also known by its acronym WoW, among the largest of multiplayer online role-playing games, set in a fauxmedieval, Tolkienesque fantasy world where players adopt the online personas of fantasy characters, undertake quests and journeys, meet other players, and combat fantasy creatures and monsters.

keenly interested in two: the prosaic work environments and cultures of digital labor, and virtual communities of shared cultural practice. A good example of the former is a long-term study by J.A. English-Lueck (b. 1953) of the cultural worlds fashioned by software designers, engineers, and other high-tech professionals in Northern California’s Silicon Valley, a location increasingly mythologized (rightly or wrongly) in popular American culture as a digital Garden of Eden. Her ethnographic writing is itself an outgrowth of the Silicon Valley Cultures Project – an initiative begun by faculty at San Jose State University in the early 1990s to longitudinally study and document the cultural effects of the region’s emerging digital industries. Published in 2002, English-Lueck’s book, Cultures@SiliconValley, explores high-tech workers’ use of technology in creative and diverse ways to generate flexible networks of social practice that blur the sharp distinctions between such separately imagined spaces as those of the workplace and home. In these technologically “saturated” spaces, the various digital devices and communications platforms are culturally styled as part of everyday life management across different domains, from inter-employee hierarchies to marital relationships and childcare. Her 2010 ethnography Being and Well-Being: Health and the Working Bodies of Silicon Valley probes still more deeply into the everyday worlds of Silicon Valley workers. Here, English-Lueck skirts the digital per se in order to examine the extent to which the high-tech workplace cultivates subjective concern for health and health care. Individuals are tasked with their own health as “projects,” in emulation of the “project management” culture characteristic of the new economic environment (of which the industries of Silicon Valley are emblematic). With respect to research that evokes digital culture in its most abstract sense, building games – for example, Minecraft and Animal Crossing – and massive multiplayer online role-playing games (MMORPGs) – such as RuneScape and Fortnite – conjure interactive environments unlike any ever studied (or likely even imagined) by anthropologists. In many cases, the high degree of social interactivity now technically possible in these games provokes many important questions about what it means to be a social being at all: In what ways are such e­ nvironments – the products of human ingenuity – consonant with human culture and practice in the “real” world; indeed, in what ways does the sociality of these games overlap with the world outside? For example, Bonnie A. Nardi’s 2010 ethnography My Life as A Night Elf Priest: An Anthropological Account of World of Warcraft exemplifies anthropological fascination with virtual worlds that are simultaneously material and transcendent. Nardi’s study investigates the culture of a game – World of Warcraft (WoW) – that at its peak in the late 2000s boasted a “population” of over 11 million regular players (it has since declined to approximately 5 million). She proposes that this virtual world can best be understood by way of American philosopher John Dewey’s (1859–1952) theory of pragmatism, according to which human aesthetics are cultivated through engagement with the world 234

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

(rather than through contemplation of abstractions such as truth and beauty). For Nardi, this world is “a powerful visual experience like viewing a striking landscape.” World of Warcraft, in this sense, is an aesthetically rich domain open to rule-governed intervention by active agents (American and Chinese players) who import both their ingenuity and bias (such as misogyny) into the game’s fantastic digital landscapes and interactions. The often-posed question about “addiction” (“problematic use,” as Nardi terms it) in relation to video games is dispelled in reframing the game as an alternative aesthetic experience to such “real”-world possibilities as sports, historical re-enactment, and dance – which, Nardi argues, are of limited accessibility to many WoW gamers in the sense that they offer no similar experience of mastery. Studies such as Horst and Miller’s, English-Lueck’s, and Nardi’s illustrate an idea that Horst and Miller elaborate in another book, Digital Anthropology (2012): that digital technologies “intensify” an already powerful dialectic between globalizing forces for cultural homogeneity and the explosive proliferation and diversification of “particularities.” The transnational political economy of digital power is the broad context in which Jamaican access to technology is played out, but its fusion with everyday forms of value embeds the digital world in a specific matrix of social relations over which Jamaicans exert control. In contrast, the social hierarchies, employee inequities, work requirements, and theories of health and illness in Silicon Valley suggest profound effects of technology-as-workplace over which employees have only partial control. In even sharper contrast, the unfettered subjective agency of the virtual play in World of Warcraft evokes a parallel universe of aesthetic value no less compelling and “real” than those of the material world. The irony in this emerging universality of digital culture – that an irreducible binary of 0s and 1s produces apparently limitless particularity – is a tension that anthropologists have little choice but to navigate. Though common sense suggests that the universal and the particular reside at the opposite poles of some abstract measuring stick, it seems closer to the truth to say that in the context of the digital age, they interpolate each other in a paradoxical fashion: The more universally pervasive the binary system becomes, the more fragmented are its manifestations. Moreover, Horst and Miller also propose that there is a deceptive quality of the “intermediate” that is frequently associated with digital technologies in that these appear to constitute a “buffer” between human beings and “authentic” and/ or “pre-digital” culture. Anthropologists are admonished never to romanticize the “prehistoric” analog by attributing to it a more primordial human authenticity. Indeed, it is to the analysis of such widely dispersed narratives (in the vein of “things were so much easier and less complicated before this technology”) that anthropologists must turn in order to shed light on the “framed” and constructed character of cultural meaning in relation to a new era of digital technologies. Horst and Miller suggest other important considerations for a more powerful anthropology of the digital age – ones that tie it directly to very traditional principles of anthropological theory. First, they urge a renewed attention to holism. 235

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

COVID-19 According to the World Health Organization (WHO) and Centers for Disease Control (CDC), COVID-19 is a new, highly contagious respiratory disease transmitted primarily by human saliva droplets/discharge when individuals are in close proximity to each other. Its effects range from mild to severe flu symptoms, and it has been shown to have a higher morbidity rate among people with underlying conditions (for instance, cardiovascular and respiratory diseases, cancer, and diabetes).

As they see it, much of the literature in popular culture, media studies, and even anthropology has been overly reductive in viewing digital culture through too narrow a lens. Studies that ignore the holistic entanglements between digital practice and such institutionalized abstractions as economy, kinship, and religion miss something essential about the contextualized making of digital culture. Second, they propose that the principle of cultural relativism has great relevance for an anthropology of the digital age. Thus, it makes little sense to regard globalization of the digital as a homogenizing force when many studies (such as the Jamaican cellphone study) suggest the deep effects of cultural difference on how and why digital technologies are used. We should recognize, therefore, that many digital cultures stoke diversity and proliferation by giving “voice and visibility to those who are peripheralized by modernist and similar perspectives.” From this vantage, widely held assumptions regarding the ineffable homogenizing power of digital technologies to “bring the world together” all but ignore the fact that new digital worlds embody a wide range of culture-specific values, attitudes, practices, and assumptions. The effort to fully appreciate the power of this dialectic leads Horst and Miller to reflect on the human capacity to abstract in principle. If one were to historicize this ability, they suggest, one could see that the digital age marks but the latest chapter in a drive toward abstracting value and meaning. Money, for instance, has long been subject to this type of cultural overdetermination – it is intensely abstract, deterritorialized, quantitative, and distant from the personal. In sum, it is “alienated” from the conditions of labor, as Marx and Engels might say.The advent of the digital is reminiscent of this historical development. Like money, the digital saturates – it “produces too much culture” and threatens to overwhelm. It seems at once everywhere and nowhere in particular, pervasive yet not tangible. This “brave new world” and the anxieties it produces are one source of the tendency to romanticize the pre-digital. Happily for anthropologists, this process merges easily into hotly politicized debates over such issues as copyright, intellectual property, and file sharing. These in turn provoke still deeper questions about online openness and freedom, as well as their inverse: the closed and controlled. Of course, as with money, one cannot put the proverbial “cat back in the bag,” and it appears likely that (short of an apocalyptic event) humanity will never be able to revert to a pre-digital world. For the extent to which this is true, anthropologists will doubtless have rich subject matter in the investigation of digital culture for many years to come.The possibilities outlined above merely scratch the surface of a burgeoning field of interest. A number of online sectors cry out for anthropological study – among them e-commerce (especially via Amazon.com and other mega-retailers), online “dating” (a domain of activity that attracts many millions of adults globally), and, especially with the global threat posed by COVID-19 (aka the “novel coronavirus”) beginning in 2019, online pedagogy from kindergarten through graduate school. 236

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. Do you agree with Gabriella Coleman that predictions of a utopian “digital age” have depended on cultural images of rupture and transformation? Coleman was writing of the 1990s, but can you think of ways in which these ideas are still used to describe the digital future? 2. Does the development of Web 2.0 change the possibilities for anthropological research? If so, how? 3. How do digital discourses support a general view that modernization is inevitably good? 4. How does the digital practice of “linking-up” help create social and support networks in Jamaica, and for whom are such networks especially beneficial? 5. How does John Dewey’s theory of “pragmatism” help to understand the formation of compelling online worlds such as World of Warcraft? 6. In light of your experience with the contemporary world, what are some areas of digital activity that you believe merit future study by anthropologists? 7. COVID-19 has affected many aspects of higher education, including the use of digital technologies. What has your experience of digital education been like in the COVID-19 era, and how is it different from traditional in-class instruction?

Anthropocene Key Words: Anthropocene, Holocene, human exceptionalism, International Union of Geological Sciences, non-governmental organizations (NGOs), posthuman turn, speciocide, speculative fabulation New ways of imagining entanglements of culture and technology such as those discussed above are doubtless exciting for many younger anthropologists seeking to pursue research relevant to the contemporary world. Thanks to scholars like Said, Foucault, Wolf, and others, it is now universally accepted that the hermetic, self-contained, and ahistorical systems imagined by earlier generations of sociocultural anthropologist have been cracked wide open and purged of their colonial-era enchantments. The wondrous artificially intelligent digital technologies of our times represent perhaps an apogee of human creative and scientific accomplishment – the fruit of human imagination and ingenuity that touches billions of people on a daily basis. 237

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

speciocide The deliberate or inadvertent killing of an entire living species of plants or animals. human exceptionalism An idea implicit in many academic disciplines (and especially anthropology) that human beings, alone in the natural world, are privileged and should be the focus of efforts to save, liberate, and/ or redeem from global crises and catastrophes. Anthropocene An interdisciplinary body of thought that proposes that a new geological, biological, and social “epoch” be assigned the Earth, dating from the beginning of humanity’s profound disruption of natural processes to the present. International Union of Geological Sciences A non-governmental organization of professional geologists that fosters global cooperation in geological science and identifies areas of global scientific consensus on, and approaches to, various geological and climatological matters. Holocene A geological epoch that began between 11,000 and 12,000 years ago, after the last glacial epoch (“ice age”).

One might consequently imagine that ours is a time of great promise for a­ nthropology – new vistas of interest generally signal vitality in any academic field. But it bears noting that we are also participants in a critical discipline that does not float freely above the world, detached and indifferent. Our interests, though frequently provincial and inconsequential on the larger canvas of human activity (indeed, they often speak to the privilege we possess as academics), can only continue to exist if the world in which they matter does. It is perhaps for this reason that among anthropologists, sometimes shrill warnings have in recent years occasionally eclipsed optimism for a disciplinary future. As Anna Tsing (b. 1952) writes of our species in general, “we are all already dead, through environmental crisis. That we live speaks to patches of liveability among new forms of death.” Death hastened by ozone depletion, deforestation, unrestrained terraforming, and the circulation of toxic pathogens. Death stoked by deglaciation, speciocide, and overpopulation. Death provoked by global pandemics, widespread ocean pollution, and unfettered fossil fuel extraction. If the human species itself stands condemned, what future could academic disciplines like anthropology really have? Such assessments are sobering, to say the least. Any simmering research enthusiasms must be tempered, therefore, by recognition of the perilous moment in which we live. To do otherwise would be to display tone-deafness to the many predicaments of late modernity – predicaments largely of our own making. As Meredith Evans (b. 1988) and Nadine Ryan (b. 1984) frame the matter, “human exceptionalism” and the will to dominate nature are “part of the problem.” In the view of many anthropologists, the human species is precariously situated as never before – poised either to resolve the many problems that confront us on a global scale or to succumb to them.What the latter would entail, no one knows, but it would surely not be characterized by the phrase “happily ever after.” In trying to understand the ways in which humanity has made its proverbial bed, a new, eclectic body of theory has emerged that is as promising as it is (in some respects) provocative: Anthropocene.Taking its cue from geological and paleontological terminology that brackets the Earth’s past into phases, stages, and epochs, the Anthropocene concept reflects a growing interdisciplinary consensus that at some point over the past several hundred years (“when” precisely is a matter of dispute among various types of scientist), the activities and interventions of human beings in the world became so extensive as to surpass, erode, or even upend natural processes (geological, biological, and ecosystemic) of the Earth itself. The term itself was first used by an atmospheric chemist, Paul J. Crutzen (b. 1933), and a biologist, Eugene F. Stoemer (1934–2012), in 2000, and in the years since it has gained traction as a way to designate a new geological epoch in which humanity has been an important factor in changes to all aspects of planetary geology and ecology. Somewhat controversially, in 2019 the International Union of Geological Sciences voted to accept the recommendation of a special working group that the Anthropocene replace that part of the Holocene after 1950 (the beginning of the “atomic age” and the scattering of radioactive debris throughout the world) as the current epoch of geological time. Proponents hope to see their proposal ratified by 2021. 238

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

Within anthropology, what makes this area of theorizing new is not so much that it involves the interface of culture to nature; after all, anthropologists of many stripes have for decades studied how ecologies are engaged and shaped by human activity. Rather, the conceptual novelty of Anthropocene stems from the way in which it destabilizes the boundary between the cultural and the natural, rendering these mutually constitutive and entangled in a nonbinary, “patchy” (to use Tsing’s term) quilt of uneven processes and different scales of intensification and relaxation, rates of escalation and deceleration – both of human interventions in nature and of nature’s intrusions into the human. So how, exactly, is the Anthropocene concept applied? It is important to note that it is not generally thought of as a theoretical “school,” still less a research methodology, but rather as a new way of imagining the complex relations among species and across nature in a new and unprecedented epoch – an instantiation of what Amelia Moore calls a “contemporary problem space.” It is not to be viewed as the epistemic foundation for nomothetic hypotheses to be devised and tested – activities that produce quantifiable outcomes for tidy labeling and tabling. To do so would amount, some argue, to a naïve reification of a model drawn from the natural sciences – a tautological undertaking that reduces complexity, impoverishes imagination, and renders social science a “handmaiden” of natural, or “hard” science. Donna Haraway (b. 1944) has used the phrase “speculative fabulation” to suggest how anthropological work in this area might be imagined. In this, anthropologists and others should collaborate in “what-if ” thought experiments in which “possible worlds” are conjured. These imagination-scapes might be populated by different configurations of human practice in which, among other things, non-human species would be re-imagined as collaborators in human social life; as Haraway puts it elsewhere, all flora and fauna (dogs, snails, fungi, microbes, orchids, mollusks, or whatever) would transcend their default status as merely represented Others in anthropological theory (in which they are “good to think with”) and become co-subjects in a common world of multispecies practice (in which they become “here to live with”). In this way, Anthropocene would highlight the importance of studying those interfaces of encounter between the human and the non-human, in which all interlocutors “generate mutual ecologies and coproduced niches.” Amelia Moore has discussed her own ethnographic research in the Bahamas as a good example of how anthropologists might engage what she terms “Anthropocene spaces.” Focusing on the intersection of multispecies life-worlds with the inorganic, she frames this space as one in which both natural and anthropogenic process and practice are in unceasing dialectic. Bahamian macroand micro-ecologies are ones characterized by deep mutuality in which, for instance, “human waste and run-off lead to algal blooms offshore that affect the course of coral growth, inspiring novel restoration plans” and “whip-like crawfish antennae wave from under artificial habitats laid by fishers.” Geopolitically, tourism and the pending “anthropogenic disaster” of sea-level rise and coastline 239

speculative fabulation A phrase coined by Donna Haraway to frame the type of collaborative efforts that Anthropocene scholars should be making to imagine new possibilities for, and configurations of, human engagement with the non-human.

A HISTORY OF ANTHROPOLOGICAL THEORY

non-governmental organizations (NGOs)  Institutions and organizations that operate independently of government, that do not generally amass profit from their endeavors, and whose missions typically address various social, political, and economic concerns.

erosion are now linked in discourses that position the Bahamas as something other than the tropical paradise of global tourism; the islands become, instead, vulnerable sites of “environmental fragility” in which neoliberal exhortations to expand the fisheries sector have been supplanted by conservationist ones according to which overfishing has precipitated “declining numbers of commercial species and poor reef health.” This framing has, in turn, stimulated new formations of institutional partnership among non-governmental organizations (NGOs) and state-level bureaucracies to regulate the fishing industry, even as new frictions unfold. One such rupture discussed by Moore pits Bahamian lobster fishers, concerned with limitations imposed on their export markets, against transnational regulatory regimes that threaten to foreclose on exports to Europe and the United States as “consumers demand a sustainable stamp for their imported seafood.” In illuminating these interdependencies, her research and theorizing are but one example of how anthropologists have in recent years adjusted their frame of reference to bind human and non-human species in relations of mutuality and ecological interdependency in and across spaces of anthropogenic change. Despite the intriguing promise of such work, it is also clear that Anthropocene – the proposed foundation for a new research paradigm – is not without its critics. For one thing, there is the problematic tendency to slip into a comfortable logic of “good Anthropocene,” as Meredith Evans and Nadine Ryan have called it, or, elsewhere by Tsing, to become the “‘fix-it’ people.” According to Evans and Ryan, human management of nature by way of technology is little more than an extension of “colonial” logic – this time applied to the natural world, as opposed to non-Western peoples. For instance, old-growth forests in British Columbia have been patronizingly positioned as in need of human intervention for their own protection. Though Evans and Ryan do not say so, this is eerily reminiscent of European colonial administrations, in such places as central Africa and Melanesia, which sought to regulate, manage, and control native populations who, “child-like” and primitive, were in no position to manage themselves. From a theoretical perspective, such reasoning would seem deeply unreflexive in viewing itself, alone among Western ideologies, as immune to the darker logics by which some human beings infantilize, commodify, and pacify both other human beings and other species. As Tsing and Haraway reflect, this interventionist narrative amounts to a unilineal “sacred secular story” in which a “techno-fix” becomes the triumphant human resolution that places “Modern Man” (that Enlightenmentera construction: white, male, heterosexual, rational) above the rest of Creation; it is a contemporary rendition of a utopian salvationist vision – an unreflexive “techno-optimism” destined for failure and oblivion. Similarly, in her discussion of Anthropocene in the Bahamas, Moore also maintains that understanding how Anthropocene itself has been fashioned as a discursive regime is at least as important (if not more so) than “work that is un-reflexively ‘in’ the Anthropocene 240

Part Four  // The Early Twenty-First Century

(taking the framing of the problem and responses to it for granted).” In this way, as Chris Hann (b. 1953) discusses, various anthropologists (notably Haraway and Tsing) have regarded the focus on anthropos (that is, a single species) at the heart of the Anthropocene concept to be a distortion of the natural world rather than a profound recognition of it. Finally, it is also worth noting that the very entanglements and boundary blurrings that Anthropocene highlights are imagined to be so deeply woven that for anthropologists, the concept might signal an eruption of precisely the inverse problem discussed above. As renowned anthropologist of science and technology Bruno Latour (b. 1947) suggests, Anthropocene might become a “poisonous gift” – one that may well stimulate a rethinking of anthropos as the main object of our theorizing, but in so doing fundamentally destabilize a vision of the human that is and has been in large measure sui generis. This possibility opens the prospect that, far from fetishizing Enlightenment Man or at least anthropos, anthropology – the storied science of humanity – might be left without a concept of the “human” as its primary object altogether. Over the past several decades, the deconstruction and problematizing of key disciplinary tropes (culture, gender, sexuality, religion, etc.) has perhaps made inevitable an ontological questioning of what we can call “the human concept,” but that does not make this realization any less thorny (even embarrassingly so) for professional anthropologists who would rather not see their scholarly field made irrelevant or redundant among the other (presumably still) human sciences. Perhaps it is with a certain stoicism, then, that anthropological theorists soldier on into uncharted conceptual territories that interrogate ontologies and delve into what has been called the “posthuman turn.” Regardless of the problems attendant on the Anthropocene concept for all subfields of anthropology – archaeological, biological, cultural, and linguistic anthropology – it seems certain that across the profession it constitutes part of a broader response to predicaments that threaten us on a planetary scale. For that reason alone, and despite what many believe to be its conceptual inadequacy, it seems likely that Anthropocene or some more nuanced version of it will remain within the anthropological toolkit for the foreseeable future.

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. How might adding the term Anthropocene to our narrative of global geology promote better understanding of humans as part of a global ecology? 2. Why do some anthropologists believe that the term Anthropocene reproduces, albeit unwittingly, a colonial logic?

241

posthuman turn  In anthropology, an approach that recognizes and seeks to eliminate implicit anthropocentrism from considerations of human nature, and attempts to identify and study interconnections between human and non-human life.

This page intentionally left blank 

Conclusion Key Words: history of the present Even as the academic discipline of anthropology, bloodied but resilient through the epistemological struggles of the 1970s and 1980s, lumbered through the 1990s and into a new millennium, the theory-related challenges of the late twentieth century, far from being resolved, have been frustratingly exacerbated in the twenty-first. Not coincidentally, one of the frequent criticisms of volumes such as this is that they lack thematic coherence over the course of the most recent few decades. With humility, we believe that this has more to do with the state of the discipline than with the efforts of authors to interpret and expose the discipline’s current predicament(s). More than ever, anthropological theory is viewed as fraught, contested, problematic, colonized, and skewed in favor of power and privilege. Accordingly, one general theme to emerge, largely from within, has been a deepening of the disciplinary critiques that began with postmodern and postcolonial approaches. Nobody would now argue that anthropology was imagined and institutionalized, in its formative years and decades, on anything other than Eurocentric configurations of power and knowledge. Now, some two decades into the new century, recognition of these facts (for facts they be) has fragmented how disciplinarians imagine their past. This is no longer (if indeed it ever was) an idle or inconsequential question of “idealism versus materialism” or “science versus interpretation.” Many who call themselves anthropologists view their work, in the main, through the lens of empiricism and science – founded on and grounded in rationality and reason. Many others emphasize that to make and disseminate theory is inevitably a political act – one that stems from social privilege. As such, and depending on who does the crafting, theoretical discourse is either a mortar that binds or a solvent that undoes various sorts of hierarchies and orthodoxies (political, economic, racialized, gendered, and others). If anthropology is a field that emphasizes the emancipatory and liberating aspects of deep knowledge, then neutrality on this issue is hardly an option, at least not if one wants to be party to an ethical and responsible discipline. The great Irish poet W.B. Yeats (1865–1939) famously penned, “Things fall apart; the centre cannot hold; … The best lack all conviction, while the worst / Are full of passionate intensity.” Because it is far from our desire, as framers of an anthropological history text widely used in classrooms, to be among Yeats’s “worst,” we are forced to thread a needle with an exceedingly narrow eye. We

CONCLUSION

history of the present  A phrase coined by Michel Foucault referencing the role of power-laden rationalities/logics in structuring modern institutions. It is to understanding the frequently opaque or hidden “genealogies” of these contemporary arrangements that his vision of history was oriented: that is, not to studying the past for the sake of understanding the present in a tautological way, but to analyzing the present in order to glean the significance of past events and activities.

must, on the one hand, be attentive to the institutional needs of the discipline that for many remains “positivist” (on which more below), while, on the other hand, acknowledging the provisional and undeniably colonial foundations of our field of scholarship: its assumptions and claims, its inclusions and exclusions. How should we balance our desire to be sanguine about “progress” in scientific accomplishment and knowledge – which suggests optimism about a bright disciplinary future – with the argument that to remain viable, anthropology must, in some sense, cease to be what it has been? It seems increasingly clear that in order to meet the ethical challenges anthropologists have always championed, we must both leave the epistemological shackles of the discipline’s colonial past behind and purge our implicitly colonial present, especially as it is embedded in ethnographic representation. Although such considerations are not easily resolved, still we should not confuse hardened and emotionally charged rhetoric and occasional posturing (in our experience, inevitable properties of professional interaction) for collaborative reasoning and appeals to empirically grounded insight. Here, in the sixth edition of A History of Anthropological Theory, we extend a form of historical exposition that has been increasingly called into question: a linear narrative that undeniably privileges a canon of disciplinary ancestors who remain for many anthropologists central to their understanding of the field. While we defend our perspective (and the legacy of science, generally), we trust that we do not do so “defensively,” as it were, but in the spirit of dialogue not solely with the “ancestors” we discuss but also with the discipline as it exists in the here and now. In our Conclusion to this edition, we offer some reflections on how our perspective has been formed and why we consider it at least valuable, though certainly far from the only narrative worthy of consideration. In making sense of  “where we are now” in anthropology (what Michel Foucault enigmatically called the “history of the present”), we need first to confront the problematic way in which the term history is conflated with a taken-for-granted understanding of the “past.”That is, as A. Irving Hallowell (1892–1974) once wrote, we will broadly treat “the history of anthropology as an anthropological problem.” To do so, we address below two important developments, separate yet interrelated: first, the emergence of decolonization as a leitmotif across anthropology in all its subfields, and second, the ways in which institutional anthropology has shaped and constrained knowledge production and theory building across the discipline.

What’s in a Name? Key Words: creative non-fiction, nominalism First, let us consider the term history as tethered to our narrative. Above all, this book foregrounds a chronological sequence – that is, a history. The term history 244

CONCLUSION

is frequently misleading, because its primary usage in everyday English is as a synonym for “the past.” But histories are not “the past”; they are stories, complete with plots, protagonists, antagonists, dramatic hooks, and more-or-less satisfying (if unresolved) endings. In an important sense, narratives such as this are “mythic” in their resonance: they bestow origins and form, explaining and valorizing the things that anthropologists do and the ways in which they see things. We stop short of saying they are “fiction,” because this term suggests a lack of interpretive discipline (in the technical sense of this term), which most anthropologists try to avoid. Let us say, rather, that anthropological histories like this one are, as John Van Maanen puts it, “creative non-fiction.”That is, they are creatively framed within the imaginations of their authors and are the outcome of informed decisionmaking about topic selection – what to consider relevant and worthy of prose, and what to exclude as tangential or irrelevant. Inevitably, different stories of this type discuss and valorize divergent sorts of “tales.” Beyond the term history, we also have to consider what it means to call something “anthropology” or “anthropological.” The danger of this framing is that in referring to anthropology in this way, we fall altogether too easily into the trap of nominalism.That is, we assume something exists merely because we fashion a name for it. In truth, the proverbial emperor has no clothes. As we discuss in more detail below, there really is no “anthropology” that exists outside of the institutional contexts in which it is defined, enabled, and constrained. More precisely, there is no transhistorical field of anthropological knowledge that exists in the past, present, and future independently of how we represent and institutionalize it. Accordingly, authors of volumes such as this one are always obliged to make choices about how they define anthropology. In this volume, as in previous editions, we paint the evolution of our field on a very broad canvas – one that considers anthropology to be an intellectual and imaginative enterprise that in some sense existed well before formal consolidation of the professional discipline in the late nineteenth century.This “pre-professional” anthropology exists, at least in our telling, on the scale of many hundreds of years and incorporates figures from domains as different as Classical philosophy, medieval theology, and nineteenth-century psychoanalysis. Arguably, however, it matters less what we have chosen to include than what we have excluded, ignored, or downplayed. It is to this thorny question that we turn next.

A Canon in Question Key Words: chronos, kairos, mentalité Let us now consider the proverbial elephant in the room, desert, jungle, laboratory, swamp, excavation site, factory, suburb, or wherever else anthropologists do their work. It is increasingly clear that the traditional anthropological canon of 245

creative non-fiction  A phrase used by many anthropologists to highlight the unstable, liminal character of ethnographic knowledge as a product of both empirical observation and creative interpretation. nominalism The philosophical problem of attributing objective reality to any phenomenon or aspect of experience merely because we give name to it.

CONCLUSION

chronos  An ancient Greek term for chronological or sequential time that can be quantified and measured in units.

kairos An ancient Greek term for time qualitatively conceived as appropriate, propitious, and/or opportune in contrast to a linear sequence of units. Mythic narratives are often discussed in terms of their kairosbound, permanently “happening” character.

venerable “ancestors” is no longer tenable in its conventional form.Why? Because if we are to take the sundry critiques documented in Part Four seriously, we must look to our own “house,” as much as we do to, say, hospitals, prisons, and international development organizations. Anthropology, no less than any other product of historically situated knowledge and power, incorporates many unexamined assumptions. It is no accident that, like other fields of Euro-American scholarship, it has tended to be overwhelmingly white, male, and politically “conservative.” In sum, not only has the field been “colonized” but it has also been the agent of colonialist logic among non-Europeans from its earliest days. In a recent article, Mariam Durrani (b. 1981) cautions teachers of anthropology against overreliance on, and rote reproduction of, a “chronos-inspired pedagogy that disregards the impact of colonial forms of symbolic organization on our present discipline.” In this perspective, chronological frames (such as the one employed in this book) too frequently reproduce “colonialist and patriarchal norms” in a rather slavish fetishizing of disciplinary lineage and sequential time. It is true that Boas, Malinowski, Radcliffe-Brown, Mead, Geertz, Turner, and Lévi-Strauss – central players, all, in a select group of quasi-mythical “founders” of one school or another – are not situated “on high” as the result of democratic selection in which “all sides” have been given equal weight and consideration. Still, it would seem that they remain firmly enshrined within an anthropological pantheon that many professional anthropologists continue to recognize as more or less valid. Why this is the case perhaps touches more on the disciplinary regimes of academic institutions (on which more below) than it does on the decontextualized coherence and/or persuasiveness of one or another theoretical orientation. In any event, to redress this situation Durrani proposes that we adopt a kairosoriented exposition of theory – that is, theory and knowledge as these are formed in “particular moments,” rather than in a teleological arc the end of which is already known in advance. So, rather than replicate the well-worn tale of a simplistic and context-free unilineal evolutionism giving way to more intricate and ethnographically rich Malinowskian functionalism, we can assist in the decolonizing of anthropological knowledge through discussing the work of such understudied figures as African-American anthropologist Zora Neale Hurston, whose 1931 book Barracoon:The Story of the Last “Black Cargo” (2018 [1931]) foregrounded a deeply ethical, respondent-centered, and reflexive commitment to exposing the human tragedy of slavery that, for Durrani, contrasts works by other anthropologists of the period, especially those working under the auspices of colonial power (which, of course, described virtually all anthropologists at that time). If we, as teachers of the history of anthropological theory, could recapture the work of such marginalized figures, Durrani holds, we could critically re-envisage the discipline in such a way as to avoid the flaws of an ossified, uncritically accepted “canon.” Elsewhere, the tone is more strident still. In discussing their “Decanonizing Anthropology syllabus project,” graduate students at Oregon State University note 246

CONCLUSION

bluntly that “the traditional canon of academic anthropology has been violent in its exclusion of Indigenous, non-male, non-white, and otherwise marginalized voices.” Eurocentric, cisgendered, and heteronormative perspectives are, in their view, upended only in the deep interrogation of practices and institutions that have shaped academic knowledge. Crucially here, as in Durrani’s essay, the calls for decolonial revision are not viewed as a sweeping indictment of conventional theory so much as necessary and long-needed corrective measures in the face of a frequently racist canon, many of whose apotheosized immortals have “hung around for disturbingly long.” In addition to Hurston, recommended replacement texts for the traditional canon include such little-known figures as Santee Dakota Sioux Charles Eastman (1858–1939) as a substitute for Lewis Henry Morgan. Eastman (whose Sioux name was Hakadah and later Ohíye S’a) wrote in a manner that, in retrospect, was clearly well ahead of its time – foregrounding such issues as consciousness, subjectivity, and posthumanism at a time when Morgan and other evolutionists were still considering ancestry on the basis of unilineal evolutionism. An oddly similar vein of criticism comes from an unexpected source: medieval historiography. In a 2014 essay, K. Patrick Fazioli (b. 1982) excoriates those anthropologists who, perhaps obliviously, elide the European Middle Ages as a period of serious pre-professional anthropological thought. We have, he writes, “perpetuated the notion of an incurious, insular, and intolerant medieval mentalité, despite considerable historical evidence that writers of this period produced anthropological insights of comparable sophistication to those in the ancient or early modern worlds.” Like the decolonizing critique of the professional canon, much of this medieval parallel would appear to derive from careless (not to say lazy) scholarship and shallow knowledge of what we have in earlier editions called an “intellectually precarious” medieval synthesis. Their writing demonstrates that thinkers such as Thomas Aquinas, Albertus Magnus (c. 1200–80), and Roger Bacon (c. 1219/20–c. 1292), to name but a few, not only drew heavily on the writings of Plato, Aristotle, Herodotus, Cicero (106–43 BCE), and other Classical thinkers in framing creative responses to the dominion of a powerful medieval Church but also addressed questions of continuing importance to anthropologists: among them, the intersection of different forms of social and cultural knowledge, how to properly understand science and empiricism in the study of nature, and the ontology of human beings versus animals. Moreover, Fazioli argues, the contours of ethnography as a distinctive genre of anthropological writing are also apparent in a range of medieval texts by such figures as Gerald of Wales (1146–1223), a bishop who traveled in and wrote about Wales and Ireland, and Franciscan monk William of Rubruck (1220–93), who wrote about Mongol society while missionizing in the Volga River region of what is now central Russia. In the case of both individuals, Fazioli tells us that “contemporary anthropologists would be astonished at how closely these works follow the form and structure of a traditional ethnographic 247

mentalité A French word (translated into English as “mentality”) often used in social science and literary disciplines to characterize the total assemblage of beliefs, assumptions, and moral dispositions that pervade a historical period or social community.

CONCLUSION

monograph, including discussion of subsistence practices, economy, law, kinship, marriage, food, culture, dress, personal hygiene, religion and ritual, warfare, material culture, language, and so on.” There can be no doubt that many biases and ethnocentrisms exist in these writings; still, in our view we should refrain from anachronistic evaluation of them just as we tend to do when discussing Tylor or Morgan – both of whom are still held aloft as central players in the professional canon and arguably deserve discussion in volumes such as this one.

On the Other Hand … Key Words: ambient pietism, Anthropology News, presentism Do the decolonizing critiques of recent years, wide-ranging and biting though they occasionally are, not mean that we should exclude some figures for their human flaws and sins? Our answer is a qualified no, because when discussing ideas of a theoretical nature (for instance, Malinowski’s functionalism as opposed to his racism as revealed in his much-discussed diaries), we believe that perfunctory dismissals are problematic and detract from a better appreciation of where anthropology comes from. While separating ideas from their progenitors is inevitably difficult and controversial, we should remember that calls to decolonize anthropological knowledge may caution not to take received authority at face value. But neither do they advocate descent into epistemological anarchy, atheoretical meandering, or solipsism. To the contrary, such voices encourage us to be more exacting and inclusive (in historical as well as contemporary terms) in our search for theoretical innovation and heretofore marginal or little-known thinkers, in the hope that true knowledge will bring us to a more just and humane global society. Although there is no universal agreement on the matter, in our view we should not be so quick to throw the baby out with the proverbial bathwater. Consider a perspective first offered by Herbert Lewis (b. 1934) in 1998 and reaffirmed in 2019 that, much as we might have hoped otherwise, and for all their purported insight, those fanning the flames of disciplinary critique had failed to substantially advance the field or even to suggest new ways to address those issues that had, until disciplinary critique became the vogue, been the focus for “modernist” anthropology. Adding to this frank evaluation, Lewis subsequently argued that an even bigger problem for the next generation of anthropologists might derive from a growing failure to adequately “dialogue with the ancestors.” Thus, some years later, contemporary undergraduates, and even graduate students, are seldom required to really confront the work of their disciplinary forebears in other than a cursory fashion. Instead, it is largely assumed (in no small measure as a result of reading postmodern and decolonizing critiques) that the substance and

248

CONCLUSION

method of earlier generations is both theoretically and morally bankrupt and that, consequently, there is little need to become acquainted with – let alone embrace – the work of “unenlightened” ancestors: heirs and handmaidens, all, to a colonialist mentalité. Indeed, the harshest among these critics have treated anthropology in much the same manner as they claim anthropology has treated non-Western peoples: as monolithic, single-minded, internally undifferentiated, and, to state the matter baldly, primitive. Lewis is not alone in wondering aloud about the continuing value of an anthropological discipline whose practioners seek – many with great zeal – to erode the very epistemic foundations on which the field was built. In a recent series of essays on the topic of  “classics” in anthropology, specifically concerning their effects on and value to the current state of the field, anthropologists of various ages, backgrounds, and theoretical orientations offer a variety of insights as to what monographs styled as classic have contributed to their anthropological education. Fred Myers (b. 1948), for instance, reflects that those books generally considered classic or canonical serve a vital and irreplaceable function in that “such works are part of the process of recognizing that knowledge and its production are historically embedded in institutions and social relations, difficult to develop, partial, and always subject to further questioning.” Although it is true that some such works may be “unredeemable,” the very best “allow for the exercise of … complex argument and critique, based on shared ‘texts.’” Books like Malinowski’s Argonauts of the Western Pacific and Evans-Pritchard’s Witchcraft, Oracles, and Magic among the Azande are consequently more than the ossified remnants of a colonialist undertaking (although some monographs may doubtless be considered that, too); they are works that “still speak to us” by providing sharp and in many cases hard-won ethnographic insights from which it is possible to compare across time and space; ideas about witchcraft as a process of social othering and exclusion, for instance, continue to resonate in today’s world across various domains – from the treatment of immigrants to the fear of contagious illness. While these works were arguably quite progressive and culturally sensitive in the context of their writing, one need not assume this to be the case for a given work to merit attention. Coming at this same issue from a different angle, John L. Jackson (b. 1971) makes the case that even works which by any standard cannot be countenanced as morally or scientifically accurate still merit discussion. For instance, Jackson suggests that the value of reading the transparently racist pseudoscience of Carleton Coon today is in the fact that many of Coon’s ideas are still being made and circulated today, “just in newfangled ways with more nuanced jargon and sophisticated technological accoutrements.” Students and others who would rather not read from the inimical past, he observes, seem to imagine that “the only way to think about knowledge is as the relentless pursuit of something that inoculates us from the need to know what has already been thought on a subject.”

249

CONCLUSION

presentism An implicit or explicit privileging of the present (and its associated ideas and perspectives) as transparently “better,” in terms of theory and ethics, than the past. ambient pietism  Anastasia Piliavsky’s term for collapising theoretical insight into an always-already ethical position. Anthropology News  The bimonthly news magazine published by and for members of the American Anthropological Association.

Moreover, contemporary anthropology – an academic field of splinters and ­ ssions – has become a discipline in which, as Anastasia Piliavsky (b. 1981) sugfi gests, a narrow and damaging presentism rules the roost, one in which moralizing about a bigoted colonial past renders us, ironically, less creative, less courageous, and extremely derivative. This fosters and supports, she proposes, what she calls an ambient pietism in the discipline, according to which analysis is supplanted with “assertions of one’s own moral or political stance” and in which our “normative position is deployed as fundamental social theory” (italics in original). Instead of being bound together by “once-shared questions,” we are now fragmented into theoretical positions that are recursively projected in axiomatic fashion onto ethnographic data; “the shock of novelty quickly gives way to an experience of uniformity” as “the confusion of advocacy for analysis has made contemporary anthropology allergic to any kind of genuine moral or political difference.” In a 2019 essay published in Anthropology News, Lewis again spoke in defense of the anthropological ancestors, arguing that the postmodern “revolution” originated more in the “anger and disenchantment” of the political Left in the 1960s and 1970s than in the flaws of anthropologists who, he maintains, have been unjustly caricatured. Perhaps, he reflects, the field had succumbed to a collective sense of frustration and impotency in face of a world gone awry, and that the criticism turned outward – seemingly ineffectual – was more effective and (perversely) satisfying when turned inward. In effect, the discipline itself became a target when all others proved immune to the barbs of anthropological reasoning. The postcolonial and decolonizing critiques have become, for Lewis, an invitation for anthropologists to feel shame and stigma – to carry a “large scarlet ‘C’” on their consciences in the expectation that such will prove morally and (presumably) epistemologically salutary for the health of the discipline. He dryly observes that “despite the games some commentators play with the notion, ‘to know’ did not mean to control, to exploit, to dominate, or to feel superior.” Rather, anthropologists of yesteryear worked and wrote tirelessly (often for “peanuts” and with little prospect of academic advancement) in defense of and devotion to the peoples among whom they lived and worked – certainly by the 1960s at “home” as well as abroad. Of course, if, as we have been arguing, we refrain from simple dismissal of the traditional canon, opting instead to expand it, then at least part of Lewis’s argument will be moot. Graduate-level education, however, will continue to confront the issue of a dearth of familiarity among students with the many legacies of anthropologists, famous and infamous, known and unknown. This brings us back to a review of some of the developments we outline in the later sections of this book and to our thoughts on the role that the institutional apparatuses of that hallowed industry we call academia play in structuring and disciplining the education of student anthropologists.

250

CONCLUSION

Demystifying the Department Whether or not there is a groundswell of support for deconstructing or decolonizing the traditional anthropological canon, as we enter the third decade of the twenty-first century we can at least perceive the tissues that connect and the fault lines that rupture theoretical orientations within and across the discipline – most obviously (from the student point of view) in their spaces of education: academic departments and classrooms, but also in the textbooks they are assigned. From a loftier vantage, we can also consider how the famous institutional structuring of anthropology in North American universities into four fields has affected ideas about anthropological ancestors. The contested character of an education in college anthropology, most especially in terms of theory, is often transparent. Proponents of anthropology as an “interpretive science” seek to understand the global interconnections among power, identity, and practice. These constitute a camp of humanistically oriented scholars whose proverbial tents (not to mention departmental offices) are pitched alongside those who would defend a biocultural, ecological, or materialist vision of their discipline. Generally speaking, the distinction between “public” and “applied” anthropology mirrors this rift, at least to the extent that many applied practitioners tend to embrace positivism as traditionally received within the academy at large. Self-described public anthropologists may or may not be “applied” scholars in this sense, but in all cases their chief desire is to bring to light for non-academic consumption the cultural biases, misapprehensions, and distortions in power that shape events in the world (albeit with mixed degrees of success, as our Part Four discussion of public anthropology recognizes). On another level, we do see among those influenced by gender and sexuality theory, postcolonial theory, and the postmodern critiques an unabashed interest in activism for social justice and equality. While positivist-oriented anthropologists often share these concerns, there is on the whole much less enthusiasm for fusing scientific with social ambitions. This has in turn led to something of a diffidence within either camp to the methods and goals of the other. Arguments and disputes happen, and it is often embarrassingly clear who gets along with whom among departmental faculty. That undergraduate and graduate students encounter this “diversity of perspective” up close – in lecture halls, university corridors, and at departmental receptions – is incontrovertible. Unfortunately, although an important experience for young anthropologists, student encounters with the sharply divergent backgrounds, theoretical orientations, and opinions of their professors can also be somewhat misleading about both the durability and value of various perspectives. According to Herbert Lewis, this opacity is exacerbated by contemporary curricula in which students are seldom given the opportunity to immerse themselves in many watershed texts of disciplinary anthropology. These texts are frequently

251

CONCLUSION

referred to in graduate seminars but are rarely explored in any sustained depth these days, and, even when they are discussed in detail, it is often for the purpose of displaying the “misrepresentation” of older schools and personalities – these are our ancestors, and here is how they got it wrong. For this reason, Lewis feared that “the basic questions that our predecessors [perhaps a preferable term to ‘ancestors’] struggled with years ago are still with us, but the hard-won lessons they taught us are being forgotten.” One possible implication of the postmodern and decolonizing critiques has therefore been that the field is so theoretically divided as to spell the end of academic anthropology as we know it. Nevertheless, the structural constraints and exigencies of academic colleges and departments should not be sidelined as factors in the persistence and apparent permanence of institutional anthropology.

Colonial Texts Extending this discussion, let us briefly consider anthropology as a material artifact. Any honest assessment of the state of anthropology as a field of knowledge production must consider this work in terms of who crafts it and who it is crafted for – in our case, a textbook about anthropological theory (although the materiality of professional anthropology is disseminated in many forms: films, peer-reviewed journals, monographs, field reports, occasional papers, etc.). At the risk of oversimplification (and despite efforts by the Center for a Public Anthropology, among others), this textbook is produced by and exists within a postsecondary-education– centered industry that publishes, distributes, and profits from academic works. Importantly, the niche market of textbook production, in particular, depends on the considerable purchasing power of students in colleges and universities at home and abroad. The depth and breadth of sales of any given book, in turn, are driven by the processes of course adoption by individual faculty who typically (but certainly not always) make their own decisions about which books to assign for courses they instruct. Faculty make their decisions on the basis of a host of subjective considerations related to their own subfield interests and training. According to the logic of publishing, textbooks that appeal to the largest share of  “adopters” will sell the most copies, thus consolidating a market share and ensuring the viability of subsequent editions (which, with some variation, are expected to appear every four or five years). Books that sell many copies, therefore, can reasonably expect to be reproduced materially, and the claims and positions of their authors solidified as orthodoxy – that is, as canon. Complicating matters, the textbook-publishing industry dances an intricate and ongoing quadrille with a variety of different college and department needs and configurations. Faculty work and teach within a host of institutionalized bureaucracies. In North America, these are mainly academic departments 252

CONCLUSION

in postsecondary colleges and universities. Anthropology departments, we might reasonably argue, are more internally varied than most.We generally operate in the institutional context of the traditional “four fields” (sociocultural, linguistic, biological, and archaeological anthropology), with the occasional “fifth” (applied and/ or practicing, although not yet “public,” anthropology). Our colleagues write and teach across a spectrum of assumptions and backgrounds, ranging from the quantitative and positivistic to the humanistic and poststructural, and all stops in between. Because faculty who teach courses in the history of anthropology frequently emerge from different wings of the discipline, with diverse theoretical groundings and concerns, when it comes to selection of textbooks, those books that embrace a wide range of theoretical vantages and orientations are likely to be more appealing than those anchored in a particular perspective or subfield.

A Four-Field Future? Let us briefly address the issue of the fabled “four fields” (setting aside the “fifth” for the purpose of discussion), an institutional fact the premise of which is no longer accepted by many North American anthropologists. A 2006 debate on the issue in Anthropology News is diagnostic of an enduring fascination with the theme of unity, especially across the “sacred bundle” (as Daniel Segal [b. 1958] and Sylvia Yanagisako [b. 1945] have called it) of the historical four fields in North American anthropology. In debating the state of four-field anthropology, anthropologists, both pro- and anti-schism, were given equal time to air their differences. Some, such as R. Brooke Thomas (b. 1939), stand firm in a “traditional” position, arguing that “our strength as a discipline seems to lie in the multiple perspectives we can bring to a problem.” His expectation was that pressing environmental needs confronting the globe will inevitably bring together biological and cultural approaches in the coming generations. On the other side of the issue, Fran Mascia-Lees (b. 1953) has suggested that rumors of peaceful coexistence – theoretically and practically – among the subfields have been greatly exaggerated. Despite her personal commitment to anthropological holism, the stark facts suggest that while much is made of disciplinary unity, with relatively few exceptions most professionals blithely pursue research agendas that focus squarely on one of the subfields. It is vital, therefore, that we ask ourselves the very serious question of whether there exist “compelling intellectual connections” among us, or whether assumptions to this effect are little more than an artifact of our professional past. In fact, Mascia-Lees suggests, no one in particular is to blame for this “crisis” of fragmentation; it has been a largely organic and even predictable development within what continues to be a vibrant, efflorescing discipline. 253

CONCLUSION

In light of such disagreements, it would not do to adopt a smug posture on the issue, content in our comfortable certainties about the future of anthropology. If it is true, as Eric Wolf proposed in the early 1980s and as we discussed earlier, that a unified anthropology springs more from institutional developments and forms of regimentation and discipline in the modern academy than it does from consensus about social and cultural theory, there is no reason to suppose that anthropology needs to be unified across four fields in order to retain its analytical value or power. The European academy provides a strong precedent, given that social anthropology, biological anthropology, linguistics, and archaeology are seldom, if ever, housed within the same departments and colleges. It is also true that schism within North American university anthropology departments has taken place and seemingly without apocalyptic consequences; witness painful ruptures at Stanford, Duke, Calgary (since repaired), and Harvard, among others.

Histories to Come Key Words: Black Lives Matter, structural racism, weapons of mass destruction In 2002, the American Anthropological Association celebrated its centennial year, a distinguished commemoration that coincided with a chorus of voices, from all quarters of the discipline, clamoring for increased introspection and attention to the future of the field. That same year, in their introduction to the centennial edition of American Anthropologist, Regna Darnell (b. 1943) and Frederic W. Gleach (b.  1960) wrote that we were living in and passing through a “Janus-faced” moment, in which we were “looking both to the past and to the future for inspiration.” These comments did not reflect that aloof, unsentimental, and detached anthropology prized in the heydays of evolutionism and structural-functionalism, but an impassioned, ethically committed hope for the future. It is a perspective that suggests that the future relevance of anthropology lies in its ability to contribute to essentially moral debates about social relations. Following the lead of public anthropology and calls to decolonize the discipline, future theory may well turn on the moral implications of the narratives we construct – the stories we tell – about human diversity, agency, and rights. The sites of such theorizing may be university departments, professional journals, and conferences. Or, as others have chosen, these discussions might take place in the more public arenas that comprise today’s mass media: newspapers, magazines, television, the internet, and other forms of social and electronic media. If this is indeed to be the discipline’s path, anthropologists must be prepared to continue divesting themselves of illusions concerning the history of their field as a “pure” science free from colonial consequences and pretensions. As a 254

CONCLUSION

consequence of a variety of political and social events and movements, especially following the end of World War II, few would now dispute that past approaches to making anthropological theory tell a (his-)story that is deeply embedded in Euro-American experience. In the case of the story we present in this book, the many theoretical orientations of academic anthropology are, thus, extensions and blendings of patterns of Western science and humanism from antiquity to the present. Arguably, the most momentous historical episodes of all in this epistemological lineage have been the voyages of geographical “discovery,” which brought Europeans into contact with non-Europeans and launched the period of crosscultural encounter that, in one way or another, has been a centripetal focus for anthropology ever since. We should not forget that this “encounter” was anything but neutral, for it also resulted in a colonial subjugation and erasure that has been the dark belly of anthropology ever since. As proponents of decolonizing anthropology have so importantly told us, non-Eurocentric stories – non-Eurocentric anthropologies – remain largely to be told. This recasting of anthropological knowledge is perhaps the most welcome, and inevitable, consequence of latetwentieth- and early-twenty-first-century theory. After all, as Darnell and Gleach observed, “there is a certain satisfaction in casting our nets so broadly that almost anything can be encompassed by the term anthropology, as long as it is thought about anthropologically.” In closing, we note that among sociocultural and linguistic anthropologists, there is certainly excitement over new areas of research. We see aspects of this in the study of global social media and the exponential digitalization of communications technologies, as well as in an increased comprehension and questioning of received assumptions about gender, sexuality, and even (with the recent rise of posthumanism) the separation of humanity from the rest of the biological world. We see it, too, in a growing commitment to a public anthropology that is ethically engaged and renders us something other than indifferent bystanders on the world stage – an anthropology that interrogates the ideological roots of such institutions as biomedicine and international development. Finally, as discussed above, we glimpse discontent and restlessness in the extensive efforts to “decolonize” anthropological narratives such as those presented in this book. In these respects, at least, the field is “on the move” in the best possible sense; anthropologists are reflexively open to embracing and expanding a core value of anthropology that situates unity in diversity and blurs the boundaries between the natural and cultural, the familiar and the exotic, and (pointedly) the canonical and the non-canonical. The future also looks exciting for archaeological and biological anthropology, where new theoretical perspectives on identity, ethnicity, and race, coupled with new on-the-ground practices of professional inclusion, have set the stage for novel outcomes that have yet to unfold. The Anthropocene in particular holds great promise for re-imaginings of archaeological and biological anthropology in relation to the other fields of anthropology, to the discipline of anthropology as a 255

CONCLUSION

structural racism Refers to the normalization and institutionalization of unequal social and power relations among different racial and ethnic groups. Black Lives Matter  Founded in 2013, BLM is an international socialjustice movement whose mission is to dismantle white supremacy, call attention to structural racism and injustice, and intervene against state-sponsored violence against communities of color. weapons of mass destruction Or WMDs, the euphemistic term for weapon technologies with the potential to cause casualties on a massive scale – for example, biological, chemical, and nuclear weapons.

whole, and to the multitude of other intellectual and sociopolitical pursuits aimed at addressing the perilous state of the world. Clearly, these enthusiasms have been formed in the context of profound insecurities about the world that confronts us. Among these, the destabilizing and relativizing of academic and other forms of authority vex many teaching anthropologists in ways that are not easily resolved. Globalizing vectors of cultural practice, combined with deep ethical commitments to a decolonizing world and the untethering of anthropological knowledge from its own Eurocentric roots, have conspired to decenter (and perhaps undermine) the meaning and value of anthropology as a scholarly field. Not infrequently, it is our own insight that makes us wary and curbs our passion for the novel. We see this in an increase of attention to the withering effects of anthropological privilege across multiple domains – Eurocentric, white, cisgender, heteronormative, and able-bodied, to name a few. How are we to overcome such difficulties, when they seem lodged in the discipline’s DNA, not to mention a public imagination that continues to uncritically accept such discarded binaries as “civilized” and “primitive”? Similarly, the fashioning of Anthropocene as a new focus of the ethnographic gaze, public anthropology, and disciplinary ethics, for instance, have in many ways made crystal clear what had long been implicit: that how humans treat one another and how humanity as a whole exploits the planet will have consequences: sooner or later, the bill must be paid. Admittedly, cynicism is difficult to avoid, especially given that seemingly intractable problems confront us at every turn, threatening to destabilize the future in frightening ways. The global pandemic beginning in 2019, COVID-19, for instance, now saturates every social institution and touches the lives of virtually all peoples in the world. The unrelenting nature of this contagion both confirms the fact of global interconnectedness itself and, more ominously, the speed at which such viral diseases can infect millions or even billions. As if pathogens and the global pandemics they spawn were not sufficient triggers of pessimism, in the United States, case after case of racially motivated killing of mainly young African-American men by police have once again brought to the forefront of national awareness the pernicious legacy of structural racism in the US – a recognition crystalized both in the birth of a new, multi-ethnic social movement, Black Lives Matter, and in weeks and months of unrest and protesting. Terrible as these events are, they represent only part of a very grim picture on the broader canvas. Humanity is also confronted by exponential global warming and climate change; the destructive effects of unrestrained resource extraction; attacks on biodiversity; snowballing population densities; unbridled neoliberalism and the obscene discrepancies of social status, wealth, influence, and access it foments (even to the most basic amenities of life such as clean water and nutritious food); resurgent nationalisms and nativisms; violent ideologies of many kinds; and the ease with which ever more lethal weapons of mass destruction are circulated, acquired, made, and used.

256

CONCLUSION

In what ways can anthropology help us to make sense of these developments and, where possible, intervene to solve them? More to the point, at least in relation to this volume, can the story we tell of anthropological theory – despite being eclectic, unsettled, and (perhaps) pre-decolonized – help us ferret out the root causes of human malpractice, malfeasance, and enmity, to one another and to the world in general? Further, how does our narrative contribute to a more powerful focus on what we assume to be true, real, or taken for granted in current anthropological reasoning? If we venture to forecast what to expect in coming years, we believe that most anthropologists today would affirm that the discipline’s ongoing intellectual vigor is not undermined but revealed, both by the proliferation of interests, perspectives, and methods and by the eagerness with which practitioners engage one another, articulating and defending their positions both in print and in the heated salons of professional conferences. For these reasons, arguments over theory are perhaps better thought of as means of integrating diverse kinds of practitioners into a single, flexible, yet enduring whole. All things considered, it hardly seems controversial to maintain that it is the strength of debate, rather than the narrowness of opinion, that is the hallmark of any strong academic discipline. If such were not the case, there would likely be little or no interest in books such as this one. Finally, it seems to us fitting to return to what is perhaps the most important site of anthropological practice for most university-based anthropologists: the classroom. From the perspective of teaching anthropology, it bears noting that sometimes courses in the history of anthropological theory are taught by the acrobatic “trapeze method,” meaning that theories are connected by “swinging” from older to more recent orientations as the academic semester or quarter progresses. Connections among theories taught according to this method often remain implicit and are, therefore, at best superficial and at worst conducive to the false impression that theories float above real people like acrobats who never touch the ground. This impression is perhaps unavoidable. Still, this book shows that the history of theory is defined not so much by “facts” as by the proclivities of different anthropological historians and historians of theory and by the vagaries and extent of consensus that develop around one or another perspective. Only the most novice readers will conclude, after reading this book, that theory is simply “out there,” ready to be plucked from the air by a particularly ingenious or fortuitous “discoverer.” Far from being unsullied by human hands, students of the diversity of opinion within anthropology will benefit from what is perhaps the most enduring insight of twenty-first-century anthropology so far: that the making of knowledge about human life is a labor-intensive, contentious, and thoroughly human activity. After modernity, anthropological theory too – unlike the acrobat – has its feet planted on terra firma.

257

CONCLUSION

STUDY QUESTIONS 1. According to Herbert Lewis, how have postmodern trends in anthropological theory distorted and misrepresented the value of anthropological ancestors? 2. In reference to which issues have anthropologists debated the pros and cons of a four-field schism? 3. What government departments and organizations are in the greatest need of advice from anthropologists? 4. What is meant by the phrase “creative non-fiction,” and how might it be used to frame anthropological writing? 5. How might a kairos-oriented anthropology prove productive in ways that a chronos-oriented one cannot? 6. In what ways would decolonizing our conventional narrative of anthropological history help to make the canon more inclusive? 7. Ten years from now, which anthropological theories do you think will prevail?

258

Glossary This glossary defines the key words bolded in the text. They are also defined in the margins. adaptation  In cultural ecology,

the result of cultures adjusting to environments, or in Darwinian evolution, the result of natural selection. adhesions  Edward Burnett Tylor’s name

for cultural traits that are statistically significantly associated. agency  In recent anthropological

theory, creative acts of intentioned individuals that generate social form and meaning. alchemy  An array of medieval

experimental practices intended to transform matter from one state of being into another (for instance, lead into gold). In this way, alchemy foreshadowed modern chemistry. allopathic  The treatment of illness

and disease using the knowledge and techniques of Western biomedicine. altruism  Self-sacrificing behavior,

seemingly contrary to natural selection. ambient pietism  Anastasia Piliavsky’s

term for collapising theoretical insight into an always-already ethical position. American Anthropological Association (AAA)  Founded in 1902, the AAA is

the largest professional association of anthropologists in the world, with a membership of over 10,000.

American Anthropologist  The

flagship professional and peerreviewed journal of the American Anthropological Association. analog  Electronic signals characterized

by a limitless range of possible values within a specified range, made increasingly obsolete with the widening availability of digital technology. ancestor worship  The veneration of

departed relatives; in classical cultural evolutionism, a religious phase. androcentrism  A deeply held and

culturally conditioned bias that views males as inherently intellectually, spiritually, morally, and physically superior to females. anglocentrism  A privileging of the

Anglo-American English language as a global medium of communication and patterns of cultural practice and consumption, tending to marginalize other languages and those who use them. anima  An invisible and diffuse

supernatural force that can take the form of souls and ghosts. anomie  According to Émile Durkheim,

the sense of personal alienation caused by the absence of familiar social norms.

259

GLOSSARY Anthropocene  An interdisciplinary

body of thought that proposes that a new geological, biological, and social “epoch” be assigned the Earth, dating from the beginning of humanity’s profound disruption of natural processes to the present. anthropo-geography  The study of

relationships among geographically contiguous cultures, as practiced by Friedrich Ratzel. anthropological feminism  A term

generally used synonymously with feminist anthropology. anthropological political economy 

The view that peoples exposed to the global expansion of capitalism experience and modify it in different and creative ways. Anthropology News  The bimonthly

news magazine published by and for members of the American Anthropological Association. anti-languages  As discussed by M.A.K.

Halliday, anti-language varieties share basic grammar and vocabulary with other varieties but are stylized and valorized by members of socially marginal or ostracized groups – typically for the purpose of signaling social inclusion and exclusion. antipodes  Opposites, or peoples on

opposite sides of the world. anti-structure  According to Victor

Turner, the side of culture expressed through ritual “chaos,” as during liminal states. applied anthropology  Anthropology

conducted by anthropologists working outside traditional academic settings such as universities. 260

armchair anthropologist  An

anthropologist who has done little or no fieldwork. Augustinian Christianity  The

theology of Saint Augustine, which became the state religion of Rome and prevailed during the first part of the Middle Ages. australopiths  Primitive, ape-like

human ancestors known from fossils found in Africa. authoritative knowledge  The idea that

one body of knowledge is privileged over other bodies in that it has greater access to ultimate reality or the “truth.” autoethnographic  A term suggesting

both the study of a culture and/or society by a member of that culture and/or society and the inclusion of autobiographical information in ethnographic writing in such a way that the author in a sense becomes their own informant. band  The simplest form of human social

organization, placed in evolutionary sequence before the tribe, chiefdom, and state. barbarism  See savagery basic personality structure  In

psychodynamic anthropology, core personality, shaped by primary cultural institutions and projected onto secondary cultural institutions. behavioral domain  In the theory of

cultural materialism, what people do, contrasted with what people think. behavioral genetics  The branch of

genetics that investigates inherited contributions to behavioral differences. berdache  Originally a seventeenth-

century French term designating

GLOSSARY

a younger, submissive partner in a homosexual relationship, referring historically to Indigenous individuals who appeared, from the perspective of French colonizers and others, to be neither men nor women in terms of behavior and appearance. binary coding  In computer software

and other information technology, the expression of meaning in sequences of 0s and 1s, two binary digits that can be exponentially combined and recombined to produce new meanings. binary oppositions  In French

structural anthropology, the universal logic of dualities. binomial nomenclature  The hierarchical

system of classifying living things into named scientific groups, with one name for genus and a second name for species. biocultural anthropology 

Anthropology aimed at exploring interactions between human biology and culture, usually according to ecology. biogenetic law  The principle that

ontogeny, the growth of the individual, recapitulates phylogeny, the growth of the species. bio-logic  A term used to describe a

foundational assumption of biological determinism that underlies Western scientific reasoning about sex and gender. biologize  To regard as caused by

heredity more than by environment. biology of nepotism  A colloquial

label for sociobiology focusing on the preferential treatment of kin. biomedicine  The science-based form

of ethnomedical knowledge and practice dominant in Western societies.

Black Lives Matter  Founded in 2013,

BLM is an international social-justice movement whose mission is to dismantle white supremacy, call attention to structural racism and injustice, and intervene against state-sponsored violence against communities of color. body language  A colloquial term for

nonverbal communication. body-reasoning  A term describing the

Western scientific assumption that the human body is a universal foundation for objective knowledge concerning social and sexual identity. bourgeoisie  In Marxist terminology,

the middle class. British empiricism  The scientific

epistemology of induction fashioned by philosophers Francis Bacon and John Locke. British social anthropology  The

school of structuralism and functionalism led by Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown and Bronislaw Malinowski. California Series in Public Anthropology 

A book series started in 2001 by Robert Borofsky and published by the University of California Press.The series is devoted to promoting and disseminating work by anthropologists who are “engaged intellectuals” and to recasting how a public readership interprets issues of social importance. Calvinist Protestantism  Those

Christian doctrines and practices traced to John Calvin that oppose Roman Catholicism on the basis of scripture and justification by faith. capitalism  The political economic

system characterized by private ownership of the means of 261

GLOSSARY

production and unfettered exchange of commodities in the marketplace, yielding profit. cargo cults  Melanesian religious

revitalization movements that anticipate and celebrate the future return of material affluence. catastrophism  The geological doctrine

that agents of geological change have been more dramatic in the past than in the present; contrasted with uniformitarianism. Center for a Public Anthropology  A

non-profit institution founded in 2001 by Robert Borofsky that promotes the application of anthropological method and theory to addressing and resolving “public problems in public ways.” cephalic index  The measured ratio of

head breadth to head length, used in nineteenth-century racial classifications. charismatic prophets  As identified

by Max Weber, individuals who experience a revelation that mandates the establishment of a new social order based on new ethical ideals. chronos  An ancient Greek term for

chronological or sequential time that can be quantified and measured in units. civilization  See savagery classical cultural evolutionism  The

theoretical orientation of nineteenthcentury cultural evolutionists who used the comparative method. classificatory  A type of kinship,

contrasted with the descriptive type, that merges kinship categories. cline  A mapped gradient of the

geographical distribution of a particular genetic trait, sometimes used as a replacement for the concept of race. 262

clitoridectomy  A rite of passage

still practiced in some societies in which adolescent females are forced to undergo excision of their clitoris, frequently justified on the grounds of religion. code-switching  The use by a speaker

or speakers of more than one language variety, grammar, or vocabulary within a speech event, typically in response to extralinguistic variables such as the identity of participant-listeners and the relative formality or context of the event. cognitive anthropology  The school

concerned with folk taxonomies and semantic domains as practiced in ethnolinguistics and by ethnoscientists in the New Ethnography. collective consciousness  According

to Émile Durkheim, the source of collective representations of social facts, sometimes called the group mind. collective representations  According to

Émile Durkheim, manifestations of the collective consciousness, or group mind. colonial encounter  The historical

encounter between European colonizers and the Indigenous peoples of the world, who were then often marginalized or oppressed by colonialism. communist revolution  In Marxist

theory, the replacement of bourgeois by proletarian ownership of the means of production, ushering in socialism and ultimately communism. communitas  A term employed by Victor

Turner to refer to the ritual fusion of individuals into a collective identity. comparative method  The use of

extant primitive peoples to represent

GLOSSARY

extinct primitive peoples, as in classical cultural evolutionism. componential analysis  A research

technique of cognitive anthropologists used to generate folk taxonomies of semantic domains. configurationalism  The search for

cultural patterns, often in the idiom of psychology. consanguine  A family type based on

group marriage between brothers and sisters. contextual archaeology  Another name

for post-processual archaeology critical of the nomothetic New Archaeology. contract societies  In the schema of

Henry Maine, societies that stress individualism, hold property in private, and maintain control by legal sanctions; contrasted with status societies. core  In world-system theory,Western

nations and regions that expropriate and control resources of non-Western nations and regions; contrasted with periphery. cosmological order  A phrase

describing the nature of otherworldly deities or powers and their relationships to human beings. cosmology  The branch of philosophy

concerned with the origin and structure of the universe. COVID-19  According to the World Health

Organization (WHO) and Centers for Disease Control (CDC), COVID-19 is a new, highly contagious respiratory disease transmitted primarily by human saliva droplets/discharge when individuals are in close proximity to each other. Its effects range from mild to severe flu symptoms, and it has been shown to have a higher morbidity rate among people with underlying conditions (for instance,

cardiovascular and respiratory diseases, cancer, and diabetes). creationism  The view that biological

species are divinely created and do not evolve. creative non-fiction  A phrase used

by many anthropologists to highlight the unstable, liminal character of ethnographic knowledge as a product of both empirical observation and creative interpretation. creolization  An anthropological term

borrowed from linguistics suggesting the fusion of divergent cultural concepts and practices, particularly in the context of postcolonial and globalization studies. criterion of form  The criterion used

by anthropo-geographers to determine that similar cultural forms are the result of diffusion. critical anthropologists  Anthropologists

who self-reflect and share criticisms of positivism. cross-cousins  Cousins related through

parents of the opposite sex. cross-cultural analysis  Analysis of

similarities and differences across cultures. cultural appropriation  A phrase that

suggests the adoption of culturally meaningful aspects of one social community (for instance, language varieties, clothing styles, hairstyles) by members of a dominant social community. Because this process often involves the non-consensual extraction of subaltern culture by members of a dominant group or class, the process has come to be regarded by many as a form of colonial violence. cultural eclectics  Anthropological

theorists who on different occasions 263

GLOSSARY

attach causal priority to the domain of thought rather than behavior, or behavior rather than thought. cultural ecology  The examination

of interactions between cultural and environmental variables. cultural idealists  Anthropological

theorists who attach causal priority to the domain of thought rather than behavior. cultural materialism   The theory of

Marvin Harris that distinguishes emic from etic perspectives and mental from behavioral domains, and that advocates infrastructural determinism. cultural neo-evolutionism  Twentieth-

century cultural evolutionism, a revival and reformulation of classical cultural evolutionism. cultural relativism  The proposition

that cultural differences should not be judged by absolute standards. cultural resource management (CRM) 

Activities that share the practical goal of protecting and preserving objects and places deemed to be of cultural significance. Cultural Survival  Co-founded in

1972 by David Maybury-Lewis and Pia Maybury-Lewis, Cultural Survival is a non-governmental organization that globally advocates for Indigenous peoples’ rights and culture. Cultural Survival Quarterly  Formerly

the Cultural Survival Newsletter, Cultural Survival Quarterly is the main periodical publication of the Cultural Survival NGO. It features essays by scholars and Indigenous writers on topics related to Indigenous peoples’ rights around the world. 264

culture  Defined many ways; with

reference to the Enlightenment, the accumulated way of living created by people and transmitted from one generation to the next extrasomatically rather than through genes. culture areas  Geographical areas

associated with particular cultures. culture-at-a-distance  The study

of cultures without the benefit of fieldwork, practiced by American psychological anthropologists in the era of World War II. culture circle  In German, Kulturkreis, a

concept used to represent the process of cultural diffusion. culture-historical archaeology 

Archaeology as practiced in the era of Franz Boas’s historical particularism. culturology  Leslie White’s name for the

nomothetic study of culture. cybernetics  The study of regulatory

systems and structures taking various forms, including digital, mechanical, biological, and social systems, a term now aligned most closely with how any system is controlled by technology. Darwinism  A general label for ideas

associated with Charles Darwin’s theory of evolution. deconstruction  A term describing

the ambition of postmodernism to understand the political and cultural contexts “hidden” behind the writing, or “construction,” of narratives. deduction  In scientific epistemology,

the use of logic to reason from general to particular statements; contrasted with induction.

GLOSSARY deistic  Pertaining to deism, the view

that God created the universe but remains relatively uninvolved in its day-to-day operations; contrasted with theistic. deme  A reproductively isolated human

population, sometimes used as a synonym for the concept of race. descent group  Individuals who

perceive themselves to be descended in a lineage from a real or hypothetical common ancestor. descriptive  A type of kinship system,

contrasted with the classificatory type, that splits kinship categories. development and underdevelopment theory  André Gunder Frank’s theory

about the systematic exploitation of underdeveloped nation-states and regions by developed nation-states and regions. diachronic  Historically oriented, or

concerned with the past; contrasted with synchronic. dialect  A specific variety of a broader,

more inclusive language system in which aspects of vocabulary and grammar index the social and cultural background of a speaker or community of speakers. dialectical materialism  The

philosophy of Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels, commonly called Marxism. diary disease  Pierre Bourdieu’s

tongue-in-cheek label for the radical deconstruction of some postmodern theorists, particularly those preoccupied with second-guessing their own analyses. dictatorship of the proletariat  In

the theory of dialectical materialism, the temporary phase of political

organization leading to permanent communism. diffusionism  The doctrine that

cultural innovations evolve once and are then acquired through borrowing or immigration; contrasted with independent invention. digital  Referring to the use of two

digits, 0 and 1, in creating specific sequences of electronic directions or information, particularly in the context of computer software. diglossia  The coexistence of different

languages or language varieties within a relatively integrated speech community. Differential use among these is typically conditioned by context of use, formality of occasion, the identity of participants in a speech event, and so on. discourses of power  Michel Foucault’s

phrase for the spectrum of institutions, rhetorics, and strategies employed by one group to dominate another group. DNA  Deoxyribonucleic acid, the

biochemical substance of heredity. dominant symbol  Victor Turner’s

term for a symbol with multiple, and sometimes contradictory, meanings. Dot Com collapse  Also referred to as

the “Dot Com crash” or “bursting of the Dot Com bubble,” a sharp drop in stock value for many internet-based e-companies in 1999–2001, following a protracted period of strong growth and uninhibited venture capitalism throughout the 1990s. doxa  Pierre Bourdieu’s term for a

psychological state in which all members of a community consider relations natural, including relations 265

GLOSSARY

of social, economic, and political inequality.

adapted their behaviors in ways that can be maladaptive in contemporary settings.

dualism  The idea of philosopher

epigenetic evolution  The evolutionary

René Descartes that mind and matter constitute distinct realms knowable by distinct means. ego  Translated “I”; according to

Sigmund Freud, the part of the psyche that interacts with the outside world. Electra complex  According to

Sigmund Freud, the troublesome psychological state of girls induced by their sexual desire for their fathers; contrasted with the Oedipus complex. elementary forms  For Émile

Durkheim, the equivalent of collective representations, similar to elementary structures. elementary structures  In French

structural anthropology, universal mental logics and their cultural manifestations. emergent  In poststructural theory, the

term suggests the fluid character of culture and consciousness – always in the process of becoming and never “completed.” emic  In theories including cultural

materialism, the epistemological perspective of the investigated, or “the insider point of view”; contrasted with etic. enculturation  The process of an

individual acquiring culture, usually while growing up. entropy  Disorder in the universe,

increasing according to the second law of thermodynamics. environment of evolutionary adaptedness  A term used by

evolutionary psychologists to designate prehistoric settings to which humans 266

process by which environmentally induced alteration of the expression of genes can be inherited, tantamount to Lamarckism. epiphenomenon  A phenomenon

resulting from another phenomenon. epistemology  The branch of

philosophy that explores the nature of knowledge. ethical  Pertaining to prescriptions for

correct behavior that put the individual in accordance with a metaphysical order. ethnocentric  Pertaining to

ethnocentrism, or cultural bias. ethnography of communication (EOC)  Originally called the

“ethnography of speaking,” EOC was intended by Dell Hymes as a method of applying ethnographic methods to the analysis of patterns of meaningful speech use within and across social and speech communities. The change in name reflects a recognition that meaningful communication is also nonvocal and nonverbal. ethnohydrology  The ethnographic

study of how people think about, use, and manage water and water resources. ethnolinguistics  A general term for

the anthropological study of language in cultural context. ethnomedical  Pertaining to

ethnomedicine, the anthropological study of non-Western medical systems. ethnoscience  A term referencing the

collection of theories and methods used in cognitive anthropology.

GLOSSARY ethnosemantics  Refers to the study

of linguistic meaning, logic, and organization in cultural context. ethology  The study of animal behavior in

the understanding that it sheds light on the innateness of certain human behaviors. ethos  A term meaning spiritual

character, used by some anthropologists to characterize a whole culture. etic  In theories including cultural

materialism, the epistemological perspective of the investigator, or “the outsider point of view”; contrasted with emic. eugenicist  Pertaining to eugenics,

the now-discredited science that endeavored to “improve” humanity through selective breeding. Eurocentric  The rating of non-European

cultures according to a generalized European scale of norms and values. evolution  Whether in the realm of

culture or biology, the transformation of one form into another. evolutionary developmental biology  Or “evo-devo,” the genetic

study of how development in different organisms occurs, with the aim of inferring evolutionary relationships among those organisms. evolutionary psychology  An

outgrowth of sociobiology that uses Charles Darwin’s theory of evolution to explain aspects of human mentality and behavior as adaptations from the past. exogamy  The practice of marrying or

mating outside one’s kinship group; contrasted with endogamy. false consciousness  In the theories of

Marxism and cultural materialism, the

capability of people to misrepresent the meaning of their behavior to themselves and others. father figures  In the psychology of

Sigmund Freud, totems that represent culturally ambivalent attitudes toward adult men. female infanticide  The practice of

treating male children more favorably than female children, resulting in more female deaths. feminist anthropology  The view

that perspectives and values associated with gender, and in particular those that inform ideas about “women” as a global category different from “men,” must be incorporated into anthropological reasoning and writing. fields  According to Pierre Bourdieu,

the dynamic configuration, or network, of objective relationships among social agents and positions. first cause  A phrase from ancient

Greek philosophy that signals the ultimate source of all causation (hence existence) in the universe. It was adapted by Aquinas and other medieval thinkers for Christian theology. fixed action pattern  as conceived

by human ethologists, an innate sequence of behavior released by a key stimulus of an innate releasing mechanism. folk taxonomies  According to

cognitive anthropologists, culturally conditioned maps of semantic domains. formalists  Economic anthropologists

who maintained that Western economic concepts apply to nonWestern economies; contrasted with substantivists. 267

GLOSSARY four-field approach   The traditional

approach of American anthropology that divides the study of anthropology into the four fields of archaeological, biological, cultural, and linguistic anthropology. French rationalism  The intellectual

tradition associated with René Descartes and the scientific epistemology of deduction. French structural anthropology   The

theoretical orientation of Claude Lévi-Strauss and his followers, invoking elementary mental structures, reciprocity, and binary oppositions. Freudian anthropology   The school

of psychological anthropology incorporating certain elements of the psychology of Sigmund Freud, also called psychodynamic anthropology. functionalism  In British social

anthropology, either Alfred Reginald Radcliffe-Brown’s theory of how parts of a society contribute to the whole of society or Bronislaw Malinowski’s theory of how culture responds to biological needs in a hierarchically organized way. Geisteswissenschaften  Translated

“human sciences,” including anthropology; contrasted with Naturwissenschaften. gender  The various social roles and

identities attributed to individuals and groups on the basis of biological sex. genealogical method  The method

of focusing ethnographic fieldwork on kinship, pioneered by British social anthropologists, notably William H.R. Rivers. general evolution  In the cultural

evolutionary schema of Marshall 268

Sahlins and Elman Service, the study of long-range evolutionary progress and trends. generalized exchange  According to

Claude Lévi-Strauss, the exchange of women among more than two kinship groups, promoting greater social solidarity than restricted exchange. general systems theory  A cybernetic

model for culture used in the New Archaeology. gestalt  A psychological configuration,

attributed by some psychological anthropologists to an entire culture. G.I. Bill  Technically the Serviceman’s

Readjustment Act, the General Infantry Bill implemented in the United States in 1944 in order to provide various benefits to veterans of World War II, including subsidized tuition and living expenses for veterans wishing to attend college or vocational school. globalization  The expansion of

Western institutions and lifeways into non-Western cultures and the emergence of new forms of cultural practice that are global in scope. global village  Marshall McLuhan’s

term for an increasingly interconnected global society. glocalization  A term popularized

by Roland Robertson to describe the coexistence of globalizing and particularizing tendencies in a society. Great Chain of Being  A medieval

philosophical schema that ranked all cosmic and earthly elements, including people, in a single ascending line of importance.

GLOSSARY great man theory of history  The

theory that individuals affect the course of history more than do historical circumstances. great tradition  Robert Redfield’s term

for cultures characterized by literacy, industrialization, and rational religions; contrasted with little tradition. group mind  According to Émile

Durkheim, the source of collective representations of social facts, sometimes called collective consciousness. group selection  A form of natural

selection in which individuals behave altruistically, helping their group, and thereby helping themselves; contrasted with kin selection. habitus  Pierre Bourdieu’s term for the

capacity of individuals to innovate cultural forms based on their personal histories and positions within the community. hegemony  A term for the capacity of

one social group to impose particular beliefs or political and economic conditions upon another group. heliocentrism  Literally “sun-

centeredness,” the diffusionist view that world civilizations arose from sun worship in Egypt and then spread elsewhere. hereditarianism  The idea that

differences among human beings can be accounted for primarily in terms of differential gene distribution to an extent greater than most twenty-firstcentury biological anthropologists would accept. hermeneutics  The study of meaning,

especially in literary texts, applied by interpretive and postmodern anthropologists to the study of culture.

Hinduism  An umbrella term for the

many local and regional religions of India, most of which emphasize the concept of dharma (loosely defined as cosmic law or ultimate truth, toward which Hindus aspire with the goal of salvation), together with their associated myths, rituals, and ascetic practices. historical linguistics  The study of

language over time, consisting of the reconstruction and descriptive tracking of language genealogies over time. historical particularism  The

theoretical orientation of Franz Boas and many of his students who focused on the particular histories of particular cultures. history of the present  A phrase coined

by Michel Foucault referencing the role of power-laden rationalities/logics in structuring modern institutions. It is to understanding the frequently opaque or hidden “genealogies” of these contemporary arrangements that his vision of history was oriented; that is, not to studying the past for the sake of understanding the present in a tautological way, but to analyzing the present in order to glean the significance of past events and activities. holistic  Pertaining to an overarching

or integrated outlook, often associated with the broad scope of anthropological inquiry. Holocene  A geological epoch that

began between 11,000 and 12,000 years ago, after the last glacial epoch (“ice age”). human biogram  A term used in

human ethology to describe the alleged suite of inherited predispositions of Homo sapiens. 269

GLOSSARY human exceptionalism  An idea implicit

in many academic disciplines (and especially anthropology) that human beings, alone in the natural world, are privileged and should be the focus of efforts to save, liberate, and/or redeem from global crises and catastrophes. Human Genome Diversity Project  A

late-twentieth-century international research project involving the use of DNA obtained from Indigenous populations to reconstruct the pattern of evolutionary relationships among those populations. Human Genome Project  A late-

twentieth-century international research project that succeeded in mapping, or assigning, the structures of human DNA to particular places on particular human chromosomes. humanism  A system of thought

that prioritizes people, contrasted with nature and with a divine or metaphysical order. Human Terrain System (HTS)  From

2007 to 2015, a United States army program in which servicepersons trained across a range of social scientific fields studied civilian populations in regions where the army was deployed, in order to advise military leaders on how best to engage and communicate with these populations, broadly supporting the goals of counterinsurgency. hypothetico-deductive model  A

philosophical model for scientific explanation used in the New Archaeology. hysteria  The clinical condition of calm

hallucination that got Sigmund Freud interested in psychology. 270

id  Or libido, according to Sigmund

Freud, the part of the human psyche that expresses natural desires. idealist  Pertaining to idealism, the view

that ideas more than material existence cause culture change. ideational  A term describing the view of

Max Weber and others that the holistic individual is central to the creation, maintenance, and change of culture. ideology  A term used by Karl Marx and

Marxist scholars denoting a system of beliefs that influences the outlooks of individuals and groups. idiographic  Pertaining to a

particularizing approach to description and explanation; contrasted with nomothetic. illocutionary acts  Pertains to linguistic

performances and accomplishments made “real” in and through the speech itself (for instance, “I promise,” “I swear”). Imperial Synthesis  A name for the

nineteenth-century synthesis of archaeology, racism, and colonialism. incest  Culturally proscribed inbreeding

that, according to Sigmund Freud, is an act that led to the primal patricide. inclusive fitness  In sociobiology, the

measure, or result, of kin selection. independent invention  The doctrine,

linked to psychic unity, that cultural innovation can occur independently in more than one place; contrasted with diffusionism. indigenous anthropology  A phrase

employed by some anthropologists (e.g., Donald Messerschmidt) to indicate the study of particular social

GLOSSARY

communities and cultures by members of those cultures, rather than outsiders or those working within a Eurocentric colonial system. Indigenous archaeology  Archaeology

that in theory and practice incorporates Indigenous perspectives and participation. indirect rule  The British colonial policy

of co-opting Indigenous leaders in order to avoid having to govern by force. induction  In scientific epistemology, the

process of arriving at generalizations about particular facts; contrasted with deduction. informant  In anthropological fieldwork,

someone who provides information to the fieldworker. infrastructural determinism  In

Marvin Harris’s theory of cultural materialism, the name for the belief that culture change usually begins in the etic infrastructure. inheritance of acquired characteristics 

The mechanism of biological evolution, proposed by Jean Lamarck, whereby traits acquired in one generation can be transmitted to subsequent generations. innate releasing mechanism  As

conceived by human ethologists, the mechanism that, when triggered by a key stimulus, releases a fixed action pattern. inner-worldly asceticism  According

to Max Weber, the ethical demand of Calvinist Protestantism that Christians not retreat from the world in order to live piously. instrumental symbols  Victor Turner’s

term for those symbols that can be consciously wielded in ritual as a form

of technology in order to achieve particular ends. International Union of Geological Sciences  A non-governmental

organization of professional geologists that fosters global cooperation in geological science and identifies areas of global scientific consensus on, and approaches to, various geological and climatological matters. interpretive anthropology  The

anthropological school, associated with Clifford Geertz, espousing the view that culture is lived experience integrated into a coherent, public system of symbols that renders the world intelligible. interpretive archaeology  Another

name for contextual, or post-processual, archaeology, reflecting its origins in interpretive anthropological theory. intersex  Refers to individuals born

with an atypical blend of genetic and phenotypical sex characteristics, the combination of which is not fully described in conventional sex nomenclature. ivory tower  A euphemistic and usually

pejorative term for the academy or universities. Jensenism  The label attached to the

view of behavioral geneticist Arthur Jensen that IQ is highly heritable and differs among human races. jointly told tales  A phrase coined

by John Van Maanen to describe the postmodern effort to produce ethnographic narratives that are dialogical and that showcase the “shared character of cultural descriptions.” kairos  An ancient Greek term for time

qualitatively conceived as appropriate, 271

GLOSSARY

propitious, and/or opportune in contrast to a linear sequence of units. Mythic narratives are often discussed in terms of their kairos-bound, permanently “happening” character. key stimulus  As conceived by human

ethologists, the device that triggers an innate releasing mechanism, thus releasing a fixed action pattern. kinesics  The scientific study of human

body motion. kin selection  In sociobiology,

reproductive success via genes shared with relatives; sometimes called the biology of nepotism. knowledge  According to Michel

Foucault, information linked to social discourses of power. K-selection  In certain evolutionary

theories, the reproductive strategy whereby parents choose to have few offspring and invest heavily in their upbringing, contrasted with r-selection. kula ring  A cultural and economic

exchange network among inhabitants of the Trobriand Islands, studied by Bronislaw Malinowski. Kulturkreis  Translated “culture circle”;

according to certain theorists, the pattern of diffusion of cultural traits. labor theory of value  The proposition

of Karl Marx that commodities should be valued in terms of the human labor required to produce them. Lamarckism  The evolutionary

philosophy of Jean Lamarck, notably his mechanism of the inheritance of acquired characteristics. landscape archaeology  Archaeology

that considers artifacts and features to be expressions of culture, both 272

incorporating and modifying elements of the natural world. language ideology  A phrase that

describes beliefs, conventional understandings, and values associated with any given language variety as held by speakers themselves. langue  In Ferdinand de Saussure’s

linguistics, reference to language as an abstract system that can be studied independently of actual speech, or parole. law of universal gravitation  Isaac

Newton’s scientific explanation of universal planetary and earthly motion. layer-cake model of culture  Leslie

White’s model of culture, with technology and economy at the bottom, ideology at the top, and social and political organization in between. liminal  An ephemeral psychosocial

space in which social arrangements are subject to transformation, inversion, and affirmation. lineages  Multi-generational kinship

groups with membership determined by ties to common ancestors. link-up  A phrase identified by Heather

Horst and Daniel Miller as important to many Jamaican cellphone users, in particular young women of low income who employ cellphones as a “coping strategy” for establishing and maintaining social and economic networks. little tradition  According to Robert

Redfield, cultures characterized by illiteracy, preindustrial economies, and “irrational” supernatural beliefs; contrasted with great tradition. madness  According to Michel

Foucault, a cognitive and emotive

GLOSSARY

condition defined by people in power, the definitions changing over time. maintenance systems  In the

psychological anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s primary cultural institutions without Freudian components. Manchester School  A coterie of

anthropologists trained under Max Gluckman at Manchester University in the 1950s and 1960s. Marxism  A collection of views derived

from Karl Marx and Friedrich Engels and their theory of dialectical materialism. material culture  Cultural meaning

expressed in the products of human artifice, or artifacts. materialism  In dialectical materialism,

the belief that human existence determines human consciousness; in cultural materialism, the equivalent of the principle of infrastructural determinism. matrilateral cross-cousin m ­ arriage 

Marriage to a child of one’s mother’s brother; contrasted with patrilateral cross-cousin marriage. matrilineal  Unilineal kinship systems

reckoned through the female line. means of production  In dialectical

materialism, how people make a living in the material world. mechanical philosophy  The

philosophy, inspired by the law of universal gravitation, portraying the universe as a complex machine with fine-tuned, interacting parts. mechanical solidarity  According

to Émile Durkheim, social cohesion maintained by similarities among individuals; contrasted with organic solidarity.

mechanics  The medieval science of

motion. medical anthropology  The cross-

cultural, pan-historical study of sickness and health. medieval synthesis  A perspective on

the natural universe that attempted to harmonize faith and reason by fusing philosophical ideas from Greco-Roman antiquity with medieval Christian theology and concern for the allocation of authority (in both human society and the cosmos more generally.) mental domain  In the theory of

cultural materialism, what people think, contrasted with what people do. mentalité  A French word (translated

into English as “mentality”) often used in social science and literary disciplines to characterize the total assemblage of beliefs, assumptions, and moral dispositions that pervade an historical period or social community. Midwestern Taxonomic Method  The

archaeological classification used in culture-historical archaeology. missing links  Perceived gaps in the

evolutionary record. modernity  According to postmodern

theorists, the Enlightenment-inspired, invented tradition of dispassionate scientific inquiry. modernization  The Western practice

of transforming non-capitalist, preindustrial economies into capitalist, industrial economies. modernization theory  An eclectic

range of social scientific and historical perspectives that track the transformation of  “traditional” societies, 273

GLOSSARY

industries, economies, and political systems into “modern” ones. monogenesis  The doctrine that human

races constitute a single biological species with a common origin and with differences produced over time; contrasted with polygenesis. monotheism  The belief in a

single deity; contrasted with polytheism. Moundbuilder Myth  The myth that a

mysterious people other than Native Americans built impressive earthen mounds throughout the American Midwest. multiculturalism  Descriptively, a

term that refers to the coexistence of a multiplicity of cultures, adopted by many nation-states, including Canada and India, as a formal aspect of public policy, seeking to promote and deepen it as a social and political attribute. multilineal  According to Max

Weber, culture change occurring in fits and starts in different historical contexts; according to Julian Steward, “branching” cultural evolution; contrasted with universal and unilineal cultural evolution. multivocal  The quality of having

more than one possible meaning or interpretation. museological  Pertaining to museology,

the academic discipline focusing on museum organization, management, and cultural representation. naked apery  A disparaging term used

to describe unfounded assertions about the inheritance of human behavior. 274

national character  According to

certain psychological anthropologists, the dominant personality of a nation. natural children  The early theological

conception of  “primitive” peoples as capable of  “improvement” and conversion to Christianity. natural selection  Charles Darwin’s

mechanism for biological evolution, involving struggle for existence and survival of the fittest. natural slaves  The early theological

conception of  “primitive” peoples as innately imperfect and subservient to European Christians. nature  In the context of the nature

versus nurture debate, the source of human behavior from heredity rather than environment. Naturwissenschaften  Translated

“natural sciences”; contrasted with Geisteswissenschaften. neo-evolutionists  Twentieth-century

anthropologists who revived and reformulated nineteenth-century classical cultural evolutionism. neoliberal economics  A form of

political-economic ideology in which governments promote competition among businesses within a capitalist market theoretically free of state oversight. Neolithic  Or New Stone Age, the

period of prehistory characterized by polished stone tools and the domestication of animals and plants. Neptunists  Geologists who proposed

that the principal agent of major geological change was the subsidence of water; contrasted with Vulcanists.

GLOSSARY New Archaeology  The nomothetic

archaeology advocated by Lewis Binford; also called processual archaeology. New Ethnography  A synonym

for cognitive anthropology that references the methods and theories of ethnoscience and ethnosemantics. New Physical Anthropology  The name

for physical anthropology committed to the synthetic theory of evolution. New Stone Age  See Neolithic nihilism  The perspective that traditional

values and beliefs are fundamentally uncertain and that existence is at base nonsensical. noble savagery  The romanticization of

“primitive” life. nominalism  The philosophical problem

of attributing objective reality to any phenomenon or aspect of experience merely because we give a name to it. nomothetic  Generalizing; contrasted

with idiographic. nonbinary  Refers to individuals who

identify with neither conventional masculine nor conventional feminine social roles. non-governmental organizations (NGOs)  Institutions and organizations

that operate independently of government, that do not generally amass profit from their endeavors, and whose missions typically address various social, political, and economic concerns. normal science  According to Thomas

Kuhn, science conducted within a scientific paradigm. nurture  In the context of the nature

versus nurture debate, the source of

human behavior from environment rather than heredity. obscurantism  Deliberate obfuscation

or vagueness aimed at preventing facts or details about something from becoming known. Oedipus complex  According to

Sigmund Freud, the troublesome psychological state of boys induced by their sexual desire for their mothers; contrasted with the Electra complex. Ogotemmêli  A priest and cosmologist of the

Dogon people of central Mali in western Africa. Ogotemmêli, who from the 1940s through the 1950s shared his knowledge with French ethnographer Marcel Griaule, remains a critical source of information on Dogon religion and mythology Old Stone Age  See Paleolithic ontogeny  The biological growth of an

individual. organic (or organismic) analogy 

Likening society to an organism, a conceptual device of numerous anthropological theorists. organic solidarity  According to Émile

Durkheim, social cohesion maintained by differences and interdependence among individuals; contrasted with mechanical solidarity. original sin  The Christian idea that

early sin resulted in the expulsion of humanity from the Garden of Eden. orthogenesis  The idea that biological

evolution operates in one direction, usually leading to Homo sapiens. oscillating equilibrium  Edmund

Leach’s term for the continuing existence of social structure, even against the backdrop of constant social change. 275

GLOSSARY Other  A postmodern-era label for

the people anthropologists study, anthropologists being labeled Self. Paleolithic  Or Old Stone Age, the

period of prehistory characterized by chipped and flaked stone tools and hunting and gathering. paradigm  According to Thomas Kuhn,

an intellectual framework for “normal” science, which is superseded by another paradigm in a scientific “revolution.” parole  In Ferdinand de Saussure’s

linguistics, reference to language as actually used in speech, often deviating from the abstract structural system of language, or langue. participant observation  The style of

anthropological fieldwork requiring the fieldworker to see things from both the “native” and the fieldworker’s points of view. patriarchy  A social group governed

exclusively by a male or groups of males. patrilateral cross-cousin marriage 

Marriage to a child of one’s father’s sister; contrasted with matrilateral cross-cousin marriage. patrilineal  Unilineal kinship systems

reckoned through the male line. perfectibility  The idea that humankind

is capable of progressing or evolving into some desired end point. periphery  In world-system theory,

non-Western regions dominated economically and politically by Western regions; contrasted with core. perlocutionary acts  Pertains to the

effects of a linguistic performance on the listener(s) (for instance, the effect of

276

fear created by the phrase “the end of the world is coming”). personality variables  In the psychological

anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s basic personality structure without Freudian components. phenotype  The product of gene action,

often affected by environment. philosophical anarchist  Following

Paul Feyerabend, someone who believes that all scientific paradigms are logically equivalent, with no logical way to choose among them. phonemes  Minimally contrasting

pairs of sounds that create linguistic meaning. phonemics  The study of linguistic

meaning created by sounds. phonetics  The study of linguistic

sounds that create meaning. phylogeny  The evolutionary growth of

a species. pietistic  Pertaining to piety, or religious

reverence and devotion. Pioneer Fund  A philanthropic

organization dedicated to advancing the “scientific study of heredity and human differences,” said by its detractors to be tinged with biological determinism and racism. pleasure principle  According to

Sigmund Freud, living libidinously, as directed by the id; contrasted with reality principle. policy of Indian termination and assimilation  A general phrase for

a series of formal US government legislative policies that sought to

GLOSSARY

dismantle Native American cultural and tribal organization from the 1940s through the 1960s. In particular, House Concurrent Resolution 108 (1953) formalized the policy of “termination” of Indian tribal identity (by withdrawing all federal assistance and eliminating the reservation system). political economy  An anthropological

perspective viewing sociocultural form at the local level as penetrated and influenced by global capitalism. pollution  According to Mary Douglas,

aspects of the world unexplained by a society’s basic categories of understanding, thereby threatening the social order; contrasted with purity. polyandry  Mating or marriage involving

one woman and more than one man. polygenesis  The doctrine that human

races constitute separate species with separate origins and innate differences; contrasted with monogenesis. polygenic  Variation in phenotype

affected by the action of many genes. polysemous  Having more than one

meaning or significance. polytheism  The belief in multiple

deities; contrasted with monotheism. positivism  The view that science is

objective and value-free. Positivism   The scientific philosophy of

Auguste Comte. postcolonial perspective  The

anthropological study of how the legacy of colonialism has altered both the former colonizing and the formerly colonized states.

posthuman turn  In anthropology, an

approach that recognizes and seeks to eliminate implicit anthropocentrism from considerations of human nature, and attempts to identify and study interconnections between human and non-human life. postmodern  Pertaining to

postmodernism, the intellectual stance that experience is subjective and no one version of it can be authoritative. post-processual archaeology 

Postmodern-era archaeology critical of the New Archaeology; also called contextual archaeology. post-structural  An adjective that

expresses disenchantment with static, mechanistic, and controlling models of culture, with a consequent interest in social process and agency. potlatch  A Pacific Northwest

Indigenous ceremony characterized by conspicuous exchange and consumption of goods. practice (or praxis)  According to

Pierre Bourdieu, the concept that society is constructed by purposeful, creative agents who bring society to life through talk and action. Prague School  A school of linguists

based in Prague that pioneered the analysis of phonemes. prehistory  The period of human

existence before writing. presentism  An implicit or explicit

privileging of the present (and its associated ideas and perspectives) as transparently “better,” in terms of theory and ethics, than the past.

277

GLOSSARY primal patricide  In Sigmund Freud’s

hypothetical primeval family, the killing of the father by his sons. primary cultural institutions  In

psychodynamic anthropology, institutions that affect how children are raised and that shape basic personality structure. primeval family  In Sigmund Freud’s

reconstruction of human history, the first family form – monogamous, nuclear, and patriarchal. primitive communism  In some

versions of Marxism, the view that past primitive peoples lived in a state to which future communism will, in a fashion, return. processual archaeology  A name

post-processual archaeologists use for the nomothetic New Archaeology. profane  According to Émile Durkheim,

that which is routine, mundane, impure, and “of the world”; contrasted with the sacred. progress  The movement of humanity

from a perceived inferior toward a perceived superior state. projective systems  In the

psychological anthropological model of John Whiting and Irvin Child, the equivalent of Abram Kardiner’s secondary cultural institutions without Freudian components. proletariat  In the lexicon of Marxism,

the working class. proxemics  The scientific study of

posture as a form of nonverbal communication, sometimes called “body language.”

278

psyche  According to Sigmund Freud,

the subconscious, comprising the id, ego, and superego. psychic unity  The doctrine that all

peoples have the same fundamental capacity for change. psychodynamic  Pertaining to the

school of psychological anthropology that adopted certain elements of the psychology of Sigmund Freud; often called Freudian anthropology. psychological anthropology 

Anthropology concerned with the relationship between cultures and personalities. public anthropology  An anthropology

primarily and directly engaged with issues of concern to the general public, rather than to anthropologists alone. punctuated equilibrium  The concept

that evolution occurs not always slowly and gradually but sometimes variably, with long periods of little change interspersed with rapid periods of extensive change. purity  According to Mary Douglas,

the ideal of a seamless social order symbolically excluding that which threatens a society’s basic categories of understanding; contrasted with pollution. queer  Originally a nineteenth-

century pejorative for same-sex relationships and desires, the term has been “reclaimed” in recent decades as an umbrella concept for nonheteronormative perspectives, politics, and academics. racial memory  According to Sigmund

Freud, the subconscious awareness of the history of the human psyche.

GLOSSARY racism  A variously defined label for

views that differences among human races are relatively fixed by nature and can be ranked from inferior to superior. rationalized  According to Max Weber,

evolved through the systematization of ideas, corresponding norms of behaviors, and motivational commitment to those norms. reality principle  According to Sigmund

Freud, the principle of realizing that acting on the pleasure principle is dangerous and immature. reason  The exercise of human cognitive

functions independent or semiindependent of experience. reciprocal altruism  In sociobiology,

the “biological Golden Rule,” said to account for altruistic behavior among non-relatives. reciprocity  According to Marcel Mauss,

the elementary principle of exchanging gifts; according to Claude Lévi-Strauss, the elementary principle of exchanging women. recombinant DNA  The ground-

breaking laboratory technology that allowed DNA from one organism to be cloned and inserted into another organism, facilitating understanding of how DNA works in those organisms. reflexivity  A popular postmodern

analytical strategy of reflecting on the biases and assumptions that inform one’s own theories and perspectives. relatively non-privileged  A phrase

coined by Max Weber to describe those socio-economic classes in complex societies most prone to the creation of new social forms.

religion  An integrated system of

meanings and practices that seeks to connect humankind and nature with a divine or metaphysical order. repressive hypothesis  A conventional

term for the historical process in which ideas about “normal” sexual expression came to have social power over sexual behavior and mores in Western society. restricted exchange  According to

Claude Lévi-Strauss, the exchange of women between two kinship groups. revitalization movement  A term

coined by Anthony F.C. Wallace to describe the spontaneous evolution of culture that occurs when communities experience conditions of extreme social and economic duress or marginalization. Rhodes-Livingstone Institute  A

research institute in Zambia that conducted much ethnographic research in the final years of British colonialism, later called the Zambian National Research Institute. rhoticity  Describes a dialect in which

there is conventional pronunciation of /r/ following a vowel in such words as “car” or “fourth.” Frequently, such usage or lack thereof denotes broader social meanings associated with social class or geo-linguistic region. ritual  Any form of prescribed behavior

that is periodically repeated and links the actions of the individual or group to a metaphysical order of existence. ritual process  Arnold van Gennep’s

term for the tripartite nature of ritual, involving separation from society,

279

GLOSSARY

transition to a new social status, and a new incorporation into society. rituals of rebellion  A phrase coined by

Max Gluckman to describe the socially constructive role of ritual in helping to avoid real conflict. r-selection  In certain evolutionary

theories, the reproductive strategy whereby parents choose to have many offspring and invest lightly in their upbringing, contrasted with K-selection. ruling class  In the theory of dialectical

materialism, the class that controls the means of production. Russian social anthropology  A

term now used by some Russian anthropologists to distinguish current social and cultural research in the region from the outmoded Soviet ethnology, which imposed a framework of dialectical materialism on all research. sacred  According to Émile Durkheim,

that which is pure, powerful, and supernatural; contrasted with the profane. salvage ethnography  Ethnography

motivated by the need to obtain information about cultures threatened with extinction or assimilation. salvation  According to Max Weber, escape

from worldly capriciousness and evil through social arrangements rationalized in accordance with a divine plan, typically revealed by charismatic prophets. Sapir-Whorf hypothesis  The

proposition of Edward Sapir and Benjamin Whorf that the structure of language conditions the nature of cultural meaning. savagery/barbarism/civilization  A

popular nineteenth-century tripartite 280

schema for the universal evolution of humanity. science  A system of thought that

prioritizes nature, contrasted with humankind and with a divine or metaphysical order. scientific racism  Improper or incorrect

science that actively or passively supports racism. scientific revolution  According to

Thomas Kuhn, the replacement of one scientific paradigm with another. secondary cultural institutions  In

psychodynamic anthropology, social institutions that are projections of basic personality structure and help people cope with the world. second law of thermodynamics  The

scientific proposition that the universe is running down, thereby increasing disorder, or entropy. secularism  The assumption that

religious faith and institutions are waning in the context of better scientific understanding of the universe and modernizing world. semantic domain  A mental domain

of cultural meaning that is the focus of inquiry in cognitive anthropology. semiotic  Pertaining to the relationship

between symbols and what they represent. seriationally  According to the

archaeological principle of seriation, or relative dating by the evolution of artifact style. sexual selection  Charles Darwin’s

evolutionary mechanism whereby members of one sex compete for the attention of members of the opposite sex.

GLOSSARY shamans  Magico-religious specialists

who communicate with ancestral ghosts and other spirits. sign  In Ferdinand de Saussure’s

linguistics, the pair formed in the relation of a signifier to a signified, the essence of relations among meaningful units in a language. signified  In Ferdinand de Saussure’s

linguistics, one of two units making up the sign, the concept generated in our minds when represented by a sound or image, the signifier. signifier  In Ferdinand de Saussure’s

linguistics, one of two units making up the sign, the word or image that represents a concept, the signified. Silicon Valley  A name given to the

southern end of the San Francisco Bay area in northern California, specifically to the Santa Clara Valley, which has been among the most fertile centers of the high-tech industry. Silicon Valley Cultures Project 

Founded in 1991 by anthropologists at San Jose State University, a project conducting long-term, multi-sited research into high-technology communities and workplaces, the use of information technology, and the heterogeneous cultural worlds that connect workers and residents with the region’s high-tech industry and economy. social constructionism  The theory that

sociocultural phenomena are products of historically situated interpersonal negotiation accomplished through patterned language and activity. Social Darwinism  A loosely used term

referring to social philosophies based

on Darwinian evolutionism, especially the mechanism of natural selection. social dynamics  In Positivism, the

study of social change. social facts  Émile Durkheim’s name

for social phenomena, his units of sociological analysis. social function  In British social

anthropology, the contribution of a part of society to the whole of society; sometimes called social physiology. social morphology  In British social

anthropology, according to the organismic analogy, the study of social structure. social physiology  In British social

anthropology, according to the organismic analogy, the study of social function. social process  According to late

structural-functionalism, social change as the ongoing creation of a fluid, dynamic social structure. social statics  In Positivism, the study of

social stability. social structure  In British social

anthropology, the social matrix of behavior; sometimes called social morphology. sociobiology  An investigation of the

biological basis of social behavior using the evolutionary principles of kin selection and inclusive fitness. sociolinguistics  A branch of linguistics

that examines the interrelations between speech/communication and other domains of social and cultural life (for instance, the categories of regional origin, ethnicity, gender, age-set, socioeconomic status). 281

GLOSSARY solipsism  The idea that the individual

self is the only reality and that the external world exists only in one’s imagination. Sophistry  An ancient Greek school

of thought that attached greater importance to practical skills and social effectiveness than to the search for objective knowledge and absolute truth. Southwest School  A group of German

philosophers who differentiated human sciences, or Geisteswissenschaften, and natural sciences, or Naturwissenschaften. Spanglish  An informal and often

pejorative term for a hybrid language variety in geo-linguistic settings or regions in which both English and Spanish language varieties are spoken. It is typically associated with Spanishspeaking communities in different regions of the US and is frequently characterized by code-switching and neologism. species  A group of organisms whose

members can reproduce only with one another. specific evolution  In the cultural

evolutionary schema of Marshall Sahlins and Elman Service, the study of how cultures differentiate by adapting to local environments. speciocide  The deliberate or

inadvertent killing of an entire living species of plants or animals. speculative fabulation  A phrase

coined by Donna Harraway to frame the type of collaborative efforts that Anthropocene scholars should be making to imagine new possibilities for, and configurations of, human engagement with the non-human. 282

speech acts  J.L. Austin’s term to

describe the social character of any given occasion of speech; these occasions involve the linguistic forms used, the intentions embedded within those forms, and the effects (intended and unintended) on those listening. speech community  Dell Hymes’s

term for a social group that is partially integrated through language and can therefore be identified by way of a shared use of a language or language variety. speech event  Dell Hymes’s term for

a specific form of communicative exchange that is conditioned by various culturally specific and extralinguistic variables. Standard American English (SAE)  Refers to the “umbrella” or

“majority’” variety of English used in the US. Because it is widely perceived to be lacking distinctive regional, ethnic, or class markers, SAE is the language variety of education, media, and socio-economically privileged classes. It is conventionally considered, by speakers and non-speakers alike, to be the basic standard against which other varieties of spoken English are measured and evaluated. status societies  In the schema of

Henry Maine, societies that are familyoriented, hold property in common, and maintain control by social sanctions; contrasted with contract societies. Stoicism  An ancient school of thought

that believed that nature and society are intrinsically orderly, allowing particular societies to be compared and contrasted in accordance with universal principles.

GLOSSARY Stone Age  The Old Stone Age, or

Paleolithic, and the New Stone Age, or Neolithic. Stonewall Riots  A series of

spontaneous civil protests by gay and lesbian activists in the wake of a June 1969 police raid on the Stonewall Inn, a gay nightclub in the Greenwich Village district of New York City. stratigraphy  The archaeological dating

of artifacts relative to their placement in systematically layered earth. structural-functionalism  In British

social anthropology, the synchronic concern with social structure and social function. structuralism  In British social

anthropology, the synchronic concern with social structure, sometimes called social morphology; in French structural anthropology, the concern with the elementary forms of minds and cultures. structural Marxists  Proponents

of a theoretical blend of Marxism, dialectical philosophy, and French structural anthropology. structural racism  Refers to the

normalization and institutionalization of unequal social and power relations among different racial and ethnic groups. structure of the conjuncture  Marshall

Sahlins’s phrase describing the space of intersection between different cultural structures, where contingency produces historical change. struggle for existence  Charles Darwin’s

view that evolution by natural selection involves competition for limited resources and results in survival of the fittest.

subconscious  According to Sigmund

Freud, the part of the mind that is the seat of the psyche, of which people are aware only unconsciously. sublimate  According to Sigmund

Freud, to rechannel libidinous desires into culturally acceptable thoughts and behaviors. subsidiarity  A social and political

principle, embedded in many modern nation-states, according to which authority should be exercised at the local level except in situations that only a higher level of authority can address. substantivists  Economic

anthropologists who maintained that Western economic concepts do not apply to non-Western economies; contrasted with formalists. sui generis  In its own realm, or on its

own terms. superego  According to Sigmund Freud,

the part of the psyche, sometimes called conscience, that monitors the id and mediates between the ego and the outside world. superorganic  The idea that culture is

distinct from and “above” biology. survival of the fittest  In Charles

Darwin’s theory of evolution by natural selection, the adaptive outcome of the struggle for existence. survivals  Edward Burnett Tylor’s name

for nonfunctional cultural traits that are inherited from past generations. swamping effect  The observation

in Charles Darwin’s time that small variations would always be diluted by heredity and therefore could not increase or intensify through natural selection. 283

GLOSSARY symbolic anthropology  The

anthropological school, associated with Victor Turner, espousing the view that social solidarity is a function of the systems of symbolic logic that connect people. symbolic capital  According to Pierre

Bourdieu, the body of meanings, representations, and objects held to be prestigious or valuable to a social group. symbolic domination  According

to Pierre Bourdieu, the tendency of dominant social groups to create and sustain a worldview in which all members of a society, including subjugated members, participate. symbolic interactionism  A

sociological theory, associated with Talcott Parsons, that focuses on the decision-making strategies of individuals in social situations; similar to transactionalism. sympathetic magic  Magic that can

affect an object through a similar object. synchronic  Concerned with the present

more than the past; contrasted with diachronic. synthetic philosophy  The all-

encompassing philosophy of Herbert Spencer based on the premise that homogeneity is evolving into heterogeneity everywhere. synthetic theory of evolution  The

twentieth-century theoretical synthesis of Darwinian evolutionism and Mendelian genetics. taboos  Culturally prescribed

prohibitions. tabula rasa  Translated “blank slate,” the

idea that the mind acquires knowledge 284

through experience rather than recognizes knowledge that is innate. taxonomies  According to Pierre

Bourdieu, internalized symbolic representations that make the social world what it is for people who live in it. teleology  The idea that biological

evolution adheres to a long-term purpose or goal. text  In the interpretive anthropology

of Clifford Geertz, the equivalent of culture, interpreted through a process of thick description. theistic  Pertaining to theism, the

view that God created the universe and remains active in its day-to-day operations; contrasted with deistic. theodicy  A Christian term used by Max

Weber to describe the explanation of evil in the world despite the existence of an omnipotent, just, and loving God. thermodynamic law  E × T > P, or

energy times technology yields cultural product, the nomothetic basis of Leslie White’s culturology. thermodynamics  The study of

conversion of energy in the universe, a fundamental part of culturology as expressed in the second law of thermodynamics. thesis-antithesis-synthesis  In

dialectical materialism, Friedrich Hegel’s form for dialectical change. thick description  In the interpretive

anthropology of Clifford Geertz, the process of interpreting culture as text. third gender  A widely used term

that denotes both the existence of nonbinary gender identities and the

GLOSSARY

general fluidity of gender as a cultural formation. Thomistic Christianity  The theology

of Thomas Aquinas, which unified scientific, humanistic, and religious ways of knowing. Three Age System  The archaeological

ages of Stone, Bronze, and Iron. totems  Objects of collective cultural

veneration, according to several anthropological theorists, that are central to the maintenance of social stability. transactionalism  The anthropological

theory of Fredrik Barth that focuses on the decision-making and economicmaximizing strategies of individuals; similar to symbolic interactionism. transcendental essences  The

concept of ancient Greek philosopher Plato that the pure ideas of objects are more real than the varied individual manifestations of those ideas. transgender  The designation of

personal and social identities that do not conform to conventional or normative ideas about appropriate gender and sex roles within a society. transmigrate  To pass into another body

after death, as do spirits and ghosts. truthy  A satirical term coined by

television personality Stephen Colbert to describe the implicit acceptance of a proposition where logic dictates otherwise or where there is a seeming lack of supporting evidence. Two Spirit  Since 1990, a term used by

many Indigenous people in North America to designate individuals in Indigenous societies who elide the gender binary of man–woman.

typological thinking  Thinking of

biological groups as homogeneous or pure when in fact they are heterogeneous and mixed. underdevelopment  A condition

that, in the opinion of many political economists, is actually caused rather than ameliorated by international development initiatives. uniformitarianism  The doctrine that

gradual geological agents of change have operated throughout the past; contrasted with catastrophism. unilineal  Pertaining to the view that

cultural evolution proceeds along the same lines everywhere, as in classical cultural evolution; contrasted with multilineal and universal evolution. unilineal kinship systems  Kinship

systems reckoned through one parental line, either matrilineal or patrilineal. United Nations General Assembly 

The General Assembly is the central policy-making body of the United Nations, and the only UN body in which all member states have equal representation. universal  Pertaining to a single schema

for global cultural evolution; contrasted with unilineal and multilineal evolution. universal historians  Enlightenment

thinkers who promulgated comprehensive laws and schemas of human history. universal pattern  In cultural

materialism, the levels of culture – infrastructure, structure, and superstructure – with emic and etic and mental and behavioral dimensions. vitalism  The idea that biological

evolution is self-motivated or willed. 285

GLOSSARY Volksgeist  Translated “spirit of the

people”; according to some early theorists, the ethnographic essence of a people. Vulcanists  Geologists who proposed

that major geological changes were caused by the elevation of land brought about by volcanic heat; contrasted with Neptunists. vulgar materialists  A label for cultural

materialists who, according to their critics, ignore dialectical thinking. weapons of mass destruction  Or

WMDs, the euphemistic term for weapon technologies with the potential to cause casualties on a massive scale – for example, biological, chemical, and nuclear weapons. Web 2.0  A phrase coined in the mid-

2000s to describe the development of new online tools and platforms that enable the creation and distribution of user-generated content – for instance, blogs, wikis, and social networking websites. world anthropologies  A term

referring to the existence or potential existence of different forms of anthropological theory and professional

286

practice, rooted in different cultural and linguistic traditions around the world. World of Warcraft  Also known by its

acronym WoW, among the largest of multiplayer online role-playing games, set in a faux-medieval, Tolkienesque fantasy world where players adopt the online personas of fantasy characters, undertake quests and journeys, meet other players, and combat fantasy creatures and monsters. world-system  According to political

economists, the global expansion of Western capitalism, creating a world-system of unequal commodity exchange. world-system theory  Immanuel

Wallerstein’s theory that core nationstates are engaged in the systematic exploitation of peripheral nation-states for labor and natural resources. xenophobic  Pertaining to xenophobia,

the fear and dislike of foreigners. Y2K  Also known as “the Millennium

Bug,” an acronym for the Year 2000, referring both to a computer technology problem and to the consequent social panic that emerged in the run-up to the year 2000.

Sources and Suggested Readings This list of sources and suggested reading comprises annotated citations of books, and a few articles, culled from a vast literature in the history of anthropological theory. The list concentrates on secondary sources, or sources written about the past, but includes some primary sources, or sources written in the past, including, for recent theory, near the present. Although many books are relevant to more than one part of A History of Anthropological Theory, with few exceptions, they are listed only once. Some original or earlier dates of publication appear in square brackets. For certain reprint editions, dates appear in brackets only. Subsequent to the publication of the first edition of A History of Anthropological Theory, traditional published print media have become increasingly supplemented, and sometimes superseded, by electronic media in the forms of websites, blogs, podcasts, videos, and other rapidly evolving platforms for the communication of information. A few citations in this list include electronic locations, but, because these are evolving so rapidly, we, the authors of this book, have not made an effort to provide even a remotely comprehensive list of them. In so doing, we are confident that users of the book, students and professors alike, will want to customize their own electronic searches. We cheer them on in this endeavor, in the knowledge that exploring the internet yields rich rewards and, often, real surprises. Part One: The Early History of Anthropological Theory

A study of the roots of anthropology in antiquity, focusing on an early Greek philosopher of materialism.

Anthropology in Antiquity

Campbell, Gordon Lindsay. 2006. Strange Creatures: Anthropology in Antiquity. London: Gerald Duckworth & Co., Ltd. An exploration of ancient ideas of the

Darnell, Regna, ed. 1974. Readings in the History of Anthropology. New York: Harper and Row. A collection of primary sources, including some from ancient times.

creation of the world from Greco-Roman times to Europeans’ encounter with the Americas.

Cole, Thomas. 1967. Democritus and the Sources of Greek Anthropology. Cleveland: Western Reserve University Press.

Edelstein, Ludwig. 1967. The Idea of Progress in Classical Antiquity. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press. An examination of the ancient foundations of an idea intertwined with the history of anthropological theory.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Gernet, Louis. 1981. The Anthropology of Ancient Greece. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

An examination of ancient Greeks’

An informative study of the ancient roots

human differences.

attempts to answer questions about human nature, especially questions about

of anthropology.

A book of anthropology in and about

Snowden, Frank M., Jr. 1991. Before Color Prejudice:The Ancient View of Blacks. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Greece.

A historical study of the cultural contexts

Humphreys, S.C. 1984. Anthropology and the Greeks. New York: Routledge.

of race and racism.

Keil, Geert, and Nora Kreft, eds. 2019. Aristotle’s Anthropology. New York: Cambridge University Press. A wide-ranging collection of 15 essays

Voget, Fred W. 1975. A History of Ethnology. New York: Holt, Rinehart and Winston.

on the philosophical underpinnings

A compendium of ethnological

of Aristotle’s morality, politics, and the

developments, beginning in antiquity and

biology of human nature.

extending into the twentieth century.

Kluckhohn, Clyde. 1961. Anthropology and the Classics. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

The Middle Ages

A study of the ancient roots of anthropology by a distinguished American anthropologist.

Boas, George. 1966. Essays on Primitivism and Related Ideas in the Middle Ages. New York: Octagon Books. Analyses of ideas that have influenced –

Launay, Robert, ed. 2010. Foundations of Anthropological Theory: From Classical Antiquity to Early Modern Europe. Indianapolis: Wiley-Blackwell.

and, in turn, been influenced by – anthropology.

social theorists from Herodotus to Adam

Brehaut, Ernest. 1964. An Encyclopedist of the Dark Ages, Isidore of Seville. New York: B. Franklin.

Ferguson, including Muslim theorists.

A biographical account of the life and

A selection of original writings by early

times of one of the most influential early

Malefijt, Annemarie de Waal. 1974. Images of Man: A History of Anthropological Thought. New York: Alfred Knopf. An intellectual and social history of anthropological theory beginning in Classical times.

Sassi, Maria Michela. 2001. The Science of Man in Ancient Greece. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 288

Christian historians.

Fazioli, K. Patrick. 2014. “The Erasure of the Middle Ages from Anthropology’s Intellectual Genealogy.” History and Anthropology 25.3: 336–55. An exposition of how the assumption of a sharp epistemological break between medieval and modern

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS European philosophy has led to unwarranted devaluation of medieval anthropology.

Davis, Thomas W. 2004. Shifting Sands: The Rise and Fall of Biblical Archaeology. Oxford: Oxford University Press. A history of archaeology and archaeologists

Friedman, John B. 1963. The Monstrous Races in Medieval Art and Thought. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. A historical account of the anthropologically exotic.

Gerald of Wales. 1983 (c. 1188). The History and Topography of Ireland. Harmondsworth, UK: Penguin Classics. A medieval text that, although heavily filtered through a Christian bias, nevertheless stands as a significant ethnographic study for its time.

interested in biblical scholarship.

Dudley, Edward J., and Maximillian E. Novak, eds. 1972. The Wild Man Within: An Image in Western Thought from the Renaissance to Romanticism. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. The history of an image incorporated into many anthropological portrayals of nonWestern peoples.

Höfele, Andreas, and Stephen Langué, eds. 2011. Humankinds:The Renaissance and Its Anthropologies. Berlin: Walter de Gruyter.

Lovejoy, Arthur O. 1936. Great Chain of Being: A Study of the History of an Idea. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

A sustained argument that European

An analysis of a philosophical schema that

what it means to be human.

prevailed during the Middle Ages and shaped anthropology.

Mahdi, Muhsin. 1957. Ibn Khaldûn’s Philosophy of History: A Study in the Philosophic Foundation of the Science of Culture. London: G. Allen and Unwin. An analysis of the work of a medieval Islamic historian who described Arab and Bedouin culture “scientifically.”

The Renaissance

continental philosophical and AngloAmerican cultural anthropologies are both rooted in Renaissance efforts to define

Houck, Daniel W. 2020. Aquinas, Original Sin, and the Challenge of Evolution. New York: Cambridge University Press. A biblical scholar argues that Thomas Aquinas’s doctrine of original sin is not necessarily incompatible with the idea of evolution.

León-Portilla, Miguel. 2002. Bernardino de Sahagún: First Anthropologist. Trans. Maurico J. Mixco. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.

Allen, Don C. 1963. The Legend of Noah: Renaissance Rationalism in Art, Science and Letters. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

The life and times of a sixteenth-

An analysis of Renaissance thought that

ethnographic method of participant

highlights Christianity.

observation.

century Spanish Franciscan scholar sometimes portrayed as an early cultural anthropologist and practitioner of the

289

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Levin, Harry. 1969. The Myth of the Golden Age in the Renaissance. Bloomington: Indiana University Press. An examination of the Renaissance

Bieder, Robert E. 1986. Science Encounters the Indian, 1820–1880:The Early Years of American Ethnology. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.

discovery of Greco-Roman glories.

A history of early American ethnology shaped by interactions between

Penrose, Boies. 1955. Travel and Discovery in the Renaissance, 1420–1620. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Indigenous and non-Indigenous

An account of the early phases of

Burgaleta, Claudio M. 1999. Jose de Acosta, S.J. (1540–1600): His Life and Thought. Chicago: Loyola Press.

European global exploration.

populations.

Piggott, Stuart. 1989. Ancient Britons and Antiquarian Imagination. New York: Thames and Hudson.

A biography of the Jesuit humanist and

A distinguished British archaeologist

“liberation” theologies.

missionary, who, according to the author, helped establish the foundation for later

writes about the development of antiquarianism in the Renaissance.

Trigger, Bruce. 1990. A History of Archaeological Thought. New York: Cambridge University Press. A comprehensive history of archaeology,

Campbell, Mary B. 1988. The Witness and the Other World: Exotic European Travel Writing, 400–1600. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. An examination of the early phase of European geographical exploration.

beginning with classical Renaissance historicism.

Voyages of Geographical Discovery

Cohen, William B. 1980. The French Encounter with Africans:White Response to Blacks, 1530–1880. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. A history of French attitudes toward

Banton, Michael. 1998. Racial Theories. 2nd ed. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Africans in the early colonial period.

A revised edition of a study that demonstrates how eighteenth- and

Coon, Carleton S. 1962. The Origin of Races. New York: Alfred A. Knopf.

nineteenth-century scientists viewed

The controversial book in which Coon

races as permanent “types,” featuring a

asserts that five human races originated in

new chapter on race as a social construct.

the species Homo erectus and maintained their integrity during the evolution of

Berkhofer, Robert F., Jr. 1979. The White Man’s Indian: Images of the American Indian from Columbus to the Present. New York: Random House. A history of Indigenous peoples as seen through the eyes of “whites.”

290

Homo erectus into Homo sapiens.

_____. 1981. Adventures and Discoveries: The Autobiography of Carleton S. Coon. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Coon’s recollection of his life and times, including controversies about race.

Anthropological View Contrasting the Africa of Fact and the Africa of Fiction. Rev. ed. Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland Press.

Curtin, Philip D. 1964. The Image of Africa: British Ideas and Action, 1780–1850. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

A revisionist history of the British depiction

A history of British attitudes toward

Hanzeli,Victor E. 1969. Missionary Linguistics in New France: A Study of Seventeenth and Eighteenth Century Descriptions of American Indian Languages. The Hague: Mouton.

Africans in the early colonial period.

Dickason, Olive Patricia. 1984. The Myth of the Savage and the Beginnings of French Colonialism in the Americas. Edmonton: University of Alberta Press.

of Africa.

An assessment of the linguistic writings of early French missionaries in America.

An account of how early French perceptions of Indigenous peoples in North America influenced French colonialism.

Dussel, Enrique. 1995. The Invention of the Americas: Eclipse of “The Other” and the Myth of Modernity. New York: Continuum. An account of the origin of an anthropological image of America.

Hodgen, Margaret T. 1964. Early Anthropology in the Sixteenth and Seventeenth Centuries. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press. Accounts of anthropology in the early modern period.

Huddleston, Lee Eldridge. 1967. Origins of American Indians: European Concepts, 1492–1729. Austin: University of Texas Press.

Fabian, Johannes. 2002. Time and the Other: How Anthropology Makes Its Object. New York: Columbia University Press.

A history of early European attempts to

A critical anthropological account

Moore, Sally Falk. 1994. Anthropology and Africa: Changing Perspectives on a Changing Scene. Charlottesville: University Press of Virginia.

of how Anglo-American and French anthropologists have treated the concept of time, including the ethnographic present.

explain the origin of Native Americans.

An account of how changes in Africa have

Garbarino, Merwyn S. 1983. Sociocultural Theory in Anthropology: A Short History. Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland Press.

interacted with changing anthropological

A concise history of major sociocultural

Pagden, Anthony. 1987. The Fall of Natural Man:The American Indian and the Origins of Comparative Ethnology. New York: Cambridge University Press.

theories beginning with the period of European geographical exploration.

Hammond, Dorothy, and Alta Jablow. 1992. The Africa that Never Was: Four Centuries of British Writing about Africa – An

views of Africa.

An account of how Europeans’ early perceptions of Indigenous peoples affected both populations.

291

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Schwartz, Stuart B., ed. 1994. Implicit Understandings: Observing, Reporting and Reflecting on the Encounters between Europeans and Other Peoples in the Early Modern Era. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Kaznar, Lawrence A. 2008. Reclaiming a Scientific Anthropology. 2nd ed. Plymouth, UK: AltaMira Press.

Analyses of early encounters between

should return to its empirical roots.

An examination of recent advances in science accompanied by a critique of postmodernism, arguing that anthropology

Europeans and non-Europeans.

Stocking, George W., Jr., ed. 1993. Colonial Situations: Essays on the Contextualization of Ethnographic Knowledge. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. Analyses of anthropology in the context of colonialism.

Wauchope, Robert. 1962. Lost Tribes and Sunken Continents: Myth and Method in the Study of American Indians. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. An account of early theories linking

Kuhn, Thomas S. 1970. The Structure of Scientific Revolutions. 2nd ed. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. An influential history of the Scientific Revolution as a shift of paradigms.

Lindberg, David C., and Robert S. Westman, eds. 1990. Reappraisals of the Scientific Revolution. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Thirteen scholars across a wide range of subjects re-evaluate the social context and consequences of the Scientific Revolution from the perspective of three decades ago.

Indigenous peoples to Europeans.

The Scientific Revolution

Hall, Marie Boas. 1962. Scientific Renaissance, 1450–1630. New York: Harper. A history of key developments in the Scientific Revolution.

Henry, John. 1997. The Scientific Revolution and the Origins of Modern Science. Old Tappan, NJ: Macmillan. A concise history of the Scientific Revolution.

Hull, David. 1990. Science as Process: An Evolutionary Account of the Social and Conceptual Development of Science. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

Marks, Jonathan. 2009. Why I Am Not a Scientist: Anthropology and Modern Knowledge. Berkeley: University of California Press. An outspoken biological anthropologist explains what science is, why popular understandings of science are difficult to reconcile with one another, and what a scientific anthropology might look like in the twenty-first century.

Richards, Robert J., and Lorraine Daston. 2016. Kuhn’s Structure of Scientific Revolutions at Fifty: Reflections on a Science Classic. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A collection of essays examining the

An account of how science develops in

historical circumstances of Thomas Kuhn’s

social contexts.

enormously influential 1962 book about

292

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS paradigm shift, of which the Scientific Revolution was Kuhn’s prime example.

Tambiah, Stanley Jeyaraja. 1990. Magic, Science, Religion, and the Scope of Rationality. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Danesi, Marcel, ed. 1995. Giambattista Vico and Anglo-American Science: Philosophy and Writing. Berlin: Mouton de Gruyter. An assessment of the contributions of the influential Italian Enlightenment thinker.

and religion, with reference to debates

Faull, Katherine M., ed. 1995. Anthropology and the German Enlightenment: Perspectives on Humanity. Lewisburg, PA: Bucknell University Press.

among these three positions during the

A volume of essays about eighteenth-

Scientific Revolution.

century German views on human nature,

An anthropological reconsideration of the classic distinction among magic, science,

including essays on Johann Herder and

The Enlightenment

Immanuel Kant.

Berry, Christopher J. 1997. Social Theory of the Scottish Enlightenment. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University Press.

Harris, Marvin. 1968. The Rise of Anthropological Theory: A History of Theories of Culture. New York: Harper Collins.

An examination of cultural and historical

Theories of culture critiqued from the

theorizing in Scotland between 1740 and

perspective of cultural materialism,

1790, updating Gladys Bryson’s Man and

beginning with the Enlightenment.

Society (see below).

Bryson, Gladys. 1968 [1945]. Man and Society:The Scottish Inquiry of the Eighteenth Century. New York: Augustus M. Kelly.

Jones, Peter, ed. 1991. The Science of Man in the Scottish Enlightenment: Hume, Reid and Their Contemporaries. New York: Columbia University Press.

An examination of Scottish Enlightenment

Assessments of the anthropological

contributions to anthropology.

relevance of key Scottish Enlightenment figures.

Cloyd, E.L. 1972. James Burnett, Lord Monboddo. Oxford: Clarendon Press. who thought that a properly conditioned

Locke, John. 1994 [1690]. An Essay Concerning Human Understanding. Amherst, NY: Prometheus Books.

ape could learn to talk like a human

An essay setting forth Locke’s concept of

being.

tabula rasa, an intellectual foundation of

A biography of an Enlightenment thinker

the Enlightenment.

Daiches, David, Peter Jones, and Jean Jones, eds. 1986. A Hotbed of Genius: The Scottish Enlightenment, 1730–1790. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University Press.

Mali, Joseph. 1992. The Rehabilitation of Myth:Vico’s New Science. New York: Cambridge University Press.

An intellectual history of the Scottish

An appraisal of the work of Giambattista

Enlightenment.

Vico.

293

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Miller, Cecilia. 1993. Giambattista Vico: Imagination and Historical Knowledge. New York: St. Martin’s Press.

of complexities of the so-called

Another account of Vico’s life and times.

Wolff, Larry, and Marco Cipolloni, eds. 2007. The Anthropology of the Enlightenment. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.

Pagden, Anthony. 2013. The Enlightenment and Why It Still Matters. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

Enlightenment project.

A wide-ranging series of essays on the intellectual history of Enlightenment

A distinguished historian revisits the

anthropology, focusing on ethnography

Enlightenment and argues that it was the

and highlighting a number of European

time of the development of a sweeping

national traditions.

and unifying vision of humankind.

Rapport, Nigel, and Wardle, Huon, eds. 2018. An Anthropology of the Enlightenment: Moral Social Relations Then and Today. London: Bloomsbury Academic.

Zammito, John H. 2002. Kant, Herder, and the Birth of Anthropology. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. An examination of the relationship between philosophers Immanuel Kant and Johann Herder, aimed at

Rethinking the term Enlightenment

demonstrating how anthropology

anthropology, ten essays examine key

originated in philosophy.

themes, notably moral philosophy and Adam Smith as an early theorist of modernity.

The Rise of Positivism

Rousseau, George Sebastian, and Roy Porter, eds. 1990. Exoticism in the Enlightenment. Manchester: Manchester University Press.

Comte, Auguste. 1830–42. Positive Philosophy. Trans. Harriet Martineau. New York: AMS Press.

European conceptualizations of “exoticlooking” peoples.

Saiedi, Nader. 1992. The Birth of Social Theory: Social Thought in the Enlightenment and Romanticism. Lanham, MD: University Press of America.

Auguste Comte’s explication of Positivism.

Pickering, Mary. 1993. Auguste Comte: An Intellectual Biography. Vol. I. New York: Cambridge University Press. A partial intellectual biography of the archi­­­­tect of nineteenth-century Positivist philosophy.

The origins of social theory in the eighteenth and early nineteenth centuries.

Wellman, Chad. 2011. Becoming Human: Romantic Anthropology and the Embodiment of Freedom. University Park: Pennsylvania State University Press.

Steinmetz, George, ed. 2005. The Politics of Method in the Human Sciences: Positivism and Its Epistemological Others. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. Various essays on ways to rehabilitate

A redefinition of anthropological

positivism in the social sciences, including

modernity based on an exposition

some essays on anthropology.

294

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Marxism

Archibald, W. Peter. 1992. Marx and the Missing Link: Human Nature. Atlantic Highlands, NJ: Humanities Press International.

Friedman, Jonathan. 1974. “Marxism, Structuralism, and Vulgar Materialism.” Man 9.3: 444–69. An exposition of the similarities and differences among three overlapping anthropological approaches ascendant in the 1970s.

An evaluation of Karl Marx’s anthropological thinking.

Berlin, Isaiah. 1996. Karl Marx: His Life and Environment. 4th ed. New York: Oxford University Press. A biographical account of the life and

Godelier, Maurice. 1978. Perspectives in Marxist Anthropology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. A sophisticated exposition of Marxism written by a well-known structural Marxist in the heyday of that field.

times of Karl Marx.

Bloch, Maurice. 1983. Marxism and Anthropology: The History of a Relationship. London: Clarendon Press.

Marx, Karl, and Friedrich Engels. 1992 [1848]. The Communist Manifesto. Ed. David McLellan. New York: Oxford University Press.

An account of the influence of

Marx and Engels’s exposition of dialectical

Marxism on American, British, and

materialism.

French anthropologists, showing how anthropologists have moved away of primitive societies toward

Patterson, Thomas Carl. 2003. Marx’s Ghost: Conversations with Archaeologists. Oxford: Berg.

interpretations based on a revised vision

An overview of the impact of Marxist

of capitalism.

thinking on archaeology, focusing on the

f rom Karl Marx’s original interpretation

rise of civilization and the origin of states

Donham, Donald L. 1990. History, Power, Ideology: Central Issues in Marxism and Anthropology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

and including a discussion of V. Gordon Childe’s concept of the urban revolution.

Donham asks whether Marxism is “part

———. 2009. Karl Marx, Anthropologist. New York: Berg.

of the problem” and then answers with a

A history of Marxism, beginning with the

Marxist analysis of the Maale kingdom of

Enlightenment and ending with a vision

southern Ethiopia.

for Marxist anthropology in the twentyfirst century.

Engels, Friedrich. 1972 [1884]. Origin of the Family, Private Property, and the State. 2nd ed. Ed. Eleanor B. Leacock. New York: International Publishers Company. Engels’s views on cultural evolution.

Price, David. 1997. “Anthropologists on Trial:The Lessons of McCarthyism.” Paper presented at the Annual Meeting of the American Anthropological Association,Washington, DC, November.

295

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Price describes the trials and tribulations of five Fellows of the American Anthropological Association.

———. 2016. Cold War Anthropology:The CIA, the Pentagon, and the Growth of Dual Use Anthropology. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

———. 2000. “The AAA and the CIA?” Anthropology News 41.8: 13–14.

Price recounts the overt and covert

Price recounts interactions between the

complex on the development of

CIA and the American Anthropological

anthropology after World War II, notably

Association in the 1950s.

the CIA, the FBI, and various post-9/11

influence of the American security

counterinsurgency agencies.

———. 2003a. “The Spies Who Came in from the Dig.” The Guardian, September 4. alleged spying by twentieth-century

Wakin, Eric. 1992. Anthropology Goes to War: Professional Ethics and Counterinsurgency in Thailand. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

archaeologists.

An analysis of ethical and political

Price describes episodes of spying and

considerations surrounding

———. 2003b. Threatening Anthropology: McCarthyism and the FBI’s Surveillance of Activist Anthropologists. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. An investigative report on anthropologists as victims and perpetrators of spying in the era of the Cold War.

anthropologists working for the American government in Thailand in the 1960s.

Wax, Dustin M., ed. 2008. Anthropology at the Dawn of the Cold War:The Influence of Foundations, McCarthyism, and the CIA. London: Pluto Press. Eight historians situate anthropology in a

———. 2008. Anthropological Intelligence: The Deployment and Neglect of American Anthropology in the Second World War. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. Price probes the activities of many anthropologists working in the American war effort.

———. 2011. Weaponizing Anthropology: Social Science in Service of the Militarized State. Oakland, CA: AK/CounterPunch Books.

time when the world was transitioning from the geopolitics of World War II to the 1950s.

Woolfson, Charles. 1982. The Labour Theory of Culture: A Re-examination of Engels’Theory of Human Origins. London: Routledge. An evaluation of Engels’s writings on anthropology.

Classical Cultural Evolutionism

Price describes and evaluates the role of

Ackerman, Robert. 1990. J.G. Frazer: His Life and Work. New York: Cambridge University Press.

social scientists, including anthropologists,

A biography of the classical cultural

in post-9/11 military counterinsurgency

evolutionist who studied myth, folklore,

initiatives.

and religion.

296

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Barnard, Alan. 2000. History and Theory in Anthropology. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Assessments of the lesser-known British

A survey of some of the great theoretical

emphasis on the shifting interests of

Erickson, Paul A., and Liam D. Murphy, eds. 2016. Readings for a History of Anthropological Theory. 5th ed. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.

theoreticians.

A collection of original writings by

debates in anthropology, organized thematically and chronologically with

classical cultural evolutionist.

anthropological theorists from the

Bowler, Peter J. 1990. The Invention of Progress:The Victorians and the Past. Cambridge, MA: Blackwell.

nineteenth to the early twenty-first

An examination of the relationship

Eriksen, Thomas Hylland, and Finn Sivert Nielson. 2001. A History of Anthropology. Herndon,VA: Pluto Press.

between the ideas of progress and the past in Victorian times.

centuries.

A history of social and cultural

Burrow, J.W. 1966. Evolution and Society: A Study in Victorian Social Theory. London: Cambridge University Press.

anthropology from the nineteenth century onward, focusing on themes and controversies after World War I.

A study of evolutionism as an expression of Victorian themes.

Coombes, Annie E. 1994. Reinventing Africa: Museums, Material Culture, and Popular Imagination in Late Victorian and Edwardian England. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.

Fortes, Meyer. 1970. Kinship and the Social Order:The Legacy of Lewis Henry Morgan. Chicago: Aldine. Evaluation of a nineteenth-century American cultural evolutionist by a twentieth-century British social anthropologist.

An evaluation of the role of museums in shaping and reflecting European attitudes toward Africans.

Fraser, Robert. 1990. The Making of The Golden Bough:The Origins and Growth of an Argument. New York: St. Martin’s Press.

Crook, Paul. 2007. Darwin’s Coat-Tails: Essays on Social Darwinism. New York: Peter Lang.

A book about the evolution of James

An examination of Darwin’s views on effect of these views on human conflict

Frazer, James G. 1985 [1890]. The Golden Bough. Abr. and rev. ed. Old Tappan, NJ: Macmillan.

and eugenics into the twentieth century.

An abbreviated version of Frazer’s

competition, war, and aggression and the

Diamond, Alan, ed. 1991. The Victorian Achievement of Sir Henry Maine: A Centennial Appraisal. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Frazer’s magnum opus.

monumental multivolume work on the evolution of myth, folklore, and religion.

Hinsley, Curtis M., Jr. 1994. The Smithsonian and the American Indian:

297

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Making a Moral Anthropology in Victorian America. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press.

Moore, Jerry D. 1997. Visions of Culture:An Introduction to Anthropological Theories and Theorists.Walnut Creek, CA:AltaMira Press.

A study of the role a leading museum

Introductions to numerous influential

played in the development of nineteenth-

cultural theorists, including some from

century American anthropology.

the nineteenth century.

Ihanus, Juhani. 1999. Multiple Origins: Edward Westermarck in Search of Mankind. Frankfurt: Peter Lang.

Morgan, Lewis Henry. 1985 [1877]. Ancient Society. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.

An appraisal of the Victorian-era

Morgan’s magnum opus.

anthropologist who studied the history of marriage and had ties to cultural evolutionists, social anthropologists, and psychologists.

Moses, Daniel Noah. 2009. The Promise of Progress:The Life and Work of Lewis Henry Morgan. Columbia: University of Missouri Press.

Judd, Neil Merton. 1967. The Bureau of American Ethnology: A Partial History. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.

A comprehensive and detailed biography

A history of one of the most influential

career.

revealing Morgan’s international influence and some surprising activities late in his

institutions of anthropology in the United States.

Mantena, Karuna. 2010. Alibis of Empire: Henry Maine and the Ends of Liberal Imperialism. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. A book challenging the view that the

Rumney, Jay. 1966. Herbert Spencer’s Sociology: A Study in the History of Social Theory. New York: Atherton Press. An account of Spencer as a social evolutionist.

the sustained rationalizations of the British

Sanderson, Stephen K. 1992. Social Evolutionism: A Critical History. Cambridge, MA: Blackwell.

Empire when, instead, they were superseded

A critique of social evolutionism

by a “culturalist” doctrine paving the way for

encompassing the Victorian era.

doctrines of progress and civilization were

the colonial policy of indirect rule.

McGee, R. Jon, and Richard Warms, eds. 2011. Anthropological Theory: An Introductory History. 5th ed. Mountain View, CA: Mayfield Publishers. A collection of writings by key

Spencer, Herbert. 1967. The Evolution of Society: Selections from Herbert Spencer’s Principles of Sociology. Ed. Robert L. Carneiro. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. A collection of Spencer’s writings on social evolution.

anthropological theorists from the nineteenth century to the present, with introductions and pedagogical aids.

298

Stocking, George W., Jr. 1987. Victorian Anthropology. New York: Free Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A masterful history of anthropology in the

An account of how nineteenth-

Victorian era.

century German imperialism allowed anthropology to challenge humanism in

———, ed. 1988. Objects and Others: Essays on Museums and Material Culture. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

intellectual battles that resembled the

A collection of writings on the roles of

Evolutionism versus Diffusionism

museums in anthropology.

———, ed. 1994. The Collected Works of E.B.Tylor. New York: Routledge. A compendium of the writings of the Victorian “father” of British anthropology.

“culture wars” of today.

Arnold, Bettina. 1992. “The Past as Propaganda: How Hitler’s Archaeologists Distorted European Prehistory to Justify Racist and Territorial Goals.” Archaeology July/ August: 148–51.

Trautman, Robert R. 2008. Lewis Henry Morgan and the Invention of Kinship. New ed. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press

The title of this article tells it like it is, or

An updated biography of Morgan that

Chatters, James C. 2002. Ancient Encounters: Kennewick Man and the First Americans. New York: Simon & Schuster.

places him on the foundation of the anthropological study of kinship.

was.

One of the first scientists to examine

Trigger, Bruce. 1998. Sociocultural Evolution: Calculation and Contingency. Malden, MA: Blackwell.

Kennewick Man tells his story about the discovery and interpretation of the famous and controversial skeleton.

A theoretical archaeologist writes about sociocultural evolutionism from the medieval period to the Romantic reaction to the French Revolution.

Colavita, Jason. 2013. Faking History: Essays on Aliens, Atlantis, Monsters, and More. Charleston, SC: CreateSpace. The title speaks for itself.

Tylor, Edward Burnett. 1873 [1871]. Primitive Culture. New York: Gordon Press. Tylor’s summation of anthropological knowledge.

Elkin, A.P., and N.W.G. Macintosh, eds. 1974. Grafton Elliot Smith:The Man and His Work. Sydney, Australia: Sydney University Press. A collection of articles about a pioneering

———. 1898 [1881]. Anthropology: An Introduction to the Study of Man and Civilization. New York: D. Appleton.

Australian anthropologist who espoused

The first anthropology “textbook.”

Fagan, Garrett G., ed. 2006. Archaeological Fantasies: How Pseudoarchaeology Misrepresents the Past and Misleads the Public. New York: Routledge.

Zimmerman, Andrew. 2001. Anthropology and Anti-Humanism in Imperial Germany. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

diffusionism.

299

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A wide-ranging collection of reality checks on

A documented account of how

popular misconceptions about archaeological

anthropologists were complicit in, and

subjects such as the Nazca lines.

in some cases responsible for, the racial theories and practices of Nazi Germany.

Gingrich, Andre. 2005. “German Anthropology During the Nazi Period: Complex Scenarios of Collaboration, Persecution and Competition.” In Fredrik Barth, Andre Gingrich, Robert Parkin, and Sydel Silverman, One Discipline, Four Ways: British, German, French, and American Anthropology, 111–36. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A reflection on accountability for

Williams, Stephen. 1991. Fantastic Archaeology:The Wild Side of North American Prehistory. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press. A lighthearted excursion into the outrageous and unrealistic ideas and portrayals – for example, Indiana Jones – that exasperate “real” archaeologists.

anthropologists’ links to Nazism.

Heyerdahl, Thor. 1965. The Kon Tiki Expedition. London: Allen & Unwin. Heyerdahl tells the story of his famous trans-Pacific expedition from Peru to Tahiti, designed to demonstrate the possibility of pre-Columbian contact between the Old and New Worlds.

Archaeology Comes of Age

Abrams, Elliot M., and AnnCorinne Freter, eds. 2005. The Emergence of the Moundbuilders: The Archaeology of Tribal Societies in Southeastern Ohio. Athens: Ohio University Press. Several authors explain how tribal

Perry, William J. 1968 [1923]. The Children of the Sun: A Study in the Early History of Civilization. Saint Clair Shores, MI: Scholarly Press.

societies in the Hocking River Valley of Ohio evolved largely indigenously rather than through immigration, as proposed by the Moundbuilder Myth.

The book that explains why Perry believed civilization arose in Egypt and then spread elsewhere.

Praetzellis, A. 2011. Death by Theory: A Tale of Mystery and Archaeological Theory. Rev. ed. Plymouth, UK: AltaMira Press.

Bahn, Paul G., ed. 1996. The Cambridge Illustrated History of Archaeology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. A history of worldwide archaeology focusing on Europeans’ interactions with

In this textbook-as-novel, students learn

non-Europeans, introduced by a survey of

about archaeological theory by trying to

the “archaeology of archaeology.”

solve a fictive mystery surrounding the Washington Venus.

Schafft, Gretchen E. 2004. From Racism to Genocide: Anthropology in the Third Reich. Chicago: University of Illinois Press. 300

Bentley, Alexander, Herbert D.G. Maschner, and Christopher Chippendale, eds. 2008. Handbook of Archaeological Theories. Lanham, MD: AltaMira Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

research paradigms, linkages to other

Creation Museum. 2020. https:// creationmuseum.org.

disciplines, and relationships between

The official website of the Creation

theory and practice, with some attention

Museum in Petersburg, Kentucky.

Expositions of a host of archaeological

to past theories.

Bowden, Mark. 1991. Pitt Rivers:The Life and Archaeological Work of LieutenantGeneral Augustus Henry Lane Fox Pitt Rivers, DCL, FRS, FSA. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Daniel, Glyn E., ed. 1981. Towards a History of Archaeology. New York: Thames and Hudson. A collection of essays on the history of archaeology, edited by a distinguished British prehistorian.

An intellectual biography of a pioneering British archaeologist.

Brunhouse, Robert Levere. 1974. In Search of the Maya:The First Archaeologists. New York: Ballantine Books.

———. 1986. Some Small Harvest:The Memories of Glyn Daniel. London: Thomas and Hudson. The eminent historian of prehistory reflects on his life, times, and career.

A lively account of the excitement surrounding early Mayan archaeology.

Bueno, Christina. 2016. The Pursuit of Ruins: Archaeology, History, and the Making of Modern Mexico. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press. An account of how the modern Mexican

Daniel, Glyn E., and Colin Renfrew. 1988. The Idea of Prehistory. 2nd ed. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University Press. An account of developments leading to acceptance of the idea of prehistory in nineteenth-century Europe.

government has embraced and incorporated Mexico’s archaeological heritage to help create a distinctive national identity.

Claassen, Cheryl, ed. 1994. Women in Archaeology. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.

Díaz-Andreu, Margarita. 2007. A World History of Nineteenth Century Archaeology: Nationalism, Colonialism, and the Past. Oxford: Oxford University Press. The story of the origins and expansion of archaeological ideas and institutions told

A collection of articles by and about

against the backdrop of contemporary

women archaeologists.

geopolitics.

Cordell, Linda, and Don Fowler, eds. 2005. Southwest Archaeology in the Twentieth Century. Salt Lake City: University of Utah Press.

Díaz-Andreu, Margarita, and Marie Louise Stig Sørensen, eds. 1998. Excavating Women: History of Women in European Archaeology. New York: Routledge.

A wide-ranging collection of appraisals of

A collection of “engendered” accounts

archaeology in the American Southwest,

of European national archaeological

some historical and others personal.

traditions.

301

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Drower, Margaret S. 1995. Flinders Petrie: A Life in Archaeology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

A history of archaeological dating techniques and chronologies, including the chronology of the Three Ages.

A biography of the famous Egyptologist.

Fagan, Brian. 2018. A Little History of Archaeology. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

Grayson, Donald K., ed. 1983. The Establishment of Human Antiquity. Orlando, FL: Academic Press. Perspectives on the origins of the idea of

An accessible, concise, and engaging

human antiquity in nineteenth-century

history of archaeology from its early days

anthropology.

of grand discoveries and controversies through its current deployment of sophisticated investigative technologies.

Fowler, Don D. 2000. A Laboratory for Anthropology: Science and Romanticism in the American Southwest, 1846–1930. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.

Hawkes, Jacquetta Hopkins. 1982. Adventurer in Archaeology:The Biography of Sir Mortimer Wheeler. New York: St. Martin’s Press. A biography of one of the best-known and most colorful twentieth-century British archaeologists.

American anthropology and archaeology

Johnson, Matthew. 2012. Archaeological Theory: An Introduction. 2nd ed. Chichester, UK: Blackwell.

from the Mexican-American War to the

A history of twentieth-century

New Deal.

archaeological theory rooted in the

A history of the idea of “The Southwest” in

nineteenth century and beyond.

Ginger, Ray. 1974. Six Days or Forever?: Tennessee v. John Thomas Scopes. Oxford: Oxford University Press. A historical account of the famous 1925 “Monkey Trial” in Dayton, Tennessee, pitting creationism against evolutionism.

Kehoe, Alice B., and Mary Beth Emmerichs, eds. 1999. Assembling the Past: Studies in the Professionalization of Archaeology. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press. A collection of essays exploring the

Givens, Douglas. 1992. Alfred Vincent Kidder and the Development of Americanist Archaeology. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.

transition from antiquarianism to

A biography of a well-known early

Lubbock, John. 1977 [1865]. Pre-Historic Times. North Stratford, NH: Ayer.

archaeologist of the American Southwest.

professionalism in American archaeology in the decades around 1900.

Lubbock’s summation of mid-nineteenth-

Gräslund, Bo. 1987. The Birth of Prehistoric Chronology: Dating Methods and Dating Systems in Nineteenth Century Scandinavian Archaeology. New York: Cambridge University Press. 302

century prehistoric archaeology.

Lyell, Charles. 1863. Geological Evidences of the Antiquity of Man. 4th ed. New York: AMS Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Lyell’s landmark summation of the

A collection of perspectives on the history

evidence for human prehistoric antiquity.

of archaeology in the formerly colonized continent.

Meltzer, David, ed. 1998 [1848]. Ancient Monuments of the Mississippi Valley, by E.G. Squier and E.H. Davis, with an Introduction by David Meltzer. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution. An edited edition of the landmark

Rowley-Conwy, Peter. 2007. From Genesis to Prehistory:The Archaeological Three Age System and Its Contested Reception in Denmark, Britain, and Ireland. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

evaluation of evidence for prehistoric

An historical account of how and why the

Mississippi Valley moundbuilders.

Three Age System of the 1830s was readily accepted in Scandinavia but robustly

Murray, Tim. 1999. Encyclopedia of Archaeology: The Great Archaeologists. 2 vols. Santa Barbara, CA: ABC-Clio.

contested in Britain and Ireland until the 1870s.

arranged chronologically from the

Rupke, Nicholas A. 1983. The Great Chain of History:William Buckland and the English School of Geology (1814–1849). Oxford: Clarendon Press.

Renaissance to the present.

A history of the early exploration of British

A collection of biographical sketches of “the greatest archaeologists ever,”

caves with prehistoric human remains.

———. 2011. “Archaeologists and Indigenous People: A Maturing Relationship.” Annual Review of Anthropology 40: 363−378.

Silverberg, Robert. 1986. The MoundBuilders. Athens: Ohio University Press.

The author reviews and evaluates some

people other than Native Americans built

developments aiming to reconcile two

prehistoric earthen mounds throughout

communities with a history of being at

the midwestern United States.

A history of the myth that mysterious

odds with one another.

O’Brien, Michael J., and R. Lee Lyman. 1998. James A. Ford and the Growth of Americanist Archaeology. Columbia: University of Missouri Press.

Smith, Pamela Jane, and Donald Mitchell, eds. 1998. Bringing Back the Past: Historical Perspectives on Canadian Archaeology. Hull, QC: Canadian Museum of Civilization. A collection of histories of archaeology in

An account of Ford’s role in the development

Canada divided into sections on people,

of the “culture history” approach to

institutions, regions, and “toward the

archaeology during the heyday of Boasian

present.”

anthropology in the United States.

Robertshaw, Peter, ed. 1990. A History of African Archaeology. Portsmouth, NH: Heinemann.

Thomas, David Hurst. 2000. Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, and the Battle for Native American Identity. New York: Basic Books. 303

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Inspired by the 1996 discovery of

A history of ideas about human

“Kennewick Man,” a history of relationships

evolution in the pre- and post-Darwinian

among American archaeologists,

periods.

governments, and Native Americans.

Van Riper, A. Bowdin. 1993. Men among the Mammoths:Victorian Science and the Discovery of Human Prehistory. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A detailed history of scientific developments in the 1850s and 1860s leading to acceptance of the idea of prehistory in Britain.

———. 1989a. Evolution:The History of an Idea. Rev. ed. Berkeley: University of California Press. A history of the complex idea of evolution.

———. 1989b. The Mendelian Revolution: The Emergence of Hereditarian Concepts in Modern Science and Society. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press. An examination of “nature versus nurture”

Willey, Gordon R., and Jeremy A. Sabloff. 1995. A History of American Archaeology. 3rd ed. New York: W.H. Freeman. A comprehensive history of American archaeology.

in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries.

———. 1996. Charles Darwin:The Man and His Influence. New York: Cambridge University Press. A scientific biography of Darwin.

Charles Darwin and Darwinism

Bannister, Robert C. 1988. Social Darwinism: Science and Myth. Rev. ed. Philadelphia: Temple University Press. An analysis of scientific and extrascientific

Burckhardt, Richard W., Jr. 1990. The Spirit of System: Lamarck and Evolutionary Biology. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. A scientific biography of the famous preDarwinian evolutionist Jean Lamarck.

rationalizations for a Darwinian interpretation of society.

Bowler, Peter J. 1983. The Eclipse of Darwinism: Anti-Darwinian Evolution Theories in the Decades around 1900. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Carey, Nessa. 2012. The Epigenetics Revolution: How Modern Biology Is Rewriting Our Understanding of Genetics, Disease and Inheritance. New York: Columbia University Press. An exposition of the nature and implication of epigenetic evolution,

An explanation of how Darwin’s theory of

the process by which environmentally

evolution by natural selection fell out of

induced alteration of the expression of

scientific favor by 1900.

genes can be inherited, tantamount to Lamarckism.

———. 1986.Theories of Human Evolution: A Century of Debate, 1844–1944. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press. 304

Clements, Harry. 1983. Alfred Russel Wallace: Biologist and Social Reformer. London: Hutchinson.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A biography of the co-discoverer of the

The second part of the biography.

idea of natural selection.

Costa, James T. 2014. Darwin,Wallace, and the Origin of Species. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. A historical study emphasizing the

Eckman, Paul. 1973. Darwin and Facial Expression: A Century of Research in Review. Orlando, FL: Academic Press. A book that traces the history of human ethology back to Charles Darwin.

independence of the co-discovery of the theory of evolution by natural selection by Charles Darwin and Alfred Russel Wallace.

Coyne, Jerry. 2009. Why Evolution Is True. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

Eiseley, Loren C. 1958. Darwin’s Century: Evolution and the Men Who Discovered It. Garden City, NY: Doubleday. A non-technical history of key developments in Darwinism.

An accessible presentation of the evidence in favor of evolution and a response to people who think that evolution is false.

Darwin, Charles. 1964 [1859]. On the Origin of Species: A Facsimile of the First Edition. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Darwin’s magnum opus.

Fichman, Martin. 2004. An Elusive Victorian:The Evolution of Alfred Russel Wallace. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. An examination of the work and controversial intellectual views of the man who, with Charles Darwin, came up with the idea of evolution by natural selection.

———. 1981 [1871]. The Descent of Man and Selection in Relation to Sex. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

Gillispie, Charles C. 1996 [1951]. Genesis and Geology. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Darwin’s explanation of human evolution.

A study of the influence of Christian theology on geology in the decades

Degler, Carl. 1992. In Search of Human Nature:The Decline and Revival of Darwinism in American Social Thought. New York: Oxford University Press. An examination of the ebb and flow of Social Darwinism in the United States.

leading up to On the Origin of Species.

Gilman, Nicholas Wright. 2001. A Life of Sir Francis Galton: From African Exploration to the Birth of Eugenics. New York: Oxford University Press. An informative biography of Charles

Desmond, Adrian. 1994. Huxley:The Devil’s Disciple. London: Michael Joseph.

Darwin’s cousin and the recognized founder of eugenics.

The first of a two-part biography of Darwin’s “bulldog,” Thomas Henry Huxley.

———. 1997. Huxley: Evolution’s High Priest. London: Michael Joseph.

Glick, Thomas F., ed. 1988. The Comparative Reception of Darwinism. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 305

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A collection of articles examining the

An analysis of Darwinism as an expression

early reception of Darwinism in several

of its social time and place.

countries.

Gould, Stephen Jay. 1987. Time’s Arrow, Time’s Cycle: Myth and Metaphor in the Discovery of Geological Time. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. A book about influences on the geological

Hofstadter, Richard. 1992 [1944]. Social Darwinism in American Thought. Boston: Beacon Press. An analysis of Social Darwinism in America in the decades after On the Origin of Species.

conceptualization of time in the nineteenth century.

———. 1996. The Mismeasure of Man. New York: W.W. Norton. An examination of the use and abuse

Lyell, Charles. 1970 [1830]. Principles of Geology. Forestburgh, NY: Lubrecht and Cramer. Lyell’s landmark treatise on uniformitarian geology.

of anthropometric measurements by nineteenth-century racial anthropologists.

Greene, John C. 1959. The Death of Adam: Evolution and Its Impact on Western Thought. Ames: Iowa State University Press.

Mayr, Ernst. 1990. The Growth of Biological Thought: Diversity, Evolution, and Inheritance. Cambridge, MA: The Belknap Press of Harvard University. A masterful history of biology by one of

An eloquent history of Darwinism and its

the architects of the twentieth-century

implication for anthropology.

synthetic theory of evolution.

Haller, John S., Jr. 1995 [1971]. Outcasts from Evolution: Scientific Attitudes of Racial Inferiority, 1859–1900. Champaign: University of Illinois Press.

———. 1991. One Long Argument: Charles Darwin and the Genesis of Modern Evolutionary Thought. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

An account of the persistence of racist

An exposition of the Darwinian origins of

views in post-Darwinian anthropology.

evolutionism.

Hawkins, Mike. 1997. Social Darwinism in European and American Thought, 1860–1945: Nature as Model and Nature as Threat. New York: Cambridge University Press. An interpretive history of Social Darwinism

McCown, Theodore D., and Kenneth A.R. Kennedy, eds. 1972. Climbing Man’s Family Tree: A Collection of Major Writings on Human Phylogeny, 1699–1971. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.

in Euro-American culture.

A collection of interpretations of human evolution spanning three centuries.

Himmelfarb, Gertrude. 1959. Darwin and the Darwinian Revolution. London: Chatto and Windus. 306

M’charek, Amande. 2005. The Human Diversity Project: An Ethnography

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

of Scientific Practice. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Lifelong Quest to Prove Darwin Right. New York: Simon and Schuster.

The author turns the ethnographic lens

A biography of the Dutch scientist who set

on two laboratories and generalizes on her

out to find the “missing link” and in 1890

observations.

discovered “Pithecanthropus erectus” or “Java Man.”

Millhauser, Milton. 1959. Just Before Darwin: Robert Chambers and Vestiges. Middletown, CT:Wesleyan University Press. the most notable pre-Darwinian

Spencer, Frank, comp. 1986. Ecce Homo: An Annotated Bibliographic History of Physical Anthropology. Westport, CT: Greenwood.

evolutionists.

A major sourcebook compiled by a leading

A scientif ic biography of one of

historian of physical anthropology.

Olby, Robert C. 1995. The Origins of Mendelism. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A history of early modern genetics and

———, ed. 1997. History of Physical Anthropology: An Encyclopedia. New York: Garland.

hereditarian outlooks in science.

A comprehensive, two-volume encyclopedic history of physical

Oldroyd, David R. 1996. Thinking about the Earth: A History of Ideas in Geology. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. An intellectual history of geology by a respected historian of science.

anthropology.

Stanton, William Ragan. 1960. The Leopard’s Spots: Scientific Attitudes toward Race in America, 1815–1859. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A history of American anthropology in

Ruse, Michael. 1997. Monad to Man: The Concept of Progress in Evolutionary Biology. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. A history of biology linked to the idea of progress.

the first half of the nineteenth century, highlighting the “American School.”

Stocking, George W., Jr. 1982. Race, Culture and Evolution: Essays in the History of Anthropology. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

Schiller, Francis. 1992. Paul Broca: Founder of French Anthropology, Explorer of the Brain. New York: Oxford University Press.

An analysis of important themes in

An intellectual biography of the leading

———, ed. 1990. Bones, Bodies, and Behavior: Essays on Biological Anthropology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

French physical anthropologist of the nineteenth century.

nineteenth- and twentieth-century anthropology.

A collection of articles on a wide range

Shipman, Pat. 2000. The Man Who Found the Missing Link: Eugene Dubois and His

of topics in the history of physical anthropology.

307

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Young, Robert M. 1985. Darwin’s Metaphor: Nature’s Place in Victorian Culture. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Gilman, Sander L. 1993. Freud, Race, and Gender. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

An examination of the conceptualization

themes in Freudianism.

An examination of anthropological

of “nature” in nineteenth-century science and culture.

Sigmund Freud

Bock, Kenneth. 1999. Rethinking Psychological Anthropology. 2nd ed. New York: W.H. Freeman. A historically oriented overview of

Kardiner, Abram, and Edward Preble. 1961. They Studied Man. Cleveland: World Publishing Company. Biographical sketches of prominent early anthropologists accompanied by an essay on the contributions of Sigmund Freud.

attentive to the influence of Sigmund

Ritvo, Lucile B. 1990. Darwin’s Influence on Freud: A Tale of Two Sciences. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

Freud.

Histories of nineteenth- and twentieth-

psychological anthropology

Ferguson, Harvie. 1996. The Lure of Dreams: Sigmund Freud and the Construction of Modernity. London: Routledge.

century Darwinian biology and Freudian psychology.

Harvie argues that Freud’s influence

Spiro, Melford E. 1992. Oedipus in the Trobriands. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction.

on social anthropology extends beyond

An account of Bronislaw Malinowski’s

a now-unfashionable evolutionism

investigation of Freudian psychology in

to a now-fashionable rejection

the Trobriand Islands.

of rationality embedded in postmodernism.

Freud, Sigmund. 1960 [1913]. Totem and Taboo. Trans. Abraham A. Brill. New York: Random House.

Wallace, Edwin R., IV. 1983. Freud and Anthropology: A History and Reappraisal. Madison, CT: International Universities Press. A critical examination of the relationship

Freud’s anthropological speculations on

between Freudian psychology and

the origin of the conflict between culture

anthropology.

and the human psyche.

———. 1973 [1928]. The Future of an Illusion. Rev. and ed. James Strachey. London: Hogarth Press and the Institute of Psycho-Analysis.

Émile Durkheim

Freud’s further thoughts on the conflict

Alexander, Jeffrey C., and Philip Smith, eds. 2005. The Cambridge Companion to Durkheim. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

between culture and the human

A collection of 15 articles exploring the

psyche.

multifaceted influence of Durkheim on

308

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS late-twentieth- and early-twenty-firstcentury social theory.

Emirbayer, Mustafa, ed. 2003. Emile Durkheim: Sociologist of Modernity. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley-Blackwell.

Allen, N.J., W.E.S. Pickering, and W. Watts Miller, eds. 1998. On Durkheim’s Elementary Forms of Religious Life. New York: Routledge.

A comprehensive collection of Durkheim’s

A collection of essays on Durkheim’s

late-twentieth- and early-twenty-first-

“masterpiece” examining his views on

century social theory.

writings on a wide range of subjects accompanied by essays by modern theorists connecting those writings to

religion and society from contemporary and historical perspectives.

Besnard, Philippe, ed. 1983. The Sociological Domain, the Durkheimians and the Founding of French Sociology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Jones, Robert A. 1986. The Sociological Theories of Émile Durkheim. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications. An assessment of Durkheim’s sociology.

Jones, Susan Stedman. 2001. Durkheim Reconsidered. Oxford: Polity.

Examinations of Durkheim’s role in

A reinterpretation of Durkheim’s

shaping French sociology.

contributions in historical perspective.

Durkheim, Émile. 1966 [1897]. Suicide. New York: Free Press. Durkheim analyzes suicide from his

Lement, Charles. 2006. Durkheim’s Ghosts: Cultural Logics and Social Things. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

sociological perspective.

A series of essays on how Durkheim’s theory of knowledge has affected the

———. 1982 [1895]. The Rules of Sociological Method. New York: Free Press.

cultural and social sciences, focusing on

Durkheim explains the importance of

semiotics.

key theorists, with special attention to

social facts.

———. 1984 [1893]. The Division of Labor in Society. Trans. W.D. Hall. New York: Free Press.

Lukes, Steven. 1985. Émile Durkheim: His Life and Work: A Historical and Critical Study. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.

Durkheim explains the distinction between

An interpretation of Durkheim’s

mechanical and organic solidarity.

intellectual life and times.

———. 1995 [1912]. The Elementary Forms of the Religious Life. Trans. Karen E. Fields. New York: Free Press.

Parkin, Frank. 1992. Durkheim. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

Durkheim analyzes the collective

Strensky, Ivan. 2006. The New Durkheim. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.

conscious and the sacred role of religion.

A biographical account of Durkheim.

309

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS In a series of essays Strensky

Max Weber

revitalizes Durkheimian theory by applying it to contemporary social issues such as terrorism, sacrif ice, and animal rights.

Ertman, Thomas C., ed. 2017. Max Weber’s Economic Ethic of the World’s Religions: An Analysis. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Turner, Stephen P. 1993. Émile Durkheim: Sociologist and Moralist. New York: Routledge.

Several scholarly specialists seek to mine

An evaluation of Durkheim as a

the great divide between Western and

moralist.

Eastern world religions.

Marcel Mauss

Gell, Alfred. 1998. Art and Agency: An Anthropological Theory. Oxford: Clarendon Press.

Fournier, Marcel. 2006. Marcel Mauss: A Biography.Trans. Jane Moore Todd. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. An English translation of what is widely regarded as the definitive biography of Mauss.

what is relevant in Weber’s ambitious unfinished work in order to shed light on

An exposition of an anthropological theory that art is a category of human action.

Keys, Charles F. 2002. “Weber and Anthropology.” Annual Review of Anthropology 31: 233–55. Keys reviews Weber’s position on the

Godelier, Maurice. 1999. The Enigma of the Gift. Trans. Nora Scott. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

theoretical relationship between religion

A new interpretation of Mauss’s theory

Geertz’s interpretive anthropology and

of gift-giving from one of the gurus of

Pierre Bourdieu’s theory of practice.

and political economy and his influence on, among other theories, Clifford

structural Marxism.

James, Wendy, and N.J. Allen, eds. 1998. Marcel Mauss: A Centenary Tribute. New York: Berghahn Books. A collection of essays re-evaluating the

Löwith, Karl. 1993. Max Weber and Karl Marx. London: Routledge. A comparison and contrast of the two great thinkers, emphasizing the concepts of rationality and self-alienation.

work and influence of Mauss.

Mauss, Marcel. 2016 [1924]. The Gift: Expanded Edition. Trans. Jane I. Guyer. Chicago: Hau Books.

Symonds, Michael. 2015. Max Weber’s Theory of Modernity:The Endless Pursuit of Meaning. New York: Routledge. Symonds shows how Weber’s ideas

Mauss’s classic 1924 essay accompanied by

of paradox and brotherliness help

excerpts from other works that shed light

render human suffering and death

on his intellectual influences and personal

meaningful in a world devoid of

life and times.

Western religion.

310

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Weber, Max. 1993 [1922]. The Sociology of Religion. Boston: Beacon Press.

of his contribution to social science,

Weber’s classic formulation of religion,

the f irst edition to include sections

paying special attention to the ways

on Marxism, psychoanalysis, and

in which religion effects social change

deconstructionism.

linguistics, and semiology, revised f rom

in a variety of cultural and historical settings.

———. 1996 [1920]. The Protestant Ethic and the Spirit of Capitalism. Ed. Randall Collins. Los Angeles: Roxbury.

Harris, Roy. 1991. Reading Saussure: A Critical Commentary on the “Cours de Linguistique Générale.” Chicago: Open Court Publishing. A relatively sophisticated discussion and critique of Saussurian theory by a

Written before The Sociology of

distinguished philosopher of language

Religion, this book looks at the

and specialist on Saussure.

dialectical relationship between Calvinist Protestantism as an ideology and the expansion of capitalism in the Renaissance and beyond.

Holdcroft, David. 1991. Saussure: Signs, System, and Arbitrariness. New York: Cambridge University Press. A sophisticated introduction to

Ferdinand de Saussure

Saussurian theory that scrutinizes his

Chandler, Daniel. 2017. Semiotics: The Basics. 3rd ed. Abingdon, UK: Routledge.

philosopher of language and science

A popular textbook introducing semiotics,

contemporary scholars.

linguistics from the perspective of a and offers some important insights into the relative value of Saussure for

a field for which Ferdinand de Saussure with examples drawn from contemporary

Joseph, John E. 2012. Saussure. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

media and culture studies.

A comprehensive biography of Saussure

was foundational, in jargon-free language

with a detailed chronology of the

Culler, Jonathan. 1976. Ferdinand de Saussure. Harmondsworth, UK: Penguin Books.

development of his ideas in a European

An engaging biographical introduction to contribution to social science, linguistics,

Saunders, Carol, ed. 2004. The Cambridge Companion to Saussure. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

and semiology.

Saunders brings together a team of 15

Saussure and a concise discussion of his

context.

scholars to evaluate Saussure’s earlier

———. 1986. Ferdinand de Saussure. Rev. ed. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.

work in linguistics and structuralism,

An engaging biographical introduction

later unfinished work in semantics and

to Saussure and concise discussion

semiotics.

the Course in General Linguistics, and

311

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Saussure, Ferdinand de. 1998 [1916]. Course in General Linguistics. Trans. Roy Harris. Chicago: Open Court Publishing.

Barrett, Stanley R. 1996. Anthropology: A Student’s Guide to Theory and Method. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.

Saussure’s magnum opus, redacted

theories and methods accompanied by

after his death f rom his own lecture

ethnographic examples derived from the

notes and those of his students,

author’s own fieldwork.

An exposition of major twentieth-century

including all his contributions to language theory.

Part Two: The Earlier Twentieth Century

Bateson, Mary C. 1994 [1984]. With a Daughter’s Eye: A Memoir of Gregory Bateson and Margaret Mead. New York: Harper Collins. A biography of Mead and her third husband, by their daughter.

American Cultural Anthropology

Baker, Lee. 1998. From Savage to Negro: Anthropology and the Construction of Race, 1896–1954. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Benedict, Ruth. 1977. An Anthropologist at Work:The Writings of Ruth Benedict. Ed. Margaret Mead. Westport, CT: Greenwood. A collection of key writings by Benedict,

A history of American anthropology and

edited by her long-time friend and

African-American experiences in the years

colleague.

between two landmark United States Supreme Court decisions affecting race relations.

———. 1989 [1934]. Patterns of Culture. Boston: Houghton Mifflin. Benedict’s classic analysis of three

———. 2004. “Franz Boas Out of the Ivory Tower.” Anthropological Theory 4.1: 29–51.

cultures, for decades an anthropology best-seller.

Baker explains Boas’s gravitation toward public engagement, his contemporary impact as a public intellectual, and his work as deployed in public discourse today.

Bernardo, Susan M., and Graham J. Murphy. 2006. Ursula K. Le Guin: A Critical Companion. Westport, CT: Greenwood Press. A guide designed to introduce teachers

Banner, Lois W. 2010. Intertwined Lives: Margaret Mead, Ruth Benedict, and Their Circle. New York: Knopf Doubleday Publishing Group.

and students to Le Guin’s writing, including its anthropological influences.

mixture of their personal and professional

Boas, Franz. 1989. A Franz Boas Reader: The Shaping of American Anthropology, 1883–1911. Ed. George W. Stocking, Jr. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

lives, as well as the lives of their various

A book that places major works of Boas in

husbands and friends.

historical perspective.

A carefully researched examination of the childhoods of Mead and Benedict and the

312

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Bock, Philip K., and Stephen C. Leavitt. 2018. Rethinking Psychological Anthropology: A Critical History. 3rd ed. Long Grove, IL: Waveland Press.

Key papers of an anthropologist who

An overview of psychological anthropolpsychodynamic phase through the cur-

Cole, Douglas. 1999. Franz Boas:The Early Years, 1858–1906. Seattle: University of Washington Press.

rent revival of cognitive anthropology.

The first of a projected two-part scholarly

ogy from its early psychoanalytic and

advanced psychological anthropology in the post–World War II period.

biography, profiling Boas from his

Caffrey, Margaret M. 1989. Ruth Benedict: Stranger in This Land. Austin: University of Texas Press.

childhood in Germany to his departure from

A biography of Benedict that explores her

Cole, Sally Cooper. 2004. Ruth Landes: A Life in Anthropology. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

sense of personal and cultural alienation.

the American Museum of Natural History.

Carroll, J.B., ed. 1956. Language,Thought and Reality: Selected Writings of Benjamin Lee Whorf. New York: John Wiley and Sons.

A biography of a student of Franz Boas

A collection of key writings by the

Cote, James E. 1994. Adolescent Storm and Stress: An Evaluation of the MeadFreeman Controversy. Mahwah, NJ: Laurence Erlbaum Associates.

co-formulator of the Sapir-Whorf hypothesis.

Cassidy, Robert. 1982. Margaret Mead: A Voice for the Century. New York: Universe Books.

and Ruth Benedict who pioneered anthropological studies of race and gender.

A contribution to the anthropological debate about Mead’s ethnographic work in Samoa.

A biography of Mead highlighting her ability to communicate with the public.

Chaney, Anthony. 2017. Runaway: Gregory Bateson, the Double Bind, and the Rise of Ecological Consciousness. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.

Cressman, Luther S. 1988. A Golden Journey: Memoirs of an Archaeologist. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. A book in which Cressman shows why he should be remembered as more than Margaret Mead’s first husband.

An intellectual biography of Margaret

his prescient anticipation of postmodern

Cummings, Elizabeth. 1993. Understanding Ursula K. Guin. Rev. ed. Columbia: University of South Carolina Press.

ecological awareness.

An exploration of Le Guin’s science fiction

Mead’s third husband and free-thinking communication theorist emphasizing

writings identifying their anthropological

Chasdi, Eleanor H., ed. 1994. Culture and Human Development:The Selected Papers of John Whiting. New York: Cambridge University Press.

influences.

Darnell, Regna. 1990. Edward Sapir: Linguist, Anthropologist, Humanist. 313

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

A biography of the distinguished Boasian

Deacon, Desley. 1997. Elsie Clews Parsons: Inventing Modern Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

anthropologist and co-formulator of the

A biography of a pioneering American

Sapir-Whorf hypothesis.

social theorist who was a patron of

Berkeley: University of California Press.

Boasian anthropologists.

———. 2000. And Along Came Boas: Continuity and Revolution in Americanist Anthropology. Philadelphia: John Benjamins Publishing. Written with postmodernism in mind,

De Vos, George A., and L. Bryce Boyer. 1989. Symbolic Analysis Cross-Culturally: The Rorschach Test. Berkeley: University of California Press.

an institutionally focused history

Psychological and psychoanalytic

of American anthropology f rom

anthropologists examine the efficacy of

the Bureau of American Ethnology

the Rorschach Test in three non-Western

onward.

cultures.

———. 2001. Invisible Genealogies: A History of Americanist Anthropology. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

Driver, Harold Edson. 1962. The Contribution of A.L. Kroeber to Culture Area Theory and Practice. Baltimore: Waverly Press.

A reinterpretation of American

An American anthropologist recounts

anthropology aimed at counteracting

Kroeber’s contributions to Native

postmodern anthropologists’ efforts to

American anthropology.

set themselves apart from their Boasian predecessors.

Darnell, Regna, and Frederic W. Gleach, eds. 2002. Celebrating a Century of the American Anthropological Association: Presidential Portraits. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press. A history of American anthropology as revealed in the contributions of past presidents of the American Anthropological Association.

Du Bois, Cora. 1944. The People of Alor: A Social-Psychological Study of an EastIndian Island. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press. A classic monograph in the tradition of psychodynamic anthropology.

Duncan, James. 1980. “The Superorganic in American Cultural Geography.” Annals of the Association of American Geographers 70.2: 181–98. A critical philosophical evaluation of the

———. eds. 2017. Historicizing Theories, Identities, and Nations. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

concept of the superorganic in both

An assemblage of 13 innovative articles,

Leslie White.

geography and the anthropology of Robert Lowie, Alfred Louis Kroeber, and

five of which focus on Franz Boas and link his thoughts to modern issues and events, for example 9/11.

314

Erickson, Paul A. 1993. “Zora Neale Hurston.” In Anthropological Lives:

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Biographies of Eminent Anthropologists, 23–27. New Delhi: Reliance Publishing House.

Gacs, Ute, et al., eds. 1988. Women Anthropologists: A Biographical Dictionary. New York: Greenwood Press.

A brief biography of American

Biographical sketches of numerous

anthropologist Zora Neale Hurston.

women in all fields of modern anthropology, including their

Fagan, Kevin. 2000. “Ishi’s Kin to Give Him Proper Burial.” San Francisco Chronicle, August 10.

backgrounds and professional

A newspaper reporter’s account of the Ishi

Greenhouse, Carol J. 2010. “Introduction: Cultural Subjects and Objects: The Legacies of Franz Boas and Its Futures in Anthropology, Academe, and Human Rights.” Proceedings of the American Philosophical Society 154.1: 1–7.

affair.

Foerstel, Lenora, and Angela Gilliam, eds. 1991. Confronting the Margaret Mead Legacy: Scholarship, Empire and the South Pacific. Philadelphia: Temple University Press.

accomplishments.

An introduction to a group of five papers reflecting on Boas’ legacy presented at a

Examinations of Mead’s legacy to

symposium commemorating the 150th

anthropology.

anniversary of his birth.

Freeman, Derek. 1982. Margaret Mead and Samoa:The Making and Unmaking of an Anthropological Myth. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

Grinanger, Patricia. 1999. Uncommon Lives: My Lifelong Friendship with Margaret Mead. Lanham, MD: Rowman and Littlefield.

The book that began a protracted

Recollections of a lifelong confidante of

anthropological debate about Mead’s

Mead, revealing Mead’s opinions about her

ethnographic work in Samoa.

supporters and detractors.

———. 1997. Margaret Mead and the Heretic:The Making and Unmaking of an Anthropological Myth. New York: Penguin Putnam, Inc.

Grosskurth, Phyllis. 1988. Margaret Mead: A Life of Controversy. London: Penguin Books.

An updated version of Freeman’s

both her outspokenness on public

book Margaret Mead and Samoa

issues and the scholarly criticism of her

(1982).

fieldwork.

———. 1998. The Fateful Hoaxing of Margaret Mead: A Historical Analysis of Her Samoan Research. Boulder, CO: Westview Press.

Gruber, Jacob. 1970. “Salvage Ethnology and the Shaping of Anthropology.” American Anthropologist 72.6: 1289–99.

An expansion of Freeman’s argument

An evaluation of the role of salvage

that Mead was misled by the mischievous

ethnology in anthropology, written a

joking of her native informants.

generation after the heyday of salvage

A brief biography of Mead that addresses

315

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS ethnology during the lifetime of Franz Boas.

Herskovits, Melville J. 1953. Franz Boas. New York: Scribner. A biography of Boas by an accomplished

Handler, Richard, ed. 2000. Excluded Ancestors, Inventible Traditions: Essays Toward a More Inclusive History of Anthropology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Boasian anthropologist.

A collection of essays on “little-known

Hill, Lynda Marion. 1996. Social Rituals and the Verbal Art of Zora Neale Hurston. Washington, DC: Howard University Press.

scholars” who have contributed to

An appraisal of the writings of Zora Neale

the history of anthropology, featuring

Hurston, a student of Franz Boas who

an essay on the anthropological

believed that folklore was an important

“canon.”

means of transmitting African-American culture.

Hare, Peter H. 1985. A Woman’s Quest for Science: A Portrait of Anthropologist Elsie Clews Parsons. Amherst, NY: Prometheus Books.

Holmes, Lowell D. 1986. Quest for the Real Samoa:The Mead-Freeman Controversy and Beyond. Westport, CT: Greenwood.

Another biography of Parsons.

A contribution to the anthropological debate about Mead’s ethnographic work

Harrison, Ira E., and Faye V. Harrison, eds. 1999. African-American Pioneers in Anthropology. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.

in Samoa.

Portraits of Af rican-American

Honigmann, John J. 1975. The Development of Anthropological Ideas. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

anthropologists, including W.

A history of anthropology with an

Montague Cobb, Zora Neale Hurston,

emphasis on psychological anthropology.

and Elliot Skinner, written to “critically reconstruct” and “decolonize” anthropology.

Howard, Jane. 1984. Margaret Mead: A Life. New York: Simon and Schuster. A biography of Mead written to appeal to

Helm, June, ed. 1988. Pioneers of American Anthropology:The Uses of Biography. New York: AMS Press. Biographical accounts of early American anthropologists.

the public.

Hurston, Zora Neale. 2006. Dust Tracks on The Road: An Autobiography. New York: Harper Collins. A reissue of Hurston’s 1942 autobiography,

Hemenway, Robert. 1977. Zora Neale Hurston: A Literary Biography. Chicago: University of Illinois Press.

in which she recounts her upbringing,

The biography of Hurston that

Hyatt, Marshall. 1990. Franz Boas, Social Activist:The Dynamics of Ethnicity. New York: Greenwood Press.

helped rehabilitate her literary and anthropological reputation.

316

beginning with her childhood in Florida.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A biographical account of Boas’s involvement with social issues pertaining to the anthropological understanding of ethnicity.

Janiewski, Dolores. 2004. Reading Benedict/ Reading Mead: Feminism, Race, and Imperial Visions. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Kroeber, A.L., and Clyde Kluckhohn. 1952. Culture: A Critical Review of Concepts and Definitions. Cambridge, MA: Peabody Museum of American Archaeology and Ethnology. A compendium of conceptualizations of culture by two anthropologists who conceptualized culture as shared values.

Another account and interpretation of the life and times of Ruth Benedict and Margaret Mead.

Kroeber, Karl, and Clifton Kroeber, eds. 2003. Ishi in Three Centuries. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

Kardiner, Abram, and Edward Preble. 1961. They Studied Man. Cleveland: World Publishing.

Two of A.L. Kroeber’s sons present

Accounts of key anthropological theorists,

death, and post-mortem repatriation.

reminiscences of their father, Ishi, and various issues surrounding Ishi’s captivity,

with an expanded section on Sigmund Freud and his influence on anthropology.

Keeley, Lawrence. 1996. War before Civilization:The Myth of the Peaceful Savage. Oxford: Oxford University Press. An archaeologist gives evidence why the romanticized view of peaceable prehistoric peoples is contrary to fact.

Kroeber, Theodora. 1970. Alfred Kroeber: A Personal Configuration. Berkeley, CA: University of California Press. A loving biography of Kroeber by his wife.

———. 2011. Ishi in Two Worlds, 50th Anniversary Issue. Berkeley: University of California Press. A reissue of Theodora Kreober’s account of

King, Lily. 2014. Euphoria: A Novel. New York: Harper Collins.

Ishi and his relationship with her husband, Alfred Louis Kroeber.

A fictionalized account of Margaret Mead and two of her three husbands in New Guinea in the 1930s.

Koerner, Konrad, ed. 1985. Edward Sapir: Appraisals of His Life and Work. Amsterdam: John Benjamins.

Lapsley, Hilary. 1999. Margaret Mead and Ruth Benedict:The Kinship of Women. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press. An examination of the lifelong friendship between two of the most eminent

A collection of evaluations by key Boasian

Boasian-era anthropologists, highlighting

anthropologists commemorating the

personality, sexuality, and professional

centenary of Sapir’s birth.

accomplishments.

Kroeber, A.L. 1944. Configurations of Cultural Growth. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Lee, Penny. 1996. The Whorf Theory Complex: A Critical Reconstruction. Amsterdam: John Benjamins Publishing.

Kroeber’s magnum opus.

317

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A carefully researched account of

century, including Alice Fletcher, Zelia

Benjamin Lee Whorf’s views on linguistic

Nuttalls, and Elsie Clews Parsons.

relativity, published on the occasion of the centenary of his birth.

Linton, Adelin, and Charles Wagley. 1971. Ralph Linton. New York: Columbia University Press.

Lutkehaus, Nancy C. 2008. Margaret Mead:The Making of an American Icon. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. An account of Mead as a famous

A biography of an accomplished Boasian-

spokesperson for anthropology and

era anthropologist.

forerunner of public anthropology.

Lipset, David. 1980. Gregory Bateson:The Legacy of a Scientist. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall. A biography of Mead’s third husband and

Mandler, Peter. 2013. Return from the Natives: How Margaret Mead Won the Second World War and Lost the Cold War. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.

the scientist responsible for the “double-

The author wades into the contentious

bind” theory of schizophrenia.

issue of anthropologists’ participation in government-sponsored military agendas

Lowie, Robert H. 1937. History of Ethnological Theory. New York: Rinehart and Company.

by revisiting the participation of Mead and her associates in American efforts to contend with fascism and communism.

Lowie contrasts Boasian ethnology with the ethnology of his nineteenth-century predecessors.

———. 1959. Robert H. Lowie, Ethnologist: A Personal Record. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand.

Manson, William C. 1988. The Psychodynamics of Culture: Abram Kardiner and Neo-Freudian Anthropology. Westport, CT: Greenwood. An examination of the life and work of the chief architect of psychodynamic

Lowie’s autobiography.

anthropology.

———. 1960 [1920]. Primitive Society. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. Lowie’s summation of anthropology

Mead, Margaret. 1954. “The Swaddling Hypothesis: Its Reception.” American Anthropologist 56.3: 395–409.

contrasted with the summations of

Mead clarifies some of the misconceptions

nineteenth-century evolutionists.

surrounding the critical reception of Geoffrey Gorer’s swaddling hypothesis in

Lurie, Nancy. 1999. Women and the Invention of American Anthropology. Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland Press.

the 1950s.

Profiles of women who helped

———. 1990 [1972]. Blackberry Winter. Magnolia, MA: Peter Smith.

anthropology achieve recognition as an

The first volume of Mead’s projected

academic discipline in the early twentieth

multivolume autobiography.

318

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

———. 1990 [1928]. Coming of Age in Samoa. Magnolia, MA: Peter Smith. The book that launched Mead’s career.

American Southwest. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press. A collection of articles highlighting contributions of women anthropologists

———. 2005 [1974]. Ruth Benedict, A Humanist in Anthropology, 30th Anniversary Edition. New York: Columbia University Press.

working in the American Southwest.

A reissue of the biography of Benedict by

Patterson, Thomas. 2001. A Social History of Anthropology in the United States. Oxford: Berg Publishers.

her long-time friend and colleague.

A history of American anthropology in the context of wider currents in American

Modell, Judith Schachter. 1983. Ruth Benedict: Patterns of a Life. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press. A biography of Benedict that explores her personal interest in cultural patterns.

society, including colonialism and territorial expansionism.

Price, David H. 2001. “‘The Shameful Business’: Leslie Spier on the Censure of Franz Boas.” History of Anthropology Newsletter 27.2: 9–12. Price reflects on the 1919 censure of Franz

Murphy, Robert Francis. 1972. Robert H. Lowie. New York: Columbia University Press.

Boas by the American Anthropological

A biography of Lowie by an accomplished

Redman, Samuel J. 2016. Bone Rooms: From Scientific Racism to Human Prehistory in Museums. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

American anthropologist.

Murra, John V., ed. 1976. American Anthropology:The Early Years. St. Paul, MN: West.

Association.

A biological anthropologist tells the story of why museums such as the Smithsonian

A collection of articles about pioneering

Institution began collecting human

American anthropologists.

remains and how these same museums have grappled with repatriating them to

Orans, Martin. 1996. Not Even Wrong: Margaret Mead, Derek Freeman, and the Samoans. Ed. L.L. Langness and Robert B. Edgerton. Novato, CA: Chandler and Sharp.

ancestral groups.

A contribution to the anthropological

the public.

Rice, Edward. 1979. Margaret Mead: A Portrait. New York: Harper and Row. A biography of Mead written to appeal to

debate about Mead’s ethnographic work in Samoa.

Parezo, Nancy J., ed. 1993. Hidden Scholars: Women Anthropologists and the Native

Rigdon, Susan M. 1988. The Culture Facade: Art, Science, and Politics in the Work of Oscar Lewis. Champaign: University of Illinois Press.

319

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A biography of a twentieth-century

A biography of a Boasian-era

anthropologist who studied the culture of

anthropologist who studied African-

poverty.

American culture.

Sapir, Edward. 1958. Culture, Language, and Personality: Selected Essays. Ed. David Mandelbaum. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Spindler, George Dearborn, ed. 1978. The Making of Psychological Anthropology. Berkeley: University of California Press.

A collection of essays on the relationships

psychological anthropology.

Assessments of the foundations of

among language, culture, and personality by the leading anthropological linguist of the Boasian era.

Seymour, Susan C. 2015. Cora Du Bois: Anthropologist, Diplomat, Agent. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

Spiro, Jonathan Peter. 2009. Defending the Master Race: Conservation, Eugenics, and the Legacy of Madison Grant. Burlington: University of Vermont Press. A history of scientific racism, mainly in the United States and focusing on the Nordics.

A biography of the groundbreaking

the American Office of Strategic Services

Starn, Orin. 2004. Ishi’s Brain: In Search of America’s Last “Wild” Indian. New York: Norton.

during World War II, and later came under

The saga of losing and then finding the

investigation by the FBI for her opposition

brain of the famous California Indian

to the Vietnam War.

befriended by Alfred Louis Kroeber.

Shankman, Paul. 2009. The Trashing of Margaret Mead: Anatomy of an Anthropological Controversy. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Steward, Julian Haines. 1973. Alfred Kroeber. New York: Columbia University Press,

An update of the longstanding controversy

cultural ecologist and evolutionist.

Boasian anthropologist who helped found psychodynamic anthropology, worked for

A biography of Kroeber by a distinguished

generated by Derek Freeman’s criticism of Mead’s fieldwork in Samoa.

Silverman, Sydel, ed. 2003. Totems and Teachers: Key Figures in the History of Anthropology. Rev. ed. Lanham, MD: Rowman and Littlefield.

Stocking, George W., Jr., ed. 1985. Observers Observed: Essays on Ethnographic Fieldwork. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. A collection of articles about the history of ethnographic fieldwork.

Accounts of the history of anthropology shaped by the relationship between prominent students and teachers.

Simpson, George Eaton. 1973. Melville J. Herskovits. New York: Columbia University Press. 320

———, ed. 1986. Malinowski, Rivers, Benedict and Others: Essays on Culture and Personality. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. A collection of articles exploring themes in psychological anthropology.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

———, ed. 1996. Volksgeist as Method and Ethic: Essays on Boasian Ethnography and the German Anthropological Tradition. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

relationships among American

A collection of essays highlighting Boasian

of anthropology from the eighteenth

Thoresen, Timothy H., ed. 1975. Toward a Science of Man: Essays in the History of Anthropology. Hawthorne, NY: Mouton de Gruyter.

century to the present.

A collection of articles highlighting the

anthropology, evolutionary anthropology, and institutions and national traditions

archaeologists, governments, and Native Americans.

contributions of Boas and his students.

———. 2001. Delimiting Anthropology: Occasional Inquiries and Reflections. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. historian of anthropology, highlighting

Valentine, Lisa Philips, and Regna Darnell, eds. 1999. Theorizing the Americanist Tradition. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.

Boasian anthropology, evolutionary

A collection of “state-of-the-art” appraisals

anthropology, and numerous institutions

of American and Canadian anthropology

and national traditions from the

designed to challenge the notion that the

eighteenth century to the present.

Boasian tradition lacks theory.

Taylor, Walter W., John Fischer, and Evon Z.Vogt, eds. 1973. Culture and Life: Essays in Memory of Clyde Kluckhohn. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.

Whiting, John W., and Irvin I. Child. 1984 [1953]. Child Training and Personality: A Cross-Cultural Study. Westport, CT: Greenwood.

Commemorations of the work of an

and personality.

A collection of essays by the eminent

A landmark cross-cultural study of culture

American anthropologist interested in cross-cultural values.

Textor, Robert T., ed. 2005. Margaret Mead: The World Ahead: An Anthropologist Anticipates the Future. New York: Berghahn Books. A collection of Mead’s writing on

Williams,Vernon J., Jr. 1996. Rethinking Race: Franz Boas and His Contemporaries. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky. Assessments of the efforts of Boas and his contemporaries to overcome an anthropological legacy of racism.

the future of humanity as shaped by purposeful human action.

Thomas, David Hurst. 2000. Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, and the Battle for Native American Identity. New York: Basic Books.

Winters, Christopher, ed. 1991. International Dictionary of Anthropologists. New York: Garland. A sourcebook of information on American and other national anthropologists of the modern era,

Inspired by the 1996 discovery

including backgrounds and professional

of “Kennewick Man,” a history of

accomplishments.

321

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Young,Virginia Heyer. 2005. Ruth Benedict: Beyond Relativity, Beyond Pattern. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

ethnographic work among the Nuer and

One of Benedict’s graduate students tells

individuals, but also how individuals shape

Ellen, Roy, et al., eds. 1989. Malinowski Between Two Worlds:The Polish Roots of an Anthropological Tradition. New York: Cambridge University Press.

cultures.

Investigations of the Polish background of

how, toward the end of her life, Benedict was exploring not only how cultures shape

Azande of eastern Africa.

Bronislaw Malinowski.

Zumwalt, Rosemary Lévy. 2019. Franz Boas:The Emergence of the Anthropologist. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press. tracing Boas’s entry into anthropology,

Evans, T.M.S., and Don Handelman, eds. 2006. The Manchester School: Practice and Ethnographic Praxis in Anthropology. New York: Berghan Books.

beginning with his birth in Germany in 1858

The theory and history of the extended

and ending with his leaving the American

case study method of ethnographic

Museum of Natural History in 2006,

fieldwork pioneered by Max Gluckman

including his pivotal field trip to Baffin Island

and his associates.

A personal and professional biography

and early years at Columbia University.

British Social Anthropology

Barker, Pat. 1991. Regeneration. New York: Viking.

Evans-Pritchard, E.E. 1940. The Nuer: A Description of the Modes of Livelihood and Political Institutions of a Nilotic People. Oxford: Clarendon Press. An influential structural-functional text

An acclaimed novel about World War I,

combining the study of empirical social

situated at the soldier rehabilitation

relations with a concern to understand the

facility Craiglockhart and exploring the

cultural logic informing social life among

relationships among anthropologist and

the Nuer of southern Sudan.

psychiatrist Wiliam H.R. Rivers and some of his patients.

DeWalt, Kathleen M., and Billie R. DeWalt. 2002. Participant Observation: A Guide for Fieldworkers. Walnut Creek, CA: AltaMira Press. A how-to book about the fieldwork

———. 1976 [1937]. Witchcraft, Oracles, and Magic among the Azande. Oxford: Clarendon Press. In this seminal ethnography, EvansPritchard infuses structural-functional analysis with a concern for the meaning and logic of non-Western beliefs and practices.

technique generally regarded as

Douglas, Mary. 1980. Edward EvansPritchard. New York:Viking Press.

Firth, Raymond, ed. 1964 [1957]. Man and Culture: An Evaluation of the Work of Bronislaw Malinowski. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul Limited.

A biography of the distinguished British

Eminent British social anthropologists

social anthropologist known for his

reflect on Malinowski’s life and times.

pioneered by Bronislaw Malinowski.

322

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Gellner, Ernst. 1998. Language and Solitude:Wittgenstein, Malinowski, and the Habsburg Dilemma. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

An examination of the relationship

A comparison of two seemingly different

Herle, Anita, and Sandra Rouse, eds. 1998. Cambridge and the Torres Strait: Centenary Essays on the 1898 Anthropological Expedition. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

thinkers who shared assumptions derived from common childhood experiences in the Habsburg Empire.

between social and linguistic anthropology in Britain.

Gluckman, Max. 1955. Custom and Conflict in Africa. Glencoe, IL: Free Press.

A collection of illustrated assessments of

In one of his most influential texts,

Torres Strait that helped shape twentieth-

Gluckman examines the political and

century British social anthropology at

contested nature of social structures

Cambridge University.

the multidisciplinary expedition to the

and the rituals in which these are

———. 1963. Order and Rebellion in Tribal Africa. New York: Free Press.

Hiatt, L.R. 1996. Arguments about Aborigines: Australia and the Evolution of Social Anthropology. New York: Cambridge University Press.

An examination of the influence of cultural

An introduction to the anthropology of

norms on the decisions taken by tribal

Australian Aborigines that examines their role

courts in Africa.

as exemplars of early humanity in the work

expressed.

of influential social theorists such as Émile

Goody, Jack. 1995. The Expansive Moment: The Rise of Social Anthropology in Britain and Africa, 1918–1970. New York: Cambridge University Press.

Durkheim, Sigmund Freud, and E.B. Tylor.

A history of British social anthropology,

Hugh-Jones, Stephen, and James Laidlaw, eds. 2001. The Essential Edmund Leach. 2 vols. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

highlighting its African connection.

A selection of numerous writings by Leach, in the first volume on anthropology

Handler, Richard, ed. 2004. Significant Others: Interpersonal and Professional Commitments in Anthropology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

and society, and in the second volume on culture and human nature.

with spouses, partners, friends, and

Kuklik, Henrika. 1992. The Savage Within: The Social History of British Anthropology, 1885–1945. New York: Cambridge University Press.

informants.

A contextual history of British social

A collection of articles about anthropologists and their relationships

anthropology in its heyday.

Henson, Hilary. 1974. British Social Anthropologists and Language: A History of Separate Development. Oxford: Clarendon Press.

Kuper, Adam. 1983. Anthropology and Anthropologists:The Modern British School. Rev. ed. New York: Routledge. 323

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS An informative history of British social anthropology.

———. 1989 [1967]. A Diary in the Strict Sense of the Term. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.

———. 1999. Among the Anthropologists: History and Context in Anthropology. London: Athlone Press.

Malinowski’s personally revealing diary of

An analysis of some of the central

Marcus, Julie, ed. 1993. First in Their Field: Women and Australian Anthropology. Concord, MA: Paul and Company Publishers Consortium.

theoretical arguments in anthropology by an anthropologist especially interested in British social anthropology.

his fieldwork experiences.

Assessments of the importance of female

Langham, Ian G. 1981. The Building of British Social Anthropology. Norwell, MA: Kluwer Academic Publishers. A history of the foundations of British social anthropology.

Australian anthropologists.

Quiggin, A. Hingston. 1942. Haddon the Head Hunter: A Short Sketch of the Life of A.C. Haddon. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Larsen, Timothy. 2014. The Slain God: Anthropologists and the Christian Faith. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

A biography of the life and times of a

Countering the stereotype that

member of the Cambridge expedition to

anthropologists are non- or anti-

the Torres Straits.

prominent member of the Cambridge University school of anthropology and

Christian, an investigation of prominent anthropologists, including E. E. EvansPritchard, who in one way or another avowed Christianity.

Radcliffe-Brown, A.R. 1964 [1922]. The Andaman Islanders. New York: Free Press. Radcliffe-Brown’s highly regarded

Leach, Jerry W., and Edmund Leach, eds. 1983. The Kula: New Perspectives on Massim Exchange. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

ethnography using a structuralfunctionalist framework.

anthropological understanding of

———. 1965 [1952]. Structure and Function in Primitive Society. New York: Free Press.

the Trobriand Islands kula exchange

Radcliffe-Brown’s exposition of

network famously analyzed by Bronislaw

structuralism and functionalism.

Twenty-two articles update

Malinowski.

Malinowski, Bronislaw. 1984 [1922]. Argonauts of the Western Pacific. Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland Press.

Sanjek, Roger, ed. 1990. Fieldnotes:The Making of Anthropology. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. Accounts of past and present

Malinowski’s critically acclaimed

issues in fieldwork treated as the

ethnography of the Trobriand

core of anthropological

Islanders.

research.

324

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Schumaker, Lyn. 2001. Africanizing Anthropology: Fieldwork, Networks, and the Making of Cultural Knowledge in Central Africa. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

An assessment of Malinowski’s contributions to the anthropological study of myth.

An account of ethnographic fieldwork

Tambiah, Stanley. 2002. Edmund Leach: An Anthropological Life. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

sponsored by the Rhodes-Livingston

A biography of the distinguished British

Institute in Northern Rhodesia

anthropologist who both advanced

(Zambia), which became a cornerstone

structural-functionalist theory and

of the Manchester School of social

introduced anglophone readers to Claude

anthropology.

Lévi-Strauss and French structuralism.

Slobodin, Richard. 1978. W.H.R. Rivers. New York: Columbia University Press. A biography of the British anthropologist

Urry, James. 1993. Before Social Anthropology: Essays on the History of British Anthropology. Newark, NJ: Gordon and Breach.

who pioneered the genealogical method

A collection of essays on early modern

of fieldwork.

British anthropology.

Stocking, George W., Jr. 1992. The Ethnographer’s Magic and Other Essays in the History of Anthropology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Vermeulen, Han, and Artura A. Roldan, eds. 1995. Fieldwork and Footnotes: Studies in the History of European Anthropology. New York: Routledge.

A collection of essays about fieldwork and

A collection of articles about the history of

related anthropological topics.

anthropological traditions in Europe.

———. 1995. After Tylor: British Social Anthropology, 1888–1951. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Young, Michael. 2004. Malinowski: Odyssey of an Anthropologist, 1884–1920. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

An authoritative history of British social

A biography of Malinowski’s early years,

anthropology in the first half of the

including his famous fieldwork in the

twentieth century.

Trobriand Islands.

———, ed. 1984. Functionalism Historicized: Essays on British Social Anthropology. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Part Three: The Later Twentieth Century

A collection of essays on British social

French Structural Anthropology

anthropology highlighting functionalism.

Strenski, Ivan. 1992. Malinowski and the Work of Myth. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

Angermuller, Johannes. 2015. Why There Is No Poststructuralism in France:The Making of an Intellectual Generation. London: Bloomsbury. 325

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS An argument that while poststructuralism is widely understood to have

Trans. Nora Scott. London:Verso Books.

originated in France in reaction to the

An authoritative intellectual biography

structuralism of Claude Lévi-Strauss, post-

of Lévi-Strauss written by a distinguished

structural French intellectuals themselves

former student and proponent of

did not adopt that label, because their

structural Marxism.

views were too divergent.

Bertholet, Denis. 2003. Claude Lévi-Strauss. Paris: Plon.

Graeber, David, and Marshall Sahlins. 2017. On Kings. Chicago: Hau Press. Two distinguished anthropologists team

A biographical account of the life and

up to give an ethnographically rich,

contributions of the architect of French

sophisticated, and witty account of how

structural anthropology.

kingship has come to be.

Boon, James A. 1972. From Symbolism to Structuralism: Lévi-Strauss in a Literary Tradition. New York: Harper and Row.

Henaff, Marcel. 1991. Claude Lévi-Strauss. Paris: Belfond. The life and work of Lévi-Strauss.

An analysis of Lévi-Strauss as a literary figure.

Champagne, Roland. 1987. Claude LéviStrauss. Old Tappan, NJ: Scribner’s Reference. A biographical study of Lévi-Strauss.

———. 1998. Claude Lévi-Strauss and the Making of Structural Anthropology. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press. An explication of Lévi-Strauss’s structuralism, with emphasis on kinship systems, classification systems, and

Douglas, Mary. 1966. Purity and Danger: An Analysis of Concepts of Pollution and Taboo. New York: Praeger.

mythology.

the meaning and structuring of social

Jenkins, Alan. 1979. The Social Theory of Claude Lévi-Strauss. London: Macmillan.

boundaries.

An account of key theoretical elements of

Douglas’s groundbreaking study of

French structural anthropology.

Fardon, Richard. 1999. Mary Douglas: An Intellectual Biography. London: Routledge. An examination of five decades of

Johnson, Christopher. 2003. Claude LéviStrauss:The Formative Years. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

writing by the eminent British social

Another biography of Lévi-Strauss, this

anthropologist and Africanist whose work

one concentrating on his youth and early

was informed by French structuralist

adulthood.

theory.

Godelier, Maurice. 2018. Claude LéviStrauss: A Critical Study of His Thought. 326

Leach, Edmund R. 1989 [1970]. Claude Lévi-Strauss. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS An assessment of the work of Lévi-

miscommunication and antagonism

Strauss by a distinguished British social

between Indigenous peoples and explorers.

anthropologist.

———. 1976. Culture and Communication: The Logic by which Symbols Are Connected. New York: Cambridge University Press. In this concise text, Leach introduces

Pace, David. 1978. “Structuralism in History and the Social Sciences.” American Quarterly 30.3: 282–97. A comprehensive discussion of LéviStrauss’s work and influence on various disciplines through the late 1970s.

French structuralism to an anglophone readership.

Lévi-Strauss, Claude. 1969. Elementary Structures of Kinship. Ed. James Harlebell et al. Boston: Beacon Press. Lévi-Strauss’s seminal structural analysis of kinship.

———. 1974 [1963]. Structural Anthropology. New York: Basic Books. Lévi-Strauss’s exposition of structuralism.

Robbins, Joel. 2005. “Introduction: Humiliation and Transformation: Marshall Sahlins and the Study of Cultural Change in Melanesia.” In Joel Robbins and Holly Wardlow (eds.), The Making of Global and Local Modernities in Melanesia: Humiliation,Transformation, and the Nature of Cultural Change, pp. 3–21. London: Ashgate. An examination and critique of Sahlins’s perspective that “humiliation” (as a psycho-social fact) serves as a linchpin

———. 1987 [1950]. Introduction to the Work of Marcel Mauss. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul.

in questions of cultural continuity and

Lévi-Strauss explains the significance

postcolonial theory.

discontinuity in Melanesia, as well as a bridge to contemporary work in

of the man to whom he is theoretically indebted.

———. 1992 [1955]. Tristes Tropiques. Trans. John Weightman and Doreen Weightman. New York: Penguin Books. Lévi-Strauss’s autobiographically based reflections on fieldwork and theory.

Rossi, Ino, ed. 1974. The Unconscious in Culture:The Structuralism of Claude LéviStrauss in Perspective. New York: Dutton. Expositions of Lévi-Strauss’s structuralism.

Sahlins, Marshall. 1985. Islands of History. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Sahlins promulgates his view that

Obeyesekere, Gananath. 1992.The Apotheosis of Captain Cook: European Mythmaking in the Pacific. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

“structure” is the historically objectified relations of cultural order.

structural analysis of the Hawaiian

———. 1995. How “Natives”Think: About Captain Cook, for Example. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

colonial encounter, offering an alternative

Sahlins’s book-length rejoinder to

explanation for Cook’s death based on

Gananath Obeyesekere’s criticisms

Obeyesekere challenges Marshall Sahlins’s

327

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS contained in The Apotheosis of Captain Cook.

Sériot, Patrick. 2014. Structure and the Whole: East, West, and NonDarwinian Biology in the Origins of Structural Linguistics, Trans. Amy Jacobs-Colas. Boston, MA: De Gruyter Mouton.

D’Andrade, Roy. 1995. The Development of Cognitive Anthropology. New York: Cambridge University Press. An exposition of cognitive anthropology in historical perspective.

A history of semiotics focusing on the

Gumperz, John J., and Stephen C. Levinson, eds. 1996. Rethinking Linguistic Relativity. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Prague School of structural linguistics,

A variety of authors question linguistic

from which Claude Lévi-Strauss drew

relativity, the basis of the Sapir-Whorf

inspiration.

hypothesis.

Stocking, George W., Jr., ed. 1996. Romantic Motives: Essays on Anthropological Sensibility. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.

Hall, Robert A. 1987. Leonard Bloomfield: Essays on His Life and Work. Philadelphia: John Benjamins.

Accounts of anthropological styles, some

century linguist who pioneered phonemic

in French.

Wickens, Patrick. 2010. Claude LéviStrauss:The Poet in the Laboratory. New York: Penguin Press. An interpretation of Lévi-Strauss as an artist who changed the face of scientific anthropology.

Wiseman, Boris, ed. 2009. The Cambridge Companion to Lévi-Strauss. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Several analyses of the significance of Lévi-Strauss to a variety of academic and artistic disciplines.

Cognitive Anthropology

Aarsleff, Hans. 1982. From Locke to Saussure: Essays on the Study of Language and Intellectual History. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.

Evaluations of the work of a twentiethanalysis.

Hymes, Dell. 1983. Essays in the History of Linguistic Anthropology. Philadelphia: John Benjamins. A distinguished anthropological linguist writes about the history of his subject.

———, ed. 1974. Studies in the History of Linguistics: Traditions and Paradigms. Ann Arbor, MI: Books on Demand. A major collection of articles about themes in the history of linguistics.

Joseph, John. 2002. From Whitney to Chomsky: Essays in the History of American Linguistics. Philadelphia: John Benjamins. A varied collection of essays on theorists

A history of linguistics beginning in the

and theories in American linguistics in

late seventeenth century.

historical perspective.

328

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Pike, Eunice. 1981. Ken Pike: Scholar and Christian. Dallas, TX: Summer Institute of Linguistics, Academic Publications.

An updated approach to ethnolinguistics examining expressed relations among language, culture, and identity in Czech, English, French, and German traditions.

A biographical account of the linguist who helped formulate the distinction between emics and etics.

Pike, Kenneth. 1943. Phonetics, a Critical Analysis of Phonetic Theory and a Technique for the Practical Description of Sounds. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. An early exposition of Pike’s thinking behind what in linguistics and anthropology has come to be called the emic−etic distinction.

Sebeok, Thomas Albert, ed. 1966. Portraits of Linguists: A Biographical Source Book for the History of Western Linguistics, 1746–1963. Bloomington: Indiana University Press. A valuable source of information about linguists of the last two centuries.

Shore, Brad. 1996. Culture in Mind: Cognition, Culture, and the Problem of Meaning. Oxford: Oxford University Press. A historically oriented attempt to bridge the gap between anthropology and psychology with a theory of the mind.

Cultural Neo-Evolutionism

Balter, Michael. 2009. The Goddess and the Bull: Çatalahöyük: An Archaeological Journey to the Dawn of Civilization. London: Routledge. Science writer Balter’s account of the history of excavations at an ancient site in Turkey, recounting differing approaches by processual and post-processual archaeologists.

Binford, Lewis R. 1983. In Pursuit of the Past. London: Thames and Hudson. An exposition of the New Archaeology by the leading New Archaeologist.

Bohannan, Paul, and Mark Glazer, eds. 1989. High Points in Anthropology. 2nd ed. New York: McGraw-Hill. A collection of writings by influential anthropologists of the nineteenth and twentieth centuries.

Carneiro, Robert L. 2003. Evolutionism in Cultural Anthropology: A Critical History. Boulder, CO: Westview Press. A prominent follower of cultural

Tyler, Stephen. 1969. Cognitive Anthropology. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and Winston. A book about cognitive anthropology, written in its heyday.

Underhill, James W. 2012. Ethnolinguistics and Cultural Concepts:Truth, Love, Hate and War. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

evolutionism recounts its broad history.

Clemmer, Richard O., Daniel Myers, and Mary Elizabeth Rudden, eds. 1999. Julian Steward and the Great Basin:The Making of an Anthropologist. Salt Lake City: University of Utah Press. A critical assessment of Steward’s influence on American anthropology linking his career to changes in

329

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS anthropological theories, including cultural ecology.

Fried, Morton H. 1967. The Evolution of Political Society: An Evolutionary View. New York: McGraw-Hill.

Patterson, Thomas C. 1994. Toward a Social History of Archaeology in the United States. Ed. Jeffrey Quilter. Orlando, FL: Harcourt Brace College Publishers. A history of American archaeology in social contexts.

Variation in political organization explained in evolutionary terms.

Green, Sally. 1981. Prehistorian: A Biography of V. Gordon Childe. Bradford-on-Avon, UK: The Moonraker Press. A biography of the maverick “Marxist”

Peace, William J. 2004. Leslie A.White: Evolution and Revolution in Anthropology. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press. An intellectual and political biography of one of the key theorists of cultural neo-evolutionism.

archaeologist who described Neolithic and

Harris, David R., ed. 1994. The Archaeology of V. Gordon Childe. Concord, MA: Paul and Company Publishers Consortium.

Pinsky,Valerie, and Alison Wylie, eds. 1995. Critical Traditions in Contemporary Archaeology: Essays in the Philosophy, History and Socio-Politics of Archaeology. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.

A collection of articles evaluating Childe’s

Critical archaeological perspectives.

urban “revolutions.”

contributions to archaeology.

Kerns,Virginia. 2003. Scenes from the High Desert: Julian Steward’s Life and Theory. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.

Reyman, Jonathan E., ed. 1992. Rediscovering Our Past: Essays on the History of American Archaeology. Avebury, UK: Aldershot. A collection of articles representing

An intellectual and personal biography of

new views on the history of American

the eminent cultural neo-evolutionist and

archaeology.

ecologist.

Manners, Robert Alan, ed. 1964. Process and Pattern in Culture: Essays in Honor of Julian Steward. Chicago: Aldine Publishing Company.

Sabloff, Paula L.W. 1998. Conversations with Lew Binford: Drafting the New Archaeology. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press. A series of interviews with Binford

Examinations of Julian Steward’s role in

recounting in personal terms the origins of

the development of cultural ecology and

the New Archaeology in the 1960s.

evolution.

McNairn, Barbara. 1980. The Method and Theory of V. Gordon Childe. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University Press. An intellectual biography of Childe.

330

Sahlins, Marshall D., and Elman R. Service, eds. 1960. Evolution and Culture. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. Sahlins and Service reconcile the evolutionary theories of Julian Steward and Leslie White.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Service, Elman R. 1962. Primitive Social Organization: An Evolutionary Perspective. New York: Random House.

White’s explanation of cultural evolution in terms of thermodynamics and the principles of culturology.

Variation in social organization explained in evolutionary terms.

———. 2008. Modern Capitalist Culture. Walnut Creek, CA: Left Coast Press.

———. 1985. A Century of Controversy. Orlando, FL: Academic Press.

An abridged version of White’s little-

A history of ethnology written by the

evolution of capitalism from early times.

known unfinished manuscript on the

prominent cultural neo-evolutionist.

Steward, Julian. 1972 [1955]. Theory of Culture Change:The Methodology of Multilinear Evolution. Champaign: University of Illinois Press. Steward’s explanation of cultural evolution

Cultural Materialism

Harris, Marvin. 1979. Cultural Materialism: The Struggle for a Science of Culture. New York: Random House. Harris’s cultural materialist manifesto.

contrasted with the explanations of Leslie White and others.

Trigger, Bruce G. 1980. Gordon Childe: Revolutions in Archaeology. New York: Columbia University Press. A biography of Childe by a respected

———. 1990 [1974]. Cows, Pigs,Wars, and Witches:The Riddles of Culture. New York: Random House. One of several popular books written by Harris to demonstrate the explanatory power of cultural materialism.

historian of archaeology.

Wax, Dustin M., ed. 2008. Anthropology at the Dawn of the Cold War: The Influence of Foundations, McCarthyism, and the CIA. Ann Arbor, MI: Pluto Press. Reflections on the circumstances of

———. 1998. Theories of Culture in Postmodern Times. Walnut Creek, CA: AltaMira Press. A restatement of the tenets of cultural materialism in the anthropological environment three decades after The Rise of Anthropological Theory (1968).

various institutions and people in the period 1946–64.

White, Leslie A. 1949. The Science of Culture. New York: Grove Press.

Harris, Marvin, and Marshall Sahlins. 1979. “‘Cannibals and Kings’: An Exchange.” New York Review of Books 26.11. Harris and Sahlins defend their opposing

A collection of seminal essays on

explanations of Aztec cannibalism,

culturology.

prompted by Sahlins’s critical review of Harris’s book Cannibals and Kings.

———. 1959. The Evolution of Culture: The Development of Civilization to the Fall of Rome. New York: McGraw-Hill.

Koznar, Lawrence A., and Stephen K. Sanderson, eds. 2007. Studying Societies and Cultures: Marvin Harris’s Cultural 331

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Materialism and Its Legacy. Boulder, CO: Paradigm Publishers. A collection of appraisals and examples of

A prominent evolutionary psychologist sets forth the principles and applications of his science.

cultural materialism in anthropology.

Murphy, Martin F., and Maxine L. Margolis, eds. 1995. Science, Materialism, and the Study of Culture. Gainesville: University Press of Florida. Several essays by anthropologists

Cravens, Hamilton. 1988. The Triumph of Evolution:The Heredity-Environment Controversy, 1900–1941. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press. Historical background for exploring “nature versus nurture” in anthropology.

committed to understanding culture from a materialist point of view.

Nature versus Nurture

Dawkins, Richard. 1989 [1976]. The Selfish Gene. 2nd ed. New York: Oxford University Press. Dawkins’s “ultra-Darwinist” exposition of

Ardrey, Robert. 1961. African Genesis: A Personal Investigation into the Animal Origins and Nature of Man. New York: Atheneum.

evolution and contribution to sociobiology.

Ardrey’s “popular” views on human

In this best-seller, the well-known atheist

evolution and the “innateness” of human

defends atheism rationally.

———. 2006. The God Delusion. Boston: Houghton Mifflin Harcourt.

aggression.

Barkow, Jerome H., ed. 2006. Missing the Revolution: Darwinism for Social Scientists. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

———. 2009. The Greatest Show on Earth: The Evidence for Evolution. New York: Free Press. In sprawling and captivating detail, the famous defender of evolution shows

In postmodern times, several authors

why the evidence for evolution is so

make a pitch for social scientists to

compelling.

reconsider a Darwinian approach.

Barkow, Jerome H., Leda Comides, and John Tooby, eds. 1991. The Adapted Mind: Evolutionary Psychology and the Generation of Culture. New York: Oxford University Press.

Dunn, Leslie C. 1991. A Short History of Genetics: The Development of Some of the Main Lines of Thought, 1864– 1939. Ames: Iowa State University Press. A history of genetics and genetics issues.

A foundational text of the discipline of evolutionary psychology, setting forth its origins, aspirations, and key tenets.

Buss, David. 2001. Evolutionary Psychology: The New Science of the Mind. 4th ed. New York: Pearson. 332

Ekman, Paul. 2007. Emotions Revealed: Recognizing Faces and Feelings to Improve Communication and Emotional Life. 2nd. ed. New York: Holt Paperbacks. A popular psychologist loosely applies evolutionary biology to explain the form

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS and function of facial expression across cultures.

Class Structure in American Life. New York: Free Press. A controversial study purporting to

Fox, Evelyn Keller. 2010. The Mirage of a Space between Nature and Nurture. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

demonstrate that in the United States the

A historian of science offers an

hereditary differences.

distribution of social class is significantly an expression of the distribution of

explanation of how nature and nurture came to be separated conceptually and offers an alternative conceptualization that removes “versus” f rom the debate.

Hrdy, Sarah Blaffer. 1977. The Langurs of Abu: Female and Male Strategies of Reproduction. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. An early study applying sociobiology to

Fox, Robin. 2011. The Tribal Imagination: Civilization and the Savage Mind. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

primatology, arguing that infanticide among the langur monkeys of India promotes the reproductive success of high-ranking males.

The latter-day views of an American anthropologist who has spent decades writing about the evolutionary underpinnings of present-day human behavior.

Kevles, Daniel J. 1995 [1985]. In the Name of Eugenics: Genetics and the Uses of Human Heredity. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. A history of genetics, eugenics, and related

Goldhaber, Dale. 2012. The Nature-Nurture Debates: Bridging the Gap. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

scientific and social issues.

addressed and resolved by the holistic

Kuhl, Stefan. 1994. The Nazi Connection: Eugenics, American Racism, and German National Socialism. New York: Oxford University Press.

perspectives of evolutionary psychology

An examination of the scientific and social

and developmental systems theory.

underpinnings of German National Socialism.

Grafen, Alan, and Mark Ridley, eds. 2007. Richard Dawkins: How A Scientist Changed the Way We Think. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

Larson, Edward J. 1996. Sex, Race, and Science: Eugenics in the Deep South. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Twenty essayists evaluate the impact

An examination of eugenics in the

of the famous evolutionary biologist,

American South.

An argument that the nature−nurture debate can only be satisfactorily

rationalist, and atheist from social, scientific, and literary perspectives.

Herrnstein, Richard, and Charles Murray. 1994. The Bell Curve: Intelligence and

Leakey, L.S.B. 1966. White African: An Early Autobiography. Cambridge, MA: Schenkman. Louis Leakey’s early life in Africa.

333

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Leakey, Mary. 1984. Disclosing the Past: An Autobiography. New York: Doubleday.

McLaren, Angus. 1990. Our Own Master Race: Eugenics in Canada, 1885–1945. Toronto: McClelland and Stewart.

Mary Leakey’s account of her life with and

A history of Canadian eugenics in the late

without Louis.

nineteenth and early twentieth centuries.

Leakey, Richard E. 1984. One Life: An Autobiography. Salem, NH: Salem House. Richard Leakey’s account of his life written

Morrell,Virginia. 1995. Ancestral Passions: The Leakey Family and the Quest for Humankind’s Beginnings. New York: Simon and Schuster.

while he was critically ill.

Biographies of Louis, Mary, and Richard Leakey.

Maasen, Sabine. 1995. Biology as Society, Society as Biology: Metaphors. Ed. Everett Mendelsohn et al. Norwell, MA: Kluwer Academic Publishers. An examination of the interplay among biological and sociological conceptualizations.

Marks, Jonathan. 2002. What It Means to Be 98% Chimpanzee: Apes, People, and Their Genes. Berkeley: University of California Press. A provocative anthropological critique of biological assertions and activities.

———. 2009. Why I Am Not a Scientist: Anthropology and Modern Knowledge. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Morris, Desmond. 1980. The Naked Ape. New York: Dell. The book that spawned the phrase “naked apery.”

Neel, James V. 1994. Physician to the Gene Pool: Genetic Lessons and Other Stories. New York: John Wiley and Sons. The autobiography of a leading human geneticist.

Nisbet, Alec. 1977. Konrad Lorenz. New York: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich. A biography of the pioneering European ethologist.

Marks explores the roles of fact and

Panofsky, A. 2014. Misbehaving Science: Controversy and the Development of Behavior Genetics. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

authority in the creation of scientific

A sociologist writes about the political and

knowledge, including in biological

ideological underpinnings of behavioral

anthropology.

genetics, underscoring its shortcomings

———. 2017. Is Science Racist? (Debating Race). Malden, MA: Polity.

and linking it to eugenics.

anthropology, expanding themes explored

Poliakov, Leon. 1974. The Aryan Myth: A History of Racist and Nationalist Ideas in Europe. Trans. Edmund Howard. London: Chatto and Windus.

in his earlier publications.

A critical history of Aryanism.

Marks probes and exposes how racism can be embedded in science, including

334

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Provine, William B. 1987. The Origins of Theoretical Population Genetics. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

An analysis of the troubled relationship between anthropological science and politics in the era of the Holocaust.

For the mathematically inclined, a history of the early phase of population genetics.

Ruse, Michael. 1984. Sociobiology: Sense or Nonsense? Rev. ed. Norwell, MA: Kluwer Academic Publishers. A critique of sociobiology by a well-known

Shipman, Pat. 1994. Evolution of Racism: The Human Difference and the Use and Abuse of Science. New York: Simon and Schuster. A scientific critique of racism by a respected physical anthropologist.

philosopher of science.

Rushton, J. Philippe. 1995. Race, Evolution, and Behavior: A Life History Perspective. Piscataway, NJ: Transaction Books.

Spencer, Frank. 1990. Piltdown: A Scientific Forgery. New York: Oxford University Press. The story of a famous whodunit.

Rushton’s controversial ranking of human

and anatomical variables, a ranking

———, ed. 1982. A History of American Physical Anthropology, 1930–1980. New York: Academic Press.

labeled scientifically racist.

Histories of American physical

races based on their standings on scales of measurement of numerous behavioral

anthropology in the mid-twentieth

Rutter, Michael. 2006. Genes and Behavior: Nature-Nurture Interplay Explained. Walden, MA: Blackwell Publishing.

century.

A child psychologist and psychiatrist

Thorpe, W.H. 1979. The Origins and Rise of Ethology. Westport, CT: Greenwood.

employs non-technical language to sort

A history of ethological approaches to the

out the major issues and their implications

study of animal and human behavior.

for public policy and discourse.

Sahlins, Marshall. 1976. The Use and Abuse of Biology: An Anthropological Critique of Sociobiology. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.

Tiger, Lionel, and Michael McGuire. 2010. God’s Brain. Blue Ridge Summit, PA: Prometheus Books. Two evolutionarily oriented investigators set forth their views on the neurological

An early negative critique of the

basis of religion, the evolved function of

sociobiological perspective in

religion, and the impact of religion on the

anthropology.

brain.

Schafft, Gretchen E. 2004. From Racism to Genocide: Anthropology in the Third Reich. Urbana: University of Illinois Press.

Tucker, William H. 2007. The Funding of Scientific Racism:Wickliffe Draper and the Pioneer Fund. Champaign: University of Illinois Press.

335

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

of trying to demonstrate the innate

Wright, Robert. 1995. The Moral Animal: Why We Are the Way We Are:The New Science of Evolutionary Psychology. New York:Vintage Publishing.

inferiority of African Americans, with

In one of the early popular expressions of

the result that the scientific validity

evolutionary psychology, the author covers

of research supported by the fund is

evolved predispositions as varied as office

suspect.

politics and monogamous sex.

Weikart, Richard. 2004. From Darwin to Hitler: Evolutionary Ethics, Eugenics, and Racism in Germany. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.

The Symbolic Turn

An expose of the fund and its founder, purporting to show how they have pursued a surreptitious political agenda

A history of the interplay of scientific,

Agar, Michael. 1980. “Hermeneutics in Anthropology: A Review Essay.” Ethos 8.3: 253–72.

social, and political themes in the

A review of two key books, one by Stephen

emergence of policies leading to the

R. Tylor and the other by Paul Rabinow

Holocaust.

and William M. Sullivan, published in late 1970s that helped incorporate

Wilson, Edward O. 1975. Sociobiology:The New Synthesis. Cambridge, MA: The Belknap Press of Harvard University. The book that introduced sociobiology to science and society.

hermeneutics into anthropology.

Ashley, Kathleen, ed. 1990. Victor Turner and the Construction of Cultural Criticism: Between Literature and Anthropology. Indianapolis: Indiana University Press.

———. 1994a. Naturalist. Washington, DC: Island Press.

Several authors explore the intersection

An autobiography of the founder of

Turner’s work.

of anthropology and literature through

sociobiology.

———. 1994b. On Human Nature. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Bachmann-Medick, Doris. 2016. Cultural Turns: New Orientations in the Study of Culture. Trans. Adam Blauhut. De Gruyter.

A discussion of the relevance of

A German scholar at the International

sociobiology to Homo sapiens.

Graduate Centre for the Study of Culture sorts through the sometimes bewildering

Wolpoff, Milford, and Rachel Caspari. 1997. Race and Human Evolution: A Fatal Attraction. New York: Simon and Schuster.

number of recent theoretical orientations

An examination of historical relationships

Comaroff, Jean, and John L. Comaroff. 1991. Of Revelation and Revolution, Vol. 1: Christianity, Colonialism, and

among theories of race and human evolution.

336

in the social sciences, including interpretive anthropology.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Consciousness in South Africa. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

system,” and the analysis of a Balinese cockfight.

Part one of an influential “historical

the native Tswana and landscape of South

———. 1996. After the Fact:Two Countries, Four Decades, One Anthropologist. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

Africa, focusing on the eighteenth and

Geertz’s autobiography.

ethnography” and Weberian study of the colonial inscription of European culture on

nineteenth centuries.

———. 1997. Of Revelation and Revolution, Vol. 2:The Dialectics of Modernity on a South African Frontier. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

———. 2008. Available Light: Anthropological Reflection on Philosophical Topics. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. The guru of interpretive anthropology waxes philosophical, including about the public.

Part two of the Comaroffs’ ethnography.

Funari, Pedro Paulo, Andrés Zarankin, and Emily Stove, eds. 2005. Global Archaeological Theory: Contextual Voices and Contemporary Thoughts. Ithaca, NY: Kluwer Academic/Plenum Publishers.

Gerhardt, Uta. 2002. Talcott Parsons: An Intellectual Biography. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. The author weaves Parsons’s key theoretical sociological tenets into an account of their real-world relationship to American democracy.

Archaeologists from across the Americas,

social discourse informed by ethics and

Hodder, Ian. 1986. Reading the Past: Current Approaches to Interpretation in Archaeology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

involvement of the public.

An exposition of post-processual

notably from South America, reflect on older archaeological theories and chart a new course for archaeology as

archaeology by a leading post-

Geertz, Clifford. 1968. Islam Observed: Religious Development in Morocco and Indonesia. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

processualist.

A comparison of the diversity of beliefs

A turn-of-the-century collection of essays

and practices among Muslims in two

surveying the theoretical landscape of

different societies.

archaeology edited by the leading post-

———, ed. 2001. Archaeological Theory Today. Cambridge, UK: Polity Press.

processual archaeologist of the day.

———. 1977 [1973]. The Interpretation of Cultures. New York: Basic Books. “interpretive anthropology,” which

———. 2018. Where Are We Heading?:The Evolution of Humans and Things. New Haven, CT:Yale University Press.

contains Geertz’s influential essays about

The celebrated post-processual

“thick description,” religion as a “cultural

archaeologist reflects on the implication

The classic treatise of American

337

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS for the future of the Earth of the long-

In this work, Turner presents his influential

standing entanglements of humans and

reworking of van Gennep’s thesis

material culture.

concerning ritual transformation.

Schneider, David M. 1980. American Kinship: A Cultural Account. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. A well-known “interpretive” account of

Van Gennep, Arnold. 1961 [1959]. The Rites of Passage. Trans. Monika B. Vizedon and Gabrielle L. Caffee. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

kinship advocating a more “structuralist”

Van Gennep’s original formulation of the

approach to understanding symbols and

“liminal” transition from one social state

looking to the coherence and logic behind

to another, as accomplished in and by

the symbolic “system” first described by

religious ritual.

Clifford Geertz.

St. John, Graham, ed. 2008. Victor Turner and Contemporary Cultural Performance. New York: Berghahn Books.

Wallace, Anthony F. 1966. Religion: An Anthropological View. New York: Random House. Wallace develops his theoretical

On the twenty-fifth anniversary of

perspective on religion, and in

Turner’s death, several of his followers

particular its capacity to effect personal

argue that there is a need for a revival of

psychological “mazeway transformation”

his theories.

and social “revitalization” in response to cultural stress or dissonance.

Thomassen, Bjørn. 2016. Liminality and the Modern: Living Through the In-Between. Abingdon, UK: Routledge.

———. 1972. The Death and Rebirth of the Seneca. New York: Random House.

An update and expansion of application of

Wallace’s classic study of colonization

the concept of liminality first popularized

and social change among the Seneca

by Arnold van Gennep and Victor Turner.

nation of eastern North America, combining Durkheimian and Weberian

Turner,Victor. 1967. The Forest of Symbols: Aspects of Ndembu Ritual. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.

perspectives.

In this prototypical ethnography of the

Worsley, Peter. 1968. The Trumpet Shall Sound. New York: Schocken Books.

symbolic “school,” Turner employs an

In this classic account of “cargo cults” in

instrumental theory of Ndembu symbols

the South Pacific, Worsley writes from a

to show how they are effective in

distinctly Weberian perspective

producing certain ritual transformations, which ultimately result in social cohesion.

———. 1969. The Ritual Process: Structure and Anti-Structure. Hawthorne, NY: Aldine de Gruyter. 338

Transactionalism

Bailey, Frederick George. 1996. The Civility of Indifference: On Domesticating Ethnicity. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS An ethnographic study of a village in

sociologist generally credited with coining

eastern India in which individuals and

the term.

ethnic groups compete with one another for moral and political authority.

Barth, Fredrik. 1959. Political Leadership among Swat Pathans. London: Athlone Press.

Eriksen, Thomas Hylland. 2015. Fredrik Barth: An Intellectual Biography. London: Pluto Press. Hylland pays tribute to the professional accomplishments of fellow Norwegian

An ethnographic classic about the

Barth, with whom the theory of

contested nature of political and

transactionalism is most closely

economic organization in the Swat Valley

associated.

of Pakistan.

———. 1966. Models of Social Organization. Occasional Paper No. 23. London: Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland.

Paine, Robert. 1994. Herds of the Tundra: A Portrait of Saami Reindeer Pastoralism. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press. An ethnographic account of Saami

A brief paper outlining the essential

pastoralism in Norway and the effects of

features of Barth’s theory of

government efforts to control it.

transactionalism.

———, ed. 1969. Ethnic Groups and Boundaries:The Social Organization of Culture Difference. Boston: Little, Brown, and Company.

Anthropology and Feminism

A classic volume of essays on the

Di Leonardo, Micaela. 1991. Gender at the Crossroads of Knowledge: Feminist Anthropology in the Postmodern Era. Berkeley: University of California Press.

processes involved in the construction

A broad range of essays that examine

of ethnic identities and boundaries

the effects of feminist scholarship on the

in which individual social actors are

study of race, biology, language, culture,

shown to maximize their own economic

and economy.

advantage.

An ethnographic study of village culture

Behar, Ruth, and Deborah A. Gordon, eds. 1995. Women Writing Culture. Berkeley: University of California Press.

and social organization in northern Bali.

Taking its name from the successful

———. 1993. Balinese Worlds. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

deconstructionist volume Writing

Blumer, Herbert. 1986 [1937]. Symbolic Interactionism: Perspective and Method. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Culture, this edited collection explores

A systematic exposition of the theory of

Boddy, Janice. 1989. Wombs and Alien Spirits:Women, Men, and the Zâr Cult in

symbolic interactionism written by the

the “poetics” of ethnography as viewed through the lens of feminist theory.

339

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Northern Sudan. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. This feminist ethnography looks at

1982. Feminist Theory: A Critique of Ideology. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

how Islamic ideals of feminine purity

A collection of essays that examine the

conflict with local women’s desire for

relations among feminist theory, science,

empowerment, as manifested in spirit

language, nationality, and other social

possession.

institutions.

Bourdieu, Pierre. 2001. Masculine Domination. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press. masculine domination as a form of

Lamphere, Louise. 2004. “Unofficial Histories: A Vision of Anthropology from the Margins.” American Anthropologist 106.1: 126–39.

symbolic violence endemic in everyday life.

In this historically rich essay, Lamphere

The famous French theorist explains

discusses the different approaches of

Cattell, Maria G., and Marjorie M. Schweitzer, eds. 2006. Women in Anthropology: Autobiographical Narratives and Social History. Walnut Creek, CA: Left Coast Press.

women anthropologists (particularly those who are also women of color) to valorize the f requently unacknowledged contributions of women to anthropology.

Academic anthropologists recount the challenges they faced in establishing themselves professionally.

Lewin, Ellen, ed. 2006. Feminist Anthropology: A Reader. Malden, MA: Blackwell.

Connell, R.W. 2005. Masculinities. Berkeley: University of California Press.

A compendium of classic and

In this key early text in the field of

traces the history of feminist scholarship

masculinity studies, Connell investigates

within anthropology.

contemporary ethnographic essays that

the politics, practices, psychology, and sexualities connected to expressions of masculinity in a variety of contexts.

Geller, Pamela L., and Miranda K. Stockett, eds. 2006. Feminist Anthropology: Past, Present, Future. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press.

McClaurin, Irma, ed. 2001. Black Feminist Anthropology:Theory, Politics, Praxis, and Poetics. Piscataway, NJ: Rutgers University Press. Nine authors explore black perspectives in feminist anthropology at the turn of the century.

An edited collection in which contributors explore the contentious history and current state of feminist anthropology, attempting to break new epistemological ground.

Moore, Henrietta L. 1988. Feminism and Anthropology. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press. A theoretical study of the gendered

Keohane, Nannerl O., Michelle Z. Rosaldo, and Barbara C. Gelpi, eds. 340

character of kinship, domestic life, and the state.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Olson, Gary A., and Elizabeth Hirsch, eds. 1995. Women Writing Culture. Albany: State University of New York Press.

ostensibly promotes, but simultaneously homogenizes, diversity.

and literature as “sites” for the social

———. 1988. The Gender of the Gift: Problems with Women and Problems with Society in Melanesia. Berkeley: University of California Press.

construction of gendered knowledge.

An ethnographic study of the politics of

A collection of interviews with leading feminist scholars who view language

gift exchange and gender relations in

Oyewùmí, Oyèrónké. 1997. The Invention of Women: Making an African Sense of Western Gender Discourses. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.

Melanesia.

Oyewùmí deconstructs the Western

Visweswaran, Kamala. 1997. “Histories of Feminist Ethnography.” Annual Review of Anthropology 26.1: 591–621.

category of “women,” arguing that its

A historical overview of the

underlying biological determinism does

development of feminist anthropology

not feature in the social organization of

f rom the late nineteenth through the

Yoruban society.

end of the twentieth centuries, paying special attention to the changing

Reiter, Rayna R., ed. 1975. Toward an Anthropology of Women. New York: Monthly Review Press.

conceptual relationship between

A key text in feminist anthropology in

Political Economy

which contributors criticize androcentric

“gender” and “sex.”

models that reconceptualize the place of

Ahluwalia, Pal, and Bill Ashcroft. 2008. Edward Said. New York: Routledge.

women across various societies.

A brief, accessible introduction to the

epistemology and look to develop new

theory and politics of Edward Said.

Rosaldo, Michelle Zimbalist, and Louise Lamphere, eds. 1974. Woman, Culture and Society. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.

Asad, Talal, ed. 1973. Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter. Ithaca, NY: Ithaca Press.

A seminal collection of essays that explore

Among the earliest and best-known

the structural contexts and constraints

explorations of anthropology in relation

underpinning gender differences.

to Western colonialism, a book crucial in raising awareness among anthropologists.

Strathern, Marilyn. 1987. “An Awkward Relationship: The Case of Feminism and Anthropology.” Signs 12.2: 276–92.

———. 2007. On Suicide Bombing. New York: Columbia University Press.

A theoretical essay exploring the

The eminent scholar of religious and

boundaries between feminism as a

secular cultural traditions tackles

discrete discipline and anthropology

complexities surrounding this headline

as a Western field of scholarship that

news.

341

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Ashcroft, Bill, Gareth Griffiths, and Helen Tiffin, eds. 1995. The Post-Colonial Studies Reader. London: Routledge.

The author updates the first edition of

A significant interdisciplinary compilation

other evolving theoretical orientations in

of 90 important essays in the field

twenty-first century anthropology.

her landmark introduction by comparing and contrasting postcolonialism with

of postcolonial studies, essays that represent less a “canon” than a crosssection of current debates and foci within the field.

McCarthy, Connor. 2010. The Cambridge Introduction to Edward Said. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. McCarthy explores the relationship

Dhareshwar,Vivek. 1998. “Valorizing the Present: Orientalism, Postcoloniality, and the Human Sciences.” Cultural Dynamics 10.2: 211–31.

between the public and private lives of

A short but theoretically sophisticated to theorizing cultural difference and

Mintz, Sidney W. 1986. Sweetness and Power:The Place of Sugar in Modern History. New York: Penguin Books.

“Otherness” in the postcolonial world,

A fascinating historical study of the

especially in terms of the shortcomings of

powerful effect that sugar and the sugar

Western epistemology.

trade have had in forming new European

analysis of the problems that accrue

one of the most famous recent public intellectuals.

cultural meanings and political and

Dirks, Nicholas B., Geoff Eley, and Sherry B. Ortner, eds. 1993. Culture/Power/ History: A Reader in Contemporary Social Theory. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

economic relationships.

A collection of essays on the recent

An analysis of the development of Said’s

history of anthropology, including one by

understanding of subjectivity before

Ortner that is very useful for situating the

and after the publication of Orientalism,

theoretical developments that led to the

with reference to his reflexive mode of

rise of political economy in the 1970s.

knowledge production and to key Marxist

Pannian, Prasad. 2016. Edward Said and the Question of Subjectivity. London: Palgrave Macmillan.

scholars.

Fine, Ben. 2001. Social Capital versus Social Theory: Political Economy and Social Science at the Turn of the Millennium. London: Routledge. An interesting blend of the theories of

Polanyi, Karl. 1944. The Great Transformation:The Political and Economic Origins of Our Time. Boston: Beacon Press.

political economy and Pierre Bourdieu’s

A landmark analysis of the social

concept of social, or symbolic, capital.

implication of the rise of the market economy, written by a scholar

Ghandi, Leela. 2019. Postcolonial Theory: A Critical Introduction. 2nd ed. New York: Columbia University Press. 342

associated with the substantivist side of the substantivist−formalist debate in anthropology.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Redfield, Robert. 1971 [1956]. Peasant Society and Culture: An Anthropological Approach to Civilization. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

the nineteenth and twentieth centuries

Redfield’s proto-political economy looks at

voices heard.

as tools for expanding and deepening Western empires, and likewise by colonial subjects endeavoring to make their own

the continuum between “folk” and “urban” traditions in Mexico.

Rees, David, ed. 2006. The Ethnographic Moment: Correspondence of Robert Redfield and F.G. Friedman. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction Publishers.

Schneider, Peter, and Jane Schneider. 1986. Culture and Political Economy in Western Sicily. Orlando, FL: Academic Press. The Schneiders explore the way in which rural Italian underdevelopment and alienation of the south from the north

Focusing on the last years of his life,

produced local conditions in which new

correspondence between anthropologist

forms of local economy could flourish, in

Redfield and humanist Friedman

particular the Sicilian Mafia.

illuminating Redfield’s view that the urban−rural continuum is central to understanding peasant life.

Spanos, William V. 2009. The Legacy of Edward W. Said. Champaign: University of Illinois Press.

Roseberry, William. 1989. Anthropologies and Histories: Essays in Culture, History, and Political Economy. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.

A thought-provoking assessment of Said’s

A well-known collection of essays in

such as Michel Foucault, Martin Heidegger,

which Roseberry looks at the relationship

Jacques Derrida, and Jacques Lacan.

contributions to post-structural theory, particularly as his work may be assessed in relation to other theorists of his generation

between capitalism and the historical formation of social and political power, as well as the role power has played in shaping cultural meaning and practice.

Taussig, Michael T. 1980. The Devil and Commodity Fetishism in South America. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press.

Said, Edward W. 1978. Orientalism. New York:Vintage Books.

A widely read ethnography in

Arguably the seminal text in postcolonial

explores how Colombian peasants use

studies, authored by its most celebrated

locally meaningful symbolism and ritual to

exponent.

critique the powerful capitalist economic

anthropological political economy that

system in which they live.

———. 1994. Culture and Imperialism. New York:Vintage Books.

culture and, by extension, what is

Wallerstein, Immanuel. 1974. The Modern World System: Capitalist Agriculture and the Origins of the World Economy in the Sixteenth Century. Orlando, FL: Academic Press.

excluded from it, showing how fiction

Wallerstein’s influential exposition of

and media were used over the course of

the expansive capitalist “world system,”

Said explores the role of literature in forging a sense of a distinctly Western

343

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS cast in terms of a “core” of consumers

Austin’s seminal book moves the study of

who control and exploit the labour and

language away from a narrow focus on

resources of a poor “periphery.”

grammar to an investigation of languagein-use as a form of social activity.

———. 2004. World-Systems Analysis: An Introduction. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. explicates world-systems analysis three

Duranti, Alessandro. 2000. “An Historical Perspective on Contemporary Linguistic Anthropology.” Teaching Anthropology: SACC Notes 7.2: 20–4.

decades after he first proposed it.

A brief essay by a well-known linguistic

Wallerstein systematically and concisely

Warraq, Ibn. 2007. Defending the West: A Critique of Edward Said’s Orientalism. Amherst, NY: Prometheus Books. A trenchant critique of Orientalism, in which Warraq takes Said to task for misrepresenting both Western authors and the West’s interaction with nonWestern Others.

Wilcox, Clifford. 2006. Robert Redfield and the Development of American Anthropology. Lanham, MD: Rowman and Littlefield. A biography of the anthropologist who distinguished between “great” and “little” traditions.

Wolf, Eric R. 1982. Europe and the People without History. Berkeley: University of California Press. A well-known study drawing on the ideas of Immanuel Wallerstein and André Gunder Frank to argue that local cultures around the world are not self-contained, but develop in a dialectical relationship with the expansive forces of global capitalism.

Linguistic Anthropology Comes of Age

Austin, J.L. 1962 (2018). How to Do Things with Words. Eastford, CT: Marino Fine Books. 344

anthropologist that discusses the shortcomings of language study as seen by cultural anthropologists, and proposes a more contemporary teaching strategy that notes important paradigm shifts in linguistic anthropology.

Halliday, M.A.K. 1976. “Anti-Languages.” American Anthropologist 78: 570–84. This well-known essay examines the ways in which some linguistic varieties, or dialects, can be framed as oppositional to “dominant” varieties in societies characterized by stratification and unequal access to social power.

Hymes, Dell. 1964. “Introduction: Towards an Ethnography of Communication.” American Anthropologist 66.6: 1–34. In this pivotal essay in linguistic anthropology, Hymes moves language studies away from focus on the structure of language as abstracted from social context and toward a deeper study of the relations between linguistic form and content, and especially toward a stronger understanding of how communicative acts code for different types of significance in speech communities.

Labov, William. 2006 [1966]. The Social Stratification of English in New York City.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

An influential work examining the broad historical conditions, notably the

Labov’s classic sociolinguistic study of

development of print-capitalism and

language use in New York City is widely

the post-medieval voyages of discovery,

regarded as one of the first to explore the

which allowed nation-states to become

interrelations among language, social

“imagined” as new forms of community in

class, and situational context.

Europe and its colonies.

Lippi-Green, Rosina. 1997. English with an Accent: Language, Ideology, and Discrimination in the United States. New York: Routledge.

Berger, Peter L., and Thomas Luckmann. 1967. The Social Construction of Reality: A Treatise in the Sociology of Knowledge. New York: Doubleday.

In a significant contribution to US

An exposition of sociology that views

sociolinguistics and language ideology,

the “real” as being the non-objective

Lippi-Green discusses language

product of constructive processes, mainly

discrimination in the US. In particular,

language-related, in which people

she looks at how dominant perspectives

participate during daily life.

on “accent” are a tool in sustaining and perpetuating social inequities.

Woolard, Kathryn A., and Bambi B. Schieffelin. 1994. “Language Ideology.” Annual Review of Anthropology 23: 55–82.

Bourdieu, Pierre. 1977. Outline of a Theory of Practice. Trans. Richard Nice. New York: Cambridge University Press. Bourdieu’s best-known formulation of his theory of “practice” in which social unity and diversity are produced by creative,

Woolard and Schieffelin review

historically situated agents who actively

scholarly approaches to the study of

structure and restructure their worlds of

“metalinguistics” – social beliefs about

experience.

the roles, and valorization of, language varieties.

Postmodernity

Clifford, James. 1988. The Predicament of Culture:Twentieth-Century Ethnography, Literature, and Art. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.

AAA Statement on Race. 1998. www .americananthro.org/ConnectWithAAA /Content.aspx?ItemNumber=2583

Clifford’s reflections on how the

The American Anthropological

or identification, is undermined by the

Association’s official position on race,

powerful insight that ethnographies are

informed by the theories of social

textual artifice.

possibility of an “objective” description of culture, and even its very definition

constructionism.

Anderson, Benedict. Imagined Communities: Reflections on the Origin and Spread of Nationalism. London:Verso, 1991.

Clifford, James, and George E. Marcus, eds. 1986.Writing Culture:The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography. Berkeley: University of California Press. 345

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

research, proposing instead that

Foucault, Michel. 1973 [1965]. Madness and Civilization: A History of Insanity in the Age of Reason. Trans. Richard Howard. New York: Pantheon Books.

ethnographies are cultural “texts” in which

Foucault’s landmark investigation into

the ethnographer’s own subjectivities are

the contingent nature of, and historical

deeply embedded.

trajectory behind, Western beliefs about

The highly influential collection of essays that alerted anthropologists to the problematic character of “objectivist”

the condition of “insanity” and treatment

Comaroff, John, and Jean Comaroff. 1992. Ethnography and the Historical Imagination. Boulder, CO: Westview Press.

of the “insane.”

An influential call to rethink basic tenets

Foucault’s outline of his argument that

of the concepts of structure and function

“knowledge” and “truth” are inexorably

by focusing ethnographic attention on

linked to social and political power,

historical process and political-economic

and that buried beneath the off icial

transformation.

discourse of modernity and civilization

———. 1982. The Archaeology of Knowledge. New York: Pantheon Books.

are to be found echoes of dissenting

Cussett, Francois. 2008. French Theory: How Foucault, Derrida, Deleuze & Co. Transformed the Intellectual Life of the United States. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press.

“voices.”

A French perspective on the rollicking

Giddens, Anthony. 1979. Central Problems in Social Theory: Action, Structure, and Contradiction in Social Analysis. Berkeley: University of California Press.

and often divisive impact of postmodern

A sophisticated theoretical treatment of

thinking on American academic and

the interrelations among power, social

public intellectual life.

structure, and subjective agency.

Dirks, Nicholas B., Geoff Eley, and Sherry B. Ortner, eds. 1993. Culture/Power/ History: A Reader in Contemporary Social Theory. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.

Gramsci, Antonio. 1992. Prison Notebooks. Vol. 1. Trans. and ed. Joseph A. Buttigieg. New York: Columbia University Press.

A collection of theoretical statements

written while he was a prisoner,

informed by post-structuralism,

describing the ways in which power

postmodernism, and the views of Michel

inscribes itself on and insinuates its way

Foucault and Pierre Bourdieu.

into social life.

Feyerabend, Paul. 1993. Against Method. 3rd ed. London:Verso. The third edition of Feyerabend’s

———. 1996. Prison Notebooks.Vol. 2. Trans. and ed. Joseph A. Buttigieg. New York: Columbia University Press.

classic 1975 statement of philosophical

A continuation of Gramsci’s study of

anarchism.

power and hegemony.

346

Gramsci’s perspectives on power,

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

———. 2007. Prison Notebooks.Vol. 3. Trans. and ed. Joseph A. Buttigieg. New York: Columbia University Press.

Hobsbawm, Eric J., and Terence Ranger, eds. 1992. The Invention of Tradition. New York: Cambridge University Press.

The third volume of Gramsci’s study of

A collection of essays looking at the

power and hegemony.

historical process behind the recent production of “ancient” traditions – such

Grenfell, Michael. 2005. Pierre Bourdieu: Agent Provocateur. London: Continuum International.

as Hugh Trevor-Roper’s study of the

An account of Bourdieu’s views on many

“inventing” history in this way.

Scottish kilt – and the general problem of what social purposes might be served by

subjects, ranging from the Algerian war to capitalism.

———, ed. 2008. Pierre Bourdieu: Key Concepts. Montreal: McGill-Queen’s University Press.

Johnson, Thomas M., and Carolyn F. Sargent, eds. Medical Anthropology: A Handbook of Theory and Method. New York: Greenwood Press, 1990. A review of theory and method in medical

Experts explain Bourdieu’s key concepts

anthropology and ethnomedicine, and a

in terms accessible to both students and

survey of different ethnomedical systems.

scholars.

Grenfell, Michael, and Kate Paul. 2018. Bourdieu, Language-Based Ethnographies and Reflexivity: Putting Theory into Practice. Milton Park, UK:Taylor & Francis Ltd. An overview of Bourdieu-inspired

Landy, David, ed. 1977. Culture, Disease, and Healing: Studies in Medical Anthropology. New York: Macmillan. A comprehensive textbook that introduces readers to emic and etic dimensions of medical anthropology.

language-based ethnographic research, accompanied by a series of illustrative case studies.

Gutting, Gary, ed. 2005. The Cambridge Companion to Foucault. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Lawlor, Leonard, and John Nale, eds. 2014. The Cambridge Foucault Lexicon. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. A reference book comprising more than 100 entries identifying and explicating

Numerous essays on Foucault’s many

Foucault’s theoretical concepts as well

interests, from madness to sexuality, with

as the theorists who influenced him and

an extensive bibliography.

were influenced by him.

Hettinger, Blaine T. 2016. The Family Tree Guide to DNA Testing and Genetic Genealogy. Cincinnati, OH: Family Tree Books.

Lewontin, Richard. 1972. “The Apportionment of Human Variation.” Evolutionary Biology 6: 381–98.

An explanation of how DNA testing kits

that helped pave the way for undermining

work and what they can and cannot

the validity of the typological concept of

reveal.

race.

The influential study of human diversity

347

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Lindenbaum, Shirley, and Margaret Lock. 1993. Knowledge, Power and Practice:The Anthropology of Medicine and Everyday Life. Berkeley: University of California Press.

Preston, John, Gonzalo Munévar, and David Lamb, eds. 2000. The Worst Enemy of Science?: Essays in Memory of Paul Feyerabend. New York: Oxford University Press.

A collection of essays that examine the

Eight essayists evaluate the legacy

cultural production of ethnomedical

of the flamboyant and iconoclastic

knowledge in different societies.

opponent of traditional scientif ic epistemology.

Lock, Margaret, and Vinh-Kim Nguyen. 2010. The Anthropology of Biomedicine. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley-Blackwell. Two medical anthropologists bring

Sankar, Andrea. 1999. Dying at Home: A Family Guide for Caregiving. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.

nuance to the biomedical assumption of a

A cultural history of death and

standardized body isolated from cultural

caregiving at home, combined with an

context, focusing on the deployment of

anthropologically informed guide for

medical technologies around the world.

primary caregivers on how to look after patients in the home.

Lutz, Catherine. 1988. Unnatural Emotions: Everyday Sentiments on a Micronesian Atoll and Their Challenge to Western Theory. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

Scheper-Hughes, Nancy. 1992. Death without Weeping:The Violence of Everyday Life in Brazil. Berkeley: University of California Press.

A thought-provoking, postmodern

A widely read postmodern ethnography

ethnography of the “emotional” world of

in which Scheper-Hughes examines the

a small island in Micronesia, illuminating

cultural construction of knowledge about

the cultural basis of emotions and

health and illness in a poor Brazilian

highlighting inadequacies in how

community.

Western “scientific” theorists have divided the world into the categories of, among other dichotomies, “self” versus “other.”

Seidman, Stephen, ed. 1994. The Postmodern Turn: New Perspectives on Social Theory. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

Nichter, Mark. 2008. Global Health:Why Cultural Perceptions, Social Representations, and Biopolitics Matter. Tucson: University of Arizona Press.

Varied interpretations of postmodern

Writing for both activist social scientists

engagement to deal with, among other

Trevethan, Wenda R., E.O. Smith, and James L. McKenna. 2007. Evolutionary Medicine and Health: New Perspectives. Oxford: Oxford University Press.

global health issues, the resurgence of

Twenty-three articles shine an

infectious diseases.

evolutionary light on numerous

and public health practitioners and policy makers, the author advocates widespread

348

social science a decade after the postmodern perspective emerged.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS contemporary health and wellness issues

Ashford deconstructs the diverse

in cultures around the world.

connotations of the word globalization and in so doing addresses pressing global

Weinberg, Darin. 2014. Contemporary Social Constructionism: Key Themes. Philadelphia: Temple University Press.

issues of the day.

constructionist approach has played out

Coleman, Simon. 2000. The Globalization of Charismatic Christianity. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

across a wide swath of social sciences.

A contribution to the globalization-

A primer of sorts on how the social

focused literature, in which Coleman looks

Part Four: The Early Twenty-First Century Globalization

Appadurai, Arjun. 1996. Modernity at Large: Cultural Dimensions of Globalization. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press. An ethnographically based deconstruction of the concept of modernity.

______. 2013. The Future as Cultural Fact: Essays on the Global Condition. London: Verso Books. In a sequel to his 1996 book Modernity at Large, while drawing on his own fieldwork

at the cultural, political, and economic dimensions of a transnational religious movement.

Escobar, Arturo. 1995. Encountering Development:The Making and Unmaking of the Third World. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. An examination of the role of Western development policy – in Escobar’s view, the heir to colonial regimes – in creating, naturalizing, and economically subjugating the “Third World.”

Featherstone, Mike, ed. 1990. Global Culture: Nationalism, Globalization, and Modernity. London: Newbury Sage.

in Mumbai, India, Appadurai analyzes the

Various essays on the relations among

tangled web of forces affecting global

culture, nation, the world system, and

prosperity and poverty.

globalization.

_____. 2015. Banking on Words:The Failure of Language in the Age of Derivative Finance. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

Inda, Jonathan Xavier, and Renato Rosaldo, eds. 2007. The Anthropology of Globalization: A Reader. 2nd ed. London: Blackwell Publishing.

The eminent theorist of globalization turns

An introduction to anthropological

his attention to the global economic crisis

thinking about globalization, with

of 2008, blaming, alongside greed and

ethnographic specificity and attention to

corruption, language as a key cause.

global disaporas.

Axford, Barrie. 2013. Theories of Civilization. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.

Lewellen, Ted. 2002. The Anthropology of Globalization: Cultural Anthropology 349

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Enters the 21st Century. Westport, CT: Greenwood. A survey of anthropological interests in globalization, with special emphasis on migration, diasporas, and refugees.

Culture, Gender, and Sexualities

Foucault, Michel. 1990 [1978]. The History of Sexuality,Volume 1: An Introduction (The Will to Knowledge). New York: Vintage Books.

Logan, Robert K. 2013. McLuhan Misunderstood: Setting the Record Straight. Toronto: Key Publishing House.

The first in seminal social theorist and

Revisiting the work of pioneering

which Foucault deconstructs what he calls

communication theorist Marshall

the “repressive hypothesis,” according

McLuhan, the author shows how

to which all talk of human sexuality is

much McLuhan has to offer by way of

believed to have been suppressed in

understanding the roles and impacts of

Western culture from the seventeenth

modern social platforms and other digital

through the twentieth centuries.

historian Michel Foucault’s three-part “archaeology” of human sexuality, in

media.

McLuhan, Marshall, and Bruce R. Powers. 1989. The Global Village:Transformations in World Life and Media in the 21st Century. New York: Oxford University Press.

Herdt, Gilbert. 2005. The Sambia: Ritual, Sexuality, and Change in Papua New Guinea. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth Publishing. In this well-known example of contemporary studies in non-Western

Posthumous essays on the effects of

sexual practices and meanings, the

media and technology in a globalizing

Sambian ritualization of adolescent

world.

homosexuality followed by permanent adult heterosexuality provokes questions

Robertson, Roland. 1992. Globalization: Social Theory and Global Culture. London: Sage.

about sexual orientation as a feature of

A wide-ranging introduction to the debates that characterize the study of

Lyons, Andrew P., and Harriet D. Lyons, eds. 2011. Sexualities in Anthropology: A Reader. Malden, MA: Wiley-Blackwell.

globalization.

An edited collection that surveys the

political, economic, and cultural

evolutionary selection.

historical development of approaches to

Stiglitz, Joseph E. 2002. Globalization and Its Discontents. New York: W.W. Norton.

sexuality from within anthropology, with

From the perspective of globalization

century evolutionist to functionalist,

theory, a turn-of-the-century critique of

structuralist, and symbolic approaches,

how powerful financial institutions such

and with contemporary contributors

as the World Trade Organization, World

addressing a range of issues of concern

Bank, and International Monetary Fund

to twenty-first century anthropology,

have contributed to the perpetuation of

including the politics of sexual orientation

global inequalities.

and genital cutting.

350

contributions ranging from nineteenth-

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

McNabb, Charlie. 2017. Nonbinary Gender Identities: History, Culture, Resources. Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield. A pathfinder book and guide for

Valentine, David. 2007. Imagining Transgender: An Ethnography of a Category. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

nonbinary and binary individuals seeking

This study investigates the

to inform themselves about options for

institutionalization of the term

gender expression.

transgender to denote collective identity and the politics of a marginalized

Ortner, Sherry B. 1997. Making Gender: The Politics and Erotics of Culture. Boston: Beacon Press.

community, with Valentine tracking

A collection of essays in which social

1990s New York City.

the growth in the term’s popularity as a category of belonging and activism in

differences and hierarchy between men and women are explored in relation to broader ideas about “nature” versus “culture.”

———. 2006. Anthropology and Social Theory: Culture, Power, and the Acting Subject. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

Public Anthropology

Angel-Ajani, Asal,Victoria Sanford, Phillippe Bourgeois, et. al. 2006. Engaged Observer: Anthropology, Advocacy, and Activism. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press. Anthropologists who have done fieldwork

The well-known feminist scholar and

in dangerous and conflict-torn parts of

theoretician presents her views on critical

the world reflect on the many challenges

anthropological issues.

in attempting to benefit the populations they study.

Ortner, Sherry B., and Harriet Whitehead, eds. 1981. Sexual Meanings: The Cultural Construction of Gender and Sexuality. New York: Cambridge University Press. Essays on political and cultural contexts

Atalay, Sonya. 2012. Community-Based Archaeology: Research with, by, and for Indigenous and Local Communities. Oakland, CA: University of California Press.

for the social construction of gender

An archaeologist and Native American

difference in Western and non-Western

explains the benefits of archaeological

societies.

engagement with the communities implicated in archaeological research.

Pascoe, C.J. 2011. Dude,You’re a Fag: Masculinity and Sexuality in High School. Berkeley: University of California Press. This innovative ethnography looks at

Beck, Sam, and Carl A. Maida, eds. 2013. Toward Engaged Anthropology. New York: Berghahn Books.

how masculinity and male sexuality are

Various anthropologists chart a new

discursively and practically constructed

course toward participatory anthropology

in a racially diverse United States high

in aid of democratization and social

school.

justice.

351

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Besteman, Catherine. 2013. “Three Reflections on Public Anthropology.” Anthropology Today 29.6: 3–6.

Paradigms? Center for a Public Anthropology: Open Anthropology Series.

Besteman explores the varied definitions,

Turning the anthropological lens on the

epistemologies, and ethnographic/

discipline itself, a call for the reorientation

ethnoscape applications and effects of an

of academic anthropology away from

“engaged” versus a “public” anthropology.

the so-called publication treadmill toward a wider engagement with the

Besteman, Catherine, and Hugh Gusterson, eds. 2005. Why America’s Top Pundits Are Wrong: Anthropologists Talk Back. Berkeley: University of California Press.

public, promising greater health for the

A collection of essays in which leading

Brewis, A., A. Robinger, A. Wutich, E. Adams, et al. 2019. “Water Sharing, Reciprocity, and Need: A Comparative Study of Interhousehold Water Transfers in Sub-Saharan Africa.” Economic Anthropology 6.2: 208–21.

scholars join the conversation on important and highly charged public issues, such as poverty, racism, violence against women, and American foreign policy.

profession and greater good for the world at large.

In this recent contribution to public

Borofsky, Rob. 2005. Yanomami:The Fierce Controversy. Berkeley: University of California Press.

anthropology, the authors use

A pioneer public anthropologist offers

regions of water scarcity – findings

his views on the controversy surrounding

that they hope will affect public policy

anthropologists’ treatment of the

formation.

ethnographic methods to identify an important cross-cultural practice in

Yanomami of Venezuela.

An argument that the anthropological

Darnell, Regna, and Frederic W. Gleach, eds. 2015. Corridor Talk to Culture History: Public Anthropology and Its Consequences. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

industry of knowledge production has

Nine anthropologists recount how they

largely failed to live up to its promise

have brought their methods and theories

to “change the world,” challenging

to the attention of multiple publics.

———. 2011. Why a Public Anthropology? Honolulu: Center for a Public Anthropology.

anthropologists to find better and more compelling ways to create and sustain engagement with the mainstream public, and to create a more transparent and publicly accountable discipline.

Edwards, David B. 2010. “Counterinsurgency as a Cultural System.” Small Wars Journal 27 (December). Edwards provides a comprehensive

———. 2019. An Anthropology of Anthropology: Is It Time to Shift

352

analysis and evaluation of the Human Terrain System program as of 2010,

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS based on in-depth interviews and first-

concerning the exercise of American

hand observation of training at Fort

military power.

Leavenworth, Kansas.

A thoughtful review essay that examines

Gregory,Thomas, and Daniel R. Gross. 2004. “Guilt by Association:The American Anthropological Association’s Investigation of ‘Darkness in El Dorado.’” American Anthropologist 106.4: 687–98.

key themes and perspectives in several

A critical evaluation of the association’s

recent texts in public anthropology.

handling of accusations leveled against

Feinberg, Ben. 2006. “The Promise and Peril of Public Anthropology.” Human Rights & Human Welfare 6: 165–77.

anthropologist Napoleon Chagnon and

Fields, Alan Jeffrey. 2007. “Responsible Public Anthropology.” Public Anthropology. https://web.archive.org /web/20070927101934/http://www .publicanthropology.org/Journals /Grad-j/Wisconsin/fields.htm.

his colleagues over their fieldwork in Venezuela.

In this discussion, Fields illuminates

Hedican, Edward J. 2016. Public Anthropology: Engaging Social Issues in the Modern World. Toronto: University of Toronto Press.

advantages and disadvantages to erecting

In this comprehensive review, Hedican

public anthropology as a bridge between

discusses and analyzes many vectors of

academic researchers and their broader

public anthropology, in both historical

publics. In particular, he cautions against

perspective and current application.

the sacrifice of academic rigor for the sake

Among the topics discussed are

of activism, and vice versa.

anthropologists working in the fields of forensics, medical practice and public

Forman, Shepard, ed. 1995. Diagnosing America: Anthropology and Public Engagement. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.

health, legal and social justice activism,

A collection of essays advocating

challenging assumptions regarding the

Kelly, John D., Beatrice Jauregui, Sean T. Mitchell, et al., eds. 2010. Anthropology and Global Counterinsurgency. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

morally neutral character of anthropology.

A collection of published conference

anthropological engagement in the formulation of American public policy,

counterinsurgency, and technology and the media.

papers exploring the heated political

Gonzãlez, Alberto J., ed. 2004. Anthropologists in the Public Sphere: Speaking Out on War, Peace, and American Power. Austin: University of Texas Press.

and ethical debate surrounding anthropologists’ participation with the American military in counterinsurgency efforts in Afghanistan and elsewhere.

Several dozen examples of recent anthropological editorializing in nonacademic publications, especially

Lamphere, Louise. 2009. “David MayburyLewis and Cultural Survival: Providing

353

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

a Model for Public Anthropology.” Anthropological Quarterly 82.4: 1049–54.

An invitation to dialogue among anthropologists and other social scientists

Lamphere discusses the pioneering work

about the role of political engagement in

of David and Pia Maybury-Lewis, founders

a globalizing, postmodern world.

in 1972 of Cultural Survival, an NGO dedicated to protecting and advocating for Indigenous rights.

Lucas, George R. 2009. Anthropologists in Arms:The Ethics of Military Anthropology. New York: AltaMira Press.

Tierney, Patrick. 2000. Darkness in El Dorado: How Scientists and Journalists Devastated the Amazon. New York: W.W. Norton & Company. Tierney levels serious, and controversial, ethical charges against anthropologist

A book-length treatment of the ethical

Napoleon Chagnon and his colleatues

and epistemological issues surrounding

during their fieldwork among the

anthropological engagement with the

Yanomami people of Venezuela.

military and intelligence agencies, with

present, in which the military and civilian

Vine, David. 2011. “‘Public Anthropology’ in Its Second Decade: Robert Borofsky’s Center for a Public Anthropology.” American Anthropology 113.2: 336–40.

academics worked together in theaters

In this evaluation of the impact of

of war.

Robert Borofsky’s Center for a Public

special attention paid to the Human Terrain System (HTS) program and to the murky ethical problems that accompany this and other initiatives, past and

Anthropology, Vine reviews the objectives,

Purcell, Trevor W. 2000. “Public Anthropology: An Idea Searching for a Reality.” Transforming Anthropology 9.2: 30–3. A short editorial summarizing some of the main ambitions of public anthropology.

Rhodes, Lorna A. 2004. Total Confinement: Madness and Reason in the Maximum Security Prison. Berkeley: University of California Press.

successes, and failures of the initiative some ten years after it was founded.

World Traditions and Collaborative Anthropology

Boškovic´, Aleksandar, ed. 2010. Other People’s Anthropologies: Ethnographic Practice at the Margins. New York: Berghahn Books. An edited volume of essays by well-

A contribution to the University of

known anthropologists that documents

California Press “Public Anthropology”

the status, history, and character of

series, in which Rhodes explores the

ethnographic research outside the Anglo-

complex world and fragile politics of the

American and French traditions.

super-maximum-security prison.

Smith, Gavin. 1999. Confronting the Present:Towards a Politically Engaged Anthropology. New York: Berg. 354

Darnell, Regna, and Frederic W. Gleach, eds. 2014. Anthropologists and Their Traditions across National Borders. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press.

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Twelve anthropologists recount historically how prominent Western anthropologists

des Sciences de l’Homme. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.

have delved into the anthropologies of

A landmark study of witchcraft beliefs

peripheral national traditions.

and practices in western France. FavretSaada’s theoretical orientation emphasizes

Deloria,Vine, Jr. 1988 (1969). Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press.

the social production of knowledge and

An influential work outlining the many

into English.

the power of words to make social reality; a good, if rare, example of the rapid translation of a non-English monograph

ways in which Native Americans have

institutions (including the discipline of

Gellner, Ernest, ed. 1980. Soviet and Western Anthropology. New York: Columbia University Press.

anthropology).

A collection of essays exploring

been culturally decimated by various governmental, educational, and economic

convergence and divergence between

De Martino, Ernesto. 2005 [1961]. The Land of Remorse: A Study of Southern Italian Tarantism. Trans. Dorothy Louise Zinn. London: Free Association Books.

Western anthropologies and anthropology

An ethnographic exploration of “tarantula”

for the attention it pays to one of the

spirit possession in a southern region

twentieth century’s most significant non-

of Italy, a landmark work of Italian

Western anthropologies.

as constructed through the prism of Marxist theory (that is, dialectical materialism); though dated, valuable

anthropology, translated and published in English over 40 years after the appearance of its original Italian edition.

Fahim, Hussein, and Katherin Helmer. 1980. “Indigenous Anthropology in Non-Western Countries: A Further Elaboration.” Current Anthropology 21.5: 644–63.

Griaule, Marcel. 1965 [1948]. Conversations with Ogotemmêli: An Introduction to Dogon Religious Ideas [French: Dieu d’Eau: Entretiens avec Ogotemmêli]. Trans. Ralph Butler. New York: Oxford University Press. An early, seminal work of dialogical or collaborative ethnography, in which the

An account of perspectives, positions, and

“author” (French anthropologist Griaule)

themes presented at a 1978 conference

cedes much ethnographic authority and

held in Austria on the topic of indigenous

voice to the “informant” (Dogon priest

and non-Western anthropology; an

Ogotemmêli).

insightful narrative for providing a window onto “decolonizing” voices at an embryonic phase of the postmodern critique in anthropology.

Favret-Saada, Jeanne. 1980. Deadly Words: Witchcraft in the Bocage. Trans. Maison

Messerschmidt, Donald A. 1981. “On Indigenous Anthropology: Some Observations.” Current Anthropology 22.2: 197–8. In this short essay, Messerschmidt outlines his thoughts about what a decolonized,

355

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS “indigenous” anthropology could and should look like, with the suggestion that ethnographers might henceforth forge

Mental Illness in Rural Ireland. 20th Anniversary Ed. Berkeley: University of California Press.

a more ethical discipline by studying

In the f irst, award-winning edition

their own societies rather than those of

of this well-known ethnography of

colonized peoples.

rural Ireland, the author inadvertently revealed embarrassing details of

Restrepo, Eduardo, and Arturo Escobar. 2005. “‘Other Anthropologies and Anthropology Otherwise’: Steps to a World Anthropologies Framework.” Critique of Anthropology 25.2: 99–129.

informant biography recognized by

The authors set forth practical, political,

ostracized by her former informants.

and philosophical foundations for a

This work serves a cautionary tale

cosmopolitan anthropology that moves

to ethnographers about the ethical

beyond the hegemony of the Western

dillemmas posed in claiming authorial

tradition.

voice over and against strategies of

the informants themselves. In a new chapter in the twentieth anniversary edition, Scheper-Hughes writes with humility about the experience of being

dialogue and collaboration.

Ribeiro, Gustavo Lins. 2014. “World Anthropologies: Anthropological Cosmopolitanisms and Cosmopolitics.” Annual Review of Anthropology 48: 483–98. imperial, liberal, and radical outlooks,

Schmidt, Peter R., and Thomas C. Patterson, eds. 1995. Making Alternate Histories:The Practice of Archaeology and History in NonWestern Settings. Santa Fe, NM: School of American Research Press.

advocating a radical outlook that

An edited volume of essays by non-

problematizes Anglo-European hegemony

Western scholars that advances a

in the profession.

decolonizing critique of Western

A Brazilian anthropologist writes about

theoretical and research hegemony in the

Riberio, Gustavo Lins, and Arturo Escobar, eds. 2006. World Anthropologies: Disciplinary Transformations in Systems of Power. Oxford: Berg.

domains of archaeological and historical knowledge.

look at the processes involved in drawing

Van Maanen, John. 2011 [1988]. Tales of the Field: On Writing Ethnography. 2nd ed. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.

“world anthropologies” into a global

In this widely used textbook, Van

mainstream of anthropological practice,

Maanen introduces students to different

and at the tensions that inhere between

ways of imagining culture and writing

non-Western approaches and those of

ethnography – among them, the “jointly

the hegemonic anthropologies that the

told tale” of collaboration between

former threaten to displace.

researchers and informants.

Scheper-Hughes, Nancy. 2001 [1979]. Saints, Scholars, and Schizophrenics:

World Council of Anthropological Associations. https://www.wcaanet.org.

An edited volume in which contributors

356

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS Founded in 2005, an international

high technology is built into and affects

umbrella organization aimed at promoting

the everyday lifeworlds of workers and

communication and cooperation among

laborers in one of the tech industry

anthropologists in nations around the

centers of the world.

world, working on a range of ethnical, political, and practical issues.

Anthropologies of the Digital Age

Boellstorff, Tom. 2015. Coming of Age in Second Life: An Anthropologist Explores the Virtual Human. Rev. ed. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. Updating the initial 2008 edition of his

Gershon, Ilana. 2012. The Break-up 2.0: Disconnecting over New Media. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. An ethnography of how students use Facebook, Twitter, and other electronic platforms to carry on romantic relationships.

all virtual worlds derive from the innate

Ginsburg, Faye. 2008. “Rethinking the Digital Age.” In The Media and Social Theory, ed. David Hesmondhalgh and Jason Toynbee, pp. 127–44. London: Routledge.

human capacity for culture.

In this chapter of an edited volume,

book, the author presents an ethnography based on two years of research in the virtual world of Second Life, arguing that

Boellstorff,Tom, et al. 2012. Ethnography and Virtual Worlds: A Handbook of Methods. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. A comprehensive manual for conducting

Ginsburg discusses the ways in which discourses of the digital feed and update older narratives concerning the need for modernization of the non-modern world.

digital worlds, covering various facets of

Horst, Heather A., and Daniel Miller. 2006. The Cell Phone: An Anthropology of Communication. London: Berg.

participant observation, data collection,

A groundbreaking study of how cellphone

and interviewing.

technologies were adopted by Jamaicans

ethnographic research in online and

and the various uses to which this new

Coleman, E. Gabriella. 2010. “Ethnographic Approaches to Digital Media.” Annual Review of Anthropology 39.4: 487–505.

technology was put, with the authors investigating the economies of cellphone use and the effects of this technology on traditional social networks.

A comprehensive review of anthropological approaches to the study of digital technologies through 2010.

———, eds. 2012. Digital Anthropology. London: Berg. An edited volume of essays by

English-Lueck, J.A. 2002. Cultures@ Silicon Valley. Palo Alto, CA: Stanford University Press.

anthropologists, all of whom work on

Among the first ethnographic studies

with readings including, among others,

to investigate the many ways in which

examinations of social networking, file

issues surrounding digital culture and the social use of new technologies,

357

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS sharing, and the cultural significance of game design.

Lafontaine, Celine. 2007. “The Cybernetic Matrix of French Theory.” Theory, Culture, & Society 24.5: 27–46.

Sanjek, Roger, and Susan W. Tratner, eds. 2015. e-Fieldnotes:The Making of Anthropology in the Digital World. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press. An edited collection of anthropological

This article discusses the early efforts

essays that speak to the ways in which

by Claude Lévi-Strauss and other

new technologies have affected the

ethnologists to understand the

practices of ethnographic fieldwork,

implications of cybernetic research for

intended as a general update to Roger

anthropological, philosophical, and

Sanjek’s 1990 volume Fieldnotes: The

psychoanalytic theory.

Makings of Anthropology.

Miller, Daniel. 2011. Tales from Facebook. Cambridge: Polity.

cultural impact of the social networking

Underberg, Natalie M., and Elayne Zorn. 2013. Digital Anthropology: Anthropology, Narrative, and New Media. Austin: University of Texas Press.

platform Facebook across a range of

A volume exploring new ways to

societies, age-sets, and domains of everyday

think about cultural meaning and

life (including religion and marriage).

representation in multimedia, digitized

A study by a well-known anthropologist of material cultures investigating the profound

environments (especially the United

Nardi, Bonnie A. 2010. My Life as a Night Elf Priest: An Anthropological Account of World of Warcraft. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.

States and Peru), in particular looking at modes and tools for online representation of such social institutions as cultural heritage and education.

One of the few anthropological

comprising an ethnography probing the

Whitehead, Neil L., and Michael Wesch, eds. 2012. Human No More: Digital Subjectivities, Unhuman Subjects, and the End of Anthropology. Boulder: University Press of Colorado.

ways in which WoW players invent and

A book featuring a variety of

style new selves within a new form of

anthropological and postmodern essays

imagined community.

on the production of subjectivity within

monographs to date to comprehensively investigate the social dynamics and practices connected to an online cultural environment – World of Warcraft –

online environments, the engagement

Pertierra, Anna Christina. 2018. Media Anthropology for the Digital Age. Cambridge: Polity Press.

between online and “real world” cultural

A lively introduction to anthropologists’

including online communities and virtual

recent interest in digital communication,

worlds in Brazil, Amazonia, India, on

with an explanation of what anthropology

television, and across social networking

can bring to this field.

sites.

358

spaces, and the idea of the human, with foci of contributor engagement

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Anthropocene

Evans, Meredith, and Nadine Ryan. 2019. “(De)compositions: A Review of Anthropocene.” Fieldsights, April 29. In this brief review and analysis of an

thought and research for consideration and discussion, and various alternatives to Anthropocene are imagined in terms of their capacity to elide conventional epochal periodizations and the privileging of the human species.

“interactive multimedia” visual art exhibition dedicated to the Anthropocene

also draw attention to the paradoxes of

Latour, Bruno. 2014. “Anthropology at the Time of the Anthropocene: A Personal View of What Is to Be Studied.” Distinguished Lecture, American Anthropological Association Annual Meeting. http://www.bruno-latour.fr /sites/default/files/139-AAA -Washington.pdf.

the nature/culture binary and privileged

In this distinguished lecture to the

anthropos that continue to lurk within the

American Anthropological Association,

Anthropocene concept.

Latour, a pre-eminent anthropologist,

concept, Evans and Ryan map out how the exhibit displays represent Anthropocene as a concept that juxtaposes conflicting drives to voyeuristic pleasure derived from, and horror cultivated by, the concept’s colonial logic. The authors

philosopher, and scholar of science

Hann, Chris. 2017. “The Anthropocene and Anthropology: Micro and Macro Perspectives.” European Journal of Social Theory 20.1: 183–96.

and technology, reflects on the effects

In this review and critical analysis, Hann

paradoxes of placing human agency and

considers the role anthropologists can

anthropos at the center of a geologically

play in purging the Anthropocene concept

situated theoretical form, and the political

of Eurocentrism and taken-for-granted

relevance and controversial status of the

ideas about historical periodization. Both

concept.

of the Anthropocene concept across different fields of scholarship in the social and natural sciences, as well as on the

ethnographic and historiographical analysis, it is argued, are essential in order to understand the ways in which social perspectives of epochal transformation have changed over broad swathes of time.

Moore, Amelia. 2015. “Anthropocene Anthropology: Reconceptualizing Contemporary Global Change.” Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute 22: 27–46.

Haraway, Donna, Noboru Ishikawa, Scott F. Gilbert, et al. 2016. “Anthropologists Are Talking – About the Anthropocene.” Ethnos 81.3: 535–64.

In this ethnographically informed

In this wide-ranging conversation

unfold in relation to planetary ecological

among six eminent social and natural

crises. In her own work in the Bahamas,

scientists, the Anthropocene concept is

she shows how the social and ecological

explored and critiqued. Each participant

worlds are entangled in complex and

brings to the table aspects of their own

mutually constitutive ways.

discussion, Moore invites anthropologists to explore “Anthropocene spaces” as sites where new kinds of critical research can

359

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Tsing, Anna. 2016. “Earth Stalked by Man.” Cambridge Journal of Anthropology 34.1: 2–16.

An introductory essay to a centennial-

In this powerful essay, Tsing deracinates

their perspective on the history of

the Anthropocene concept from its

anthropological scholarship.

year edition of American Anthropologist, in which various contributors consider

Enlightenment origins and alerts us to the

of anthropic modern intrusions and

Durrani, Mariam. 2019. “Upsetting the Canon.” Anthropology News website. April 8.

“eruptions” into nature.

In this essay, Durrani reflects on the

futility of oversimplifying as global what is in reality a patchwork of uneven processes

dangers of uncritical reproduction of a

Conclusion

colonialist and patriarchal canon in the

Buell, Rebecca Renee, Samuel Burns, Zhuo Chen, et al. Decanonizing Anthropology. Footnotes (blog). 2019. https://footnotesblog .com/2019/02/15/decanonizing -anthropology/.

proposes instead a number of alternative

teaching of the anthropological. She readings and “reclaimed texts” drawn from her own classroom teaching experience.

at Oregon State University devise

Eastman, Charles A. (Ohhiyesa). 2003 [1911]. The Soul of the Indian. Mineola, NY: Dover Publications.

a “decanonized” anthropological

An important early contribution to US

history syllabus in which a variety of

ethnography by a Native American

important yet historically marginalized

scholar historically made invisible in the

anthropologists are foregrounded as

American academy and excluded from

central to any deep understanding of the

the traditional anthropological canon.

In this innovative blog post, students

field.

Da Col, Giovanni, Claudio Sopranzetti, et al. 2017. Why Do We Read the Classics? HAU: Journal of Ethnographic Theory 7.3: 1–38.

Gerald of Wales. 1983 (1187). The History and Topography of Ireland. New York: Penguin Classics. Welsh churchman and historian Gerald of Wales was among the earliest

A thoughtful series of essays by eight

“ethnographic” writers of the pre-

anthropologists of different backgrounds

professional era. His travels in and lucid

and interests, all of whom pose and

writing about medieval Wales and

ponder the same questions: among

Ireland, based on close observation, prove

them, “Why read the classics?” and “Do

inaccurate the stereotypical portrait of

the classics matter to contemporary

the intellectually “dark” European Middle

anthropology?’”

Ages.

Darnell, Regna, and Frederic W. Gleach. 2002. “Introduction.” American Anthropologist 104.2: 417–22.

Golub, Alex. 2014. “Is There an Anthropological Canon? Evidence from Theory Anthologies.” Savage

360

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS

Minds (blog). https:// savageminds.org/2014/04/06 /is-there-an-anthropological-canon -evidence-from-theory-anthologies/.

misrepresented and effectively demonized disciplinary ancestors, in the process reducing their use in current undergraduate and graduate curricula.

In this thought-provoking blog entry, Golub takes prominent readers in the history of anthropology to task for their choices regarding periodization, readings, and editorial positions – particularly as discussion of the field approaches the present.

Hallowell, A.I. 1965.The History of Anthropology as an Anthropological Problem. History of Behavioral Sciences 1:24–38.

———. 1999. “A Response to Sandy Toussaint’s Commentary: ‘Honoring Our Predecessors: A Response to Herbert Lewis’s Essay on “The Misrepresentation of Anthropology and Its Consequences.’” American Anthropologist 101.3: 609–10. In Lewis’s rejoinder to Toussaint’s review essay on his paper, he dismisses her

In a paper that is regarded by some as

criticisms on the grounds that they

the beginning of a reflexive “historical

do not relate to the intent of his thesis

anthropology of anthropology,” the

concerning the misrepresentation of

author proposes that in considering

anthropological ancestors.

the development of anthropology, we context(s) that gave rise to specific kinds

———. 2019. “The Way We Were?” Anthropology News 60.2: 10–12.

of anthropological questions relevant

In this update to his essay from 1999, Lewis

across the four fields.

again reflects on what he takes to be the

consider the cultural and historical

inaccurate treatment of the conventional

Hurston, Zora Neale. 2018. Barracoon:The Story of the Last “Black Cargo.” New York: Amistad Press.

“canon” of ancestors. He also frames the

In this important early contribution to

and professional sacrifices of many in the

dialogical ethnography, Hurston – a widely

traditional canon.

decolonizing turn as an unfair internal critique, given the ethical commitments

acclaimed African-American writer and

experience of the presumed last living

Mascia-Lees, Fran. 2006. “Can Biological and Cultural Anthropology Coexist?” Anthropology News 47.1: 9–13.

survivor of the African slave trade, Cudjo

A brief article in which Mascia-Lees

Lewis, whom she interviewed in 1927.

proposes that unity among the four fields

ethnographer historically occluded from the anthropological canon – explores the

will be achieved only if new paradigms are

Lewis, Herbert S. 1998. “The Misrepresentation of Anthropology and Its Consequences.” American Anthropologist 100.3: 716–31. Lewis asserts that in its eagerness for deconstruction, postmodern anthropological theory has

developed and questions asked that invite collaboration across diverse types of research.

McGee, R. Jon, and Richard L. Warms, eds. 2013. Theory in Social and Cultural Anthropology: An Encyclopedia. 2 vols. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications. 361

SOURCES AND SUGGESTED READINGS A reference work comprising more than 300 articles about anthropological theories and theorists accompanied by numerous user aids.

to Herbert Lewis’s Essay on ‘The Misrepresentation of Anthropology and Its Consequences.’” American Anthropologist 101.3: 605–9. Toussaint’s review essay of Lewis’s

Segal, Daniel A., and Sylvia J.Yanagisako, eds. 2005. Unwrapping the Sacred Bundle: Reflections on the Disciplining of Anthropology. Durham, NC: Duke University Press.

paper, in which she takes him to task

A provocative collection of essays in which

contributions of “old-time” versus “young”

contributors interrogate the value of, and

anthropologists.

for selectively eliminating early women anthropologists from his canon of ancestors and for reifying the relative

alternatives to, the reigning “four-field”

Smith, Eric Alden. 2006. “Anthropological Schisms.” Anthropology News 47.1: 8–11.

William of Rubruck. 2017 [c. 1253–5]. The Journal of William de Rubruck: Account of the Mongols. Scotts Valley, CA: CreateSpace Independent Publishing.

A brief article in which Smith calls on

Flemish Franciscan missionary William

anthropologists to recognize the value

of Rubruck was among the earliest pre-

of a four-field anthropology, especially in

professional ethnographers to visit and

terms of the potential contributions of the

write of a non-European culture: the

subfields to one another.

Mongols of the Volga River region in what

model of anthropology within the North American academy.

is today central Russia.

Thomas, R. Brooke. 2006. “Anthropology for the Next Generation.” Anthropology News 47.1: 9–11. the eclecticism of a four-field approach,

Wolf, Eric R. 1982. “Introduction.” In Europe and the People without History, pp. 3–23. Berkeley: University of California Press.

arguing that current disunities will

In this introductory chapter to a classic

be undetermined as pressing global

study in anthropological political

environmental problems demand research

economy, Wolf discusses the rise of

that spans anthropological scholarship.

distinctive social sciences and humanities

A brief article in which Thomas champions

disciplines as the outcome of structural

Toussaint, Sandy. 1999. “Honoring Our Predecessors: A Response

362

developments within European and North American universities.

Index Page numbers in italic represent images/maps. Adam and Eve, xxi, 9 adaptation, 133 adhesions, 34 African anthropology, 161, 225–6 agency and capitalism, 169–70, 171, 202 and colonization, 147 defined, 67 habitus, 191 and language, 180 and Parson’s framework, 151 alchemy, 7 Alexander the Great, 3 aliens, 41 allopathic treatments, 195–6 altruism, 55, 143 ambient pietism, 250 American Anthropological Association (AAA), xx, 163, 254 American Anthropologist (journal), 78, 254 American cultural anthropology, 77–104 overview, 77–8, 117 analog, 231 Anaximander, 2 ancestor worship, 35 Anderson, Benedict, 203 androcentrism, 159 anglocentrism, 222 anima, 34–5 anomie, 64 Anthropocene, 237–41, 255–6 anthropo-geography, 39 anthropological archaeology, xix, 153–4. See also various types of archaeology anthropological feminism, 158–64, 199, 205, 214 anthropological political economy, 165–76 overview, 165 anthropology and activism, 214–5 canon of, 245–55 as continuing colonization, 166, 246, 254–5 criticisms of field, 168–9, 173–4, 176, 193, 243– 8, 250 (see also diversity in; postmodernity)

and decolonization (see decolonization) diversity in, 160, 162–4 dominance of Anglo-North America, 221–3 as emergent, xxi and FBI/CIA, 28–30 first textbook, 34 future of, 254–7 history of, 244 and institutions, 245, 251–2, 254, 256–7 and Marxism, 28–30 and morality, 254 and privilege, 193, 214, 256 recognizing issues in field, 214 subfields of, xix–xx, 139, 215, 253–4 textbooks, 34, 82, 251–3 (see also canon of anthropology) and theory, xx–xxii translations of texts, 223–4 unity of, 253 See also various types Anthropology (Tylor), 34 Anthropology News (magazine), 250 anti-languages, 181, 182 antipodes, 11 antiquity, 1–5, 8, 9 anti-structure, 150 apes, 50, 139–40 applied anthropology, xix–xx, 213–6, 217–8, 251 Aquinas, Thomas, 6 archaeological anthropology, xix, 153–4. See also various types of archaeology archaeology See various types Argonauts of the Western Pacific (Malinowski), 107, 249 Aristotle, 3, 17 Ark Encounter park, 44, 45 armchair anthropologists, 34 Asad, Talal, 175 Atlantis, 12, 13 Augustine, Saint, 4, 11 Augustinian Christianity, 4–6 Austin, J.L., 177–8

INDEX australopiths, 139 authoritative knowledge, 169 autoethnography, 97 Aztecs, 13 Bahamian ecology, 239–40 Balinese cockfight, 153 band, 133 Barak District people (Afghanistan), 218 barbarism, 22, 32–3 Barracoon:The Story of the Last “Black Cargo” (Hurston), 246 Barth, Fredrik, 157–8, 224 basic personality structure, 101–2, 103 Batwai, Sam, 84 behavioral domain, 137 behavioral genetics, 142 Bell Curve,The (Hernstein and Murray), 140, 216 Benedict, Ruth, 87, 89, 90–2, 90 berdache, 206 Besteman, Catherine, 215–6 binary coding, 230, 235 binary oppositions, 119, 121 Binford, Lewis, 134–5, 153 binomial nomenclature, 51 bio-behavioral approaches, 141–3 biocultural anthropology, 141 biogenetic law, 56 bio-logic, 161 biological anthropology, xix, 139, 141. See also biological evolution biological classification of humanity, 48, 129 biological evolution, 35, 52–8, 131. See also Darwinism; evolution biologize, 139 biology of behavior, 139–40 biology of nepotism, 143. See also sociobiology biomedicine, 195–6 Black folklore, 93–6 Black Lives Matter, 256 Boas, Franz, 79–80 overview, 78–82 and Benedict, 89–90 and Freud, 100 and Hurston, 90–1, 93, 95 and Kroeber, 85 and later twentieth century influence, 117, 128–9 and Mead, 88 on natural and social sciences, 147 body language, 142 body-reasoning, 161 Bonaparte, Napoleon, 22–3 Boone, Richard D., 218 Borofsky, Robert, 210–3, 214

364

Bourdieu, Pierre, 186–7, 189–91 bourgeoisie, 22, 27 British empiricism, 16, 19 British social anthropology, 63, 104–16 overview, 104–5 Burnet, Thomas, 47, 49 California Series in Public Anthropology (book series), 211–2 Calvinist Protestantism, 69 canon of anthropology, 245–55 capitalism and anthropological field, 169 and community agency, 169–70, 171, 202 defined, 26 as dominant ideology, 170 and exploitation, 27 and medicine, 196 as world-system, 166 See also Marxism cargo cults, 147 catastrophism, 50 Catholicism, 10 cell phones, 233–4, 235 Center for a Public Anthropology, 210–2 cephalic index, 81 Chagnon, Napoleon, 210–1 Chaplin, Charlie, 26 charismatic prophets, 69, 70, 147 Child, Irvin, 102–3 Christianity and archaeology, 43 and catastrophism, 50 creationism, 44, 45, 47, 49, 51 and Darwinism, 55–6 emergence of, 4 vs. Enlightenment, 21 fundamentalist, 22–3 and inner-worldly asceticism, 69 Islam interaction, 6 and missionaries, 11–2 (see also colonization) mythology of, 112 See also various types chronos, 246 civilization and barbarism, 22, 32–3 Clark, Margaret, 163 class, 33. See also Marxism classical archaeology, xix, 8–9, 31, 41–7 classical cultural evolutionism, 30–7, 82. See also cultural neo-evolutionism classificatory kinship, 32 clines, 194 clitoridectomy, 208 code-switching, 179–80, 181, 182 cognitive anthropology, 128–9

INDEX Coleman, Gabriella, 231, 232 collaborative anthropology, 210, 213, 216–7 overview, 221–9 collective consciousness, 64 collective representations, 64 colonial encounter, 111–2 colonization and Anthropocene, 240 and anthropological field, 166, 246, 254–5 God and people, 12–3 Hawaii, 124–5, 126, 127 Imperial Synthesis, 44–5 and indigenous social order, 147 as intrusive, 115 neocolonialism, 217 and Oyewùmí’s studies, 161 Tenochtitlán, 13 See also decolonization; postcolonial perspective Coming of Age in Samoa (Mead), 89 communist revolution, 26 communitas, 150 Community Action Project (website), 212 comparative method, 20, 31, 135 componential analysis, 129 Comte, Auguste, 23–4 configurationalism, 87 Configurations of Culture Growth (Kroeber), 85 Connell, R.W., 206 consanguine, 32 conservatism, 22–3 contextual archaeology, 154, 154 contract societies, 33 Cook, James, 124–5, 126 Coon, Carleton, 14–5, 249 Copernicus, Nicolaus, 17 core nations, 166 Cortes, Herman, 13 cosmological order, 69 cosmology, 2, 16, 16–7, 127 COVID-19, 236, 256 creationism, 19, 44, 47, 49, 51 creative non-fiction, 245 creolization, 202 criterion of form, 39 critical anthropologists, 153–4 cross-cousins, 32 cross-cultural analysis, 10 cultural anthropology, xix, 77–8, 77–104, 141 overview, 117 cultural appropriation, 181, 182 cultural eclectics, 138 cultural ecology, 132–3 cultural evolutionism See classical cultural evolutionism; cultural neo-evolutionism

cultural idealists, 137–8 cultural materialism, 136–8 cultural neo-evolutionism, 130–5, 138. See also classical cultural evolutionism cultural relativism, 3, 89, 100, 126–7, 128, 228–9, 236. See also Boas, Franz; Evans-Pritchard, Edward Evan cultural resource management (CRM), 214 Cultural Survival, 209–10 Cultural Survival Quarterly (publication), 210 culture, defined, 19, 34, 170 culture areas, 37–8, 38 culture circle, 39 culture-at-a-distance, 91 culture-historical archaeology, 134 culturology, 131 Cuvier, Georges, 50 cybernetics, 230 Darkness in El Dorado: How Scientists and Journalists Devastated the Amazon (Tierney), 210–1 Darnell, Regna, 254, 255 Darwin, Charles, 31, 50, 51, 52–7 Darwinism, 47, 53–7 death, 238 decolonization as accountability, 199 and collaboration, 226–7 (see also collaborative anthropology) impacting field, 15, 250 and Indigenous archaeologists, 46–7 overview, 246–8 deconstruction, 184, 191 deduction, 16 deistic philosophy, 19 Deloria,Vine, Jr., 227 deme, 194 descent group, 114–5 descriptive kinship, 32 development and underdevelopment theory, 165 Dhareshwar,Vivek, 175 diachronic studies, 74 dialectical materialism, 24–30 dialects, 97, 178, 179–80, 181. See also diglossia diary disease, 186 dictatorship of the proletariat, 27 diffusionism, 37–41 digital, 230 digital age anthropology, 230–7 diglossia, 181, 182 discourses of power, 186–7 DNA, 52, 58–9 DNA testing kits, 194–5 dominant symbol, 149 Dominguez,Virginia, 163

365

INDEX Dot Com collapse, 232 Douglas, Mary, 122 doxa, 190 Du Bois, Cora, 102 dualism, 16 Duranti, Alessandro, 177, 180 Dürer, Albrecht, 9 Durkheim, Émile, 63–6, 117–8, 148, 223 Durrani, Mariam, 246–7 Eastman, Santee Dakta Sioux Charles, 247 economies, 157 ego, 60 Eldredge, Niles, 57–8 Electra complex, 62 elementary forms, 64 elementary structures, 65 emergent character, xxi emic theories, 128–9, 137 Empedocles, 2, 3–4 empiricism See British empiricism enculturation, 87–8 energy revolution, 132 Engels, Friedrich, 24, 25–7, 33 English-Lueck, J.A., 234, 235 Enlightenment, 18–22, 30 entropy, 131 environment of evolutionary adaptedness, 145 Epicurus, 3–4 epigenetic evolution, 58 epiphenomenon, 196 epistemology, 16 Erasmus, Desiderius, 10 espionage, 217 ethical behaviors, 68–9 ethnocentrism and anthropology’s conscience, 228 and Enlightenment philosophers, 19–20 and gender, 206 liberation from, 171, 175–6 and objectivity, 193 “primitive” vs. “civilized,” 169 and sexuality, 207 See also cultural relativism ethnography and archaeology, 31, 135 autoethnography, 97 and Center for a Public Anthropology, 210, 212 and cultural relativism, 228–9 New Ethnography, 129 and postmodernism, 192–3 salvage ethnography, 79–80 and thick description, 152 ethnography of communication (EOC), 178

366

ethnohydrology, 219–20 ethnolinguistics, 180 ethnomedical systems, 195 ethnoscience/ethnosemantics, 129 ethology, 141 ethos, 135 etic theories, 128–9, 137 eugenics, 40, 216 Eurocentricism, 68 Evans, Meredith, 240 Evans-Pritchard, Edward Evan, 109–12, 115, 174, 249 evolution accepted notions of, 43–4 and apes, 50 as controversial, 35, 44, 54, 55–7, 58 defined, 30 vs. diffusionism, 37–41 during Enlightenment, 51–2 general evolution, 134 multilineal evolution, 68, 133 neo-evolutionists, 31 during Scientific Revolution, 47, 49–50 specific evolution, 134 unilineal evolution, 133 See also biological evolution; classical cultural evolutionism; cultural neo-evolutionism; Darwinism evolutionary developmental biology (“evo-devo”), 58 evolutionary psychology, 145. See also sociobiology exogamy, 33 falling bodies, 16–8 false consciousness, 137 families, studies on, 32–3, 62 father figures, 62 Fazioli, K. Patrick, 7, 247–8 female infanticide, 33 feminist anthropology, 158–64, 199, 205, 214 Feyerabend, Paul, 185–6 fields (Bourdieu’s theory), 190 first cause, 6 Fischer, Eugen, 40 fixed action pattern, 141 folk medicine, 195, 196 folk taxonomies, 129 folklore, 93–6 formalists, 123 Fortes, Meyer, 114–5 Foucault, Michel, 186–9, 207–8, 223, 244 Frank, André Gunder, 165–6 Frazer, James, 35, 36 French rationalism, 16

INDEX French Revolution, 22, 23 French structural anthropology, 63, 112, 118–23, 126–7, 223, 230–1 overview, 118 See also structural Marxism; structuralism; structure of the conjuncture Freud, Sigmund, 59–62, 61, 88, 100 Freudian anthropology, 100–2 Friedman, Jonathan, 124 feudalism, 26–7 functionalism, 104, 108, 115 Galilei, Galileo, 17–8 Geertz, Clifford, 151–3 Geisteswissenschaften, 81 gender, 144, 159, 161–2, 205–6 genealogical method, 106 general evolution, 134 general systems theory, 135 generalized exchange, 121 genetics, 57, 142–3, 194–5 geographical explorations, 11–3, 15, 19–20 geology, 49–50, 56–7 Gerald of Wales, 247–8 gestalt, 91 G.I. Bill, 222 gifts, 66–7, 119, 219 Ginsburg, Faye, 232–3 giraffes, 52, 54 Gleach, Frederic W., 254, 255 global village, 200 globalization, 200–5, 201, 203, 204, 214 glocalization, 202 Gluckman, Max, 113–4 God and archaeology, 43 as creator of universe, 19, 44, 47, 49, 51 and divine intervention, 22, 45 and early thought systems, xxi and French rationalism, 16 grace and will, 69 and madness, 187–8 and Native peoples, 11 and nature, 6 as perfect, 5 and society, 65 See also Christianity Gould, Stephen Jay, 57–8 Grave Creek Burial Mound, 46 gravity, 18 Great Chain of Being, 51 great man theory of history, 85 great tradition, 168 group mind, 64 group selection, 55

Gumperz, John, 178 Gusterson, Hugh, 215–6 habitus, 191 Haraway, Donna, 239 Harris, Marvin, 136–8 Hegel, Georg Wilhelm Friedrich, 25–6 hegemony, 170, 204, 209 heliocentrism, 38–9 hereditarianism, 39, 55 hermeneutics, 147 Herodotus, 2 Herrnstein, Richard J., 216 Heyerdahl, Thor, 41, 42 Hinduism, 175 historical archaeologists, xix historical linguistics, 71 historical particularism, 80 history of the present, 244 Hodder, Ian, 154 Holocaust, 40 Holocene, 238 Homo sapiens, 14, 35, 52, 54 Horst, Heather A., 233, 235–6 Hospet, India, 203 human biogram, 142 human exceptionalism, 238 Human Genome Diversity Project, 59 Human Genome Project, 59 human sociobiology, 144 Human Terrain System (HTS), 216–8, 218 humanism, xxi, 2 Hurston, Zora Neale, 92–8, 94, 246 Hutton, James, 49 Huxley, Thomas, 50, 54–5, 56 Hymes, Dell, 178–9 hypothetico-deductive model, 135 hysteria, 60 idealism, 25 ideational views, 67–70 ideologies, 170 idiographic approach, 81 id/libido, 60, 61, 62 illocutionary acts, 177–8 immigration, 182 Imperial Synthesis, 44 incest, 62 inclusive fitness, 143 independent invention, 37 indigenous anthropology, 228, 229 Indigenous archaeology, 46–7 Indigenous Peoples See Native peoples indirect rule, 115

367

INDEX induction, 16 informants, 31–2 infrastructural determinism, 137–8 inheritance of acquired characteristics, 52 innate releasing mechanism, 142 inner-worldly asceticism, 69 insanity, 187–9 instrumental symbols, 149 International Union of Geological Sciences, 238 Internet, 204, 231, 232, 234–5 interpretive anthropology, 110, 146, 147–8, 151–3, 155 interpretive archaeology, 154 intersex, 208 IQ, 140 Ishi (Yana Indian), 84, 85–6 Islam, 6 ivory tower, 212 Jackson, John L., 249 Japanese anthropology, 225 Jensen, Arthur, 140 Jensenism, 140 Jesus Christ, 70 jointly told tales, 229 kairos, 246 Kardiner, Abram, 100–2, 103 Kepler, Johann, 17 key stimulus, 142 kin selection, 143 kinesics, 142 kinship, 32–3, 106, 120–1, 123, 219–20 knowledge, 187, 189 Kon-Tiki raft, 41, 42 Kroeber, Alfred Louis, 83, 84, 85–7, 86 K-selection, 140 Kuhn, Thomas, 185–6 kula ring, 108, 108 Kulturkreis, 39–40 labor theory of value, 27 Labov, William, 179–80 Lamarck, Jean-Baptiste Pierre Antoine de Monet, 52 Lamarckism, 56, 57 Lamphere, Louise, 162–4, 163, 210, 213 landscape archaeology, 154–5, 154 language anglocentrism, 222 anti-languages, 181, 182 body language, 142 of future, 204 of Native peoples, 72–3, 98–9 and publishing texts, 226 Standard American English, 181

368

Standard Average European, 99–100 translations of texts, 223–4, 225 See also linguistic anthropology language ideology, 182 langue, 73, 180 Latin American anthropology, 225–6 layer-cake model of culture, 132, 135 Le Guin, Ursula Kroeber, 87 Leach, Edmund, 112, 223 Leonardo da Vinci, 8 Lévi-Strauss, Claude, 118–22, 124, 126–7, 183, 223, 230–1 Lewis, Herbert, 248–9, 250, 251 Lewontin, Richard, 194 LGBTQ people, 205–6, 208 liminality, 149, 150 lineages, 107 linguistic anthropology, xix, 71, 98–9, 128, 177–82, 255 overview, 177 linguistics, 71–4 link-up, 233 Linnaean classification, 48, 129 Linnaeus, Carolus, 48, 51 little tradition, 168 Locke, John, 19 logic, 216 Lowie, Robert, 82–3, 83 Lubbock, John, 34, 44 Lyell, Charles, 43, 49–50, 54 Machiavelli, Niccolò, 10 madness, 187–9 magic, 35 Maine, Henry, 33 maintenance systems, 103 Malinowski, Bronislaw, 109 overview, 107–8, 115–6 and British social anthropology, 104 as controversial, 207, 228, 248 Malthus, Thomas Robert, 53 Manchester School, 113–4 Marx, Karl, 24–7, 33, 64 Marxism overview, 24–30 archaeologists, 46 and Harris, 138 legacy of, 225 in mid-1970s, 155 and nihilism, 3 structural Marxists, 123–4 and White, 130–1, 132 and the world system, 165–6 masculinity, 206 Mason, Charlotte Osgood, 95

INDEX materialism, 25, 26, 28 matrilateral cross-cousin marriage, 121 matrilineal kinship, 32 Maugliki, Atamau, 101 Mauss, Marcel, 66–7 McCarthy, Joseph, 29 McLennan, John, 33 McLuhan, Marshall, 200 Mead, Margaret, 87, 88, 89–90, 92, 207 means of production, 25 mechanical philosophy, 19 mechanical solidarity, 63 mechanics, 16–7 medical anthropology, 195–7 medieval synthesis, 7 Meggers, Betty, 134 men, 144, 192, 206 Mendel, Gregor, 57 mental domain, 137 mentalité, 247, 249 Messerschmidt, Donald, 228 methodological individualism, 156 Metrics Project, 212 Michigan school, 134 Middle Ages, 5–7, 247 Midwestern Taxonomic Method, 134 military, 216–8, 218 Miller, Daniel, 233, 235–6 missing links, 56 Modern Times (film), 26 modernity, 183–4, 186 modernization, 165–6 modernization theory, 233 Mohammed, 6 monogenesis, 13 monotheism, 35 Moore, Amelia, 239–41 morality, 55–6 More, Thomas, 10 Morgan, Lewis Henry, 31–3, 132, 247 Moses,Yolanda, 163 Moundbuilder Myth, 44 multiculturalism, 175 multilineal evolution, 68, 133 multivocality, 149 Murray, Charles, 216 museological, 214 mutations, 57 Myers, Fred, 249 naked apery, 140 Nardi, Bonnie A., 234–5 national character studies, 91 Native peoples Alorese personalities, 101, 102

Azande society, 111 Aztecs, 13 and collaboration, 213 (see also collaborative anthropology) and Cultural Survival, 210 Dogon people, 227 and Durkheim, 65 and Eastman, 247 and first contact, 11–2 and Grave Creek Burial Mound, 44, 46 health and illness, 195, 196 Hopi language, 98–9, 99 and Human Genome Diversity Project, 59 and Imperial Synthesis, 44 Indigenous anthropology, 228, 229 Indigenous archaeology, 46–7 Inuit language, 72–3 Ishi (Yana Indian), 84, 85–7 Kachin peoples, 112 and Kroeber, 84 and Lowie, 83 and modern anthropology, 15 and Morgan, 31–2 Native Hawaiians, 124–5, 126, 127 Ndembu people, 148, 149–50 North American Native peoples, 20, 20, 38, 227 Nuer society, 110–1, 110 in Patterns of Culture (Benedict), 91 policy of Indian termination and assimilation, 227 Trobriand Islanders, 107–9 Two Spirit people, 206 Yanomami and Amazon researchers, 211 Yoruban society, 161 Zande people, 174 natural children, 12 natural selection, 54, 56–7, 194. See also Darwinism natural slaves, 11 nature, 139, 145 nature vs. nurture, 139–45 Naturwissenschaften, 81 Nazism, 39–41, 82 Neel, James, 210–1 neocolonialism, 217 neo-evolutionists, 31. See also cultural neo-evolutionism neoliberal economics, 216 Neolithic period, 43 Neptunists, 49–50 New Archaeology, 134–5, 138, 153 New Ethnography, 129 New Physical Anthropology, 141 New Stone Age, 43 New World, 11, 12–3, 41 Newton, Isaac, 17–8, 19, 47

369

INDEX nihilism, 3, 184 Noah’s Ark, 45 noble savagery, 20 nominalism, 245 nomothetic approach, 81, 132–3, 135 nonbinary, 208 non-governmental organizations (NGOs), 240 normal science, 185 North America, 38 Norwegian anthropology, 157–8, 224 Nuer society, 110–1, 110 nurture, 139, 145 Obeyesekere, Gananath, 125 obscurantism, 127 Oedipus complex, 62 Ogotemmêli, 227 Old Stone Age, 43 Old World, 13 One Flew Over the Cuckoo’s Nest (film), 188 online games, 234–5 organic solidarity, 64 organic/organismic analogy, 104, 105 Orientalism (Said), 173–5 Origin of Races, The (Coon), 14 On the Origin of Species (Darwin), 53–4, 57 original sin, 10 orthogenesis, 52 oscillating equilibrium, 112 Other/Othering, 15, 169, 175, 222, 226–7 Oyewùmí, Oyèrónké, 161 Paleolithic period, 43 paradigms, 185 Parker, Ely, 31–2 parole, 73, 180 Parsons, Elsie Clews, 162 Parsons, Talcott, 151 participant-observation, 108, 110 patriarchy, 160 patrilateral cross-cousin marriage, 121 patrilineal kinship, 32, 33 Patterns of Culture (Benedict), 91 perfectibility, 21 performance, 180, 199 periphery, 166 perlocutionary acts, 178 personality variables, 103 phenotype, 142 philosophical anarchism, 185 phonemes, 119 phonetics, 128 phylogeny, 56 pietism, 22 Pike, Kenneth, 128–9

370

Piliavsky, Anastasia, 250 Pioneer Fund, 140, 216 Plato, 3 Playfair, John, 49 pleasure principle, 61 policy of Indian termination and assimilation, 227 political economy, 165–76 overview, 165 pollution, 122 polyandry, 33 polygenesis, 13–4, 80–1 polygenic components, 142 polysemous signifiers, 73 polytheism, 35 populism, 215–6 Positivism, 22–4 positivism and archaeology, 135 defined, 24 and insanity, 188 and linguistic anthropology, 177 as misguided, 191 and public/applied anthropology, 251 and “value-free” science, 28 postcolonial perspective, 161, 171–6. See also collaborative anthropology; decolonization posthuman turn, 241 postmodernity, 183–97, 192–3, 200, 201–3, 214 overview, 183–5, 184, 186 post-processual archaeology, 154–5 post-secondary education, 222–3 post-structuralism, 183–4 potlatch, 133 poverty, 27 power, 186–7, 190 practice/praxis, 190 Prague School, 119 Praise of Folly,The (Erasmus), 10 precontact archaeology, xix prehistoric archaeology, xix, 8–9 prehistory, 30–1, 42–4 presentism, 250 primal patricide, 62 primary cultural institutions, 101–2, 103 primeval family, 62 primitive communism, 25 Prince,The (Machiavelli), 10 processual archaeology, 135. See also New Archaeology profane, 65 progress, 21 projective systems, 103 proletariat, 27 Protagoras, 2–3 Protestantism, 10, 12–3

INDEX protests, 167, 167, 208 proxemics, 142 psyche, 60 psychic unity, 37 psychodynamic approach, 101–2, 103 psychological anthropology, 87, 100–3 psychology, 59–62, 61, 145 Ptolemy, 17 public anthropology, xx, 173, 209–20, 251, 255 overview, 209–11 punctuated equilibrium, 57–8 purity, 122 Putnam, Carleton, 14–5 queer, as term, 208 “race” biological vs. cultural anthropology, 141 as constructed, 20 monogenesis, 13 and Nazism, 39–41 polygenesis, 13–4 racial “types,” 14–5 and social constructionism, 194–5 racial memory, 61 racism archaeology recognizing, 46–7 The Bell Curve (Hernstein and Murray), 140, 216 in biological anthropology, 55 and clichés, 207 as current, 249 defined, 39 Imperial Synthesis, 44 Jensenism, 140 Origin of Races, The (Coon), 14 polygenism, 13–4, 80–1 and Rushton, 140 scientific racism, 140 and sociobiologists, 144 structural racism, 256 See also Nazism Radcliffe-Brown, Alfred Reginald, 104, 105–7, 114–6 rationalism See French rationalism rationalized, 69 Ratzel, Friedrich, 39 reality principle, 61 reason, 21 reciprocal altruism, 143 reciprocity, 66, 119–21, 124, 229 recombinant DNA, 58–9 Redfield, Robert, 168, 168 reflexivity, 184

refugees, 173 relatively nonprivileged, 68 religion, xxi. See also various religions Renaissance, 8–10 repressive hypothesis, 207 Republic (Plato), 3 restricted exchange, 121 revitalization movement, 147 Rhodes, Cecil, 172 Rhodes-Livingstone Institute, 113 rhoticity, 179–80 ritual process, 150 rituals, 65, 68, 148 rituals of rebellion, 113–4 Rivers, William H.R., 106 Robertson, Roland, 200, 202 Rosaldo, Michelle, 164 Rosenberg, Alfred, 40 Rousseau, Jean-Jacques, 20, 165 r-selection, 140 ruling class, 25 Rushton, J. Phillippe, 140 Russian social anthropology, 225 Ryan, Nadine, 240 sacred, 65 Sahlins, Marshall, 124–6, 133–4, 144, 223 Said, Edward W., 173–5 salvage ethnography, 79–80 salvation, 68 Sapir, Edward, 98 Sapir-Whorf hypothesis, 98–9, 99 Saussure, Ferdinand de, 71–4 savagery/barbarism/civilization, 21, 32–3 scapes, 204 Scheper-Hughes, Nancy, 228 Schieffelin, Bambi B., 182 Schmidt, Wilhelm, 39 Scholasticism, 6–7 science anthropology as part of, xxi Classical, 2 and classical cultural evolutionism, 35–6 normal science, 185 and positivism, 24 questioning, 18 scientific racism, 140 Scientific Revolution, 15–8, 47, 49–50 scientific revolution, 185 Searle, John, 178 second law of thermodynamics, 131 secondary cultural institutions, 101–2, 103 secularism, 175 semantic domain, 129 semiotics, 151

371

INDEX seriation, 43 Service, Elman, 133–4 sexual selection, 55 sexuality overview, 205–9 and Coming of Age in Samoa, 89 and Malinowski’s work, 107, 109, 207 and naked apery, 139 and pleasure principle, 61 and primeval family, 62 shamans, 35 signified/signifiers, 72–3, 74 signs, 72–3 Silicon Valley, 234 Silicon Valley Cultures Project, 234 slavery, 14 Smith, Grafton Elliot, 39 social activism, 167, 167, 208. See also Boas, Franz social capital, 192 social constructionism, 193–4 Social Darwinism, 56. See also Darwinism social dynamics, 23 social facts, 64 social function, 105 social morphology, 105 social physiology, 105 social process, 113 social science, 19, 23 social statics, 23 social structure, 105, 107 sociobiology, 142–5. See also evolutionary psychology sociolinguistics, 180 Socrates, 3 solidarity, 63–4, 121, 148–9 solipsism, 127, 184 Sophistry, 2–3 souls, 34–5 Southwest School, 81 Spanglish, 181 species, 51–2 specific evolution, 134 speciocide, 238 speculative fabulation, 239 speech acts, 177–8, 180, 181 speech community, 178 speech events, 178, 180, 181 Spencer, Herbert, 34–5, 56 Standard American English (SAE), 181 Standard Average European (SAE) languages, 99–100 status societies, 33 Steward, Julian, 132–3 Stoicism, 4, 19 Stone Age, 43

372

Stonewall Riots, 208 Strathern, Marilyn, 160 stratigraphy, 43 structural Marxism, 123–4 structural racism, 256 structural-functionalism, 104, 107, 110, 112, 167–8 structuralism, 104, 119, 124–7, 145. See also French structural anthropology; post-structuralism structure of the conjuncture, 125–6 struggle for existence, 53 subconscious, 60 sublimation, 61 subsidiarity/subsidium, 7 substantivists, 123 superego, 60 superorganic concept, 85 survival of the fittest, 53 survivals, 34 swamping effect, 57 symbolic anthropology, 110, 146, 147–50, 148–50, 155 symbolic capital, 190–1 symbolic domination, 190 symbolic interactionism, 156 symbolic turn in anthropology, 146–8 symbols, 147–9 sympathetic magic, 35 synchronic, 74 synchronic study, 105 synthetic philosophy, 56 Synthetic Theory of Evolution, 57, 141 taboos, 62 tabula rasa, 4, 19 Taussig, Michael, 171 taxonomies, 190, 191 technology, 231–6, 240 teleology, 52 text (of culture), 152, 191–5 Thales, 2 theistic philosophy, 19 theodicy, 68 thermodynamic law, 131–2 thermodynamics, 131–2 thesis-antithesis-synthesis, 25 thick description, 152 Third Gender, 206 Thomas, David Hurst, 45–6 Thomas, R. Brooke, 253 Thomistic Christianity, 6–7 Thomsen, Christian, 42–3 Three Age System, 42–3 Tierney, Patrick, 210–1 timeline of anthropology theory, xvii–xviii Todd, Zoe, 229

INDEX totemic structure, 120 totems, 65 transactionalism, 156–8 transcendental essences, 3 transgender, 205–6 transmigration, 35 travel writing, 2, 247–8 truth, xxi, 187, 189, 216 truthy, 216 Turner,Victor, 114–5, 148–50 Turtles All the Way Down (story), 152 twentieth century overview, 77, 117–8 twenty-first century, overview, 199–200 Two Spirit, 206 Tylor, Edward Burnett, 34–5 typological thinking, 141 underdevelopment theory, 165, 166 uniformitarianism, 50 unilineal evolution, 133 unilineal kinship systems, 32 United Nations General Assembly, 219 universal evolution, 133 universal historians, 21 universal pattern, 137 Utopia (More), 10 values as universal, 3 van Gennep, Arnold, 150 vernacular of resistance, 181 vitalism, 52 Volksgeist, 23, 39 Vulcanists, 49–50 vulgar materialists, 28

Wallace, Alfred Russel, 53, 54, 146–7 Wallerstein, Immanuel, 166 war, 216–8, 218 Washburn, Sherwood L., 141 water, 219–20 weapons of mass destruction, 256 Web 2.0, 232 Weber, Max, 67–9, 146 White, Leslie, 130–2, 131, 133–4 Whiting, John, 102–3 Whorf, Benjamin Lee, 98 Why America’s Top Pundits Are Wrong: Anthropologists Talk Back (Besteman and Gusterson), 215–6 Wilson, Daniel, 43 Wilson, Edward O., 143, 144 Wissler, Clark, 37–8 witchcraft, 111 Witchcraft, Oracles, and Magic among the Azande (Evans-Pritchard), 111, 249 women, 119–21, 124, 144. See also feminist anthropology Woolard, Kathryn A., 182 world anthropologies, 222 World of Warcraft (WoW), 234–5 world-system theory, 165, 166, 202 Worsaae, Jens J.A., 43 Worsley, Peter, 147 Wutich, Amber, 219–20 xenophobia, 144 Y2K, 231–2 Zeno, 4

373